Hadithi wa Kiroho ya Miji Miwili

Mfalme, kiongozi wa dini, wakuu wa serikali, wote walilazimika kutii na kufuata amri za watu waliochafuka mawazoni na kuwa kama wenda wazimu. Wale waliotangaza kifo cha mfalme walimfuata pia kwa kumnyonga. Machinjano yalikuwa mengi sana. Watu wote wliodhaniwa kuwa hawayaungi mkono mapinduzi walichinjwa ovyo. Ufaransa ikawa mbuga ya majeshi ya watu wasio na utaratibu, wakizunguka zunguka na kuchijana. Katika mji wa Paris machafuko yalikuwa yakifuatana mfululizo, na raia waligawanyika katika vikundi vya usaliti; visivyokuwa na jambo la kufanya ila kuzungukazunguka tu na kufanya ghasia …… Nchi ilikuwa karibu kufilisika, jeshi la askari ililikuwa likifanya ghasia, likidai mishahara ya nyuma ambayo haikulipwa. Watu katika mitaa walikuwa shidani kukosa chakula, mikoani kulijaa maharamia ambao walipora kila kitu kilichoonekana, na ustaarabu ulikuwa katika ukingo wa kutoweka kwa ajili ya fujo na ghasia zilizoenea kila mahali bila mtu wa kuzikomesha. Kengele iliyopigwa usiku wa manane ndiyo iliyokuwa alama ya machinjo yake. Mfalme, kiongozi wa dini, wakuu wa serikali, wote walilazimika kutii na kufuata amri za watu waliochafuka mawazoni na kuwa kama wenda wazimu. Wale waliotangaza kifo cha mfalme walimfuata pia kwa kumnyonga. Machinjano yalikuwa mengi sana. Watu wote wliodhaniwa kuwa hawayaungi mkono mapinduzi walichinjwa ovyo. Ufaransa ikawa mbuga ya majeshi ya watu wasio na utaratibu, wakizunguka zunguka na kuchijana. Katika mji wa Paris machafuko yalikuwa yakifuatana mfululizo, na raia waligawanyika katika vikundi vya usaliti; visivyokuwa na jambo la kufanya ila kuzungukazunguka tu na kufanya ghasia …… Nchi ilikuwa karibu kufilisika, jeshi la askari ililikuwa likifanya ghasia, likidai mishahara ya nyuma ambayo haikulipwa. Watu katika mitaa walikuwa shidani kukosa chakula, mikoani kulijaa maharamia ambao walipora kila kitu kilichoonekana, na ustaarabu ulikuwa katika ukingo wa kutoweka kwa ajili ya fujo na ghasia zilizoenea kila mahali bila mtu wa kuzikomesha. Kengele iliyopigwa usiku wa manane ndiyo iliyokuwa alama ya machinjo yake.

newcovenantpublicationsintl
from newcovenantpublicationsintl More from this publisher
15.04.2023 Views

New Covenant Publications International Ltd. S<strong>wa</strong>hili<br />

Hakimiliki © 2020. Machapisho <strong>ya</strong> Kimataifa <strong>ya</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

Haki zote zimehifadhi<strong>wa</strong>. Hakuna sehemu <strong>ya</strong> kitabu hiki inaweza kunakili<strong>wa</strong> au zinaa<br />

katika aina yoyote au k<strong>wa</strong> njia yoyote ile bila idhini <strong>ya</strong> maandishi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mwenye<br />

hakimiliki, isipoku<strong>wa</strong> nukuu fupi k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi la mapitio, maoni, au taaluma. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

mas<strong>wa</strong>li au habari zaidi, <strong>wa</strong>siliana na k<strong>wa</strong> mchapishaji.<br />

Haki zote zimehifadhi<strong>wa</strong>. Hakuna sehemu <strong>ya</strong> kitabu hiki inaweza kutole<strong>wa</strong>, kutunz<strong>wa</strong> au<br />

kunakili<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> muundo au k<strong>wa</strong> namna yoyote, iwe k<strong>wa</strong> elektroniki, kimakanika,<br />

kufotokopi, ku-rekodi au vinginevyo pasipo ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> maandishi <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi<br />

isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kutoa sehemu kama rejea katika kufundisho. K<strong>wa</strong> taarifa na kibali unaweza<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>asiliana na mchapishaji.<br />

ISBN: 359-2-85933-609-1<br />

ISBN: 359-2-85933-609-1<br />

Akaorodhesha Katika - Publication Cataloging (CIP)<br />

Kuhariri na Kubuni: Kundi la Kimataifa <strong>ya</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

Kuchapish<strong>wa</strong> nchini Uingereza.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>nza Uchapishaji Mei 26 M<strong>wa</strong>ka 2020<br />

Kuchapish<strong>wa</strong> na: Machapisho <strong>ya</strong> Kimataifa <strong>ya</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

New Covenant Publications International Ltd.,<br />

Kemp House, 160 City Road, London, EC1V 2NX<br />

Tembelea tovuti: www.newcovenant.co.uk


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ellen White


Mfalme, kiongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini, <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> serikali, wote <strong>wa</strong>lilazimika kutii na kufuata amri za<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liochafuka ma<strong>wa</strong>zoni na ku<strong>wa</strong> kama wenda <strong>wa</strong>zimu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liotangaza kifo cha<br />

mfalme <strong>wa</strong>limfuata pia k<strong>wa</strong> kumnyonga. Machinjano <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> mengi sana. Watu wote<br />

wliodhani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong>ungi mkono mapinduzi <strong>wa</strong>lichinj<strong>wa</strong> ovyo. Ufaransa ika<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbuga <strong>ya</strong> majeshi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>sio na utaratibu, <strong>wa</strong>kizunguka zunguka na kuchijana. Katika<br />

mji <strong>wa</strong> Paris machafuko <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kifuatana mfululizo, na raia <strong>wa</strong>liga<strong>wa</strong>nyika katika<br />

vikundi v<strong>ya</strong> usaliti; visivyoku<strong>wa</strong> na jambo la kufan<strong>ya</strong> ila kuzungukazunguka tu na kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

ghasia …… Nchi iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kufilisika, jeshi la askari ililiku<strong>wa</strong> likifan<strong>ya</strong> ghasia, likidai<br />

mishahara <strong>ya</strong> nyuma ambayo haikulip<strong>wa</strong>. Watu katika mitaa <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> shidani kukosa<br />

chakula, mikoani kulijaa maharamia ambao <strong>wa</strong>lipora kila kitu kilichoonekana, na<br />

ustaarabu uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika ukingo <strong>wa</strong> kutoweka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> fujo na ghasia zilizoenea kila<br />

mahali bila mtu <strong>wa</strong> kuzikomesha. Walipoanza mapinduzi k<strong>wa</strong> ukubali <strong>wa</strong> mfalme <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipata <strong>wa</strong><strong>wa</strong>kilishi wengi zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> kila hali. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo<br />

mwingi zaidi. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>jui jinsi <strong>ya</strong> kutumia uwezo huo kiakili. Waka<strong>wa</strong><br />

wenye kuonea na kudhulumu <strong>wa</strong>tu. Halafu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaazimia kujipigania na kulipa kisasi.<br />

Walioone<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>geukia <strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>onea.<br />

Pambano Kuu<br />

Sura 15 - Uta<strong>wa</strong>la Wa Ufaransa Wa Kitisho: Ukweli Wake<br />

Ellen G. White


Ukurasa huu umeach<strong>wa</strong> tupu k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi.


New Covenant Publications<br />

International Ltd.<br />

Vitabu Vilivyorekebish<strong>wa</strong>, Akili Zilizobadilish<strong>wa</strong><br />

New Covenant Publications International Ltd.,<br />

Kemp House, 160 City Road, London, EC1V 2NX<br />

Email: newcovenantpublicationsintl@gmail.com


Shukrani<br />

Kitabu hiki ni kujitolea k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu Baba.


Dibaji<br />

New Covenant Publications International inaunganisha tena msomaji na mpango<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kimungu <strong>wa</strong> kuufunga mbingu na dunia na kuimarisha utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

upendo. Nembo, Sanduku la Agano lina<strong>wa</strong>kilisha urafiki kati <strong>ya</strong> Kristo Yesu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu Wake na umuhimu <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Kama ilivyoandik<strong>wa</strong>, “hii itaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

agano nitakalofan<strong>ya</strong> na nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Israeli asema B<strong>wa</strong>na, nitaweka sheria <strong>ya</strong>ngu<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong>o na kuiandika mioyoni m<strong>wa</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu Wangu, nami nitaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>o.” (Yeremia 31:31-33; Waebrania 8:8-10). K<strong>wa</strong> kweli, agano jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

linashuhudia ukombozi, uliosababish<strong>wa</strong> na ugomvi na kuwek<strong>wa</strong> muhuri na damu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi, wengi <strong>wa</strong>mevumilia mateso mazito na ukandamizaji<br />

usioeleweka, uliound<strong>wa</strong> ili kufuta ukweli. Hasa katika Enzi za Giza, nuru hii<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> imeping<strong>wa</strong> vikali na kufich<strong>wa</strong> na mila <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu na ujinga <strong>wa</strong> umma,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu wenyeji <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>medharau na <strong>wa</strong>likiuka agano<br />

hilo. Athari <strong>ya</strong> maele<strong>wa</strong>no na maovu <strong>ya</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong>lichochea janga la<br />

udhoofishaji usiodhibitika na un<strong>ya</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>saji <strong>wa</strong> kiibilisi, ambapo <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong> kafara k<strong>wa</strong> njia isiyo haki, <strong>wa</strong>kikataa kutoa uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dhamiri. Hata<br />

hivyo, maarifa <strong>ya</strong>liyopotea <strong>ya</strong>lifufuli<strong>wa</strong>, has<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Enzi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> 16 ilizua <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> ukweli, mabadiliko <strong>ya</strong><br />

kimsingi na mtikisiko, kama unavyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika Upingaji <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Hata hivyo, kupitia kiasi hiki, unagundua tena umuhimu usiobadilika <strong>wa</strong><br />

mapinduzi ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> umoja kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mtazamo <strong>wa</strong> Wageuzi na mapainia wengine<br />

jasiri. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> maoni <strong>ya</strong>o, unaweza kuele<strong>wa</strong> vita vinavyoibuka, sababu za<br />

kimsingi zinazosababisha upinzani huo na uingiliaji <strong>wa</strong> ajabu.<br />

Wito wetu: “Vitabu Vilivyorekebish<strong>wa</strong>, Akili Zilizobadilish<strong>wa</strong>,” hututhibisha<br />

utofauti <strong>wa</strong> tanzu <strong>ya</strong> fasihi, uliotung<strong>wa</strong> katika <strong>wa</strong>kati mgumu na athari <strong>ya</strong>ke. Pia<br />

inaangazia dharura <strong>ya</strong> ubadilishaji <strong>wa</strong> kibinafsi, kuzali<strong>wa</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> na mabadiliko.<br />

Wakati uchapishaji <strong>wa</strong> Gutenberg, pamoja na shirika la tafsiri, ulivyosambaza<br />

kanuni za imani iliyorekebish<strong>wa</strong>, miaka 500 iliyopita, vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> habari v<strong>ya</strong><br />

kidijitali na vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> habari mtandaoni vinge<strong>wa</strong>siliana katika kila lugha kuhusu<br />

taa <strong>ya</strong> ukweli n<strong>ya</strong>kati hizi za mwisho.


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong>


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

2


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Yaliyomo<br />

Sura 1. Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Hali <strong>ya</strong> Mwicho <strong>wa</strong> Ulimwengu ............................................................... 6<br />

Sura 2. Ubatizo <strong>wa</strong> Moto ....................................................................................................... 13<br />

Sura 3. Giza la Kiroyo Katika ................................................................................................ 17<br />

Sura 4. Wanakinga Imani...................................................................................................... 23<br />

Sura 5. Nuru Inangaa Katika Uingereza ................................................................................ 30<br />

Sura 6. Mashujaa Wawili ....................................................................................................... 37<br />

Sura 7. Mapinduzi Yanaanza ................................................................................................. 47<br />

Sura 8. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Korti ........................................................................................................... 58<br />

Sura 9. Nuru Ili<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> Katika Usuisi .................................................................................. 69<br />

Sura 10. Maendeleo Katika Ujeremani .................................................................................. 73<br />

Sura 11. Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Waana <strong>wa</strong> Wafalme .......................................................................... 79<br />

Sura 12. Mapambazuko Katika Ufransa ................................................................................ 84<br />

Sura 13. Katika Uholandi na Scandanavia ............................................................................ 95<br />

Sura 14. Ukweli Unaendelea Katika Uingereza .................................................................... 99<br />

Sura 15. Mapinduzi <strong>ya</strong> Ufaransa ......................................................................................... 107<br />

Sura 16. Kutafuta Uhuru Katika Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong> ..................................................................... 117<br />

Sura 17. Ahadi za Kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo .................................................................................. 121<br />

Sura 18. Nuru Mp<strong>ya</strong> Katika Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong> ............................................................................ 129<br />

Sura 19. Sababu gani Uchungu Mkub<strong>wa</strong> Ule? .................................................................... 142<br />

Sura 20. Upendo k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo .................................................................. 147<br />

Sura 21. Kutes<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Aijili <strong>ya</strong> Mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> Mpumbafu ao Mjinga .............................. 156<br />

Sura 22. Unabii Unatimilika ................................................................................................ 163<br />

Sura 23. Siri <strong>ya</strong> Wazi <strong>ya</strong> Pahali Patakatifu .......................................................................... 171<br />

Sura 24. Kristo Anafan<strong>ya</strong> Kazi Gani Sasa? ......................................................................... 178<br />

Sura 25. Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu Isiyogeuka ................................................................................. 181<br />

Sura 26. Washujaa k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Ukweli .............................................................................. 190<br />

Sura 27. Mabadiliko <strong>ya</strong> Kweli ............................................................................................. 194<br />

Sura 28. Hukumu Nzito ....................................................................................................... 201<br />

3


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 29. Asili <strong>ya</strong> Uovu ......................................................................................................... 206<br />

Sura 30. Uadui <strong>wa</strong> Shetani ................................................................................................... 212<br />

Sura 31. Pepo Wachafu ........................................................................................................ 214<br />

Sura 32. Namna <strong>ya</strong> Kumshinda Shetani .............................................................................. 216<br />

Sura 33. Kinacholala Ng’ambo <strong>ya</strong> Pili <strong>ya</strong> Kaburi ............................................................... 223<br />

Sura 34. Roho za Wafu? ...................................................................................................... 230<br />

Sura 35. Uhuru <strong>wa</strong> Zamiri Unatish<strong>wa</strong> ................................................................................. 235<br />

Sura 36. Migogoro Inayokaribia .......................................................................................... 243<br />

Sura 37. Maandiko - Mlinda Yetu Pekee ............................................................................. 248<br />

Sura 38. Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu Ulio <strong>wa</strong> Mwisho .................................................................... 252<br />

Sura 39. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> Taabu ................................................................................................... 257<br />

Sura 40. Ukombozi Mkub<strong>wa</strong> ............................................................................................... 265<br />

Sura 41. Dunia katika Uharibifu .......................................................................................... 273<br />

Sura 42. Vita Imemalizika ................................................................................................... 277<br />

4


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

5


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 1. Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Hali <strong>ya</strong> Mwicho <strong>wa</strong> Ulimwengu<br />

Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kilele cha Mizeituni, Yesu akatazama juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema. Mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

makutano kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na majengo mazuri <strong>ya</strong> hekalu. Kushuka k<strong>wa</strong> jua kukaangazia weupe <strong>wa</strong><br />

teluji <strong>wa</strong> kuta zake za marimari na kumulikia mnara <strong>wa</strong> zahabu na mnara mrefu<br />

mwembamba (Pinnacle). Mtoto gani <strong>wa</strong> Israeli aliweza kutazama juu <strong>ya</strong> maajabu ha<strong>ya</strong> bila<br />

kufurahi sana na kushangaa! Lakini ma<strong>wa</strong>zo mengine <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> moyoni m<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. “Naye<br />

alipokaribia, akaona muji, akalia juu <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Luka 19:41.<br />

Machozi <strong>ya</strong> Yesu haiku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe, inga<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Getesemane, mambo <strong>ya</strong> maumivu makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyokaribia, na si mbali sana na, Kalvari,<br />

mahali pa kusulubi<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini haiku<strong>wa</strong> mambo hayo <strong>ya</strong>liyotia kivuli juu <strong>ya</strong>ke katika saa hii<br />

<strong>ya</strong> furaha. Alilia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema <strong>wa</strong>takaoangamiz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Historia <strong>ya</strong> zaidi <strong>ya</strong> miaka elfu <strong>ya</strong> upendeleo <strong>wa</strong> kipekee <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na ulinzi mkub<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

ulifunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong>, ilifunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> macho <strong>ya</strong> Yesu. Yerusalema<br />

uliheshimi<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia yote. B<strong>wa</strong>na “amechagua Sayuni ... ku<strong>wa</strong> kao lake”.<br />

Zaburi 132:13. K<strong>wa</strong> miaka mingi, manabii <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitoa ujumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

maonyo. Siku k<strong>wa</strong> siku damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na kondoo iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitole<strong>wa</strong>, ikionyesha M<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

Kondoo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Israeli kama taifa angalilinda utii <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, Yerusalema ungalisimama milele,<br />

mchaguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Lakini historia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liopendelez<strong>wa</strong> iliku<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong><br />

kukufuru na kuasi. Zaidi kuliko upendo <strong>wa</strong> huruma <strong>wa</strong> baba, Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye<br />

“huruma k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke na makao <strong>ya</strong>ke”. 2 Mambo 36:15. Wakati maombi na makaripio<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liposhind<strong>wa</strong>, alituma za<strong>wa</strong>di bora sana <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni, M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu Mwenyewe, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutetea pamoja na muji usiotubu <strong>wa</strong> moyo mgumu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> miaka mitatu B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> nuru na utukufu aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiingia na kutoka miongoni<br />

m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Akifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi njema na kuponyesha wote <strong>wa</strong>lioone<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani”.<br />

Kuhubiri wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong>, na vipofu kupata kuona tena, kuwezesha viwete<br />

kutembea, na viziwi kusikia, kutakasa wenye ukoma, kufufua <strong>wa</strong>fu, na kuhubiri Habari<br />

Njema k<strong>wa</strong> masikini. Tazama Matendo 10:38; Luka 4:18; Matayo 11:5.<br />

Mtembezi asiye na makao, aliishi k<strong>wa</strong> kusaidia wenye mahitaji na kupunguza misiba <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu, ku<strong>wa</strong>sihi kukubali za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> uzima. Mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> huruma <strong>ya</strong>liyoping<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ie<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na mioyo migumu, <strong>ya</strong>karudia na mwendo <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> huruma, upendo<br />

usioelezeka. Lakini Israeli akamuacha Rafiki <strong>wa</strong>ke mwema na Msaidizi <strong>wa</strong> pekee.<br />

Maombezi <strong>ya</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kazarauli<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Saa <strong>ya</strong> tumaini na musamaha iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikipita upesi. Wingu lile ambalo liliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

likijikusan<strong>ya</strong> katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> kukufuru na kuasi iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kupasuka juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye<br />

6


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kosa. Yeye ambaye peke <strong>ya</strong>ke alipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>okoa k<strong>wa</strong> hatari <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kifo amezarauli<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

kutukan<strong>wa</strong>, kukatali<strong>wa</strong>, na aliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kusulubi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Kristo alipotazama Yerusalema, mwisho <strong>wa</strong> muji mzima, taifa lote, uliku<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Alisikia malaika m<strong>wa</strong>ngamizi pamoja na upanga ulioinuka juu <strong>ya</strong> mji ambao uliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu makao <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Katika mahali palepale ambapo baadaye pakashik<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Tito na jeshi lake, akatazama k<strong>wa</strong> bonde vi<strong>wa</strong>nja vitakatifu na mabaraza. Na machozi<br />

machoni akaona kuta kuzunguk<strong>wa</strong> na majeshi <strong>ya</strong> kigeni. Alisikia shindo la jeshi kutembea<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> vita, sauti za <strong>wa</strong>mama na <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>lililia mkate ndani <strong>ya</strong> muji uliozunguk<strong>wa</strong>. Aliona<br />

nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ke takatifu, majumba <strong>ya</strong>ke na minara, <strong>ya</strong>kitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ndimi za moto, fungu la<br />

kuharibika lenye ku<strong>wa</strong>ka na kutoka moshi.<br />

Kutazama katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati, aliona <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> ahadi kuta<strong>wa</strong>nyika katika kila inchi, “kama<br />

mavunjiko <strong>ya</strong> merikebu k<strong>wa</strong> p<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>ya</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong>”. Huruma <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, upendo mkuu, <strong>ya</strong>kapata<br />

usemi katika maneno <strong>ya</strong> kusikitisha: “Ee Yerusalema, unaoua manabii, na ku<strong>wa</strong>piga k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mawe <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ko! Ni mara ngapi nimetaka kukusan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>ko pamoja,<br />

kama vile kuku anavyokusan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>ke chini <strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke, lakini ninyi<br />

hamukutaka”! Matayo 23:37.<br />

Kristo aliona katika Yerusalema mfano <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu uliokazana katika kutoamini na<br />

kuasi, ukijiharakisha k<strong>wa</strong> kukutana na hukumu za kulipiza kisasi cha Mungu. Moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ukashik<strong>wa</strong> na huruma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liohuzunish<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong> na dunia. Alitamani sana<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>fariji wote. Alitaka kutoa roho <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kifo k<strong>wa</strong> kuleta wokovu karibu nao.<br />

Mtukufu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni katika machozi! Mambo ile huonesha namna gani ni vigumu<br />

kuokoa mwenye kosa k<strong>wa</strong>matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kuharibu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Yesu aliona ulimwengu<br />

kujitia katika madanganyo kama <strong>ya</strong>le ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lileta uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema. Zambi<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kukataa Kristo; zambi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu ingeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukataa sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, msingi <strong>wa</strong> serekali <strong>ya</strong>ke katika mbingu na dunia. Mamilioni<br />

katika utum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zambi,ambao <strong>wa</strong>tahukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong> pili, <strong>wa</strong>liweza kukataa<br />

kusikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong> kweli katika siku <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> hukumu.<br />

Uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Hekalu Tukufu<br />

Siku mbili kabla <strong>ya</strong> Pasaka, Kristo akaenda tena na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mizeituni kutazama mji. Mara moja tena akatazama hekalu katika fahari <strong>ya</strong> kungaa k<strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

taji la uzuri. Solomono, aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye busara kuliko <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> Israeli, alimaliza<br />

hekalu la k<strong>wa</strong>nza, jengo nzuri kuliko ambalo dunia haijaona. Baada <strong>ya</strong> maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Nebukadneza, ikajeng<strong>wa</strong> tena karibu miaka mia tano kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Lakini hekalu la pili halikulingana na la k<strong>wa</strong>nza katika uzuri. Hakuna wingu la utukufu,<br />

hakuna moto kutoka mbinguni, ulioshuka juu <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Sanduku, kiti cha rehema,<br />

na meza <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda havikupatikana pale. Hakuna sauti kutoka mbinguni iliyojulisha<br />

kuhani mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Hekalu la pili halikutukuz<strong>wa</strong> na wingu la utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu,<br />

7


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

lakini lilitukuz<strong>wa</strong> na ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> uhai k<strong>wa</strong> yule ambaye aliku<strong>wa</strong> Mungu mwenyewe katika<br />

mwili. “Mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> mataifa yote” <strong>ya</strong>likuja k<strong>wa</strong> hekalu lake <strong>wa</strong>kati Mtu <strong>wa</strong> Nazareti<br />

alipofundisha na kuponyesha katika vi<strong>wa</strong>nja takatifu. Lakini Israeli alikataa za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong><br />

matoleo <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Pamoja na M<strong>wa</strong>limu mnyenyekevu aliyepita kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mlango<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> zahabu siku ile, utukufu ukatoka hata milele k<strong>wa</strong> hekalu. Maneno <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>litimia: “Nyumba yenu imeach<strong>wa</strong> kwenu tupu”. Matayo 23:38.<br />

Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong>lishangaz<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> utabiri <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong> maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> hekalu, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litamani kufahamu maana <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Herode Mkub<strong>wa</strong> alitoa k<strong>wa</strong> ukarimu juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

hekalu hazina za Waroma na Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi. Vipande vikub<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> marimari nyeupe,<br />

vilipelek<strong>wa</strong> kutoka Roma, vikafan<strong>ya</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> ujenzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liita uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o, kusema: “Tazama mawe na majengo ha<strong>ya</strong>”! Marko 13:1.<br />

Yesu akatoa jibu la <strong>wa</strong>zi na la kushitusha: kweli nina<strong>wa</strong>mbia ninyi, Halitabaki jiwe juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> jiwe pasipo kubomole<strong>wa</strong>”. Matayo 24:2. B<strong>wa</strong>na ali<strong>wa</strong>ambia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi k<strong>wa</strong>mba atakuja<br />

mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, alipotaja hukumu juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema, mafikara <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>karejea k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kurudi, na <strong>wa</strong>kauliza: “Maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati gani? na nini alama <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ko, na <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia”? Matayo 24:3.<br />

Kristo akaonyesha mbele <strong>ya</strong>o ishara <strong>ya</strong> mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuonekana kabla <strong>ya</strong><br />

kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati. Unabii alioutaja uliku<strong>wa</strong> na sehemu mbili maana <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakati<br />

ulipoku<strong>wa</strong> ukitabiri uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema, unabii huu ulionyesha pia mfano <strong>wa</strong> matisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho.<br />

Hukumu zilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Israeli k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>likataa na <strong>wa</strong>kasulubisha<br />

Masi<strong>ya</strong>. “Basi <strong>wa</strong>kati munapoona chukizo la uharibifu lililosem<strong>wa</strong> na Danieli nabii,<br />

likisimama k<strong>wa</strong> pahali patakatifu (yeye anayesoma afahamu), halafu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lio katika<br />

Yudea <strong>wa</strong>kimbie k<strong>wa</strong> milima”. Matayo 24:15,16. Tazama vile vile Luka 21:20,21. Wakati<br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida za kuabudu sanamu za Waroma zitakapo wek<strong>wa</strong> katika ki<strong>wa</strong>nja kitakatifu inje <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuta za mji, ndipo <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>tapash<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta usalama katika kukimbia. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takao okoka ha<strong>wa</strong>pashwe kuchele<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi zake, hasira ilikwisha kutaj<strong>wa</strong><br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema. Ugumu <strong>wa</strong> kuto kuamini k<strong>wa</strong>ke ulifan<strong>ya</strong> maangamizo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli.<br />

Tazama Mika 3:9-11.<br />

Wakaaji <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema <strong>wa</strong>limshitaki Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> chanzo cha taabu zote ambazo zilifika<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong>o katika matokeo <strong>ya</strong> zambi zao. Inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>limjua yeye ku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa, <strong>wa</strong>katangaza<br />

kifo chake ku<strong>wa</strong> cha lazima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> salama <strong>ya</strong>o kama taifa. Wakapatana katika<br />

maamuzi <strong>ya</strong> kuhani <strong>wa</strong>o mkuu k<strong>wa</strong>mba inafaa mtu mmoja afe k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

taifa lote lisiangamie. Tazama Yoane 11:4753.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>liua Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> sababu alikemea zambi zao, <strong>wa</strong>kajizania <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liopendele<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu na kutumainia B<strong>wa</strong>na ku<strong>wa</strong>komboa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

adui zao! Uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Karibu miaka makumi ine B<strong>wa</strong>na alikawisha hukumu<br />

8


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

zake. Kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kungali Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, <strong>wa</strong>jinga ambao ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua tabia na kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>toto ha<strong>wa</strong>kufurahia nuru ambayo <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>liikataa k<strong>wa</strong> zarau katika mahubiri <strong>ya</strong><br />

mitume, Mungu aliwezesha nuru kuangaza juu <strong>ya</strong>o. Waliona namna gani unabii ulitimia, si<br />

katika kuzali<strong>wa</strong> tu na maisha <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, bali katika kifo chake na ufufuo. Watoto<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi za <strong>wa</strong>zazi; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lipokataa nuru ingine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liope<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> zambi za <strong>wa</strong>zazi na <strong>wa</strong>kajaza kipimo cha uovu <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi katika ugumu <strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kakataa shauri la mwisho la rehema. Ndipo<br />

Mungu akaondoa ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>o. Taifa likaach<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> mwongozi lililo<br />

mchagua. Shetani akaamsha tamaa kali sana na mba<strong>ya</strong> kuliko za roho. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kakosa akili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kata<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu na hasira <strong>ya</strong> upofu, <strong>ya</strong> shetani katika ukaidi <strong>wa</strong>o. Marafiki na ndugu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasalitiana <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o. Wazazi <strong>wa</strong>kaua <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o, na <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o. Wata<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kujita<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe. Tamaa ika<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jeuri.<br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>kakubali ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> uwongo k<strong>wa</strong> kuhukumu M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu asiye na<br />

kosa. Sasa mashitaki <strong>ya</strong> uwongo <strong>ya</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o ku<strong>wa</strong> si <strong>ya</strong> haki. Kuogopa Mungu<br />

hakuku<strong>wa</strong>shitusha tena. Shetani aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiongoza taifa.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> makundi <strong>ya</strong> upinzani <strong>wa</strong>kaanguka mmoja juu za mwingine na ku<strong>wa</strong> bila<br />

huruma. Hata utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> hekalu haukuweza kuzuia ukali <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> kutisha. Mahali<br />

patakatifu pakanajisi<strong>wa</strong> na miili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lioua<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>shawishi <strong>wa</strong> kazi hii <strong>ya</strong> kishetani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na hofu yo yote k<strong>wa</strong>mba Yerusalema ingeharibi<strong>wa</strong>!<br />

Uliku<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Hata <strong>wa</strong>kati majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Waroma <strong>wa</strong>lipozunguka hekalu, makundi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lisimama imara k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zo k<strong>wa</strong>mba Aliye juu angejitia kati k<strong>wa</strong> kushinda k<strong>wa</strong> maadui<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o. Lakini Israeli alitupia mbali ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, na sasa haku<strong>wa</strong> na ulinzi.<br />

Alama za Musiba<br />

Unabii uliyotole<strong>wa</strong> na Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema <strong>ya</strong>litimia <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Dalili na maajabu <strong>ya</strong>litokea. K<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> miaka saba mtu aliendelea kupanda na<br />

kutelemuka katika njia za Yerusalema, kutangaza misiba itakayokuja. Kiumbe hiki cha<br />

ajabu kilifung<strong>wa</strong> gerezani na kuazibi<strong>wa</strong>, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> matusi maba<strong>ya</strong> hayo akajibu tu, “Ole,<br />

ole k<strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema”! Aliua<strong>wa</strong> katika mitego <strong>ya</strong> maadui aliyotabiri.<br />

“Hakuna Mkristo hata mmoja aliyeangamia katika uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema. Baada <strong>ya</strong><br />

Waroma chini <strong>ya</strong> uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Cestius <strong>wa</strong>lipozunguka mji, k<strong>wa</strong> gafula <strong>wa</strong>kaacha mazingi<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati kila kitu kilionekana ku<strong>wa</strong> cha kufaa k<strong>wa</strong> shambulio. Mkuu <strong>wa</strong> Roma akaondoa<br />

majeshi <strong>ya</strong>ke bila sababu ndogo <strong>wa</strong>zi. Alama iliyoahidi<strong>wa</strong> ilitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kingojea. Luka 21:20,21.<br />

Mambo <strong>ya</strong>kafanyika k<strong>wa</strong> namna ambayo hata Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi ama Waroma ha<strong>wa</strong>kupinga<br />

kukimbia k<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo. Katika kushind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Cestius, Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>kafuata, na <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

majeshi hayo mawili <strong>ya</strong>lipokutana, Wakristo popote katika inchi <strong>wa</strong>liweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> kimbilio<br />

lao bila kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa salama, k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Pella.<br />

9


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, <strong>ya</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kifuata Cestius na jeshi lake <strong>wa</strong>kaangukia upande<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> nyuma. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> shida sana Waroma <strong>wa</strong>lifaulu katika kukimbia k<strong>wa</strong>o. Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi<br />

pamoja na mateka <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>karudia na ushindi Yerusalema. Lakini kufaulu k<strong>wa</strong> namna hii<br />

kuli<strong>wa</strong>letea uba<strong>ya</strong> tu. Jambo hilo lili<strong>wa</strong>sukuma k<strong>wa</strong> ile roho <strong>ya</strong> ukaidi <strong>wa</strong> kupinga k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Waroma ambao k<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>kaleta msiba muba<strong>ya</strong> sana juu <strong>ya</strong> muji uliohukumi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hasara ziliku<strong>wa</strong> za ajabu zile zilianguka juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema <strong>wa</strong>kati mji ulizunguk<strong>wa</strong> tena<br />

na Titus. Mji ulizunguk<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Pasaka, <strong>wa</strong>kati mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipokusanyika ndani <strong>ya</strong> kuta zake. Duka za akiba zikaharibi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kisasi<br />

cha makundi <strong>ya</strong> mabishano. sasa matisho yote <strong>ya</strong> njaa <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>fikia. Wanaume <strong>wa</strong>katafuna<br />

ngozi <strong>ya</strong> mikaba <strong>ya</strong>o na viatu na kifuniko cha ngao zao. Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaenda<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uficho usiku inje k<strong>wa</strong> kukusan<strong>ya</strong> mimea fulani <strong>ya</strong> pori <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kiota inje <strong>ya</strong> kuta<br />

za mji, inga<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kizunguuk<strong>wa</strong> na kuua<strong>wa</strong> na mateso makali, na mara k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mara <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kirudia katika usalama ndani <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>lin<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong> akiba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lizopata k<strong>wa</strong> shida sana. Waume <strong>wa</strong>kaiba <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>o, na <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>ume <strong>wa</strong>o. Watoto<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kan<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong> chakula kiny<strong>wa</strong>ni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>zee <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Roma kuogopesha sana Wayuda ili<strong>wa</strong>kubali <strong>wa</strong>meshind<strong>wa</strong>. Wafung<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liazibi<strong>wa</strong>, kutes<strong>wa</strong>, na kusulubi<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> ukuta <strong>wa</strong> mji. K<strong>wa</strong> bonde la Yosafati na<br />

Kalvari, misalaba ikasimamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wingi sana. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> vigumu kupitia katikati <strong>ya</strong><br />

misalaba hiyo. Ndivyo lilivyo timilika agizo la kutisha lililotaj<strong>wa</strong> na Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

kiti cha hukumu cha Pilato: “Damu <strong>ya</strong>ke iwe juu yetu na juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto wetu”. Matayo<br />

27:25.<br />

Tito alijaz<strong>wa</strong> na hofu kuu alipoona miili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu kulala k<strong>wa</strong> malundo katika mabonde.<br />

Kama mtu aliye katika maonyo, akatazama hekalu nzuri na akatoa agizo k<strong>wa</strong>mba kusiwe<br />

hata jiwe moja lake linalopas<strong>wa</strong> kugus<strong>wa</strong>.. Akatoa mwito <strong>wa</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>simulazimishe kuchafua mahali patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> damu. Kama <strong>wa</strong>kiweza<br />

kupigania mahali po pote pengine, hapana Muroma atapash<strong>wa</strong> kutendea jeuri utakatifu <strong>wa</strong><br />

hekalu! Yosefu mwenyewe, ali<strong>wa</strong>sihi, aka<strong>wa</strong>omba kujitoa, k<strong>wa</strong> kujiokoa wenyewe, mji <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

na mahali pao pa ibada. Lakini maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kajibi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> laana chungu. Mishale <strong>ya</strong><br />

makelele ikatup<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke, mwombezi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu. Juhudi za Tito ili<br />

kuokoa hekalu ziliku<strong>wa</strong> bure. Mmoja aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> mkuu kuliko yeye alitangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

halitabaki jiwe juu <strong>ya</strong> jiwe pasipo kubomole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mwishowe Tito akaamua kukamata hekalu k<strong>wa</strong> gafula, akakusudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

ikiwezekana ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuokole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maangamizi. Lakini maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ke ha<strong>ya</strong>kujali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Kinga cha moto kikatup<strong>wa</strong> upesi na askari mmoja k<strong>wa</strong> tundu ndani <strong>ya</strong> ukumbi, na mara<br />

moja vyumba vilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> na miti <strong>ya</strong> mierezi kuzunguuka hekalu takatifu vika<strong>wa</strong>ka moto.<br />

Tito akaenda k<strong>wa</strong> haraka mahali pale, na akaagiza <strong>wa</strong>askari kuzima ndimi za moto. Maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ha<strong>ya</strong>kufuat<strong>wa</strong>. Katika hasira <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>askari <strong>wa</strong>katupa vinga v<strong>ya</strong> moto ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyumba<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> karibu na hekalu, na tena pamoja na panga zao <strong>wa</strong>kaua hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

10


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokimbilia ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu. Damu ikatiririka kama maji juu <strong>ya</strong> vipandio v<strong>ya</strong><br />

hekalu.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hekalu, mara mji wote uka<strong>wa</strong> mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> Waroma.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>kaacha minara <strong>ya</strong>o isiyoshindika. Alipokwisha kuitazama na<br />

mshangao, akasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni Mungu mwenyewe aliyeitoa mikononi m<strong>wa</strong>ke; k<strong>wa</strong>ni<br />

hakuna mashini za vita, hata zenye nguvu, zingeweza kushinda minara kub<strong>wa</strong> sana. Mji<br />

pamoja na hekalu vilibomole<strong>wa</strong> tangu msingi, na mahali ambapo nyumba takatifu iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

imesimama “palilim<strong>wa</strong> kama shamba linavyolim<strong>wa</strong>” Yeremia 26:18. Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> milioni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaangamia; <strong>wa</strong>liookoka <strong>wa</strong>kapelek<strong>wa</strong> kama mateka, <strong>wa</strong>kauzish<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kakokot<strong>wa</strong> chini hata Roma, <strong>wa</strong>katup<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> pori ndani <strong>ya</strong> vi<strong>wa</strong>nda v<strong>ya</strong><br />

michezo, ao kuta<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> mahali pote kama <strong>wa</strong>tembezi <strong>wa</strong>sio na makao.<br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>lijaza <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe kikombe cha kisasi. Kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> taifa lao na<br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>liyofuata kuta<strong>wa</strong>nyika k<strong>wa</strong>o, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ndiyo kuvuna mavuno ambayo mikono<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o yenyewe ilipanda “O, Israel, umejiharibu wewe mwenyewe “k<strong>wa</strong> maana umeanguka<br />

sababu <strong>ya</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong>ko”. Hosea 13:9; 14:1. Mateso <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>naonyesh<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara kama<br />

azabu ili<strong>wa</strong>fikia <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo mdanganyi mkuu hujitahidi<br />

kuficha kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe. K<strong>wa</strong> kukataa sababu <strong>ya</strong> hukumu k<strong>wa</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na<br />

rehema, Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>lilazimisha ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Hatuwezi kujua namna gani tunapash<strong>wa</strong> kushukuru Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> amani na ulinzi<br />

tunaofurahia. Ni nguvu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inayozuia <strong>wa</strong>nadamu kuanguka kabisa katika mikono <strong>ya</strong><br />

Shetani. Waasi na <strong>wa</strong>sio na shukrani <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na sababu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kushukuru Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napo pitisha mipaka <strong>ya</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu,<br />

ulinzi huondole<strong>wa</strong>. Mungu hasimame kama mwuaji <strong>wa</strong> mhukumu juu <strong>ya</strong> kosa. Huacha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naokataa rehema zake kuvuna <strong>wa</strong>lichopanda. Kila mushale <strong>wa</strong> nuru uliokatali<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

mbegu iliyopand<strong>wa</strong> inayozaa lazima mavuno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ikiping<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bidii,<br />

mwishowe itaondole<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, hakuna tena nguvu <strong>ya</strong> kuzuia tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong> za roho,<br />

hakuna ulinzi k<strong>wa</strong> uovu na uadui <strong>wa</strong> Shetani.<br />

Uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema ni onyo la kutisha k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naopinga maombezi <strong>ya</strong> rehema<br />

za Mungu. Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi juu <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema inaku<strong>wa</strong> na utimilizo<br />

mwengine. Katika hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mji muchaguli<strong>wa</strong> tunaona maangamizo <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu ambao<br />

ulikataa rehema za Mungu na kukan<strong>ya</strong>ga sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. Habari <strong>ya</strong> shida <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu<br />

ambayo dunia imeshuhudia ni <strong>ya</strong> giza. Matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kukataa mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuogopesha. Lakini mambo <strong>ya</strong> giza zaidi <strong>ya</strong>naonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika ufunuo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao.<br />

Wakati ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu utaondole<strong>wa</strong> kabisa, haitawezekana tena kuzuia kuripuka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu na hasira <strong>ya</strong> uovu, ulimwengu utashika, k<strong>wa</strong> namna isivyofanyika<br />

mbele, matokeo <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Shetani.<br />

Katika siku ile, kama katika uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>takombole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Tazama lsa<strong>ya</strong> 4:3; Matayo 24:30,31. Kristo atakuja mara <strong>ya</strong> pili kukusan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

11


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe. “Halafu kabila zote; na mataifa yote <strong>ya</strong> dunia <strong>ya</strong>taomboleza, nao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tamuona M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu akija katika mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu pamoja na uwezo na utukufu<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Naye atatuma malaika zake na sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> baragumu, nao <strong>wa</strong>takusan<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke toka pepo ine, toka mwisho huu <strong>wa</strong> mbingu mpaka mwisho ule”.<br />

Matayo 24:30,31.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>jihazari ili <strong>wa</strong>sizarau maneno <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Kama alivyoon<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema ili <strong>wa</strong>pate kukimbia, vile vile ameon<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu juu <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> mwisho. Wote <strong>wa</strong>takao <strong>wa</strong>pate kukimbia hasira ijao. “Na kutaku<strong>wa</strong> alama<br />

katika jua na mwezi, na nyota; na katika dunia taabu <strong>ya</strong> mataifa”. Luka 21:25. Tazama vile<br />

vile Matayo 24:29; Marko 13:24-26; Ufunuo 6:12-17. “Basi angalieni”, ndiyo maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo <strong>ya</strong> onyo la upole. Marko 13:35. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naokubali onyo hili ha<strong>wa</strong>taach<strong>wa</strong> gizani.<br />

Ulimwengu hauko ta<strong>ya</strong>ri zaidi kusadiki (amini) ujumbe k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu kuliko<br />

<strong>wa</strong>livyoku<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi k<strong>wa</strong> kupokea onyo la Mwokozi juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema. Njoo ingalipo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati, siku <strong>ya</strong> Mungu itakuja gafula k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Wakati maisha inapoendelea katika<br />

mviringo <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> siku zote; <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naposhugulika katika anasa, katika kazi, katika<br />

kukusan<strong>ya</strong> pesa; <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>napotukuza maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> dunia, na <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napotuliz<strong>wa</strong> katika salama <strong>ya</strong> uwongo-ndipo, kama mwizi <strong>wa</strong> usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane huiba<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> gafula, ndivyo uharibifu utakuja k<strong>wa</strong> gafula juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zarau na <strong>wa</strong>ovu, “<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>takimbia”. Tazama 1 Watesalonika 5:2-5.<br />

12


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 2. Ubatizo <strong>wa</strong> Moto<br />

Yesu alifunulia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke maarifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao alipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchukuli<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong>o, hata kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke katika uwezo na utukufu. Kuingia ndani sana<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao, jicho lake likaona zoruba kali zilipas<strong>wa</strong> kupiga juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

miaka iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> karibu <strong>ya</strong> mateso. Tazama Matayo 24:9,21,22. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kupitia k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong> laumu na mateso ambayo B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

alipitia. Uadui juu <strong>ya</strong> Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu ulipas<strong>wa</strong> kuonekana juu <strong>ya</strong> wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naopas<strong>wa</strong> kuamini jina lake.<br />

Upagani ulifahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba injili ikishinda, hekalu na mazabahu zake <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuondole<strong>wa</strong>; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii mioto <strong>ya</strong> mateso ika<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong>. Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>lin<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong> mali<br />

zao na kufukuz<strong>wa</strong> nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>o. Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> wenye cheo na <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tajiri na<br />

masikini, wenye elimu na <strong>wa</strong>jinga, <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong> bila huruma.<br />

Ya kianzia chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Nero, mateso <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi. Wakristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uongo ku<strong>wa</strong> ni <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lioleta njaa, tauni, na matetemeko <strong>ya</strong> inchi.<br />

Wachongezi <strong>wa</strong>kasimama ta<strong>ya</strong>ri, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> faida tu, k<strong>wa</strong> kusaliti <strong>wa</strong>sio na kosa kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>asi na tauni k<strong>wa</strong> jamii. Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katup<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> pori ama kuchom<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>hai katika vi<strong>wa</strong>nja v<strong>ya</strong> michezo (amphitheatres). Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kasulubi<strong>wa</strong>; wengine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kafunik<strong>wa</strong> na ngozi za n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> pori na kusukum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu katika u<strong>wa</strong>nja (arena)<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuchezea ili kupasuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>imb<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> siku kuu za wote makutano mengi sana<br />

<strong>ya</strong>likusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kufurahisha macho na kusalimia <strong>wa</strong>lioumiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kifo na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>chekele<strong>ya</strong> na kushangilia.<br />

Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta maficho katika mahali pa uki<strong>wa</strong> na pekee.<br />

Chini <strong>ya</strong> milima inje <strong>ya</strong> muji <strong>wa</strong> Roma, vyumba virefu vilifunuli<strong>wa</strong> katika inchi na miamba<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maelfu ngambo <strong>ya</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong> kuta za mji. Ndani <strong>ya</strong> makimbilio ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> udongo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>kazika <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>o, na hapo pia <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kukimbilia, <strong>wa</strong>lipozani<strong>wa</strong><br />

maovu na kugombez<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>lipata makao. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kakumbuka maneno <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama <strong>wa</strong>kiteseka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, inafaa <strong>wa</strong>furahi sana. Za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong>o itaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, k<strong>wa</strong> maana ndivyo <strong>wa</strong>livyotesa manabii <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>o. Tazama<br />

Matayo 5:11,12.<br />

Nyimbo za ushindi zikapanda katikati <strong>ya</strong> ndimi za moto zenye kutatarika. K<strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liona Kristo na malaika <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>tazama pamoja na usikizi mwingi sana na kutazama<br />

kusimama imara k<strong>wa</strong>o pamoja na kibali. Sauti ikaja kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha enzi cha Mungu:<br />

“Uwe m<strong>wa</strong>minifu mpaka kufa, nami nitakupa taji <strong>ya</strong> uzima”. Ufunuo 2:10.<br />

Nguvu za Shetani k<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu kanisa la Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> mauaji ziliku<strong>wa</strong> bure. Watumishi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong>, lakini injili iliendelea kuta<strong>wa</strong>nyika na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke kuongezeka.<br />

Mkristo mmoja akasema: “Tunazidi kuongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu namna munavyozidi kutuu<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

damu <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo ni mbegu”.<br />

13


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Shetani basi, ili aweze kushinda Mungu alikata shauri <strong>ya</strong> kusimamisha mwenge <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Kristo, ili apate ujanja kile alichoshind<strong>wa</strong> kupata k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu. Mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kakoma. K<strong>wa</strong> mahali pake kukawek<strong>wa</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong> mafanyikio <strong>ya</strong> kidunia heshima za<br />

muda. Waabudu sanamu <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kupokea sehemu <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kikristo, <strong>wa</strong>kikataa<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong>liyo <strong>ya</strong> maana . Wakatangaza kumkubali Yesu kama M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu na kuamini kufa na kufufuka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, lakini bila kukubali hali <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> zambi, na<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kusikia lazima <strong>ya</strong> kuungama au badiliko la moyo <strong>wa</strong>weze kuungana katika mafikara <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani katika Kristo.<br />

Sasa kanisa liliku<strong>wa</strong> katika hofu <strong>ya</strong> maangamizo. Kifungo, mateso, moto, na upanga<br />

viliku<strong>wa</strong> ni mibaraka k<strong>wa</strong> kulinganisha pamoja na jambo hili. Baadhi <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lisimama imara, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba haikupasa kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapatano. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>likubali<br />

kugeuza imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Chini <strong>ya</strong> vazi <strong>ya</strong> kondoo <strong>ya</strong> ukristo unaodai<strong>wa</strong>, Shetani aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akijificha yeye mwenyewe ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, k<strong>wa</strong> kuchafua au kuharibu imani <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Wakristo wengi mwishowe <strong>wa</strong>likubali kushusha kanuni <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Na umoja<br />

ukafanyika kati <strong>ya</strong> ukristo na upagani. Inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>abudu sanamu <strong>wa</strong>lijifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki<br />

<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>wa</strong>lizidi kujiunga k<strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu zao, ila tu <strong>wa</strong>kageuza vyombo v<strong>ya</strong><br />

ibada <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> sanamu za Yesu, na hata za Maria na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu. Mafundisho maba<strong>ya</strong>,<br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida za kuabudu mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi, na sherehe za ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu zikaunganish<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika imani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na ibada. Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo ikaharibika, na kanisa likapoteza utakatifu<br />

(usafi) na uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Wengine lakini, ha<strong>wa</strong>kudanganyika. Waliendelea kushika uaminifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba <strong>wa</strong> ukweli.<br />

Makundi Mawili ndani <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa<br />

Kuliku<strong>wa</strong> makundi mawili miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Wakati kundi moja lilijifunza maisha <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi na k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu <strong>wa</strong>katafuta kuhakikisha<br />

makosa <strong>ya</strong>o na kufuata Mfano, kundi lingine likaepuka mambo <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyofunua makosa <strong>ya</strong>o. Hata katika hali <strong>ya</strong>ke bora, <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa wote ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> kweli, safi, na amini. Yuda aliunganish<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi, ili k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho na<br />

mifano <strong>ya</strong> Yesu angeweza kugeuka k<strong>wa</strong> kuona makosa <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> upendeleo katika<br />

zambi akaalika majaribu <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Akakasirika <strong>wa</strong>kati makosa <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lihakikish<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

ndipo akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kusaliti B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke. Tazama Marko 14:10,11.<br />

Anania na Safira <strong>wa</strong>kajidai kutoa kafara kamili k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lizuia k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa<br />

sehemu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. Roho <strong>wa</strong> ukweli akafunua k<strong>wa</strong> mitume tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>janja ha<strong>wa</strong>, na hukumu za Mungu zikaokoa kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> laumu mba<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> usafi <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Tazama Matendo 5:1-11. Mateso <strong>ya</strong>lipokuja juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, <strong>wa</strong>le tu <strong>wa</strong>liotaka<br />

kuacha vyote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>litamani ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> vile mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lipokoma, <strong>wa</strong>ongofu <strong>wa</strong>liongezeka <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli, na njia ikafunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Shetani kupata pa kuwekea mguu.<br />

14


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakati Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>lipokubali kujiunga pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liogeuka k<strong>wa</strong> nusu tu kutoka<br />

katika ushenzi, Shetani akashangilia. Ndipo aka<strong>wa</strong>tia moyo kutesa <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liodumu ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kufuru (<strong>wa</strong>asi), <strong>wa</strong>lipoungana na wenzao nusu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pagani <strong>wa</strong>kaelekeza vita <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> kanuni (zaidi) <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo.<br />

Ilitaki<strong>wa</strong> shindano kali sana kusimama imara juu <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo na machukizo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoingiz<strong>wa</strong> kanisani. Biblia haikukubali<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> imani. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uhuru<br />

<strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong>kait<strong>wa</strong> uwongo, na <strong>wa</strong>tetezi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kaondole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> mapigano marefu, <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>liona k<strong>wa</strong>mba mutengano uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> lazima<br />

kabisa. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kusubutu kuvumilia <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu zaidi makosa <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> hatari k<strong>wa</strong> roho<br />

zao, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> mfano mba<strong>ya</strong> ungaliweza kuhatarisha imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o. Waliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba amani ingepatikana k<strong>wa</strong> bei kali sana k<strong>wa</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong> kanuni.<br />

Kama umoja ungalifanyi<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> kuvunja ukweli, heri tofauti iwepo, na hata vita.<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kipekee. Wachache katika hesabu, bila<br />

utajiri, cheo, <strong>wa</strong>la majina <strong>ya</strong> heshima, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kichuki<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ovu, hata kama vile<br />

Abeli alivyochuki<strong>wa</strong> na Kaini. Tazama M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 4:1-10. Tangu siku za Kristo hata sasa,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>meamsha chuki na upinzani <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naopenda zambi.<br />

Namna gani, basi, injili inaweza kuit<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> amani? Malaika <strong>wa</strong>liimba k<strong>wa</strong> u<strong>wa</strong>nja<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Betelehemu: “Utukufu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu aliye juu, na salama duniani, katika <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naomupendeza”. Luka 2:14. K<strong>wa</strong> inje hapo kuna kinyume kati <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> unabii huu<br />

na maneno <strong>ya</strong> Kristo: “Sikuja kuleta salama lakini upanga”. Matayo 10:34. Lakini<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nafahamika vizuri, maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> mawili <strong>ya</strong>napatana vizuri kabisa. Injili ni ujumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

amani. Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, ikikubali<strong>wa</strong> na kutii, ingeeneza amani na furaha duniani pote.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Yesu kupatanisha <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, na k<strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> mwenzake. Lakini<br />

ulimwengu wote unaku<strong>wa</strong> katika uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Shetani, adui mkali <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Injili<br />

huonyesha kanuni za maisha ku<strong>wa</strong> zinazoku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume cha tabia na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o, nazo<br />

zinapinga injili <strong>ya</strong>ke. Huchukia usafi unaofunua na kuhukumu zambi zao, na hutesa na<br />

kuangamiza <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotangaza haki na utakatifu. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> maana hii k<strong>wa</strong>mba injili huit<strong>wa</strong><br />

upanga. Tazama Matayo 10:34.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zaifu katika imani <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kuacha tumaini lao katika<br />

Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> sababu anakubali <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ovu kusitawi, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu wema na safi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napoteseka na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> ukali <strong>wa</strong>o. S<strong>wa</strong>li, namna gani, Mungu mwenye haki na rehema,<br />

ambaye uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke hauna mwisho, anaweza kukubali uzalimu na mateso <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo?<br />

Mungu ametupa ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kutosha <strong>wa</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Hatuwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

wema <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>ni hatuwezi kufahamu maongozi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mwokozi alisema, “Kumbukeni<br />

neno nililo<strong>wa</strong>ambia ninyi: Mtum<strong>wa</strong> si mkub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kama <strong>wa</strong>linitesa mimi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>tesa ninyi vile vile”. Yoane 15:20. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuvumilia mateso na mauti<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kutembea k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>yo za M<strong>wa</strong>na mpend<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

15


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wenye haki huwek<strong>wa</strong> katika tanuru <strong>ya</strong> taabu ili <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>pate kutakas<strong>wa</strong>, ili<br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong>o upate kuvuta wengine k<strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> imani na wema, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba mwenendo <strong>wa</strong><br />

uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o upate kuhukumu <strong>wa</strong>ovu na <strong>wa</strong>sioamini. Mungu huruhusu <strong>wa</strong>ovu kusitawi na<br />

kufunua uadui <strong>wa</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong>ke ili wote <strong>wa</strong>pate kuona haki <strong>ya</strong>ke na rehema zake katika<br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong>o kabisa. Kiia tendo la ukali juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu litaazibi<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba lilitende<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mwenyewe.<br />

Paulo anasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba “wote <strong>wa</strong>naotaka kuishi maisha <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>tapata<br />

mateso”. 2 Timoteo 3:12. Sababu gani, basi, k<strong>wa</strong>mba mateso huonekana <strong>ya</strong>mesinzia?<br />

Sababu moja tu k<strong>wa</strong>mba kanisa lilijiweka k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong> kidunia na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo haliamushi<br />

tena upinzani. Dini katika siku zetu si safi kama imani takatifu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na mitume <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> sababu mambo <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu <strong>ya</strong>nazani<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ubaridi, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> kidogo sana katika kanisa, Ukristo unapend<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. Acha imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kanisa la k<strong>wa</strong>nza ifufuke, na mioto <strong>ya</strong> mateso ita<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> tena.<br />

16


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 3. Giza la Kiroyo Katika<br />

Mtume Paulo alisema k<strong>wa</strong>mba siku <strong>ya</strong> Kristo haingepas<strong>wa</strong> kuja “ila maasi <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>fike<br />

mbele, na mtu yule <strong>wa</strong> kuasi akafunuliwe, m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> uharibifu, yeye mpinzani na<br />

kujionyesha mwenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>nayoit<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ao kuabudi<strong>wa</strong>, hata kuketi ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

hekalu la Mungu akijionyesha mwenyewe kama yeye ndiye Mungu”. Na zaidi, “Maana siri<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uasi hata sasa inatenda kazi”. 2 Watesalonika 2:3,4,7. Hata k<strong>wa</strong> tarehe ile <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo<br />

mtume aliona, makosa kuingia kim<strong>ya</strong> polepole, <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>ngeta<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa<br />

la Kipapa.<br />

Pole pole, “siri <strong>ya</strong> uasi” ikaendesha kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> Kudangan<strong>ya</strong>. Desturi za kipagani<br />

zikapata njia zao katika kanisa la Kikristo, zilipozui<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mateso makali chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

upagani; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati mateso <strong>ya</strong>lipokoma, ukristo ukaweka kando unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> fahari <strong>ya</strong> mapadri <strong>wa</strong> kipagani na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la. Kugeuka k<strong>wa</strong> jina tu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Constantini ukaleta furaha kub<strong>wa</strong>. Sasa kazi <strong>ya</strong> maovu ikaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> upesi. Upagani,<br />

ulionekana kushind<strong>wa</strong> kabisa.. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke na mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi <strong>ya</strong>kaingia katika<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Mapatano ha<strong>ya</strong> kati <strong>ya</strong> upagani na ukristo <strong>ya</strong>katokea katika “mutu <strong>wa</strong> zambi”<br />

aliyetabiri<strong>wa</strong> katika unabii. Dini ile <strong>ya</strong> uwongo kazi bora <strong>ya</strong> Shetani, juhudi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kukaa<br />

mwenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha ufalme k<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la dunia kufuatana na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Ni moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kiroma <strong>ya</strong> msingi k<strong>wa</strong>mba Papa amepe<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka<br />

kuu juu <strong>ya</strong> maaskofu na <strong>wa</strong>chungaji (pasteurs) katika ulimwengu wote. Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili<br />

ameit<strong>wa</strong> “B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu Papa” na ametangazi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> asiyeweza kukosa. (Tazama<br />

Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Kitabu (Nyongezo)) Madai <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong>llazimish<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani katika<br />

jang<strong>wa</strong> la majaribu <strong>ya</strong>ngali <strong>ya</strong>kiendesh<strong>wa</strong> naye kati <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Kirumi, na hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>namtolea heshima kub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoheshimu Mungu <strong>wa</strong>napigana majivuno ha<strong>ya</strong> kama vile Kristo<br />

alipambana na adui mwerevu: “Utaabudu B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ko,yeye peke utamutumikia”.<br />

Luka 4:8. Mungu hakuagiza kamwe mtu ye yote ku<strong>wa</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha kanisa. Uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

kipapa unaku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume kabisa na Maandiko. Papa hawezi ku<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kanisa la Kristo isipoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kun<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong>. Warumi huleta juu <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti<br />

madai <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lijitenga k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kweli. Lakini ni <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liacha “imani <strong>wa</strong>liyope<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu mara moja tu”. Yuda 3.<br />

Shetani alijua vizuri k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko matakatifu ambayo Mwokozi<br />

alishindana na mashambulio <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> kila shambulio, Kristo alionyesha ngabo <strong>ya</strong> kweli<br />

<strong>ya</strong> milele, kusema, “Imeandik<strong>wa</strong>”. K<strong>wa</strong> kudumisha uwezo <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na<br />

kuanzisha mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa mun<strong>ya</strong>nganyi, anapas<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea kufunga, <strong>wa</strong>tu katika<br />

kutojua Maandiko matakatifu. Mambo <strong>ya</strong> kweli matakatifu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kufich<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

komesh<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka mamia <strong>ya</strong> uenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Biblia ulikataz<strong>wa</strong> na Kanisa la<br />

17


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Roma. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kakataz<strong>wa</strong> kuisoma. Mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>askofu <strong>wa</strong>katafsiri mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuendesha madai <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo Papa akajulikana pote kama msaidizi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

ulimwenguni.<br />

Namna Sabato Ilivyogeuz<strong>wa</strong><br />

Unabii ulitangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kanisa la Kiroma “litafikiri kugeuza n<strong>ya</strong>kati na sheria”.<br />

Danieli 7:25. K<strong>wa</strong> kutoa badala k<strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu, ibada <strong>ya</strong> masura sanamu na masalio<br />

kumbukumbu, jambo hilo likaingiz<strong>wa</strong> kidogo kidogo katika ibada <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo. Agizo la<br />

baraza la ka<strong>wa</strong>ida (Tazama mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kitabu (Nyongezo)) mwishowe likaanzisha ibada hii<br />

<strong>ya</strong> sanamu. Roma ikasubutu kufutia mbali amri <strong>ya</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, inayokataza<br />

ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu, na kuga<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> kumi ili kulinda hesabu.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong>siotakas<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>kageuza amri <strong>ya</strong> ine vile vile, k<strong>wa</strong> kutangua<br />

Sabato <strong>ya</strong> zamani, siku ambayo Mungu alibariki na kutakasa (M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 2:2,3) na mahali<br />

pake <strong>wa</strong>katukuza siku kuu iliyolazimish<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>pagani kama “siku tukufu <strong>ya</strong> jua”. Katika<br />

karne za k<strong>wa</strong>nza Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli ilishik<strong>wa</strong> na Wakristo wote, lakini Shetani akatumika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuleta kusudi lake. Siku <strong>ya</strong> jua (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza) (Dimanche) ikafany<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> siku kuu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> ufufuko <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Huduma za dini zilifanyika k<strong>wa</strong> siku hiyo, lakini ilizani<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

siku <strong>ya</strong> pumziko, Sabato ikaendelea kushik<strong>wa</strong> na utakatifu.<br />

Shetani akaongoza Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, kulemeza<br />

Sabato k<strong>wa</strong> lazimisho makali, kuifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mzigo. Sasa, k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia nuru <strong>ya</strong> uongo<br />

ambamo alilete sabato kutazami<strong>wa</strong>, akaitupia zarau kama sheria <strong>ya</strong> “Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi”. Wakati<br />

Wakristo k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>wa</strong>liendelea kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Dimanche) kama siku kuu <strong>ya</strong><br />

shangwe, aka<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kufan<strong>ya</strong> Sabato ku<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> huzuni na giza ili kuonyesha<br />

machukio k<strong>wa</strong> Ki<strong>ya</strong>hudi.<br />

Mfalme Constantini akatoa amri kufan<strong>ya</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Dimanche) siku kuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote popote katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Roma (Tazama Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Kitabu ama Nyongezo). Siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

jua iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitukuz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>pagani na kuheshimi<strong>wa</strong> na Wakristo.<br />

Alilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> hivi na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Walipoongoz<strong>wa</strong> na hamu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liona <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama siku hiyo moja ilishik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wote ni kusema Wakristo na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pagani, ingeendelesha uwezo na utukufu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati Wakristo wengi<br />

wenye kumcha Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lipoongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuzania Siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Dimanche) kama yenye<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> na cheo cha utakatifu, <strong>wa</strong>liendelea kushika Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli na kuitukuza katika utiifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ine.<br />

Mdanganyi mkuu hakutimiza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Alikusudia kutumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

mjumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke, askofu mwenye kiburi anayejidai ku<strong>wa</strong> mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Mabaraza<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> ambamo <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong>likusanyika kutoka pote duniani. Karibu kila<br />

baraza Sabato iligandamiz<strong>wa</strong> chini kidogo, <strong>wa</strong>kati siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Dimanche) ikatukuz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo siku kuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pagani mwishowe ikatukuz<strong>wa</strong> kama sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, lakini<br />

18


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kumbukumbu <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Ki<strong>ya</strong>hudi na ka<strong>wa</strong>ida zake<br />

zikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> za laana.<br />

Mkufuru akafaulu katika kujionyesha mwenyewe “juu <strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>nayoit<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, ao<br />

kuabudi<strong>wa</strong>.” 2 Watesalonika 2:4. Alisubutu kugeuza amri moja tu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

inayoonyesha Mungu <strong>wa</strong> kweli na <strong>wa</strong> uhai. Katika amri <strong>ya</strong> ine, Mungu hufunuli<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

Muumba. Kama ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuumba, siku <strong>ya</strong> saba ikatakas<strong>wa</strong> kama siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

pumziko la mtu, iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> kulinda Mungu <strong>wa</strong> uhai siku zote mbele <strong>ya</strong> akili za <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

kama kitu cha ibada. Shetani hujitaidi kugeuza <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> utii <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu; k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hivyo huelekeza nguvu zake zaidi sana juu <strong>ya</strong> amri ile inayoonyesha Mungu kama Muumba.<br />

Waprotestanti sasa <strong>wa</strong>nalazimisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> Kristo Siku <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

(Dimanche) uliifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo. Lakini hapana heshima <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo<br />

iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> siku ile na Kristo au mitume <strong>wa</strong>ke. Ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

(Dimanche) iliku<strong>wa</strong> na asili <strong>ya</strong>ke katika ile “siri <strong>ya</strong> uasi” (2 Watesalonika 2:7), ambayo,<br />

hata katika siku <strong>ya</strong> Paulo, ilianza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Sababu gani inayoweza kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mageuzi<br />

ambayo Maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong>kuruhusu?<br />

Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> sita, askofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma alitangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha kanisa yote nzima.<br />

Dini <strong>ya</strong> kipagani ikatoa nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma. Joka akamupa n<strong>ya</strong>ma “nguvu zake”, na<br />

kiti chake cha ufalme na mamlaka nyingi”. Ufunuo 13:2 (Tazama Nyongezo).<br />

Sasa ikaanza miaka 1260 <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> Papa iliyotabiri<strong>wa</strong> katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong><br />

Danieli na Ufunuo. Danieli 7:25; Ufunuo 13:5-7. Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua au<br />

kuacha uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o na kukubali huduma na ibada za Papa, au kutoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o katika<br />

gereza, au kuua<strong>wa</strong>. Sasa maneno <strong>ya</strong> Yesu <strong>ya</strong>litimilika: “Nanyi mutatole<strong>wa</strong> hata na <strong>wa</strong>zazi<br />

wenu, na ndugu, na jamaa, na rafiki, na wengine wenu <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>ua. Na mutachuki<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> jina langu” Luka 21:16, 17.<br />

Ulimwengu uka<strong>wa</strong> shamba kub<strong>wa</strong> sana la vita. K<strong>wa</strong> mamia <strong>ya</strong> miaka kanisa la Kristo<br />

lilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuishi katika maficho na giza. “Yule m<strong>wa</strong>namuke akakimbia hata pori; kule ana<br />

pahali palipotengenez<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu ili <strong>wa</strong>mulishe kule siku elfu moja mia mbili na makumi<br />

sita” Ufunuo 12:6.<br />

Kuta<strong>wa</strong>z<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma kulionyesha m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> miaka <strong>ya</strong> giza.<br />

Imani ikahamish<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo na kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Badala <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutumainia M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> musamaha <strong>wa</strong> zambi na wokovu <strong>wa</strong> milele,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>katazamia Papa, na mapadri ambao ali<strong>wa</strong>tolea mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Papa aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mpatanishi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> kidunia. Alisimama k<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o. Kwenda<br />

pembeni <strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kutosha k<strong>wa</strong> azabu kali. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo akili za<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu zikatoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu zikageukia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>potevu, <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong>, niseme nini tena, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mfalme <strong>wa</strong> giza anayetumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke kupita <strong>wa</strong>o. Wakati Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>napokomesh<strong>wa</strong><br />

19


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

na mtu anapojiona mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> kama mkub<strong>wa</strong> kabisa, kitu kitakacho tazami<strong>wa</strong> tu ni<br />

hila, madanganyo, na upunguo <strong>wa</strong> tabia njema.<br />

Siku za Hatari k<strong>wa</strong> Kanisa<br />

Wachukuzi <strong>wa</strong> bendera <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chache sana. Hapo hapo ilionekana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba makosa ingeku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kushinda kabisa, na dini <strong>ya</strong> kweli kuondole<strong>wa</strong> duniani.<br />

Injili ilisahauli<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaleme<strong>wa</strong> na azabu kali. Walifundish<strong>wa</strong> kutumainia kazi zao<br />

wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> malipo <strong>ya</strong> zambi zao. Safari ndefu za kwenda kuzuru patakatifu, matendo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kitubio, ibada <strong>ya</strong> masalio <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong> kale, majengo <strong>ya</strong> makanisa, na<br />

mazabahu, malipo <strong>ya</strong> mali mingi k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa-ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutuliza hasira <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu ao kujipatia upendeleo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Karibu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> mnane, <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea<br />

kulazimisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika siku za k<strong>wa</strong>nza za kanisa maaskofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kiroho sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na ule ambao <strong>wa</strong>nachuku<strong>wa</strong> sasa. Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> uwongo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaandik<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kidangan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni <strong>ya</strong> zamani sana. Maagizo <strong>ya</strong> baraza<br />

ambayo ha<strong>ya</strong>kusiki<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuimarisha ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Papa tangu n<strong>ya</strong>kati za k<strong>wa</strong>nza,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kavumbuli<strong>wa</strong> (Tazama Nyonge 20).<br />

Waaminifu <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>liojenga juu <strong>ya</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> kweli. (1 Wakorinto 3:10,11)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kafazaika. Kuchoka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kupigana na mateso, udanagnyifu, kila kizuizi kingine<br />

ambacho Shetani angevumbua, <strong>wa</strong>tu fulani ambao <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>kakata tamaa.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong> amani na salama k<strong>wa</strong> mali <strong>ya</strong>o na maisha <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kaacha msingi <strong>wa</strong><br />

kweli. Wengine ha<strong>wa</strong>kuongopesh<strong>wa</strong> na upinzani <strong>wa</strong> adui zao.<br />

Ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu ika<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida. Mishumaa (bougies) ili<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> masanamu,<br />

na maombi <strong>ya</strong>katole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o. Desturi zisizo za maana na kuabudu uchawi zika<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

uwezo. Hata hakili yenyewe ikaonekana kupoteza nguvu zake. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu mapadri na<br />

maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kupenda anasa, na rush<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liotazamia<br />

uongozi k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>katazamia katika ujinga na makosa.<br />

Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na moja, Papa Gregoire VII akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kanisa halijakosa<br />

kamwe, na halitakosa kamwe, k<strong>wa</strong> kutokana na Maandiko. Lakini hakika za Maandiko<br />

hazikufuatana na maneno <strong>ya</strong>le. Askofu mwenye kiburi alidai pia uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuondoa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>falme. Mfano moja <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> uonevu huyu anaotetea madai <strong>ya</strong> kutoweza kukosa ni<br />

jambo alilotendea mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani, Henry IV. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu alijaribu kuzarau mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Papa, mfalme huyu akateng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa na akatosh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kiti chake cha ufalme.<br />

Watoto <strong>wa</strong>ke wenyewe <strong>wa</strong> kifalme <strong>wa</strong>kashawishi<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa katika uasi juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

baba <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Henry akaona lazima <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> amani pamoja na Roma. Pamoja na mke <strong>wa</strong>ke na<br />

mtumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke m<strong>wa</strong>minifu akavuka milima mirefu (Alpes) katika siku za baridi kali, ili<br />

apate kujinyenyekea mbele <strong>ya</strong> Papa. Alipofikia ngome <strong>ya</strong> Gregoire, akapelek<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

20


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

u<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong> inje. Kule, katika baridi kali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> majira <strong>ya</strong> baridi, na kich<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi na<br />

vikan<strong>ya</strong>gio, alingoja ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> Papa kuja mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ni baada <strong>ya</strong> siku tatu za kufunga na<br />

kuungama, ndipo askofu akamtolea rehema. Na hivyo ni katika hali <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mfalme<br />

alipas<strong>wa</strong> kungoja ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> Papa k<strong>wa</strong> kupata tena alama za cheo ao kutumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kifalme. Gregoire, alipofurahia ushindi <strong>wa</strong>ke, akatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

kuangusha kiburi cha <strong>wa</strong>falme.<br />

Ni ajabu <strong>ya</strong> namna gani tofauti kati <strong>ya</strong> askofu mwenye kiburi na upole na utulivu <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo anayejionyesha mwenyewe kama mwenye kuomba ruhusa k<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> moyo.<br />

Alifundisha <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke: “Naye anayetaka ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza katikati yenu ataku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mtum<strong>wa</strong> wenu” Matayo 20:27.<br />

Namna Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Uongo Yaliingia<br />

Hata mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuanzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> cheo cha Papa mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>pagani wenye<br />

maarifa <strong>wa</strong>kapata usikizi na kutumia muvuto <strong>wa</strong>o katika kanisa. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liendelea<br />

kujifungia k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> maarifa zote <strong>ya</strong> kipagani na <strong>wa</strong>kalazimisha wengine<br />

kujifunza elimu ile kama njia <strong>ya</strong> kueneza mvuto <strong>wa</strong>o katikati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pagani. Ndipo makosa<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaingiz<strong>wa</strong> katika imani <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo.<br />

Moja<strong>wa</strong>po miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> makosa ha<strong>ya</strong> makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi ni imani <strong>ya</strong> kutokufa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

roho <strong>ya</strong> mtu na ufahamu <strong>wa</strong> nafsi katika mauti. Mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liweka msingi ambao<br />

Roma ikaanzisha sala k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na ibada <strong>ya</strong> Bikira Maria. Kutokana na hiyo, uzushi<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mtu asiyetubu, ambayo <strong>ya</strong>liingiz<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni katika<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong> Papa.<br />

Ndipo njia ikatengenez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuingiza uvumbuzi mwingine <strong>wa</strong> kipagani, ambao Roma<br />

iliita “toharani”, na iliotumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuogopesha makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jinga na <strong>ya</strong> kuamini mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uchawi. Usishi huu uliamini ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> pahali pa mateso ambapo roho zisizostahili<br />

hukumu <strong>ya</strong> milele, zinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuteseka juu <strong>ya</strong> malipizi <strong>ya</strong> zambi zao, na kutoka pale,<br />

zikiisha takas<strong>wa</strong>, zinakubali<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni (Tazama Nyongezo).<br />

Uvumbuzi mwingine ukahitaji<strong>wa</strong>, kuwezesha Roma kupata faida k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> woga na<br />

makosa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Huu ulitole<strong>wa</strong> na mafundishojuu <strong>ya</strong> ununuzi <strong>wa</strong> huruma<br />

(indulgences). Ondoleo nzima la zambi za sasa, zilizopita na za <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao liliahidi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojitoa k<strong>wa</strong> vita vilivyofany<strong>wa</strong> na Papa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kupanua mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kulipiza adui zake ao kuangamiza <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liosubutu kukataa mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kiroho. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> kulipa mali katika kanisa <strong>wa</strong>naweza kujiokoa katika zambi zao, na pia kuokoa roho<br />

za rafiki zao zinazoteseka katika miako <strong>ya</strong> moto. K<strong>wa</strong> njia hiyo Roma ikajaza masanduku<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke na kusaidia fahari <strong>ya</strong>ke, anasa na uovu <strong>wa</strong> kujidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Yule<br />

asiyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pahali pa kuweka kich<strong>wa</strong> chake (Tazama Nyongezo).<br />

Meza <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na likapig<strong>wa</strong> na kafara <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> misa. Mapadri <strong>wa</strong> Papa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajidai kufan<strong>ya</strong> mkate na divai v<strong>ya</strong> Meza <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ku<strong>wa</strong> mwili <strong>wa</strong> kweli na damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

21


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kweli <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na Yesu Kristo”. K<strong>wa</strong> majivuno <strong>ya</strong> kutukana Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>kadai<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuumba Mungu, Muumba <strong>wa</strong> vitu vyote. Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>kalazimish<strong>wa</strong> maumivu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kifo, kuungama imani <strong>ya</strong>o katika uzushi <strong>wa</strong> machukizo <strong>ya</strong> kutukana mbingu.<br />

Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na tatu kile chombo kikali sana kati <strong>ya</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> Papa<br />

kikaanzish<strong>wa</strong>-Baraza kuu la kuhukumia <strong>wa</strong>zushi <strong>wa</strong> dini (Inquisition). Katika mabaraza <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>ya</strong> siri Shetani na malaika zake <strong>wa</strong>lita<strong>wa</strong>la roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Bila kuonekana katikati<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Mungu alisimama, alipoandika k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> maagizo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

maovu <strong>ya</strong> kutisha na kuandika historia <strong>ya</strong> matendo <strong>ya</strong>o maba<strong>ya</strong> sana kuonekana machoni pa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu. “Babeli Mkuu” “anale<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu”. Tazama Ufunuo 17:5,6. Miili<br />

iliyoteseka <strong>ya</strong> mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini (martyrs) ikalalamika mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

kisasi juu <strong>ya</strong> ule uwezo <strong>wa</strong> mkufuru.<br />

Papa aka<strong>wa</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong>la mkali peke <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> dunia yote. Wafalme na <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

(empereurs) <strong>wa</strong>litii maagizo <strong>ya</strong> askofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma. K<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> mamia <strong>ya</strong> miaka<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Roma <strong>ya</strong>kakubali<strong>wa</strong> na wengi. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kaheshimi<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kusaidi<strong>wa</strong> sana. Kamwe tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati ule, kanisa la Roma liliku<strong>wa</strong> halijafikia kadiri <strong>ya</strong> cheo<br />

kikub<strong>wa</strong>, cha fahari, ao uwezo <strong>wa</strong> namna ile. Lakini “azuhuri <strong>ya</strong> cheo cha Papa iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu”.<br />

Maandiko matakatifu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> karibu bila kujulikana. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lichukia nuru iliyofunua zambi zao. Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kipimo cha haki, ilipoondole<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>katumia uwezo bila kizuio. Majumba makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Papa na maaskofu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

monyesho <strong>ya</strong> upotovu <strong>wa</strong> machukizo. Maaskofu wengine <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na makosa <strong>ya</strong> maovu<br />

sana hata <strong>wa</strong>kajaribu ku<strong>wa</strong>ondosha kama <strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> kutisha <strong>wa</strong>sioweza kuvumili<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi Ula<strong>ya</strong> haikufan<strong>ya</strong> maendeleo kamwe katika maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kweli,<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> ufundi na maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> jamii. Ukristo ukapat<strong>wa</strong> na kupooza k<strong>wa</strong> tabia na<br />

maarifa... Ndiyo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kufukuza Neno la Mungu!<br />

22


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 4. Wanakinga Imani<br />

Katika mda mrefu <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa, kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shahidi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liolinda<br />

imani katika Kristo kama mpatanishi <strong>wa</strong> pekee kati <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na mtu. Walishika Biblia<br />

kama kiongozi pekee k<strong>wa</strong> maisha, na kuheshimu Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Wakahesabi<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pinga dini, maandiko <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kakomesh<strong>wa</strong>, kuelez<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong>, ao kuondole<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasimama imara.<br />

Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> na nafasi ndogo katika maandiko <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu, ila tu katika mashitaki <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong>o. Kila kitu “cha kupinga dini”, iki<strong>wa</strong> ni <strong>wa</strong>tu ao maandiko, Roma alitafuta<br />

kuharibu. Roma ilijitahidi vile vile kuharibu kila kumbukumbu la maovu <strong>wa</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>siokubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kabla <strong>ya</strong> uvumbuzi <strong>wa</strong> ufundi <strong>wa</strong> kupiga chapa, vitabu<br />

viliku<strong>wa</strong> vichache k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo juu <strong>ya</strong> uchache <strong>wa</strong> vitabu hii haikuzuia Waroma<br />

kutimiza kusudi lao. Kanisa la Roma lilipopata uwezo likanyoosha mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuangamiza wote <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokataa kukubali uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Katika Uingereza dini <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo zamani za kale iliku<strong>wa</strong> imekwisha kupata mizizi,<br />

haikuharibi<strong>wa</strong> na ukufuru <strong>wa</strong> Waroma. Mateso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> kipagani <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> tu za<strong>wa</strong>di<br />

ambayo makanisa <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza <strong>ya</strong>lipata k<strong>wa</strong> Roma. Wakristo wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokimbia mateso katika Uingereza <strong>wa</strong>kipata kimbilio katika Scotland. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo ukweli<br />

ukachukuli<strong>wa</strong> katika nchi <strong>ya</strong> Irlande, na katika inchi hizi ukweli ulikubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> furaha.<br />

Wakati Wasaxons <strong>wa</strong>liposhambulia Uingereza, upagani ukapata mamlaka, na Wakristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukimbilia milimani. Katika Scotland, karne moja baadaye, nuru ikaangazia<br />

inchi za mbali sana. Kutoka Irlande Columba akakuja na <strong>wa</strong>idizi <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> kisi<strong>wa</strong><br />

cha pekee cha Iona ku<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> kazi zao za kueneza injili. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>injilisti<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> kuliku<strong>wa</strong> mchunguzi <strong>wa</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ukweli huu ukaingiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Masomo <strong>ya</strong>kaanzish<strong>wa</strong> pale Iona, ambamo <strong>wa</strong>jumbe (missionnaires)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litoka na kwenda Scotland, Uingereza, Ujeremani, Uswisi, na hata Italia.<br />

Roma Inakutana na Dini <strong>ya</strong> Biblia<br />

Lakini Roma ilikusudia kuweka Uingereza chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> sita<br />

<strong>wa</strong>jumbe (missionnaires) <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kajaribu kutubisha Wasaxons <strong>wa</strong>pagani. Jinsi kazi<br />

ilivyoendelea, <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> kiPapa <strong>wa</strong>kakutana na Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> zamani za kale -<strong>wa</strong>pole,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu, wenye kupatana na maneno <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko katika tabia, mafundisho, na <strong>wa</strong><br />

mwenendo mwema. Wale <strong>wa</strong>kiroma <strong>wa</strong>lionyesha imani <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi, ukuu, na<br />

kiburi cha kipapa. Roma alilazimisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba makanisa ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo <strong>ya</strong>pate kukubali<br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> askofu mkuu. Waingereza <strong>wa</strong>kajibu k<strong>wa</strong>mba Papa hakutaj<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mkuu<br />

katika kanisa na <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kumtolea tu utii ule unaofaa k<strong>wa</strong> kila mfuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua b<strong>wa</strong>na mwingine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

23


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sasa roho <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma ikafunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Akasema mwongozi <strong>wa</strong> Roma:<br />

“Kama hamutapokea <strong>wa</strong>ndugu <strong>wa</strong>nao<strong>wa</strong>letea amani, mutapokea maadui <strong>wa</strong>takao<strong>wa</strong>letea<br />

vita”. Vita na udanganyifu vikatumi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shahidi ha<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> Biblia,<br />

hata <strong>wa</strong>kati makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waingereza <strong>ya</strong> kaharibi<strong>wa</strong> au kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kutii Papa.<br />

Katika inchi iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> mbali na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma, k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi miili <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo<br />

iliishi na usalama kidogo bila uovu <strong>wa</strong> kipapa. Waliendelea kutumia Biblia ku<strong>wa</strong> kiongozi<br />

pekee cha imani. Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liamini umilele <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>lishika<br />

Sabato <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ine. Makanisa <strong>wa</strong>lioshika imani hii na kuitumia <strong>wa</strong>liishi katika Afrika <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kati na miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Waarmenia <strong>wa</strong> Asia.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liosimama imara mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa, Wavaudois (Waldenses) <strong>wa</strong>lisimama<br />

<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Katika inchi kanisa za Kiroma ziliimarisha kiti chake, makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Piedmont<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kadumisha uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati ukakuja ambapo Roma ilishurutisha juu <strong>ya</strong> utii <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Lakini wengine, <strong>wa</strong>likataa kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> Papa ao maaskofu, <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kulinda usafi na<br />

unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Utengano ukatokea. Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioambatana na imani <strong>ya</strong> zamani<br />

sasa <strong>wa</strong>kajitenga. Wengine, k<strong>wa</strong> kuacha inchi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> Alpes za milima mirefu (Alps),<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kainua mwenge <strong>ya</strong> ukweli katika inchi za kigeni. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kakimbilia katika ngome za<br />

miamba <strong>ya</strong> milima na huko <strong>wa</strong>kalinda uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu.<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> dini iliimarish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu lenye kuandik<strong>wa</strong>. Wakulima hao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu, <strong>wa</strong>liofungi<strong>wa</strong> inje <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu, ha<strong>wa</strong>kufikia <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli<br />

katika upinzani <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la uasi. Imani <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong>o iliku<strong>wa</strong> uriti <strong>wa</strong>o kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mababa zao. Walitoshele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la mitume. “Kanisa<br />

jang<strong>wa</strong>ni”, sio serekali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la kiburi iliyota<strong>wa</strong>z<strong>wa</strong> katika mji mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu,<br />

lililoku<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kweli la Kristo, mlinzi <strong>wa</strong> hazina za ukweli ambazo Mungu alizoweka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu.<br />

Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> sababu muhimu zilizoongoza k<strong>wa</strong> utengano <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kweli kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la KiRoma iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni uchuki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa hili juu <strong>ya</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. Kama<br />

ilivyotabiri<strong>wa</strong> na unabii, mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la KiRoma likagandamiza sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

katika mavumbi. Makanisa chini <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma <strong>ya</strong>kalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuheshimu siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Dimanche). K<strong>wa</strong> kosa la kupita ka<strong>wa</strong>ida wengi miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kafazaika sana hata inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lishika Sabato, <strong>wa</strong>kaacha kutumika pia siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma (Dimanche). Lakini jambo hilo haliku<strong>wa</strong>furahisha <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa.<br />

Walilazimish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Sabato ichafuliwe, na <strong>wa</strong>kashitaki <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liosubutu kuonyesha<br />

heshima <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Mamia <strong>ya</strong> miaka kabla <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo (Reformation) Wavaudois (Waldenses)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na Biblia katika lugha <strong>ya</strong>o yenyewe. Jambo hili lika<strong>wa</strong>telea kutes<strong>wa</strong><br />

kulikowengine. Wakatangaza Roma ku<strong>wa</strong> Babeli mkufuru <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo. Katika hatari <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kasimama imara kushindana na maovu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> uasi kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

24


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wavaudois (Waldenses) <strong>wa</strong>liokana mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kakataa ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu kama<br />

kuabudu miungu, na <strong>wa</strong>kashika Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli. (Tazama Nyongezo).<br />

Nyuma <strong>ya</strong> ngome za juu sana za milima Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>kapata mahali pa kujificha. Ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kimbizi <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o urefu <strong>wa</strong> munara juu <strong>ya</strong>o katika ukuu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasema juu <strong>ya</strong> yule ambaye Neno lake linaku<strong>wa</strong> la kudumu kama milima <strong>ya</strong> milele.<br />

Mungu aliimarisha milima; si mkono lakini ule unaoku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo usio na mwisho<br />

ungaliweza kuihamisha. K<strong>wa</strong> namna ile ile akaimarisha sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mkono <strong>wa</strong> mtu<br />

haungeweza kuongoa milima na kuitupa k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu baharini, kama vile hauwezi kubadili<br />

sheria moja <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Wasafiri ha<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kunungunika k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong> mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o; ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> peke <strong>ya</strong>o katika uki<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> milima. Walijifurahisha katika uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ibada. Kutoka ngome <strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>wa</strong>liimba sifa za Mungu, na majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Roma ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza<br />

kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha nyimbo zao za shukrani.<br />

Damani (Bei) <strong>ya</strong> Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Ukweli<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na bei kuliko nyumba na inchi, rafiki, jamaa, hata<br />

maisha yenyewe. Kutokea m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> utoto, vijana <strong>wa</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> kuheshimu maagizo<br />

matakatifu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Kurasa za Biblia ziliku<strong>wa</strong> chache; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>ya</strong> damani <strong>ya</strong>liwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kukumbuka. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liweza kukariri sehemu nyingi<br />

za Agano la Kale na Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Walifundish<strong>wa</strong> toka utoto kuvumilia ugumu na kufikiri na kutenda k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe. Walifundish<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua madaraka, kujilinda k<strong>wa</strong> usemi, na kufahamu hekima<br />

<strong>ya</strong> utulivu. Neno moja la ujinga linaposiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maadui <strong>wa</strong>o lingeweza kuleta hasara <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong> mamia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ndugu, k<strong>wa</strong>ni kama vile mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu katika kuwinda mawindo,<br />

maadui <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>nawinda <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liosubutu kutangaza uhuru <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini.<br />

Wavaudois k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong>litaabika k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> chakula chao. Kila mahali padogo pa<br />

udongo <strong>wa</strong> kulimi<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong> milima palitumi<strong>wa</strong> vizuri. Kiasi katika utumizi <strong>wa</strong> feza na<br />

kujikana <strong>ya</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong>o ambayo <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>lijifunza. Kazi iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> taabu<br />

lakini <strong>ya</strong>kufaa k<strong>wa</strong> af<strong>ya</strong>, basi ndicho mtu anachohitaji katika hali <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kuanguka. Vijana<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba nguvu zao zote ni za Mungu, zipate kusitawish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kazi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Wavaudois <strong>ya</strong>lifanana na kanisa la n<strong>ya</strong>kati za mitume. Kukataa mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Papa na askofu, <strong>wa</strong>lishika Biblia ku<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>siyoweza kukosa. Wachungaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o, ha<strong>wa</strong>kufanana na mapadri <strong>wa</strong> kiburi <strong>wa</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kalisha kundi la Mungu,<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza katika malisho <strong>ya</strong> majani mabichi na chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> Neno takatifu lake. Watu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likusanyika si ndani <strong>ya</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong> maridadi ao makanisa makuu <strong>ya</strong> majimbo, bali<br />

katika mabonde <strong>ya</strong> Milima mirefu, ao, katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> hatari, ndani <strong>ya</strong> ngome <strong>ya</strong> miamba,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong> ukweli kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Wachungaji<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuhubiri injili tu, <strong>wa</strong>lizuru <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>katumika k<strong>wa</strong> kuamusha umoja na upendo<br />

25


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> ndugu. Kama Paulo fundi <strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> hema, kila mmoja <strong>wa</strong>o alijifunza kazi fulani<br />

ambayo k<strong>wa</strong>yo, kama ni lazima, kingemusaidia k<strong>wa</strong> kujitegemea mwenyewe.<br />

Vijana <strong>wa</strong>lipata mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>o. Biblia ilifany<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> masomo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mhimu. Injili za Matayo na Yoane ziliwek<strong>wa</strong> katika ukumbusho, pamoja na barua<br />

nyingine. Mara zingine katika mapango <strong>ya</strong> giza udongoni, k<strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong> mienge (torches),<br />

Maandiko matakatifu <strong>ya</strong>liandik<strong>wa</strong>, mstari k<strong>wa</strong> mstari. Malaika kutoka mbinguni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kazunguuka <strong>wa</strong>tumishi ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu.<br />

Shetani alilazimisha mapadri <strong>wa</strong> Papa na maaskofu kuzika Neno la Ukweli chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

machafu <strong>ya</strong> makosa na ibada <strong>ya</strong> uchawi. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> ajabu likalind<strong>wa</strong> bila<br />

kuchafuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> miaka yote <strong>ya</strong> giza. Kama safina juu <strong>ya</strong> mawimbi mazito, Neno la<br />

Mungu linashinda zoruba zinazolitisha kuliharibu. Kama vile dini <strong>ya</strong>mefikia bamba la jiwe<br />

lenye zahabu na feza iliyofich<strong>wa</strong> chini upande <strong>wa</strong> juu, ni vivyo hivyo Maandiko matakatifu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na hazina <strong>ya</strong> ukweli iliyofunuli<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu, <strong>wa</strong>naopenda kuomba<br />

Mungu alichagua Biblia ku<strong>wa</strong> kitabu cha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu wote ku<strong>wa</strong> ufunuo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe. Kila ukweli uliotambuli<strong>wa</strong> ni uvumbuzi mup<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>ndishi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> vyuo v<strong>ya</strong>o katika milima vijana wengine <strong>wa</strong>litum<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza katika<br />

Ufaransa ao Italia, ambapo paliku<strong>wa</strong> na nafasi kub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho na uchunguzi<br />

kuliko katika inchi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> milima mirefu. Vijana <strong>wa</strong>liotum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lijihatarisha k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu.<br />

Walipambana na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Shetani <strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>lazimisha mambo <strong>ya</strong> kipinga ukweli <strong>wa</strong> dini<br />

na madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> hatari. Lakini elimu <strong>ya</strong>o tokea utoto ika<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> jambo hili.<br />

Katika vyuo po pote <strong>wa</strong>lipokwenda ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweka tumaini lao k<strong>wa</strong> kitu cho chote.<br />

Mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>lita<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> kama kuficha hazina zao kub<strong>wa</strong>-Maandiko. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara<br />

<strong>wa</strong>livyoweza <strong>wa</strong>liweka k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu sehemu za maandiko njiani m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao mioyo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o ilionekana kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kupokea ukweli. Waiiotubu na kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipatikana katika vyuo hii v<strong>ya</strong> elimu, mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli<br />

ikaenea k<strong>wa</strong> chuo chote kizima. Huku <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kupata m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kile <strong>wa</strong>lichoit<strong>wa</strong> “Upinzani <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> dini”.<br />

Vijana Walifundish<strong>wa</strong> Ku<strong>wa</strong> Wajumbe (<strong>wa</strong> injili)<br />

Wakristo Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>lijisikia ku<strong>wa</strong> na madaraka makuu <strong>ya</strong> kutoa nuru <strong>ya</strong>o iangaze.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu <strong>wa</strong>litafuta kuvunja utum<strong>wa</strong> ambao Roma ililazimisha.<br />

Wahudumu <strong>wa</strong> Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kutumika k<strong>wa</strong> miaka tatu katika shamba la misioni<br />

kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuongoza kanisa nyumbani--chanzo cha kufaa k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> mchungaji katika<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati ambazo roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu zinajaribi<strong>wa</strong>. Vijana <strong>wa</strong>liona mbele <strong>ya</strong>o, si utajiri <strong>wa</strong> kidunia<br />

na sifa, bali taabu na hatari na labda mateso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini. Wajumbe <strong>wa</strong>litembea <strong>wa</strong>wili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>wili, kama vile Yesu alivyo<strong>wa</strong>tuma <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

26


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>ngejulisha ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>ngeuletea kushind<strong>wa</strong>. Kila mhuburi aliku<strong>wa</strong> na ujuzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kazi fulani ao ufundi, na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>liendesha kazi <strong>ya</strong>o chini <strong>ya</strong> kifuniko cha mwito <strong>wa</strong><br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong> dunia , k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida kama mfan<strong>ya</strong> biashara ao <strong>ya</strong> mchuuzi. “Walichukua mavazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

hariri, vitu vilivyofanyiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> zahabu, na vitu vingine, ... na <strong>wa</strong>likaribish<strong>wa</strong> vizuri kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> biashara mahali <strong>wa</strong>ngezarauli<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>jumbe (missionnaires)” Walichukua k<strong>wa</strong><br />

siri nakala za Biblia, nzima ao kipande. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara shauku <strong>ya</strong> kusoma Neno la Mungu<br />

ilipoamush<strong>wa</strong>, sehemu fulani za Biblia ziliach<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liozihitaji.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>wa</strong>zi na mavazi machafu na safari <strong>ya</strong> udongo mzito, <strong>wa</strong>jumbe ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lipita<br />

katika miji mikub<strong>wa</strong> na kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> inchi za mbali. Makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kasimamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> haraka<br />

njiani <strong>wa</strong>limopita, na damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini ikashuhudia ukweli. K<strong>wa</strong> uficho na ukim<strong>ya</strong>, Neno<br />

la Mungu likitukana na kupokele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> furaha ndani <strong>ya</strong> nyumba na mioyoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>liamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba mwisho <strong>wa</strong> vitu vyote hauku<strong>wa</strong> mbali sana. Walipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kijifunza Biblia <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>natia moyo k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kujulusha wengine juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

ukweli Walipata faraja, tumaini, na amani k<strong>wa</strong> kum<strong>wa</strong>mini Yesu. Namna nuru ilifurahisha<br />

mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>litamani sana kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>li zake k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> katika giza la<br />

makosa la kipapa.<br />

Chini <strong>ya</strong> uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa na mapadri, wengi <strong>wa</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> kutumainia kazi ao<br />

matendo <strong>ya</strong>o mazuri k<strong>wa</strong> kuokole<strong>wa</strong>. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kijiangalia <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe, akili zao<br />

ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikiishi katika hali <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> zambi, kutesa moyo na mwili, lakini bila kurijika.<br />

Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>lipoteza maisha <strong>ya</strong>o katika viumba v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> (moines). K<strong>wa</strong> mafungo <strong>ya</strong> mara<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mara na kutesa mwili, kukesha usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane, k<strong>wa</strong> kusujudia mahali pa baridi,<br />

mawe <strong>ya</strong> maji maji, k<strong>wa</strong> safari ndefu--za kwenda kuzuru Pahali patakatifu--k<strong>wa</strong> kuogopa <strong>ya</strong><br />

hasira <strong>ya</strong> kisasi cha Mungu--wengi <strong>wa</strong>liendelea kuteseka hata kuchoka kukadumisha. Bila<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>li moja <strong>ya</strong> tumaini <strong>wa</strong>kazama ndani <strong>ya</strong> kaburi.<br />

Wenye Zambi Walimushota Kristo<br />

Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>litamani sana kufungulia mioyo hizi zilizoumia na njaa <strong>ya</strong> habari za amani<br />

katika ahadi za Mungu na ku<strong>wa</strong>onyesha k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kama tumaini lao la pekee la wokovu.<br />

Mafundisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba matendo mema <strong>ya</strong>naweza ku<strong>wa</strong> pahali pa zambi <strong>ya</strong>liyotambuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong>ke ni<strong>wa</strong> uongo. Tabia nzuri za Mwokozi aliyesulibi<strong>wa</strong> na kufufuka<br />

zinaku<strong>wa</strong>, ndiyo msingi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kikristo. Hali <strong>ya</strong> matumaini <strong>ya</strong> moyo k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

inapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu sana kama vile kiungo k<strong>wa</strong> mwili ao cha tawi k<strong>wa</strong> mzabibu.<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>papa na <strong>wa</strong>padri <strong>ya</strong>liongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutazama Mungu na hata Kristo<br />

kama <strong>wa</strong>kali na <strong>wa</strong> kugombeza, k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo bila huruma k<strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong>mba uombezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>padri na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu ulipas<strong>wa</strong> kuomb<strong>wa</strong>. Wale ambao akili zao zimeangazi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>litamani<br />

sana kuondoa vizuizi ambavyo Shetani amevijaza, ili <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>weze kuja mara moja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, kuungama zambi zao, na kupokea msamaha na amani.<br />

Kushambulia Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

27


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Wavaudois k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu ukatoa sehemu zilizoandik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu za<br />

Maandiko matakatifu. Nuru <strong>ya</strong> ukweli ikaingia k<strong>wa</strong> akili nyingi za giza, hata Jua la Haki<br />

likaangaza katika moyo n<strong>ya</strong>li zake za kupen<strong>ya</strong>. Kila mara msikilizaji alihitaji sehemu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko ipate kukariri<strong>wa</strong>, kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba apate kuhakikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba alisikia vizuri.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liona ni bure namna gani uombezi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wenye zambi hauna<br />

faida. Wakapiga kelele k<strong>wa</strong> furaha, “Kristo ni kuhani <strong>wa</strong>ngu; damu <strong>ya</strong>ke ni kafara <strong>ya</strong>ngu;<br />

mazabahu <strong>ya</strong>ke ni mahali pangu pa kuungamia”. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> mufuriko mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> nuru uliyo<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o, hata <strong>wa</strong>lionekana k<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lichukuli<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Hofu yote <strong>ya</strong> kifo<br />

ikafutika. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>liweza kutamani gereza kama <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo kutukuza Mkombozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Katika mahali pa siri Neno la Mungu lililet<strong>wa</strong> na kusom<strong>wa</strong>, mara zingine k<strong>wa</strong> roho<br />

moja, <strong>wa</strong>kati mwingine k<strong>wa</strong> kundi ndogo la <strong>wa</strong>tu lililotamani sana nuru. Mara nyingi usiku<br />

mzima ulitumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> namna hii. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara maneno kama ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kasem<strong>wa</strong>: “Je,<br />

Mungu atakubali sadaka <strong>ya</strong>ngu? Atanifurahia? Atanisamehe”? Jibu liliku<strong>wa</strong>, soma, “Kujeni<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ngu, ninyi wote munaosumbuka na wenye mizigo mizito, nami nita<strong>wa</strong>pumzisha ninyi”.<br />

Matayo 11:28.<br />

Roho zile zenye furaha zikarudia nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>o kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> nuru, kukariri k<strong>wa</strong><br />

wengine, k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>livyoweza, maarifa map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>o. Walipata ukweli na njia <strong>ya</strong> uhai!<br />

Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>lisem<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotamani ukweli.<br />

Mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> ukweli alikwenda k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> namna ninyi <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuuliza alitoka <strong>wa</strong>pi ao alikwenda <strong>wa</strong>pi. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mekwisha kupat<strong>wa</strong> na ushindi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo k<strong>wa</strong> kumuuliza. Aliweza ku<strong>wa</strong> malaika kutoka mbinguni!<br />

Walitaka maelezo zaidi juu <strong>ya</strong> jambo hilo.<br />

Katika mambo mengi mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> ukweli alifan<strong>ya</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> inchi nyingine ao<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> akipunguza maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke katika gereza ao labda mifupa <strong>ya</strong>ke iligeuka nyeupe<br />

mahali aliposhuhudia ukweli. Lakini maneno aliyoacha nyuma <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kitenda kazi <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>liona hatari kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kazi za ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kuzunguka zunguka. Nuru <strong>ya</strong> ukweli ingefutia mbali mawingu mazito <strong>ya</strong> kosa lililofunika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu; ingeongoza akili k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu peke <strong>ya</strong>ke na mwisho kuharibu mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>, katika kushika imani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la zamani, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni ushuhuda imara k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uasi <strong>wa</strong> Roma na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ikaamsha chuki na mateso. Kukataa k<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kuacha<br />

Maandiko iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kosa ambalo Roma haikuweza kuvumilia. Roma Inakusudia<br />

Kuangamiza Wavaudois (Waldenses)<br />

Sasa mapigano makali kuliko yote juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>kaanza katika makao <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

milimani. Wapelelezi (quisiteurs) <strong>wa</strong>liwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>yo <strong>ya</strong>o. Tena na tena mashamba <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> na baraka <strong>ya</strong>kaharibi<strong>wa</strong>, makao <strong>ya</strong>o na makanisa madogo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kaondole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hakuna mashitaka iliyoweza kulet<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> tabia njema <strong>ya</strong> namna hii <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

28


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokataz<strong>wa</strong>. Kosa lao kub<strong>wa</strong> liliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>kuabudu Mungu kufuatana na<br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Papa. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> “kosa hili” kila tukano na mateso ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu ao Shetani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Wakati Roma ilikusudia kukomesha dini hii (secte) iliyochuki<strong>wa</strong>, tangazo likatole<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Papa ku<strong>wa</strong>hukumu kama <strong>wa</strong>pingaji <strong>wa</strong> dini na ku<strong>wa</strong>toa k<strong>wa</strong> mauaji. (Tazama Nyongezo).<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>kusitaki<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>vivu, <strong>wa</strong>sio <strong>wa</strong>aminifu, ao <strong>wa</strong>sio na utaratibu; lakini ilitangaz<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenye mfano <strong>wa</strong> wenye uta<strong>wa</strong> na utakatifu uliovuta “kondoo la zizi la<br />

kweli”. Tangazo hili likaita <strong>wa</strong>shiriki wote <strong>wa</strong> kanisa kuungana k<strong>wa</strong> mapigano <strong>ya</strong><strong>wa</strong>pingaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong> dini<br />

Kama vile kuchochea tangazo hili liliachia viapo vyovyote wote <strong>wa</strong>liokubali kwenda<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> vita; tangazo hili lika<strong>wa</strong>tolea haki k<strong>wa</strong> kila mali <strong>wa</strong>liweza kupata k<strong>wa</strong> wizi, nalika<br />

ahidi ondoleo la zambi zote k<strong>wa</strong> yule angeweza kuua mpinga dini yeyote. Jambo hilo<br />

likavunja mapatano yote <strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upendeleo <strong>wa</strong> Wavaudois, <strong>wa</strong>kakataza <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote ku<strong>wa</strong>pa msaada wowote, na ku<strong>wa</strong>pa uwezo <strong>wa</strong>tu wote kukamata mali <strong>ya</strong>o”. Andiko<br />

hii linafunua <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi mungurumo <strong>wa</strong> joka, na si sauti <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Roho <strong>ya</strong> namna moja<br />

iliyosulibisha Kristo na kuua mitume, ile ilisukuma Nero mwenye hamu <strong>ya</strong> kum<strong>wa</strong>ga damu<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu katika siku zake, iliku<strong>wa</strong> kazini k<strong>wa</strong> kuondoa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pend<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Bila kutazama vita <strong>ya</strong> Papa juu <strong>ya</strong>o na mauaji makali sana <strong>wa</strong>liyo<strong>ya</strong>pata, <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>naogopa Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liendelea kutuma <strong>wa</strong>jumbe (Missionnaires) kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong><br />

damani. Waliwind<strong>wa</strong> hata kuu<strong>wa</strong><strong>wa</strong>, lakini damu <strong>ya</strong>o ilinywesha mbegu iliyopand<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuzaa matunda.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo Wavaudois <strong>wa</strong>lishuhudia Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi kabla <strong>ya</strong> Luther.<br />

Walipanda mbegu <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo (Reformation) <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyoanza <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Wycliffe,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaota na kukomaa katika siku za Luther, na <strong>ya</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea hata mwisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati.<br />

29


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 5. Nuru Inangaa Katika Uingereza<br />

Mungu hakukubali Neno lake liharibiwe kabisa. Katika inchi mbalimbali za Ula<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liosukum<strong>wa</strong> na Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta ukweli kama vile hazina zilizofich<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

bahati njema <strong>wa</strong>liongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Maandiko matakatifu, <strong>wa</strong>kipendez<strong>wa</strong> kukubali nuru k<strong>wa</strong> bei<br />

yo yote itakayohitaji<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe. Inga<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kuona vitu vyote <strong>wa</strong>zi, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kiwezesh<strong>wa</strong> kutambua mambo mengi <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong>liyozik<strong>wa</strong> ao fich<strong>wa</strong> tangu zamani.<br />

Wakati ulifika k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko kupe<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika lugha <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. Dunia<br />

ilikwisha kupitisha usiku <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> manane. Katika inchi nyingi kukaonekana dalili za<br />

mapambazuko.<br />

Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na ine “nyota <strong>ya</strong> asubuhi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo (Reformation)” ikatokea<br />

katika Uingereza. John Wycliffe alijulikana huko college ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> elimu<br />

sana. Alielemish<strong>wa</strong> na hekima <strong>ya</strong> elimu, kanuni za kanisa, na sheria <strong>ya</strong> serkali,<br />

alita<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> kuingia katika kazi ngumu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> raia na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini. Alipata<br />

malezi <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> vyuo, na akafahamu maarifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> mashule. Cheo na ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong><br />

ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>ke viliamuru heshima za rafiki na maadui. Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>lizui<strong>wa</strong> kutupa zarau<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> chazo cha Matengenezo k<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha ujinga ao uzaifu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioikubali.<br />

Wakati Wycliffe alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akingaliki huko college, akaingia majifunzo <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko<br />

matakatifu. Hata sasa Wicliffe alijifahamu ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye hitaji kub<strong>wa</strong>, ambao hata<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>la mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ha<strong>ya</strong>taweza kumtoshelea. Katika<br />

Neno la Mungu aliona kile ambacho aliku<strong>wa</strong> anatafuta bila mafanikio. Hapa akamuona<br />

Kristo akitangaz<strong>wa</strong> kama mteteaji pekee <strong>wa</strong> mtu. Akakusudia kutangaza ukweli<br />

aliyovumbua.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke, Wycliffe hakujitia mwenyewe katika upinzani na Roma.<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna alivyotambua <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi, makosa <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma, akazidi k<strong>wa</strong> bidii<br />

kufundisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba Roma iliacha Neno la Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> desturi za asili za <strong>wa</strong>tu. Akashitaki bila oga upadri k<strong>wa</strong> kuweza kuondoshea mbali<br />

Maandiko, na akataka k<strong>wa</strong> lazima k<strong>wa</strong>mba Biblia irudishwe k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke uwekwe tena ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mhubiri hodari na mwenye maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuamsha moyo, na maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kila siku <strong>ya</strong>lionyesha ukweli aliyohubiri. Ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, usafi <strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke, na bidii <strong>ya</strong>ke na ukamilifu aliouhubiri <strong>ya</strong>kampa<br />

heshima k<strong>wa</strong> wote. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaona uovu katika Kanisa la Roma. Wakapokea k<strong>wa</strong> shangwe<br />

isiyofich<strong>wa</strong> kweli ambazo zililet<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi<strong>wa</strong>zi na Wycliffe. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> kiPapa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajaz<strong>wa</strong> na hasira: Mtengenezaji huyu aliku<strong>wa</strong> akipata mvuto mkub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Mvumbuzi Hodari <strong>wa</strong> Kosa<br />

Wycliffe aliku<strong>wa</strong> mvumbuzi hodari <strong>wa</strong> kosa na akapambana bila woga juu <strong>ya</strong> matumizi<br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyoruhusi<strong>wa</strong> na Roma. Alipoku<strong>wa</strong> padri <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, aka<strong>wa</strong> shujaa k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa<br />

30


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

malipo <strong>ya</strong> kodi <strong>ya</strong>liyodai<strong>wa</strong> na Papa kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Uingereza. Majivuno <strong>ya</strong> Papa<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mamlaka juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> vyote viwili kweli na<br />

ufunuo. Matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Papa <strong>ya</strong>lichochea hasira, na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe <strong>ya</strong>livuta akili za<br />

uongozi <strong>wa</strong> taifa. Mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong>likusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa malipo <strong>ya</strong> kodi.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>liojitenga na mambo <strong>ya</strong> dunia, maskini <strong>wa</strong>kajaa katika Uingereza, kum<strong>wa</strong>nga<br />

sumu juu <strong>ya</strong> ukub<strong>wa</strong> na kufaniki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> taifa. Maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> (moines) <strong>ya</strong> uvivu na<br />

uombaji <strong>wa</strong> vitu ao mali haiku<strong>wa</strong> tu gharama kub<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, <strong>wa</strong>geuza kazi<br />

nzuri ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuzarauli<strong>wa</strong>. Vijana <strong>wa</strong>lipotoka na kuharibika. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lishawishwi kujitoa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> kukosa ukubali <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi tu, bali bila<br />

ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>o na kinyume cha mwito <strong>wa</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> “chukizo hili lisilo la kibinadamu” kama<br />

vile Luther baadaye alilitia “kuonyesha dalili <strong>ya</strong> mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu zaidi na mjeuri kuliko <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mkristo na mtu, “ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong>” mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto iki<strong>wa</strong> migumujuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Hata <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi katika vyuo vikub<strong>wa</strong> (universites) <strong>wa</strong>lidangany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuvut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuungana namaagizo <strong>ya</strong>o. Mara <strong>wa</strong>liponas<strong>wa</strong> katika mtego iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

haiwezekani kupata uhuru. Wazazi wengi <strong>wa</strong>likataa kutuma vijana <strong>wa</strong>o katika vyuo<br />

vikub<strong>wa</strong>. Vyuo vikazoofika, na ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> elimu ukaenea pote.<br />

Papa akatoa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kusikia maungamo na kutoa rehema-shina la<br />

uovu mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Wakageuka k<strong>wa</strong> kuzidisha faida zao, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojitenga k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kidunia <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kabisa kutoa masamaha hata <strong>wa</strong>vunja sheria <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kienda<br />

mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong>o, na makosa maba<strong>ya</strong> zaidi <strong>ya</strong>kaongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> haraka. Za<strong>wa</strong>di<br />

zilizopasa kusaidia <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong> na maskini zikaenda k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>. Utajiri <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojitenga k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> kidunia ukaongezeka daima, na majumba <strong>ya</strong>o makub<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

meza za anasa vikaonyesha zaidi kuongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> umaskini k<strong>wa</strong> taifa. Huku <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kukaza uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong>wengi <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> katika imani <strong>ya</strong> uchawi na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kuamini ku<strong>wa</strong> kazi yote <strong>ya</strong> dini iliyoonyesha ukubali <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa,<br />

kusujudu <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, kufan<strong>ya</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>di k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, hili liliku<strong>wa</strong> la kutosha k<strong>wa</strong> kujipatia<br />

nafasi mbinguni!<br />

Wycliffe k<strong>wa</strong> maarifa safi, akashambulia mizizi <strong>ya</strong> uovu, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba utaratibu<br />

wenyewe ni <strong>wa</strong> uongo na ulipas<strong>wa</strong> kuondole<strong>wa</strong> kabisa. Mabishano na mas<strong>wa</strong>li <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>kiamsh<strong>wa</strong>. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiongoz<strong>wa</strong> kujiuliza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>kupas<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta<br />

rehema zao k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu zaidi kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> askofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma. (Tazama Nyongezo). “Wata<strong>wa</strong><br />

na mapadri <strong>wa</strong> Roma,” <strong>wa</strong>kasema, “<strong>wa</strong>ko <strong>wa</strong>natula kama ugonj<strong>wa</strong> unaoit<strong>wa</strong> (cancer),<br />

Mungu anapash<strong>wa</strong> kutuokoa, kama sivyo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>taangamia”. Wata<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ombezi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojidai k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kifuata mfano <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba Yesu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kisaidi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili wema <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Madai ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaongoza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia kujifunza ukweli <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe.<br />

Wycliffe akaanza kuandika na kuchapa vimakaratasi na tuvitabu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, kuita<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia na Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke. Si k<strong>wa</strong> njia ingine bora kuliko angeweza<br />

31


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kutumia k<strong>wa</strong> kumuangusha yule mn<strong>ya</strong>ma mkub<strong>wa</strong> ambaye Papa alimufanyiza, na ndani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke mamilioni <strong>wa</strong>liokamat<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wycliffe alipoit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutetea haki za ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Uingereza juu <strong>ya</strong> kujiingiza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Roma, alitaj<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> balozi <strong>wa</strong> kifalme katika inchi <strong>ya</strong> Hollandi. Hapo ilimfan<strong>ya</strong> rahisi<br />

kupelekeana habari na mapadri kutoka Ufaransa, Italia, na Ispania, na aliku<strong>wa</strong> na bahati <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutazama nyuma matukio <strong>ya</strong>liyofich<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke huko Uingereza. Katika <strong>wa</strong>jumbe ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> baraza <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Papa akasoma tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> serekali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa.<br />

Akarudi Uingereza kukariri mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na juhudi kub<strong>wa</strong>, kutangaza ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kiburi na udanganyifu viliku<strong>wa</strong> miungu <strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kurudi Uingereza, Wycliffe akapokea kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme kutaj<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kasisi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Lutterworth. Jambo hili liliku<strong>wa</strong> uhakikisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba mfalme aliku<strong>wa</strong> bado hajachuki<strong>wa</strong><br />

na kusema k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi. Muvuto <strong>wa</strong> Wycliffe ukaonekana katika muundo <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

taifa. Radi za Papa zikatup<strong>wa</strong> upesi juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Matangazo matatu <strong>ya</strong> Papa <strong>ya</strong>katum<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuamuru mipango <strong>ya</strong> gafula <strong>ya</strong> kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> “upinzani <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong><br />

dini”<br />

Kufika k<strong>wa</strong> matangazo <strong>ya</strong> Papa kukawek<strong>wa</strong> agizo katika Uingereza pote kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mpinga <strong>wa</strong> dini. (Tazama Nyongezo). Ilionekana kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wycliffe alipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuanguka upesi k<strong>wa</strong> kisasi cha Roma. Lakini yeye aliyetangaza k<strong>wa</strong> mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong><br />

zamani, “usiogope ...: mimi ni ngabo <strong>ya</strong>ko” (M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 15:1), akanyosha mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

kulinda mtumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Kifo kikaja, si k<strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> askofu aliyeamuru<br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Kifo cha Gregoire XI kulifuat<strong>wa</strong> na uchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> mapapa <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>pinzani. (Tazama<br />

Nyongezo). Kila mmoja akaita <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>ke kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita k<strong>wa</strong> mwengine, kukaza<br />

maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> hofu kuu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinzani <strong>wa</strong>ke na ahadi za za<strong>wa</strong>di mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinzani <strong>ya</strong>lifan<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>liweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> mashambuliano<br />

mmoja k<strong>wa</strong> mwengine, na Wycliffe k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule aliku<strong>wa</strong>akipumzika.<br />

Mutengano pamoja na bishano yote na uchafu ambayo vilita<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mategenezo k<strong>wa</strong> kuwezesha <strong>wa</strong>tu kuona hakika hali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma. Wycliffe akaita<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu kuzania kama mapapa ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kisemea ukweli katika kuhukumiana<br />

mmoja k<strong>wa</strong> mwengine kama mpinga Kristo.<br />

Akakusudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba nuru inapas<strong>wa</strong> kuenez<strong>wa</strong> kila pahali katika Uingereza, Wycliffe<br />

akatengeneza kundi la <strong>wa</strong>hubiri, kujishusha, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojitoa <strong>wa</strong>liopenda ukweli na<br />

kuamania kuipanua. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kifundisha katika barabara za miji<br />

mikub<strong>wa</strong>,na katika njia inchini, <strong>wa</strong>kitafuta <strong>wa</strong>zee, <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong>, na maskini, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>fungulia habari za furaha za neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Kule Oxford, Wycliffe akahubiri Neno la Mungu ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyumba vikub<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> chuo<br />

kikuu. Akapata cheo cha Daktari (Docteur) <strong>wa</strong> injili. Lakini kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> mno <strong>ya</strong> maisha<br />

32


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> kutafsiri k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> Kiingereza, ili kila mtu katika<br />

Uingereza aweze kusoma kazi za ajabu za Mungu.<br />

Anashambuli<strong>wa</strong> na Ugonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Hatari<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> gafula kazi zake zikasimamish<strong>wa</strong>. Inga<strong>wa</strong> aliku<strong>wa</strong> hajaeneza miaka makumi<br />

sita, taabu isiyokoma, kujifunza, na mashambulio <strong>ya</strong> maadui <strong>ya</strong>lilegeza nguvu zake<br />

nakumfan<strong>ya</strong> aonekane mzee upesi. Akashambuli<strong>wa</strong> na ugonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> hatari. Wata<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>lifikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba atatubu k<strong>wa</strong> uovu alioufan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa, na <strong>wa</strong>kaenda haraka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

chumba chake ili <strong>wa</strong>sikilize maungamo <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Unaku<strong>wa</strong> na kifo k<strong>wa</strong> midomo <strong>ya</strong>ko”,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasema; “uguswe basi k<strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>ko, na ukane mbele yetu mambo yote uliyosema<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hasara yetu”.<br />

Mtengenezaji akasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu. Ndipo akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia mlinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke kumuinua katika<br />

kitanda chake. Katika ku<strong>wa</strong>kazia macho k<strong>wa</strong> imara, akasema katika sauti hodari <strong>ya</strong> nguvu<br />

ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> iki<strong>wa</strong>letea kutetemeka mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara, “Sitakufa, bali nitaishi; na tena<br />

nitatangaza matendo maovu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>”. Waliposhangaz<strong>wa</strong> na kupata ha<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>katoka chumbani k<strong>wa</strong> haraka.<br />

Wycliffe aliishi k<strong>wa</strong> kuweka katika mikono <strong>wa</strong>na inchi <strong>wa</strong>ke silaha za nguvu sana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupinganisha Roma-Biblia, mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>liyewek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa utum<strong>wa</strong>ni,<br />

kuangazia na kuhubiri <strong>wa</strong>tu. Wycliffe alijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni miaka michache tu <strong>ya</strong> kazi iliyobaki<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke; aliona upinzani aliopash<strong>wa</strong> kukutana nao; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kuti<strong>wa</strong> moyo na ahadi za Neno<br />

la Mungu, akaendelea. Katika nguvu zote zake za akili, na tajiri k<strong>wa</strong> matendo, alita<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong><br />

na maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> jambo hili, kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko zote. Mtengenezaji katika<br />

nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ukasisi huko Lutterworth, alizarau wimbi lililosirika, akajitia mwenyewe<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke aliyoichagua.<br />

Mwishowe kazi ikatimilika-tafsiri <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> Biblia k<strong>wa</strong> kingereza. Mtengenezaji<br />

akaweka katika mikono <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Kiingereza nuru ambayo haipashwi kuzimish<strong>wa</strong><br />

kamwe. Alifan<strong>ya</strong> mengi zaidi kuvunja vifungo v<strong>ya</strong> ujinga na kufungua na kuinua inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

kuliko ilivyo kwisha kufanyi<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>shindi k<strong>wa</strong> shamba za vita.<br />

Ni k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> taabu tu nakala za Biblia ziliweza kuzidish<strong>wa</strong>. Mapezi <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> sana kupata kitabu kile, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu iliku<strong>wa</strong> vigumu k<strong>wa</strong> wenye kufan<strong>ya</strong> nakala<br />

kuweza kumaliza maombi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Wanunuzi <strong>wa</strong>tajiri <strong>wa</strong>litamani Biblia nzima. Wengine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kanunua tu kipande. Katika hali nyingi, jamaa zilijiunga kununua nakala moja. Biblia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wycliffe k<strong>wa</strong> upesi ikapata njia <strong>ya</strong>ke nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Wycliffe sasa akafundisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kipekee <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti-wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani katika Kristo na haki moja tu <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko. Imani mp<strong>ya</strong> ikakubali<strong>wa</strong> karibu nusu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wangereza. Tokeo la Maandiko likaleta hofu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Wakati ule<br />

hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na sheria katika inchi <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza <strong>ya</strong> kukataza Biblia, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

33


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

haijaandik<strong>wa</strong> bado katika lughanyingine. Sheria za namna ile zilifanyika baadaye na<br />

zikakaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu.<br />

Tena <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> papa <strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> shauri mba<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha sauti <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji. K<strong>wa</strong>nza, mkutano <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>askofu ukatangaza maandiko <strong>ya</strong>ke ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupinga<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> dini. Walipovuta mfalme kijana, Richard II, upande <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kapata agizo la<br />

kifalme kufunga wote <strong>wa</strong>naohukumu mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>liyokataz<strong>wa</strong> na Roma.<br />

Wycliffe akait<strong>wa</strong> toka k<strong>wa</strong> mkutano kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> baraza kuu la taifa (parlement). K<strong>wa</strong><br />

uhodari akashitaki serkali <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Rome mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza la taifa na akaomba<br />

matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> desturi mba<strong>ya</strong> zilizotole<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa. Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>kakosa lakufan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitazami<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mtengenezaji, katika miaka <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> uzee, peke <strong>ya</strong>ke bila<br />

rafiki, angeinama k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> mfalme. Lakini baadala <strong>ya</strong>ke, Baraza likaamsha na<br />

mwito <strong>wa</strong> kugusa moyo uliofany<strong>wa</strong> na ghasia (makelele) za Wycliffe, ukavunja amri <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuteso, na Mtengenezaji aliku<strong>wa</strong> huru tena.<br />

Mara <strong>ya</strong> tatu alilet<strong>wa</strong> hukumunu, na mbele <strong>ya</strong> mahakama makuu <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa <strong>ya</strong> kifalme.<br />

Hapa sasa kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji itasimamish<strong>wa</strong>. Hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Papa.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>litimiza kusudi zao, Wycliffe atatoka katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> hukumu na na kuelekea<br />

kwenye n<strong>ya</strong>li za moto.<br />

Wycliffe Anakataa Kukana<br />

Lakini Wycliffe hakukana. Pasipo hofu akashikilia mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke na sukumia mbali<br />

mashitaka <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Akaalika <strong>wa</strong>sikilizi <strong>wa</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong> hukumu la Mungu na<br />

akupima uzito <strong>wa</strong> madanganyo na wongo <strong>wa</strong>o katika mizani <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong> milele. Uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Roho Mtakatifu uliku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji. Kama mishale kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mfuko <strong>wa</strong> mishale<br />

<strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, maneno <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji <strong>ya</strong>katoboa mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o. Mashitaka <strong>ya</strong> upinga dini,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyo<strong>ya</strong>leta juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, aka<strong>ya</strong>rudisha k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

“Pamoja na nani, munavyo fikiri,” akasema, “munayeshindana naye? na mzee anaye<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukingo <strong>wa</strong> kaburi? la! pamoja na ukweli-Ambayo unaku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu kuliko<br />

wewe, na utakushinda”. Aliposema vile, akatoka na hata mtu moja <strong>wa</strong> maadui zake<br />

hakujaribu kumzuia.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kutimiz<strong>wa</strong>, lakini mara nyingine tena alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutoa<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> injili. Aliit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliz<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza la kuhukumu la kipapa kule<br />

Roma, ambalo kila mara liliku<strong>wa</strong> likim<strong>wa</strong>nga damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu. Msiba <strong>wa</strong> kupooza<br />

ulizuia safari ile. Lakini inga<strong>wa</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke haikuweza kusiki<strong>wa</strong> pale Roma, aliweza kusema<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> barua. Mtengenezaji akam<strong>wa</strong>ndikia Papa barua, ambayo, inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> heshima na<br />

kikristo moyoni, iliku<strong>wa</strong> kemeo kali k<strong>wa</strong> ukuu na kiburi k<strong>ya</strong> jimbo la Papa.<br />

34


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wycliffe akaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> Papa na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>ke upole na unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo,<br />

muonyesha <strong>wa</strong>zi si k<strong>wa</strong>o tu bali k<strong>wa</strong> miliki <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo wote tofauti kati <strong>ya</strong>o na B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

ambaye <strong>wa</strong>najidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Wycliffe alitumainia kabisa k<strong>wa</strong>mba maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> bei <strong>ya</strong> uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Mfalme, Papa na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>ke, na ilionekana kweli<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> miezi michache ikiwezekana <strong>wa</strong>ngemletea kifo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

dini. Lakini uhodari <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> imara.<br />

Mtu ambaye k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati wote <strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke alisimama imara katika kutetea ukweli<br />

hakuna mtu <strong>wa</strong>kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> adui zake. B<strong>wa</strong>na aliku<strong>wa</strong> mlinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke; na sasa,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati adui zake <strong>wa</strong>lipohakikisha kupata mawindo <strong>ya</strong>o, mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ukamuhamisha<br />

mbali <strong>ya</strong>o. Katika kanisa lake huko Lutterworth, <strong>wa</strong>kati alipotaka kufan<strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> meza <strong>ya</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, akaanguka na kupinga kupooza communion), anakauka viungo, na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

mfupi akakata roho <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Mpinga Mbiu <strong>wa</strong> Wakati <strong>wa</strong> Sasa<br />

Mungu alitia neno la ukweli katika kiny<strong>wa</strong> cha Wycliffe. Maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lilind<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kazi zake zikazidish<strong>wa</strong> hata msingi ukawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo (Reformation).<br />

Hapaku<strong>wa</strong> mtu aliyekwenda mbele <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe ambaye k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke aliweza kutengeneza<br />

utaratibu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> matengenezo. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mpinga mbiu<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> sasa. Bali katika<br />

ukweli ambayo alioonyesha, kuliku<strong>wa</strong> umoja na ukamilifu ambao <strong>wa</strong>tengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>liofuata<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuzidisha, na ambao wengine ha<strong>wa</strong>kuufikia. Mjengo uliku<strong>wa</strong> imara na <strong>wa</strong> kweli, hata<br />

hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na mahitaji <strong>ya</strong> kugeuz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokuja baada <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> ambayo Wycliffe alianzisha ni kufungua mataifa <strong>ya</strong>liyofung<strong>wa</strong> na Roma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> na msingi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika Biblia. Hapa ndipo chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> kijito cha<br />

mibaraka kilicho tiririka tokea zamani za miaka tangu karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na ine. Aliye<br />

fundish<strong>wa</strong> kuona Roma kama uta<strong>wa</strong>la usieku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa na kukubali heshima isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

s<strong>wa</strong>li k<strong>wa</strong> heshima <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho na desturi za miaka elfu, Wycliffe akageukia mbali na<br />

mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> yote ili kusikiliza Neno Takatifu la Mungu. Badala <strong>ya</strong> kanisa inayosema k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> Papa, alitangaza mamlaka moja tu <strong>ya</strong> kweli ku<strong>wa</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inayosema k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> Neno lake. Na alifundisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba Roho Mtakatifu ndiyo mtafsiri <strong>wa</strong>ke pekee.<br />

Wycliffe aliku<strong>wa</strong> mmoja <strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>liokuja nyuma <strong>ya</strong>ke. Usafi <strong>wa</strong> maisha, juhudi imara katika kujifunza na kazi,<br />

uaminifu daima, na upendo kama ule <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, viliku<strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> mtangulizi <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Biblia ndiyo iliyomfan<strong>ya</strong> vile alivyoku<strong>wa</strong>. Majifunzo <strong>ya</strong> Biblia<br />

itakuza kile fikara, ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> ndani, na mvuto <strong>wa</strong> roho ambao kujifunza kwengine<br />

hakuwezi. Hutoa msimamo <strong>wa</strong> kusudi, uhodari na ushujaa. Juhudi, kujifunza k<strong>wa</strong> heshima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko hutolea ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> akili nyingi, pia na <strong>wa</strong> kanuni bora, kuliko<br />

hekima <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu.<br />

35


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Wycliffe, <strong>wa</strong>lijulikana kama “Wycliffites” na “Lollards”, <strong>wa</strong>kata<strong>wa</strong>nyika<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zingine, <strong>wa</strong>kichukua injili. Sasa k<strong>wa</strong> sababu mwongozi <strong>wa</strong>o aliondole<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong>katumika na juhudi nyingi kuliko mbele. Matukano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaja<br />

kusikiliza. Wengine <strong>wa</strong> cheo kikub<strong>wa</strong>, na hata bibi <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> miongoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liogeuka. Katika pahali pengi mifano <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma iliondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> makanisa.<br />

Lakini mateso makali <strong>ya</strong>kazukia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liosubutu kukubali Biblia kama kiongozi<br />

chao. K<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza katika historia <strong>ya</strong> inchi <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza amri <strong>ya</strong> kifocha <strong>wa</strong>fia<br />

upinzani <strong>wa</strong> kufungia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> dini kiliamri<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> injili. Kifo ao mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini ikafuatana na kufuatana. Wakawind<strong>wa</strong> kama adui za kanisa na <strong>wa</strong>saliti <strong>wa</strong><br />

nchi, <strong>wa</strong>teteaji <strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kuhubiri katika mahali pa siri, kutafuta kimbilio<br />

katika nyumba za maskini, na mara nyingi kujificha mbali ndani <strong>ya</strong> matundu na mapango.<br />

Ukimia, uvumilivu, <strong>wa</strong> kutokubali uchafu <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini ukaendelea kuenez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

karne nyingi. Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong>lijifunza kupenda Neno la Mungu na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong>lites<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>katoa mali <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kidunia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo. Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kukaa katika makao <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>wa</strong>kakaribisha ndugu zao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liofukuz<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>o pia <strong>wa</strong>lipofukuz<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>kakubali k<strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liotup<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hesabu haiku<strong>wa</strong> ndogo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liojitoa bila woga ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli katika gereza za<br />

hatari na katikati <strong>ya</strong> mateso na miako <strong>ya</strong> moto <strong>wa</strong>kifurahi k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lihesabi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>listahili kujua “ushirika <strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Machukio <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Papa ha<strong>ya</strong>kuweza<br />

kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mwili <strong>wa</strong> Wycliffe ulidumu katika kaburi. Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> miaka makumi ine<br />

baada <strong>ya</strong> kufa k<strong>wa</strong>ke, mifupa <strong>ya</strong>ke ikafufuli<strong>wa</strong> na ikaunguz<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, na majibu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ikatup<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kijito kando kando. “Kijito hiki”, asema m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi mzee,majifu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

“<strong>ya</strong>kachukuli<strong>wa</strong> katika Avon, Avon katika Severn, Severn katika bahari nyembamba, bahari<br />

nyembamba katika bahari kub<strong>wa</strong>. Na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo majifu <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe inaku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke, ambayo sasa <strong>ya</strong>meta<strong>wa</strong>nyika ulimwenguni mwote.”<br />

Katika mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe, Jean Huss <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia aliongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuachana na<br />

makosa mengi <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma. Kutoka Bohemia kazi ikapanuka k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zingine.<br />

Mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukita<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo makub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

36


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 6. Mashujaa Wawili<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>nzoni k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> tisa Biblia iliku<strong>wa</strong> imekwisha kutafsiri<strong>wa</strong> na ibada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote ikafanyika katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia. Lakini Gregoire VII alikusudia kuweka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu utum<strong>wa</strong>ni, na tangazo likatole<strong>wa</strong> kukataza ibada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> Kibohemia.<br />

Papa akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni furaha k<strong>wa</strong> Mwenye enzi yote k<strong>wa</strong>mba ibada <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

ifanyiwe katika lugha isiyojulikana.” Lakini Mungu anaweka ta<strong>ya</strong>ri <strong>wa</strong>jumbe k<strong>wa</strong> kulinda<br />

kanisa. Wavaudois wengi na Waalbigenses, <strong>wa</strong>lipofukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mateso, <strong>wa</strong>kaja<br />

Bohemia. Wakatumika k<strong>wa</strong> bidii katika siri. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli ikalind<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> siku za Huss kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika Bohemia <strong>wa</strong>liohukumu machafu ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

kanisa. Vitisho v<strong>ya</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa vikaamsh<strong>wa</strong>, na mateso <strong>ya</strong>kafunguli<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> injili.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> mda ikaamri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba wote <strong>wa</strong>liotoka k<strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchom<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini Wakristo, <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea mbele kushinda k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi lao. Mmoja<br />

akatangaza alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akifa, “Kutainuka mmoja kutoka miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, bila upanga<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la mamlaka, na juu <strong>ya</strong>ke ha<strong>wa</strong>taweza kumushinda.” Ta<strong>ya</strong>ri mmoja aliku<strong>wa</strong> akipanda,<br />

ambaye ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kupinga Roma utashitusha mataifa.<br />

Yohana Huss aliku<strong>wa</strong> mnyenyeke<strong>wa</strong> tangu kuzali<strong>wa</strong> na aliku<strong>wa</strong> ameach<strong>wa</strong> mapema<br />

<strong>ya</strong>tima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kifo cha baba <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mama <strong>ya</strong>ke mta<strong>wa</strong>, kuzania elimu na kuogopa <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu kama hesabu ku<strong>wa</strong> thamani <strong>ya</strong> vile tunavyo, akatafuta kulinda urithi huu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kijana <strong>wa</strong>ke. Huss alijifunza k<strong>wa</strong> chuo cha jimbo, baadaye akaenda k<strong>wa</strong> chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong><br />

(universite) kule Prague, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> umaskini <strong>wa</strong>ke akapokele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bure.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> upesi Huss akajitofutisha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maendeleo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> upesi.<br />

Upole <strong>wa</strong>ke, alipokwisha kupata mwenendo (tabia) ukampatia heshima <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu.<br />

Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mshiriki m<strong>wa</strong>minifu <strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma na mwenye kutafuta na juhudi mibaraka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kiroho. Kanisa la Roma linajidai kutoa. Baada <strong>ya</strong> kutimiza majifunzo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> college,<br />

akaingia katika ukasisi (upadri). K<strong>wa</strong> haraka alipofikia cheo kikuu, akapelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> jumba<br />

la mfalme. Akafany<strong>wa</strong> pia m<strong>wa</strong>limu (fundi) <strong>wa</strong> chuo kikuu na baadaye mkuu <strong>wa</strong> chuo<br />

kikuu (recteur). M<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi mwema munyenyekevu aka<strong>wa</strong> kiburi cha inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke, jina lake<br />

likajulikana po pote katika Ula<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Jerome, ambaye baadaye alishirikiana na Huss, akaleta toka Uingereza maandiko <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wycliffe. Malkia <strong>wa</strong> Uingereza, aliyegeuz<strong>wa</strong> na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe,<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> binti <strong>wa</strong> mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke kazi za Mtengenezaji<br />

zikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> sana katika inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong>. Huss akainama na kukubali k<strong>wa</strong> heshima<br />

matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>liyolet<strong>wa</strong>. Ta<strong>ya</strong>ri, inga<strong>wa</strong> hakuijua, akaingi k<strong>wa</strong> njia ambayo iliweza<br />

kumwongoza mbali sana <strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Picha mbili Inamvuta Huss<br />

37


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, <strong>wa</strong>geni <strong>wa</strong>wili kutoka Uingereza, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> elimu, <strong>wa</strong>lipokea nuru na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaja kuieneza katika Prague. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>kan<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka kuacha kusudi lao, <strong>wa</strong>katafuta mashauri mengine. Walipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fundi pia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>hubiri, katika mahali <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kachora picha mbili. Moja ikaonyesha<br />

kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika Yerusalema, “Mpole, naye amepanda m<strong>wa</strong>na punda” (Matayo<br />

21:5) na akafuat<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika mavazi <strong>ya</strong> kuzeeka juu <strong>ya</strong> safari na miguu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi. Picha ingine ilieleza m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano <strong>wa</strong> askofu-papa katika kanzu zake za utajiri na taji<br />

tatu, mwenye akapanda farasi ambaye amepamb<strong>wa</strong> vizuri sana, ametanguli<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>piga<br />

tarumbeta na kufuat<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> baraza <strong>ya</strong> papa (cardinals) na maaskofu katika mavazi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kifalme.<br />

Makutano <strong>ya</strong>kaja kutazama mapicha. Hapana mtu aliweza kushind<strong>wa</strong> kusoma maana.<br />

Kuka<strong>wa</strong> makelele mengi katika Prague, na <strong>wa</strong>geni <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba inafaa kuondoka.<br />

Lakini picha ikaleta <strong>wa</strong>zo kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Huss na ikamwongoza karibu sana na uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Biblia na <strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe. Inga<strong>wa</strong> aliku<strong>wa</strong> hakujita<strong>ya</strong>risha bado kukubali<br />

matengenezo yote <strong>ya</strong>liyotete<strong>wa</strong> na Wycliffe, aliona tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma, na<br />

akalaumu kiburi, tamaa <strong>ya</strong> nguvu, na makosa <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> dini.<br />

Prague Ikawek<strong>wa</strong> Chini <strong>ya</strong> Makatazo<br />

Habari zikapelek<strong>wa</strong> Roma, na Huss akait<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> Papa. Kutii<br />

kungalileta kifo cha kweli. Mfalme na malkia <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia, chuo kikuu, <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> chuo<br />

kikuu, na <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> serkali, <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga katika mwito k<strong>wa</strong> askofu k<strong>wa</strong>mba Huss aruhusiwe<br />

kubaki huko Prague na kujibu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe. Baadaye, Papa akaendelea kuhukumu<br />

nakulaumu Huss, na akatangaza mji <strong>wa</strong> Prague ku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> makatazo.<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka ule hukumu hii ikatia kofu. Watu <strong>wa</strong>limuzania Papa kama mjumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, <strong>wa</strong> kushika funguo za mbingu na jehanamu na ku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo kuita hukumu.<br />

Iliamini<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mpaka ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza Papa kutosha laana, <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>ngefungi<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> heri. Kazi zote za dini zikakataz<strong>wa</strong>. Makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kafung<strong>wa</strong>. Ndoa<br />

zikaazumish<strong>wa</strong> katika u<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Wafu <strong>wa</strong>kazik<strong>wa</strong> bila kanuni ndani <strong>ya</strong> mifereji ao<br />

mashambani.<br />

Prague ikajaa na msukosuko. Kundi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kalaumu Huss na <strong>wa</strong>kadai<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba alazimiswe kwenda Roma. K<strong>wa</strong> kutuliza makelele, Mtengenezaji akapelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mda katika kijiji chake cha kuzali<strong>wa</strong>. Hakuacha kazi zake, bali alisafiri katika inchi na<br />

kuhubiri makutano <strong>ya</strong> hamu kub<strong>wa</strong>. Wakati m<strong>wa</strong>msho katika Prague ulipotulia, Huss<br />

akarudi kuendelea kuhubiri Neno la Mungu. Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> hodari, lakini malkia na<br />

wenye cheo kikuu wengi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki zake, na <strong>wa</strong>tu katika hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kamfuata.<br />

Huss alisimama peke <strong>ya</strong>ke katika kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Sasa Jerome akajiunga katika matengenezo.<br />

Wawili ha<strong>wa</strong> baadaye <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>o, na katika mauti ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza<br />

kuachana. Katika <strong>wa</strong>tu bora ha<strong>wa</strong> ambao huleta nguvu <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> tabia, Huss aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

38


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi. Jerome, k<strong>wa</strong> kujinyenyekea k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, akapata thamani <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

kunyenyekea k<strong>wa</strong> mashauri <strong>ya</strong>ke. Chini <strong>ya</strong> kazi zao za muungano matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>kazambaa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> upesi.<br />

Mungu akaruhusu nuru kuangaza juu <strong>ya</strong> akili za <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>teule, ku<strong>wa</strong>funulia<br />

makosa mengi <strong>ya</strong> Roma, lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kupokea nuru yote <strong>ya</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> ulimwenguni. Mungu<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutoka katika giza <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma, na akazidi ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza,<br />

hatua k<strong>wa</strong> hatua, namna <strong>wa</strong>liweza kuichukua. Kama utukufu wote <strong>wa</strong> jua la azuhuri k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liodumu gizani mda mrefu, nuru kamili inge<strong>wa</strong>letea kurudi nyuma. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo<br />

aliifunua kidogo kidogo, jinsi ilivyowezekana kupokele<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Matengano katika kanisa likaendelea. Mapapa <strong>wa</strong>tatu sasa <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kishindania<br />

mamlaka. Ushindano <strong>wa</strong>o ukajaza jamii <strong>ya</strong> mataifa <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo wote machafuko.<br />

Hakutoshele<strong>wa</strong> na kuvurumisha laana, kila mmoja ni kununua silaha na kupata <strong>wa</strong>askari.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kweli feza ziweko; k<strong>wa</strong> kupata hizi, za<strong>wa</strong>di, fazili, na mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>ya</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> biashara. (Tazama Nyongezo)<br />

Pamoja na uhodari ulioongezeka Huss akapiga ngurumo juu <strong>ya</strong> machukizo <strong>ya</strong>liyo<br />

vumili<strong>wa</strong> katika jina la dini. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kashitaki Roma <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi ku<strong>wa</strong> chanzo cha shida<br />

iliyoharibu miliki <strong>ya</strong> kikristo. Tena Prague ilionekana kukaribia ugomvi <strong>wa</strong> damu. Kama<br />

katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> zamani, mtumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lishitaki<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> “yeye mtaabishaji <strong>wa</strong><br />

Israeli”. 1 Wafalme 18:17. Mji ukawek<strong>wa</strong> tena chini <strong>ya</strong> mkatazo, na Huss akarudish<strong>wa</strong> tena<br />

katika kijiji chake cha kuzali<strong>wa</strong>. Akasema kuanzia mahali pa kub<strong>wa</strong> sana pa <strong>wa</strong>zi, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

jamii <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo wote, kabla <strong>ya</strong> kukata roho <strong>ya</strong>ke kama mshuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli.<br />

Baraza kub<strong>wa</strong> likait<strong>wa</strong> kukutana kule Constance (Udachi <strong>wa</strong> kusini na magharibi),<br />

likait<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> mfalme Sigismund na mmoja <strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> mapapa <strong>wa</strong>pinzani <strong>wa</strong>tatu,<br />

Yohana XXIII. Papa Yohana, ambaye tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke na maongozi <strong>ya</strong>liweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi<br />

mba<strong>ya</strong>, hakusubutu kupinga mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Sigismund. (Tazama Nyongezo). Makusudi makuu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyopash<strong>wa</strong> kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kupon<strong>ya</strong> msukosuko katika kanisa kungoa mafundisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>siyopatana na <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyotangaz<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa ku<strong>wa</strong> kweli. Wapinzani <strong>wa</strong>wili<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>kait<strong>wa</strong> kwenda mbele pamoja na John Huss. Wa k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>lituma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>o. Papa John akaja na mashaka mengi, kuogopa kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makosa<br />

ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lileta ha<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> taji pia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi zilizo ilinda. Huku alifan<strong>ya</strong> kuingia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke katika mji <strong>wa</strong> Constance na baridi kub<strong>wa</strong>, lililofanyi<strong>wa</strong> na mapadri na maandamano<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> mfalme. Juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> chake chandarua cha zahabu, kuchukuli<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>amuzi <strong>wa</strong>ne <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>. Mwenyeji (host) alilet<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kupamb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> utajiri<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu (cardinals) na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> cheo kikub<strong>wa</strong> vika urembo <strong>wa</strong>kushangaza.<br />

Wakati ule ule msafiri mwengine aliku<strong>wa</strong> akikaribia Constance. Huss aliachana na rafiki<br />

zake kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>taonana tena, kufikiri vile safari <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikimwongoza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kingingi (mti <strong>wa</strong> kufungia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kuchom<strong>wa</strong> moto). Alipata hati (ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kupita) k<strong>wa</strong><br />

39


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia na hati ingine vile vile k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme Sigismund. Lakini alifan<strong>ya</strong><br />

matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>ke yote katika maoni <strong>ya</strong>nayoweza kuelekea kifo chake.<br />

Mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> Salama Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mfalme<br />

Katika barua k<strong>wa</strong> rafiki zake akasema: “Ndugu zangu, ... nimefan<strong>ya</strong> safari pamoja na<br />

mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> usalama kutoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mfalme k<strong>wa</strong>kukutana na maadui <strong>wa</strong>ngu wengi <strong>wa</strong><br />

kibinadamu. ... Yesu Kristo alites<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>penzi <strong>wa</strong>ke; na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo hatupaswe<br />

kushangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba alituachia mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke? ... K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, <strong>wa</strong>penzi, kama kifo changu<br />

kinapas<strong>wa</strong> kutoa sehemu k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke, naomba k<strong>wa</strong>mba kipate kunifikia upesi, na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba aweze kuniwezesha kuvumilia mateso kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ngu yote k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu. ... Hebu<br />

tuombe k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ... k<strong>wa</strong>mba nisipate kuvunja haki hata ndogo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong> injili, ili<br />

nipate kuacha mfano bora utakao fuat<strong>wa</strong> na ndugu zangu.”<br />

Katika barua ingine, Huss alisema k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe,<br />

kujishitaki mwenyewe “k<strong>wa</strong> kupendez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuvaa mavazi <strong>ya</strong> utajiri na kuweza kupoteza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati katika shuguli zisizo na maana.” Ndipo akaongeza, “hebu utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na<br />

wokovu <strong>wa</strong> mioyo uta<strong>wa</strong>le akili <strong>ya</strong>ko, na si upato <strong>wa</strong> faida na mashamba. Epuka kuipamba<br />

nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ko zaidi <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ko; na, juu <strong>ya</strong> yote, toa uangalifu <strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> kiroho. Uwe<br />

mta<strong>wa</strong> na mpole na maskini, na usimalize chakula chako katika kufan<strong>ya</strong> karamu.”<br />

Huko Constance, Huss alipe<strong>wa</strong> uhuru kamili. K<strong>wa</strong> mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> salama <strong>wa</strong> mfalme<br />

kuliongez<strong>wa</strong> uhakikisho <strong>wa</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> Papa. Lakini, katika mvunjo <strong>wa</strong> metangazo ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kikariri<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> mda mfupi Mtengenezaji akufung<strong>wa</strong> kufuatana na agizo la<br />

Papa na <strong>wa</strong>kuu (cardinals) na kusukum<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> gereza mba<strong>ya</strong> la chini <strong>ya</strong> ngome.<br />

Baadaye akahamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ngome <strong>ya</strong> nguvu ngambo <strong>ya</strong> mto Rhine na huko mfung<strong>wa</strong><br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> akilind<strong>wa</strong>. Papa k<strong>wa</strong> upesi baadaye akawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> gereza ile ile. Alishuhudi<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye hatia <strong>ya</strong> makosa maba<strong>ya</strong>, kuua mtu k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi zaidi, kufan<strong>ya</strong> biashara <strong>ya</strong><br />

mambo matakatifu <strong>ya</strong> dini, na uzinzi, “zambi zisizofaa kutaj<strong>wa</strong>.” Baadaye akan<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong><br />

taji lake. Mapapa <strong>wa</strong>pinzani pia <strong>wa</strong>kaondole<strong>wa</strong>, na askofu mp<strong>ya</strong> akachaguli<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Inga<strong>wa</strong> pape mwenyewe aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye hatia <strong>ya</strong> makosa makub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko Huss<br />

aliyo<strong>ya</strong>weka juu <strong>ya</strong> mapadri, bali ni baraza lile lile lililoondoa cheo cha askofu likadai<br />

kuangamiza Mtengenezaji. Kifungo cha Huss kikaamsha hasira nyingi katika Bohemia.<br />

Mfalme, alipokataa kuvunja mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> usalama, akapinga mambo juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini<br />

maadui <strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kuleta mabishano kushuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba “imani<br />

haipaswi kushik<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na asiyefundisha mak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ao mtu anayezani<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

upinzani <strong>wa</strong>mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, hata <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>noaku<strong>wa</strong> na mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> usalama<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>falme.”<br />

Ku<strong>wa</strong> mzaifu sababu <strong>ya</strong> ugonj<strong>wa</strong>-gereza lenye baridi na maji maji likaleta homa ambayo<br />

karibu kumaliza maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke-mwishowe Huss akalet<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza. Mwenye<br />

kufung<strong>wa</strong> minyororo akasimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> mfalme, ambaye juu <strong>ya</strong> imani nzuri aliyoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

40


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

nayo aliaahidi kumlinda. Akashikilia ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na kutoa ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kutokubali<br />

maovu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini. Akashurutish<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua au kukana mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke ao<br />

kuu<strong>wa</strong><strong>wa</strong>, akakubali kifo cha <strong>wa</strong>fia dini.<br />

Neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikamsaidia. Mda <strong>wa</strong> juma <strong>ya</strong> kuteseka kabla <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho,<br />

amani <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni ikajaa rohoni m<strong>wa</strong>ke. “Ninaandika barua hii”, akasema k<strong>wa</strong> rafiki,<br />

“katika gereza langu, na mkono <strong>wa</strong>ngu katika minyororo, kutazamia hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong> kifo<br />

kesho. ... Wakati, k<strong>wa</strong> msaada <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo, tutakutana tena katika amani <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza<br />

sana <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>jayo, mtajifunza namna gani Mungu <strong>wa</strong> rehema amejionyesha mwenyewe<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong>ngu, namna gani <strong>ya</strong> kufaa amenisaidia katikati <strong>ya</strong> majaribu na mashindano <strong>ya</strong>ngu.”<br />

Ushindi Ulioonekana Mbele<br />

Katika gereza hii <strong>ya</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> ngome aliona ushindi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Katika ndoto zake<br />

aliona Papa na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>kifuta picha za Kristo alizofananisha k<strong>wa</strong> ukuta za kanisa<br />

ndogo huko Prague. “Njozi hii ilimsumbua: lakini kesho <strong>ya</strong>ke akaona <strong>wa</strong>paka rangi wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitumika katika kurudisha picha hizi katika hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> na rangi zenye<br />

kung’aa. ... Wapaga rangi, ... <strong>wa</strong>kazunguk<strong>wa</strong> na makutano mengi, <strong>wa</strong>kasema k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu,<br />

Sasa Papa na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>je; ha<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>ya</strong>futa tena kamwe!” Akasema Mtengenezaji, “Sura <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo haitafut<strong>wa</strong> kamwe. Walitamani kuuharibu, lakini utapakali<strong>wa</strong> tena, up<strong>ya</strong> katika<br />

mioyo yote na <strong>wa</strong>hubiri bora kuliko mimi mwenyewe.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mwisho, Huss akapelek<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza, mkutano mkub<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kungaa--mfalme, <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> kifalme, makamu (deputes) <strong>ya</strong> kifalme, <strong>wa</strong>kuu (cardinals)<br />

maaskofu-mapadri, na makundi makub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Alipoit<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho, Huss akatangaza makatao <strong>ya</strong>ke ku<strong>wa</strong> hata<br />

kana. K<strong>wa</strong> kukazia macho mfalme ambaye k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> neno lake la ahadi halikutimiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kamwe, akatangaza: “Nilikusudia, k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ngu, nionekane mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza hili,<br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote na imani <strong>ya</strong> mfalme anayeku<strong>wa</strong> hapa.” Sigismuna akageuka<br />

uso k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>, namna macho <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>ya</strong>ligeuka kum<strong>wa</strong>ngalia.<br />

Hukumu ilipokwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong>, sherehe <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> ikaanza. Tena akaomb<strong>wa</strong> kukana.<br />

Huss akajibu, k<strong>wa</strong> kugeukia <strong>wa</strong>tu: “k<strong>wa</strong> uso gani, basi, napas<strong>wa</strong> kuangalia mbinguni?<br />

Namna gani naweza kuangalia makutano ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ambao nime<strong>wa</strong>hubiri injili kamilifu?<br />

Sivyo; ninaheshimu wokovu <strong>wa</strong>o zaidi kuliko mwili huu zaifu, ambayo sasa unaamri<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufa.” Mavazi <strong>ya</strong> ukasisi <strong>ya</strong>kavuli<strong>wa</strong> moja k<strong>wa</strong> moja, kila askofu kutamka laana <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akitimiliza sehemu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> sherehe. Mwishowe, “<strong>wa</strong>kaweka juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong><br />

chake kofia ao kofia <strong>ya</strong> kiaskofu <strong>ya</strong> umbo la jengo la mawe <strong>ya</strong> kartasi, ambapo sanamu za<br />

kuogof<strong>ya</strong> za pepo mba<strong>ya</strong> zilipak<strong>wa</strong> rangi, na neno “Mzushi mkuu” yenye kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbali mbele. “Furaha kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko,” akasema Huss, “nitavaa taji la ha<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> jina<br />

lako, o Yesu. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu ulivaa taji la miiba.”<br />

41


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Huss Alikufa Juu <strong>ya</strong> Mti (Mti <strong>wa</strong> kufungia Watu <strong>wa</strong> Kuchom<strong>wa</strong> na Moto <strong>wa</strong>napo ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Wahai). Sasa akachukuli<strong>wa</strong>. Maandamano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kafuata. Wakati kila kitu kiliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> moto ku<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong>, mfia dini akashauri<strong>wa</strong> mioyo tena kuokoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kukana makosa <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Makosa gani”, akasema Huss, “nitakayokanusha? Najua mimi<br />

mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba sina kosa. Namuita Mungu kushuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba yote niliyoandika na<br />

kuhubiri iliku<strong>wa</strong> na nia <strong>ya</strong> kuokoa myoyo kutoka zambini na kupotea milele; na, k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo,<br />

`furaha kub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi nitahakikisha k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ngu ukweli ule ambayo nimeuandika na ku<br />

uhubiri.”<br />

Wakati n<strong>ya</strong>li za moto zilipo<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke, akaanza kuimba, “Yesu wewe<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Daudi, unihurumie”, na hivyo akaendelea hata sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke ikan<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong><br />

milele. Mfuasi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma mwenye bidii, alipoelekeza mauti ao mateso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia<br />

dini Huss, na Jerome, aliyekufa baadaye, akasema: “Walijita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> moto kama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kienda k<strong>wa</strong> karamu <strong>ya</strong> ndoa. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kutoa kilio cha maumivu. Wakati<br />

miako ilipopanda, <strong>wa</strong>kaanza kuimba nyimbo; na mara haba ukali <strong>wa</strong> moto iliweza<br />

kukomesha kuimba k<strong>wa</strong>o.”<br />

Mwili <strong>wa</strong> Huss ilipoteketea, majifu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>likusany<strong>wa</strong> na kutup<strong>wa</strong> katika jito la Rhine<br />

na kupelek<strong>wa</strong> baharini iki<strong>wa</strong> kama mbegu iliyota<strong>wa</strong>nyika katika inchi zote za ulimwengu.<br />

Katika inchi zisizo julikana bado mbegu ile itazaa matunda mengi y kushuhudia ukweli.<br />

Sauti katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> baraza la Constance likaamsha minongono <strong>ya</strong> kusikika miaka yote<br />

iliyofuata. Mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke utasaidia makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi kusimama imara mbele <strong>ya</strong> mateso<br />

makali na kifo. Kifo chake kilionyesha <strong>wa</strong>zi uba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Maadui <strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisaidia shauri ambalo <strong>wa</strong>likusudia kuangamiza!<br />

Lakini damu <strong>ya</strong> mushuhuda mwengine ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kushuhudia ukweli. Jerome aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akimshauria Huss k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari na nguvu, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama ni lazima k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> hatari, angeruka k<strong>wa</strong> kumsaidia. Aliposikia habari <strong>ya</strong> kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji, m<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi m<strong>wa</strong>minifu akajita<strong>ya</strong>risha kutimiza ahadi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Bila ruhusa<br />

mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> usalama akashika njia kwenda Constance. Alipofika, akasadiki k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

alijiingiza yeye mwenyewe hatarini <strong>ya</strong> kupotea bila ku<strong>wa</strong> na namna <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> lolote k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> Huss. Akakimbia lakini akafung<strong>wa</strong> na akarudish<strong>wa</strong> anapofung<strong>wa</strong> na minyororo.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kutokea k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza majaribio <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kujibu <strong>ya</strong>likutana na<br />

makelele, “K<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>ya</strong>ko <strong>ya</strong> moto pamoja naye!” Akatup<strong>wa</strong> gerezani chini <strong>ya</strong> ngome na<br />

akalish<strong>wa</strong> mkate na maji. Mateso <strong>ya</strong> kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kaleta ugonj<strong>wa</strong> na kutiisha maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke; na adui zake kuogopa k<strong>wa</strong>mba angeweza ku<strong>wa</strong>kimbia, <strong>wa</strong>kamtendea si k<strong>wa</strong> ukali<br />

sana, japo akidumu katika gereza mda <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka moja.<br />

Jerome Anatii Baraza<br />

Mvunjo <strong>wa</strong> hati <strong>ya</strong> Huss ukaamsha zoruba <strong>ya</strong> hasira. Baraza ikakusudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba, badala<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuchoma Jerome, <strong>ya</strong>faa kumshurutisha kukana. Akape<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua kati <strong>ya</strong> mambo<br />

mawili kukana mambo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza au kufa juu <strong>ya</strong> mti. Alipo zoofish<strong>wa</strong> na ugonj<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

42


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ajali <strong>ya</strong> mitetemo <strong>ya</strong> gereza na mateso <strong>ya</strong> mashaka na <strong>wa</strong>si <strong>wa</strong>si, kutengana na marafiki, na<br />

kuhofish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kifo cha Huss, nguvu za Jerome zikafifia. Akakubali imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

kikatolika na uamuzi <strong>wa</strong> baraza uliohukumu wycliffe na Huss, lakini akasimamia “kweli<br />

takatifu” <strong>wa</strong>lizofundisha.<br />

Lakini katika upekee <strong>wa</strong> gereza lake aliona <strong>wa</strong>zi jambo alilofan<strong>ya</strong>. Ali<strong>wa</strong>za juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

uhodari na uaminifu <strong>wa</strong> Huss na akafikiri kukana k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli. Akafikiri<br />

habari <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu ambaye k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe alivumilia msalaba. Kabla <strong>ya</strong><br />

kukana k<strong>wa</strong>ke alipata usaada ndani <strong>ya</strong> mateso katika hakikisho la <strong>wa</strong>penzi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, lakini<br />

sasa majuto na mashaka <strong>ya</strong>katesa roho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Alijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong> kujikana kwingine<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kufany<strong>wa</strong> kabla <strong>ya</strong> yeye kuweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na amani pamoja na Roma. Njia ambayo<br />

aliingia ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuishia tu katika ukufuru kamili.<br />

Jerome Anapata Toba na Uhodari Mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

Upesi akapelek<strong>wa</strong> tena mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza. Waamzi ha<strong>wa</strong>kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> na kujitaa k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Ila tu k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli ndipo Jerome angaliweza kuokoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Lakini alikusudia kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong>ke na kufuata ndugu <strong>ya</strong>ke mfia dini k<strong>wa</strong> miako <strong>ya</strong> moto.<br />

Alikataa kujikania k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na, kama mtu mwenye kufa, akadai k<strong>wa</strong> heshima<br />

apewe bahati ajitetee. Maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>kashikilia k<strong>wa</strong>mba angekubali tu ao kukana mashitaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyolet<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Jerome akakataa juu <strong>ya</strong> udanganyifu kama ule. “Mumenishika bila<br />

kusema siku mia tatu na makumi ine katika gereza la kutiisha,” akasema; “Munanileta basi<br />

mbele yenu, na kutoa sikio lenu k<strong>wa</strong> adui zangu za kibinadamu, munakataa kunisikia. ...<br />

Mujihazari kuto kufan<strong>ya</strong> zambi juu <strong>ya</strong> haki. Lakini mimi, niko binadamu zaifu; maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu ni <strong>ya</strong> maana kidogo; na ninapo <strong>wa</strong>on<strong>ya</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa hukumu isiyo ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> haki,<br />

nasema machache k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu mwenyewe kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yenu.”<br />

Maombi <strong>ya</strong>ke mwishowe <strong>ya</strong>kakubali<strong>wa</strong>. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, Jerome akapiga magoti<br />

na akaomba k<strong>wa</strong>mba Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ipate kuta<strong>wa</strong>la ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke, ili asiweze kusema kitu<br />

cho chote kinacho ku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume cha ukweli ao kisichofaa k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong>ke siku<br />

ile ahadi ikatimia “Wakati <strong>wa</strong>napo<strong>wa</strong>peleka ninyi, musisumbuke namna gani ao neno gani<br />

mutakalolisema; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu mutape<strong>wa</strong> saa ile neno mutakalosema. K<strong>wa</strong> maana si ninyi<br />

munaosema, lakini Roho <strong>ya</strong> Baba yenu anayesema ndani yenu.” Matayo 10:19, 20.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka wote mzima Jerome aliku<strong>wa</strong> katika gereza, bila kuweza kusoma ao hata<br />

kuona. K<strong>wa</strong>ni maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza sana na uwezo kama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakusumbuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati k<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza. Akaonyesha <strong>wa</strong>sikilizi <strong>wa</strong>ke mstari mrefu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>liohukumi<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>amzi <strong>wa</strong>siohaki. Karibu kila kizazi <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitafuta kuinua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kafukuz<strong>wa</strong>. Kristo mwenyewe<br />

alihukumi<strong>wa</strong> kama mfan<strong>ya</strong> maovu k<strong>wa</strong> baraza la hukumu lisiyo haki.<br />

Jerome sasa akatangaza toba <strong>ya</strong>ke na kutoa ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong>mba Huss hana kosa na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni mtakatifu. “Nilimjua tokea utoto <strong>wa</strong>ke,” akasema. “Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu bora zaidi,<br />

43


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mwenye haki na mtakatifu; alihukumi<strong>wa</strong>, ijapoku<strong>wa</strong> haku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa ... niko ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufa. Sitarudia nyuma mbele <strong>ya</strong> maumivu maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>nayota<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu<br />

na adui zangu na mashahidi <strong>wa</strong> uongo, ambao siku moja <strong>wa</strong>tatoa hesabu <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

ujanja mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu Mkuu, ambaye hakuna kitu kinaweza kudangan<strong>ya</strong>.”<br />

Jerome akaendelea: “K<strong>wa</strong> zambi zote nilizozifan<strong>ya</strong> tangu ujana <strong>wa</strong>ngu, hakuna moja<br />

inayoku<strong>wa</strong> na uzito sana katika akili <strong>ya</strong>ngu, na kuniletea majuto makali, kama ile<br />

niliyofan<strong>ya</strong> katika mahali hapa pa kufisha, <strong>wa</strong>kati nilipokubali hukumu mba<strong>ya</strong> sana<br />

iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe, na juu <strong>ya</strong> mfia dini mtakatifu, John Huss, b<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ngu na<br />

rafiki <strong>ya</strong>ngu. Ndiyo! Ninatubu kutoka moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ngu, na natangaza k<strong>wa</strong> hofu kuu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba nilitetemeka k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong> mauti, nililaumu mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

hiyo ni naomba ... Mwenyezi Mungu tafazali unirehemu zambi zangu, na hii k<strong>wa</strong> upekee,<br />

mba<strong>ya</strong> kuliko zote.”<br />

Kuelekeza k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amuzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, akasema k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari, “Muli<strong>wa</strong>hukumu Wycliffe na<br />

John Huss ... mambo ambayo <strong>wa</strong>lihakikisha, na <strong>ya</strong>siyo <strong>ya</strong> udanganyifu, nafikiri, pia vile vile<br />

na kutangaza, kama <strong>wa</strong>o.” Maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kakat<strong>wa</strong>. Maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>kitetemeka na hasira,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kapaza sauti: “Haja gani iko pale <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda zaidi? Tunaona k<strong>wa</strong> macho yetu wenyewe<br />

wingi <strong>wa</strong> ukaidi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinga dini!”<br />

Bila kutikis<strong>wa</strong> na tufani, Jerome akakaza sauti: “Nini basi! munafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba naogopa<br />

kufa? Mulinishika m<strong>wa</strong>ka mzima katika gereza la kutisha, la kuchukiza kuliko mauti<br />

yenyewe. ... Siwezi bali naeleza mshangao <strong>wa</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> ushenzi mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> namna hii juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mkristo.” Akahesabi<strong>wa</strong> Kifungo na Mauti. Tena zoruba <strong>ya</strong> hasira ikatokea k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu,<br />

na Jerome akapelek<strong>wa</strong> gerezani k<strong>wa</strong> haraka. K<strong>wa</strong>ni kuliku<strong>wa</strong> wengine ambao maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>ya</strong>li<strong>wa</strong>gusa na ku<strong>wa</strong>pa ma<strong>wa</strong>zo mioyoni na <strong>wa</strong>litamani kuokoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Alizuri<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kuu wenye cheo na kumuomba sana kutii baraza. Matumaini mazuri <strong>ya</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

za<strong>wa</strong>di.<br />

“Shuhudieni k<strong>wa</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko matakatifu k<strong>wa</strong>mba niko katika makosa,” akasema,<br />

“na nitaikana k<strong>wa</strong> kiapo.”<br />

“Maandiko matakatifu”! akapaza sauti mmoja <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jaribu <strong>wa</strong>ke, “je, kila kitu basi<br />

ni kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le Maandiko? Nani anaweza ku<strong>ya</strong>fahamu mpaka kanisa<br />

ame<strong>ya</strong>tafsiri?”<br />

“Je, maagizo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na bei kuliko injili <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi wetu?” akajibu Jerome.<br />

“Mpunga dini!” liliku<strong>wa</strong> jibu. “Natubu k<strong>wa</strong> kutetea <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu pamoja nanyi. Naona<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba unashurutish<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani”.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> gafula akapelek<strong>wa</strong> mahali pale pale ambapo Huss alitoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Alikwenda<br />

akiimba njiani m<strong>wa</strong>ke, uso <strong>wa</strong>ke ukang’aa k<strong>wa</strong> furaha na amani. K<strong>wa</strong>ke mauti ilipoteza<br />

kutisha k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Wakati mwuaji, alipotaka ku<strong>wa</strong>sha kundi, akasimama nyuma <strong>ya</strong>ke, mfia dini<br />

44


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

akapaza sauti, “tieni moto mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong>ngu, Kama niliku<strong>wa</strong> nikiogopa, singeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

hapa.” Maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ni maombi: “B<strong>wa</strong>na Baba Mwenyezi,<br />

unihurumie, na unirehemu zambi zangu; k<strong>wa</strong> maana unajua k<strong>wa</strong>mba niliku<strong>wa</strong> nikipenda<br />

sikuzote Ukweli.” Majifu <strong>ya</strong> mfia dini <strong>ya</strong>kakusanyi<strong>wa</strong> na, kama <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> Huss, <strong>ya</strong>katup<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika Rhine. Basi k<strong>wa</strong> namna hii <strong>wa</strong>chukuzi <strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liangamiz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Kuua<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Huss kuli<strong>wa</strong>sha moto <strong>wa</strong> hasira na hofu kuu katika Bohemia. Taifa lote<br />

likamtangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu m<strong>wa</strong>minifu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli. Baraza likaweke<strong>wa</strong> mzigo <strong>wa</strong> uuaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kaleta mvuto mkub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko mbele, na wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo. Papa na mfalme <strong>wa</strong>kaungana kuangamiza<br />

tendo hili la dini, na majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Sigismund <strong>ya</strong>katup<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Bohemia. K<strong>wa</strong> kushambulia<br />

wenye imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo.<br />

Lakini Mwokozi akainuli<strong>wa</strong> juu. Ziska, mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>skari <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke, aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwongozi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia. Tumaini katika usaada <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>kashindana na majeshi <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>ngaliweza kulet<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o. Mara nyingi<br />

mfalme alikashambulia Bohemia, ila tu k<strong>wa</strong> kufukuz<strong>wa</strong>. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss <strong>wa</strong>kainuli<strong>wa</strong> juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong> mauti, na hakuku<strong>wa</strong> kitu cha. Mshujaa Ziska akafa, lakini pahali pake<br />

pakakombole<strong>wa</strong> na Procopius, k<strong>wa</strong> heshima fulani aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwongozi <strong>wa</strong> uwezo zaidi.<br />

Papa akatangaza pigano juu <strong>ya</strong> maovu (crusade) juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss. Majeshi mengi<br />

akatumbukia juu <strong>ya</strong> Bohemia, k<strong>wa</strong> kutes<strong>wa</strong> tu na maangamizi. Pigano lingine la maovu<br />

likatangaz<strong>wa</strong>. Katika inchi zote za dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma katika Ula<strong>ya</strong>, mali na vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> vita<br />

vikakusany<strong>wa</strong>. Watu wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaja k<strong>wa</strong> bendera <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma. Majeshi makub<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaingia Bohemia. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika tena ku<strong>wa</strong>fukuza. Majeshi mawili <strong>wa</strong>kakribiana<br />

hata mto tu ndio ulioku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong>o. “Wapiga vita juu <strong>ya</strong> maovu (crusade) <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika jeshi bora kub<strong>wa</strong> na la nguvu, lakini badala <strong>ya</strong> kuharakisha ngambo <strong>ya</strong> kijito, na<br />

kumaliza vita na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss, ambao <strong>wa</strong>likuja toka mbali kukutana nao, <strong>wa</strong>kasimama<br />

kutazama k<strong>wa</strong> kim<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>pingaji.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> gafula hofu kuu <strong>ya</strong> ajabu ikaangukia jeshi. Bila kupiga kishindo jeshi kub<strong>wa</strong> lile<br />

likatiish<strong>wa</strong> na likata<strong>wa</strong>nyika kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba lilifukuz<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu isiyoonekana. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Huss <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>fuata <strong>wa</strong>kimbizi, na mateka makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaanguka mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shindi.<br />

Vita badala <strong>ya</strong> kuleta umaskini, ika<strong>wa</strong>letea <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia utajiri. Miaka michache baadaye,<br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> Papa mp<strong>ya</strong>, pigano juu <strong>ya</strong> maovu lingine likawek<strong>wa</strong>. Jeshi kub<strong>wa</strong> likaingia<br />

Bohemia. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss <strong>wa</strong>karudi nyuma mbele <strong>ya</strong>o, kuvuta maadui ndani zaidi <strong>ya</strong><br />

inchi, ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza ku<strong>wa</strong>za ushindi ulikwisha kupatikana.<br />

Mwishowe jeshi la askari la Procopius likasogea ku<strong>wa</strong>piganisha vita. Namna sauti <strong>ya</strong><br />

jeshi lililo karibia iliposiki<strong>wa</strong>, hata kabla <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> macho, hofu<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> tena ikaanguka iuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pigani <strong>wa</strong> crusade. Wafalme, <strong>wa</strong>kuu, na <strong>wa</strong>askari <strong>wa</strong><br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida, <strong>wa</strong>katupa silaha zao, <strong>wa</strong>kakimbia pande zote. Maangamizo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kamili, na<br />

45


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

tena mateka makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaanguka mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shindi. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili jeshi la<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu hodari k<strong>wa</strong> vita, <strong>wa</strong>liozoea vita, <strong>wa</strong>kakimbia bila shindo mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tetezi <strong>wa</strong> taifa<br />

ndogo na zaifu. Adui <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong> na hofu kub<strong>wa</strong> isiyo <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu. Yule aliyekimbiza<br />

majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Wamidiani mbele <strong>ya</strong> Gideoni na <strong>wa</strong>tu miatatu <strong>wa</strong>ke, alinyosha tena mkono<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Tazama Waamuzi 7:1925; Zaburi 53:5.<br />

Kusaliti<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Njia <strong>ya</strong> Upatanishi<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa mwishowe <strong>wa</strong>katumia njia <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho. Mapatano likafan<strong>ya</strong><br />

ambalo k<strong>wa</strong>lo likasaliti <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia katika uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia <strong>wa</strong>kataja<br />

sharti inne k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> amani kati <strong>ya</strong>o na Roma: (1) uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri Biblia; (2) haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

kanisa lote katika mambo mawili hayo <strong>ya</strong> mkate na divai katika ushirika na matumizi <strong>ya</strong><br />

lugha <strong>ya</strong> kienyeji katika ibada <strong>ya</strong> Mungu; (3) Kutenga <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini la kikristo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kazi zote za kidunia na mamlaka; na, (4) <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kosa, hukumu <strong>ya</strong> baraza za serkali juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> mapadri iwe sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>. Hukumu za Papa zikakubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mambo mane <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>kubaliwe, “lakini haki <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>ya</strong>eleza ... inapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> baraza--<br />

katika maneno mengine, k<strong>wa</strong> Papa na k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme.” Roma ikashinda k<strong>wa</strong> unafiki na<br />

madanganyo mambo ambayo k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> vita alishind<strong>wa</strong>. Kukubalia Roma uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kutafsiri maandishi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss, kama juu <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, iliweza kupotosha maana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupendeza makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika Bohemia, kuona k<strong>wa</strong>mba jambo lile lilisaliti uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o,<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kukubali mapatano. Kutopatana kukaumka, na kuletaugomvi kati <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

wenyewe. Procopius mwenye cheo akashind<strong>wa</strong>, na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia ukakoma.<br />

Tena majeshi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>askari <strong>ya</strong> kigeni <strong>ya</strong>kashambulia Bohemia, na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liodumu ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong> injili <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> katika hatari k<strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> damu. K<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>lisimama imara.<br />

Wakakaz<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta kimbilio katika mapango, <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kukusanyika kusoma Neno la<br />

Mungu na kujiunga katika ibada <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe k<strong>wa</strong> siri <strong>wa</strong>katuma k<strong>wa</strong> inchi<br />

mbali mbali <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza “k<strong>wa</strong>mba katikati <strong>ya</strong> milima <strong>ya</strong> Alps (safu <strong>ya</strong> milima mirefu)<br />

kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la zamani, la kudumu juu <strong>ya</strong> misingi <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko, na kukataa maovu <strong>ya</strong><br />

ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> Roma.” K<strong>wa</strong> furaha kub<strong>wa</strong>, uhusiano <strong>wa</strong> kuandikiana uka<strong>wa</strong> kati <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

na Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Waendense furaha kub<strong>wa</strong>, (Vaudois). Msimamo imara <strong>wa</strong> injili, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

Bohemia <strong>wa</strong>kangoja usiku kucha <strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong>o, katika saa <strong>ya</strong> giza kuu hata <strong>wa</strong>kageuza<br />

macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> upeo kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naokesha hata asubui.<br />

46


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 7. Mapinduzi Yanaanza<br />

Wak<strong>wa</strong>nza miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioit<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza kanisa kutoka gizani m<strong>wa</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma k<strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong> imani safi zaidi kukasimama Martin Luther.<br />

Hakuogopa kitu chochote bali Mungu, na kukubali msingi wowote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani bali<br />

Maandiko matakatifu. Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu anayefaa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Miaka <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> Luther ilitumi<strong>wa</strong> katika nyumba masikini <strong>ya</strong> mlimaji <strong>wa</strong><br />

Ujeremani. Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke alimukusudia ku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na sheria (mwombezi), lakini Mungu<br />

akakusudia kumufan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye mjengaji katika hekalu kub<strong>wa</strong> ambalo liliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

likiinuka pole pole katika karne nyingi. Taabu, kukataz<strong>wa</strong>, na maongozi magumu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ni masomo ambamo Hekima lsiyo na mwisho ilimta<strong>ya</strong>risha Luther k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Baba <strong>wa</strong> Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong> kutenda. Akili <strong>ya</strong>ke safi ikamwongoza<br />

kutazama utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka. Hakupendez<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati Luther, bila ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

akuingia katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> (monastere). Ilichunkua miaka miwili ili baba apatane<br />

na mtoto <strong>wa</strong>ke, na hata hivyo maoni <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kibaki <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>le. Wazazi <strong>wa</strong> Luther<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajitahidi kulea <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o katika kumjua Mungu. Bidii zao ziliku<strong>wa</strong> za haki na<br />

kuvumilia kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> mafaa. N<strong>ya</strong>kati zingine <strong>wa</strong>litumia ukali<br />

sana, lakini Mtengenezaji mwenyewe aliona katika maongozi <strong>ya</strong>o mengi <strong>ya</strong> kukubali kuliko<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuhukumu.<br />

Katika masomo Luther alitende<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukali na hata mapigano. Akites<strong>wa</strong> na njaa mara<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mara. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> giza, na juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> dini iliodumu <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ule ikamuogopesha. Akilala usiku na moyo <strong>wa</strong> huzuni, katika hofu <strong>ya</strong> daima k<strong>wa</strong> kufikiria<br />

Mungu kama sultani mkali, zaidi kuliko Baba mwema <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Wakati alipoingia k<strong>wa</strong> chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong> (universite) cha Erfurt, matazamio <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mazuri sana kuliko katika miaka <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Wazazi <strong>wa</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>wa</strong>lioipata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> matumizi mazuri <strong>ya</strong> pesa na bidii, <strong>wa</strong>liweza kumusaidia k<strong>wa</strong> mahitaji yote. Na rafiki<br />

zake wenye akili sana <strong>wa</strong>kapunguza matokeo <strong>ya</strong> giza <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

mivuto <strong>ya</strong> kufaa, akili <strong>ya</strong>ke ikaendelea upesi. Matumizi <strong>ya</strong> bidii upesi ikamutia katika cheo<br />

kikuu miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> wenzake.<br />

Luther hakukosa kuanza kila siku na maombi, moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke kila mara ukipumuamaombi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uongozi. “Kuomba vizuri, “akisema kila mara, “ni nusu bora <strong>ya</strong> kujifunza.” Siku moja<br />

katika chumba cha vitabu (librairie) cha chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong> akavumbua Biblia <strong>ya</strong> Kilatini<br />

(Latin), kitabu ambacho hakukiona kamwe. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> akisikia sehemu za Injili na N<strong>ya</strong>raka<br />

(Barua), ambazo alizania ku<strong>wa</strong> Biblia kamili. Sasa, k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, akatazama, juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Neno la Mungu kamili. K<strong>wa</strong> hofu na kushangaa akageuza kurasa takatifu na akasoma yeye<br />

mwenyewe maneno <strong>ya</strong> uzima, kusimama kidogo k<strong>wa</strong> mshangao, “O”, kama Mungu<br />

angenipa kitabu cha namna hii k<strong>wa</strong>ngu mwenyewe!” Malaika <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kando <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

47


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mishale <strong>ya</strong> nuru kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>kafunua hazina za kweli k<strong>wa</strong> ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Hakikisho kub<strong>wa</strong> la hali <strong>ya</strong>ke ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye zambi likamushika kuliko zamani.<br />

Kutafuta Amani<br />

Mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> kupata amani pamoja na Mungu <strong>ya</strong>kamwongoza kujitoa mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>. Hapa aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitaki<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi ngumu za chini sana na kuomba<br />

omba nyumba k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba. Akaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu katika kujishusha huku,akiamini hii<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> lazima sababu <strong>ya</strong> zambi zake. Alijizuia mwenyewe saa zake za usingizi na kujinyima<br />

hata <strong>wa</strong>kati mdogo <strong>wa</strong>kula chakula chake kichache, akapendez<strong>wa</strong> na kujifunza Neno la<br />

Mungu. Alikuta Biblia iliyofungi<strong>wa</strong> mnyororo k<strong>wa</strong> ukuta <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hiki (Biblia) akaenda mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara.<br />

Akaanza maisha magumu sana zaidi, akijaribu kufunga,kukesha, na kujitesa k<strong>wa</strong> kutisha<br />

maovu <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akasema baadaye, “Kama mta<strong>wa</strong> angeweza kupata mbingu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi<br />

zake za uta<strong>wa</strong>, hakika ningepas<strong>wa</strong> kustahili mbingu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi hiyo. ... Kama ingeendelea<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu, ningepas<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua uchungu <strong>wa</strong>ngu hata kufa.” K<strong>wa</strong> bidii <strong>ya</strong>ke yote, roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong>ke haikupata usaada. Mwishowe akafika karibu hatua <strong>ya</strong> kukata tamaa.<br />

Wakati ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo yote <strong>ya</strong>mepotea, Mungu akainua rafiki k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke. Staupitz akafungua Neno la Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>wa</strong> Luther na akamwomba kutojitazama<br />

mwenyewe na kutazama k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. “Badala <strong>ya</strong> kujitesa mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi<br />

zako, ujiweke wewe mwenyewe katika mikono <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi. Umutumaini, katika haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke, malipo <strong>ya</strong> kifo chake...M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu kukupatia uhakikisho<br />

<strong>wa</strong> toleo <strong>ya</strong> kimungu. ... Umpende yeye aliyekupenda mbele.” Maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong><br />

mvuto mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Amani ikakuja k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke ili<strong>ya</strong>taabika.<br />

Alipotakas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> padri, Luther akait<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> cheo cha m<strong>wa</strong>limu katika chuo kikuu<br />

(universite) cha Wittenberg. Akaanza kufundisha juu <strong>ya</strong> Zaburi, Injili, na k<strong>wa</strong> barua k<strong>wa</strong><br />

makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sikilizi <strong>wa</strong>liopendez<strong>wa</strong>. Staupitz, mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke akamwomba kupanda k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mimbara na kuhubiri. Lakini Luther akajisikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba hastahili kusema k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika<br />

jina la Kristo. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> tu baada <strong>ya</strong> juhudi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu ndipo alikubali maombi <strong>ya</strong> rafiki<br />

zake. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> katika Maandiko, na neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi uwezo ambao alifundisha nao ukweli ukasadikisha ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>o, na nguvu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

ikagusa mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> akingali mtoto <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma, haku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

ataku<strong>wa</strong> kitu kingine cho chote. Akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuzuru Roma, aliendelea safari <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

miguu, kukaa katika nyumba za <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> njiani. Akajaz<strong>wa</strong> na ajabu hali nzuri na <strong>ya</strong> damani<br />

ambayo alishuhudia. Wata<strong>wa</strong> (moines) <strong>wa</strong>likaa katika vyumba vizuri, <strong>wa</strong>kajivika <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe katika mavazi <strong>ya</strong> bei kali, na kujifurahisha k<strong>wa</strong> meza <strong>ya</strong> damani sana. Mafikara <strong>ya</strong><br />

Luther <strong>ya</strong>lianza kuhangaika.<br />

48


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mwishowe akaona k<strong>wa</strong> mbali mji <strong>wa</strong> vilima saba. Akaanguka mwenyewe chini<br />

udongoni, kupaaza sauti: “Roma mtakatifu, nakusalimu!” Akazuru makanisa akasikiliza<br />

hadizi za ajabu zilizokariri<strong>wa</strong> na mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> ibada zote zilizohitaji<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Po pote, mambo <strong>ya</strong>kamushangaza --uovu miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi, ubishi usiofaa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maaskofu. Akachukiz<strong>wa</strong> na (unajisi) <strong>wa</strong>o hata <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> misa. Akakutana upotevu,<br />

usharati. “Hakuna mtu anaweza ku<strong>wa</strong>zia,” akaandika, “zambi gani na matendo maovu sana<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ko <strong>ya</strong>kitendeka katika Roma. ... Watu huzoea kusema, ` Kama kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na jehanumu,<br />

Roma inajeng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke.’”<br />

Ukweli juu <strong>ya</strong> ngazi <strong>ya</strong> Pilato<br />

Kuachi<strong>wa</strong> kuliahidi<strong>wa</strong> na Papa k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>takaopanda juu <strong>ya</strong> magoti <strong>ya</strong>o “Ngazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Pilato,” <strong>wa</strong>liozania ku<strong>wa</strong> ilichukuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwujiza toka Yerusalema hata Roma. Luther<br />

siku moja aliku<strong>wa</strong> akipanda ngazi hizi <strong>wa</strong>kati sauti kama radi ilionekana kusema, “Mwenye<br />

haki ataishi k<strong>wa</strong> imani.” Waroma 1:17. Akaruka k<strong>wa</strong> upesi k<strong>wa</strong> magoti <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> na<br />

hofu kuu. Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati ule akaona k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi kuliko mbele neno la uongo la kutumaini kazi<br />

za binadamu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wokovu. Akageuza uso <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Roma. Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati ule<br />

mutengano ukakomaa ku<strong>wa</strong> hata akakata uhusiano wote na kanisa la Roma.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke kutoka Roma, Luther akapokea cheo cha m<strong>wa</strong>limu (docteur) <strong>wa</strong><br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Sasa aliku<strong>wa</strong> na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kujitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko<br />

ambayo ali<strong>ya</strong>penda. Akaweka naziri (<strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> Mungu) kuhubiri k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu Neno la<br />

Mungu, si mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>Papa. Haku<strong>wa</strong> tena mta<strong>wa</strong> tu, bali mjumbe aliyeruhusi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

Biblia, aliyeit<strong>wa</strong> kama mchungaji (pasteur) k<strong>wa</strong> kulisha kundi la Mungu lilloku<strong>wa</strong> na njaa<br />

na kiu <strong>ya</strong> ukweli. Akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong> bidii k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong>paswe kupokea mafundisho<br />

mengine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le ambayo <strong>ya</strong>nayojeng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko matakatifu.<br />

Makundi yenye bidii <strong>ya</strong>kapenda sana maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Habari <strong>ya</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mwokozi, hakikisho la msamaha na amani katika damu <strong>ya</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong>ke ikafurahisha mioyo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Huko Wittenberg nuru ili<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong>, ambayo n<strong>ya</strong>li <strong>ya</strong>ke iongezeke kungaa zaidi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati.<br />

Lakini kati <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na uongo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> vita. Mwokozi wetu Mwenyewe alitangaza:<br />

“Musifikiri <strong>ya</strong> kama nimekuja kuleta salama duniani, sikuja kuleta salama lakini upanga.”<br />

Matayo 10:34. Akasema Luther, miaka michache baada <strong>ya</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo:<br />

“Mungu ... ananisukuma mbele ... nataka kuishi katika utulivu; lakini nimetup<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong><br />

makelele na mapinduzi makuu.”<br />

Huruma za kuuzisha<br />

Kanisa la Roma lilifan<strong>ya</strong> Biashara <strong>ya</strong> Neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Chini <strong>ya</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> kuongeza<br />

mali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kujenga jengo la Petro mtakatifu kule Roma, huruma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi<br />

zilizotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuuzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> Papa. K<strong>wa</strong> bei <strong>ya</strong> uovu hekalu lilipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujeng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni jambo hili ambalo liliamusha adui<br />

49


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma na kufikia k<strong>wa</strong> vita ambayo ilitetemesha kiti cha Papa na<br />

mataji matatu juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha askofu huyu.<br />

Tetzel, mjumbe aliyechaguli<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza uujishaji <strong>wa</strong> huruma katika Ujeremani,<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> amehakikish<strong>wa</strong> makosa maba<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, lakini alitumi<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuendesha mipango <strong>ya</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> Papa katika Ujeremani. Akasema bila ha<strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

uongo na hadizi za ajabu k<strong>wa</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>jinga <strong>wa</strong>naoamini <strong>ya</strong>siyo na msingi.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> na neno la Mungu ha<strong>wa</strong>ngedangany<strong>wa</strong>, lakini Biblia ilikataz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wakati Tetzel alipoingia mjini, mjumbe alimutangulia mbele, kutangaza: “Neema <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu na <strong>ya</strong> baba mtakatifu inaku<strong>wa</strong> milangoni mwenu”. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kamkaribisha mtu <strong>wa</strong><br />

uwongo anayetukana Mungu kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba angeku<strong>wa</strong> Mungu mwenyewe. Tetzel, kupanda<br />

mimbarani ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, akatukuza uujisaji <strong>wa</strong> huruma kama za<strong>wa</strong>di za damani sana za<br />

Mungu. Akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> sheti cha msamaha, zambi zote ambazo<br />

mnunuzi angetamani kuzitenda baadaye zitasamehe<strong>wa</strong> na “hata toba si <strong>ya</strong> lazima.”<br />

Akahakikishia <strong>wa</strong>sikilizi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba vyeti v<strong>ya</strong>ke v<strong>ya</strong> huruma viliku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kuokoa <strong>wa</strong>fu; k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule kabisa pesa inapogonga k<strong>wa</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> sanduku<br />

lake, roho inayolipi<strong>wa</strong> pesa ile itatoroka kutoka toharani (purgatoire) na kufan<strong>ya</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

kwenda mbinguni.<br />

Zahabu na feza zikajaa katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> hazina <strong>ya</strong> Tetzel. Wokovu ulionunuli<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mali ulipatikana k<strong>wa</strong> upesi kuliko ule unaohitaji toba, imani, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> bidii k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kushindana na kushinda zambi. (Tazama Nyongezo). Luther akajaz<strong>wa</strong> na hofu kuu. Wengi<br />

katika shirika lake <strong>wa</strong>kanunua vyeti v<strong>ya</strong> msamaha. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>kaanza kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mchungaji (pasteur) <strong>wa</strong>o, k<strong>wa</strong> kutubu zambi na kutumainia maondoleo <strong>ya</strong> zambi, si k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sababu <strong>wa</strong>litubu na <strong>wa</strong>litamani matengenezo, bali k<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> sheti cha huruma. Luther<br />

akakataa, na aka<strong>wa</strong>on<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba isipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kutubu na kugeuka, <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuangamia katika zambi zao. Wakaenda k<strong>wa</strong> Tetzel na malalamiko k<strong>wa</strong>mba muunganishaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o alikataa vyeti v<strong>ya</strong>ke, na wengine <strong>wa</strong>kauliza k<strong>wa</strong> ujasiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba mali <strong>ya</strong>o irudishwe.<br />

Alipojaz<strong>wa</strong> na hasira, mta<strong>wa</strong> (religieux) akatoa laana za kutisha, akataka mioto i<strong>wa</strong>ke mbele<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote, na akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “alipata agizo k<strong>wa</strong> Papa kuunguza <strong>wa</strong>pinga dini wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naosubutu kupinga, vyeti v<strong>ya</strong>ke v<strong>ya</strong> huruma takatifu zaidi.”<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Luther Inaanza<br />

Sauti <strong>ya</strong> Luther ikasiki<strong>wa</strong> mimbarani katika onyo la kutisha. Akaweka mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

tabia mba<strong>ya</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong> zambi na kufundisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba haiwezekani k<strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi zake<br />

mwenyewe kupunguza zambi zake ao kuepuka malipizi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hakuna kitu bali toba k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu na imani katika Kristo inaoweza kuokoa mwenye zambi. Neema <strong>ya</strong> Kristo haiwezi<br />

kununuli<strong>wa</strong>; ni za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> bure. Akashauri <strong>wa</strong>tu kutokununua vyeti v<strong>ya</strong> huruma, bali<br />

kutazama k<strong>wa</strong> imani k<strong>wa</strong> Mkombozi aliyesulubi<strong>wa</strong>. Akasimulia juu <strong>ya</strong> habari mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> uchungu na akahakikisha <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> kuamini Kristo<br />

ndipo mtu atapata amani na furaha.<br />

50


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakati Tetzel alipoendelea na kiburi chake cha kukufuru, Luther akajitahidi kusema<br />

kutokukubali k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Nyumba <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Wittenberg iliku<strong>wa</strong> na picha (reliques) ambayo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sikukuu fulani <strong>ya</strong>lionyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Maondoleo kamili <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>liozuru kanisa na <strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> maungamo. Jambo moja la mhimu sana la n<strong>ya</strong>kati<br />

hizi, sikukuu <strong>ya</strong> Watakatifu Wote, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikikaribia. Luther, alipoungana na makundi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyo jita<strong>ya</strong>risha kwenda kanisani, akabandika k<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> kanisa mashauri makumi<br />

tisa na tano juu <strong>ya</strong> kupinga <strong>ya</strong> uuzishaji <strong>wa</strong> vyeti (musamaha).<br />

Makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kavuta uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. Yakasom<strong>wa</strong> na ku<strong>ya</strong>kariri po pote,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kasitusha sana <strong>wa</strong>tu katika mji wote. K<strong>wa</strong> maelezo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lionyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa masamaha <strong>ya</strong> zambi na kuachili<strong>wa</strong> malipizi <strong>ya</strong>ke haukutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Papa ao k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mtu ye yote. Ilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong>mba neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ilitole<strong>wa</strong> bure k<strong>wa</strong> wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoitafuta k<strong>wa</strong> toba na imani.<br />

Mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> na Luther <strong>ya</strong>kata<strong>wa</strong>nyika pote katika Ujeremani na baada <strong>ya</strong><br />

majuma machache <strong>ya</strong>kasikilika pote katika Ula<strong>ya</strong>. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liojifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa<br />

la Roma <strong>wa</strong>kasoma mashauri ha<strong>ya</strong> (mambo <strong>ya</strong>lioandik<strong>wa</strong> na Luther) k<strong>wa</strong> furaha, kutambua<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong>o sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Walijisikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba B<strong>wa</strong>na aliweka mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke kufunga maji<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyotomboka <strong>ya</strong> uovu uliolet<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Roma. Waana <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme na <strong>wa</strong>amuzi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

siri <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi k<strong>wa</strong>mba kizuio kilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kiburi ambayo<br />

ilikataa kuacha maamuzi <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Wapadri <strong>wa</strong> hila, kuona faida zao ku<strong>wa</strong> hatarini, <strong>wa</strong>kakasirika. Mtengenezaji<br />

(Reformateur) aliku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>shitaki <strong>wa</strong>kali <strong>wa</strong>kushindana naye. “Nani asiyejua, ” akajibu,<br />

“k<strong>wa</strong>mba si mara nyingi mtu kuleta ma<strong>wa</strong>zo mp<strong>ya</strong> bila. kushitaki<strong>wa</strong> kukaamsha<br />

mabishano? ... Sababu gani Kristo na <strong>wa</strong>fia dini wote <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong>? K<strong>wa</strong> sababu ... <strong>wa</strong>lileta<br />

mambo map<strong>ya</strong> bila kupata k<strong>wa</strong>nza shauri la unyenyekevu la mtu <strong>wa</strong> hekima na maoni <strong>ya</strong><br />

zamani.”<br />

Makaripio <strong>ya</strong> adui za Luther, masingizio <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke, ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

uovu juu <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>juu <strong>ya</strong>ke kama garika. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> ameamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ongozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tajiunga naye k<strong>wa</strong> furaha katika matengenezo. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati aliona siku bora<br />

zikipambazuka k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa.<br />

Lakini kutiia moyo kukageuka ku<strong>wa</strong> karipio. Wakuu wengi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa na jamii <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> serkali k<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba ukubali <strong>wa</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli karibu<br />

ungaliharibu mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma, kuzuia maelfu <strong>ya</strong> vijito vinavyotiririka sasa katika nyumba<br />

<strong>ya</strong> hazina <strong>ya</strong>ke, na vivi hivi kupunguza anasa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa. Kufundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

kumutazama Kristo peke <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wokovu kungeangusha kiti cha askofu na<br />

baadaye kuharibu mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe kupinga<br />

Kristo na kweli ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinzani k<strong>wa</strong> mtu aliyetum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>angazia.<br />

51


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Luther akatetemeka <strong>wa</strong>kati alipojiangalia mwenyewe--mtu mmoja akapinga <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

nguvu nyingi <strong>wa</strong> dunia. “Mimi niliku<strong>wa</strong> nani?” akaandika, “kupinga enzi <strong>ya</strong> Papa, mbeie<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ... <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> dunia na ulimwengu wote ulitetemeka? ... Hakuna mtu anaweza kujua<br />

namna gani moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu uliteseka mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka hii miwili <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na katika kukata<br />

tamaa, naweza kusema katika kufa moyo, nilizama.” Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati usaada <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu<br />

ulishind<strong>wa</strong>, alitazama k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu peke <strong>ya</strong>ke. Aliweza kuegemea katika usalama juu <strong>ya</strong> ule<br />

mkono ulio <strong>wa</strong> guvu zote.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> rafiki Luther akaandika: “Kazi <strong>ya</strong>ko <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza ni kuanza na ombi. ... Usitumaini<br />

kitu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi zako mwenyewe, k<strong>wa</strong> ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>ko mwenyewe: Tumaini tu katika Mungu,<br />

na katika mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu.” Hapa kuna fundisho la maana k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojisikia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu ame<strong>wa</strong>ita kutoa k<strong>wa</strong> wengine ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu.<br />

Katika vita pamoja na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> uovu kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na mahitaji <strong>ya</strong> kitu kingine zaidi kuliko<br />

akili na hekima <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu.<br />

Luther Alikimbilia Tu k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia<br />

Wakati adui <strong>wa</strong>likimbilia k<strong>wa</strong> desturi na desturi <strong>ya</strong> asili, Luther alikutana nao<br />

anapoku<strong>wa</strong> na Biblia tu, bishano ambayo ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kujibu. kutoka mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> Luther na<br />

maandiko kulitoka n<strong>ya</strong>li za nuru ambazo ziliamsha na kuangazia maelfu. Neno la Mungu<br />

liliku<strong>wa</strong> kama upanga unaokata ngambo mbili, unaokata njia<strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Macho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, k<strong>wa</strong> mda mrefu <strong>ya</strong>liongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida za kibinadamu na <strong>wa</strong>ombezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

kidunia, sasa <strong>wa</strong>limugeukia Kristo katika imani na Yeye aliyesulubish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Usikizi huu ukaamsha woga k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa. Luther akapokea mwito kuonekana<br />

huko Roma. Rafiki zake <strong>wa</strong>lijua vizuri hatari ile iliyomngoja katika mji mwovu huo,<br />

uliokwisha kuny<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini <strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Wakauliza k<strong>wa</strong>mba apokee mashindano<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke katika Ujeremani.<br />

Jambo hili likatendeka, na mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa akachaguli<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliza mambo yenyewe.<br />

Katika maagizo k<strong>wa</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong> huyu, alijulish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Luther alikwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama mpingaji <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini. Mjumbe aliku<strong>wa</strong> basi ni “kutenda na kulazimisha bila<br />

kukawia.” Mjumbe akape<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> “kumufukuza katika kila upande <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani;<br />

kumfukuzia mbali, kumlaani, na kutenga <strong>wa</strong>le wote <strong>wa</strong>lioambatana naye”, Ku<strong>wa</strong>tenga na<br />

cheo cho chote kiki<strong>wa</strong> cha kanisa ao cha serkali, ila tu mfalme, hatajali kumkamata Luther<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke na ku<strong>wa</strong>toa k<strong>wa</strong> kisasi cha Roma.<br />

Hakuna alama <strong>ya</strong> kanuni <strong>ya</strong> kikristo ao hata haki <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida inapas<strong>wa</strong> kuonekana katika<br />

maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong>. Luther haku<strong>wa</strong> na nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kueleza <strong>wa</strong>la kutetea musimamo <strong>wa</strong>ke; lakini<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> amekwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mpingaji <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini na k<strong>wa</strong> siku ile ile<br />

alishauri<strong>wa</strong>, kushitaki<strong>wa</strong>, kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong>, na kulaumi<strong>wa</strong>. Wakati Luther alihitaji sana shauri la<br />

rafiki <strong>wa</strong> kweli, Mungu akamtuma Melanchthon kule Wittenberg. Shida <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Melanchthon, ikachanganyika na usafi (utakatifu) na unyofu <strong>wa</strong> tabia, ikashinda sifa <strong>ya</strong><br />

52


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu wote. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi aka<strong>wa</strong> rafiki m<strong>wa</strong>minifu sana <strong>wa</strong> Luther--upole <strong>wa</strong>ke, uangalifu, na<br />

usahihi ika<strong>wa</strong>zidisho la bidii na nguvu za Luther.<br />

Augsburg palitaj<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa hukumu, na Mtengenezaji (Reformateur) akaenda<br />

huko k<strong>wa</strong> miguu. Vitisho vilifany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba angeua<strong>wa</strong> njiani, na rafiki zake <strong>wa</strong>kamuomba<br />

asijihatarishe. Lakini maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong>, “Ninaku<strong>wa</strong> kama Yeremia, mtu <strong>wa</strong> ushindano,<br />

na ugomvi; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna matisho <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>lizidi, ndipo furaha <strong>ya</strong>ngu iliongezeka...<br />

Wamekwisha kuharibu heshima (sifa) <strong>ya</strong>ngu na mwenendo <strong>wa</strong>ngu. ... Kuhusu roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu,<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kuikamata. Yeye anayetaka kutangaza neno la Kristo ulimwenguni, inampasa<br />

kutazamia kifo <strong>wa</strong>kati wowote.”<br />

Akari <strong>ya</strong> kufika k<strong>wa</strong> Luther huko Augsburg kukaleta kushele<strong>wa</strong> kukub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mjumbe<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Papa. Mpinga mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> dini anayeamsha ulimwengu akaonekana sasa ku<strong>wa</strong> chini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Roma; hakupas<strong>wa</strong> kuponyoka. Mjumbe alikusudia kulazimisha Luther<br />

kukana, ao isipowezekana alazimishe kwenda Roma kufuata n<strong>ya</strong>yo <strong>ya</strong> Huss na Jerome.<br />

Mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa akatuma <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kum<strong>wa</strong>mbia Lutter afike bila ahadi <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi salama<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mfalme na matumaini <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe wema <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo mtengenezaji akakataa.<br />

Hata <strong>wa</strong>kati alipopata ahadi <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> mfalme mkuu ndipo akakubali kuonekana mbele<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa. Kama mpango <strong>wa</strong> busara, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kumpata<br />

Luther k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kujioyesha kama <strong>wa</strong>pole.<br />

Mjumbe akajionyesha ka<strong>wa</strong> rafiki mkub<strong>wa</strong>a, lakini akaomba k<strong>wa</strong>mba Luther ajitoe<br />

kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa na kukubali kila kitu bila mabishano <strong>wa</strong>la s<strong>wa</strong>li. Luther, k<strong>wa</strong> kujibu,<br />

akaonyesha heshima <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli, ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong> kujibu makatazo yote kuhusu <strong>ya</strong>le aliyo<strong>ya</strong>fundish<strong>wa</strong>, na kuweka mafundisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke chini <strong>ya</strong> uamuzi <strong>wa</strong> vyuo vikub<strong>wa</strong> (universites). Lakini alikataa juu <strong>ya</strong> mwendo <strong>wa</strong><br />

askofu katika kummulazimisha kukana bila kuonyesha na kuhakikisha kosa lake.<br />

Jibu moja tu liliku<strong>wa</strong>, “uKane, ukane”! Mtengenezaji akaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba msiimamo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke unakubali<strong>wa</strong> na Maandiko. Hakuweza kukana ukweli. Mjumbe, aliposhind<strong>wa</strong> kujibu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mabishano <strong>ya</strong> Luther, akamulemeza na zoruba <strong>ya</strong> laumu, zarau, sifa <strong>ya</strong> uongo maneno<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kiasili (traditions), na mezali (maneno) <strong>ya</strong> Wababa, akikatalia Mtengenezaji<br />

nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kusema. Luther mwishowe, bila kupenda, akamupa ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kutoa jibu lake k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maandiko.<br />

Akasema,akiandika k<strong>wa</strong> rafiki, “Mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> ingeweza kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> wengine; na jambo la pili, mtu anaku<strong>wa</strong> na bahati nzuri sana <strong>ya</strong> kutumika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hofu nyingi, kama si k<strong>wa</strong> zamiri, <strong>ya</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> kiburi na <strong>wa</strong> kusema ovyo ovyo ambaye njia<br />

ingine angeshinda k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke makali.” K<strong>wa</strong> mkutano uliofuata, Luther<br />

akaonyesha maelezo mafupi na <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>ya</strong>nayoshuhudi<strong>wa</strong> na Maandiko.<br />

Kartasi hii, baada <strong>ya</strong> kusoma k<strong>wa</strong> sauti nguvu, akaitoa k<strong>wa</strong> askofu, naye akaitupa kando<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> zarau, kuitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> mchanganyiko <strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> bure na mateuzi <strong>ya</strong>siyofaa. Sasa<br />

53


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Luther akakutana na askofu <strong>wa</strong> kiburi k<strong>wa</strong> u<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe--mambo <strong>ya</strong> asili na<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa--na kuangusha kabisa majivuno <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Askofu akapoteza kujita<strong>wa</strong>la kote na katika hasira akapandisha sauti, “ukane! ao<br />

nitakutuma Roma”. Na mwishowe akatangaza, katika sauti <strong>ya</strong> kiburi na hasira, “uKane, ao<br />

usirudi tena.” Mtengenezaji k<strong>wa</strong> upesi akaondoka pamoja na rafiki zake, hivyo kutangaza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong>mba asingoje k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba atakana. Hili si jambo ambalo askofu alilokusudia.<br />

Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Luther Sasa, akaach<strong>wa</strong> peke <strong>ya</strong>ke pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>saidizi <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>katazamana<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o na huzuni k<strong>wa</strong> kushind<strong>wa</strong> kusikotazami<strong>wa</strong> katika mipango <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Makutano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> pale <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kulinganisha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>wili<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> na kuhukumu <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe roho iliyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> nao, vivyo hivyo na nguvu na ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong> nia zao. Mtengenezaji, munyenyekevu, mpole, imara, k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> upande<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke; mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa, mwenye kujisifu, mwenye kiburi, mpumbavu, bila hata neno moja<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, lakini <strong>wa</strong> juhudi <strong>ya</strong> kupandisha sauti, “uKana, ao utumwe Roma.”<br />

Kuokoka Toka Augsburg<br />

Rafiki za Luther <strong>wa</strong>kasihi sana k<strong>wa</strong>mba hivi iliku<strong>wa</strong> bure k<strong>wa</strong>ke kubakia, heri kurudi<br />

Wittenberg bila kukawia, na lile onyo halisi lifuatwe. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo akaondoka Augsburg kabla<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mapambazuko juu <strong>ya</strong> farasi, akisindikiz<strong>wa</strong> na mwongozi moja tu aliyetole<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>muzi. K<strong>wa</strong> siri akafan<strong>ya</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong>ke katika njia za giza za mji. Maadui, <strong>wa</strong>angalifu tena<br />

<strong>wa</strong>uaji, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kifan<strong>ya</strong> shauri la kumuangamiza. N<strong>ya</strong>kati hizo ziliku<strong>wa</strong> za mashaka na<br />

maombi <strong>ya</strong> juhudi. Akafikia mlango katika ukuta <strong>wa</strong> mji. Ulifunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke, na<br />

pamoja na mwongozi <strong>wa</strong>ke akapita ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kabla mjumbe kupata habari <strong>ya</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong><br />

Luther, aliku<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong>ke K<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> kutoroka k<strong>wa</strong> Luther<br />

mjumbe akajaz<strong>wa</strong> na mshangao na hasira. Alitumaini kupokea heshima kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

mambo angatendea mtu huyu anaye sumbuake kanisa. Katika barua k<strong>wa</strong> Frederick,<br />

mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>Saxony, akashitaki Luther k<strong>wa</strong> ukali, kuomba k<strong>wa</strong>mba Frederick amtume<br />

Mtengenezaji Roma ao amfukuze kutoka Saxony.<br />

Mchaguzi aliku<strong>wa</strong> hajafahamu sana mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mtengenezaji, lakini alivut<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na usikivu <strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Frederick akaamua ku<strong>wa</strong>, mpaka <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

mtengenezaji atahakikisha ku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa. Frederick aka<strong>wa</strong>mlinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika jibu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa akaandika: “Tangu M<strong>wa</strong>limu Martino alipoonekana mbele yenu huko<br />

Augsburg, mungepash<strong>wa</strong> kutoshele<strong>wa</strong>. Hatukutumainia k<strong>wa</strong>mba mungemulazimisha<br />

kukana bila kumsadikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> na makosa. Hakuna wenye elimu hata mmoja<br />

katika uta<strong>wa</strong>la wetu aliyenijulisha <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Martino <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> machafu,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kupinga Kristo ao <strong>ya</strong> kupinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini.” Mchaguzi aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

matengenezo ilihitaji<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sisi akafurahi kuona mvuto bora uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

katika kanisa.<br />

54


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka mmoja tu ulipita tangu Mtengenezaji alipoweka mabishano k<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa, lakini maandiko <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liamusha mahali pote usikizi mp<strong>ya</strong> katika Maandiko<br />

matakatifu. Si k<strong>wa</strong> pande zote tu za Ujeremani, bali k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zingine, <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasongana k<strong>wa</strong> chuo kikuu. Vijana <strong>wa</strong>lipokuja mbele <strong>ya</strong> Wittenberg k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza “<strong>wa</strong>kainua mikono <strong>ya</strong>o mbinguni, na kusifu Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kuweza kuleta nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

ukweli kuangaza kutaka mji huu.”<br />

Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> amegeuka nusu tu k<strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma. Lakini aliandika,<br />

“Ninasoma amri za maaskofu, na ... sijui kama Papa ndiye anayeku<strong>wa</strong> mpinzani <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

yeye mwenyewe, ao mtume <strong>wa</strong>ke, zaidi <strong>ya</strong> yote kristo ameelez<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong> kabisa na<br />

kusulubi<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>o.”<br />

Roma ikazidi kukasirish<strong>wa</strong> na mashambulio <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Wapinzani <strong>wa</strong>shupavu, hata<br />

<strong>wa</strong>alimu (docteurs) katika vyuo vikuu v<strong>ya</strong> Kikatoliki, <strong>wa</strong>katangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba yule angeweza<br />

kumua mta<strong>wa</strong> yule angeku<strong>wa</strong> bila zambi. Lakini Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> mlinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Mafundisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kasiki<strong>wa</strong> po pote--“katika nyumba ndogo na nyumba za <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> (couvents), ...<br />

katika ngome za wenye cheo, katika vyuo vikub<strong>wa</strong>, katika majumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu Luther akaona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ukweli mhimu juu <strong>ya</strong> kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong><br />

imani iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikishik<strong>wa</strong> na Mtengenezaji, Huss, <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia. “Tumeku<strong>wa</strong> na vyote”<br />

akasema Luther, “Paul, Augustine, na mimi mwenyewe, Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Huss bila kujua!”<br />

“ukweli huu ulihubiri<strong>wa</strong> ... karne iliyopita na ikachom<strong>wa</strong>!”<br />

Luther akaandika basi mambo juu <strong>ya</strong> vyuo vikuu: “Ninaogopa sana k<strong>wa</strong>mba vyuo vikuu<br />

vitaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> milango mikub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> jehanumu, isipoku<strong>wa</strong> vikitumika k<strong>wa</strong> bidii k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kueleza Maandiko matakatifu, na ku<strong>ya</strong>kaza ndani <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> vijana. ... Kila chuo ambamo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>shunguliki daima na Neno la Mungu kinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuharibika.”<br />

Mwito huu ukaenea po pote katika Ujermani. Taifa lote likashituka. Wapinzani <strong>wa</strong><br />

Luther <strong>wa</strong>kamwomba Papa kuchukua mipango <strong>ya</strong> nguvu juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Iliamri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>hukumiwe mara moja. Mtengenezaji na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke, kama<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kutubu, <strong>wa</strong>ngepas<strong>wa</strong> wote kuteng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Ushirika Mtakatifu.<br />

Shida <strong>ya</strong> Kutisha<br />

Hiyo iliku<strong>wa</strong> shida <strong>ya</strong> kutisha sana k<strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo. Luther haku<strong>wa</strong> kipofu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

zoruba karibu kupasuka, lakini alitumaini Kristo ku<strong>wa</strong> egemeo lake na ngabo <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Kitu<br />

kinacho karibia kutokea sikijui, na sijali kujua. ... Hakuna hata sivile jani linawezakuanguka,<br />

bila mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Baba yetu. Kiasi gani zaidi atatuchunga! Ni vyepesi kufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Neno,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ni Neno ambalo lilifanyika mwili lilikufa lenyewe.” Wakati barua <strong>ya</strong> Papa ilimufikia<br />

Luther, akasema: Ninaizarau, tena naishambulia, k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni<strong>ya</strong> uovu, <strong>ya</strong> uongo.... Ni Kristo<br />

yeye mwenyewe anayelaumi<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ta<strong>ya</strong>ri ninasikia uhuru kub<strong>wa</strong> moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ngu;<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ni mwishowe ninajua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Papa ni mpinga kristo na kiti chake cha ufalme ni kile<br />

cha Shetani mwenyewe.”<br />

55


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Lakini mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Roma halikukosa ku<strong>wa</strong> na matokeo. Wazaifu na <strong>wa</strong>abuduo ibada <strong>ya</strong><br />

sanamu <strong>wa</strong>katetemeka mbele <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> Papa, na wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba maisha <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> damani sana kuhatarisha. Je, kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kwisha? Luther angali<br />

bila woga. K<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kutisha akarudisha juu <strong>ya</strong> Roma yenyewe maneno <strong>ya</strong> hukumu.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> makutano <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nainchi <strong>wa</strong> vyeo vyote Luther akachoma barua <strong>ya</strong> Papa.<br />

Akasema, “Mapigano makali <strong>ya</strong>meanza sasa. Hata sasa niliku<strong>wa</strong> nikicheza tu na Papa.<br />

Nilianza kazi hii k<strong>wa</strong> jina la Mungu; si mimi atakaye imaliza, na k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ngu.... Nani<br />

anayejua kama Mungu hakunichagua na kuniita na kama ha<strong>wa</strong>pashwe kuogopa hiyo, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kunizarau, <strong>wa</strong>nazarau Mungu Mwenyewe? ...<br />

“Mungu hakuchagua kamwe kuhani aokuhani mkuu <strong>wa</strong>la mtu mkub<strong>wa</strong> yeyote; bali k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida huchagua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> chini na wenye kuzarauli<strong>wa</strong>, hata mchungaji kama Amosi. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kila kizazi, <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kukemea <strong>wa</strong>kuu, <strong>wa</strong>falme, <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme, <strong>wa</strong>kuhani,<br />

na wenye hekima, k<strong>wa</strong> hatari <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o. ... Sisemi k<strong>wa</strong>mba niko nabii; lakini nasema<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kuogopa kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> sababu niko peke <strong>ya</strong>ngu na <strong>wa</strong>o ni wengi.<br />

Ninaku<strong>wa</strong> hakika <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili, k<strong>wa</strong>mba neno la Mungu linaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nami, na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba haliko pamoja nao.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni haiku<strong>wa</strong> bila vita <strong>ya</strong> kutisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye mwenyewe ambaye Luther aliamua<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> kutengana k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho na kanisa: “Ee, uchungu <strong>wa</strong> namna gani iliniletea, ijapo<br />

niliku<strong>wa</strong> na Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ngu, kuhakikisha mimi mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

ningepas<strong>wa</strong> kusubutu kusimama pekee <strong>ya</strong>ngu kumpinga Papa, na kumutangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

mpinzani <strong>wa</strong> Kristo! Mara ngapi sikujiuliza mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> uchungu s<strong>wa</strong>li lile ambalo<br />

liliku<strong>wa</strong> mara nyingi midomoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Papa: ‘Ni wewe peke <strong>ya</strong>ko mwenye hekima?<br />

Je, <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>nadanganyika? Itaku<strong>wa</strong> namna gani, kama, mwishoni wewe mwenyewe<br />

ukionekana ku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa na ni wewe anayeshawishi katika makosa <strong>ya</strong>ko roho nyingi kama<br />

hizo. Ni nani basi atakayehukumi<strong>wa</strong> milele? Hivi ndivyo nilipigana na nafsi <strong>ya</strong>ngu na<br />

Shetani hata Kristo, k<strong>wa</strong> neno lake la hakika, akaimarisha moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu juu <strong>ya</strong> mashaka<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>.”<br />

Amri mp<strong>ya</strong> ikaonekana, kutangaza mtengano <strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa la Roma, kumshitaki kama aliyelaani<strong>wa</strong> na Mbingu, na kuweka ndani <strong>ya</strong> hukumu<br />

ilete <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaopokea mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Upinzani ni sehemu <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>le ambao Mungu<br />

hutumia k<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha ukweli zinazofaa hasa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>o. Kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na ukweli <strong>wa</strong><br />

sasa katika siku za Luther; kuna ukweli <strong>wa</strong> sasa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kanisa leo. Lakini ukweli<br />

hautakiwe na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi leo kuliko ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>liompinga Luther.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoonyesha ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu ha<strong>wa</strong>paswi kutazamia kupoke<strong>wa</strong> na upendeleo<br />

mwingi zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>tengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> zamani. Vita kuu kati <strong>ya</strong> kweli na uwongo, kati <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo na Shetani, itaongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> historia <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu huu. Tazama Yoane<br />

15:19, 20; Luka 6:26.<br />

56


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

57


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 8. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Korti<br />

Mfalme mp<strong>ya</strong>, Charles V, akamiliki k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani. Mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Saxony ambaye alisaidia Charles kupanda k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha ufalme, akamwomba kutotendea<br />

Luther kitu chochote mpaka <strong>wa</strong>kati atakapo ruhusu kumusikiliza. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo mfalme aka<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika hali <strong>ya</strong> mashaka na <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Papa ha<strong>wa</strong>ngerizish<strong>wa</strong> na kitu chochote<br />

isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kifo cha Luther. Mchaguzi akatangaza “M<strong>wa</strong>limu Luther anapash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong><br />

haki (ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> usalama), ili apate kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amzi<br />

wenye elimu, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>wa</strong>sio na upendeleo.”<br />

Makutano <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika huko Worms. K<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> kifalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

Ujeremani <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kukutana na mfalme <strong>wa</strong>o kijana katika mkusanyiko. Wakuu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa na <strong>wa</strong> serkali na mabalozi <strong>wa</strong> inchi za kigeni wote <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika kule Worms. Bali<br />

jambo ambalo lililoamusha usikivu mwingi liliku<strong>wa</strong> la Mtengenezaji. Charles alimuamuru<br />

mchaguzi kumleta Luther pamoja naye, kumuhakikishia ulinzi na kuahidi mazungumzo<br />

huru juu <strong>ya</strong> mas<strong>wa</strong>li katika mabishano. Luther akam<strong>wa</strong>ndikia mchaguzi: “Iki<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

mfalme ananiita, siwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka huo ni mwito <strong>wa</strong> Mungu mwenyewe. Kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kitaka kutumia nguvu juu <strong>ya</strong>ngu, ... Ninaweka jambo hili mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. ...<br />

Kama hataniokoa, maisha <strong>ya</strong>ngu ni <strong>ya</strong> maana kidogo. ... Unaweza kutazamia lolote kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ngu ... isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kukimbia na mimi kukana maneno <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Kukimbia siwezi, na<br />

tena kukana ni zaidi.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna habari ilienea k<strong>wa</strong>mba Luther alipash<strong>wa</strong> kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza,<br />

msisimuko uka<strong>wa</strong> pahali pote. Aleander, mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa, k<strong>wa</strong> kujulish<strong>wa</strong> hatari na<br />

akakasirika. Kuchunguza juu <strong>ya</strong> habari ambayo Papa alikwisha kutolea azabu <strong>ya</strong> hukumu<br />

ingeku<strong>wa</strong> kuzarau mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> askofu. Na tena, zaidi mabishano yenye uwezo <strong>ya</strong> mtu huyu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>naweza kugeuza <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme wengi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Papa. Akamuon<strong>ya</strong> Charles juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutoruhusu Luther kufika Worms na akashawishi mfalme kukubali.<br />

Bila kutulia juu <strong>ya</strong> ushindi huu, Aleander akaendelea kuhukumu Luther, kushitaki<br />

Mtengenezaji juu <strong>ya</strong> “fitina, uasi, ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> heshima, na matukano”. Lakini ukali <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ukafunua roho ambayo aliyoku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Anasukum<strong>wa</strong> na fitina na kulipisha kisasi.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> juhudi zaidi tena Aleander akasihi sana mfalme kutimiza amri za Papa.<br />

Aliposumbuli<strong>wa</strong> sana na maombi <strong>ya</strong> mjumbe Charles akamwomba kuleta kesi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

baraza. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si mwingi <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liopendelea Mtengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea ku<strong>ya</strong>tarajia<br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong>kasome<strong>wa</strong> na Aleander. Mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> Saxony haku<strong>wa</strong> pale, lakini baazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>shauri <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kaandika <strong>ya</strong>liyosem<strong>wa</strong> na mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa.<br />

Luther Anashitaki<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Mpinga Imani <strong>ya</strong> Dini<br />

58


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza na usemaji unaokolea, Aleander akajitahidi mwenyewe kuangusha Luther<br />

kama adui <strong>wa</strong> kanisa na serekali. “Haki,, makosa <strong>ya</strong> Luther <strong>ya</strong>metosha”, akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kushuhudia kuchom<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mamia elfu <strong>wa</strong>pinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini.”<br />

“Ni <strong>wa</strong>nani <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong> Luther? Kundi la <strong>wa</strong>alimu wenye kiburi, mapadri<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ovu, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>potovu, <strong>wa</strong>nasheria <strong>wa</strong>jinga, na wenye cheo <strong>wa</strong>lioaibish<strong>wa</strong>. ...Kundi la<br />

katoloki si lina<strong>wa</strong>pita mbali sana k<strong>wa</strong> wingi, k<strong>wa</strong> akili na k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo! Amri <strong>ya</strong> shauri moja<br />

la kusanyiko hili tukufu litaangazia <strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu, litaon<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sio na busara, litaamua<br />

wenye mashaka na kuimarisha <strong>wa</strong>zaifu.”<br />

Mabishano <strong>ya</strong> namna ile ile ingali inatumi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naosubutu kutoa<br />

mafundisho kamili <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu. “Ni <strong>wa</strong>nani ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho map<strong>ya</strong>?<br />

Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> si wenye elimu, <strong>wa</strong>chache k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu, na <strong>wa</strong> cheo cha maskini sana. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kijidai ku<strong>wa</strong> na ukweli, na ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liochaguli<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu. Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jinga na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liodanganyi<strong>wa</strong>. Namna gani kanisa letu ni kub<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu na mvuto!”<br />

Mabishano ha<strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>ko na nguvu zaidi sasa kuliko siku za Mtengenezaji.<br />

Luther haku<strong>wa</strong> pale, pamoja na maneno <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi na <strong>ya</strong> kusadikisha <strong>ya</strong> Neno<br />

la Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> kushinda shujaa Papa. Watu karibu wote <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri, si k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kumuhukumu tu, yeye na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke, bali, ikiwezekana, kuongoa upinzani <strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> dini. Yote Roma iliweza kusema katika kujitetea mwenyewe imesem<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini tofauti<br />

kati <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na uwongo ingeonekana <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi namna <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kujitoa <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

vita. Sasa B<strong>wa</strong>na akagusa moyo <strong>wa</strong> mshiriki mmoja <strong>wa</strong> baraza atoe maelezo <strong>ya</strong> matendo <strong>ya</strong><br />

jeuri <strong>ya</strong> Papa. Duc Georges <strong>wa</strong> Saxe akasimama katika mkutano huu <strong>wa</strong> kifalme; na<br />

akaonyesha sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> kabisa uwongo na machukizo <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma:<br />

“Kuzulumu ... kunapaza sauti juu <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Ha<strong>ya</strong> yote imewek<strong>wa</strong> kando na shabaha <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

moja tu ni ... pesa, pesa, pesa, ... ili <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong>naopash<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha ukweli, <strong>wa</strong>sinene<br />

kitu kingine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> uongo, na si ku<strong>wa</strong>vumilia tu, lakini ku<strong>wa</strong>lipa, k<strong>wa</strong>ni namna<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nazidi kusema uongo, ndipo <strong>wa</strong>nazidi kupata faida. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> kisima hiki kichafu maji ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

machafu hutiririka. Mambo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sherati na ulevi. Hunyoosha mkono k<strong>wa</strong> uchoyo ... Ole! ni<br />

aibu iliyolet<strong>wa</strong> na askofu kinachotupa roho maskini nyingi katika hukumu <strong>ya</strong> milele.<br />

Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> mambo yote inapas<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika.” Sababu mnenaji aliku<strong>wa</strong> adui maalumu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji alitoa mvuto mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>katoa n<strong>ya</strong>li za nuru katika giza <strong>ya</strong> uovu na ikafungua mioyo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ukweli. Uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli ukata<strong>wa</strong>la hata maadui <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo na<br />

ukata<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> ambayo ilikaribia kutimiz<strong>wa</strong>. Sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mmoja mkuu<br />

kuliko Luther ikasiki<strong>wa</strong> katika mkutano ule.<br />

Baraza ikawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha hesabu <strong>ya</strong> mambo yote <strong>ya</strong>liyo ku<strong>wa</strong> magandamizo<br />

ambayo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> mazito k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani. Oroza hii ikaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme, na<br />

kumuomba achukue hatua k<strong>wa</strong> kusahihisha mambo maba<strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>. Wakasema <strong>wa</strong>ombaji,<br />

59


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Ni <strong>wa</strong>jibu wetu kuzuia maangamizi na aibu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wetu. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo sisi wote<br />

pamoja tunakuomba k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu sana, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> haraka sana, kuagiza<br />

matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> mambo yote na kufan<strong>ya</strong> itimilike.”<br />

Luther Anaamuri<strong>wa</strong> Kufika Barazani<br />

Baraza sasa likaomba kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji. Mwishowe mfalme akakubali, na<br />

Luther akaalik<strong>wa</strong>. Mwito ukaf<strong>wa</strong>tana na ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kusafiri salama. Hati hizo mbili<br />

zikapelek<strong>wa</strong> Wittenberg na mjumbe aliyeagiz<strong>wa</strong> kumusindikiza Worms.<br />

Kujua chuki na uadui juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, rafiki za Luther <strong>wa</strong>liogopa k<strong>wa</strong>mba cheti cha kusafiri<br />

salama hakitaheshimi<strong>wa</strong>. Akajibu: “Kristo atanipa Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kushinda <strong>wa</strong>huduma<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> uongo. Nina <strong>wa</strong>zarau katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>ngu; nita<strong>wa</strong>shinda k<strong>wa</strong> kifo changu. Huko<br />

Worms <strong>wa</strong>nashugulika sana k<strong>wa</strong> kunilazimisha; ni kane kukana k<strong>wa</strong>ngu kutaku<strong>wa</strong> huku:<br />

Nilisema zamani k<strong>wa</strong>mba Papa aliku<strong>wa</strong> kasisi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo; sasa na tangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye ni<br />

mpinzani <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, na mtume <strong>wa</strong> Shetani.”<br />

Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, rafiki <strong>wa</strong>tatu <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kumsindikiza Luther. Moyo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Melanchton ukaambatana k<strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong> Luther, na akatamani sana kumfuata. Lakini<br />

maombi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kakatali<strong>wa</strong>. Akasema Mtengenezaji: “Kama sitarudi, na adui zangu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kiniua, endelea kufundisha, na kusimama imara katika ukweli. Utumike k<strong>wa</strong> nafasi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu. ... Kama ukizidi kuishi, mauti <strong>ya</strong>ngu itaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maana kidogo.” Mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

ikagandamiz<strong>wa</strong> na maono <strong>ya</strong> huzuni. Waliambi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lihukumi<strong>wa</strong> huko Worms. Mjumbe, huogopa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> usalama <strong>wa</strong> Luther k<strong>wa</strong> baraza,<br />

akauliza kama aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiendelea kutamani kwenda. Akajibu: “ijapoku<strong>wa</strong> nilikataz<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika kila mji, nitaendelea.”<br />

Huko Erfurt, Luther akapitia katika njia alizoku<strong>wa</strong> akipitia kila mara, akazuru kijumba<br />

chake cha nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, na akafikiri juu <strong>ya</strong> mapigano ambamo nuru iliojaa sasa katika<br />

Ujeremani imeta<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri. Jambo hili alikataz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kulifan<strong>ya</strong>, lakini mjumbe akamtolea ruhusa, na mtu aliyefany<strong>wa</strong> zamani mtu <strong>wa</strong> kazi ngumu<br />

za nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>, sasa akaingia k<strong>wa</strong> mimbara.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>kasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> kushangaa sana. Mkate <strong>wa</strong> uzima ulivunj<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> roho hizo<br />

zenye njaa. Kristo aliinuli<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>o na juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>papa, maaskofu, <strong>wa</strong>falme (<strong>wa</strong>kuu), na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>falme. Luther hakusema juu <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke katika hatari <strong>ya</strong>ke. Katika Kristo aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

amejisahau mwenyewe. Akajificha nyuma <strong>ya</strong> Mtu <strong>wa</strong> Kalvari, akitafuta tu kuonyesha Yesu<br />

kama Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> wenye zambi.<br />

Uhodari <strong>wa</strong> Mfia Dini<br />

Wakati Mtengenezaji alipoendelea mbele, makundi k<strong>wa</strong> hamu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kusongana<br />

karibu naye na k<strong>wa</strong> sauti za upole <strong>wa</strong>kamuon<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Waroma. “Watakuchoma”, akasema<br />

mwengine, “na kugeuza mwili <strong>wa</strong>ko ku<strong>wa</strong> majivu, kama <strong>wa</strong>livyomfan<strong>ya</strong> Jean Huss.” Luther<br />

60


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

akajibu, “ijapo <strong>wa</strong>nge<strong>wa</strong>sha moto njiani mote toka Worms hata Wittenberg, ... ningetembea<br />

kati kati <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> jina la B<strong>wa</strong>na; ningeonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong>o, ... kushuhudia B<strong>wa</strong>na Yesu<br />

Kristo.”<br />

Kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong>ke huko Worms kukafan<strong>ya</strong> msukosuko mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Rafiki <strong>wa</strong>katetemeka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> usalama <strong>wa</strong>ke; maadui <strong>wa</strong>kaogopa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> ushawishi <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>padri akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> ngome <strong>ya</strong> mwenye cheo mwema, mahali, ilitangaz<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

magumu yote <strong>ya</strong>ngeweza kutengenez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kirafiki. Warafiki <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha hatari<br />

zilizomngoja. Luther, bila kutikisika, akatangaza: “Hata kuki<strong>wa</strong> mashetani wengi ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

mji <strong>wa</strong> Worms kama vigae juu <strong>ya</strong> nyumba, lazima nitaingia.”<br />

Alipofika Worms, makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi sana <strong>ya</strong>kakusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> mji k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kumukaribisha. Kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si nyingi sana. “Mungu ataku<strong>wa</strong> mkingaji <strong>wa</strong>ngu,”<br />

akasema Luther alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akishuka k<strong>wa</strong> gari lake. Kufika k<strong>wa</strong>ke kulijaza <strong>wa</strong>padri hofu<br />

kuu. Mfalme aka<strong>wa</strong>ita <strong>wa</strong>shauri <strong>wa</strong>ke. Ni upande gani unaopash<strong>wa</strong> kufuat<strong>wa</strong>? Padri mmoja<br />

mkali akatangaza: “Tumeshauriana mda mrefu juu <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili. Mfalme mtukufu<br />

uondoshe mbio mtu huyu. Upesi, Sigismund hakuwezesha John Huss kuchom<strong>wa</strong>?<br />

Hatulazimishwe kutoa cheti cha mpinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>la kuliheshimu.m “Hapana,”<br />

akasema mfalme, “tunapash<strong>wa</strong> kushika ahadi yetu.” Tulipatana k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mtengenezaji<br />

angepash<strong>wa</strong> kusiki<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mji wote ulitamani kuona mtu huyu <strong>wa</strong> ajabu. Luther, mwenye kuchoka sababu <strong>ya</strong><br />

safari, alihitaji ukim<strong>ya</strong> na pumziko. Lakini alifurahia pumziko <strong>ya</strong> saa chache <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> cheo kikuu, wenye cheo, <strong>wa</strong>padri, na <strong>wa</strong>nainchi <strong>wa</strong>limuzunguka kabisa. Kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenye cheo <strong>wa</strong>lioomba na juhudi k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> matumizi<br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kanisa. Maadui pamoja na rafiki <strong>wa</strong>lifika kumtazama m<strong>wa</strong> shujaa. Kuvumulia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong> imara na k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari. Uso <strong>wa</strong>ke mdogo <strong>wa</strong>kufifia, uliku<strong>wa</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> upole<br />

na hata <strong>wa</strong> furaha. Juhudi nyingi <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke ikatoa uwezo ambao hata maadui zake<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kusimama kabisa. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>lisadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> naye; wengine <strong>wa</strong>katangaza, kama <strong>wa</strong>livyofan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>farisayo juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo: “Ana<br />

pepo.” Yoane 10:20.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> siku iliyofuata afisa mmoja <strong>wa</strong> mfalme akaagiz<strong>wa</strong> kumpeleka Luther k<strong>wa</strong> chumba<br />

kikub<strong>wa</strong> cha <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji. Kila njia ilijaa na <strong>wa</strong>shahidi wenye shauku <strong>ya</strong> kutazama juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mta<strong>wa</strong> aliyesubutu kushindana na Papa. Jemadari mzee mmoja, aliyeshinda vita nyingi,<br />

akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia k<strong>wa</strong> upole: “Maskini mta<strong>wa</strong>, unataka sasa kwenda kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko<br />

vita mimi ao kapiteni wengine <strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> katika mapigano <strong>ya</strong> damu nyingi. Lakini, iki<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama madai <strong>ya</strong>ko ni <strong>ya</strong> haki, ...endelea katika jina la Mungu,na usiogope kitu chochote.<br />

Mungu hatakuacha.”<br />

Luther Anasimama Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baraza<br />

61


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mfalme akaketi kitini, anapozungu k<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> cheo wenye sifa katika ufalme.<br />

Martin Luther sasa alipash<strong>wa</strong> kujibu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Kuonekana huku kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kwenyewe ishara (alama) <strong>ya</strong> ushindi juu <strong>ya</strong> cheo cha Papa. Papa alimhukumu mtu huyu, na<br />

mtu huyu alisimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza <strong>ya</strong> hukumu iliyowek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Papa. Papa alimweka<br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> makatazo, akakati<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> chama cha kibinadamu, na huku akaalik<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

manemo <strong>ya</strong> heshima, na kupokele<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> mkutano <strong>wa</strong> heshima sana katika ulimwengu.<br />

... Roma iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikishuka kutoka kitini chake, nailiku<strong>wa</strong> ni sauti la mta<strong>wa</strong> lililomushusha.”<br />

Mzali<strong>wa</strong> mnyenyekevu Mtengenezaji akaonekanamwenye kutish<strong>wa</strong> na kufazaika.<br />

Wafalme wengi, <strong>wa</strong>kamkaribia, na mmoja akamnongoneza “Musi<strong>wa</strong>ogope <strong>wa</strong>naoua mwili<br />

lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kuua nafsi.” Mwengine akasema: “Na mutakapopelek<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na <strong>wa</strong>falme k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu, mtape<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>wa</strong> baba yenu lile mtakalo<br />

lisema.” Tazama Matayo 10:28, 18, 19.<br />

Ukim<strong>ya</strong> mwingi uka<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mkutano uliosongana. Ndipo afisa mmoja <strong>wa</strong> mfalme<br />

akasimama na, kushota k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther, akauliza k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mtengenezaji ajibu<br />

mas<strong>wa</strong>li mawili-ao ata<strong>ya</strong>kubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni <strong>ya</strong>ke, na ao atakusudia kukana mashauri<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nayoandik<strong>wa</strong> humo. Vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> vitabu vilipokwisha kusom<strong>wa</strong>, Luther, k<strong>wa</strong> s<strong>wa</strong>li la<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza, akakubali vitabu ku<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>ke. “K<strong>wa</strong> s<strong>wa</strong>li la pili,” akasema, ningetenda bila busara<br />

kama ningejibu bila kufikiri. Ningehakikisha kidogo kuliko hali <strong>ya</strong> mambo inavyotaka, ao<br />

zaidi kuliko kweli inavyotaka. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo ninaomba mfalme mtukufu, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

unyenyekevu wote, unitolee <strong>wa</strong>kati, ili nipate kujibu bila kukosa juu <strong>ya</strong> neno la Mungu.”<br />

Luther akasadikisha makutano k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakutenda k<strong>wa</strong> hasira ao bila kufikiri. Utulivu<br />

huu, na kujita<strong>wa</strong>la, isiyotazami<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mtu aliyejionyesha ku<strong>wa</strong> mgumu na asiyebadili<br />

shauri <strong>ya</strong>kamwezesha baadaye kujibu k<strong>wa</strong> busara na heshima ikashangaza maadui zake na<br />

kukemea kiburi chao.<br />

Kesho <strong>ya</strong>ke alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutoa jibu lake la mwisho. K<strong>wa</strong> mda moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke ukadidimia.<br />

Maadui zake <strong>wa</strong>lionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ngeshinda. Mawingu <strong>ya</strong>kakusanyika kando <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaonekana kumtenga na Mungu. Katika maumivu <strong>ya</strong> roho akatoa malalamiko <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuhuzunisha sana, ambayo Mungu tu anaweza ku<strong>ya</strong>fahamu kabisa.<br />

“Ee Mwenyezi Mungu <strong>wa</strong> milele!” akapaza sauti; “kama ni k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu za ulimwengu<br />

huu tu ambapo napash<strong>wa</strong> kutia tumaini langu, yote imekwisha. ... Saa <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho<br />

imefika, hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ngu imekwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong>. ... Ee Mungu, unisaidie juu <strong>ya</strong> hekima yote<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu. ... M<strong>wa</strong>nzo ni <strong>wa</strong>ko, ... na ni m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> haki na <strong>wa</strong> milele. Ee B<strong>wa</strong>na,<br />

unisaidie! Mungu m<strong>wa</strong>minifu na asiyebadilika, mimi si mtumainie mtu ye yote. ...<br />

Umenichagua k<strong>wa</strong> kazi hii. ... Simama k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ngu, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> jina la mpend<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ko Yesu Kristo, anayeku<strong>wa</strong> mkingaji <strong>wa</strong>ngu, ngao <strong>ya</strong>ngu, na mnara <strong>wa</strong>ngu <strong>wa</strong> nguvu.”<br />

Lakini haiku<strong>wa</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong> mateso, maumivu, <strong>wa</strong>la mauti <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe ambayo<br />

ilimlemea na hofu kuu. Alijisika upungufu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Katika uzaifu <strong>wa</strong>ke madai <strong>ya</strong> ukweli<br />

62


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngeweza kupata hasara. Si k<strong>wa</strong> usalama <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe, bali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ushindi <strong>wa</strong><br />

injili alishindana na Mungu. Katika ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> usaada imani <strong>ya</strong>ke ikashikilia juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo,<br />

Mkombozi mkuu. Hangeonekana pekee <strong>ya</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza. Amani ikarudi k<strong>wa</strong> roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke, na akafurahi k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuinua Neno la Mungu mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

mataifa.<br />

Luther aka<strong>wa</strong>za juu <strong>ya</strong> jibu lake, akachunguza maneno katika maandiko <strong>ya</strong>ke, na akapata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko matakatifu mahakikisho <strong>ya</strong> kufaa k<strong>wa</strong> kusimamia maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ndipo,<br />

akatia mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kushoto k<strong>wa</strong> Kitabu Kitakatifu, akainua mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kuume<br />

mbinguni na akaapa k<strong>wa</strong> kiapo “kukua m<strong>wa</strong>minifu k<strong>wa</strong> injili, na k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru kutangaza<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong>ke, hata ingeweza kutia mhuri k<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kumtia damu <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Luther Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baraza Tena<br />

Wakati alipoingiz<strong>wa</strong> tena ndani <strong>ya</strong> Baraza, aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye ukim<strong>ya</strong> na amani, lakini<br />

shujaa mwenye tabia nzuri, kama mshuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Mungu miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> dunia.<br />

Ofisa <strong>wa</strong> mfalme akauliza uamuzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Je, alitaka kukana? Luther akatoa jibu lake k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sauti <strong>ya</strong> unyenyekevu, bila ugomvi <strong>wa</strong>la hasira. Mwenendo <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si na<br />

<strong>wa</strong> heshima; lakini akaonyesha tumaini na furaha ambayo ilishangaza makutano.<br />

“Mfalme mwema sana, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>tukufu, mab<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> neema,” akasema Luther,<br />

“naonekana mbele yenu leo, kufuatana na agizo nililope<strong>wa</strong> jana. Kama katika ujinga,<br />

ningevunja desturi utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> mahakama, ninaomba munirehemu; k<strong>wa</strong>ni sikukomalia<br />

katika ma nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme, bali katika maficho <strong>ya</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Ndipo akasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika kazi zake zingine zilizochap<strong>wa</strong> alieleza habari <strong>ya</strong> imani<br />

na matendo mema; hata maadui zake <strong>wa</strong>lizitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> za kufaa. Kuzikana ingehukumu<br />

kweli ambazo wote <strong>wa</strong>likubali. Aina <strong>ya</strong> pili ni <strong>ya</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> kufunua makosa na<br />

matumizi maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> cheo cha Papa. Kuharibu ha<strong>ya</strong> ni kuimarisha jeuri <strong>ya</strong> Roma na<br />

kufungua mlango ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi sana k<strong>wa</strong> ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> heshima k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Katika aina <strong>ya</strong> tatu<br />

alishambulia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liosimamia maovu <strong>ya</strong>nayoku<strong>wa</strong>ko. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> akakiri<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> mkali zaidi kuliko ilivyofaa. Lakini hata vitabu hivi hataweza<br />

kuvikana k<strong>wa</strong>ni adui za ukweli <strong>wa</strong>ngepata nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> kulaani <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ukali<br />

mwingi zaidi.<br />

Akaendelea, “Nitajitetea mwenyewe kama Kristo alivyofan<strong>ya</strong>: Kama nimesema viba<strong>ya</strong>,<br />

kushuhudia juu <strong>ya</strong> uovu’ ... K<strong>wa</strong> huruma za Mungu, ninakusihi, mfalme asio na upendeleo,<br />

na ninyi, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la bora, na <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong> kila aina, kushuhudia kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong><br />

manabii na mitume k<strong>wa</strong>mba nilidanganyika. Mara moja ninapokwisha kusadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

jambo hili, nitakana makosa yote, na nitaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kushika vitabu v<strong>ya</strong>ngu na<br />

kuvitupa motoni. ...<br />

“Bila <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si, ninafurahi kuona k<strong>wa</strong>mba injili inaku<strong>wa</strong> sasa kama k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za<br />

zamani, ambayo ni chanzo cha taabu na fitina. Hii ni tabia, na mwisho <strong>wa</strong> neno la Mungu.<br />

63


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

`Sikuja kuleta salama duniani lakini upanga,’alisema Yesu Kristo. ... Mujihazali k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuzania munazuia ugomvi musitese Neno takatifu la Mungu na kuangusha juu yenu<br />

garika la kutisha la hatari kub<strong>wa</strong> za misiba <strong>ya</strong> sasa, na maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> milele.”<br />

Luther alisema k<strong>wa</strong> Kijeremani; Sasa aliomb<strong>wa</strong> kukariri maneno <strong>ya</strong>le<strong>ya</strong>le k<strong>wa</strong> Kilatini.<br />

Akatoa tena maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi kama mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

ulimusimamia katika jambo hili. Wata<strong>wa</strong>la wengi <strong>wa</strong>lipofush<strong>wa</strong> sana na makosa na ibada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> sanamu hata m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni ha<strong>wa</strong>kuona nguvu <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> Luther, lakini kukariri<br />

kuka<strong>wa</strong>wezesha kuele<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liofunga macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> nuru juu <strong>ya</strong> ugumu <strong>wa</strong>kakasirish<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Mnenaji mkuu <strong>wa</strong> baraza akasema k<strong>wa</strong> hasira: “Haujajibu s<strong>wa</strong>li<br />

lililotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ko. ... Unataki<strong>wa</strong> kutoa jibu la <strong>wa</strong>zi na halisi. ... Utakana <strong>wa</strong>la hutakana?”<br />

Mtengenezaji akajibu: “Hivi mtukufu mwema na mwenye uwezo sana unaniomba jibu <strong>wa</strong>zi,<br />

raisi,aa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>, nitakutolea moja, na ni hili: Siwezi kutoa imani <strong>ya</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> Papa ao k<strong>wa</strong><br />

baraza, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ni <strong>wa</strong>zi kama siku ambayo <strong>wa</strong>likosa na mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara kubishana<br />

wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> wenyewe. Ila tu nikisadikish<strong>wa</strong> na ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko,... Siwezi na<br />

sitakana, k<strong>wa</strong>ni si salama k<strong>wa</strong> Mkristo kusema kinyume cha zamiri <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ni hapa<br />

ninasimamia, siwezi kufan<strong>ya</strong> namna ingine; basi Mungu anisaidie. Amen.”<br />

Ndivyo mtu huyu <strong>wa</strong> haki alivyosimama. Ukuu <strong>wa</strong>ke na usafi <strong>wa</strong> tabia, amani <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

furaha <strong>ya</strong> moyo, vilionekana k<strong>wa</strong> wote alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akishuhudia ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> imani hiyo<br />

inayoshinda ulimwengu. K<strong>wa</strong> jibu lake la k<strong>wa</strong>nza Luther alisema na adabu, k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> utii<br />

kabisa. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>lizania k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuomba <strong>wa</strong>kati iliku<strong>wa</strong> tu m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> kukana.<br />

Charles mwenyewe, alipoona hali <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong>, mavazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> zamani,<br />

na urahisi <strong>wa</strong> hotuba <strong>ya</strong>ke, akatangaza: “Mta<strong>wa</strong> huyu hatanifan<strong>ya</strong> kamwe ku<strong>wa</strong> mpinga<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong> dini.” Lakini ushujaa na nguvu alioshuhudia sasa, uwezo <strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong>ke,<br />

ukashangaza <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. Mfalme aliposhangaa sana, akapaza sauti: “Mta<strong>wa</strong> huyu anasema<br />

bila kuogopa na moyo usiotikisika.”<br />

Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kashind<strong>wa</strong>. Wakatafuta kushikilia mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>o, si k<strong>wa</strong> kukimbilia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, bali k<strong>wa</strong> vitisho, inayoku<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida la Roma. Musemaji <strong>wa</strong> baraza<br />

akasema: “Kama hutaki kukana, mfalme na wenye vyeo <strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong>taona jambo gani la<br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mpinga imani <strong>ya</strong> diniasiye sikia nashauri.” Luther akasema k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu:<br />

“Mungu anisaidie, k<strong>wa</strong>ni siwezi kukana kitu kamwe.”<br />

Wakamwomba atoke <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kishauriana pamoja. Kukataa kutii<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Luther kungeuza historia <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>ya</strong>ka nyingi. Wakakata shauri k<strong>wa</strong> kumpatia<br />

nafasi tena <strong>ya</strong> kukana. Tena s<strong>wa</strong>li likauliz<strong>wa</strong>. Je, angewezekana mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke? “Sina<br />

jibu lingine la kutoa,” akasema, “kuliko lile nililokwisha kutoa.”<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>kahuzunika k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o ulizarauli<strong>wa</strong> na mta<strong>wa</strong> maskini.<br />

Luther alisema k<strong>wa</strong> wote k<strong>wa</strong> heshima inayomfaa Mkristo na utulivu, maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

64


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na hasira <strong>wa</strong>la masingizio. Akajisahau mwenyewe na kujiona k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbele tu <strong>ya</strong> yeye aliye mkuu <strong>wa</strong> mwisho sana kuliko <strong>wa</strong>papa, <strong>wa</strong>falme, na <strong>wa</strong>falme<br />

(<strong>wa</strong>kuu). Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> pale, kuvuta mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> ufalme.<br />

Wata<strong>wa</strong>la wengi <strong>wa</strong>kakubali <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi haki <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Kundi lingine k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ule halikuonyesha imani <strong>ya</strong>o, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliokuja <strong>wa</strong>kasaidia bila woga<br />

matengenezo. Mchaguzi Frederic, akasikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong> Luther na kuchom<strong>wa</strong> moyo. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha na moyo akashuhudia ushujaa <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu na kujita<strong>wa</strong>la k<strong>wa</strong>ke, na akajitahidi<br />

kusimama imara zaidi katika kumtetea. Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba hekima <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>papa, <strong>wa</strong>falme, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>askofu inaonekana bure k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> ukweli.<br />

Mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa alipoona mvuto <strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> Luther, akaamua kutumia njia yote <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke ili kum<strong>wa</strong>ngamiza Mtengenezaji. K<strong>wa</strong> elimu na akili <strong>ya</strong> ujanja akaonyesha<br />

mfalme kijana hatari <strong>ya</strong> kupoteza urafiki usaada <strong>wa</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong><br />

asiye na maana.<br />

Kesho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> jibu <strong>wa</strong> Luther, Charles akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong> baraza kusudi lake k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kudumisha na kulinda dini <strong>ya</strong> Katoliki. Mashauri <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kutumi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Luther na mambo <strong>ya</strong> upinzani <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini aliyofundisha: “Nitatoa mfalme zangu<br />

kafara, hazina zangu , rafiki zangu, mwili <strong>wa</strong>ngu, damu <strong>ya</strong>ngu, roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu na maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu. ... Nitamushitaki na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke, kama <strong>wa</strong>asi <strong>wa</strong>pinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>tenga k<strong>wa</strong> Ushirika takatifu, k<strong>wa</strong> mkatazo, na k<strong>wa</strong> namna yo yote iliyofikiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>angamiza.” Lakini, mfalme akatangaza, hati <strong>ya</strong> kupita salama <strong>ya</strong> Luther inapas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuheshimi<strong>wa</strong>. Anapash<strong>wa</strong> kuruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kufika nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>ke salama.<br />

Cheti cha Usalama cha Luther Katika Hatari<br />

Wajumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa tena <strong>wa</strong>kaagiza k<strong>wa</strong>mba hati <strong>ya</strong> kupita salama <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji<br />

isiheshimiwe. “Rhine (jina la mto) unapash<strong>wa</strong> kupokea majivu <strong>ya</strong>ke, kama ulivyopokea <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

majivu <strong>ya</strong> John Huss k<strong>wa</strong> karne iliyopita.” Lakini <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani, inga<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>lijitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> adui k<strong>wa</strong> Luther, <strong>wa</strong>kakataa kuvunja ahadi iliotole<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> taifa.<br />

Wakataja misiba ambayo iliyofuata kifo cha Huss. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kusubutu kuleta juu <strong>ya</strong> Ujeremani<br />

maovu makali mengine.<br />

Charles, k<strong>wa</strong> kujibu k<strong>wa</strong> shauri mba<strong>ya</strong>, akasema: “Ijapo heshima na imani ingepas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufut<strong>wa</strong> mbali ulimwenguni mwote, vinapas<strong>wa</strong> kupata kimbilio ndani <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>falme.” Akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> na maadui <strong>wa</strong> Luther <strong>wa</strong> kipapa kumtendea Mtengenezaji kama<br />

vile Sigismund alivyomtendea Huss. Lakini akakumbuka Huss alipoonyesha minyororo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke kati <strong>ya</strong> makutano na kumkumbusha mfalme juu <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>ke aliyoahidi, Charles V<br />

akasema, “Singetaka kufazaika kama Sigismund.”<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi tu Charles akakataa ukweli uliotole<strong>wa</strong> na Luther. Alikataa kuacha<br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> desturi k<strong>wa</strong> kutembea katika njia za kweli na haki. Kama baba zake, alitaka<br />

kupigania dini <strong>ya</strong> Papa. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo akakataa kukubali nuru mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> siku<br />

65


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

zetu, kuna wengi <strong>wa</strong>naoshikilia desturi za asili za mababa zao. Wakati B<strong>wa</strong>na anapotuma<br />

nuru mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nakataa kuipokea k<strong>wa</strong> sababu haikupokele<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>baba <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Hatutakubali<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu tunapotazama k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>baba wetu k<strong>wa</strong> kuamua <strong>wa</strong>jibu wetu pahali<br />

pa kutafuta Neno la Kweli k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu wenyewe. Tutauliz<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> nuru mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

inayoangaza sasa juu yetu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu.<br />

Uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulisema kupitia Luther k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani. Roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ili<strong>wa</strong>sihi k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> wengi katika mkutano ule. Kama Pilato, karne<br />

nyingi mbele <strong>ya</strong>o, kama vile Charles V, katika kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> jeuri <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu, akaamua<br />

kukana nuru <strong>ya</strong> ukweli.<br />

Mashauri juu <strong>ya</strong> Luther <strong>ya</strong>kaenea pote, <strong>ya</strong>kaleta <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si katika mji wote. Rafiki wengi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipojua ukali <strong>wa</strong> hila <strong>ya</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mtengenezaji hakupas<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong><br />

kafara. Mamia <strong>ya</strong> wenye cheo <strong>wa</strong>kaahidi kumlinda. K<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> nyumba na katika<br />

pahali pa <strong>wa</strong>tu wote matangazo <strong>ya</strong> kubandik<strong>wa</strong> ukutani <strong>ya</strong>kawek<strong>wa</strong>, mengine <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>kuhukumu na mengine <strong>ya</strong> kumkubali Luther. K<strong>wa</strong> tangazo moja kukaandik<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

maana, “Ole <strong>wa</strong>ko, Ee inchi, <strong>wa</strong>kati mfalme <strong>wa</strong>ko ni mtoto.” Muhubiri 10:16. Furaha nyingi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Luther ikasadikisha mfalme na baraza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kila jambo lisilo la haki<br />

lililoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke lingehatarisha amani <strong>ya</strong> ufalme na nguvu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha mfalme.<br />

Juhudi k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Masikilizano na Roma<br />

Frederic <strong>wa</strong> Saxony akaficha k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule akamlinda k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu sana, kulinda mazunguko <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

<strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> maadui zake. Lakini wengi ha<strong>wa</strong>kujaribu kuficha huruma <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> Luther. “Chumba<br />

kidogo cha m<strong>wa</strong>limu,” akaandika Spalatin, “hakiwezi kuenea <strong>wa</strong>geni wote <strong>wa</strong>liojileta<br />

wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> kumuzuru.” Hata <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> na imani katika mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kujizuia lakini kushangalia ule ukamilifu uliomuongoza kuvumilia mauti<br />

kuliko kuvunja zamiri <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Juhudi nyingi zikafanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kupata kuwezesha Luther kupatana na Roma. Wenye<br />

cheo na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>kamuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama akifan<strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke pekee kupinga<br />

kanisa na baraza, hatahamish<strong>wa</strong> kukati<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> ufalme na bila ulinzi. Tena akaomb<strong>wa</strong><br />

sana, kutii hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mfalme. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo hangaliogopa kitu. “Ninakubali,” akasema k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujibu, “na moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu wote, k<strong>wa</strong>mba mfalme, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, na hata Mkristo mnyonge sana,<br />

anapash<strong>wa</strong> kujaribu na kuhukumu kazi zangu; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kanuni moja, k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kamate<br />

neno la Mungu ku<strong>wa</strong> kipimo chao. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>na kitu cha kufan<strong>ya</strong> bali kukitii.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mwito mwengine akasema: “Ninakubali kukana cheti cha usalama <strong>wa</strong>ngu. Naweka<br />

nafsi <strong>ya</strong>ngu na maisha <strong>ya</strong>ngu katika mikono <strong>ya</strong> mfalme, lakini neno la Mungu--kamwe!”<br />

Akataja mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kutii baraza la <strong>wa</strong>tu wote, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kanuni k<strong>wa</strong>mba baraza<br />

itakiwe kuamua kufuatana na Maandiko. “K<strong>wa</strong> ile inayohusu neno la Mungu na imani, kila<br />

Mkristo anaku<strong>wa</strong> muhukumu mwema kama Papa, inga<strong>wa</strong> anatete<strong>wa</strong> na milioni <strong>ya</strong><br />

66


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mabaraza.” Wote <strong>wa</strong>wili rafiki na maadui, mwishowe, <strong>wa</strong>kasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba juhudi<br />

zaidi juu <strong>ya</strong> mapatano ingeku<strong>wa</strong> bure.<br />

Kama Mtengenezaji angelikubali jambo moja tu, Shetani na majeshi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>ngalipata<br />

ushindi. Lakini msimamo <strong>wa</strong>ke imara usiotikisika uliku<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kuweka kanisa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uhuru. Mvuto <strong>wa</strong> mtu mmoja huyu aliyesubutu kufikiri na kutenda k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mwenyewe ulipash<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kugeuza kanisa na ulimwengu, si k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe<br />

tu, bali k<strong>wa</strong> vizazi vyote v<strong>ya</strong> baadaye. Luther aliagiz<strong>wa</strong> upesi na mfalme kurudi nyumbani<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ke. Tangazo hili lingefuata k<strong>wa</strong> upesi na hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mawingu <strong>ya</strong> kutisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kafunika njia <strong>ya</strong>ke, lakini kama alivyotoka Worms, moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke ukajaa na furaha na sifa.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kuondoka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, ili musimamo <strong>wa</strong>ke imara usizaniye ku<strong>wa</strong> uasi, Luther<br />

akaandika k<strong>wa</strong> mfalme: “Ninaku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong> kutii k<strong>wa</strong> moyo kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ko,<br />

katika heshima <strong>wa</strong>la katika zarau, katika maisha ao katika mauti, na kuto kukubali kitu<br />

kingine cho chote isipoku<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu ambalo mtu huishi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke. ... Wakati<br />

faida <strong>ya</strong> milele,inahusika mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu si mtu anapash<strong>wa</strong> kujiweka chini <strong>ya</strong> mtu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> namna ile katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> kiroho ni kuabudu k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, na kunapas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba peke <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> safari kutoka Worms, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>kakaribisha kama mfalme mta<strong>wa</strong><br />

aliyeteng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa, na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>wa</strong>kamheshimu mtu aliyelaumi<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mfalme. Akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri, na bila kujali makatazo <strong>ya</strong> mfalme, akaingia tena k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mimbara. “Siku ahidi kamwe mimi mwenyewe kufunga neno la Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> mnyororo,”<br />

akasema, “ama sitalifunga.”<br />

Mda kidogo baada <strong>ya</strong> kutoka Worms, <strong>wa</strong>simamizi <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>kamshawishi mfalme<br />

kutoa amri juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Luther alitangaz<strong>wa</strong> kama “Shetani mwenyewe chini <strong>ya</strong> umbo la mtu<br />

anayevaa kanzu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>.” Mara ruhusa <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kupita inapomalizika, mipango ilipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukamat<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kukataza kumkaribisha, kumupa chakula <strong>wa</strong>la kiny<strong>wa</strong>ji, ao k<strong>wa</strong><br />

neno ao tendo, msaada <strong>wa</strong>la kushirikiana naye. Alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> mikononi m<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke pia kufung<strong>wa</strong> na mali <strong>ya</strong>o kun<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong>. Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kuharibi<strong>wa</strong>, na mwishowe, wote <strong>wa</strong>ngesubutu kutenda kinyume cha agizo hili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lihusika katika hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> Saxe na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la wote, <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki<br />

sana <strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji, <strong>wa</strong>lipotoka Worms baada kidogo <strong>ya</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, na agizo la<br />

mfalme likapokea ukubali <strong>wa</strong> baraza. Waroma <strong>wa</strong>lishangilia. Wakaamini mwicho <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji kuti<strong>wa</strong> mhuri kabisa.<br />

Mungu Anatumia Frederic <strong>wa</strong> Saxe<br />

Jicho la uangalifu lilifuata mwendo <strong>wa</strong> Luther, na moyo <strong>wa</strong> kweli na bora ulikusudia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kumwokoa. Mungu ukamtolea Frederic <strong>wa</strong> Saxe mpango k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji. K<strong>wa</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong> kurudi nyumbani Luther akatengana na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

haraka akapelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> mwitu k<strong>wa</strong> jumba la Wartburg, ngome <strong>ya</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

67


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mlima. Maficho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> na fumbo ambalo hata Frederic mwenyewe hakujua<br />

mahalialipopelek<strong>wa</strong>. Ujinga huu uliku<strong>wa</strong> na kusudi; hivi mchaguzi hakujua kitu, hangeweza<br />

kufunua kitu. Akatoshele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mtengenezaji aliku<strong>wa</strong> salama, akatulia.<br />

Mvua <strong>wa</strong> nyuma, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>jua kali, na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika ukapita, na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> baridi<br />

ukafika, na Luther aliendelea ku<strong>wa</strong> mfung<strong>wa</strong>. Aleander na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi. Nuru<br />

<strong>ya</strong> injili ikaonekana karibu kukomesh<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini nuru <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea<br />

kuangaza k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zaidi.<br />

Usalama huko Wartburg<br />

Katika salama <strong>ya</strong> urafiki <strong>wa</strong> Wartburg, Luther akafurahi ku<strong>wa</strong> inje <strong>ya</strong> fujo <strong>ya</strong> vita.<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ni mtu aliyezoea maisha <strong>ya</strong> kazi na magumu makali, hangevumilia kukaa<br />

bila kufan<strong>ya</strong> lolote. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> siku za upekee, hali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ikafika k<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Akaogopa kuzani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mwoga k<strong>wa</strong> kujitosha k<strong>wa</strong> mabishano. Ndipo akajilaumu<br />

mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> uvivu <strong>wa</strong>ke na kujihurumia mwenyewe.<br />

Lakini, kila siku alifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> ajabu kuliko ingeonekana mtu mmoja kuweza kufan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Kalamu <strong>ya</strong>ke haikukaa bure. Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>lishangaa na kufazaika k<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> angali akitumika. K<strong>wa</strong> wingi <strong>wa</strong> vitabu vidogo v<strong>ya</strong> kalamu <strong>ya</strong>ke vikaenea<br />

katika Ujeremani pote. Akatafsiri pia Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> lugha <strong>ya</strong> Ujeremani. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> Patemo, akaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> mda karibu m<strong>wa</strong>ka mzima kutangaza injili na<br />

kukemea makosa <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati. Mungu akavuta mtumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> juk<strong>wa</strong>a <strong>ya</strong> maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Katika upekee na giza <strong>ya</strong> kimbilio lake mlimani, Luther akateng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> misaada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kidunia na kukosa sifa <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu. Aliokole<strong>wa</strong> basi k<strong>wa</strong> kiburi na kujitumainia<br />

vinavyolet<strong>wa</strong> mara nyingi na ushindi.<br />

Namna <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>navyofurahia k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru ambao kweli ina<strong>wa</strong>letea, Shetani anatafuta<br />

upotosha ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o na upendo kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na ku<strong>wa</strong>imarisha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

kibinadamu, kuheshimu chombo na kutojali Mkono ambao unaoongoza mambo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Mara nyingi <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>naposifi<strong>wa</strong> huongoz<strong>wa</strong> kujitumainia wenyewe. Watu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>riku<strong>wa</strong>angalia juu <strong>ya</strong> uongozi badala <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu. Kutoka katika<br />

hatari hii Mungu alitaka kulinda Matengenezo. Macho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>limugeukia Luther kama<br />

mfasi <strong>wa</strong> ukweli; aliondole<strong>wa</strong> ili macho <strong>ya</strong>le yote <strong>ya</strong>pate kuongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mwenyezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

milele <strong>wa</strong> ukweli.<br />

68


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 9. Nuru Ili<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> Katika Usuisi<br />

Juma chache baada <strong>ya</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Luther katika kibanda cha mchimba madini katika<br />

Saxe, Ulric Zwingli akazali<strong>wa</strong> katika nyumba ndogo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji katika milima mirefu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Alpes. Alipokele<strong>wa</strong> pahali penye maubule makub<strong>wa</strong>, akili <strong>ya</strong>ke m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni tu ikavut<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Kando <strong>ya</strong> babu <strong>wa</strong>ke m<strong>wa</strong>namke, alisikiliza hadizi chache za damani za<br />

Biblia alizokusan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> shida kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> hadizi na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>ya</strong>liyotokea<br />

zamani.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> umri <strong>wa</strong> miaka kumi na mitatu akaenda Berne, mahali palipoku<strong>wa</strong> shule lililoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

la sifa sana katika Usuisi. Hapa, lakini, kukatokea hatari. Juhudi nyingi zikafany<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kumvuta katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> bahati baba <strong>ya</strong>ke akapata habari <strong>ya</strong><br />

makusudi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>. Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba mafaa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nawe <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kufa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini na akamwongoza kurudi nyumbani.<br />

Agizo likasiki<strong>wa</strong>, lakini kijana hakuweza kurizika katika bonde lake la kuzali<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

akaenda kufuata masomo <strong>ya</strong>ke huko Ba le. Ni hapo ambapo Zwingli alisikia mara <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza injili <strong>ya</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu isionunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Huko Wittembach, alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akijifunza<br />

(kiyunani) Kigiriki na Kiebrania, akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko matakatifu, k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo n<strong>ya</strong>li<br />

za nuru <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikatole<strong>wa</strong> katika akili za <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi alioku<strong>wa</strong> akifundisha. Akatangaza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kifo cha Kristo ni ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> kipekee <strong>wa</strong> mwenye zambi. K<strong>wa</strong> Zwingli maneno<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong> ni n<strong>ya</strong>li <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> nuru unayotangulia mapambazuko.<br />

Zwingli akait<strong>wa</strong> upesi kutoka Bale k<strong>wa</strong> kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> maisha. Kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza iliku<strong>wa</strong> katika vila<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> milima mirefu. Akatakas<strong>wa</strong> kama padri, “akajitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu na<br />

roho <strong>ya</strong>ke yote k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta kweli <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” Namna alizidi kutafuta Maandiko, zaidi<br />

tofauti ikaonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke kati <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na mambo <strong>ya</strong> kupinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Akajitoa mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia kama Neno la Mungu, amri moja tu inayofaa na <strong>ya</strong> haki.<br />

Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba Biblia inapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mfariji <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe. Akatafuta usaada wowote<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kupata ufahamu kamili <strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong>ke, na akaomba usaada <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu.<br />

“Nikaanza kumuomba Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke, “baadaye akaandika, “na Maandiko<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaanza ku<strong>wa</strong> rahisi zaidi k<strong>wa</strong>ngu.”<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>liyohubiri<strong>wa</strong> na Zwingli ha<strong>ya</strong>kupoke<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Luther. Yaliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. “iki<strong>wa</strong> Luther anahubiri Kristo,” akasema Mtengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Usuisi,<br />

“anafan<strong>ya</strong> ninavyofan<strong>ya</strong>. ... Hakuna hata neno moja lililoandik<strong>wa</strong> nami k<strong>wa</strong> Luther <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

lililoandik<strong>wa</strong> na Luther k<strong>wa</strong>ngu. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> sababu gani? ... Ili ipate kuonyesh<strong>wa</strong> namna gani<br />

Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu anaku<strong>wa</strong> katika sauti moja k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe, hivi sisi <strong>wa</strong>wili, bila<br />

mgongano, tunafundisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ulinganifu kama huo.”<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1516 Zwingli akaalik<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> huko<br />

Einsiedeln. Hapa alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutumia kama Mtengenezaji mvuto ambao ungesiki<strong>wa</strong> mbali<br />

hata kuvuka milima mirefu (Alpes) alipozali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

69


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika vitu v<strong>ya</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Einseideln ni sanamu <strong>ya</strong> Bikira, <strong>wa</strong>lisema k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong>kufan<strong>ya</strong>. Juu <strong>ya</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na maandiko, “Ni hapa<br />

kunapatikana msamaha <strong>wa</strong> zambi zote.” Makundi mengi <strong>wa</strong>kaja k<strong>wa</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> Bikira<br />

kutoka pande zote za Usuisi, na hata kutoka Ufaransa na Ujeremani. Zwingli akapata nafasi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutangaza uhuru k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> injili k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu.<br />

“Musizani,” akasema, “k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu yuko katika hekalu hii zaidi kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> upande<br />

mwingine <strong>wa</strong>uumbaji. ... Je, kazi zisizofaa, safari za taabu, sadaka, masanamu, sala za<br />

Bikira ao za <strong>wa</strong>takatifu zingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong>patia neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu? ... Ni manufaa gani <strong>ya</strong><br />

kofia <strong>ya</strong> kungaa, kich<strong>wa</strong> kilichonole<strong>wa</strong> vizuri, kanzu ndefu na yenye kuvut<strong>wa</strong>, ao viato<br />

vyenye mapambo <strong>ya</strong> zahabu?” “Kristo,” akasema, “aliyetole<strong>wa</strong> mara moja juu <strong>ya</strong> msalaba,<br />

ni toko na kafara, alifan<strong>ya</strong> kipatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi za <strong>wa</strong>aminifu hata milele.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> wengi liliku<strong>wa</strong> uchungu <strong>wa</strong> kukatisha tamaa kuambi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba safari <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuchokesha iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> bure. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kufahamu rehema <strong>wa</strong>liyotole<strong>wa</strong> bure katika<br />

Yesu Kristo. Njia <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni iliyowek<strong>wa</strong> na Roma ili<strong>wa</strong>toshelea. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni rahisi sana<br />

kutumaini wokovu <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>padri na Papa kuliko kutafuta usafi <strong>wa</strong> moyo.<br />

Lakini kundi lingine <strong>wa</strong>kapokea k<strong>wa</strong> furaha habari za ukombozi k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, na<br />

katika imani <strong>wa</strong>kakubali damu <strong>ya</strong> Muokozi ku<strong>wa</strong> kipatanisho chao. Ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>karudi k<strong>wa</strong>o<br />

kuonyesha wengine nuru <strong>ya</strong> damani <strong>wa</strong>liyoipokea. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi ukweli ukapelek<strong>wa</strong> mji k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mji, na hesabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>safiri k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu pa Bikira ikapunguka sana. Sadaka sasa<br />

zikapunguka, na k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo mshahara <strong>wa</strong> Zwingli uliyoku<strong>wa</strong> ukitoka humo. Lakini<br />

jambo hilo lilimletea tu furaha namna alivyoona k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo <strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukivunj<strong>wa</strong>. Ukweli ukapata uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Zwingli Akait<strong>wa</strong> Zurich<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> miaka mitatu Zwingli akait<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri katika kanisa kub<strong>wa</strong> la Zurich, mji<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong> ushirika <strong>wa</strong> Suisi. Mvuto uliotumi<strong>wa</strong> hapa ulisiku<strong>wa</strong> mahali pengi.<br />

Wapadri <strong>wa</strong>liomwita k<strong>wa</strong> kazi hiyo <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> kumfahamisha ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka<br />

mageuzi:<br />

“Utaweka juhudi yote kukusan<strong>ya</strong> mapato k<strong>wa</strong> mfululizo bila kusahau kitu cho chote. ...<br />

Utaku<strong>wa</strong> na juhudi <strong>ya</strong> kuongeza mapato kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> misa, na k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kila agizo la dini.” “Juu <strong>ya</strong> uongozi <strong>wa</strong> sakramenti, mahubiri, na ulinzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

kundi, ... unaweza kutumia mtu mwingine, na zaidi sana katika mahubiri.”<br />

Zwingli akasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> ukim<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> agizo hili, na akasema k<strong>wa</strong> kujibu, “Maisha <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo <strong>ya</strong>mefich<strong>wa</strong> mda mrefu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Nitahubiri juu habari yote <strong>ya</strong> Injili <strong>ya</strong> Mtakatifu<br />

Matayo. ... Ni k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> sifa <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> wokovu <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong><br />

roho, na k<strong>wa</strong> kujijenga katika imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli, ambapo nitajitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ngu.”<br />

70


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>kajikusan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kusikia mahubiri <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akaanza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kufungua Injili na kueleza maisha, mafundisho, na mauti <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. “Ni k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo,”<br />

akasema, “ambapo natamani ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza ninyi--k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong><br />

wokovu.” Wenye maarifa <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la, <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi, <strong>wa</strong>fundi, na <strong>wa</strong>kulima <strong>wa</strong>kasikiliza<br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akakemea makosa bila hofu na maovu <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>karudi kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa kuu <strong>wa</strong>kimusifu Mungu. “Mtu huyu,” <strong>wa</strong>kasema, “ni mhubiri <strong>wa</strong> ukweli.<br />

Ataku<strong>wa</strong> Musa wetu, kutuongoza kutoka katika giza hii <strong>ya</strong> Misri.” Baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

upinzani ukaanza. Wata<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kamushambulia k<strong>wa</strong> zarau na matusi; wengine <strong>wa</strong>katumia<br />

ukali na matisho. Lakini Zwingli akachukua yote k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu.<br />

Wakati Mungu anapojita<strong>ya</strong>risha kuvunja viungo v<strong>ya</strong> pingu v<strong>ya</strong> ujinga na ibada <strong>ya</strong><br />

sanamu Shetani anatumika na uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> kufunika <strong>wa</strong>tu katika giza na<br />

kufunga minyororo <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zaidi. Roma ikaendelea kutia nguvu mp<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufungua soko <strong>ya</strong>ke katika mahali pote pa Ukristo, ukitoa msamaha k<strong>wa</strong> mali. Kila zambi<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> na bei <strong>ya</strong>ke, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lipe<strong>wa</strong> chetibila malipo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi kama hazina <strong>ya</strong><br />

kanisa ililind<strong>wa</strong> yenyekujaa vizuri. ... Hivi mashauri mawili ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea--Roma<br />

kuruhusu zambi na kuifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> mapato <strong>ya</strong>ke, Watengenezaji kulaumu<br />

zambi na kuonyesha Kristo kama kipatanisho na mkombozi.<br />

Uchuuzi <strong>wa</strong> cheti cha Kuachi<strong>wa</strong> Zambi katika Usuisi<br />

Katika Ujermani biashara <strong>ya</strong> kuachi<strong>wa</strong> (zambi) iliongoz<strong>wa</strong> na mwovu sana Tetzel.<br />

Katika Usuisi biashara hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Samson, mta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Italia. Samson<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> amekwisha kujipatia pesa nyingi kutoka Ujeremani na Usuisi k<strong>wa</strong> kujaza hazina <strong>ya</strong><br />

Papa. Sasa akapitia Usuisi, kun<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kulima masikini mapato <strong>ya</strong>o machache na<br />

kulipisha za<strong>wa</strong>di nyingi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tajiri. Mtengenezaji k<strong>wa</strong> upesi akaanza kumpinga.<br />

Kufaniki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Zwingli kuliku<strong>wa</strong> namna hiyo kufunua kujidai k<strong>wa</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong> huyu hata<br />

akashurutisha kutoka kwenda sehemu zingine. Huko Zurich, Zwingli akahubiri k<strong>wa</strong> bidii<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> biashara <strong>ya</strong> msamaha. Wakati Samson alipokaribia mahali pale akakutana<br />

na mjumbe aliyemtetea neno kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> baraza k<strong>wa</strong> kum<strong>wa</strong>ambia aanze kazi, akatumia<br />

mwingilio <strong>wa</strong> hila, lakini, akarudish<strong>wa</strong> bila kuuzisha hata barua moja <strong>ya</strong> msamaha, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

upesi akatoka Usuisi.<br />

Tauni, au Kifo Kikub<strong>wa</strong>, kikapitia k<strong>wa</strong> Usuisi k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu sana katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1519.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuona namna iliku<strong>wa</strong> bure na bila damani masamaha <strong>ya</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kinunua; <strong>wa</strong>katamani sana msingi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Huko Zurich, Zwingli<br />

akagonj<strong>wa</strong> sana, na habari ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong>mba alikufa. K<strong>wa</strong> saa ile <strong>ya</strong> kujaribi<strong>wa</strong><br />

akatazama k<strong>wa</strong> imani msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kalvari, akatumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba kafara <strong>ya</strong> Kristo iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutosha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi. Aliporudi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> mauti, iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuhubiri injili k<strong>wa</strong> bidii kub<strong>wa</strong> sana kuliko mbele. Watu <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>litoka kuangalia<br />

mgonj<strong>wa</strong> karibu <strong>ya</strong> kifo, <strong>wa</strong>kafahamu vizuri kuliko mbele, damani <strong>ya</strong> injili.<br />

71


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Zwingli alifikia hali <strong>ya</strong> kuele<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi juu <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na kupata ujuzi ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke uwezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke unaogeuza. “Kristo,” akasema, “... alitupatia ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> milele ... mateso <strong>ya</strong>ke ni ...<br />

kafara <strong>ya</strong> milele, na huleta kupona k<strong>wa</strong> milele; huridisha haki <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le wote <strong>wa</strong>naotegemea juu <strong>ya</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> nguvu na <strong>ya</strong> imara. ...<br />

Panapoku<strong>wa</strong> imani katika Mungu, kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na juhudi inayoendesha na kusukuma <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kazi njema.”<br />

Hatua k<strong>wa</strong> hatua Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea katika Zurich. Katika mushtuko adui zake<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaamka k<strong>wa</strong> kushindana k<strong>wa</strong> bidii. Mashambulio mingi <strong>ya</strong>kafany<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Zwingli.<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini anapash<strong>wa</strong> kun<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>. Askofu <strong>wa</strong> Constance<br />

akatuma <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>tatu k<strong>wa</strong> Baraza la Zurich, kumshitaki Zwingli juu <strong>ya</strong> kuhatarisha<br />

amani na utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> jamii. Kama mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ikiwek<strong>wa</strong> pembeni, akasema,<br />

machafuko kote ulimwenguni <strong>ya</strong>tatokea.<br />

Baraza likakataa kukamata mpango juu <strong>ya</strong> Zwingli, na Roma ikajita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

shambulio jip<strong>ya</strong>. Mtengenezaji akapaliza sauti: “Muache <strong>wa</strong>je”; Nina<strong>wa</strong>ogopa kama vile<br />

mangenge <strong>ya</strong>nayo tokajuu <strong>ya</strong>kimbiavyo mavimbi <strong>ya</strong>nayo mgurumo k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Juhudi za <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa ziendelesha kazi <strong>wa</strong>liotamani kuharibu. Kweli ikaendelea<br />

kusambaa. Katika Ujeremani <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>lipohuzunish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutoweka k<strong>wa</strong> Luther,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati<strong>wa</strong> moyo tena <strong>wa</strong>lipoona maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> injili katika Usuisi. Namna Matengenezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liimarish<strong>wa</strong> katika Zurich, matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lionekana zaidi kabisa katika kuvunj<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uovu na kuendelesh<strong>wa</strong> utaratibu.<br />

Mabishano (Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma)<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuona namna mateso <strong>ya</strong> kutangaza kazi <strong>ya</strong> Luther katika Ujeremani haikufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

kitu, Warumi <strong>wa</strong>kakusudiakuwe mabishano na Zwingli. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> na hakika <strong>ya</strong> ushindi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua si makali tu pa vita bali <strong>wa</strong>amuzi <strong>wa</strong>liopash<strong>wa</strong> kuamua kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>bishanaji.<br />

Na kama <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kupata Zwingli katika uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>ngefan<strong>ya</strong> angalisho ili<br />

asikimbie. Shauri hili, basi, likafich<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu. Mabishano <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> huko<br />

Bade. Lakini Baraza la Zurich, kuzania makusudi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Papa na <strong>wa</strong>lipoony<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

vigingi v<strong>ya</strong> moto vilivyo<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> katika makambi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katoliki k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shahidi <strong>wa</strong><br />

injili, <strong>wa</strong>kamkataza mchungaji <strong>wa</strong>o kujihatarisha maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> kwenda Bade, mahali<br />

damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli iliku<strong>wa</strong> imetiririka, ingeleta kifo kweli.<br />

Oecolampadius na Haller <strong>wa</strong>kachaguli<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Watengenezaji, <strong>wa</strong>kati Dr. Eck<br />

mwenye sifa, akisaidi<strong>wa</strong> na jeshi la <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye elimu sana na <strong>wa</strong>padri, aliku<strong>wa</strong> ndiye<br />

shujaa <strong>wa</strong> Roma.<br />

Waandishi <strong>wa</strong>kachaguli<strong>wa</strong> wote k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katoliki, na wengine <strong>wa</strong>kakataz<strong>wa</strong> kuandika ao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>sipotii <strong>wa</strong>u<strong>wa</strong>we. M<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi mmoja, aliyeshiriki katika mabishano akaandika abari kila<br />

jioni juu <strong>ya</strong> mabishano <strong>ya</strong>liyofanyika mchana ule. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong>wili wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaagiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoa kila siku barua za Oecolampadius, k<strong>wa</strong> Zwingli huko Zurich. Mtengenezaji akajibu,<br />

72


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

anapotoa shauri. K<strong>wa</strong> kuepuka uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> mlinzi <strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> mji, <strong>wa</strong>jumbe ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>lileta vikapo v<strong>ya</strong> bata juu <strong>ya</strong> vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>karuhusi<strong>wa</strong> kupita bila kizuizi.<br />

Zwingli “alitumika zaidi,” akasema Myconius, “k<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke, kukesha k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

usiku, na shauri alilopeleka Bade, kuliko angeweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kubishana mwenyewe<br />

katikati <strong>ya</strong> adui zake.” Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kafika Bade na mavazi <strong>ya</strong> hariri <strong>ya</strong> fahari sana <strong>ya</strong><br />

mapambo <strong>ya</strong> vitu v<strong>ya</strong> damani. Wakasafiri na anasa sana, na kukaa k<strong>wa</strong> meza zilizojaa<br />

v<strong>ya</strong>kula vitamu sana na divai nzuri sana. Kuka<strong>wa</strong> tofauti kub<strong>wa</strong> sana kati <strong>ya</strong>o na<br />

Watengenezajiambao chakula chao cha kiasi kika<strong>wa</strong>kalisha k<strong>wa</strong> mda mfupi tu mezani.<br />

Mwenyeji <strong>wa</strong> Oecolampade, aliyempeleleza chumbani m<strong>wa</strong>ke, akamkuta akijifunza kila<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ao akiomba, na akajulisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba mpinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini huyo aliku<strong>wa</strong> “mta<strong>wa</strong><br />

sana.”<br />

Katika mkutano, “Eckakapanda na majivuno katika mimbara iliyopamb<strong>wa</strong> vizuri sana,<br />

lakini mnyenyekevu Oecompade, aliyevaa mavazi <strong>ya</strong> kiasi, akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua kiti<br />

chake mbele <strong>ya</strong> mpinzani <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kiti kilichochor<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong> sana.” Sauti <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong> Eck<br />

na majivuno mingi hakumtisha. Mtetezi <strong>wa</strong> imani aliku<strong>wa</strong> anatazamia mshahara mzuri.<br />

Wakati alipokosa mabishano bora, akatumia matukano na hata maapizo ama laana.<br />

Oecolampade, mwenye adabu na mwenye kujihazari, akakataa kushiriki katika<br />

mabishano. Inga<strong>wa</strong> aliku<strong>wa</strong> mpole na adabu katika mwenendo, akajionyesha mwenyewe<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo na imara. Mtengenezaji akashikamana k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu katika Maandiko.<br />

“Desturi,” akasema, “haina uwezo katika Usuisi wetu, isipoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria; sasa katika<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> imani, Biblia ndiyo sheria yetu.”<br />

Utulivu, kutumia akili k<strong>wa</strong> Mtengenezaji, unyenyekevu na adabu ulioonyesh<strong>wa</strong>, ikavuta<br />

mafikara na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kachukia majivuno <strong>ya</strong> kiburi cha Eck.<br />

Mabishano <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> siku kumi na mnane. Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kadai ushindi.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>jumbe wengi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Roma, na baraza ikatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong> na pamoja na Zwingli, <strong>wa</strong>ondoshwe kanisani. Lakini<br />

mashindano <strong>ya</strong>katokea katika mvuto <strong>wa</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti. Baada <strong>ya</strong> mda<br />

mfupi tu, miji mikub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Berne na Bâ le ikajitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Sura 10. Maendeleo Katika Ujeremani<br />

Kutoweka k<strong>wa</strong> ajabu k<strong>wa</strong> Luther kukaweka Ujeremani wote katika hofu kub<strong>wa</strong>. Habari<br />

ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> na wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliua<strong>wa</strong>. Kuka<strong>wa</strong> maombolezo makub<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaapa k<strong>wa</strong> kitisho kulipiza kisasi cha kifo chake.<br />

Ijapo <strong>wa</strong>iishangilia mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kifo kilichozani<strong>wa</strong> cha Luther, adui<br />

zake <strong>wa</strong>lijaz<strong>wa</strong> na hofu ku<strong>wa</strong> sasa k<strong>wa</strong>mba ameku<strong>wa</strong> mfung<strong>wa</strong>. “Njia moja tu<br />

inayotubakilia k<strong>wa</strong> kuokoa kesi letu,” akasema mmoja <strong>wa</strong>o, “ni ku<strong>wa</strong>sha mienge, na<br />

kumuwinda Luther katika ulimwengu wote na kumrudisha k<strong>wa</strong> taifa linalomwita.” Kusikia<br />

73


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> salama, ijapo aliku<strong>wa</strong> mfung<strong>wa</strong>, jambo hili likatuliza <strong>wa</strong>tu, huku<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisoma maandiko <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> bidii sana kuliko mbele. Hesabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioongezeka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajiunga k<strong>wa</strong> kisa cha mshujaa aliyetetea Neno la Mungu.<br />

Mbegu ambayo Luther alipanda ikatoa matunda mahali pote. kutoku<strong>wa</strong>po k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

kukafan<strong>ya</strong> kazi ambayo ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke hakungeweza kufan<strong>ya</strong>. Na sasa mwongozi <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

mkuu ameondole<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tumikaji wengine <strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> bidii ili kazi <strong>ya</strong> maana sana<br />

iliyoanzish<strong>wa</strong> isipingwe. Sasa Shetani akajaribu kudangan<strong>ya</strong> na kuangamiza <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>pokeza kazi iliyogeuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hila pahali pa kazi <strong>ya</strong> kweli. K<strong>wa</strong> namna kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> uongo k<strong>wa</strong> karne la k<strong>wa</strong>nza, ndipo kukatokea manabii <strong>wa</strong> uongo k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong><br />

kumi na sita.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>kajizania wenyewe kupokea mafumbulio <strong>ya</strong> kipekee kutoka<br />

Mbinguni na kuchaguli<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza kazi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo ambayo<br />

ilianzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uzaifu na Luther. K<strong>wa</strong> kweli, <strong>wa</strong>libomoa kile Mtengenezaji alichofan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Walikataa kanuni <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo k<strong>wa</strong>mba Neno la Mungu ni amri moja tu, <strong>ya</strong> kutosha <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani na maisha. K<strong>wa</strong> kiongozi kile kisichokosa <strong>wa</strong>kaweka maagizo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

hakika, <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe na maono.<br />

Wengine k<strong>wa</strong> urahisi <strong>wa</strong>kaelekea k<strong>wa</strong> ushupavu na kujiunga pamoja nao. Mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

wenye bidii ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kaleta m<strong>wa</strong>msho mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Luther aliku<strong>wa</strong> ameamsha <strong>wa</strong>tu kuona haja<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, na sasa <strong>wa</strong>tu wengine <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong> na madai<br />

<strong>ya</strong> “manabii” <strong>wa</strong>p<strong>ya</strong>. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea pale Wittenberg na <strong>wa</strong>kalazimisha<br />

madai <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> Melanchton: “Tumetum<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu. Tuliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mazungumzo <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida pamoja na Mungu; tunajua jambo litakalotokea; k<strong>wa</strong> neno moja,<br />

tunaku<strong>wa</strong> mitume na manabii, na tunatoa mwito k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>limu Luther.”<br />

Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>kafazaika. Akasema Melanchton; hapa panaku<strong>wa</strong> kweli roho za ajabu<br />

katika <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>; lakini roho gani? ... K<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine tujihazari kuzima Roho <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, na k<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine, k<strong>wa</strong> kudangany<strong>wa</strong> na roho <strong>ya</strong> Shetani.”<br />

Tunda la Mafundisho Map<strong>ya</strong> Limeonekana (limetambulika)<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuzarau Biblia ao kuikataa yote kabisa. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong>kaacha<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o na kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong>. Watu <strong>wa</strong>liojizania k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni wenye uwezo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kurudisha nafsi na kuongoza kazi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>kafaulu tu kuileta katika<br />

uharibifu. Sasa Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kapata tumaini lao, nakulalamika k<strong>wa</strong> furaha. “Juhudi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwisho tena, na wote <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> wetu.”<br />

Luther huko Wartburg, aliposikia mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyotendeka, akasema na masikitiko sana:<br />

“Nilifikiri <strong>wa</strong>kati wowote k<strong>wa</strong>mba Shetani angetumia mateso ha<strong>ya</strong>.” Akatambua tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> “manabii.” Upinzani <strong>wa</strong> Papa na mfalme haukumletea<br />

mashaka makub<strong>wa</strong> sana na shida kama sasa. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> “rafiki” za<br />

Matengenezo, kukatokea adui zake <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> kuamsha vita na kuleta fujo.<br />

74


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Luther aliongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na kupelek<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> kujisikia binafsi. Huku<br />

kila mara aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitetemeka k<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke: “Kama ningelijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong>liumiza mtu mmoja, mtu mmoja tu, inga<strong>wa</strong> mnyenyekevu na<br />

mnyonge-lisipoweza ku<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong>ni linaku<strong>wa</strong> ni injili yenyewe--ningekufa mara kumi kuliko<br />

mimi kuikana.”<br />

Wittenberg yenyewe iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikianguka chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini isiyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

akili na machafuko. Katika Ujeremani pote adui za Luther <strong>wa</strong>katwika mzigo huo juu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Katika uchungu <strong>wa</strong> roho akajiuliza, “Je, ni hapo basi kazi hii kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo<br />

ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kumalizikia?” Tena, kama vile aliku<strong>wa</strong> akishindana na Mungu katika sala, amani<br />

ikaingia moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ke. “Kazi si <strong>ya</strong>ngu, bali ni <strong>ya</strong>ko mwenyewe,” akasema. Lakini<br />

akakusudia kurudi Wittenberg.<br />

Aliku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> laana <strong>ya</strong> ufalme; Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kumuua, rafiki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likataz<strong>wa</strong> kumlinda. Lakini aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi <strong>ya</strong> injili iliku<strong>wa</strong> katika hatari, na katika<br />

jina la B<strong>wa</strong>na akatoka bila uwoga kupigana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli. Ndani <strong>ya</strong> barua k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mchaguzi, Luther akasema: “Ninaenda Wittenberg chini <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> yule anayeku<strong>wa</strong> juu<br />

kuliko ule <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme na <strong>wa</strong>chaguzi. Sifikiri kuomba usaada <strong>wa</strong> fahari <strong>ya</strong>ko, <strong>wa</strong>la kutaka<br />

ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ko, ningependa kukulinda mimi mwenyewe. ... Hakuna upanga unaoweza kusaidia<br />

kazi hii. Mungu peke <strong>ya</strong>ke anapash<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> kila kitu.” Katika barua <strong>ya</strong> pili, Luther<br />

akaongeza: “Niko ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kukubali chuki <strong>ya</strong> fahari <strong>ya</strong>ko na hasira <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu wote. Je,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> Wittenberg si kondoo zangu? Na hainipasi, kama ni lazima, kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> mauti<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o?”<br />

Uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Neno<br />

Makelele haikukawia kuenea katika Wittenberg k<strong>wa</strong>mba Luther alirudi na alitaka<br />

kuhubiri. Kanisa likajaa. K<strong>wa</strong> hekima kub<strong>wa</strong> na upole akafundisha na kuon<strong>ya</strong>: “Misa ni kitu<br />

kiba<strong>ya</strong>; Mungu huchukia kitu hiki; kinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuharibi<strong>wa</strong>. ... Lakini mtu asiachishwe<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>cho k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu. ... Neno ... la Mungu linapasa kutenda, na si sisi. ...Tunaku<strong>wa</strong> na haki<br />

kusema: hatuna na haki kutenda. Hebu tuhubiri; <strong>ya</strong>nayobaki ni <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Nikitumia nguvu<br />

nitapata nini? Mungu hushika moyo na moyo ukikamat<strong>wa</strong>, umekamatika kabisa. ...<br />

“Nitahubiri, kuzungumza, na kuandika; lakini sitamshurutisha mtu, k<strong>wa</strong>ni imani ni tendo<br />

la mapenzi. ... Nilisimama kumpinga Papa, vyeti v<strong>ya</strong> kuachi<strong>wa</strong> zambi, na <strong>wa</strong>katoliki, lakini<br />

bila mapigano <strong>wa</strong>la fujo. Ninaweka Neno la Mungu mbele; nilihubiri na kuandika--ni jambo<br />

hili tu nililolifan<strong>ya</strong>. Na k<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>kati nilipoku<strong>wa</strong> nikilala, ... neno ambalo nililohubiri<br />

likaangusha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma, ambaye hata mta<strong>wa</strong>la ao mfalme<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kulifanyia mambo mengi maba<strong>ya</strong>. Na huku sikufan<strong>ya</strong> lolote; neno pekee lilitenda<br />

vyote.” Neno la Mungu likavunja mvuto <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>musho <strong>wa</strong> ushupavu. Injili ilirudisha<br />

katika njia <strong>ya</strong> Kweli <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liodangany<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

75


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Miaka nyingi baadaye ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini ukainuka pamoja na matokeo <strong>ya</strong> ajabu.<br />

Akasema Luther: “K<strong>wa</strong>o Maandiko matakatifu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> lakini barua yenye kufa, na wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaanza kupaaza sauti, ‘Roho! Roho! ‘ Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> uhakika sitafuata mahali ambapo roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o ina<strong>wa</strong>ongoza.”<br />

Thomas Munzer, aliku<strong>wa</strong> na bidii zaidi miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shupavu ha<strong>wa</strong>, aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong>, lakini hakujifunza dini <strong>ya</strong> kweli. “Alipoku<strong>wa</strong> na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutengeneza dunia, na akasahau, kama wenye bidii wote <strong>wa</strong>navyofan<strong>ya</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe ambaye Matengenezo ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuanzia.” Hakutaka ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> pili, hata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Luther. Yeye mwenyewe akajidai k<strong>wa</strong>mba alipokea agizo la Mungu kuingiza<br />

Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> kweli: “Ye yote anayeku<strong>wa</strong> na roho hii, anaku<strong>wa</strong> na imani <strong>ya</strong> kweli, ijapo<br />

hakuweza kuona Maandiko katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Waalimu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> bidii <strong>wa</strong>kajifan<strong>ya</strong> wenye kuta<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong> na maono, kuona ku<strong>wa</strong> kila<br />

ma<strong>wa</strong>zo na mvuto kama sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Wengine hata <strong>wa</strong>kachoma Biblia zao. Mafundisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Munzer <strong>ya</strong>kakubali<strong>wa</strong> na maelfu. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kutii <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutaka kumtumikia Mungu na Beliali. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uasi <strong>ya</strong> Munzer <strong>ya</strong>kaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

kuvunja mamlaka yote. Sherehe za kutisha za upinzani zikafuata, na mashamba <strong>ya</strong><br />

Ujeremani <strong>ya</strong>kajaa na damu.<br />

Maumivu Makuu <strong>ya</strong> Roho Sasa Yakalemea Juu <strong>ya</strong> Luther<br />

Wana <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>katangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba uasi uliku<strong>wa</strong> tunda <strong>ya</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Luther. Mzigo huu hakupash<strong>wa</strong> lakini kuleta huzuni kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mtengenezaji k<strong>wa</strong>mba kisa cha kweli kilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuaibish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na<br />

ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong> chini zaidi. K<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine, <strong>wa</strong>ongozi katika uasi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>limchukia Luther. Hakukana madai <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu tu, bali aka<strong>wa</strong>tangaza<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>asi juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> serkali. Katika uhusiano <strong>wa</strong>kamshitaki yeye ku<strong>wa</strong> mdai <strong>wa</strong><br />

msingi.<br />

Roma ilitumainia kushuhudia muanguko <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo. Na <strong>wa</strong>kamlaumu Luther hata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> makosa ambayo alijaribu k<strong>wa</strong> bidii sana kusahihisha. Kundi la ushupavu,<br />

likadai k<strong>wa</strong> uongo k<strong>wa</strong>mba lilitende<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>siyo haki, <strong>wa</strong>kapata huruma <strong>ya</strong> hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu na kuzani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>fia dini. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> katika kupingana na<br />

Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>kahurumi<strong>wa</strong> na kusafish<strong>wa</strong>. Hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong><br />

uasi <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza uliopatikana mbinguni.<br />

Shetani hutafuta kila mara kudangan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kuita zambi ku<strong>wa</strong> haki na<br />

haki ku<strong>wa</strong> zambi. Utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> uongo, utakaso <strong>wa</strong> kuiga, ungali ukionyesha roho <strong>ya</strong> namna<br />

moja kama katika siku za Luther, kugeuza mafikara kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko na kuongoza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu kufuata ma<strong>wa</strong>zo na maono kuliko sheria za Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> uhodari Luther akatetea injili<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mashambulio. Pamoja na Neno la Mungu akapigana juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> man<strong>ya</strong>nganyi<br />

76


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> Papa, <strong>wa</strong>kati aliposimama imara kama m<strong>wa</strong>mba kupinga ushupavu uliojaribu kujiunga<br />

na Matengenezo.<br />

Pande zote za upinzanihuweka pembeni Maandiko matakatifu, k<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> hekima <strong>ya</strong><br />

kibinadamu kutukuz<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong> chemchemi ama asili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli. Kufuata akili za kibinadamu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi lakuabudu kama Mungu na kufan<strong>ya</strong> hii kanuni k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> dini. Kiroma kinadai<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> na uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulioshuka k<strong>wa</strong> mustari usiovunjika toka k<strong>wa</strong> mitume na kutoa<br />

nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> ujinga na uchafu vifichwe chini <strong>ya</strong> agizo la “mitume”. Maongozi <strong>ya</strong>liyodai<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Munzer <strong>ya</strong>litoka k<strong>wa</strong> mapinduzi <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo. Ukristo <strong>wa</strong> kweli hukubali Neno la Mungu<br />

kama jaribio la maongozi yote.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke Wartburg, Luther akatimiza kutafsiri Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong>, na injili ikatole<strong>wa</strong><br />

upesi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani katika lugha <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. Ufasiri huu ukapoke<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>liopenda ukweli.<br />

Wapadri <strong>wa</strong>kashtush<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kufikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza sasa kuzungumza<br />

pamoja nao Neno la Mungu na k<strong>wa</strong>mba ujinga <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe ungehatarish<strong>wa</strong>. Roma<br />

ikaalika mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke yote kuzuia mwenezo <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna ilivyozidi<br />

kukataza Biblia, ndivyo hamu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ikazidi kujua ni nini iliyofundish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kweli. Wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioweza kusoma <strong>wa</strong>kaichukua k<strong>wa</strong>o na ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> hata <strong>wa</strong>lipokwisha<br />

kujifunza sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> moyo. Mara moja Luther akaanza utafsiri <strong>wa</strong> Agano la Kale.<br />

Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther <strong>ya</strong>kapoke<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> furaha sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> katika miji na katika vijiji.<br />

“Yale Luther na rafiki zake <strong>wa</strong>liyoandika, wengine <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>ya</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>. Wata<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liposadikish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> uharamu <strong>wa</strong> kanuni za uta<strong>wa</strong>, lakini <strong>wa</strong>jinga sana k<strong>wa</strong> kutangaza<br />

neno la Mungu ... <strong>wa</strong>kauzisha vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> Luther na rafiki zake. Ujeremani k<strong>wa</strong> upesi ukajaa<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>uzishaji <strong>wa</strong> vitabu <strong>wa</strong>jasiri.”<br />

Kujifunza Biblia Mahali Pote<br />

Usiku <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> vyuo v<strong>ya</strong> vijiji <strong>wa</strong>kasoma k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makundi madogo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyokusanyika kando <strong>ya</strong> moto. K<strong>wa</strong> juhudi yote roho zingine zikahakikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli.<br />

“Kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>ko kunaleta nuru; kunamupa mujinga ufahamu.” Zaburi 119:130.<br />

Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>lioachia mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza Maandiko sasa <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>alika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuonyesha uwongo <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho map<strong>ya</strong>. Lakini, <strong>wa</strong>jinga k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, mapadri na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kashind<strong>wa</strong> kabisa. “K<strong>wa</strong> huzuni,” akasema m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi mmoja mkatoliki, “Luther<br />

alishawishi <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba haikufaa kuamini maneno mengine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko<br />

matakatifu.” Makundi <strong>ya</strong>kakusanyika kusikia mambo <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>liyotete<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

elimu ndogo. Ujinga <strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kuu ukafunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha uongo <strong>wa</strong><br />

mabishano <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> msaada <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho rahisi <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu. Watumikaji,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>askari, <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke, na hata <strong>wa</strong>toto, <strong>wa</strong>kajua Biblia kuliko mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>alimu wenye<br />

elimu.<br />

77


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Vijana wengi <strong>wa</strong>kajitoa k<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza, kuchunguza Maandiko na kujizoeza wenyewe na<br />

kazi bora <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> zamani. Walipoku<strong>wa</strong> na akili yenye juhudi na mioyo hodari, vijana<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kapata haraka maarifa ambayo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu hakuna mtu aliweza kushindana<br />

nao. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kapata katika mafundisho map<strong>ya</strong> mambo ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lileta matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> roho<br />

zao, na <strong>wa</strong>kageuka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>lea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu na maganda <strong>ya</strong> bure <strong>ya</strong><br />

ibada za sanamu na maagizo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu.<br />

Wakati mateso <strong>ya</strong>lipoamsh<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli, <strong>wa</strong>kafuata agizo hili la Kristo:<br />

“Na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napo <strong>wa</strong>tesa ninyi katika mji huu, kimbilieni k<strong>wa</strong> mji mwengine.” Matayo<br />

10:23. Wakimbizi <strong>wa</strong>kapata mahali mlango karibu ulifunguka k<strong>wa</strong>o, na <strong>wa</strong>liweza kuhubiri<br />

Kristo, <strong>wa</strong>kati mwengine ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ao katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> faragha ao mahali pa <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Kweli ikata<strong>wa</strong>nyika k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> usio <strong>wa</strong> kuzuia.<br />

Ni k<strong>wa</strong> bure <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kanisa na <strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>wa</strong>litumia kifungo, mateso, moto, na<br />

upanga. Maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>katia muhuri k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia damu <strong>ya</strong>o, na<br />

huku mateso ilitumi<strong>wa</strong> tu kupanua ukweli. Ushupavu ambao Shetani alijaribu kuunganisha<br />

hayo, matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi kinyume kati <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani na kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

78


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 11. Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Waana <strong>wa</strong> Wafalme<br />

Moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> shuhuda “maalum”uliotamk<strong>wa</strong> zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo uliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Ushuhuda uliotole<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani huko k<strong>wa</strong> baraza la Spires<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1529. Uhodari na msimamo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong> Mungu vikaimarisha uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> karne zilizofuata, na <strong>wa</strong>katoa k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa lililotengenez<strong>wa</strong> jina la Protestanti.<br />

Maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>kazuia nguvu zilizopinga ukweli. Charles Quint akakusudia<br />

kuangamiza Matengenezo, lakini mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara alipoinua mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kupinga<br />

akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kugeukia kando <strong>ya</strong> pigo. Tena na tena k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> hatari majeshi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Turki valipotokea k<strong>wa</strong> mpaka, ao mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa ao Papa mwenyewe alifan<strong>ya</strong> vita<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo miongoni <strong>ya</strong> vita na fujo <strong>ya</strong> mataifa, Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>kapata nafasi <strong>ya</strong><br />

kujiimarisha na kujipanua.<br />

Lakini, <strong>wa</strong>kati ukafika ambao <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong>katoliki <strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> tendo la umoja juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kupinga Watengenezaji. Mfalme akaitisha baraza kukutanika huko Spires munamo m<strong>wa</strong>ka<br />

1529 na kusudi la kuharibu upingaji <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini. Kama mpango huo ukishind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> imani Charles aliku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kutumia upanga.<br />

Wakatoliki huko Spires <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha uadui <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi juu <strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji.<br />

Akasema Melanchton: “Tunaku<strong>wa</strong> maapizo na takataka <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu; lakini Kristo<br />

atatazama chini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke maskini, na ata<strong>wa</strong>linda.” Watu <strong>wa</strong> Spires <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na kiu<br />

cha Neno la Mungu, na, inga<strong>wa</strong> kuliku<strong>wa</strong> makatazo, maelfu <strong>wa</strong>kakutanika k<strong>wa</strong> huduma<br />

iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ndogo la mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> Saxony. Jambo hili likaharakisha shida.<br />

Uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> dini ukaimarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uhalali, na vikao v<strong>ya</strong> injili vikakusudia kupinga<br />

uvunjaji <strong>wa</strong> haki zao. Luther hakuruhusi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Spires lakini pahali pake pakatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la ambao Mungu aliinua k<strong>wa</strong> kutetea kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Frederic <strong>wa</strong><br />

Saxony akateng<strong>wa</strong> na kifo, lakini Duke Jean, muriti <strong>wa</strong>ke (aliyemfuata), akakaribisha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha Matengenezo na akaonyesha uhodari mkub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mapadri <strong>wa</strong>kadai k<strong>wa</strong>mba taifa ambalo lilikubali Matengenezo liwe chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Warumi. Watengenezaji k<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine, ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kukubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba Roma<br />

ilipash<strong>wa</strong> tena kuleta mataifa <strong>ya</strong>le chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyopokea Neno la Mungu.<br />

Mwishowe ikakusudi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mahali ambapo Matengenezo haikuanzish<strong>wa</strong> bado,<br />

Amri <strong>ya</strong> Worms ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kutumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu; na k<strong>wa</strong>mba “Mahali ambapo <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kuilazimisha bila hatari <strong>ya</strong> uasi, ha<strong>wa</strong>kupasa kuingiza matengenezo map<strong>ya</strong>, ...<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kupash<strong>wa</strong> kupinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> misa, ha<strong>wa</strong>kupash<strong>wa</strong> kuruhusu mkatoliki <strong>wa</strong> Roma<br />

kukubali dini <strong>ya</strong> Luther.” Shauri hili likakubali<strong>wa</strong> katika baraza, k<strong>wa</strong> kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> ukub<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mapadri na maaskofu.<br />

79


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kama amri hii ingekaz<strong>wa</strong> “Matengenezo ha<strong>ya</strong>ngeweza kuenez<strong>wa</strong> ... ao kuanzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

misingi <strong>ya</strong> nguvu ... mahali ambapo ilikwisha ku<strong>wa</strong>ko.” Uhuru ungalikataz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mazungumzo ha<strong>ya</strong>ngaliruhusi<strong>wa</strong>. Matumaini <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu <strong>ya</strong>ngeonekana kukomesh<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Washiriki <strong>wa</strong> kundi la injili <strong>wa</strong>kaangaliana k<strong>wa</strong> hofu: “Kitu gani kinachofaa kufany<strong>wa</strong>?”<br />

“Je, <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kutii, na kukubali amri hiyo? ... Waongozi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Luther <strong>wa</strong>kape<strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong>o. Fazili <strong>ya</strong> namna moja ikatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>liokubali Matengenezo kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mekwisha<br />

kukubali maoni <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Je, jambo hilo halinge <strong>wa</strong>pendeza? ...<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>wa</strong>kaangalia kanuniambapo matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>liwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> msingi<br />

ulioazimi<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>katenda k<strong>wa</strong> imani. Kanuni ile iliku<strong>wa</strong> nini? Iliku<strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> Warumi<br />

kushurutisha zamiri na kukataza uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kuuliza s<strong>wa</strong>li. Lakini, ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>o Waprotestanti ku<strong>wa</strong> na furaha <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini? Ndiyo, kama fazili <strong>ya</strong> upekee<br />

iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> katika mapatano, lakini si kama haki. ... Ukubali <strong>wa</strong> matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>liyotaki<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kuingia uhuru <strong>ya</strong> dini ilipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> mategenezo <strong>ya</strong> Saxony na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> pande zingine zote za misiki <strong>ya</strong> kikristo uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kuuliza s<strong>wa</strong>lina ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> matengenezo vilikua kuasi na vilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuuzuri<strong>wa</strong> kifungoni na kifo cha kuchom<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mti. Je, <strong>wa</strong>liweza kuruhusu kutumia mahali maalum k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini? . . . Je,<br />

Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kujitetea k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le mamia<br />

na maelfu ambao katika kufuata k<strong>wa</strong> mapatano ha<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>ngetoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o katika inchi zote<br />

za kanisa la Roma?”<br />

“Hebu tukatae amri hii,” <strong>wa</strong>kasema <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la. “Katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> zamiri uwingi <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>na uwezo.” Kulinda uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri ni kazi <strong>ya</strong> taifa, na huu ndiyo mpaka <strong>wa</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> dini.<br />

Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kuvunja kile <strong>wa</strong>lichoita “ushupavu hodari (uhodari usio <strong>wa</strong><br />

kuachia mtu nafasi yoyote).” Wajumbe <strong>wa</strong> miji iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> na uhuru <strong>wa</strong>liomb<strong>wa</strong> kutangaza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ngekubali maneno <strong>ya</strong> mashauri <strong>ya</strong>liyo kusudi<strong>wa</strong>. Waliomba muda, lakini k<strong>wa</strong>o<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kukubali<strong>wa</strong>. Karibu nusu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Watengenezaji, <strong>wa</strong>kijua<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba musimamo <strong>wa</strong>o uta<strong>wa</strong>peleka k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu ijayo na mateso. Mmoja akasema,<br />

“Tunapash<strong>wa</strong> kukana neno la Mungu, ao kuchom<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Ushindani Bora <strong>wa</strong> Waana <strong>wa</strong> Wafalme<br />

Mfalme Ferdinand, mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, akajaribu ufundi <strong>wa</strong> mvuto. “Akaomba <strong>wa</strong>ana<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme kukubali amri, ku<strong>wa</strong>hakikishia k<strong>wa</strong>mba mfalme angependez<strong>wa</strong> sana nao.”<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>kajibu k<strong>wa</strong> upole: “Tutamtii mfalme k<strong>wa</strong> kila kitu<br />

kitakacholeta amani na heshima <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.”<br />

Mwishowe mfalme akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “njia <strong>ya</strong>o moja tu inayobaki iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kujiweka<br />

nchini <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lio wengi.” Alipokwisha kusema basi, akaenda zake, bila ku<strong>wa</strong>pa<br />

80


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Watengenezaji nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kujibu. “Wakatuma ujumbe kusihi mfalme arudi : Akajibu tu, “Ni<br />

jambo lilokwisha kukat<strong>wa</strong>; kutii ni kitu tu kinachobaki.”<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> kundi la mfalme <strong>wa</strong>kajisifu wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba sababu <strong>ya</strong> mfalme na Papa<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba ile <strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji ni zaifu. Kama Watengenezaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngetumainia usaada <strong>wa</strong> mtu tu, <strong>wa</strong>ngaliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zaifu kama <strong>wa</strong>livyo zani<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Papa. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kaita “kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> taarifa la baraza kuelekea Neno la Mungu, na badala<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mfalme Charles, k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo, Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mab<strong>wa</strong>na.” Kama<br />

vile Ferdinand alivyokataa kujali nia za zamiri <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia bila kujali<br />

kukosekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke, bali kuleta ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza la taifa bila kukawia.<br />

Tangazo la heshima likaandik<strong>wa</strong> na kuwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mkutano:<br />

“Tunashuhudia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> hapa ... k<strong>wa</strong>mba sisi, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wetu, hatukubali <strong>wa</strong>la kupatana katika namna yote k<strong>wa</strong> amri iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong>, katika kila kitu<br />

kinachoku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> Neno lake takatifu, k<strong>wa</strong> zamiri yetu <strong>ya</strong> haki, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

wokovu <strong>wa</strong> roho zetu ... k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii tunakataa utum<strong>wa</strong> ambao unaotwik<strong>wa</strong> juu yetu. ...<br />

Na vilevile tunaku<strong>wa</strong> katika matumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kifalme utatenda mbele<br />

yetu kama mfalme Mkristo anayempenda Mungu kupita vitu vyote; na tunatangaza sisi<br />

wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kulipa k<strong>wa</strong>ke, na kwenu pia, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> neema, upendo wote na<br />

utii unavyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jibu wetu <strong>wa</strong> haki na <strong>wa</strong> sheria.”<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kajaa na mshangao na mshituko <strong>wa</strong> hofu k<strong>wa</strong> ushujaa <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda. Fitina,<br />

ushindano, na kum<strong>wa</strong>ga damu ilionekana bila kuepuk<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini Watengenezaji, katika<br />

kutumainia silaha <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka Kuu, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenyekujaz<strong>wa</strong> na “uhodari tele na ujasiri.”<br />

“Kanuni zilizoku<strong>wa</strong> katika ushuhuda huu <strong>wa</strong> sifa ... ilianzisha msingi kabisa <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kiprotestanti. ... Kiprotestanti kinatia uwezo <strong>wa</strong> zamiri juu <strong>ya</strong> muhukumu na mamulaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

Neno la Mungu juu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa linaloonekana ... Husema pamoja na manabii na mitume<br />

“Imetupasa kutii Mungu kuliko m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu. Ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> taji la Charles V kiliinua taji la<br />

Yesu Kristo.” Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Spires uliku<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> heshima juu <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini<br />

na madai <strong>ya</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote k<strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kupatana na zamiri zao wenyewe.<br />

Maarifa <strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji bora ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na fundisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> vizazi vyote<br />

vinavyofuatana. Shetani angali anapinga Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kiongozi cha<br />

maisha. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati wetu kuna haja <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> kanuni kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda--Biblia, na<br />

ni Biblia peke, kama kiongozi cha amri <strong>ya</strong> imani na kazi. Shetani angali anatumika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuharibu uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini. Uwezo <strong>wa</strong> mpinga Kristo ambao <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Spires <strong>wa</strong>likataa<br />

sasa unatafuta kuanzisha mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke iliyopotea.<br />

Makutano Huko Augsburg<br />

Wata<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> injili <strong>wa</strong>linyim<strong>wa</strong> kusiki<strong>wa</strong> na Mfalme Ferdinand, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kutuliza<br />

magomvi <strong>ya</strong>liyosumbua ufalme, Charles V katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka uliofuata Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Spires<br />

81


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

akaita makutano huko Augsburg. Akatangaza kusudi lake k<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza mwenyewe.<br />

Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>kait<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> Saxony akashurutish<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>shauri <strong>wa</strong>ke asionekane k<strong>wa</strong> makutano: “Je,<br />

hivyo si kujihatarisha k<strong>wa</strong> kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> kila kitu na kujifungia ndani <strong>ya</strong> kuta za muji pamoja<br />

na adui wenye nguvu?” Lakini wengine <strong>wa</strong>kam<strong>wa</strong>mbia k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari “Acha <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>patane <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe na uhodari na hoja <strong>ya</strong> Mungu itaokoka.” “Mungu ni m<strong>wa</strong>minifu:<br />

hatatuacha,” akasema Luther. Mchaguzi akashika safari kwenda Augsburg. Wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaenda kwenye mkutano na uso <strong>wa</strong> huzuni na moyo <strong>wa</strong> taabu. Lakini Luther<br />

aliye<strong>wa</strong>sindikiza hata Coburg, akaamsha imani <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kuimba wimbo ulioandik<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> safarini, “ngome yenye uwezo ndiye Mungu wetu’. Mioyo nyingi yenye uzito<br />

ika<strong>wa</strong> nyepesi k<strong>wa</strong> sauti za juhudi za kutia moyo.<br />

Wata<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>lioongoka <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia ku<strong>wa</strong> na maelezo <strong>ya</strong> maono <strong>ya</strong>o, pamoja na<br />

ushuhuda kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, <strong>ya</strong> kuonyesha mbele <strong>ya</strong> mkutano. Kazi <strong>ya</strong> mata<strong>ya</strong>risho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ikape<strong>wa</strong> Luther, Melanchton na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>o. Ungamo hili likakubali<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Waprotestanti, na <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kutia majina <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> mapatano.<br />

Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>litamani zaidi bila kuchanganisha hoja <strong>ya</strong>o na mas<strong>wa</strong>li <strong>ya</strong> siasa. Kama<br />

vile <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la Wakikristo <strong>wa</strong>liendelea kutia sahihi <strong>ya</strong> ungamo, Melanchton akaingia kati, na<br />

kusema, “Ni k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chunguzi <strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> dini na <strong>wa</strong>hubiri k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa shauri la mambo<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>; tuchunge maoni mengine k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> inchi.” “Mungu<br />

anakataza” akajibu Jean <strong>wa</strong> Saxony, “K<strong>wa</strong>mba mgenitenga. Ninakusudia kutenda <strong>ya</strong>liyo<br />

haki, bila kujihangaisha mimi mwenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> taji langu. Natamani kuungama B<strong>wa</strong>na.<br />

Kofia <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong> uchaguzi na ngozi <strong>ya</strong> mapendo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hukumu si v<strong>ya</strong> damani k<strong>wa</strong>ngu kama<br />

msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo.” Akasema mwengine katika <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la alipochukua kalamu,<br />

“Kama heshima <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ngu Yesu Kristo huidai, niko ta<strong>ya</strong>ri ... kuacha mali na maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu nyuma.” “Tafazali ningekataa mambo <strong>ya</strong>ngu na makao <strong>ya</strong>ngu, zaidi kutoka inchini<br />

m<strong>wa</strong> baba zangu na fimbo mkononi,” akaendelea, “kuliko kukubali mafundisho mengine<br />

mbali na ambayo <strong>ya</strong>nayoku<strong>wa</strong> katika ungamo hili.”<br />

Wakati ulioagiz<strong>wa</strong> ukafika. Charles V, akazunguk<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>chaguzi na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la,<br />

akakubali kuonana na Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Waprotestanti. Katika mkutano tukufu ule mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> injili <strong>ya</strong>katangaz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi na makosa <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Papa <strong>ya</strong>kaonyesh<strong>wa</strong>. Siku<br />

ile ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> “siku kub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, na siku moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> utukufu katika<br />

historia <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo na <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu.”<br />

Mta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Wittenberg akasimama peke <strong>ya</strong>ke huko Worms. Sasa mahali pake kuka<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la hodari kuliko <strong>wa</strong> ufalme. “Ninafurahi sana,” Luther akaandika, “k<strong>wa</strong>mba nimeishi<br />

hata k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, ambao Kristo ametukuz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi na mashahidi bora kama ha<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

na katika mkutano tukufu sana.” Ujumbe ambao mfalme alioukataza kuhubiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mimbara ukatangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> jumba lake la kifalme. Maneno ambayo wengi <strong>wa</strong>liifikiri kama<br />

<strong>ya</strong>siyofaa hata mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumikaji, <strong>ya</strong>lisiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mshangao na mab<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

82


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> ufalme. Wafalme <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hubiri, na mahubiri <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kweli aminifu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu. “Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mitume hapaku<strong>wa</strong> kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko, ao maungamo mazuri<br />

zaidi.”<br />

Moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> kanuni imara zaidi iliyoshik<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na Luther iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba haifae<br />

kutumainia uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kidunia katika kusaidia Matengenezo. Alifurahi k<strong>wa</strong>mba injili<br />

ilitangaz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na ufalme; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lipokusudia kuungana katika chama<br />

cha utetezi, akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> injili itatete<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu peke <strong>ya</strong>ke. ...<br />

Uangalifu wote <strong>wa</strong> siasa uliokusudi<strong>wa</strong> uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika maoni <strong>ya</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong>mba ulitole<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

hofu isiyofaa na shaka <strong>ya</strong> zambi.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> tarehe <strong>ya</strong> baadaye, kufikiri juu <strong>ya</strong> mapatano <strong>ya</strong>liyoazimi<strong>wa</strong> na Wafalme<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioongoka, Luther akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba silaha <strong>ya</strong> pekee tu katika vita hii inapash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

“upanga <strong>wa</strong> Roho.” Akaandika k<strong>wa</strong> mchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> Saxony: “Hatuwezi k<strong>wa</strong> zamiri yetu<br />

kukubali mapatano <strong>ya</strong>liyokusudi<strong>wa</strong>. Msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kristo unapas<strong>wa</strong> kuchukuli<strong>wa</strong>. Hebu<br />

utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ko uwe bila hofu. Tutafan<strong>ya</strong> mengi zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> maombi yetu kuliko maadui wetu<br />

wote k<strong>wa</strong> majivuno <strong>ya</strong>o.”<br />

Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> pahali pa siri pa sala kukaja uwezo uliotetemesha ulimwengu katika<br />

Matengenezo. Huko Augsburg Luther “hakupitisha siku bila kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> maombi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

masaa tatu.” Ndani <strong>ya</strong> chumba chake cha siri aliku<strong>wa</strong> akisikia kumiminika k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> maneno “<strong>ya</strong>nayojaa na kuabudu na hofu na matumaini.” K<strong>wa</strong><br />

Melanchton akaandika: “Kama sababu si <strong>ya</strong> haki, tuiache; kama sababu ni <strong>ya</strong> haki, sababu<br />

gani kusingizia ahadi za yule anaye tuagiza kulala bila hofu?” Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kiprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>lijenga juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Milango <strong>ya</strong> kuzimu haitalishinda!<br />

83


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 12. Mapambazuko Katika Ufransa<br />

Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Spires na Ungamo la Augsburg <strong>ya</strong>lifuat<strong>wa</strong> na miaka <strong>ya</strong> vita na giza.<br />

Yakazoofish<strong>wa</strong> na miga<strong>wa</strong>nyiko, Kiprotestanti kikaonekana katika hali <strong>ya</strong> kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> ushindi huu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi mfalme akapigana sana na kushind<strong>wa</strong>. Mwishowe<br />

akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukubali kuachia uhuru mafundisho ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong> nguvu katika<br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>ya</strong>haribu.<br />

Aliona majeshi <strong>ya</strong>ke kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong> na vita, hazina zake kutiririka, <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>wa</strong> ufalme<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke kutiish<strong>wa</strong> na uasi, na po pote ambapo imani aliyojitahidi kukomesha ikaenea. Charles<br />

V aliku<strong>wa</strong> akigombeza uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mwenye mamlaka yote. Mungu alisema, “Nuru iwe,”<br />

lakini mfalme akataka kudumisha giza. Aliposhind<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke, akazeeka<br />

upesi, akajitosha kitini cha ufalme na akaenda kujizika mwenyewe katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Katika Uswisi, hivi makambi mengi <strong>ya</strong>likubali imani <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, wengine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajifungia k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Mateso juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi ikaamka ku<strong>wa</strong> vita v<strong>ya</strong> wenyewe<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> wenyewe. Zwingli na wengi <strong>wa</strong>liojiunga katika Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>kaanguka k<strong>wa</strong> shamba<br />

la damu la Cappel. Roma ika<strong>wa</strong> na ushindi na katika mahali pengi ikaonekana kupata yote<br />

aliyopoteza. Lakini Mungu hakusahau kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine<br />

akainua <strong>wa</strong>tumishi kuendesha kazi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Katika Ufransa mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kupata nuru aliku<strong>wa</strong> ndiye Lefévre; m<strong>wa</strong>limu<br />

katika chuo kikuu cha Paris. Katika uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> zamani,<br />

uangalifu <strong>wa</strong>ke ukaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia, na akaingiza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke miongoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Akaanza kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha historia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini kama<br />

ilivyotole<strong>wa</strong> katika mapokeo <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, na aliku<strong>wa</strong> amekwisha kufan<strong>ya</strong> maendeleo <strong>ya</strong><br />

namna sana k<strong>wa</strong> hayo, alipofikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba angeweza kupata usaada kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia,<br />

akaanza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Na hapa kweli akapata <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, lakini si kama vile ilionekana<br />

katika kalenda <strong>ya</strong> Roma (Kanisa la Katoliki). Katika machukio akaenda zake k<strong>wa</strong> kazi<br />

aliyojiagizia mwenyewe na akajitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu.<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1512 kabla <strong>ya</strong> Luther ao Zwingli <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>jaanza kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Matengenezo, Lefévre akaandika, “Ni Mungu anayetupatia, k<strong>wa</strong> imani, haki ile ambayo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> neema pekee hutuhesabia haki k<strong>wa</strong> uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele.” Na <strong>wa</strong>kati alipofundisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba utukufu <strong>wa</strong> wokovu ni <strong>wa</strong> Mungu tu, na akatangaza pia k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi <strong>ya</strong> kutii ni <strong>ya</strong><br />

binadamu.<br />

Wengine miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Lefévre <strong>wa</strong>kasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> bidii maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu baada <strong>ya</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu kun<strong>ya</strong>maza, <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kutangaza ukweli.<br />

Mmoja <strong>wa</strong>o aliku<strong>wa</strong> William Farel. Alikele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> na mkatoliki mwenye<br />

juhudi, alitamani sana kuharibu kila kitu kilichojaribu pinga kanisa. “Ningesaga meno<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu kama mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu mkali,” akasema baadaye. “Ninaposikia mtu ye yote kusema<br />

84


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kinyume cha Papa.” Lakini ibada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, kuabudu mbele <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu, na<br />

kupamb<strong>wa</strong> na za<strong>wa</strong>di za mahali patakatifu hakukuweza kuleta amani <strong>ya</strong> roho. Kusadikish<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> zambi kukaimarish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, ambako matendo yote <strong>ya</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong> kumupa<br />

uhuru. Akasikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong> Lefévre: “Wokovu ni k<strong>wa</strong> neema.” “Ni msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kristo tu<br />

unaofungua milango <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni, na kufunga milango <strong>ya</strong> kuzimu.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kutubu kama kule k<strong>wa</strong> Paulo, Farel akageuka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> utum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> asili hata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. “Baada <strong>ya</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong> uuaji <strong>wa</strong> mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu mkali,” akarudi<br />

akasema, “k<strong>wa</strong> kim<strong>ya</strong> kama m<strong>wa</strong>na kondoo mwema na mpole, moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke wote<br />

umeondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Papa, na ukatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo.”<br />

Wakati Lefévre alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akita<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> nuru miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi, Farel akaendelea<br />

kutangaza kweli <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi. Mkuu mmoja <strong>wa</strong> kanisa, askofu <strong>wa</strong> Meaux, akajiunga mara<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>o. Waalimu wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaungana katika kutangaza injili, na ikavuta <strong>wa</strong>fuasi kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fundi na <strong>wa</strong>kulima hata k<strong>wa</strong> jumba la mfalme. Dada <strong>wa</strong> Francis I<br />

akakubali imani <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo. K<strong>wa</strong> matumaini bora <strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>litazamia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ambapo Ufransa ulipas<strong>wa</strong> kuvut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> injili.<br />

Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> la Kifransa<br />

Lakini matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o ha<strong>ya</strong>kutimia. Majaribu na mateso ikangoja <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Walakini, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> amani ukafika, ambao <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kupata nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> kukutana na<br />

tufani, na matengenezo <strong>ya</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> upesi. Lefévre akaanza kutafsiri <strong>wa</strong> Agano<br />

Jip<strong>ya</strong>; na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uleule ambapo Biblia <strong>ya</strong> Jeremani <strong>ya</strong> Luther ilipomalizika kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mtambo <strong>wa</strong> kupigia chapa katika Wittenberg, Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> la Kinfransa likachap<strong>wa</strong> huko<br />

Meaux. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>kulima <strong>wa</strong> Meaux <strong>wa</strong>kapata Maandiko matakatifu. Watu <strong>wa</strong> kazi<br />

katika mashamba, <strong>wa</strong>fundi katika ki<strong>wa</strong>nda cha kufanyia kazi, <strong>wa</strong>kafurahish<strong>wa</strong> na kazi <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kila siku k<strong>wa</strong> kuzungumza habari <strong>ya</strong> damani <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. Ijapo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

cheo cha chini kabisa, bila elimu na kazi ngumu <strong>ya</strong> ukulima, matengenezo, uwezo<br />

unaogeuza, <strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ukaonekana katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Nuru iliyoangaza huko Meaux ikatoa n<strong>ya</strong>li <strong>ya</strong>ke mbali. Kila siku hesabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liogeuka<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikiongezeka. Hasira kali <strong>ya</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ikakomesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mda k<strong>wa</strong> kizuio cha<br />

mfalme, lakini <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Papa <strong>wa</strong>kashinda mwishowe. Mti <strong>wa</strong>kuchoma <strong>wa</strong> pinga dini<br />

kuka<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong>. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lioshuhudia juu <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> katika miako <strong>ya</strong> moto.<br />

Ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyumba vikub<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> majumba na majumba <strong>ya</strong> kifalme, kuliku<strong>wa</strong> roho za<br />

kifalme ambamo ukweli uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> damani kuliko utajiri ao cheo ao hata maisha. Louis de<br />

Berquin aliku<strong>wa</strong> mzali<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> jamaa <strong>ya</strong> cheo kikub<strong>wa</strong>, aliyejitoa k<strong>wa</strong> majifunzo, mwenye<br />

kuadibish<strong>wa</strong> na tabia isiyolaumi<strong>wa</strong>. “Akakamilisha kila namna <strong>ya</strong> wema k<strong>wa</strong> kushika<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Luther katika machukio makuu <strong>ya</strong> kipekee.” Lakini, k<strong>wa</strong> bahati njema<br />

akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia, akashangaz<strong>wa</strong> kupata pale “si mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Roma, bali<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Luther.” Akajitoa mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> injili.<br />

85


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa <strong>ya</strong> Ufransa ikamtia gerezani kama mpinga imani <strong>ya</strong> dini, lakini<br />

akafunguli<strong>wa</strong> na mfalme. K<strong>wa</strong> miaka nyingi Francis aliku<strong>wa</strong> akisitasita kati <strong>ya</strong> Roma na<br />

Matengenezo. Mara tatu Berquin akafung<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa, na akafunguli<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mfalme, aliyekataa kumtoa kafara k<strong>wa</strong> ukorofi <strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa. Berquin akazidi<br />

kuony<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> hatari iliyotaka kumpata katika Ufransa na akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kufuata hatua za<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokwenda kutafuta usalama katika kuhamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi mbali na k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Berquin Shujaa<br />

Lakini juhudi <strong>ya</strong> Berquin ikazidi ku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu. Akakusudia mpango <strong>wa</strong> nguvu zaidi.<br />

Hakusimama tu k<strong>wa</strong> kutetea ukweli, lakini akashambulia kosa. Adui zake <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

juhudi na ukaidi zaidi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> wenye elimu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> idara <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na<br />

sifa za Mungu na dini (theologie) katika chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong> (universite) cha Paris, moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>ya</strong> juu sana katika taifa. K<strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu ha<strong>wa</strong>, Berquin<br />

akapata makusudi kumi na mbili ambayo akaitangaza <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi ku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume cha Biblia,”<br />

na akauliza mfalme kujifan<strong>ya</strong> muamzi katika shindano.<br />

Mfalme, k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na furaha <strong>ya</strong> nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kushusha majivuno <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> wenye<br />

kiburi, akaalika <strong>wa</strong>katoliki kutetea jambo lao k<strong>wa</strong> kufuata Biblia. Silaha hii hainge<strong>wa</strong>saidia<br />

zaidi; mateso na kifo cha mtu <strong>wa</strong> kuchoma iliku<strong>wa</strong> ndizo silaha ambazo <strong>wa</strong>lizifahamu zaidi<br />

namna <strong>ya</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>kajiona wenyewe kuanguka katika shimo <strong>wa</strong>lilotumaini<br />

kumtumbukiza Berquin. Wakatafuta wenyewe namna gani <strong>ya</strong> kujiepusha.<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule <strong>wa</strong>kaona kando <strong>ya</strong> moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> njia sanamu <strong>ya</strong> bikira iliyovunj<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Makundi <strong>ya</strong>kakusanyika mahali pale, <strong>wa</strong>kilia na hasira. Mfalme akachom<strong>wa</strong> moyo sana .<br />

“Ha<strong>ya</strong> ndiyo matunda <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Berquin,” <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kapaza sauti. “Kila kitu ni<br />

karibu kugeuz<strong>wa</strong>--dini, sheria, kiti cha ufalme chenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> mapatano hii <strong>ya</strong> Luther.”<br />

Mfalme akatoka Paris, na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaachi<strong>wa</strong> huru kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o. Berquin<br />

akahukumi<strong>wa</strong> na kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong> kifo. K<strong>wa</strong> hofu k<strong>wa</strong>mba Francis angetetea tena k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kumwokoa, hukumu ikafanyika k<strong>wa</strong> siku ile ile ilio tamk<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> sasa sita za mchana<br />

msongano wengi ukakusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kushuhudia jambo hili, na wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mshangao k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu aliyetes<strong>wa</strong> alichaguli<strong>wa</strong> miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu bora na <strong>wa</strong>hodari<br />

zaidi <strong>wa</strong> jamaa bora za Ufransa. Mshangao, hasira, zarau, na uchuki <strong>wa</strong> uchungu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kahuzunisha nyuso za kundi lile, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> uso mmoja hauku<strong>wa</strong> na kivuli. Mfia dini<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> na zamiri tu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Uso <strong>wa</strong> Berquin uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukingaa na nuru <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Alivaa vazi kama joho laini la<br />

kungaa, chuma puani na soksi <strong>ya</strong> zahabu.” Aliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kushuhudia imani <strong>ya</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme, na hakuna dalili iliyopasa kusingizia furaha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakati<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano ulipoku<strong>wa</strong> ukisogea polepole katika njia zilizosongana, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kapat<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mshangazo <strong>wa</strong> ushindi <strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Yeye anaku<strong>wa</strong>,” <strong>wa</strong>kasema, “kama<br />

mmoja anayekaa katika hekalu, na akifikiri vitu vitakatifu.”<br />

86


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Berquin k<strong>wa</strong> Mti Wakufungia Watu <strong>wa</strong> Kochom<strong>wa</strong> Moto<br />

Katika mti Berquin akajitahidi kusema maneno machache k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu; lakini <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaanza kupaza sauti na askari kugonganisha silaha zao, na makelele <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kazamisha<br />

sauti <strong>ya</strong> mfia dini. Hivi k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1529 mamlaka kub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na elimu <strong>ya</strong> Paris<br />

“ikatoa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> 1793 mfano <strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> kusong<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> juk<strong>wa</strong>a (mahali pa<br />

kunyong<strong>wa</strong>) maneno takatifu <strong>ya</strong> wenye kufa.” Berquin akanyong<strong>wa</strong> na mwili <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ukateketez<strong>wa</strong> katika miako <strong>ya</strong> moto.<br />

Waalimu <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>kaenda katika mashamba mengine <strong>ya</strong> kazi.<br />

Lefévre akaenda Ujermani. Farel akarudi k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong> upande wenashariki <strong>ya</strong><br />

Ufransa, kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> nuru katika makao <strong>ya</strong> utoto <strong>wa</strong>ke. Ukweli aliuofundisha ukapata<br />

<strong>wa</strong>sikizaji. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi akafukuz<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> mji. Akapitia vijijini, akifundisha katika makao<br />

<strong>ya</strong> upekee na mashamba <strong>ya</strong> majani <strong>ya</strong> uficho, kutafuta kimbilio katika pori na katika<br />

mapango <strong>ya</strong> miamba <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong>ke katika utoto <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Kama katika siku za mitume, mateso “<strong>ya</strong>metokea zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> kuendesha Habari Njema.”<br />

Wafilipi 1:12. Walipofukuz<strong>wa</strong> kutoka Paris na Meaux, “Wale <strong>wa</strong>liosambaz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaenda<br />

pahali po pote <strong>wa</strong>kihubiri neno.” Matendo 8:4. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> namna hiyo nuru ilita<strong>wa</strong>nyika mahali<br />

pengi katika majimbo <strong>ya</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> Ufransa.<br />

Mwito <strong>wa</strong> Calvin<br />

Katika moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mashule <strong>ya</strong> Paris, kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kijana mmoja m<strong>wa</strong>ngalifu, mtulivu,<br />

kijana aliyeonekana na maisha <strong>ya</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> bidii <strong>ya</strong> elimu na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini. Tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke na matumizi vikamufan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> majivuno <strong>ya</strong> chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitumaini<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> siri k<strong>wa</strong>mba Jean Calvin angeku<strong>wa</strong> mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po miongoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tetezi wenye uwezo sana, <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Lakini mshale <strong>wa</strong> nuru ukaangazia kuta za elimu<br />

nyingi na ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu ambayo Calvin amajifungia. Olivetan, binamu mtoto <strong>wa</strong> ndungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Calvin, alijiunga na Watengenezaji. Ndugu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>kazungumza pamoja juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

maneno ambayo <strong>ya</strong>nasumbua jamii la kikristo. “Hapo kuna dini mbili tu ulimwenguni,”<br />

akasema Olivetan, Mprotestanti. “Ile ... ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>mevumbua, ambamo mtu hujiokoa<br />

mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> sherehe na kazi nzuri; ingine ni ile dini ambayo inayofunuli<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

Biblia, na ambayo hufundisha mtu kutumaini wokovu tu k<strong>wa</strong> neema bila bei kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu.”<br />

“Sitaki mafundisho yenu map<strong>ya</strong>,” akajibu Calvin; “Unafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba nimeishi katika<br />

kosa siku zangu zote?” Lakini peke <strong>ya</strong>ke chumbani akatafakari maneno <strong>ya</strong> binamu (cousin)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Akajiona mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> bila mpatanishi mbeie <strong>ya</strong> Mhukumu mtakatifu na <strong>wa</strong> haki.<br />

Matendo mazuri, sherehe za kanisa, yote <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> bila uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi. Ungamo, kitubio, ha<strong>ya</strong>kuweza kupatanisha roho pamoja na Mungu.<br />

Ushahidi k<strong>wa</strong> Mchomo<br />

87


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Calvin akapitia siku moja katika u<strong>wa</strong>nja mkub<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> bahati njema akaona mpinga<br />

ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini anapokufa k<strong>wa</strong> moto. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> kifo cha kuhofisha na chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

kukati<strong>wa</strong> hukumu k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa, mfia dini akaonyesha imani na uhodari ambao m<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

kijana k<strong>wa</strong> uchungu aliona ni kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> tumaini lake mwenyewe na giza.<br />

Juu <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, alijua, “<strong>wa</strong>zushi” <strong>wa</strong>lidumisha imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Akakusudia kujifunza Biblia<br />

yenyewe na kuvumbua siri <strong>ya</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Ndani <strong>ya</strong> Biblia akampata Kristo. “Ee Baba,” akalia, “Kafara <strong>ya</strong>ke ilituliza hasira <strong>ya</strong>ko;<br />

Damu <strong>ya</strong>ke imesafisha takataka zangu; Msalaba <strong>wa</strong>ke ulichukua laana <strong>ya</strong>ngu; Mauti <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

ilitoa kafara k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu. ... Umegusa moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu, ili niweze kusimama katika matendo<br />

mema mengine yote kama mahukizo isipoku<strong>wa</strong> matendo mema <strong>ya</strong> Yesu.<br />

Sasa akakusudia kutoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> injili. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> tabia aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye woga<br />

na alitamani kujitoa mwenyewe kujifunza. Maombi <strong>ya</strong> bidii <strong>ya</strong> rafiki zake, lakini,<br />

mwishowe <strong>ya</strong>kashinda ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. Maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kama umande unaoanguka k<strong>wa</strong> kuburudisha udongo. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> sasa katika mji <strong>wa</strong><br />

jimbo chini <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> binti kifalme Margeurite, ambaye, k<strong>wa</strong> kupenda injili, akaeneza<br />

ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Calvin ikaanza pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liosikia ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>kachukua Habari Njema k<strong>wa</strong> wengine. Akaendelea, kuweka<br />

msingi <strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong>liyopas<strong>wa</strong> kutoa ushuhuda hodari k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli.<br />

Mji <strong>wa</strong> Paris ulipash<strong>wa</strong> kupokea m<strong>wa</strong>liko mwengine k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali injili. Mwito <strong>wa</strong><br />

Lefévre na Farel ulikatali<strong>wa</strong>, lakini ujumbe ulipash<strong>wa</strong> kusiki<strong>wa</strong> tena k<strong>wa</strong> vyeo vyote katika<br />

mji mkuu ule. Mfalme aliku<strong>wa</strong> hajakamata mpango <strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Roma kupinga<br />

Matengenezo. Margeurite (dada <strong>ya</strong>ke) alitamani k<strong>wa</strong>mba imani <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo ihubiriwe<br />

katika Paris. Akaagiza mhubiri <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti kuhubiri katika makanisa. Jambo hili<br />

likakataz<strong>wa</strong> na mapadri <strong>wa</strong> Papa, binti mfalme akafungua jumba. Ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kila<br />

siku hotuba inapas<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaalik<strong>wa</strong> kuhuzuria. Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika<br />

kila siku.<br />

Mfalme akaagiza k<strong>wa</strong>mba makanisa mawili <strong>ya</strong> Paris <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong>. Kamwe<br />

mji uliku<strong>wa</strong> haujavut<strong>wa</strong> na Neno la Mungu kama <strong>wa</strong>kati ule. Kiasi, usafi, utaratibu, na<br />

utendaji, mambo <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>kachukua pahali pa ulevi, uasherati, shindano, na uvivu. Weakati<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likubali injili, <strong>wa</strong>lio wengi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaikataa. Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kafaulu kupata tena<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o. Tena makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kafung<strong>wa</strong> na mti <strong>wa</strong> kufungia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kuchom<strong>wa</strong><br />

ukasimamish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Calvin aliku<strong>wa</strong> akingali Paris. Mwishowe mamlaka ikakusudia kumleta k<strong>wa</strong> ndimi za<br />

moto. Haku<strong>wa</strong> na ma<strong>wa</strong>zo juu <strong>ya</strong> hatari <strong>wa</strong>kati rafiki <strong>wa</strong>likuja k<strong>wa</strong> haraka k<strong>wa</strong> chumba<br />

chake na habari k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> njiani m<strong>wa</strong>o kumfunga. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule sauti <strong>ya</strong><br />

bisho likasiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> inje. Hapo hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kupoteza. Rafiki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kakawisha <strong>wa</strong>kuu mlangoni na wengine <strong>wa</strong>kasaidia Mtengenezaji kumshusha chini k<strong>wa</strong><br />

dirisha, na k<strong>wa</strong> haraka akaenda k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba ndogo <strong>ya</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> kazi aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki <strong>wa</strong><br />

88


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Matengenezo. Akajigeuza mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> mavazi <strong>ya</strong> mwenyeji <strong>wa</strong>ke na, kuchukua jembe<br />

mabegani, akaanza safari <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akasafiri upande <strong>wa</strong> Kusini, akapata tena kimbilio katika<br />

uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Margeurite.<br />

Calvin hakuweza kubakia <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu bila kazi. Mara msukosuko ulipotulia akaenda<br />

kutafuta shamba mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kazi huko Poities, mahali makusudi map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kufaa<br />

kukubali<strong>wa</strong>. Watu <strong>wa</strong> namna zote <strong>wa</strong>lisikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> furaha habari njema. K<strong>wa</strong> namna hesabu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> ikiongezeka, <strong>wa</strong>kafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni vyema kukusanyikia inje <strong>ya</strong><br />

mji. K<strong>wa</strong> pango mahali miti na miamba <strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> uficho pakachaguli<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa<br />

mkutano. Katika mahali hapa pa uficho Biblia ikasom<strong>wa</strong> na kufasiri<strong>wa</strong>. Hapo ibada <strong>ya</strong> meza<br />

<strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ikafanyika k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa. K<strong>wa</strong> kanisa<br />

ndogo hilo kukatoka <strong>wa</strong>hubiri wengi <strong>wa</strong>aminifu.<br />

Mara ingine tena Calvin akarudi Paris, lakini akakuta karibu kila mlango <strong>wa</strong> kazi<br />

umefung<strong>wa</strong>. Yeye mwishowe akakusudia kwenda Ujeremani. K<strong>wa</strong> shida aliacha Ufransa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati zoruba ilitokea juu <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti. Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia<br />

kupambana na pigo hodari juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> Roma ile iliyopash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuamsha taifa lote. Matangazo k<strong>wa</strong> kushambulia misa katika usiku moja <strong>ya</strong>kawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Ufransa pote. Mahali pa kuendeleza kazi <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, tendo hilo la upumbavu lika<strong>wa</strong>pa<br />

Warumi sababu <strong>ya</strong> kudai kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>pinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini” kama <strong>wa</strong>fitini <strong>wa</strong><br />

hatari k<strong>wa</strong> usitawi <strong>wa</strong> kiti cha mfalme na amani <strong>ya</strong> taifa.<br />

Moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> matangazo liliwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> chumba cha pekee cha mfalme.<br />

Uhodari <strong>wa</strong> upekee <strong>wa</strong> kujiingiza k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> kushangaza ha<strong>ya</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> mfalme na<br />

jambo hilo likaamsha hasira <strong>ya</strong> mfalme. Ghazabu <strong>ya</strong>ke ikapata usemi katika maneno makali:<br />

“Wote <strong>wa</strong>kamatiwe bila tofauti <strong>wa</strong>naozani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Luther. Nita<strong>wa</strong>angamiza<br />

wote.” Mfalme akajiweka k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Roma.<br />

Uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Hofu Kuu<br />

Mfuasi maskini <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo aliyezoea kuita <strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong> mikutano <strong>ya</strong><br />

siri akakamat<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> kutish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kifo cha gafula k<strong>wa</strong> mti <strong>wa</strong> kuchom<strong>wa</strong>, akaamuri<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuongoza mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Papa k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> kila mprotestanti katika mji. Hofu <strong>ya</strong> ndimi <strong>ya</strong><br />

moto ika<strong>wa</strong> nyingi sana, na akakubali kusaliti ndugu zake. Morin, polisi <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, pamoja<br />

na msaliti, k<strong>wa</strong> polepole na ukim<strong>ya</strong> akapita katika njia za mji. Walipofika mbele <strong>ya</strong> nyumba<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mtu mmoja <strong>wa</strong> Luther, msaliti akafan<strong>ya</strong> ishara, lakini bila kusema neno. M<strong>wa</strong>ndamano<br />

ukasimama, <strong>wa</strong>kaingia nyumbani, jamaa likakokot<strong>wa</strong> na kufung<strong>wa</strong> minyororo, na mfuatano<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kutisha ukaendelea katika kutafuta <strong>wa</strong>tu wengine <strong>wa</strong>p<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kutesa. “Morin<br />

akatetemesha mji wote. ... Uliku<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> hofu kuu.”<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaua<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mateso makali, ikaamri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba moto upunguzwe<br />

ili kuzidisha mateso <strong>ya</strong>o. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>likufa kama <strong>wa</strong>shindaji, musimamo <strong>wa</strong>o usiotikisika,<br />

amani <strong>ya</strong>o kamili. Watesi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kajiona wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong>. “Watu <strong>wa</strong> Paris<br />

89


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>kapata nafasi <strong>ya</strong> kuona aina gani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ma<strong>wa</strong>zo map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liweza kuleta. Hakuna<br />

mimbara iliku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> kulinganish<strong>wa</strong> na mjumba kub<strong>wa</strong> la <strong>wa</strong>fia dini. Furaha ikaangazia<br />

nyuso kunjufu za <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kielekea ... pahali pa kuua<strong>wa</strong> ... na<br />

kuomba k<strong>wa</strong> usemaji <strong>wa</strong> kushangaza k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> injili.”<br />

Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>kasitaki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>likusudia kuua <strong>wa</strong>katoliki, kupindua serkali, na<br />

kumua mfalme. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kutoa hata kivuli cha ushahidi k<strong>wa</strong> kushuhudia mambo<br />

yenyewe. Huku ukali ukapiga juu <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>sio na kosa ukaongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> uzito<br />

<strong>wa</strong> malipizi, na katika karne zilizofuata kukatokea maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> namna ile <strong>wa</strong>liyotabiri<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> mfalme, serkali <strong>ya</strong>ke, na raia <strong>wa</strong>ke. Lakini <strong>ya</strong>kalet<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kafiri na <strong>wa</strong>katoliki <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe.<br />

Kuvunja dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti ndiko kulileta juu <strong>ya</strong> Ufransa misiba hii <strong>ya</strong> kutisha.<br />

Mashaka, hofu, na vitisho sasa vikaenea k<strong>wa</strong> makundi yote <strong>ya</strong> jamii. Mamia <strong>wa</strong>kakimbia<br />

kutoka Paris, <strong>wa</strong>kajihamisha wenyewe kutoka inchini m<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong>, wengi kati <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>wa</strong>katoa ishara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>likubali imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Papa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kashangaz<strong>wa</strong> na hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>pinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini” isiyofikiri<strong>wa</strong> iliyovumili<strong>wa</strong><br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Kupiga Chapa Kulikataz<strong>wa</strong><br />

Francis I akapendez<strong>wa</strong> kukusan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> u<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye elimu <strong>ya</strong> maandiko<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zote. Lakini, wenye mafikara na juhudi <strong>ya</strong> kukomesha uzushi, baba huyu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> elimu akatoa amri kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba uchapaji <strong>wa</strong> vitabu umeondole<strong>wa</strong> pote katika<br />

Ufransa! Francis I ni moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> mifano <strong>ya</strong> historia kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba akili <strong>ya</strong> masomo<br />

hailinde <strong>wa</strong>tu juu <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini na mateso.<br />

Wapadri <strong>wa</strong>kadai k<strong>wa</strong>mba aibu iliyofanyi<strong>wa</strong> Mbingu <strong>ya</strong> juu k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> misa<br />

isafishwe katika damu. Tarehe 21 Januari 1535, iliwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> sherehe <strong>ya</strong> kutisha. Mbele<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kila mlango mwenge <strong>wa</strong> moto uka<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> heshima <strong>ya</strong> “sakramenti takatifu.”<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> usiku kucha makutano <strong>ya</strong>kakutanika k<strong>wa</strong> jumba la mfalme.<br />

“Majeshi <strong>ya</strong>kachukuli<strong>wa</strong> na askofu <strong>wa</strong> Paris chini <strong>ya</strong> chandalu<strong>wa</strong> nzuri, ... Baada <strong>ya</strong><br />

majeshi kutembeza mfalme ... Francis I k<strong>wa</strong> siku ile hakuvaa taji, <strong>wa</strong>la kanzu <strong>ya</strong> cheo.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kila mazabahu akainama k<strong>wa</strong> kujinyenyekea, si k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> makosa iliyonajisi roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke, ao damu isiyo na kosa iliyoharibu mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke, bali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> “zambi <strong>ya</strong> mauti” <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liosubutu kuhukumu misa.<br />

Katika chumba kikub<strong>wa</strong> cha mjumba la askofu mfalme akatokea na katika maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

usemi <strong>wa</strong> hasira akasikitikia “makosa, matukano, siku <strong>ya</strong> huzuni na ha<strong>ya</strong>,” ambayo ilikuja<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> taifa. Na akaalika <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> ufalme kusaidia kungoa baala <strong>ya</strong> “uzushi”<br />

ambayo ilitisha Ufransa k<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu. Machozi <strong>ya</strong>kajaa k<strong>wa</strong> usemi <strong>wa</strong>ke, na mkutano wote<br />

ukaomboleza, k<strong>wa</strong> umoja <strong>wa</strong>kasema k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu, “Tutaishi na kufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> dini<br />

<strong>ya</strong>Kikatoliki!”<br />

90


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Neema ile iletayo wokovu” ilionekana, lakini Ufransa ilipoangazi<strong>wa</strong> na m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke, ikautupilia mbali, ikachagua giza zaidi kuliko nuru. Wakaita uba<strong>ya</strong> wema, na wema<br />

uba<strong>ya</strong>, hata <strong>wa</strong>lipoanguka ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kutes<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hila <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> ukaidi. Nuru ambayo<br />

ingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong>okoa k<strong>wa</strong> udanganyifu, k<strong>wa</strong> kuchafua roho zao na kosa <strong>ya</strong> uuaji, <strong>wa</strong>kaikataa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuasi.<br />

Tena mkutano ukafanyika. “K<strong>wa</strong> mwendo mfupi (majuk<strong>wa</strong>a) mahali pa kunyongea <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kajeng<strong>wa</strong> mahali Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kuchom<strong>wa</strong> motoni <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong> hai,<br />

na ilitengenez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba matata <strong>ya</strong><strong>wa</strong>shwe <strong>wa</strong>kati mfalme alipokaribia, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano ulipash<strong>wa</strong> kusimama k<strong>wa</strong> kushuhudia <strong>wa</strong>uaji.” Hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na kutikisika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

upande <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liopash<strong>wa</strong> kufa. K<strong>wa</strong> kushurutish<strong>wa</strong> kukana, mmoja akajibu: “Mimi<br />

naamini tu <strong>ya</strong>le manabii na mitume <strong>wa</strong>liyohubiri mbele na <strong>ya</strong>le jamii lote la <strong>wa</strong>takatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liamini. Imani <strong>ya</strong>ngu inaku<strong>wa</strong> na tumaini k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ambaye atashinda mamlaka yote<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuzimu.”<br />

Katika kufikia jumba la mfalme, makutano <strong>ya</strong>kata<strong>wa</strong>nyika na mfalme na maaskofu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaondoka, <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kishangilia wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi ingeendelea k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza<br />

maangamizo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini.”<br />

Habari Njema <strong>ya</strong> amani ambayo Ufransa ilikataa ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kungole<strong>wa</strong> kweli, na<br />

matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kutisha. Tarehe 21 <strong>ya</strong> Januari 1793, m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano mwengine ukapita<br />

katika njia za Paris. “Tena mfalme aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwongozi mkuu; tena kuka<strong>wa</strong> fujo na<br />

kulalamika; tena kukasiki<strong>wa</strong> kilio cha <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong>; tena kuka<strong>wa</strong> majuk<strong>wa</strong>a<br />

meusi; na matukio <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong>kamalizika k<strong>wa</strong> mauaji na sana; Louis XVI, alipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akishindana mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>linzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> gereza na <strong>wa</strong>nyongaji, akakokot<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> gogo,<br />

na hapo akashik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu nyingi hata shoka lilipoanguka, na kich<strong>wa</strong> chake<br />

kilichokat<strong>wa</strong> kikajifingirisha k<strong>wa</strong> juk<strong>wa</strong>a.”<br />

Karibu na mahali pale pale <strong>wa</strong>tu 2800 <strong>wa</strong>kaangamiz<strong>wa</strong> na machine yenye kisu cha<br />

kukata <strong>wa</strong>tu kich<strong>wa</strong> (guillotine). Matengenezo ikaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu Biblia yenye<br />

kufunguli<strong>wa</strong>. Upendo usio na mwisho ukajulisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kanuni za mbinguni. Wakati Ufransa<br />

ilipokataa za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni, ikapanda mbegu <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu. Hakuku<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> kuepuka<br />

matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liyotendeka ambayo mwisho uliku<strong>wa</strong> mapinduzi na uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kuhofisha.<br />

Farel shujaa na mwenye uhodari akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukimbia kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuzali<strong>wa</strong> na kwenda Uswisi. Lakini akaendelea kutumia mvuto uliokusudi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

matengenezo katika Ufransa. Pamoja na usaada <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengine <strong>wa</strong>liofukuz<strong>wa</strong>, maandiko<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremani <strong>ya</strong>katafsiri<strong>wa</strong> katika Kifransa na pamoja na Biblia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kifransa ikachap<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wingi sana. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> dini vitabu hivyo<br />

vikauzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> eneo kub<strong>wa</strong> sana katika Ufransa.<br />

Farel akaingia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke katika Uswisi k<strong>wa</strong> mwenendo mnyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu,<br />

akaingiza k<strong>wa</strong> werevu kweli za Biblia. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaamini, lakini <strong>wa</strong>padri <strong>wa</strong>kaja<br />

91


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kusimamisha kazi, na <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>wa</strong>kaharakish<strong>wa</strong> kuipinga. “Hiyo<br />

haiwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> injili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo,” <strong>wa</strong>padri <strong>wa</strong>kashurutisha, “kuona kuihubiri hakuwezi kuleta<br />

amani, bali vita.”<br />

Akaenda mji k<strong>wa</strong> mji, kuteseka na njaa, baridi, na kuchoka,na mahali pote katika ajali <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akahubiri sokoni, ndani <strong>ya</strong> makanisa, mara zingine katika mimbara <strong>ya</strong><br />

makanisa makub<strong>wa</strong>. Zaidi kuliko mara moja akapig<strong>wa</strong> karibu kufa. Lakini akaendelea<br />

mbele. Mwishowe akaona miji mikub<strong>wa</strong> na midogo ilioku<strong>wa</strong> ngome za kanisa la Katoliki<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kafungua milango <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> injili.<br />

Farel alitamani kusimamisha bendera <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti katika Geneve. Kama mji huu<br />

ungaliweza kupatikana, ungaliku<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo katika<br />

Ufransa, Uswisi, na Italia. <strong>Miji</strong> mingi iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> kandokando <strong>ya</strong> miji midogo ikaamini.<br />

Pamoja na rafiki mmoja akaingia Geneve. Lakini akaruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri mara mbili tu.<br />

Mapadri <strong>wa</strong>kam<strong>wa</strong>lika mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza la kanisa, <strong>wa</strong>kaja na silaha zilizofich<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

makanzu <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kutoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Inje <strong>ya</strong> chumba kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi<br />

wenye hasira kuhakikisha kifo chake kama akiepuka baraza. Ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amzi na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>askari, inga<strong>wa</strong> hivyo <strong>wa</strong>kamwokoa. Mapema sana asubuhi akapelek<strong>wa</strong> karibu <strong>ya</strong> zi<strong>wa</strong><br />

mahali pa salama. Ndivyo ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> juhudi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> kueneza injili<br />

huko Geneve.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliz<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili, <strong>wa</strong>kachagua chombo kizaifu sana; aliku<strong>wa</strong> kijana<br />

munyonge k<strong>wa</strong> sura hata akapokele<strong>wa</strong> bila furaha na marafiki <strong>wa</strong>naojidai kusimamia<br />

Matengenezo. Lakini mtu <strong>wa</strong> namna hii angeweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> nini mahali Farel alikatali<strong>wa</strong>?<br />

“Mungu alichagua vitu zaifu v<strong>ya</strong> dunia kupatisha vitu v<strong>ya</strong> nguvu ha<strong>ya</strong>.” 1 Wakorinto 1:27.<br />

Froment M<strong>wa</strong>limu<br />

Froment akaanza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama m<strong>wa</strong>limu. Kweli alizofundisha <strong>wa</strong>toto chuoni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>ya</strong>kariri nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>o. Mara <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>kasikia Biblia ilipoku<strong>wa</strong> ikielez<strong>wa</strong>. Agano<br />

Jip<strong>ya</strong> na vitabu vidogo vikatole<strong>wa</strong> bure. Baada <strong>ya</strong> mda mtumikaji huyu pia alipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukimbia, lakini kweli alizofundisha ikaingia mioyoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Matengenezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kapand<strong>wa</strong>. Wahubiri <strong>wa</strong>karudi, na ibada <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti ikaanzish<strong>wa</strong> katika Geneve.<br />

<strong>Miji</strong> uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukmekwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>kati Calvin,<br />

alipoingia katika milango <strong>ya</strong>ke. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> njiani kwenda Basel alipolazimish<strong>wa</strong> kupitia njia<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuzunguka zunguka kupitia Geneve.<br />

Katika kuzuru huku Farel akatambua mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Inga<strong>wa</strong> Geneve ilikubali imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, lakini kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuongoka ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kutendeka ndani <strong>ya</strong> moyo k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Roho Mtakatifu, si k<strong>wa</strong> amri za mabaraza. Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Geneve <strong>wa</strong>lipokataa mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Roma, ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kabisa kuacha makosa <strong>ya</strong>liyositawish<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

92


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> jina la Mungu Farel akamsihi k<strong>wa</strong> heshima mhubiri kijana kudumu na kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi<br />

huko Calvin akarudi nyuma kuonyesha hatari. Akajitenga ili asipambane k<strong>wa</strong> ha tari na roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ukali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Geneve. Alihitaji kupata mahali pa amani na ukim<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> majifunzo, na<br />

pale k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> vitabu angeweza kufundisha na kujenga makanisa. Lakini hakujaribu<br />

kukataa. Ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke “k<strong>wa</strong>mba mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulishuka kutoka mbinguni, k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

ukamushika, na ukamukaza bila kubadilika kubakia mahali alipoku<strong>wa</strong> na haraka <strong>ya</strong> kutoka.”<br />

Ngurumo <strong>ya</strong> Laana<br />

Laana za Papa zikanguruma juu <strong>ya</strong> Geneve. Namna gani mji huu mdogo ulishindana na<br />

mamlaka hodari <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ambalo lilitetemesha <strong>wa</strong>falme na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la kutii? Kushinda k<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo kukapita, Roma ikakusan<strong>ya</strong> nguvu mp<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza<br />

maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Amri <strong>ya</strong> WaJesuite ikaanzish<strong>wa</strong>, kali zaidi, <strong>ya</strong> tabia mba<strong>ya</strong>, na hodari<br />

kuliko <strong>wa</strong>shujaa wote <strong>wa</strong> Papa. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kujali upendo <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu, na zamiri yote<br />

ikan<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>, ha<strong>wa</strong>kujali amri, upendo, lakini ile <strong>ya</strong> agizo lao. (Tazama mwisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

kitabu.)<br />

Injili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo iliwezesha <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke kuvumilia mateso, bila kukatish<strong>wa</strong> tamaa na<br />

baridi, njaa, kazi ngumu na umaskini, kushindania kweli machoni pa mbao (zenye v<strong>ya</strong>ngo)<br />

za kutundikia, gereza, na kigingi. Kijesuitisme kikatia <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke moyo mamlaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli silaha zote za udanganyifu. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuogopa kufan<strong>ya</strong> kosa kub<strong>wa</strong> ao kutumia uwongo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong>o kujigeuza sura k<strong>wa</strong> uwongo haiku<strong>wa</strong> taabu. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> shabaha <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyojifunza kukomesha dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti na kuimarisha uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Papa.<br />

Walivaa vazi la utakatifu, <strong>wa</strong>kizuru nyumba za gereza na mahospitali, kusaidia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong> na maskini, na kuchukua jina takatifu la Yesu, aliyekwenda akifan<strong>ya</strong> matendo<br />

mema. Lakini chini <strong>ya</strong> umbo la inje lisilo na kosa, makusudi maba<strong>ya</strong> na <strong>ya</strong> uuaji <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>kifich<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> kanuni <strong>ya</strong> asili <strong>ya</strong> amri k<strong>wa</strong>mba “mwisho huthibitisha njia. Uongo, wizi,<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> uongo, mauaji <strong>ya</strong> siri, <strong>ya</strong>liruhusi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lipotumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> kanisa. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

siri Wajesuite <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiingia ndani <strong>ya</strong> maofisi <strong>ya</strong> serkali nakupanda juu, ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>shauri <strong>wa</strong> mfalme na kuongoza mashauri <strong>ya</strong> mataifa. Wakajifan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupeleleza mab<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o. Wakaanzisha vyuo vikub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kuu, na vyuo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. Watoto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti k<strong>wa</strong> njia<br />

<strong>ya</strong> vyuo hivyo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kivut<strong>wa</strong> kushika kanuni za kanisa la Papa. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo uhuru<br />

ambao mababa zao <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kishindania na kutoka damu ukasaliti<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o. Po<br />

pote, Wajesuites <strong>wa</strong>lipokwenda, kukafuata m<strong>wa</strong>msho <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Papa.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>patia uwezo mwingi, tangazo la Papa likatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuimarisha<br />

(“Inquisition”) (Baraza kuu la kuhukumia <strong>wa</strong>pinga ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini la Papa. Mahakama ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong>kawek<strong>wa</strong> tena na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma, na mambo maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kutisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuweza kuonyesh<strong>wa</strong> mchana <strong>ya</strong>kakariri<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> gereza za siri (cachots). Katika<br />

93


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

inchi nyingi maelfu na maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu--<strong>wa</strong> faida kuu k<strong>wa</strong> taifa, wenye elimu sana na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojifunza zaidi, <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong> ao kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukimbilia k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zingine. (Tazama<br />

Nyongezo.)<br />

Ushindi k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo<br />

Ndizo ziliku<strong>wa</strong> njia ambazo Roma ilitumia kuzima nuru <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuondolea <strong>wa</strong>tu Neno la Mungu, na k<strong>wa</strong> kuimarisha ujinga na ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> Miaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

Giza. Lakini chini <strong>ya</strong> mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na kazi za <strong>wa</strong>tu bora ambao aliinua k<strong>wa</strong> kufuata<br />

Luther, dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti haikukomesh<strong>wa</strong>. Si k<strong>wa</strong> wema ao k<strong>wa</strong> silaha za <strong>wa</strong>falme<br />

ambaye iliweza kupata nguvu zake. Inchi ndogo sana na mataifa zaifu zaidi <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> ngome<br />

zake. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> Geneve ndogo; iliku<strong>wa</strong> Hollande, kushindana juu <strong>ya</strong> ukorofi <strong>wa</strong> Espagne;<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> Suede <strong>ya</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong> na ukame, ambazo zilipata ushindi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Karibu miaka makumi tatu Calvin alitumika Geneve k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maendeleo <strong>ya</strong><br />

Matengenezo pote katika Ula<strong>ya</strong>. Mwenendo <strong>wa</strong>ke hauku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa, <strong>wa</strong>la mafundisho<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke kukosa ku<strong>wa</strong> na makosa. Lakini aliku<strong>wa</strong> chombo cha kutangaza ukweli <strong>ya</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong><br />

kipekee; katika kuimarisha dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti juu <strong>ya</strong> mwendo <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> upesi<br />

kufaulu k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Papa, na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuingiza katike makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo<br />

unyofu na usafi <strong>wa</strong> maisha.<br />

Kutoka Geneve, <strong>wa</strong>kaenda kutangaza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo. Hapo, inchi zote za<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katafuta kupata mafundisho na kuti<strong>wa</strong> moyo. Mji <strong>wa</strong> Calvin uka<strong>wa</strong><br />

kimbilio la Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>liowind<strong>wa</strong> katika Ula<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong> Magharibi. Wakakaribish<strong>wa</strong><br />

vizuri na kutunz<strong>wa</strong> vizuri sana; na <strong>wa</strong>kapata makao pale, <strong>wa</strong>kaletea mji ulio<strong>wa</strong>pokea<br />

mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> ufundi <strong>wa</strong>o, elimu <strong>ya</strong>o, na uta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o. John Knox, Mtengenezaji hodari <strong>wa</strong><br />

Scotland (Ecosse), si hesabu ndogo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nyofu <strong>wa</strong> Uingereza, Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong><br />

Hollande na <strong>wa</strong> Espagne, na <strong>wa</strong> Huguenots <strong>wa</strong> Ufaransa, <strong>wa</strong>kachukua kutoka Geneve<br />

mwenye <strong>wa</strong> ukweli kuangazia giza k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zao za kuzali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

94


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 13. Katika Uholandi na Scandanavia<br />

Katika Uholandi ukali <strong>wa</strong> Papa ukaleta haraka upinzani. Miaka mia saba kabla <strong>ya</strong><br />

Luther, askofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari akashitaki<strong>wa</strong> na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>wili, <strong>wa</strong>liotum<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mabalozi huko Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> “jambo takatifu la askofu”; “Unakaa<br />

mwenyewe ndani <strong>ya</strong> hekalu la Mungu; baada <strong>ya</strong> mchungaji unaku<strong>wa</strong> mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kondoo, ... lakini ulipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mtumishi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi, kama upendavyo kujiita<br />

mwenyewe, unatumaini ku<strong>wa</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mab<strong>wa</strong>na. ... Unaleta ha<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> amri za Mungu.”<br />

Wengine <strong>wa</strong>katokea katika karne zote kukariri kukataa huku. Biblia <strong>ya</strong> Wavaudois<br />

ilitafsiri<strong>wa</strong> katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> Kijeremani. Wakatangaza “k<strong>wa</strong>mba hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> faida ndani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke; hakuna mizaha <strong>wa</strong>la uongo, <strong>wa</strong>la mambo <strong>ya</strong> michezo, <strong>wa</strong>la udanganyifu, bali maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kweli.” Ndivyo <strong>wa</strong>liandika rafiki za imani <strong>ya</strong> zamani tangu karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mbili.<br />

Sasa <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma ikaanza; lakini <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea<br />

kuongezeka, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba Biblia ni mamlaka pekee <strong>ya</strong> haki katika dini na k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

“hakuna mtu anayepash<strong>wa</strong> kushurutish<strong>wa</strong> kuamini, bali angepash<strong>wa</strong> kusadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mahubiri.”<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Luther <strong>ya</strong>kapata katika Uholandi <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> juhudi na <strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuhubiri injili. Menno Simons, mtu <strong>wa</strong> elimu mkatoliki na aliyetakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upadri,<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> mjinga kabisa <strong>wa</strong> Biblia na hakuisoma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong> upinzani <strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong><br />

dini. K<strong>wa</strong> ondoleo la zambi akajitahidi kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha sauti <strong>ya</strong> zamiri, lakini bila manufaa.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong>; hili pamoja na maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther<br />

ikamletea kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. K<strong>wa</strong> mda kitambo akashuhudia mtu aliyeua<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu alibatiz<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Jambo hili likamwongoza kujifunza Biblia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

ubatizo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>dogo. Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba toba na imani vinahitaji<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong><br />

ubatizo.<br />

Menno akatoka k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma na akajitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

ukweli aliyokubali. Katika Ujeremani na Uholandi kundi la <strong>wa</strong>shupavu likatokea, kuharibu<br />

kanuni na adabu, na kuendelea kufan<strong>ya</strong> maasi. Menno k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zake zote akapinga<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uongo na mashauri <strong>ya</strong> ushenzi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shupavu. K<strong>wa</strong> miaka makumi mbili na<br />

tano akapitia Uhollande na upande <strong>wa</strong> kaskazini <strong>ya</strong> Ujeremani, kutumia mvuto mkub<strong>wa</strong><br />

sana, kufananisha katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe mafundisho aliyofundisha. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> haki, mpole na mtulivu, m<strong>wa</strong>minifu na mwenye bidii. Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kageuka sababu <strong>ya</strong> kazi zake.<br />

Katika Ujeremani Charles V alikomesha Matengenezo, lakini <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>kasimama<br />

kama boma juu <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> ukaidi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Katika Uhollande mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

sana. Amri za mateso zikafuatana k<strong>wa</strong> upesi. K<strong>wa</strong> kusoma Biblia, kuisikia ao kuihubiri,<br />

kumwomba Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> siri, kukataa kusujudu mbele <strong>ya</strong> sanamu ao kuimba Zaburi iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

azabu <strong>ya</strong> kifo. Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>liangamia chini <strong>ya</strong> Charles na Philip II.<br />

95


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati moja jamaa lote lilipelek<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> hekimu (Inquisiteurs), juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutokwenda k<strong>wa</strong> misa na kuabudu nyumbani. Kijana <strong>wa</strong> mwisho katika jamaa akajibu<br />

“Tunapiga magoti yetu, na kuomba k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu apate kuangaza akili zetu na kusamehe<br />

zambi zetu; tunaombea uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> mfalme wetu, ili ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke upate kusitawi na maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>we <strong>ya</strong> furaha; tuna<strong>wa</strong>ombea <strong>wa</strong>amzi wetu, ili Mungu apate ku<strong>wa</strong>linda.” ‘’Baba na<br />

mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kahukumi<strong>wa</strong> kifo cha (kigingi) mti <strong>wa</strong> kuchoma upinzani<br />

<strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini.”<br />

Si <strong>wa</strong>naume tu lakini <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke na vijana <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>katumia ujasiri imara. “Bibi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liweza kusimama k<strong>wa</strong> vigingi v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ume <strong>wa</strong>o, na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kivumilia<br />

mchomo <strong>wa</strong> moto <strong>wa</strong>ngenongoneza maneno <strong>ya</strong> faraja ao kuimba zaburi ku<strong>wa</strong>tia moyo.”<br />

“Wasichana <strong>wa</strong>kalaz<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> kaburi zao kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiingia katika<br />

chumba chao kulala usiku; ao kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> juk<strong>wa</strong>a na moto, <strong>wa</strong>kijivika k<strong>wa</strong> mapambo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

mazuri sana, kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kienda k<strong>wa</strong> ndoa <strong>ya</strong>o.”<br />

Mateso <strong>ya</strong>kazidisha hesabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli. M<strong>wa</strong>ka k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka<br />

mfalme akashurutisha kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<strong>ya</strong> ukatili, lakini hakufaulu. William <strong>wa</strong> Orange mwishowe<br />

akaleta uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu katika Holandi.<br />

Matengenezo Katika Danemark<br />

Katika inchi za kaskazini injili ilipata mwingilio <strong>wa</strong> amani. Wanafunzi huko Wittenberg<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liporudi nyumbani <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kichukua imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo huko Scandinavia.<br />

Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther pia <strong>ya</strong>kata<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> nuru. Watu hodari <strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> kaskazini,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kageuka kutoka maovu na ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> Roma na kupokea k<strong>wa</strong> furaha kweli <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha bora <strong>ya</strong> Biblia.<br />

Tausen, “Mtengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Danemark,” kama mtoto m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni, akaonyesha akili <strong>ya</strong><br />

nguvu na akaingia k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>. Mtihani ulimtambulisha ku<strong>wa</strong> na talanta<br />

iliyoahidi kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi nzuri kanisani. M<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi kijana akaruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kujichagulia<br />

mwenyewe chuo kikub<strong>wa</strong> cha Ujeremani ama cha Uholandi, ila k<strong>wa</strong> sharti moja tu:<br />

hakupash<strong>wa</strong> kwenda Wittenberg kuhatarish<strong>wa</strong> na uzushi. Wata<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kasema hivyo.<br />

Tausen akaenda Cologne, moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> ngome <strong>ya</strong> Kiroma. Hapo hakukawia<br />

kuchukiz<strong>wa</strong>. Ni <strong>wa</strong>kati ule ule aliposoma maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther k<strong>wa</strong> furaha na akatamani<br />

sana kujifunza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kipekee <strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> vile alipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujihatarisha kupoteza usaada <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi kusudi lake likafanyika na mara<br />

aka<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi huko Wittenberg.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kurudi Danemark, hakuonyesha siri <strong>ya</strong>ke, lakini akajitahidi kuongoza wenzake k<strong>wa</strong><br />

imani safi. Akafungua Biblia na akahubiri Kristo k<strong>wa</strong>o kama tumaini pekee la mwenye<br />

zambi la wokovu. Hasira <strong>ya</strong> mkuu <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> iliku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong> sana, <strong>wa</strong>lioweka<br />

matumaini <strong>ya</strong> juu juu k<strong>wa</strong>ke ku<strong>wa</strong> mtetezi <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Akahamish<strong>wa</strong> mara moja kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong> kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> ingine na kufungi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> chumba chake<br />

96


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kidogo. Katika fito za chuma za chumba chake kidogo Tausen akazungumza na wenzake<br />

maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Kama mababa wema <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong> Danois <strong>wa</strong>ngalipatana katika shauri la<br />

kanisa juu <strong>ya</strong> uzushi, sauti <strong>ya</strong> Tausen haingalisiki<strong>wa</strong> tena kamwe; lakini badala <strong>ya</strong> kumzika<br />

hai k<strong>wa</strong> gereza la chini <strong>ya</strong> udongo, <strong>wa</strong>kafukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Amri <strong>ya</strong> mfalme, ikatangaz<strong>wa</strong>, ikatolea ulinzi k<strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho map<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kafunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kajaa tele kusikiliza. Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

katika Kidanois kikaenez<strong>wa</strong> mahali pengi. Juhudi <strong>ya</strong> kuangusha kazi ikaishia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuita<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>, na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo Danemark ikatangaza ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo.<br />

Maendeleo katika Uswedi<br />

Katika Uswedi vilevile vijana kutoka Wittenberg <strong>wa</strong>kachukua maji <strong>ya</strong> uzima k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo katika Swede, Olaf na Laurentius Petri,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lijifunza chini <strong>ya</strong> Luther na Melanchton. Kama mtengenezaji mkuu, Olaf akaamsha <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ufundi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kusema, hivyo Laurentius, sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na Melanchton, aliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

uangalifu na utulivu. Wote <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na uhodari imara. Mapadri <strong>wa</strong>kikatoliki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasukuma <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>jinga na <strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati nyingi. Olaf Petri k<strong>wa</strong> shida<br />

akaokoka na maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Watengenezaji ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong>, basi, <strong>wa</strong>kilind<strong>wa</strong> na mfalme,<br />

aliyekusudia juu <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo na akakaribisha ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>saidizi hodari katika vita <strong>ya</strong><br />

kupinga Roma.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza <strong>wa</strong> Swede, Olaf Petri k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong><br />

akatetea imani <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mababa <strong>ya</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukubali<strong>wa</strong> tu kama <strong>ya</strong>kipatana na Maandiko; akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba mafundisho mhimu <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani <strong>ya</strong>nayofundish<strong>wa</strong> katika Biblia k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi ili wote <strong>wa</strong>weza ku<strong>ya</strong>fahamu.<br />

Shindano hili linaonyesha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> namna gani <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> katika jeshi la<br />

Watengenezaji. Ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jinga, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kujitenga, wenye mabishano <strong>wa</strong> fujo--mbali<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ile. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza Neno la Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>liojua vizuri kutumia silaha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lizozipata k<strong>wa</strong> gala <strong>ya</strong> silaha <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. (Waliku<strong>wa</strong>) <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong><br />

tabia na sifa za Mungu na dini (Theologie), <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kamilifu <strong>wa</strong>liozoea mambo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong> injili, na <strong>wa</strong>lioshinda k<strong>wa</strong> urahisi wenye kutumia maneno <strong>ya</strong> ovyo <strong>ya</strong> uongo <strong>wa</strong> vyuo na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> Roma.”<br />

Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Swede akakubali imani <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti, na baraza la taifa likatangaza<br />

ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mfalme ndugu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>kaanza utafsiri <strong>wa</strong> Biblia<br />

nzima. Ikaagiz<strong>wa</strong> na baraza k<strong>wa</strong>mba po pote katika ufalme, <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kueleza<br />

Maandiko, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>toto katika vyuo <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kufundish<strong>wa</strong> kusoma Biblia.<br />

Walipookoka na magandamizo <strong>ya</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> taifa la Uswedi <strong>wa</strong>kafikia hali <strong>ya</strong><br />

nguvu na ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siofikia mbele. Baada <strong>ya</strong> karne moja, taifa hili ndogo na zaifu lika<strong>wa</strong> la<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza katika Ula<strong>ya</strong> lililosubutu kutoa mkono <strong>wa</strong> usaada--k<strong>wa</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> Ujermani mda<br />

<strong>wa</strong> shindano ndefu la Vita <strong>ya</strong> miaka makumi tatu. Ula<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong> Kaskazini ilionekana ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

97


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

tena chini <strong>ya</strong> ukorofi <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Swede ndiyo <strong>ya</strong>liwezesha Ujeremani kupata<br />

uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti na kurudisha uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri k<strong>wa</strong> inchi zile<br />

ambazo zilikubali Matengenezo.<br />

98


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 14. Ukweli Unaendelea Katika Uingereza<br />

Wakati Luther alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akifungua Biblia iliyofung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Ujeremamy,<br />

Tyndale akasukum<strong>wa</strong> na Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kufan<strong>ya</strong> tendo lilelile katika Uingereza. Biblia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wycliffe ilitafsiri<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Kilatini, ambamo muliku<strong>wa</strong> makosa mengi. Bei <strong>ya</strong> kurasa<br />

zilizoandik<strong>wa</strong> iliku<strong>wa</strong> juu sana na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo mta<strong>wa</strong>nyiko <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> shida.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1516, k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> likachap<strong>wa</strong> katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> asili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kigiriki. Makosa mengi <strong>ya</strong> tafsiri <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>kasahihish<strong>wa</strong>, na maana <strong>ya</strong>karudish<strong>wa</strong><br />

vizuri zaidi. Nakala zile zikaletea <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza ufahamu bora k<strong>wa</strong> kweli na zikatoa<br />

mwendo mp<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Lakini sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>likosa Neno la<br />

Mungu. Tyndale alipas<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza kazi <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe katika kutoa Biblia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> inchi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Akahubiri bila woga mambo <strong>ya</strong> hakika <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> tangazo la Papa k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni kanisa<br />

lililotoa Biblia, na ni kanisa pekee linaloweza kuieleza, Tyndale akajibu: “Kamwe<br />

haukutupatia Maandiko, ni wewe uliye<strong>ya</strong>ficha kwetu; ni wewe uliye<strong>wa</strong>choma <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>ya</strong>fundisha, na kama ungaliweza, ungalichoma Maandiko yenyewe.”<br />

Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> Tyndale <strong>ya</strong>kaamsha usikizi kub<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini mapadri <strong>wa</strong>kajitahidi kuharibu<br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Ni kitu gani kinapas<strong>wa</strong> kufany<strong>wa</strong>?” akapaza sauti. “Siwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> po pote. Ee!<br />

kama Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>ngaliku<strong>wa</strong> na Maandiko matakatifu katika lugha <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe kushindana na wenye kutumia maneno madanganyifu ha<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Bila Biblia haiwezekani kuimarisha <strong>wa</strong>tu katika kweli.”<br />

Nia mp<strong>ya</strong> ikaja katika ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Injili haitasema lugha <strong>ya</strong> Ungereza miongoni<br />

mwetu? ... Kanisa linapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na nuru ndogo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> azuhuri kuliko <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

mapambazuko <strong>ya</strong>ke? ... Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kusoma Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> katika lugha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuzali<strong>wa</strong>.” Ila tu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> Biblia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liweza kufikia ukweli.<br />

Mtaalamu mmoja <strong>wa</strong> Katoliki katika mabishano pamoja naye akapaza sauti <strong>ya</strong><br />

mshangao, “Ingeku<strong>wa</strong> vema kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na sheria za Mungu kuliko kukosa zile za Papa.”<br />

Tyndale akajibu, “Ninazarau Papa na sheria zake zote; na kama Mungu angenipatia maisha,<br />

kabla <strong>ya</strong> miaka mingi nitawezesha kijana anayeongoza jembe la kukokot<strong>wa</strong> na ngombe<br />

kufahamu Maandiko zaidi kuliko ninyi.”<br />

Tyndale Anatafsiri Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Kiingereza<br />

Alipofukuz<strong>wa</strong> nyumbani k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mateso, akaenda Londoni na huko k<strong>wa</strong> mda<br />

akatumika bila kizuizi. Lakini tena Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kamlazimisha kukimbia. Uingereza wote<br />

ukaonekana wenye kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Katika Ujeremani akaanza uchapaji <strong>wa</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> lugha <strong>ya</strong> kingereza. Alipokataz<strong>wa</strong> kuchapa katika mji moja, akaenda k<strong>wa</strong> mji<br />

mwengine. Mwishowe akasafiri kwenda Worms, ambako, miaka michache mbele, Luther<br />

99


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

alipotetea injili mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza. Katika mji ule kuliku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki wengi <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

Vitabu elfu tatu v<strong>ya</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> vikachap<strong>wa</strong>, na mchapo mwengine ukafuata.<br />

Neno la Mungu likapen<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> siri kule Londoni na kuenez<strong>wa</strong> po pote katika inchi.<br />

Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong>kajaribu kukomesha ukweli, lakini haikuwezekana. Askofu <strong>wa</strong> Durham<br />

akanunua k<strong>wa</strong> muuzavitabu akiba yote <strong>ya</strong> Mabiblia k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi la kuviharibu, kufikiri<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba jambo hili lingesimamisha kazi. Lakini mali ikatoa vyombo vilivyonunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> mchapo mp<strong>ya</strong> na bora kuliko. Wakati Tyndale alipofung<strong>wa</strong> baadaye, uhuru<br />

ukatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke isipoku<strong>wa</strong> ataje majina <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liomsaidia k<strong>wa</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>di zao k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mchapo <strong>wa</strong> Mabiblia. Akajibu k<strong>wa</strong>mba askofu <strong>wa</strong> Durham alifan<strong>ya</strong> zaidi kuliko kila mtu ye<br />

yote k<strong>wa</strong> kulipa bei kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> vitabu vilivyobaki mkononi.<br />

Mwishowe Tyndale akashuhudia imani <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong> mfia dini; lakini silaha<br />

alizozita<strong>ya</strong>risha ziliwezesha <strong>wa</strong>askari wengine kupigana katika karne nyingi, hata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati wetu.<br />

Latimer akasema juu <strong>ya</strong> mimbara k<strong>wa</strong>mba inafaa kusoma Biblia katika lugha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

“Tusichague njia zinazopingana, bali Neno la Mungu lituongoze: tusifuate ... mababu zetu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la kufuata <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liyotenda, bali <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liyopas<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong>.”<br />

Barnes na Frith, Ridley na Cranmer, <strong>wa</strong>ongozi katika Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>taalamu, <strong>wa</strong>kaheshimi<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> bidii ao k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> katika ushirika <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kiroma. Upinzani <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma uliku<strong>wa</strong> ni matokeo <strong>ya</strong> maarifa <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuvumbua makosa <strong>ya</strong> “kiti kitakatifu”.<br />

Uwezo Kamili <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko<br />

Kanuni kub<strong>wa</strong> iliyoshik<strong>wa</strong> na Watengenezaji ha<strong>wa</strong>--ni ile ile iliyoshik<strong>wa</strong> na Wavaudois,<br />

Wycliffe, Huss, Luther, Zwingli, na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>o--ni uwezo kamilifu <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko<br />

matakatifu. K<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kajaribu mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> dini yote na madai yote. Ni<br />

imani katika Neno la Mungu iliyosaidia <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>lipotoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kigingi. “Muwe <strong>wa</strong>kufarijika,” akasema Latimer k<strong>wa</strong> wenzake <strong>wa</strong>fia dini <strong>wa</strong>kati sauti zao<br />

ziliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kun<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong> na ndimi za moto, “tuta<strong>wa</strong>sha leo mshumaa, k<strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu, katika Uingereza, jinsi ninavyo tumaini hautazimika.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mamia <strong>ya</strong> miaka baada <strong>ya</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza <strong>ya</strong>lipotii mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong> Scotland (Ecosse) <strong>wa</strong>kashika uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mbili, hata hivyo,<br />

dini <strong>ya</strong> papa ikaimarish<strong>wa</strong> katika inchi, na sehemu zote zikafunik<strong>wa</strong> na giza nzito. Lakini<br />

miali <strong>ya</strong> nuru ikaja kuangazia giza hiyo. Wa Lollards, kutoka Uingereza pamoja na Biblia na<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Wycliffe, <strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> mengi k<strong>wa</strong> kulinda maarifa <strong>ya</strong> injili. K<strong>wa</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo kukaja maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Luther na Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> la Kingereza la Tyndale.<br />

Wajumbe ha<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukim<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kapitia milimani na katika mabonde, <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>sha katika<br />

maisha map<strong>ya</strong> mienge <strong>ya</strong> kweli iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuzimika na kufan<strong>ya</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> tena kazi<br />

ambayo iligandamiz<strong>wa</strong> na karne inne za mateso.<br />

100


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ndipo <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Papa, mara <strong>wa</strong>kaamsh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hatari iliyohofisha kazi <strong>ya</strong>o,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kapandisha <strong>wa</strong>toto wengi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu bora <strong>wa</strong> Scotland (Ecosse) k<strong>wa</strong> kigingi. Washahidi<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokufa po pote katika inchi <strong>wa</strong>kafurahisha roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu na kusudi isiyokufa <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuvunja minyororo za Roma.<br />

Yohana Knox<br />

Hamilton na Wishart, pamoja na mstari mrefu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>pole, <strong>wa</strong>katoa maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kigingi. Lakini kutoka kwenye tuta la kuni moto <strong>wa</strong> Wishart kukatokea mtu<br />

ambaye ndimi za moto hazikumun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha, mtu ambaye, chini <strong>ya</strong> uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kupinga onyo la mauti k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Papa katika inchi <strong>ya</strong> Scotland.<br />

John Knox akatupia mbali maagizo <strong>ya</strong> asili <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na akajilisha k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Neno<br />

la Mungu. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Wishart <strong>ya</strong>kathibitisha kusudi lake la kuachana na Roma na<br />

kujiunga mwenyewe na Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Aliposhurutish<strong>wa</strong> na wenzake kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuhubiri, akarudi anapotetemeka mbele<br />

<strong>ya</strong> madaraka kama hayo. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> tu baada <strong>ya</strong> siku za vita kali pamoja naye ndipo akakubali.<br />

Lakini alipokubali, akaendelea mbele na uhodari <strong>wa</strong> kutisha. Ujasiri huu <strong>wa</strong> mtengenezaji<br />

haukuogopa mtu. Alipolet<strong>wa</strong> uso k<strong>wa</strong> uso na malkia <strong>wa</strong> Scotland, Yohana Knox hakukubali<br />

kushind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kubembelez<strong>wa</strong>; hakutetemeka juu <strong>ya</strong> vitisho. K<strong>wa</strong>mba Malkia<br />

akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba alifundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kukubali dini iliyokataz<strong>wa</strong> na serekali, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo<br />

alivunja pia amri <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inayolazimisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kutii <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>o. Knox akajibu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ujasiri: “Kama <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> Izraeli wote <strong>wa</strong>likubali dini <strong>ya</strong> Farao ambao <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

nakuuliza, Bibilia, ni dini <strong>ya</strong> namna gani ingaliweza ku<strong>wa</strong> katika dunia? Ao kama <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote katika siku za mitume, <strong>wa</strong>ngaliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> Roma, ni dini <strong>ya</strong> namna<br />

gani ingaliku<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> dunia?”<br />

Akasema Marie: “Mnatafsiri Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> namna ingine, na (Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong> Roma)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natafsiri k<strong>wa</strong> namna ingine; nitam<strong>wa</strong>mini nani, na ni nani ataku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>mzi?”<br />

“Utam<strong>wa</strong>mini Mungu, ile inasem<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi katika Neno lake,” akajibu Mtengenezaji. ...<br />

Neno la Mungu linaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke lenyewe; na kama kukionekana giza lolote katika<br />

mahali fulani, Roho Mtakatifu, asiyeku<strong>wa</strong> na mabishano kati <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe, hueleza<br />

namna moja <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi mahali pengine.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> moyo usio na hofu Mtengenezaji shujaa, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke, akaendelea na<br />

kusudi lake, hata Scotland ikapata uhuru kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Papa.<br />

Kuimarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti kama dini <strong>ya</strong> taifa katika Uingereza kulituliza<br />

mateso lakini bila kuikomesha kabisa. Mengi katika maagizo <strong>ya</strong> Roma <strong>ya</strong>liendelea.<br />

Mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa ilikatali<strong>wa</strong>, lakini mahali tu ambapo mfalme alipe<strong>wa</strong> kiti kama kich<strong>wa</strong><br />

cha kanisa. Katika ibada <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kingali mbali na utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> injili. Uhuru <strong>wa</strong><br />

dini uliku<strong>wa</strong> haujafahamika. Ijapo matatizo <strong>ya</strong> kutisha ambayo Roma ilitumia ilipata<br />

101


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kimbilio lakini k<strong>wa</strong> shida na <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti, k<strong>wa</strong>ni haki <strong>ya</strong> kila mtu kuabudu<br />

Mungu kufuata zamiri <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe haikukubali<strong>wa</strong>. Wakaidi <strong>wa</strong>lipata mateso k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamia <strong>ya</strong> miaka.<br />

Maelfu <strong>ya</strong> Wachungaji (Pasteurs) Walifukuz<strong>wa</strong><br />

Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na saba maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>lifukuz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kakataz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuhuzuria mikutano yo yote <strong>ya</strong> dini isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> ile iliyoruhusi<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa. Ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

kimbilio la vilindi mwituni, <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>likusanyika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kumimina roho zao katika maombi (sala) na kusifu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liteseka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Gereza zilijaa, jamaa zikatengana. Lakini mateso ha<strong>ya</strong>kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuvuka bahari kwenda Amerika na hapo ndipo paliwek<strong>wa</strong> msingi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> utaalamu na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini.<br />

Ndani <strong>ya</strong> gereza kulijaa na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> makosa makub<strong>wa</strong>, John Bun<strong>ya</strong>n, akapumua<br />

he<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni na akaandika mizali <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ajabu <strong>ya</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong> msafiri kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> inchi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uharibifu kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Pilgrim’s Progress na Grace Abounding to the<br />

Chief of Sinners vimeongoza n<strong>ya</strong>yo nyingi k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> uzima.<br />

Katika siku <strong>ya</strong> giza <strong>ya</strong> kiroho Whitefield na Wesleys <strong>wa</strong>katokelea kama <strong>wa</strong>chukuzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

nuru k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Chini kanisa lililoanzish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>karudia zambini ambayo ni<br />

vigumu kutofautisha k<strong>wa</strong> ushenzi. Watu <strong>wa</strong> vyeo v<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>wa</strong>kacheka uchaji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> vyeo v<strong>ya</strong> chini <strong>wa</strong>kazamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maovu. Kanisa haliku<strong>wa</strong> na uhodari ao imani<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kusaidia maanguko <strong>ya</strong> neno la kweli.<br />

Kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> Haki k<strong>wa</strong> Imani<br />

Mafundisho makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong> imani, <strong>ya</strong>liyofundish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi na<br />

Luther, <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kusahauli<strong>wa</strong> kabisa; kanuni <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma <strong>ya</strong> kutumaini<br />

matendo mema k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wokovu <strong>ya</strong>kakamata nafasi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Whitefield na Wesleys <strong>wa</strong>wili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tafuti <strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wema <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Hii <strong>wa</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong><br />

salama k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> wema na kushika maagizo <strong>ya</strong> dini.<br />

Wakati Charles Wesley k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati moja alipopata ugonj<strong>wa</strong> na akatumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba kifo<br />

kiliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu, akauliz<strong>wa</strong>, msingi <strong>wa</strong> tumaini lake la uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele uliku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kitiu<br />

gani. Jibu lake: “Nimetumia juhudi <strong>ya</strong>ngu bora kumtumikia Mungu.” Rafiki ilionekana<br />

hakutoshele<strong>wa</strong> kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> jibu hili. Wesley akafikiri: “Nini! ... Anatamani kunin<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong><br />

juhudi <strong>ya</strong>ngu? Sina kitu kingine cha kutumainia.” Hiyo ndiyo iliku<strong>wa</strong> giza ambayo<br />

iliyoimara k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa, kugeuza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> tumaini lao pekee la wokovu--damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mkombozi aliyesulubi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wesley na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

inafikish<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zoni pia k<strong>wa</strong> maneno na matendo. K<strong>wa</strong> juhudi za kazi na maombi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> bidii <strong>ya</strong> kushinda maovu <strong>ya</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong> asili. Wakaishi maisha <strong>ya</strong> kujinyima na<br />

102


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kujishusha, <strong>wa</strong>kachunguza k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu kila mpango <strong>wa</strong>liochukua ambao ungeweza ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> kusaidia k<strong>wa</strong> kupata utakatifu ule ambao uliweza kutunza wema <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Lakini<br />

juhudi zao wenyewe hazikuweza ku<strong>wa</strong>pa uhuru kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> zambi ao kuvunja<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Mioto <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuzimika juu <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> dini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti, ilipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mwenge <strong>wa</strong> zamani uliotole<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Bohemia. Wengine miongoni m<strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kapata kimbilio katika Saxe (Saxony),<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kalinda imani <strong>ya</strong> zamani. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong> nuru ikaja k<strong>wa</strong> Wesley.<br />

Yohana na Charles <strong>wa</strong>katum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ujumbe kuenda Amerika. Katika meli kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kundi la <strong>wa</strong>Moravians. Wakakutana na zoruba kali sana, na Yohana, aka<strong>wa</strong> uso k<strong>wa</strong> uso na<br />

kifo, akajisikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba haku<strong>wa</strong> na hakikisho la amani na Mungu. Lakini Wajeremani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha utulivu na kutumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> mgeni. “Tangu zamani,” akasema,<br />

“nilichunguza umuhimu mkuu <strong>wa</strong> mwenendo (tabia) <strong>wa</strong>o. ... Waka<strong>wa</strong> sasa na bahati <strong>ya</strong><br />

kujaribu k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> huru bila mafikara <strong>ya</strong> woga pia na ile <strong>ya</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na kiburi,<br />

hasira na kulipisha kisasi. Katikati <strong>ya</strong> zaburi k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o ilianza, bahari ikapasuka, na<br />

kupasua tanga kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> vipande vipande, ikafunika merikebu, na kum<strong>wa</strong>nga kati kati <strong>ya</strong><br />

sakafu kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba kilindi kikuu kimekwisha kutumeza. Kilio cha nguvu kikaanza<br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Waingereza. Wajeremani k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kuimba. Nikauliza<br />

mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong>o baadaye,`Hamku<strong>wa</strong> na hofu? ‘ Akajibu Namshukuru Mungu, hapana.’<br />

Nikauliza, `Lakini <strong>wa</strong>ke wenu na <strong>wa</strong>toto ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na hofu?’ Akajibu k<strong>wa</strong> upole, `Sivyo;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke wetu na <strong>wa</strong>toto ha<strong>wa</strong>ogopi kufa.’”<br />

Moyo <strong>wa</strong> Wesley “K<strong>wa</strong> Jinsi Isiyo <strong>ya</strong> Ka<strong>wa</strong>ida Wati<strong>wa</strong> Joto”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke Uingereza, Wesley akafikia k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

Biblia chini <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> Moravia. K<strong>wa</strong> mkutano <strong>wa</strong> chama cha Wamoravian<br />

katika Londoni maneno <strong>ya</strong>kasom<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Luther. Namna Wesley alipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akisikiliza, imani ika<strong>wa</strong>sh<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Nilisikia moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu kuti<strong>wa</strong> joto<br />

ngeni,” akasema. “Nilisikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba nilimtumaini Kristo, Kristo pekee, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

wokovu: na tumaini likatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ngu, k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliondoa mbali zambi zangu, hata zangu,<br />

na aliniokoa kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> zambi na mauti.’‘<br />

Sasa aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba neema aliyojitahidi kupata k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> maombi na kufunga na<br />

kujinyima iliku<strong>wa</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>di, “bila mali na bila bei.” Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke yote ika<strong>wa</strong>ka na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutangaza po pote injili utukufu <strong>ya</strong> neema huru <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Nikatazama juu <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu<br />

wote kama mtaa <strong>wa</strong>ngu,” akasema; “po pote ninapoku<strong>wa</strong>, ninazania k<strong>wa</strong>mba, nina haki, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>ngu <strong>wa</strong> lazima, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotamani kusikia, habari za furaha<br />

za wokovu.”<br />

Akaendelea na maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke halisi na <strong>ya</strong> kujinyima, si sasa kama msingi, bali matokeo <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani; si shina, bali tunda la utakatifu. Neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu katika Kristo itaonekana katika<br />

103


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

utii. Maisha <strong>ya</strong> Wesley ilitole<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> kuhubiri kweli kub<strong>wa</strong> aliyo<strong>ya</strong>kubali--<br />

kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani katika damu <strong>ya</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, na uwezo mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

Roho Mtakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> moyo, kuendelea kuleta matunda katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>nayofanana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Whitefield na Wesleys <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>liit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule “Methodistes” na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

wenzao <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> -jina ambalo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu linazani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> la heshima. Roho Mtakatifu<br />

ali<strong>wa</strong>lazimisha kuhubiri Kristo na Yeye aliyesulubi<strong>wa</strong>. Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>liogeuka k<strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni lazima k<strong>wa</strong>mba kondoo hizi zilindwe kutoka mb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu wenye <strong>wa</strong>zimu.<br />

Wesley haku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo la kuanzisha dini lingine, lakini ali<strong>wa</strong>tengeneza chini <strong>ya</strong> kile<br />

kilichoit<strong>wa</strong> mwunganisho <strong>wa</strong> Methodiste.<br />

Uliku<strong>wa</strong> ushindani <strong>wa</strong> siri na taabu <strong>ya</strong> uinzani ambayo <strong>wa</strong>hubiri ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lipambana<br />

nayo k<strong>wa</strong> kuanzisha kanisa--k<strong>wa</strong>ni kweli iliku<strong>wa</strong> na mwingilio mahali milango labda<br />

ingedumu kuendelea yenye kufung<strong>wa</strong>. Wakuu wengine <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>kaamka k<strong>wa</strong> mshangao<br />

<strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong> juhudi katika mitaa <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Wesley, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> vipa<strong>wa</strong> mbalimbali ha<strong>wa</strong>kulinganisha kila sehemu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> dini. Tofauti kati <strong>ya</strong> Whitefield na Wesleys <strong>wa</strong>wili ilitisha <strong>wa</strong>kati moja<br />

kuleta fitina, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>lijifunza upole katika chuo cha Kristo, uvumilivu na<br />

upendo vika<strong>wa</strong>patanisha. Ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kubishana, <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao makosa na<br />

maovu <strong>ya</strong>lijaa pote.<br />

Wesley Anaepuka Kifo<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>katumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o kinyume chao. Wakuu wengi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha uchuki, na milango <strong>ya</strong> makanisa ikafung<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> imani safi. Padri,<br />

aki<strong>wa</strong>laumu juu <strong>ya</strong> mimbara, akachochea <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>jinga <strong>wa</strong> giza na <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Mara na mara<br />

Wesley akaepuka kifo k<strong>wa</strong> muujiza <strong>wa</strong> uhuruma <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Wakati ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

hakuna njia <strong>ya</strong> kuepuka, malaika katika umbo la kibinadamu alikuja upande <strong>wa</strong>ke na kundi<br />

lilianguka na mtumishi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo akapita katika usalama kutoka hatarini.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> matukio hayo, Wesley akasema: “Inga<strong>wa</strong> wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lijaribu kukamata ukosi <strong>wa</strong> shingo <strong>ya</strong>ngu ao mavazi, kuniangusha, ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kufunga<br />

kamwe: ila mmoja tu alishika upindo <strong>wa</strong> kisibau changu ambacho kikabaki mara mkononi<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ke; na upindo mwengine, ndani <strong>ya</strong> mfuko ambao uliku<strong>wa</strong>mo noti <strong>ya</strong> benki, ilipasuka<br />

lakini nusu <strong>ya</strong>ke. ... Mtu <strong>wa</strong> nguvu nyuma <strong>ya</strong>ngu akanipiga mara nyingi, na fimbo kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

mti <strong>wa</strong> Ula<strong>ya</strong> (che ne); ambayo kama angalinipaga mara moja tu k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> nyuma <strong>wa</strong><br />

kich<strong>wa</strong> changu, ingaliku<strong>wa</strong> ni mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ngu. Lakini kila mara, pigo likapotoka, sijui<br />

namna gani; k<strong>wa</strong>ni sikuweza kwenda kuume <strong>wa</strong>la kushoto.”<br />

Wamethodiste <strong>wa</strong> siku ile <strong>wa</strong>livumilia kicheko na mateso, mara nyingi mauaji. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati zingine, matangazo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote libandik<strong>wa</strong>, kuita <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotaka kuvunja<br />

madirisha na kun<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong> katika nyumba za Wamethodiste ili <strong>wa</strong>kusanyike k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

104


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ulitole<strong>wa</strong> na mahali. Mateso <strong>ya</strong> desturi <strong>ya</strong>kafanyika juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ambao kosa moja tu<br />

liliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kutafuta kugeuza wenye zambi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu na ku<strong>wa</strong>ingizisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> utakatifu!<br />

Uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> kiroho katika Uingereza kabla <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Wesley uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika hali<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo alifuta kanuni <strong>ya</strong> mema na maba<strong>ya</strong> na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na lazima <strong>ya</strong> kuishika. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> si<br />

lazima k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji kuon<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kutii amri zake, k<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>le ambao Mungu<br />

alio<strong>wa</strong>chagua k<strong>wa</strong> wokovu “<strong>wa</strong>taongoz<strong>wa</strong> kufuata uta<strong>wa</strong> na wema” <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liohukumi<strong>wa</strong> laana <strong>ya</strong> milele “ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kutii sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.”<br />

Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kishikilia k<strong>wa</strong>mba “<strong>wa</strong>teule ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kukosa neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>la,<br />

kun<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong> kibali cha Mungu,” <strong>wa</strong>lipofikia mwisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba “matendo maba<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nayotenda si maovu, ... na k<strong>wa</strong>mba, baadaye, ha<strong>wa</strong>na na nafasi <strong>wa</strong>la kuungama zambi<br />

zao ao ku<strong>ya</strong>acha k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> toba.” K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, <strong>wa</strong>katangaza, hata zambi moja katika zambi<br />

mba<strong>ya</strong> kuliko” zilizozani<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wote ku<strong>wa</strong> mvunjo mkub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi <strong>wa</strong> amri za Mungu<br />

kama si zambi mbele za Mungu “kama ikitend<strong>wa</strong> na mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>teule.” Ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi<br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> kitu cho chote kisicho mpendeza Mungu ao kilichokataz<strong>wa</strong> na sheria.”<br />

Mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

hakuna sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inayogeuka kama kipimo cha haki, lakini tabia hiyo ilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

chama chenyewe na mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kubadirish<strong>wa</strong>. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo ha<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>litoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke ambaye miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>sio na kosa <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni alianza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuvunja amri za haki za sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> juu<strong>ya</strong> amri za Mungu, zisizogeuka k<strong>wa</strong> kuimarisha tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu iliongoza wengi kukataa sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Wesley k<strong>wa</strong> uhodari akapinga mafundisho<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong> ambayo <strong>ya</strong>liongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kupinga amri <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, mafundisho juu <strong>ya</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> kila mtu<br />

(Predestination). “Neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inayoleta wokovu imeonekana k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote.”<br />

“Mungu Mwokozi wetu anayetaka <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>okole<strong>wa</strong> na kupata ujuzi <strong>wa</strong> kweli. K<strong>wa</strong>ni<br />

kuna Mungu mmoja, na mupatanishi katikati <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>tu ni mmoja, yule mtu ni<br />

Kristo Yesu, aliyejitoa mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> ukombozi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wote. ” Kristo “Nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli inaangazia nuru kila mtu anayekuja katika ulimwengu.’‘ Tito 2:11; 1 Timoteo 2:3-6;<br />

Yoane 1:9. Watu <strong>wa</strong>naoshind<strong>wa</strong> kupata wokovu ni <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokataa k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> uzima.<br />

Katika Utetezi <strong>wa</strong> Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

Katika kujibu madai k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kifo cha Kristo, amri kumi ziliondole<strong>wa</strong> pamoja<br />

na sheria za ka<strong>wa</strong>ida, Wesley akasema: “Sheria <strong>ya</strong> tabia, inayoku<strong>wa</strong> katika Amri Kumi na<br />

ikatili<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na manabii, hakuitosha. Hii ni sheria ambayo haiwezi kamwe kuvunj<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

ambayo `inasimama imara kama shuhuda m<strong>wa</strong>minifu mbinguni.’”<br />

105


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wesley akatangaza umoja kamilifu <strong>wa</strong> sheria na injili. “K<strong>wa</strong> upande moja sheria k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuendelea kutuongoza k<strong>wa</strong> injili, k<strong>wa</strong> ngambo ingine injili huendelea kutuwezesha kutimiza<br />

utimilifu inafan<strong>ya</strong> njia ku<strong>wa</strong> na sheria, k<strong>wa</strong> mfano, inatuamuru kumpenda Mungu, kupenda<br />

jirani wetu, ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pole, <strong>wa</strong>nyekevu ao <strong>wa</strong>takatifu. Tukijisikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba hatutoshi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mambo ha<strong>ya</strong>; ... lakini tunaona ahadi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kutupatia upendo huo, na kutufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu, <strong>wa</strong>pole, na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu: tunashika injili hii, <strong>ya</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> furaha: ... ` haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

sheria hutimilika ndani yetu; k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani inayoku<strong>wa</strong> katika Yesu Kristo. ...<br />

“Katika daraja la juu sana za maadui <strong>wa</strong> injili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo,” akasema Wesley, “ni <strong>wa</strong>le ...<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naofundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kuvunja ... si moja tu, <strong>wa</strong>la ndogo ao kub<strong>wa</strong> sana, bali amri zote k<strong>wa</strong><br />

jumla. ... Wanamheshimu kama Yuda alivyofan<strong>ya</strong> aliposema, `salamu, Rabi; akamubusu’ ...<br />

Hakuna namna ingine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kumusaliti k<strong>wa</strong> kumubusu, kuzungumza juu <strong>ya</strong> damu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke, na kun<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong> taji lake; kuweka nuru k<strong>wa</strong> kila sehemu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke, chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

ujanja <strong>wa</strong> kuendesha injili <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Umoja <strong>wa</strong> Sheria na Injili<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshurtisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba “hotuba <strong>ya</strong> injili hujibu vikomo vyote v<strong>ya</strong> sheria,”<br />

Wesley akajibu: “Wajibu <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kabisa <strong>wa</strong> sheria, <strong>ya</strong>ani, kusadikisha <strong>wa</strong>tu juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi, kuamsha <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>ngali katika usingizi k<strong>wa</strong> ukingo <strong>wa</strong> Gehena <strong>ya</strong> moto. ... Ni<br />

uwongo, basi kutoa mganga k<strong>wa</strong> wenye af<strong>ya</strong>, ao <strong>wa</strong>naojizania <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> na af<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Inafaa k<strong>wa</strong>nza ku<strong>wa</strong>sadikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ko <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong>, kama sivyo ha<strong>wa</strong>takushukuru k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong>ko. Inaku<strong>wa</strong> vilevile uwongo kunena habari <strong>ya</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao roho <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

haijavunjika.”<br />

Na katika kuhubiri injili <strong>ya</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, Wesley kama B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke, alitafuta<br />

“kutukuza sheria, na kuifanyiza ku<strong>wa</strong> na heshima.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 42:21. Matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

utukufu aliyoruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuona. K<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> juu nusu <strong>ya</strong> karne aliyotumia katika kazi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kahesabika zaidi kuliko nusu <strong>ya</strong> milioni. Lakini wengi <strong>wa</strong> roho<br />

zilizoinuli<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> upotovu <strong>wa</strong> zambi k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> juu na safi hauwezi kamwe<br />

kujulikana hata jamaa lote la <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napokusanyika katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke inaonyesha fundisho la thamani isiyohesabika k<strong>wa</strong> kila Mkristo.<br />

Ilipendeza Mungu k<strong>wa</strong>mba imani na unyenyekevu, juhudi isiyolegea, kujinyima na<br />

uchaji <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> mtumishi huyu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>pate kurudisha nuru katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong><br />

leo!<br />

106


Sababu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> Kweli<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 15. Mapinduzi <strong>ya</strong> Ufaransa<br />

Mataifa mengine <strong>ya</strong>likaribisha Matengenezo ku<strong>wa</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Katika inchi<br />

zingine nuru <strong>ya</strong> maarifa <strong>ya</strong> Biblia iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kufung<strong>wa</strong> kabisa. Katika inchi ingine<br />

kweli na uongo vikashindani<strong>ya</strong> uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi. Mwishowe ukweli <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni<br />

ukasong<strong>wa</strong>. Kiasi cha Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kikaondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liozarau za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong><br />

neema <strong>ya</strong>ke. Na ulimwengu wote ukaona matunda <strong>ya</strong> kukataa nuru k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi.<br />

Vita <strong>ya</strong> kupinga Biblia katika Ufransa ikatimilika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mapinduzi, ambayo ni<br />

matokeo halali k<strong>wa</strong> Roma kutosoma Maandiko. (Tazama Nyongezo.) Ni onyesho la ajabu<br />

sana lililoshuhudia mwisho <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma. Ufunuo ulitangaza matokeo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong>liyopas<strong>wa</strong> kuongezeka zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> Ufransa kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> “mtu <strong>wa</strong><br />

zambi”:<br />

“Na ki<strong>wa</strong>nja kilicho inje <strong>ya</strong> hekalu la Mungu, uache inje, <strong>wa</strong>la usipime k<strong>wa</strong> maana<br />

imetole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa, nao <strong>wa</strong>takan<strong>ya</strong>ga mji mutakatifu miezi makumi ine na miwili.<br />

Nami nita<strong>wa</strong>pa <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ngu <strong>wa</strong>wili nguvu, nao <strong>wa</strong>tatoa unabii siku elfu moja mia<br />

mbili makumi sita, <strong>wa</strong>mevik<strong>wa</strong> mavazi <strong>ya</strong> gunia. ... Hata <strong>wa</strong>takapomaliza ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o,<br />

yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma anayetoka katika shimo pasipo mwisho atafan<strong>ya</strong> vita nao; naye ata<strong>wa</strong>shinda na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ua. Na maiti <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>talala katika njia <strong>ya</strong> mji ule mkub<strong>wa</strong>, unaoit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kiroho Sodomo<br />

na Misri, ambapo tena B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu aliposulubi<strong>wa</strong>. ... Na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tafurahi juu <strong>ya</strong>o na kuchekelea, <strong>wa</strong>tapelekeana za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

manabii ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong>tesa <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia. Na kiisha siku tatu na nusu,<br />

Roho <strong>ya</strong> uhai inayotoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ikaingia ndani <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kasimama k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong>o; na<br />

woga mkub<strong>wa</strong> uka<strong>wa</strong>angukia <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>ona.” Ufunuo 11:2-11.<br />

“Miezi makumi ine na miwili” na siku elfu moja mia mbili na makumi sita” ni sa<strong>wa</strong><br />

sa<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao kanisa la Kristo lilipas<strong>wa</strong> kutes<strong>wa</strong> na magandamizo <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Miaka<br />

1260 ilianza katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 538 A.D. na ikamalizika k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798 AD. (Tazama<br />

Nyongezo.) K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Ufaransa likamfan<strong>ya</strong> Papa ku<strong>wa</strong> mfung<strong>wa</strong>, na akafa<br />

mbali na k<strong>wa</strong>o. Mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa ikakosa uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuimarisha uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> zamani.<br />

Mateso ha<strong>ya</strong>kudumu hata mwisho katika miaka 1260 yote. Katika huruma zake k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, Mungu akafupisha mda <strong>wa</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong>o kali k<strong>wa</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo.<br />

“Washahidi <strong>wa</strong>wili” ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Agano la Kale na Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kuu k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo na umilele <strong>wa</strong> sheria za Mungu, na pia k<strong>wa</strong> mpango <strong>wa</strong> wokovu.<br />

“Nao <strong>wa</strong>tatoa unabii siku elfu moja mia mbili makumi sita, <strong>wa</strong>mevik<strong>wa</strong> mavazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

gunia.” Wakati Biblia ilipokataz<strong>wa</strong>, ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke ukageuz<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong>; <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipojaribu kutangaza ukweli <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kasaliti<strong>wa</strong>, kutes<strong>wa</strong>, kuua<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>fia dini k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o ao kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukimbia--ndipo “<strong>wa</strong>shuhuda” <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>katabiri<br />

107


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“katika mavazi <strong>ya</strong> gunia.” Katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati za giza kabisa <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>kape<strong>wa</strong> hekima<br />

na mamlaka k<strong>wa</strong> kutangaza kweli <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

“Na kama mtu yeyote akitaka ku<strong>wa</strong>umiza, moto utatoka katika viny<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>o na kumeza<br />

adui zao. Na kama mtu yeyote akitaka ku<strong>wa</strong>umiza, anapash<strong>wa</strong> kuua<strong>wa</strong> namna hii.” Ufunuo<br />

11:5. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi bila ku<strong>wa</strong> na hofu <strong>ya</strong> kupata malipizi k<strong>wa</strong> kuzarau Neno la Mungu!<br />

“Hata <strong>wa</strong>takapomaliza ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o.” Wakati <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>lipokaribia<br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o katika giza, vita ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kufany<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o na “yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma anayetoka<br />

katika shimo pasipo mwisho.” Hapa kunaonekana onyesho mp<strong>ya</strong> la uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Shetani.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> busara <strong>ya</strong> Roma, kushuhudia heshima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, k<strong>wa</strong> kuifungisha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

lugha isiyojulikana, ikafich<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Chini <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>shahidi <strong>wa</strong>katabiri “katika<br />

mavazi <strong>ya</strong> gunia. ” Lakini ” yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma anayetoka katika shimo pasipo mwisho” alipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> na kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu.<br />

“Mji mkub<strong>wa</strong>” katika njia zake ambazo <strong>wa</strong>shahidi ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong>, na mahali<br />

maiti <strong>ya</strong>o ililala ni “k<strong>wa</strong> kiroho” ni Misri. K<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yote katika historia <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, Misri<br />

ndiyo iliyozidi kukana ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na ikapinga amri zake. Hakuna mfalme aliyeasi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ujasiri sana juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> mbingu kama mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Misri alivyofan<strong>ya</strong>, Farao:<br />

“Simjui B<strong>wa</strong>na, na vilevile sitaruhusu Israeli kwenda.” Kutoka 5:2. Hii ni kusema hakuna<br />

Mungu (atheisme), na taifa linalo<strong>wa</strong>kilisha Misri lingetaja mfano <strong>wa</strong> namna moja <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu na kuonyesha roho <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong> uasi.<br />

“Mji mkub<strong>wa</strong>” unafananish<strong>wa</strong> vile vile, “k<strong>wa</strong> kiroho,” na Sodomo. Maovu <strong>ya</strong> Sodomo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lionekana zaidi katika uasherati. Zambi hizi zilipas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> vile vile tabia <strong>ya</strong> taifa<br />

lililopasa kutimiza andiko hili.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kupatana na nabii, ndipo, mbele kidogo <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798 uwezo moja <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

uovu ukainuka k<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita na Biblia. Na katika inchi ambapo “<strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kun<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>, hapo pangeku<strong>wa</strong> onyesho la kutokujali ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> Farao na usherati <strong>wa</strong> Sodomo.<br />

Utimilizo <strong>wa</strong> Ajabu <strong>wa</strong> Unabii<br />

Unabii huu ulipata utimilizo <strong>wa</strong> ajabu katika historia <strong>ya</strong> Ufransa <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi<br />

(Revolution), katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1793. “Ufransa uliku<strong>wa</strong> ni taifa pekee katika historia <strong>ya</strong> dunia,<br />

ambayo k<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> baraza la sheria, likatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna Mungu, na ambaye<br />

wenyeji wote <strong>wa</strong> mji mkuu, na sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu popote, <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke na <strong>wa</strong>naume pia,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kacheza na kuimba k<strong>wa</strong> furaha k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali tangazo hili.”<br />

Ufransa ukaonyesha pia tabia ambazo zilipambanua Sodomo. M<strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong> historia<br />

anaonyesha pamoja kukana Mungu na uasherati <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa: “K<strong>wa</strong> uhusiano na sheria hizi<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> dini, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ile ambayo ilivunja muungano <strong>wa</strong> ndoa--maagano takatifu kuliko<br />

ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naweza kufan<strong>ya</strong>, na kudumu ni <strong>wa</strong> lazima k<strong>wa</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> jamaa--<br />

108


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ukageuz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> mapatano <strong>ya</strong> adabu <strong>ya</strong> hivi hivi tu <strong>ya</strong> mda, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>naweza kuunga na kuvunja k<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi. ... Sophie Arnoult, mtendaji <strong>wa</strong> kike <strong>wa</strong><br />

sifa k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> kuchekesha akasema, akaeleza ku<strong>wa</strong> ndoa <strong>ya</strong> serkali ni kama<br />

`sakramenti ao siri <strong>ya</strong> uzinzi.’”<br />

Uadui Juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo<br />

“Mahali pia B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu alisulibi<strong>wa</strong>.” Jambo hili vile vile lilitimilika k<strong>wa</strong> Ufransa.<br />

Hakuna inchi ambayo ukweli ulikutana na upinzani <strong>wa</strong> ukaidi kama Ufransa. Katika mateso<br />

iliyozuri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shahidi <strong>wa</strong> injili, Ufransa ulisulibisha Kristo katika mwili <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Karne k<strong>wa</strong> karne damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikim<strong>wa</strong>ngika. Huku Wa<strong>wa</strong>ldense<br />

(Vaudois) <strong>wa</strong>litoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> milima <strong>ya</strong> Piedmont (k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Yesu<br />

Kristo,” ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> namna ile ile uliochukuli<strong>wa</strong> na Albigeois <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Matengenezo <strong>wa</strong>lioua<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> ajabu. Mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>kuu, <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kizazi cha<br />

juu na <strong>wa</strong>binti <strong>wa</strong>zuri <strong>wa</strong>lishibisha macho k<strong>wa</strong> maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fia dini <strong>wa</strong> Yesu.<br />

Wahuguenots <strong>wa</strong>shujaa <strong>wa</strong>lim<strong>wa</strong>ga damu <strong>ya</strong>o pahali pa mapigano makali, kuwind<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> mwitu.<br />

Wazao <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong> Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> zamani <strong>wa</strong>liobaki k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na nane<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajificha katika milima <strong>ya</strong> Kusini, <strong>wa</strong>kalinda imani <strong>ya</strong> mababa zao. Wakatembea k<strong>wa</strong><br />

shida k<strong>wa</strong> maisha marefu <strong>ya</strong> utum<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> mashua <strong>ya</strong> vita (galères). Watu <strong>wa</strong> malezi<br />

safi sana na wenye akili <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa <strong>wa</strong>liishi katika minyororo, katika mateso maba<strong>ya</strong> sana,<br />

kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>nganyi na <strong>wa</strong>uaji. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kapig<strong>wa</strong> risasi na kuanguka katika damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

baridi <strong>wa</strong>napoanguka k<strong>wa</strong> magoti <strong>ya</strong>o katika sala. Inchi <strong>ya</strong>o, ikateketez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upanga,<br />

shoka, na k<strong>wa</strong> moto, “ikageuka ku<strong>wa</strong> jang<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong>, la giza.” “Mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> sana<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaendelea ... katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati zisizoku<strong>wa</strong> za giza bali katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>wa</strong> Louis XIV.<br />

Elimu iliongezeka, vitabu ao maarifa <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea vizuri, <strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na sifa<br />

za Mungu <strong>wa</strong> baraza <strong>ya</strong> hukumu na <strong>wa</strong> mji mkuu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenye maarifa (savants) na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>semaji, <strong>wa</strong>kavut<strong>wa</strong> na neema <strong>ya</strong> upole na upendo.”<br />

Uovu Mba<strong>ya</strong> Sana Kupita Mengine<br />

Lakini uovu mba<strong>ya</strong> zaidi miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> matendo maovu <strong>ya</strong> karne za kutisha iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

machinjo ao mauaji matakatiifu <strong>ya</strong> SaintBartheiemy. Chini <strong>ya</strong> mkazo <strong>wa</strong> mapadri na<br />

maaskofu, mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa akatoa ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke. Kengele kulia katika ukim<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> usiku,<br />

ikatoa ishara <strong>ya</strong> mauaji. Maelfu <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti, <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kilala nyumbani m<strong>wa</strong>o,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kitumaini neno la heshima la mfalme <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kakokot<strong>wa</strong> na kuua<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Machinjo <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea k<strong>wa</strong> siku saba katika Paris. K<strong>wa</strong> agizo la mfalme mauaji<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaenea k<strong>wa</strong> miji yote mahali Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Wakuu na <strong>wa</strong>kulima, <strong>wa</strong>zee na<br />

vijana, <strong>wa</strong>mama na <strong>wa</strong>toto, <strong>wa</strong>kachinj<strong>wa</strong> pamoja. Katika Ufransa po pote kuliku<strong>wa</strong> nafsi<br />

70.000 za ua la taifa <strong>wa</strong>kaua<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

109


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Wakati habari <strong>ya</strong> mauaji ilipofika Roma, furaha <strong>ya</strong> mapadri haikujua mpaka. Askofu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Lorraine akatolea mjumbe za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> mataji elfu; mzinga <strong>wa</strong> Saint-Ange mtakatifu<br />

akapiga ngurumo <strong>ya</strong> salamu za furaha; na kengele zikalia k<strong>wa</strong> minara <strong>ya</strong> makanisa yote;<br />

mioto <strong>ya</strong> furaha ikageuza usiku ku<strong>wa</strong> mchana; na Papa Gregoire XIII, pamoja na maaskofu<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>kuu wengine <strong>wa</strong> kanisa, <strong>wa</strong>kaenda k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano mrefu k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Saint-<br />

Louis, mahali askofu <strong>wa</strong> Lorraine aliimba Te Deum. ... Nishani ikapig<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kumbukumbu<br />

la machinjo. ... Padri <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa ... akasema k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>`siku ile akijaa na kicheko na<br />

furaha, <strong>wa</strong>kati baba mtakatifu alipokea habari, na akaenda k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> heshima k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kumshukuru Mungu na Mtakatifu Ludoviko.”<br />

Roho mba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna moja iliyosukuma kuua<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> SaintBarthelemy akaongoza pia<br />

katika maonyesho za Mapinduzi. Yesu Kristo akatangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama mjanja, na kilio cha<br />

makafiri <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa kika<strong>wa</strong>angamiza <strong>wa</strong>maskini,” maana <strong>ya</strong>ke Kristo. Matukano na uovu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaenda pamoja. Katika ha<strong>ya</strong> yote, ibada ilitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani, <strong>wa</strong>kati Kristo, katika tabia<br />

zake za kweli, usafi, na upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kupendelea wengine kuliko yeye mwenyewe,<br />

alisuubi<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

“Yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma anayetoka katika shimo pasipo mwisho atafan<strong>ya</strong> vita nao; naye<br />

ata<strong>wa</strong>shinda na ku<strong>wa</strong>ua.” Ufunuo 11:7. Mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kukana kumjua Mungu iliyota<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

katika Ufransa <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi na uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Hofu kuu ilipigana vita <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo<br />

kumpinga Mungu na Neno lake. Ibada <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikakomesh<strong>wa</strong> na baraza la Taifa. Vitabu<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> Biblia vikakusany<strong>wa</strong> na kuchom<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote. V<strong>ya</strong>ma v<strong>ya</strong> Biblia<br />

vikaharibi<strong>wa</strong>. Siku <strong>ya</strong> kustarehe <strong>ya</strong> juma ikakataz<strong>wa</strong>, na mahali pake kila siku kumi<br />

ikateng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makutano. Ubatizo na ushirika Mtakatifu (Meza <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na) vikakataz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Matangazo <strong>ya</strong>kawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa maziko kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba mauti ni usingizi <strong>wa</strong><br />

milele.<br />

Ibada <strong>ya</strong> dini yote ikakataz<strong>wa</strong>, ila tu ile <strong>ya</strong> uhuru na <strong>ya</strong> inchi. “Askofu <strong>wa</strong> kushika sheria<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Paris akalet<strong>wa</strong> ... k<strong>wa</strong> kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong> mapatano k<strong>wa</strong>mba dini aliyofundisha k<strong>wa</strong> miaka<br />

nyingi iliku<strong>wa</strong>, katika heshima yote, sehemu <strong>ya</strong> ujanja <strong>wa</strong> mapadri, ambayo haiku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

msingi hata katika historia ao ukweli takatifu. Katika maneno <strong>ya</strong> kutisha sana na <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi,<br />

akakana ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke Mungu ambako alijitakasa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

“Nao <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia <strong>wa</strong>tafurahi juu <strong>ya</strong>o na ku<strong>wa</strong>chekelea. Watapelekeana<br />

za<strong>wa</strong>di moja k<strong>wa</strong> wengine, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu manabii ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong>tesa <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> dunia.” Ufunuo 11:10. Ufransa kafiri ukan<strong>ya</strong>mazisha sauti yenye kulaumu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shahidi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Neno la ukweli likalala chini kama maiti” katika njia zake, na <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liochukia sheria za Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi. Watu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>kachafua Mfalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

mbinguni.<br />

Te Deum : Wimbo <strong>wa</strong> kushukuru <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kikatoliki unaoanza na maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> :<br />

‘’B<strong>wa</strong>na tunakusifu”.<br />

110


Uhodari <strong>wa</strong> Kutukana Mungu<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> “mapadri” <strong>wa</strong> agizo jip<strong>ya</strong> akasema: “Mungu, kama Unaku<strong>wa</strong>ko, lipisha<br />

kisasi cha matukano <strong>ya</strong>nayofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutukana jina iako. Ninakualika! Unakaa kim<strong>ya</strong>;<br />

Husubutu kutuma ngurumo zako. Nani baada <strong>ya</strong> hii atakayeamini ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ko tena?” Ni<br />

jibu gani hili la s<strong>wa</strong>li la Farao: “B<strong>wa</strong>na ni nani, nisikie sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke?”<br />

“Mupumbafu amesema moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ke: Hakuna Mungu.” Na B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema,<br />

“Upumbafu <strong>wa</strong>o utaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote.” Zaburi 14:1; 2 Timoteo 3:9. Wakati<br />

Ufransa ulipokataa ibada <strong>ya</strong> Mungu mwenye uhai haukukawia kushuka katika ibada <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuabudu Mungu <strong>wa</strong> kike <strong>wa</strong> Akili (kutumia akili), m<strong>wa</strong>namke msharati. Ibada hii<br />

ikaanzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> msaada <strong>wa</strong> mkutano <strong>wa</strong> taifa! Moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> sherehe <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zimu kusimama inayopita yote k<strong>wa</strong>ni upumbafu ilichanganyika na ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> heshima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Milango <strong>ya</strong> mapatano ikafunguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi. ... Washiriki <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> mji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaingia katika m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano <strong>wa</strong> taratibu, kuimba wimbo k<strong>wa</strong> sifa za uhuru, na<br />

kufuatana, kama kitu cha ibada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao, m<strong>wa</strong>namke mmoja aliyefunik<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyemwita Mungu <strong>wa</strong> Kike <strong>wa</strong> Kutumia Akili. Alipoku<strong>wa</strong> katika baraza <strong>ya</strong> hukumu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kamvua mwili wote k<strong>wa</strong> heshima, na <strong>wa</strong>kamweka upande <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong> msimamizi,<br />

ambapo alipojulikana k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida kama binti mchezaji <strong>wa</strong> mchezo <strong>wa</strong> kuigiza (opera).<br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong> Kike <strong>wa</strong> Kutumia Akili<br />

“Kusimamisha Mungu <strong>wa</strong> Kike <strong>wa</strong> Kutumia Akili kukafany<strong>wa</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> na kuig<strong>wa</strong> na taifa<br />

po pote, katika mahali ambapo <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>litaka kujionyesha wenyewe kulingana na usitawi<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi.”<br />

Wakati “mungu <strong>wa</strong> kike” alipolet<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mapatano; msemaji akamkamata k<strong>wa</strong> mkono,<br />

na akageukia makutano akasema: “Wanadamu, muache kutetemeka mbele <strong>ya</strong> ngurumo<br />

zaifu za mungu ambazo wogo wenu umezifan<strong>ya</strong>. Tangu leo msikubali tena umungu<br />

mwengine bali Kutumia Akili. Nina<strong>wa</strong>pongoatia picha <strong>ya</strong>ke bora na safi sana; kama<br />

kunapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na sanamu, mjitoe tu k<strong>wa</strong> hii. ...<br />

“Mungu <strong>wa</strong> kike alipokwisha kukumbatiana na msimamizi, akapandish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> gari<br />

tukufu kabisa, na akapelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa kub<strong>wa</strong> la Notre Dame, kupata nafasi <strong>ya</strong> Umungu.<br />

Hapo akainuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> juu, na kuabudi<strong>wa</strong> na wote <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong>ko.”<br />

Dini <strong>ya</strong> Papa alianza kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi ambayo kukana Mungu kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kukitimiza,<br />

kuharakisha Ufransa k<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu. Waandishi k<strong>wa</strong> kutaja machukizo <strong>ya</strong> Mapinduzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba mazidio ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha mfalme na kanisa.<br />

(Tazama Nyongezo.) K<strong>wa</strong> haki yote, mazidio ha<strong>ya</strong> inapas<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa.<br />

Kanisa la Papa lilipotosha mafikara <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme juu <strong>ya</strong> Matengenezo. Ujanja <strong>wa</strong> Roma<br />

ilisababisha ukali na ugandamizi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> uliotumi<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> mfalme.<br />

111


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Po pote injili ilikubali<strong>wa</strong>, mafikara <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>kaamsh<strong>wa</strong>. Wakaanza kutupa minyorori<br />

(viungo v<strong>ya</strong> pingu vilivyo<strong>wa</strong>shikilia) ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> ujinga na ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu.<br />

Wafalme <strong>wa</strong>liviona na <strong>wa</strong>katetemeka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uonevu <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Roma ikaharakisha ku<strong>wa</strong>sha vitisho v<strong>ya</strong>o v<strong>ya</strong> wivu. Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1525, Papa akasema<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Ufransa: “Huyu <strong>wa</strong>zimu shetani (Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti) hatatoshele<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchafua dini na kuiangamiza, bali mamlaka zote, cheo kikub<strong>wa</strong>, sheria, amri, na hata<br />

madaraja tena.” Tangazo la Papa likaon<strong>ya</strong> mfalme: “Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>tapindua amri yote <strong>ya</strong><br />

serkali na <strong>ya</strong> dini pia. ... Kiti cha mfalme kinaku<strong>wa</strong> hatarini kama vile mazabahu.” Roma<br />

ikafaulu kupanga Ufransa k<strong>wa</strong> kupinga Matengenezo.<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia <strong>ya</strong>ngeimarisha katika mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kanuni za haki, kiasi, na<br />

kweli, vinavyoku<strong>wa</strong> jiwe la pembeni k<strong>wa</strong> usitawi <strong>wa</strong> taifa. “Haki inainua taifa.” Maana<br />

“Kiti cha ufalme kinasimamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> haki.” Mezali 14:34; 16:12. Tazama Isa<strong>ya</strong> 32:17.<br />

Yeye anayetii sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu atazidi k<strong>wa</strong> kweli kuheshimu na kutii amri za inchi. Ufransa<br />

ulikataza Biblia. Karne k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> haki, <strong>wa</strong> ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong> elimu na matendo mema,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na imani k<strong>wa</strong> kuteseka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli, <strong>wa</strong>kaenda k<strong>wa</strong> taabu kama <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika jahazi, <strong>wa</strong>kaangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kigingi (tita), ao kuoza ndani <strong>ya</strong> pango za gereza.<br />

Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>kapata usalama katika kukimbia k<strong>wa</strong> miaka 250 baada <strong>ya</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Matengenezo.<br />

“Labda hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na kizazi cha Ufransa, k<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule mrefu ambao<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kushuhudia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> injili kukimbia mbele <strong>ya</strong> mauaji kali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zimu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tesi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o, na kuchukua akili <strong>ya</strong>o pamoja nao, vitu v<strong>ya</strong> ufundi, utendaji, na roho <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> utaratibu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutangulia <strong>wa</strong>kapita, k<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha inchi ziiizo<strong>wa</strong>patia kimbilio. ... Kama ha<strong>wa</strong> wote<br />

sasa <strong>wa</strong>liofukuza <strong>wa</strong>ngalirudi Ufransa, ingaliku<strong>wa</strong> inchi <strong>ya</strong> namna gani ... kub<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong><br />

usitawi, na <strong>ya</strong> furaha--mfano k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa--ingaliku<strong>wa</strong>! Lakini bidii isiyo <strong>ya</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong> upofu<br />

na kizazi kisichoku<strong>wa</strong> na huruma kikafukuza k<strong>wa</strong> inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke kila m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> nguvu, kila<br />

shujaa <strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> utaratibu, kila mtetezi m<strong>wa</strong>minifu <strong>wa</strong> kiti cha mfalme. ... Mwishowe<br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> taifa ukatimilika.”<br />

Matokeo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi pamoja na machafuko.<br />

Ingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> Nini<br />

Kukimbia k<strong>wa</strong> Wahuguenots,ufungufu na inchi nzima uka<strong>wa</strong> katika Ufransa. <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

usitawi k<strong>wa</strong> vi<strong>wa</strong>nda ikaanguka k<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu. ... Ikakadirish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba, k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mapinduzi, maelfu mia mbili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>maskini katika Paris <strong>wa</strong>kadai mapendo k<strong>wa</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong><br />

mfalme. Wajesuites peke <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lifaniki<strong>wa</strong> katika taifa lililoharibika.”<br />

Injili ingalileta suluhu k<strong>wa</strong> magumu hayo <strong>ya</strong>liyoshinda mapadri <strong>wa</strong>ke, mfalme, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> sheria, na mwishowe <strong>wa</strong>kaingiza taifa katika uharibifu. Lakini chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

Roma <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kapoteza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi <strong>ya</strong> kujinyima na upendo <strong>wa</strong> choyo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> mazuri <strong>ya</strong> wengine. Mtajiri haku<strong>wa</strong> na karipio k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>kugandamiza maskini;<br />

112


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

maskini ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na msaada k<strong>wa</strong> uzaifu <strong>wa</strong>o. Choyo <strong>ya</strong> mtajiri na uwezo <strong>ya</strong>kazidi<br />

kulemea. K<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi, <strong>wa</strong>tajiri <strong>wa</strong>kakosea <strong>wa</strong>maskini, na <strong>wa</strong>maskini <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>chukia<br />

matajiri.<br />

Katika majimbo mengi madaraka <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong>kazi <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> wenyeji na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kutii maagizo <strong>ya</strong> kupita kiasi. Madaraja <strong>ya</strong> katikati na <strong>ya</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong><br />

kazi <strong>wa</strong>kalipish<strong>wa</strong> kodi <strong>ya</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> serkali na <strong>wa</strong> dini. “Wakulima na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> vijiji <strong>wa</strong>liweza kutes<strong>wa</strong> na njaa, k<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong>o ha<strong>wa</strong>kujali. ... Maisha <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tumikaji <strong>wa</strong>kulima <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kazi isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho na taabu isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kitulizo; maombolezo <strong>ya</strong>o ... <strong>ya</strong>iizani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> zarau <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu. ... Mambo maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

rush<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kakubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hakika na <strong>wa</strong>amzi. ... Ya kodi, ... nusu <strong>ya</strong> feza ikaenda k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hazina <strong>ya</strong> mfalme ao <strong>ya</strong> askofu; inayobaki ikatumi<strong>wa</strong> ovyo ovyo katika anasa <strong>ya</strong> upotovu.<br />

Na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liozoofisha hivi wenzao <strong>wa</strong>kaachili<strong>wa</strong> wenyewe bila kulipa kodi na <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na haki k<strong>wa</strong> sheria ao k<strong>wa</strong> desturi, k<strong>wa</strong> maagizo yote <strong>ya</strong> serkali. ... K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

mamilioni <strong>wa</strong>lihukumi<strong>wa</strong> maisha maba<strong>ya</strong> bila tumaini.” (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> karne mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mapinduzi kiti cha ufalme kilikali<strong>wa</strong> na Louis XV,<br />

aliyetambulika naku<strong>wa</strong> mfalme mvivu, asiyejali, na <strong>wa</strong>anasa. K<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> feza <strong>ya</strong> serkali<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na matatizo na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kakasirish<strong>wa</strong>, haikuhitaji<strong>wa</strong> jicho la nabii kuona maasi<br />

makali. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> vigumu kuharakisha hoja <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Ajali iliyongojea<br />

Ufransa ilielez<strong>wa</strong> katika jibu la kujipenda ama choyo cha mfalme, “Baada <strong>ya</strong>ngu, garika!”<br />

Roma ilivuta <strong>wa</strong>falme na vyeo v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la kuweka <strong>wa</strong>tu katika utum<strong>wa</strong>, kukusudia<br />

kufunga wote <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na <strong>wa</strong>tu katika vifungo v<strong>ya</strong>ke v<strong>ya</strong> minyororo juu <strong>ya</strong> roho zao. Huku<br />

hali mba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> tabia njema ambayo ni matokeo <strong>ya</strong> siasa hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kutisha zaidi mara<br />

elfu kuliko mateso <strong>ya</strong> kimwili. Kukosa Biblia, na kujitia katika kujipendeza, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajifunika katika ujinga na kuzama katika maovu, kabisa ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kujita<strong>wa</strong>la.<br />

Matokeo Yaliyopat<strong>wa</strong> katika Damu<br />

Baadala <strong>ya</strong> kudumisha <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi katika utii <strong>wa</strong> upofu k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke, kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Roma ikaishia katika ku<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> makafiri na <strong>wa</strong>pinduzi. Dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kaizarau kama<br />

ujanja <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>padri. Mungu mmoja <strong>wa</strong>liomujua ni mungu <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Waliangalia tamaa <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

na ukatili kama tunda la Biblia, na ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka tena kusikia habari <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Roma ilieleza viba<strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, na sasa <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kakataa vyote viwili Biblia na<br />

Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke. Katika urejeo, Voltaire na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kakataa kabisa Neno la Mungu<br />

yote pamoja kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> kukana Mungu. Roma ikakan<strong>ya</strong>ga <strong>wa</strong>tu chini <strong>ya</strong> kisigino chake cha<br />

chuma; na sasa <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>wa</strong>katupia mbali kuzui<strong>wa</strong> kote (amri). Walipokasirish<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kakataa kweli na uongo pamoja.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi, k<strong>wa</strong> ukubali <strong>wa</strong> mfalme, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kapata k<strong>wa</strong> mitaa<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida mfano <strong>wa</strong> juu kuliko ule <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu na mapadri pamoja. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo kipimo cha<br />

uwezo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> katika mikono <strong>ya</strong>o; lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuta<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> kukitumia k<strong>wa</strong> hekima na<br />

113


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

utaratibu (kiasi). Watu <strong>wa</strong>liotende<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kulipiza kisasi <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe.<br />

Walioone<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katumia fundisho <strong>wa</strong>lilojifunza chini <strong>ya</strong> uonevu na <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>tesa.<br />

Ufransa ukavuna katika damu mavuno <strong>ya</strong> utii <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Roma. Mahali Ufransa, chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kanisa la Roma, uliweka tita (kigingi) la k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo, hapo<br />

Mapinduzi <strong>ya</strong>kaweka mashini <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kukata <strong>wa</strong>tu vich<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Ni mahali pale<br />

ambapo, k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na sita, <strong>wa</strong>fia dini <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lichom<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>likat<strong>wa</strong> vich<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mnani. Wakati amri<br />

za sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ziliwek<strong>wa</strong> pembeni, taifa likaingia katika giza na machafuko <strong>ya</strong> mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la. Vita juu <strong>ya</strong> Biblia katika historia <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu ikajulikana k<strong>wa</strong> jina la Uta<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

<strong>wa</strong> hofu kuu. Yeye aliyeshinda leo akahukumi<strong>wa</strong> kesho <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Mfalme, <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini, na <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong>kalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kujiweka chini <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye <strong>wa</strong>zimu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioamuru kifo cha mfalme mara <strong>wa</strong>kamfuata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

juk<strong>wa</strong>a. Machinjo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>liozani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na uchuki k<strong>wa</strong> Mapinduzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kakusudi<strong>wa</strong>. Ufransa uka<strong>wa</strong> shamba kub<strong>wa</strong> la mabishano, <strong>ya</strong>liyo<strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong><strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hasira<br />

kali <strong>ya</strong> tamaa. “Katika Paris,fujo ikafuata fujo ingine, na <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>kajitenga katika<br />

machafuko <strong>ya</strong> fitina, <strong>ya</strong>liyoonekana yenye bidii si k<strong>wa</strong> kitu kingine bali kusudi moja. ...<br />

Inchi iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kushind<strong>wa</strong>, majeshi <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kifan<strong>ya</strong> fujo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> deni <strong>ya</strong><br />

malipo, <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> Paris <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na njaa, mitaa ikaangamiz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>nganyi, na<br />

utamaduni na maendeleo viliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kukomesh<strong>wa</strong> katika machafuko <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

uta<strong>wa</strong>la na upotovu.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> yote ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> ukali na mateso ambayo Roma<br />

ilifundisha k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu sana. Haiku<strong>wa</strong> sasa <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong>liokokot<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kigingi.<br />

Ni Zamani <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ao kuchinj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>la kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kujihamisha. “Damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>padri<br />

ilitiririka juu <strong>ya</strong> majuk<strong>wa</strong>a. Majahazi na gereza, zamani ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikijaa na Wahuguenots,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kajaa sasa na <strong>wa</strong>tesi <strong>wa</strong>o. Wakafungi<strong>wa</strong> na minyororo k<strong>wa</strong> viti v<strong>ya</strong>o na kukokota k<strong>wa</strong><br />

gasia, <strong>wa</strong>padri <strong>wa</strong> Katoliki <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kajua misiba ile yote ambayo kanisa lao lilipatisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> bure kabisa juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zushi <strong>wa</strong>pole.” (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

“Ndipo siku zile zikaja ... <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>pelelezi <strong>wa</strong>lijificha k<strong>wa</strong> kila pembe; <strong>wa</strong>kati mashine<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kukatia vich<strong>wa</strong> iliku<strong>wa</strong> ndefu na <strong>ya</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi kila asubuhi: <strong>wa</strong>kati magereza<br />

zikijaa kama ki<strong>wa</strong>nja kama chumba cha chini cha merikebu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>; <strong>wa</strong>kati damu na<br />

uchafu vika<strong>wa</strong> kama pofu na kutiririka katika mifereji <strong>ya</strong> mabati hata mto seine” ... mistari<br />

mirefu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lisukum<strong>wa</strong> chini k<strong>wa</strong> marisaa makub<strong>wa</strong>. Matundu <strong>ya</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

upande <strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>wa</strong> mashua kub<strong>wa</strong> iliosongana. ... Hesabu <strong>ya</strong> vijana <strong>wa</strong>naume na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> miaka kumi na saba <strong>wa</strong>liua<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> serekali ile mba<strong>ya</strong> sana, inajulikana ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamia. Watoto <strong>wa</strong>changa <strong>wa</strong>lioteng<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kifua cha mama <strong>wa</strong>karush<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mkuki na k<strong>wa</strong> mkuki mwengine k<strong>wa</strong> cheo cha <strong>wa</strong> Jacobins.” (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

114


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ha<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ni mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Amri <strong>ya</strong>ke ni madanganyo na makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

ni kuleta uharibifu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, kutia ha<strong>ya</strong> kiumbe cha Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu kusudi la<br />

Mungu la upendo, na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo kuleta sikitiko mbinguni. Basi k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ufundi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, huongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutupa laumu juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba mateso ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

yote <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> shauri la Muumba. Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liona dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

danganyifu, aka<strong>wa</strong>shurutisha kuzania dini yote kama danganyifu na Biblia kama hadisi<br />

(uongo).<br />

Kosa la Hatari<br />

Kosa la mauti ambalo lilileta msiba <strong>wa</strong> namna hiyo k<strong>wa</strong> Ufransa liliku<strong>wa</strong> kuitokujali<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli huu mmoja mkub<strong>wa</strong>; uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kweli unaoku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong> makatazo <strong>ya</strong> sheria<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Laiti ungalisikiliza maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ngu! Ndipo salama <strong>ya</strong>ko ingaliku<strong>wa</strong> kama mto,<br />

na haki <strong>ya</strong>ko kama mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> bahari.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 48:18. Wale ambao ha<strong>wa</strong>tasoma fundisho<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Kitabu cha Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naalik<strong>wa</strong> kulisoma katika historia.<br />

Wakati Shetani alitenda k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kuacha utii, kazi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ikageuka.. K<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kazui<strong>wa</strong> kufikia matumizi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o kamili. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>kutafuta matokeo k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong>ke na kuvumbua asili <strong>ya</strong> taabu<br />

zao. Lakini katika mapinduzi sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliwek<strong>wa</strong> kando k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi na Baraza la Taifa.<br />

Na katika Uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Hofu Kuu uliofuata, kazi na matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liweza kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> wote.<br />

Kuvunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> haki na nzuri matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke inapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> maangamizi. Roho <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong> kiasi, ambaye analazimisha uaguzi juu <strong>ya</strong> uwezo mkali <strong>wa</strong> Shetani, uliotoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kiasi kikub<strong>wa</strong>, na yule ambaye furaha <strong>ya</strong>ke ni taabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu aliruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liochagua uasi <strong>wa</strong>liachi<strong>wa</strong> kuvuna matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke. Inchi ikajaa na zambi.<br />

Kutoka mitaa iliyoteketez<strong>wa</strong> na miji iliyoangamiz<strong>wa</strong> kilio, cha kutisha kilisiki<strong>wa</strong> cha<br />

maumivu makali. Ufransa ukatikisish<strong>wa</strong> kama k<strong>wa</strong> tetemeko. Dini, sheria, kanuni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wote, jamaa, serkali, na kanisa--vyote vikashind<strong>wa</strong> na mkono mpotovu ambao uliinuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupinga sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Washuhuda <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>liochinj<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> yule “anayotoka<br />

katika shimo pasipo mwisho,” ha<strong>wa</strong>kubakia kim<strong>ya</strong>.” Na nyuma <strong>ya</strong> siku tatu na nusu, roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uhai ikatoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ikaingia ndani <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kasimama juu <strong>ya</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong>o; woga<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> ukaangukia <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>tazama.” Ufunuo 11:11. Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1793<br />

Baraza la Taifa la Ufransa likaweka amri za kutenga Biblia kando. Miaka mitatu na nusu<br />

baadaye, shauri la kutangua amri hizi likakubali<strong>wa</strong> na mkutano ule ule. Watu <strong>wa</strong>katambua<br />

lazima <strong>ya</strong> imani katika Mungu na Neno lake kama msingi <strong>wa</strong> uwezo na maarifa <strong>ya</strong> wema na<br />

uba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>wili” (Maagano <strong>ya</strong> Kale na Jip<strong>ya</strong>) nabii akatangaza zaidi:<br />

“Wakasikia sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> kutoka mbingu ikisema k<strong>wa</strong>o: Pandeni hata hapa. Wakapanda<br />

mbinguni katika wingu, adui zao <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>tazama.” Ufunuo 11:12. “Washahidi ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>wili<br />

115


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu” <strong>wa</strong>kaheshimi<strong>wa</strong> zaidi kuliko mbele. Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1804 Chama cha Biblia cha<br />

Uingereza na inchi za kigeni kikatengenez<strong>wa</strong>, kikafuat<strong>wa</strong> na matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> namna hii juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> bara la Ula<strong>ya</strong>. Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1816 chama cha Biblia cha Waamarica kikaimarish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Biblia ikatafsiri<strong>wa</strong> tangu hapo katika mamia mengi <strong>ya</strong> lugha na matamko. (Tazama<br />

Nyongezo).<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1792, uangalifu kidogo ukatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liopasha kwenda<br />

kufundisha na inchi za kigeni. Lakini karibu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mnane<br />

mabadiliko kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kafanyika. Watu <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>toshelewi na kufuata akili za binadamu<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>kapat<strong>wa</strong> na lazima <strong>ya</strong> ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> kimungu na dini <strong>ya</strong> hakika. Tokea <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

huu kazi za ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kigeni zikapata maendeleo kuliko mbele. (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

Maendeleo katika ufundi <strong>wa</strong> uchapishaji ulisaidia sana k<strong>wa</strong> maenezi <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. Kupotea<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> upendeleo usio na haki <strong>wa</strong> zamani na ubaguzi <strong>wa</strong> taifa na mwisho <strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwengu, askofu <strong>wa</strong> Roma kukafungua njia k<strong>wa</strong> mwingilio <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu. Sasa<br />

Biblia ikachukuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kila sehemu <strong>ya</strong> dunia.<br />

Kafiri Voltaire akasema: “Nachoka kusikia kukariri k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu kumi na mbili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lianzisha dini <strong>ya</strong> kikristo.” Nita<strong>wa</strong>onyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu mmoja anatosha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuiangamiza” (N.B Missine,sentence). Mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga katika vita juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Biblia. Lakini ni mbali k<strong>wa</strong> kuiangamiza. Mahali paliku<strong>wa</strong> mia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Voltaire,<br />

sasa panaku<strong>wa</strong> vitabu ama nakala mamia <strong>ya</strong> maelfu <strong>ya</strong> Kitabu cha Mungu. Katika maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mtengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo, “Biblia ni chuma cha mfin<strong>ya</strong>nzi iliyomaliza nyundo nyingi.”<br />

Chochote kitu kilichojeng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> mtu kitaangush<strong>wa</strong>; lakini kile ambacho<br />

kilijeng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu, kitasimama milele<br />

116


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 16. Kutafuta Uhuru Katika Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

Ijapo mamlaka na imani <strong>ya</strong> Roma mambo <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>likatali<strong>wa</strong>, kanuni nyingi ziliingiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika ibada <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Uingereza. Ilidai<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong>siyokataz<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

Maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na uovu <strong>wa</strong> hatari. K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>ya</strong>shika kunafaa k<strong>wa</strong> kupunguza shimo<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> ambalo lilitenga makanisa <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo na Roma, na ilishurtish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngesaidia Wakatoliki kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti.<br />

Kundi lingine halikuamua vile. Waliangalia desturi hizi kama dalili <strong>ya</strong> utum<strong>wa</strong> ambao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likombole<strong>wa</strong>. Walifikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu katika Neno lake ameimarisha maagizo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuta<strong>wa</strong>la ibada <strong>ya</strong>ke, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>na uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kuongeza k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> ao kutosha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>. Roma ikaanza kulazimisha <strong>ya</strong>le Mungu hakukataza,na ikaishia kukataza <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

aliyo amuru <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaangalia desturi za Kanisa la Kiingereza kama nguzo za ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> ibada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> sanamu, na ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kujiunga k<strong>wa</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini Kanisa lilisaidi<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> serkali, haingeruhusu mafarakano. Mikutano isiyoruhusi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ibada ilikataz<strong>wa</strong><br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> malipizi <strong>ya</strong> kufung<strong>wa</strong>, kuhamish<strong>wa</strong> ao mauti.<br />

Kuwind<strong>wa</strong>, kutes<strong>wa</strong>, na kufung<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lioishi maisha safi <strong>ya</strong> unyofu ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza<br />

kutambua ahadi <strong>ya</strong> siku bora. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kutafuta kimbilio katika Uhollande,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasaliti<strong>wa</strong> katika mikono <strong>ya</strong> adui zao. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kavumilia k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu na mwishowe<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kashinda, na <strong>wa</strong>kapata kimbilio katika p<strong>wa</strong>ni za urafiki.<br />

Waliacha nyumba zao na mali <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> uchumi. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>geni katika inchi <strong>ya</strong> kigeni,<br />

kurudia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi mp<strong>ya</strong> ili <strong>wa</strong>pate mkate <strong>wa</strong>o. Lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kupoteza <strong>wa</strong>kati k<strong>wa</strong> uvivu ao<br />

kusikitika. Walimshukuru Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mibaraka <strong>wa</strong>liyopata na <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na furaha<br />

katika ushirika <strong>wa</strong> kiroho <strong>wa</strong> raha ambao haukusumbulu<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mungu akageuza matokeo<br />

Wakati mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulionekana uki<strong>wa</strong>shota kuvuka bahari kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> inchi<br />

ambayo <strong>wa</strong>naweza kupata inchi na kuachia <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o uriti <strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini, <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea<br />

katika njia <strong>ya</strong> maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mateso na kujihamisha viliku<strong>wa</strong> vikifungua njia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uhuru.<br />

Wakati mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>lipolazimish<strong>wa</strong> kujitenga kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Kiingereza,<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>lioishi maisha safi <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga <strong>wa</strong>owenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> maagano kama <strong>wa</strong>tu huru <strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na “k<strong>wa</strong> kutembea pamoja katika njia zake zote zilizojulish<strong>wa</strong> ao zinazopas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujulish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o.” Hapa ndipo paliku<strong>wa</strong> na kanuni <strong>ya</strong> maana sana <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kusudi hili Wasafiri <strong>wa</strong>katoka Uholandi kutafuta makao katika Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong>. Yohana<br />

Robinson, mchungaji <strong>wa</strong>o, katika hotuba <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kuaga kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> mahamisho akasema:<br />

117


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Na<strong>wa</strong>agiza mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na malaika <strong>wa</strong>ke wenye kubariki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba munifuate si<br />

mbali kama nilivyomfuata Kristo. Kama Mungu angepash<strong>wa</strong> kufunua kitu cho chote kwenu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> chombo kingine chake, muwe ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kukikubali k<strong>wa</strong> furaha mliyoku<strong>wa</strong> nayo kukubali<br />

ukweli <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong> kuhubiri; k<strong>wa</strong> maana ninaku<strong>wa</strong> na tumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

anaku<strong>wa</strong> na ukweli zaidi na nuru kuangazia <strong>ya</strong> neno lake takatifu.”<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ngu mimi, siwezi kusikitikia <strong>ya</strong> kutosha hali <strong>ya</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong><br />

matengenezo, ambayo ...haitaenda sasa mbali zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>simamizi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong><br />

matengenezo. Haiwezekani kuvuta <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Luther kufan<strong>ya</strong> hatua moja zaidi mbali<br />

kuliko Luther alivyoona; ... na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> Calvin, muna<strong>wa</strong>ona <strong>wa</strong>nabakia pale<br />

ambapo mutu mkuu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ali<strong>wa</strong>acha, ambaye hata hivyo hakuona mambo yote. ...<br />

Ijapo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> taa za ku<strong>wa</strong>ka na kuangaza katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>o, lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua shauri lote<br />

la Mungu, lakini kama <strong>wa</strong>ngaliishi leo, <strong>wa</strong>ngekubali nuru mp<strong>ya</strong> zaidi kama ile <strong>wa</strong>liyokubali<br />

mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza.”<br />

“Kumbukeni ahadi yenu na agano pamoja na Mungu na pamoja na mtu k<strong>wa</strong> mwenzake,<br />

kukubali nuru yo yote na ukweli utakaojulish<strong>wa</strong> kwenu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> neno lake lililoandik<strong>wa</strong>;<br />

lakini zaidi, mjihazari, na<strong>wa</strong>sihi, kuhusu mnayokubali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli, na kuilinganisha<br />

na kupima uzito <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko mengine <strong>ya</strong> ukweli mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuikubali; k<strong>wa</strong>ni<br />

haiwezekani k<strong>wa</strong> dunia la Kikristo ambayo ilitoka giza nzito k<strong>wa</strong> kuchele<strong>wa</strong> ifikie maarifa<br />

kamili mara moja.”<br />

Haja <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri ikaongoza Wasafiri kuvuka bahari, kuvumukia magumu <strong>ya</strong><br />

jang<strong>wa</strong>ni, na kuweka msingi <strong>wa</strong> taifa kub<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini Wasafiri ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu bado kanuni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini. Uhuru ambao <strong>wa</strong>lijitolea kafara sana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe, ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kuutolea wengine. Mafundisho ambayo Mungu alitolea Kanisa haki <strong>ya</strong> kuongoza<br />

zamiri na kuleza <strong>wa</strong>zi na kuazibu uzushi ni moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> makosa makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la<br />

Roma. Watengenezaji ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na uhuru kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> Roma <strong>ya</strong> kutovumilia. Giza<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> sana ambayo Roma ilifunika Kanisa la Kikristo haikuondole<strong>wa</strong> kabisa.<br />

Kanisa la serkali lilitengenez<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>gandamizi, <strong>wa</strong>amuzi <strong>wa</strong>lioruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kukomesha<br />

uzushi. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo uwezo <strong>wa</strong> serkali uliku<strong>wa</strong> mikononi m<strong>wa</strong> Kanisa. Mipango hii haikuleta<br />

matokeo mengine isipoku<strong>wa</strong> mateso.<br />

Roger Williams<br />

Kama vile Wasafiri <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, Roger Williams akaja k<strong>wa</strong> Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong> kufurahia uhuru<br />

<strong>wa</strong> dini. Lakini aliufahamu k<strong>wa</strong> namna ingine si kama Wasafiri, akaona mambo ambayo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>chache tu <strong>wa</strong>liona, k<strong>wa</strong>mba uhuru huu ulipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote.<br />

Aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtafuti (atafutaye) <strong>wa</strong> bidii <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Williams aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza katika<br />

Ukristo <strong>wa</strong> kisasa k<strong>wa</strong> kuanzisha serkali inayosimamia k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong><br />

zamiri.” “Watu ao <strong>wa</strong>amuzi <strong>wa</strong>naweza kukata shauri,” akasema, “ni nini inastahili kati <strong>ya</strong><br />

mtu na mtu; lakini <strong>wa</strong>napojaribu kufafanua <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, hapa <strong>wa</strong>naachana<br />

118


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

na Mungu, na hapo hapawezi ku<strong>wa</strong> na salama; k<strong>wa</strong>ni ni <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama m<strong>wa</strong>muzi<br />

anaku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo, angeweza kuamuru shauri fulani ao imani leo na ingine kesho; kama<br />

ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> ikifanyika katika Uingereza na <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> kuachana na <strong>wa</strong>malkia, na mapapa<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuachana na mabaraza katika Kanisa la Roma.”<br />

Kuhuzuria katika kanisa lililosimamish<strong>wa</strong> ililazimish<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> malipo ao kifungo.<br />

“Kushurutisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kuungana pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kuachana, yeye (Williams)<br />

aliangalia jambo hilo kama kutendea zambi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> haki zao halisi, kukokota <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>sio ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> dini k<strong>wa</strong> ibada na <strong>wa</strong>siopenda, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kukuza unafiki... Hakuna mutu<br />

alipash<strong>wa</strong> kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu, ao, akaongeza, kushikilia ibada, kinyume cha<br />

ukubali <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe!”<br />

Roger Williams aliheshimi<strong>wa</strong>, lakini haja <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini haukuweza<br />

kuvumili<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> kuepuka kufung<strong>wa</strong> akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukimbilia kati kati <strong>ya</strong> baridi ng<br />

zoruba <strong>ya</strong> majira <strong>ya</strong> baridi katika poli usiokat<strong>wa</strong> bado.<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> majuma kumi na inne,” akasema, “Nikarush<strong>wa</strong> sana katika majira <strong>ya</strong><br />

uchungu, bila ku<strong>wa</strong> na mkate ao kitanda.” Lakini “Kunguru <strong>wa</strong>kanilisha jang<strong>wa</strong>ni,” shimo<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> mti nikaitumia mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara ku<strong>wa</strong> ficho.” Akaendelea na ukimbizi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong><br />

uchungu katika theluji na mwitu usio na njia hata akapata kimbilio pamoja na kabila la<br />

Wahindi ambao aliopata matumaini na upendo <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Akaweka msingi <strong>wa</strong> jimbo la k<strong>wa</strong>nza la n<strong>ya</strong>kati za kisasa lile lililo tambua haki<br />

“k<strong>wa</strong>mba kila mutu alipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na uhuru k<strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu kufuatana na nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

zamiri <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe.” Jimbo lake ndogo, Kisi<strong>wa</strong> cha Rhode, likaongezeka na kusitawi<br />

hata k<strong>wa</strong> kanuni zake za msingi--uhuru <strong>wa</strong> serekali na <strong>wa</strong> dini--vika<strong>wa</strong> mawe <strong>ya</strong> pembeni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Jamuhuri <strong>ya</strong> Amerika.<br />

Barua <strong>ya</strong> maagano <strong>wa</strong> Uhuru<br />

Tangazo la Amerika la Uhuru likatangaz<strong>wa</strong>: “Tunashika kweli hizi ku<strong>wa</strong> zamiri binafsi,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>liumb<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong>; na k<strong>wa</strong>mba Muumba ali<strong>wa</strong>pa haki fulani<br />

zisizoondole<strong>wa</strong>; ambazo katika hizo kuna uzima, uhuru, na kutafuta furaha.” Serkali (<strong>ya</strong><br />

Amerika) iliahidi heshima <strong>ya</strong> zamiri: “Baraza kuu halitaweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> sheria hata moja<br />

inayosimamia k<strong>wa</strong> dini, ao inayokataza uhuru <strong>wa</strong> dini.”<br />

“Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> Serkali <strong>wa</strong>katambua kanuni <strong>ya</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong>mba uhusiano <strong>wa</strong> mtu na<br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ke unaku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> binadamu, na haki zake za zamiri <strong>ya</strong> daima... Ni<br />

kanuni <strong>ya</strong>kuli<strong>wa</strong> ambayo hakuna kitu kitakacho weza kuiondoa.”<br />

Habari ikaenez<strong>wa</strong> katika Ula<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuna inchi ambapo kila mtu anaweza<br />

kufurahi<strong>wa</strong> matunda <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke na kutii zamiri <strong>ya</strong>ke. Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>kasongana k<strong>wa</strong> pande za<br />

p<strong>wa</strong>ni za Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong>. Katika miaka makumi mbili kutoka siku <strong>ya</strong> kufika mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

huko Plymouth (1620), jinsi maelfu mengi <strong>ya</strong> Wasafiri <strong>wa</strong>likaa katika Uingereza Mp<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

119


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuomba kitu k<strong>wa</strong> inchi bali za<strong>wa</strong>di za kweli za kazi <strong>ya</strong>o... Waliishi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong> jang<strong>wa</strong>ni, <strong>wa</strong>kanyunyizia maji <strong>ya</strong> mti <strong>wa</strong> uhuru k<strong>wa</strong> machozi <strong>ya</strong>o, na<br />

jasho <strong>ya</strong> vipaji v<strong>ya</strong> nyuso zao, hata ukatia mizizi <strong>ya</strong>ke chini sana katika inchi.”<br />

Ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> kweli Kabisa <strong>wa</strong> Ukuu <strong>wa</strong> Taifa<br />

Kanuni za Biblia ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikifundish<strong>wa</strong> katika jamaa, chuoni, na kanisani; matunda<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lionekana katika uangallifu <strong>wa</strong> kutumia feza, akili, usafi, na kiasi. Mtu mmoja<br />

angeweza k<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> miaka “bila kuona mlevi, ao kusikia kiapo, <strong>wa</strong>la kukutana na<br />

muombaji.” Kanuni za Biblia ndizo kingo ao <strong>wa</strong>linzi <strong>wa</strong> kweli kabisa <strong>wa</strong> ukuu <strong>wa</strong> taifa.<br />

Inchi zaifu zilizoku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> inchi ingine (colony) zilifaniki<strong>wa</strong> na ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

majimbo yenye uwezo, na dunia ikaona usitawi <strong>wa</strong> “kanisa bila Papa, na serkali bila<br />

mfalme.”<br />

Lakini hesabu iliongezeka <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liovut<strong>wa</strong> na Amerika k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi tofauti na<br />

Wasafiri <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Hesabu iliyoongezeka ni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotafuta tu faida <strong>ya</strong> kidunia.<br />

Mab<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>karuhusu <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa tu k<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua ao kuongoza kazi<br />

katika Serkali.<br />

Mpango huu ulikubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kulinda usafi <strong>wa</strong> Serkali; ukaleta matokeo <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga na kanisa bila badiliko la moyo. Hata katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> injili<br />

kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jinga <strong>wa</strong> uwezo mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu. Tangu siku za<br />

Constantine hata <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, kujaribu kujenga kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> usaada <strong>wa</strong> serkali, ambapo<br />

inaweza kuonekana kuleta ulimwengu karibu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, k<strong>wa</strong> kweli huleta kanisa karibu <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu.<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Protestanti <strong>ya</strong> Amerika, na <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> Ula<strong>ya</strong> pia, <strong>ya</strong>kashind<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea<br />

mbele katika njia <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo. Wengi, kama Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong> siku za Kristo ao <strong>wa</strong>katoliki<br />

katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Luther, <strong>wa</strong>lirizika kuamini kama mababa zao <strong>wa</strong>livyoamini. Makosa na<br />

ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu vilishik<strong>wa</strong>. Matengenezo polepole <strong>ya</strong>kafa, hata kuka<strong>wa</strong> haja kub<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

<strong>ya</strong> matengenezo katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti hata katika kanisa la kiRoma <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

Luther. Hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> heshima <strong>ya</strong> namna moja k<strong>wa</strong> maoni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na kutia mafikara <strong>ya</strong><br />

binadamu k<strong>wa</strong> nafsi <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kaacha kutafuta Maandiko na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kutunza mafundisho ambayo haiku<strong>wa</strong> na msingi katika Biblia.<br />

Kiburi na upotovu (ujinga) <strong>ya</strong>kalind<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> umbo la dini, na makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kaharibika.<br />

Mambo <strong>ya</strong> asili ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kipata mizizi <strong>ya</strong><br />

nguvu. Kanisa liliku<strong>wa</strong> likishika mambo <strong>ya</strong> asili ha<strong>ya</strong> baadala <strong>ya</strong> kushindana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

“imani ambayo iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu.”<br />

Ndiyo namna kanuni ziliunguz<strong>wa</strong> heshima (aibish<strong>wa</strong>) ambazo Watengenezaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lizotesekea sana.<br />

120


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 17. Ahadi za Kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

Ahadi <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili ili kutimiza kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi ni msingi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko matakatifu. Tangu Edeni, <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>wa</strong>mengojea kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yule<br />

Aliyeahidi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>leta tena k<strong>wa</strong> Paradiso iliyopotea.<br />

Enoki, mtu <strong>wa</strong> saba katika uzao kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao <strong>wa</strong>liokaa katika Edeni, ambaye<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> karne tatu alitembea pamoja na Mungu, akatangaza, “Angalia, B<strong>wa</strong>na anakuja na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>ke, elfu kumi, ill afanye hukumu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote,” Yuda 14,15. Yobu katika<br />

usiku <strong>wa</strong> taabu akapaaza sauti, “Lakini ninajua <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong>ngu ni hai, Na <strong>ya</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> katika siku za mwisho atasimama juu <strong>ya</strong> inchi:... pasipo mwili <strong>wa</strong>ngu nitamuona<br />

Mungu: Na mimi mwenyewe nitamuona. Na macho <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong>tamutazama, <strong>wa</strong>la si<br />

mwingine.” Yoba 19:25-27. Washairi (poets) na manabii <strong>wa</strong> Biblia <strong>wa</strong>lieleza sana juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika maneno yenye m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza <strong>wa</strong> moto. “Mbingu zifurahi, na inchi<br />

ishangilie, ... Mbele <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, k<strong>wa</strong> maana anakuja; K<strong>wa</strong> maana anakuja kuhukumu inchi.<br />

Atahukumu ulimwengu k<strong>wa</strong> haki, na mataifa k<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Zaburi 96:11-13.<br />

Akasema Isa<strong>ya</strong>: “Katika siku ile itasem<strong>wa</strong>, Tazama, huyu ndiye Mungu wetu,<br />

Tumemungoja, ... Tutashangilia na tutafurahi katika wokovu <strong>wa</strong>ke.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 25:9. Mwokozi<br />

akafariji <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke na tumaini <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> atakuja tena: “Katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ngu<br />

ni makao mengi ... ninakwenda, ku<strong>wa</strong>tengenezea ninyi makao. Na kama ninakwenda, ...<br />

nitakuja tena, na nita<strong>wa</strong>karibisha ninyi k<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” “M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu atakapokuja katika<br />

utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na malaika wote pamoja naye, halafu ataketi juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke; na<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke mataifa yote <strong>wa</strong>takusanyika.” Yoane 14:2,3; Matayo 25:31,32.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>likariri k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi ahadi <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke; “Huyu Yesu aliyechukuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

toka kwenu kwenda juu mbinguni, atakuja namna hii sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> mulivyomwona akikwenda<br />

zake mbinguni.” Matendo 1:11. Na Paulo akashuhudia: “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu B<strong>wa</strong>na mwenyewe<br />

atashuka toka mbinguni, na sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>, na sauti <strong>ya</strong> malaika mkub<strong>wa</strong>, pamoja na baragumu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” 1 Watesalonika 4:16. Akasema nabii <strong>wa</strong> Patemo: “Tazama, anakuja na<br />

mawingu; na kila jicho litamwona.” Ufunuo 1:7.<br />

Halafu desturi ndefu iliyoendelea <strong>ya</strong> uovu itavunjika: “Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> dunia umekwisha<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu na <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>ke, naye atata<strong>wa</strong>la hata milele na milele.”<br />

Ufunuo 11:15. “Na kama shamba linalochipuza vitu vilivyopand<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke: ndivyo<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu ataotesha haki na sifa mbele <strong>ya</strong> mataifa yote.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 61:11.<br />

Halafu ufalme <strong>wa</strong> amani <strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> utaimarish<strong>wa</strong> “Maana B<strong>wa</strong>na atafariji Sayuni;<br />

atafariji pahali pake pote pa pori; atafan<strong>ya</strong> jang<strong>wa</strong> lake ku<strong>wa</strong> kama Edeni, na jang<strong>wa</strong> lake<br />

kama shamba la B<strong>wa</strong>na.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 51:3.<br />

Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na kumeku<strong>wa</strong> katika vizazi vyote tumaini la <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Kati<br />

<strong>ya</strong> taabu na mateso, “na kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu mkub<strong>wa</strong>, Mwokozi wetu Yesu<br />

121


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kristo” liliku<strong>wa</strong> “tumaini la baraka.” Tito 2:13. Paulo alionyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba ufufuo utafika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>liokufa katika Kristo * <strong>wa</strong>takapofufuka, na<br />

pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>hai kuchukuli<strong>wa</strong> juu kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na katika mawingu. “Na hivi” akasema,<br />

“tutaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na B<strong>wa</strong>na milele. Basi mufarijiane k<strong>wa</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong>.” 1 Watesalonika<br />

4:17.<br />

Kule Patemo m<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi mpend<strong>wa</strong> akasikia ahadi, “Ndiyo: ninakuja upesi.” Na jibu<br />

lake linasimamia ombi la kanisa. “Amina, kuja B<strong>wa</strong>na Yesu.” Ufunuo 22:20. Kati <strong>ya</strong><br />

gereza, kigingi, mahali <strong>wa</strong>naponyong<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria, pahali <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na <strong>wa</strong>fia dini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liposhuhudia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli, kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi za usemi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o na<br />

tumaini.” Walipohakikish<strong>wa</strong> na ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> Yesu mwenyewe, na baadaye ufufuo <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii, “akasema mmoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>,” <strong>wa</strong>lizarau mauti, na <strong>wa</strong>kapatikana ku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong> Waldenses <strong>wa</strong>litunzaimani ile<br />

ile, Wyccliffe, Luther, Calvin, Knox, Ridley, na Baxter <strong>wa</strong>litazamia k<strong>wa</strong> imani kurudi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na. Ndiyo iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> tumaini la kanisa la mitume, la “kanisa katika jang<strong>wa</strong>,” na la<br />

Watengenezaji.<br />

Unabii hautabiri tu namna na kusudi la kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili, bali huonyesha<br />

ishara ambazo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kujua <strong>wa</strong>kati siku ile inapokaribia. “Na kutaku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

ishara katika jua na mwezi na nyota.” Luka 21:25. “...jua litati<strong>wa</strong> giza, na mwezi hautatoa<br />

nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke, na nyota za mbingu zitaanguka, na nguvu zilizo mbinguni zitatikisika. Na <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ule <strong>wa</strong>taona M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu akikuja katika mawingu pamoja na uwezo kub<strong>wa</strong> na utukufu.”<br />

Marko 13:24-26.<br />

Muonyeshaji (nabii) basi anaonyesha moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> ishara zitakazo tangulia kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mara <strong>ya</strong> pili: “... tazama, paliku<strong>wa</strong> na tetemeko kub<strong>wa</strong> la inchi, jua likaku<strong>wa</strong> jeusi kama<br />

gunia la manyo<strong>ya</strong>, na mwezi wote ukaku<strong>wa</strong> kama damu.” Ufunuo 6:12.<br />

Tetemeko la inchi lililotikisa Ulimwengu<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kutimilika k<strong>wa</strong> unabii huu kulitokea katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1755 tetemeko la inchi<br />

lililoku<strong>wa</strong> la kutisha zaidi lililoandik<strong>wa</strong>. Lilijulikana kama tetemeko la inchi la Lisbon,<br />

likaenea Ula<strong>ya</strong>, Afrika, na Amerika. Likasiki<strong>wa</strong> Groenland, Upande <strong>wa</strong> Magharibi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Uhindi, katika Antilles, Norvege na Swede, Uingereza na Irland, k<strong>wa</strong> eneo si chini kuliko<br />

kilometres milioni ine k<strong>wa</strong> mraba. Katika Afrika mshindo uliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu sana <strong>wa</strong> nguvu<br />

kama katika Ula<strong>ya</strong>. Sehemu Kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Algiers (Mji mkuu <strong>wa</strong> Algeria) ikaharibi<strong>wa</strong>. Wimbi<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> la kutisha likazamisha p<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>ya</strong> Espagne na <strong>ya</strong> Afrika na kudidimiisha miji.<br />

Milima, “ingine katika milima inayo ku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong> sana katika Portugal, ikatikis<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

nguvu sana, tangu k<strong>wa</strong> misingi <strong>ya</strong>o; na ingine kati <strong>ya</strong>o ikafunguka k<strong>wa</strong> vilele v<strong>ya</strong>o, ambayo<br />

ilipasuka na kutengana k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> ajabu, mafungu makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>o kutup<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

mabonde <strong>ya</strong> karibu. Ndimi za moto imehadizi<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> milima hizo.”<br />

122


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Huko Lisbon “Sauti <strong>ya</strong> ngurumo ilisiki<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> udongo, na bila kukawia baadae<br />

kishindo kikali kikaangusha sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mji ule. Katika mwendo <strong>wa</strong> dakika karibu<br />

sita <strong>wa</strong>tu elfu makumi sita <strong>wa</strong>kaangamiz<strong>wa</strong>. Bahari mara ikarudi, na ikaacha kivuko kikavu;<br />

na kurudi ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke, nakuinuka juu mita makumi tano ao zaidi juu <strong>ya</strong> daraja lake la<br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida.”<br />

Tetemeko la inchi lilifanyika k<strong>wa</strong> sikukuu, <strong>wa</strong>kati makanisa na nyumba za <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong><br />

zilijaa na <strong>wa</strong>tu, <strong>wa</strong>chache sana tu <strong>wa</strong>liokoka.” “Hofu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupita kiasi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuieleza. Hakuna mtu aliyelia; hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na machozi mbele <strong>ya</strong> msiba kama huo.<br />

Wakakimbia huko na huko, <strong>wa</strong>kipayuka payuka na hofu na mshangao, <strong>wa</strong>kipiga nyuso zao<br />

na vifua, kulia, ` Mesericordia! Ni mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia?’ Wamama <strong>wa</strong>kasahau <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o, na<br />

kukimbia njiani pamoja na sanamu za misalaba. K<strong>wa</strong> bahati mba<strong>ya</strong>, wengi <strong>wa</strong>kakimbilia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa kutafuta kimbilio; lakini sacramenti iliwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bure; k<strong>wa</strong> bure viumbe<br />

maskini <strong>wa</strong>likumbatia mazabahu; masanamu, mapadri, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kazik<strong>wa</strong> katika uharibifu<br />

moja mba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> wote pamoja.”<br />

Kuti<strong>wa</strong> giza k<strong>wa</strong> jua na Mwezi<br />

Miaka makumi mbili na tano baadaye ishara ingine iliotaj<strong>wa</strong> katika unabii ikaonekana -<br />

Kuti<strong>wa</strong> giza k<strong>wa</strong> jua na mwezi. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> kutimilika k<strong>wa</strong>ke kulionyesh<strong>wa</strong> kabisa katika<br />

mazungumzo <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong> Mizeituni. “Katika siku zile<br />

nbaada <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong>le, jua litati<strong>wa</strong> giza, na mwezi hautatoa nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Marko 13:24. Siku<br />

1260, ao miaka, zilimalizika katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798, robo <strong>ya</strong> karne mbele, mateso <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

karibu kuisha kabisa. Kufuata mateso ha<strong>ya</strong>, jua likati<strong>wa</strong> giza. K<strong>wa</strong> tarehe 19 mai 1780,<br />

unabii huu ukatimilika.<br />

Shahidi aliyejionea k<strong>wa</strong> macho katika Massachusetts akaeleza jambo hili kama<br />

ifuatavyo: “Wingu nzito sana likata<strong>wa</strong>nyika juu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu nzima isipoku<strong>wa</strong> ukingo<br />

mwembamba juu <strong>ya</strong> upeo <strong>wa</strong> macho, na iliku<strong>wa</strong> giza kama inavyoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida saa<br />

tisa k<strong>wa</strong> majira <strong>ya</strong> baridi jioni... “Woga, mashaka, na hofu polepole vikajaa mioyoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu. Wana<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kasimama mlangoni, kutazama juu <strong>ya</strong> kipande cha inchi <strong>ya</strong> giza; <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>karudi kutoka kazini m<strong>wa</strong>o katika mashamba; sermala akaacha vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>ke, mhunzi<br />

kuacha ki<strong>wa</strong>nda chake, mchuuzi kuacha meza <strong>ya</strong>ke. Vyuo vikafung<strong>wa</strong>, na k<strong>wa</strong> kutetemeka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>kakimbilia k<strong>wa</strong>o. Wasafiri <strong>wa</strong>kaenda kutafuta kimbilio karibu sana <strong>ya</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong><br />

mashamba. “Ni kitu gani kita kuja?” S<strong>wa</strong>li hili liliku<strong>wa</strong> katika midomo yote na ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

moyo. Ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba zoruba kali ilitaka kupita inchini, ao siku <strong>ya</strong> maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> vitu<br />

vyote.<br />

“Mishumaa ikatumi<strong>wa</strong>, mioto <strong>ya</strong> nyumbani ikaangaza k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza mwingi kama<br />

usiku <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> baridi, bila mwezi... Kuku <strong>wa</strong>katoka na kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> vituo v<strong>ya</strong>o na<br />

kwenda kulala, mifugo ikakusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> fito za malisho na kulala, vyura vikalia, ndege<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaimba nyimbo zao za jioni, na popo <strong>wa</strong>karuka. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba usiku<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> haujafika bado...<br />

123


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Makutano <strong>ya</strong>kaja pamoja k<strong>wa</strong> mahali ... pengi. Maneno k<strong>wa</strong> hotuba zisizo za ka<strong>wa</strong>ida<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zile zisizogeuka za kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba giza ililingana na unabii <strong>wa</strong><br />

Maandiko... Giza iliku<strong>wa</strong> nyingi zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> upesi baada <strong>ya</strong> saa tano.”<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> sehemu nyingi za inchi iliku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong> sana katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati za mchana, ambaye<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kutaja saa <strong>wa</strong>la k<strong>wa</strong> saa ndogo ao kub<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>la kula chakula, ao kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

kazi zao za nyumbani, bila nuru <strong>ya</strong> mishumaa.”<br />

Mwezi kama Damu<br />

“Giza <strong>ya</strong> usiku haikukosa ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ajabu na <strong>ya</strong> kutisha kama ile <strong>ya</strong> mchana; inga<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwezi uliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu ku<strong>wa</strong> mzima, hakuna kitu kiliku<strong>wa</strong> cha kutambulikana ila tu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

msaada <strong>wa</strong> nuru isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> asili, ambayo, kama ikionekana k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba za jirani na<br />

mahali pengine k<strong>wa</strong> mbali ilionekana kama katika ile giza <strong>ya</strong> Misri ambayo ilionekana<br />

karibu kama isiyopenyeka k<strong>wa</strong> miale.” “Kama kila kitu chenye kung’aa katika ulimwengu<br />

kilifunik<strong>wa</strong> katika giza isiyopenyeka, ao kingeondole<strong>wa</strong>, giza haingaliku<strong>wa</strong> kamili kabisa.”<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane giza ikatoweka, na mwezi, <strong>wa</strong>kati ulionekana mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza,<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> na rangi <strong>ya</strong> damu.<br />

Tarehe 19 <strong>ya</strong> Mai 1780, inaku<strong>wa</strong> katika historia kama “Siku <strong>ya</strong> Giza.” Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

Musa hakuna giza <strong>ya</strong> namna ile nzito, kub<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>ya</strong>kuendelea iliyoandik<strong>wa</strong>. Maelezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>liojionea ni jibu la maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> na Yoeli miaka<br />

2500 mbele: “Jua litageuka ku<strong>wa</strong> giza, na mwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> damu mbele <strong>ya</strong> kutimia k<strong>wa</strong>ke ile<br />

siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na yenye kuogopesha.” Yoeli 2:31.<br />

“Wakati maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>napoanza kuja,” akasema Kristo, “tazameni juu, mun<strong>ya</strong>nyue<br />

vich<strong>wa</strong> vyenu k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ukombozi wenu umekaribia.” Alitolea <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

mti uliochipuka <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>ya</strong> kukua ao kuota k<strong>wa</strong> mimea: “Wakati inapochipuka,<br />

munaona na kutambua ninyi wenyewe <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mavuno <strong>ya</strong>mekwisha ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu. Vile<br />

nanyi, <strong>wa</strong>kati munapoona maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>napotokea jueni <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ni<br />

karibu.” Luka 21:28, 30, 31.<br />

Lakini katika kanisa upendo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na imani katika kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke vilipoa.<br />

Waliojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lipofush<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi juu <strong>ya</strong> ishara<br />

za kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong>lizarauli<strong>wa</strong>, hata iki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

eneo kub<strong>wa</strong>, haikujali<strong>wa</strong> na ikasahauli<strong>wa</strong>, hasa zaidi kule Amerika. Tamaa <strong>ya</strong> mali,<br />

kupigania sifa na uwezo, vikaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kuweka mbali k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao siku ile kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

ambapo mambo yote <strong>ya</strong> sasa <strong>ya</strong>tapas<strong>wa</strong> kupita.<br />

Mwokozi alitabiri hali <strong>ya</strong> kukufuru ilipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong><br />

pili. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoishi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, onyo la Kristo ni: “Mujiangalie, mioyo yenu<br />

isipate kuleme<strong>wa</strong> na ulafi na ulevi, na masumbuko <strong>ya</strong> maisha ha<strong>ya</strong>, siku ile isije kwenu<br />

gafula kama mutego.” “Lakini tazameni kila <strong>wa</strong>kati, mukiomba mupate nguvu <strong>ya</strong> kukimbia<br />

124


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> yote <strong>ya</strong>takayoku<strong>wa</strong>, na kusimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.” Luka 21:34,<br />

36.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> jambo la maana sana k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>amshwe k<strong>wa</strong> kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>nayo husiana na kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> rehema. ‘’Siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ni kub<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuogopesha, nani anayeweza kuivumilia?” Nani atakayesimama <strong>wa</strong>kati atakapoonekana<br />

yeye anayeku<strong>wa</strong> na “macho safi zaidi hata asiweze kutazama maba<strong>ya</strong>,” na hawezi<br />

“kutazama ukaidi”? “Nami nitaazibu ulimwengu k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> uba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke, na wenye<br />

zambi k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong>o, nami nitakomesha kiburi cha wenye majivuno; nami<br />

nitaangusha chini majivuno <strong>ya</strong> wenye ukali.” “Wala feza zao <strong>wa</strong>la zahabu zao hazitaweza<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ponyesha;” “Na utajiri <strong>wa</strong>o utaku<strong>wa</strong> mateka, na nyumba zao uki<strong>wa</strong>.” Yoeli 2:11;<br />

Habakuki 1:13; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 13:11; Zefania 1:18, 13.<br />

Mwito k<strong>wa</strong> Kuamka<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> maoni <strong>ya</strong> siku ile kub<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu linaita <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kutafuta uso <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

katika toba: “Siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na inakuja, k<strong>wa</strong>ni imekaribia.” “Takaseni kufunga chakula, iteni<br />

kusanyiko la dini; kusanyeni <strong>wa</strong>tu, takaseni makutano, kusanyeni <strong>wa</strong>zee, kusanyeni <strong>wa</strong>toto:<br />

... Makuhani, <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, lia katikati <strong>ya</strong> baraza na mazabahu.” “Geukeni k<strong>wa</strong>ngu<br />

na moyo wenu wote, na pamoja na kufunga chakula, na kutoa machozi na kuomboleza; na<br />

pasueni moyo wenu, <strong>wa</strong>la si mavazi yenu, geukeni k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, Mungu wenu; k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

mwenye neema na, anayejaa huruma, si mwepesi k<strong>wa</strong> kukasirika, na mwenye rehema<br />

nyingi.” Yoeli 2:1, 15-17, 12,13.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha <strong>wa</strong>tu kusimama k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo<br />

ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kutimilika. Katika huruma zake aliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kutuma mjumbe k<strong>wa</strong> kuamsha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke na ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na.<br />

Onyo hili linaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika Ufunuo 14. Hapa kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na namna tatu <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe<br />

unaoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> kama unatangaz<strong>wa</strong> na viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni na mara moja ukafuat<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> kuvuna “mavuno <strong>ya</strong> dunia.” Nabii aliona malaika akiruka<br />

“katikati <strong>ya</strong> mbingu, mwenye Habari Njema <strong>ya</strong> milele, a<strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

dunia, na kila taifa na kabila na lugha na jamaa, akasema k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>: Ogopeni Mungu,<br />

na kumutukuza k<strong>wa</strong> maana saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja. Mukam<strong>wa</strong>budu yeye aliyezifan<strong>ya</strong><br />

mbingu na dunia na bahari na chemchemi za maji.” Ufunuo 14:6. 7.<br />

Ujumbe huu ni sehemu <strong>ya</strong> “Habari Njema <strong>ya</strong> milele.” Kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuhubiri ilipe<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

kuaminish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu huongoza, lakini tangazo la sasa la habari<br />

njema linafany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo duniani. Watu <strong>wa</strong>aminifu, <strong>wa</strong>tiifu k<strong>wa</strong> maongozi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Neno lake, <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kutangaza onyo hili.<br />

Waliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitafuta maarifa <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kuihesabu “vema kuliko biashara <strong>ya</strong> feza, na faida<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ni nyororo kuliko zahabu safi.” “Siri <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ni pamoja nao <strong>wa</strong>naomwogopa; Naye<br />

ata<strong>wa</strong>onyesha agano lake.” Mezali 3:14; Zaburi 25:14.<br />

125


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ujumbe Uliotole<strong>wa</strong> na Watu Wanyenyekevu<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na sifa za Mungu na dini <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>linzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu, wenye bidii na wenye kuomba kuchunguza Maandiko, <strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza kujua<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati. Mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>ya</strong>ngeweza ku<strong>wa</strong>fungulia matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liyopash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini<br />

ujumbe ulitole<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liozarau kutafuta nuru <strong>wa</strong>kati inapoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

karibu nao <strong>wa</strong>liach<strong>wa</strong> gizani. Lakini Mwokozi anatangaza, “Yeye anayenifuata hatatembea<br />

katika giza, lakini ataku<strong>wa</strong> na nuru <strong>ya</strong> uzima.” Yoane 8:12. K<strong>wa</strong> roho ile nyota fulani <strong>ya</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni itatum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kumwongoza katika ukweli wote.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>kuhani na <strong>wa</strong>andishi <strong>wa</strong> mji<br />

Mtakatifu <strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza kutambua “ishara za <strong>wa</strong>kati” na kutangaza kuja k<strong>wa</strong> yule<br />

Aliyeahidi<strong>wa</strong>. Mika aliandika mahali pale pa kuzali<strong>wa</strong>, Danieli, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Mika 5:2; Danieli 9:25. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> bila sababu kama ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua.<br />

Ujinga <strong>wa</strong>o uliku<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> zarau lenye zambi.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> faida kub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> Israeli <strong>wa</strong>ngalipash<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza pahali, <strong>wa</strong>kati, hali<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mambo, <strong>ya</strong> tukio kub<strong>wa</strong> sana katika historia <strong>ya</strong> dunia--kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kukesha ili <strong>wa</strong>pate kumkaribisha Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu. Lakini kule<br />

Betelehemu <strong>wa</strong>safiri <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>liochoka kutoka Nazareti <strong>wa</strong>kapitia njia nyembamba k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> mashariki <strong>ya</strong> mji, kutafuta kimbilio sababu uliku<strong>wa</strong> usiku bila kuona<br />

mahali pa kupangia. Hakuna milango iliyofunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>pokea. Katika kibanda<br />

kibovu kilichota<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mifugo, mwishowe <strong>wa</strong>kapata kimbilio, na hapo<br />

Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu akazali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>kaagiz<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua habari <strong>ya</strong> furaha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojita<strong>ya</strong>risha kuipokea na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioweza k<strong>wa</strong> furaha kuijulisha. Kristo alijishusha hata akajivika hali <strong>ya</strong> binadamu,<br />

kuchukua taabu isiyo na mwisho namna alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutoa roho <strong>ya</strong>ke sadaka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi. Lakini malaika <strong>wa</strong>litamani k<strong>wa</strong>mba hata katika kujishusha k<strong>wa</strong>ke M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

Aliyejuu angeweza kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na heshima na utukufu unaofaa tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke. Je,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> inchi ha<strong>wa</strong>ngekusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> mji mkuu <strong>wa</strong> Israeli kusalimia kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke? Je,<br />

malaika ha<strong>wa</strong>ngemwonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> makutano <strong>ya</strong>liyomungojea?<br />

Malaika mmoja alizuru ulimwengu kuona <strong>wa</strong>nani <strong>wa</strong>liojita<strong>ya</strong>risha kumkaribisha Yesu.<br />

Lakini hakusikia sauti <strong>ya</strong> sifa k<strong>wa</strong>mba mda <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> umefika. Akakawia juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mji uliochaguli<strong>wa</strong> na hekalu ikasimama k<strong>wa</strong> mda mahali ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu kulionekana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> miaka nyingi, lakini hata pale paliku<strong>wa</strong> na kutojali k<strong>wa</strong> namna moja. Wakuhani katika<br />

sherehe na kiburi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitoa kafara za unajisi. Mafarisayo k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kuu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>ambia <strong>wa</strong>tu ao <strong>wa</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> kujisifu k<strong>wa</strong> pembe za njia. Wafalme, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> elimu zote (philosophes), <strong>wa</strong>alimu, wote <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siokumbuka jambo la ajabu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu aliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuonekana.<br />

126


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mshangao mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni aliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kurudi mbinguni pamoja na habari<br />

<strong>ya</strong> aibu sana, <strong>wa</strong>kati alipovumbua kundi la <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>kilinda makundi <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Wakatamani sana kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu. Hapa paliku<strong>wa</strong> na kundi la <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojita<strong>ya</strong>risha kumpokea mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. K<strong>wa</strong> gafula utukufu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni ukajaa<br />

pote katika u<strong>wa</strong>nda, kundi lisilohesabika la <strong>wa</strong>malaika likafunuli<strong>wa</strong>; na kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

furaha iliku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mjumbe kutoka mbinguni, wingi <strong>wa</strong> masauti kuimba<br />

wimbo <strong>wa</strong> furaha ambao mataifa yote <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>taimba siku moja: “Utukufu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu aliye juu, na salama duniani, katika <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naomupendeza.” Luka 2:14.<br />

Fundisho la namna gani linaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> historia <strong>ya</strong> ajabu hii <strong>ya</strong> Betelehemu! Namna gani<br />

inakemea kutokuamini kwetu, kiburi chetu na hali <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>za tunatosheka nafsini. Namna<br />

gani inatuon<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kujihazari, ili sisi vile vile tusishindwe kutambua ishara za n<strong>ya</strong>kati na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo hatutajua siku <strong>ya</strong> kuzuri<strong>wa</strong> kwetu.<br />

Si miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji tu ambamo malaika <strong>wa</strong>lipata <strong>wa</strong>linzi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>. Katika inchi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pagani vile vile kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liomtazamia--<strong>wa</strong>tajiri,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu bora wenye akili— wenye elimu zote <strong>wa</strong> Mashariki. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kiebrania <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kijifunza habari <strong>ya</strong> nyota kutokea k<strong>wa</strong> Yakobo. K<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong><br />

bidii <strong>wa</strong>lingojea kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke yeye aliyepash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> si “Faraja la Israeli” tu, bali “Nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuangazia Mataifa,” na “ku<strong>wa</strong> wokovu hata mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia.” Luka 2:25, 32; Matendo<br />

13:47. Mbingu--ikatuma nyota ikaongoza <strong>wa</strong>geni <strong>wa</strong> mataifa k<strong>wa</strong> mahali pa kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mfalme mp<strong>ya</strong> aliyezali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Ni k<strong>wa</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naomungojea” K<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo “ataonekana mara <strong>ya</strong> pili, si tena k<strong>wa</strong><br />

zambi, lakini kuokoa <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naomungojea k<strong>wa</strong> wokovu.” Waebrania 9:28. Kama habari <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi, ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili haukutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong><br />

dini <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Walikataa nuru kutoka mbinguni; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> katika hesabu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liotaj<strong>wa</strong> na mtume Paulo: “Lakini ninyi ndugu, si katika giza, hata siku ile i<strong>wa</strong>pate ninyi<br />

kama mwizi: sababu ninyi wote ni <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> nuru, na <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mchana: sisi hatuko <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

usiku <strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> giza.” 1 Watesalonika 5:4, 5.<br />

Walinzi juu <strong>ya</strong> kuta za Sayuni <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kupata habari <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mwokozi, <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kutangaza ukaribu <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> raha, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika usingizi <strong>wa</strong> zambi zao. Yesu aliona kanisa lake, kama mti <strong>wa</strong> mtini<br />

usiozaa, umefunik<strong>wa</strong> na majani <strong>ya</strong> fahari, lakini pasipo ku<strong>wa</strong> na matunda <strong>ya</strong> damani. Roho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> kweli, uvumilivu, na imani ilikosekana. Hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kiburi, unafiki,<br />

uchoyo, ugandamizi. Kanisa laukufuru lilifunga macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> alama za n<strong>ya</strong>kati.<br />

Wakatoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>kajitenga <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Namna<br />

<strong>wa</strong>livyokataa na mapash<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyowek<strong>wa</strong>, ahadi zake hazikutimiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>kakataa kupokea nuru kutoka mbinguni.<br />

Kama Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong> zamani, ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuzuri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o. B<strong>wa</strong>na akapita pembeni<br />

127


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>o na akafunua ukweli <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao, kama <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong> Betelehemu na<br />

Waakili <strong>wa</strong> Mashariki, <strong>wa</strong>lipe<strong>wa</strong> usikizi k<strong>wa</strong> nuru yote <strong>wa</strong>lioyopokea.<br />

128


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 18. Nuru Mp<strong>ya</strong> Katika Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

Mkulima m<strong>wa</strong>minifu, <strong>wa</strong> haki, ambaye alitamani kujua ukweli, aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu<br />

aliyechaguli<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu kuongoza katika kutangaza kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tengenezaji wengi wengine, William Miller alipigana na umaskini na akajifunza fundisho<br />

la kujikana.<br />

Hata katika utoto alitoa ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> akili zaidi kuliko ule <strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukomaa ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu mzima, akili <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> utendaji na ikaendelea sana, na aliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kiu cha bidii k<strong>wa</strong> maarifa. Upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kujifunza na tabia <strong>ya</strong> mafikara <strong>ya</strong> uangalifu<br />

kuambatana na ujuzi vikamfan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> hukumu na maono <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi. Aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na tabia <strong>ya</strong> matendo mema isiyolaumi<strong>wa</strong> na sifa nzuri. Alifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi za serkali na za<br />

kiaskari pamoja na sifa njema. Utajiri na heshima vilionekana kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Katika utoto aliku<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> dini. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> mtu mkub<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> hivi<br />

akajiingiza katika jamii <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na imani katika Mungu (deistes), mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> jambo k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> karibu raia wema,<strong>wa</strong>pole na <strong>wa</strong>karimu.<br />

Kuishi kati <strong>ya</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>ma v<strong>ya</strong> Kikristo, tabia zao ziliku<strong>wa</strong> za kadiri zilizofany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>zunguuka. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wema ambao uli<strong>wa</strong>patia heshima, <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong>pash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kushukuru Biblia, na za<strong>wa</strong>di hizi nzuri zika<strong>wa</strong>ongoza k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia mvuto juu <strong>ya</strong> Neno la<br />

Mungu. Miller akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuitika nia zao.<br />

Mafasiri <strong>ya</strong> kisasa <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>lionyesha magumu ambayo ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kub<strong>wa</strong> sana; lakini imani mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> kuweka Biblia kando, haikumsaidia kitu,<br />

na aka<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> kutoshele<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati Miller alipoku<strong>wa</strong> na miaka makumi tatu na<br />

ine, Roho Mtakatifu akamfahamisha moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> hali aliyoku<strong>wa</strong>mo kama mwenye<br />

zambi. Hakuona tumaini la furaha ngambo <strong>ya</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong> kaburi. Wakati ujao uliku<strong>wa</strong> giza na<br />

huzuni. K<strong>wa</strong> kutazama ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> moyo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, akasema: 1<br />

“Mbingu ziliku<strong>wa</strong> kama shaba juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> changu, na dunia kama chuma chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

miguu <strong>ya</strong>ngu... Nilipofikiri zaidi hukumu zangu zikata<strong>wa</strong>nyika. Nikajaribu kukataza<br />

ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ngu, lakini ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ngu haikuweza kuta<strong>wa</strong>lika. Nika<strong>wa</strong> maskini k<strong>wa</strong> kweli,<br />

lakini bila kufahamu sababu. Nikanungunika na kulalamika, lakini sikujua juu <strong>ya</strong> nani.<br />

Nikajua k<strong>wa</strong>mba kosa liliku<strong>wa</strong>ko, lakini sikujua namna gani ao mahali gani kupata haki.”<br />

Miller Anapata Rafiki<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> gafula,” akasema, “tabia la Mwokozi likaonekana kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong>ngu.<br />

Inaonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ngu kufahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuna Kiumbe kizuri sana na chenye huruma k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> mwenyewe upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> makosa yetu, na kutuokoa k<strong>wa</strong> kuteseka k<strong>wa</strong> azabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi... Lakini s<strong>wa</strong>li likatokea, Namna gani itawezekana kuhakikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba kiumbe cha<br />

namna hii kinaku<strong>wa</strong>ko? Inje <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, niliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba sikuweza kupata ushahidi <strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong> namna ile, ao hata hali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao...<br />

129


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Niliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba Biblia ilionyesha tu Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong> namna ninayehitaji: na nilifazaika<br />

kuona namna gani kitabu kisichoongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu kilipash<strong>wa</strong> kukuza kanuni<br />

zilizolingana kabisa kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu ulioanguka. Nikalazimish<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> ufunuo kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Yaka<strong>wa</strong><br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ngu; na katika Yesu napata rafiki. Mwokozi aka<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ngu mkuu kuliko<br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kuu elfu kumi; na Maandiko, ambayo mbele <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> giza na kinyume,<br />

sasa <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> taa k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong>ngu... Niliona B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu ku<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>mba katikati <strong>ya</strong><br />

bahari <strong>ya</strong> maisha. Biblia sasa inaku<strong>wa</strong> fundisho langu kuu, na ninaweza kusema kweli,<br />

niliitafuta k<strong>wa</strong> furaha kub<strong>wa</strong>... Nilishangaa sababu gani sikuona uzuri <strong>wa</strong>ke na utukufu<br />

mbele, na nikashangaa namna gani ningaliweza kuikataa... Nikapoteza onyo yote <strong>ya</strong> kusoma<br />

vitabu vingine, nikatumia moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> kupata hekima kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.”<br />

Miller akaungama <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi imani <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini rafiki zake <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaendele<strong>ya</strong> mbele na mabishano, hayo yote ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lishurutisha mwenyewe kupinga<br />

Maandiko. Akafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama Biblia ni ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, Kitabu hicho kinapas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujieleza chenyewe. Akakusudia kujifunza Maandiko na kupata kama kila mabishano <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong>pate kupatanish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Akaacha maelezo yo yote, akalinganisha maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> usaada <strong>wa</strong><br />

kumbukumbu <strong>ya</strong> upande na upatanifu (concordance). Kuanzia k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>nzo, kusoma shauri<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> shauri, alipoona kitu cho chote cha giza iliku<strong>wa</strong> desturi <strong>ya</strong>ke kukilinganisha pamoja na<br />

maneno yote <strong>ya</strong>nayoweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na uhusiano na fundisho lenyewe. Kila neno likaruhusi<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> na tegemeo lake juu <strong>ya</strong> maneno yenyewe. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo <strong>wa</strong>kati wo wote alipokutana<br />

maneno magumu k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu alipata maelezo katika sehemu ingine <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko.<br />

Akajifunza k<strong>wa</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> juhudi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong> kiMungu maneno <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong><br />

zaburi: “kufunua k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>ko kunaleta nuru; Kunamupa mujinga ufahamu.” Zaburi<br />

119:130.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> usikizi mwingi akajifunza kitabu cha Danieli na Ufunuo na akaona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mifano <strong>ya</strong> unabii inaweza kufahamika. Aliona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mifano yote mbalimbali, mezali,<br />

vifani, kama ha<strong>ya</strong>kuelez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyotangulia ha<strong>ya</strong>, hupata penginepo maelezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> muunganiko <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe ao kuelez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko mengine na<br />

kufahamika k<strong>wa</strong> kweli. Kiungo k<strong>wa</strong> kiungo cha mnyororo <strong>wa</strong> kweli na ku<strong>wa</strong> ni shani <strong>ya</strong><br />

bidii <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hatua k<strong>wa</strong> hatua akafuatisha mistari <strong>ya</strong> unabii. Malaika <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kiongoza akili <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Akatoshele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba maoni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>ya</strong> miaka elfu (millennium) mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia ha<strong>ya</strong>kukubali<strong>wa</strong> na Neno la Mungu. Mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong>,<strong>ya</strong> kuonyesha<br />

miaka elfu <strong>ya</strong> amani mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, ni kinyume cha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na<br />

mitume <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>liotangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ngano na magugu <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kuku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja hata<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mavuno, mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba “<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>danganyifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taendelea na kuzidi ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu.” 2 Timoteo 3:13.<br />

130


Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mwenyewe<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mafundisho juu <strong>ya</strong> kugeuka k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu na uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong> kiroho<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>kushik<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa la mitume. K<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida ha<strong>ya</strong>kukubali<strong>wa</strong> na Wakristo hata karibu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mnane. Ilifundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kutazamia mbali k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao<br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na na ku<strong>wa</strong>kataza k<strong>wa</strong>ngalia ishara za kurudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Iliongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutojali<br />

kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> kumlaki B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Miller akaona kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo halisi kulikofundish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi katika Maandiko. “K<strong>wa</strong><br />

sababu B<strong>wa</strong>na mwenyewe atashuka toka mbinguni, na sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>, na sauti <strong>ya</strong> malaika<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong>, na pamoja na baragumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” “Nao <strong>wa</strong>taona M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu akija katika<br />

mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu pamoja na uwezo na utukufu mkub<strong>wa</strong>.” “K<strong>wa</strong> maana kama umeme<br />

unavyokuja toka mashariki na unaonekana hata mangaribi; ni hivi kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu kutakavyoku<strong>wa</strong>.” “M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu atakapokuja katika utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na malaika yote<br />

pamoja naye.” “Naye atatuma malaika zake na sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> baragumu, nao <strong>wa</strong>takusan<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke.” 1 Watesalonika 4:16, 17; Matayo 24:30, 27; 25:31; 24:31.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>fu wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>tafufuka na wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>liohai <strong>wa</strong>tabadilika.<br />

“Sisi sote hatutalala, lakini sisi sote tutabadilika, k<strong>wa</strong> dakika moja, k<strong>wa</strong> kufunga na<br />

kufungua jicho, k<strong>wa</strong> baragumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho: sababu baragumu italia, na <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>siwe na kuoza, na tutabadilika. Maana sharti ule mwili wenye kuoza uvae kutokuoza, na<br />

huu <strong>wa</strong> mauti uvae kutokufa.” “Nao <strong>wa</strong>liokufa katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza; kisha<br />

sisi tulio hai, tuliobaki, tutan<strong>ya</strong>nyuli<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nao katika mawingu, kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

katika he<strong>wa</strong>, na hivi tutaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na B<strong>wa</strong>na milele.” 1 Wakorinto 15:51-53; 1<br />

Watesalonika 4:16, 17.<br />

Mtu katika hali <strong>ya</strong> sasa ni <strong>wa</strong> kufa, <strong>wa</strong>kuoza; lakini ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu utaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kutokuoza. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo mtu k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> sasa hawezi kuingia katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu. Wakati Yesu atakuja, atatoa kutokufa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na ku<strong>wa</strong>ita kuriti ufalme<br />

ambao ha<strong>wa</strong>kuuriti hata sasa.<br />

Maandiko matakatifu na Taratibu <strong>ya</strong> Miaka<br />

Ha<strong>ya</strong> pamoja na maandiko mengine k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong>kamshuhudia Miller k<strong>wa</strong>mba uta<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

<strong>wa</strong> amani <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote na kuimarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu duniani ungeku<strong>wa</strong> baada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Tena, hali <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu ililingana na maelezo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong> siku<br />

za mwisho. Alilazimish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba mda ulioga<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dunia katika hali<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> sasa uliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuisha.<br />

Namna ingine <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda ambao k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu ulichoma moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Akasema,<br />

“uliku<strong>wa</strong> utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko... Niliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyotabiri<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong>litimilika<br />

katika <strong>wa</strong>kati uliopita, mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong>litukia karibu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliotole<strong>wa</strong>... Matokeo ...<br />

<strong>ya</strong>napoku<strong>wa</strong> tu mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii, ... <strong>ya</strong>litimia katika upatano <strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liotabiri<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

131


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakati alipoona n<strong>ya</strong>kati za taratibu <strong>ya</strong> miaka ambayo ilifikia k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, hangaliweza lakini kuzitazama kama “n<strong>ya</strong>kati zilizoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> mbele”, ambazo<br />

Mungu alifunulia <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Vitu vile vilivyofunuli<strong>wa</strong> ni vyetu, na v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na wetu<br />

milele.” B<strong>wa</strong>na alitangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “hatafan<strong>ya</strong> lolote, lakini anafunulia <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

manabii siri <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Torati 29:29; Amosi 3:7. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naweza<br />

kutazamia k<strong>wa</strong> hakika kuona mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko katika historia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu<br />

iliyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi katika Maandiko.<br />

“Nilisadikish<strong>wa</strong> kabisa,” akasema Miller, “k<strong>wa</strong>mba kila andiko lililope<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu linafaa k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho; k<strong>wa</strong>mba liliandik<strong>wa</strong>; <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Roho Mtakatifu, <strong>ya</strong>meandik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> majifunzo yetu, k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> subira na faraja <strong>ya</strong> maandiko tuwe na tumaini ... k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo mimi niliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika<br />

kujitahidi kufahamu kile Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> nacho katika huruma zake kinachoonekana kufaa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kufunuli<strong>wa</strong> kwetu, siku<strong>wa</strong> na haki kupita inje <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii.”<br />

Unabii ambao ulionekana <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> kufunua <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili<br />

uliku<strong>wa</strong> Danieli 8:14: “Hata mangaribi na asubui elfu mbili mia tatu; halafu Pahali<br />

patakatifu patasafish<strong>wa</strong>.” Kufan<strong>ya</strong> Maandiko mfasiri <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe, Miller akajifunza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba siku moja katika unabii ni m<strong>wa</strong>ka moja. (Tazama Nyongezo.) Aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba siku<br />

2300 za unabii, ao miaka kabisa, ingefikia mbali sana <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> mugawo <strong>wa</strong><br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo haikuweza kutaja juu <strong>ya</strong> mahali patakatifu pa mugawo ule.<br />

Miller akakubali maelezo <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo ulimwengu ni<br />

“mahali patakatifu,” na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo akafahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba kusafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu<br />

kulikotabiri<strong>wa</strong> katika Danieli 8:14 iliku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dunia na moto k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Kama mahali kamili pa kuanzia pangeweza kupatikana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> siku 2300, akamaliza k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili ungeweza<br />

kufunuli<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

132


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

UNABII WA 2300 SIKU / MIAKA<br />

Siku <strong>ya</strong> unabii = M<strong>wa</strong>ka mmoja<br />

34<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hesabu <strong>ya</strong> hizo siku mlizoipeleleza ile nchi, <strong>ya</strong>ani, siku arobaini kila siku<br />

kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, mta<strong>ya</strong>chukua maovu yenu, ndiyo miaka arobaini, nanyi mtakujua<br />

kufarikana k<strong>wa</strong>ngu. (Hesabu 14:34) 6 Tena utakapozitimiza hizo, utalala k<strong>wa</strong> ubavu <strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuume, nawe utauchukua uovu <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Yuda; siku arobaini, siku moja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ka mmoja, nimekuagizia. (Ezekieli 4:6)<br />

457 k.k – 1844 - 2300 Siku/ Miaka. 14 Akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia, Hata n<strong>ya</strong>kati za jioni na asubuhi<br />

elfu mbili na mia tatu; ndipo patakatifu patakapotakas<strong>wa</strong>. (Danieli 8:14) 24 Muda <strong>wa</strong><br />

majuma sabini umeamri<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko, na juu <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>ko mtakatifu, ili kukomesha<br />

makosa, na kuishiliza dhambi, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uovu, na kuleta haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

milele, na kutia muhuri maono na unabii, na kumtia mafuta yeye aliye mtakatifu. 490 Siku /<br />

Miaka (Danieli 9:24)<br />

457 k.k - Amri <strong>ya</strong> kujenga tena na kurejesha Yerusalemu (Amri <strong>ya</strong> Mfalme Artaxerxes).<br />

25<br />

…Basi ujue na kufahamu, <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> tangu kuwek<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> kutengeneza na kuujenga<br />

up<strong>ya</strong> Yerusalemu hata zamani zake masihi aliye mkuu; kutaku<strong>wa</strong> na majuma saba; na katika<br />

133


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

majuma sitini na mawili utajeng<strong>wa</strong> tena pamoja na njia kuu zake na handaki, naam, katika<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za taabu. (Danieli 9:25)<br />

408 k.k - Yajenzi/ Kujenga up<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalemu<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 27 - Ubatizo na Upako <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo (Masihi). 27 Naye atafan<strong>ya</strong> agano thabiti<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> juma moja; na k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma hiyo ataikomesha sadaka na<br />

dhabihu; na mahali pake litasimama chukizo la uharibifu; na hivyo, hata ukomo, na<br />

ghadhabu iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> imem<strong>wa</strong>g<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenye kuharibu (Danieli 9:26-27)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 31 - Kusulibi<strong>wa</strong> na kifo cha Yesu Kristo. 26 Na baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le majuma sitini na<br />

mawili, masihi atakatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali, naye ataku<strong>wa</strong> hana kitu; na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> mkuu atakayekuja<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tauangamiza mji, na patakatifu; na mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke utaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na gharika, na hata<br />

mwisho ule vita vitaku<strong>wa</strong>po; uki<strong>wa</strong> umekwisha kukusudi<strong>wa</strong>. 27 Naye atafan<strong>ya</strong> agano thabiti<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> juma moja; na k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma hiyo ataikomesha sadaka na<br />

dhabihu; na mahali pake litasimama chukizo la uharibifu; na hivyo, hata ukomo, na<br />

ghadhabu iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> imem<strong>wa</strong>g<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenye kuharibu (Danieli 9:26, 27)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 34 - Stefano Anapig<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mawe. Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi. Injili k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Ulimwengu. 14 Tena habari njema <strong>ya</strong> ufalme itahubiri<strong>wa</strong> katika ulimwengu wote, ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yote; hapo ndipo ule mwisho utakapokuja (Mathayo 24: 14) 46 Paulo<br />

na Barnaba <strong>wa</strong>kanena k<strong>wa</strong> ushujaa <strong>wa</strong>kasema, Iliku<strong>wa</strong> lazima neno la Mungu linenwe<br />

kwenu k<strong>wa</strong>nza; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mnalisukumia mbali, na kujiona nafsi zenu ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

hamkustahili uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele, angalieni, t<strong>wa</strong><strong>wa</strong>geukia Mataifa (Matendo <strong>ya</strong> Mitume 13:46)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 70 - Uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalemu 1 Yesu akaenda zake, akatoka hekaluni;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kamwendea ili kumwonyesha majengo <strong>ya</strong> hekalu. 2 Naye akajibu<br />

aka<strong>wa</strong>ambia, Ham<strong>ya</strong>oni ha<strong>ya</strong> yote? Amin, na<strong>wa</strong>ambieni, Halitasalia hapa jiwe juu <strong>ya</strong> jiwe<br />

ambalo halitabomosh<strong>wa</strong>. (Mathayo 24:1, 2) 15 Basi hapo mtakapoliona chukizo la uharibifu,<br />

lile lililonen<strong>wa</strong> na nabii Danielii, limesimama katika patakatifu (asomaye na afahamu)… 21<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huo kutaku<strong>wa</strong>po dhiki kub<strong>wa</strong>, ambayo haijatokea namna <strong>ya</strong>ke tangu<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu hata sasa, <strong>wa</strong>la haitaku<strong>wa</strong>po kamwe (Mathayo 24: 15, 21)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 - Utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Hekalu Takatifu Zaidi na M<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> Hukumu Mbinguni.<br />

1810 Siku / Miaka - Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Yesu Kristo kama Kuhani wetu Mkuu katika Hekalu la<br />

Mbinguni. 14 Basi, i<strong>wa</strong>po tunaye kuhani mkuu aliyeingia katika mbingu, Yesu, M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, na tu<strong>ya</strong>shike sana maungamo yetu. 15 K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> hamna kuhani mkuu asiyeweza<br />

kuchukuana nasi katika mambo yetu <strong>ya</strong> udhaifu; bali yeye alijaribi<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na sisi<br />

katika mambo yote, bila kufan<strong>ya</strong> dhambi. 16 Basi na tukikaribie kiti cha neema k<strong>wa</strong> ujasiri,<br />

ili tupewe rehema, na kupata neema <strong>ya</strong> kutusaidia <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mahitaji (Waebrania 4:14-16).<br />

Kuvumbua Oroza <strong>ya</strong> Wakati <strong>wa</strong> Unabii<br />

134


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Miller akaendelea na uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> usiku wote pamoja na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mchana zikatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> majifunzo ambayo sasa <strong>ya</strong>lionekana ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maana<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong>. Katika sura <strong>ya</strong>nane <strong>ya</strong> Danieli hakuweza kupata dalili k<strong>wa</strong> mahali halisi pa kuanzia<br />

siku 2300; malaika Gabrieli, inga<strong>wa</strong> aliagiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamisha Danieli njozi, akamupa tu<br />

sehemu <strong>ya</strong> maelezo. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu mateso <strong>ya</strong> kutisha ilifaa kuanguka juu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

haikufunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njozi <strong>ya</strong> nabii, hakuweza kuvumilia tena. Danieli “akazimia, na<br />

kugonj<strong>wa</strong> siku chache.” “Nikashangaa k<strong>wa</strong> maono,” akasema, “lakini hakuna<br />

aliye<strong>ya</strong>fahamu.” Danieli 8:27.<br />

Lakini Mungu akaagiza mjumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke, “Fahamisha mtu huyu maono.” K<strong>wa</strong> kutii,<br />

malaika akarudi k<strong>wa</strong> Danieli, kusema: “Nimekuja sasa ili nikupe akili upate kufahamu ...<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii ele<strong>wa</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> na kufahamu maono.” Jambo moja la maana katika sura<br />

<strong>ya</strong> 8 liliach<strong>wa</strong> bila kufasiri<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong>ani, siku 2300; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo malaika, k<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea na<br />

maelezo <strong>ya</strong>ke, akaeleza sana juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati:<br />

“Mda <strong>wa</strong> majuma makumi saba umeamri<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko na juu <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

mtakatifu... Ujue basi na kufahamu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> tangu kuwek<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> kutengeneza na<br />

kujenga Yerusalema hata mupakali<strong>wa</strong>, masi<strong>ya</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> majuma saba na majuma<br />

makumi sita na mawili; njia kuu itajeng<strong>wa</strong> tena, na ukuta, hata katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati za taabu. Na<br />

nyuma <strong>ya</strong> majuma makumi sita na majuma mawili massiah atakatali<strong>wa</strong> mbali, lakini ni<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe: ... Naye atafan<strong>ya</strong> agano la nguvu pamoja na wengi k<strong>wa</strong> juma moja: na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma atakomesha kafara na toleo.” Danieli 8:16; 9:22,23, 24-27.<br />

Malaika alitum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Danieli k<strong>wa</strong> kueleza jambo aliloshind<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu “Hata<br />

mangaribi na asubui <strong>ya</strong> siku elfu mbili mia tatu; ndipo Pahali patakatifu patasafish<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Maneno <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> malaika ni ha<strong>ya</strong>, “Mda <strong>wa</strong> majuma makumi saba umeamri<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko na juu <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>ko.” Neno umeamri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> halisi maana <strong>ya</strong>ke “atakatili<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbali.” Majuma makumi saba, miaka 490, ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kukatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali kuwek<strong>wa</strong> kando k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi.<br />

Mda <strong>wa</strong> N<strong>ya</strong>kati Mbili Zilianza Pamoja<br />

Lakini kukatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali k<strong>wa</strong> nini? Hivi siku 2300 ziliku<strong>wa</strong> ni mda tu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

uliotaj<strong>wa</strong> katika sura 8, majuma makumi saba <strong>ya</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> basi ku<strong>wa</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> siku 2300.<br />

N<strong>ya</strong>kati mbili hizo zinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuanza pamoja, majuma makumi saba tangu “kuwek<strong>wa</strong> amri”<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutengeneza na kujenga Yerusalema. Kama tarehe <strong>ya</strong> amri hii ingeweza kupatikana,<br />

ndiyo ingeku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> uhakika <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300.<br />

Katika sura <strong>ya</strong> saba <strong>ya</strong> Ezra amri inapatikana, ilitole<strong>wa</strong> na Artasasta, mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Persia,<br />

katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 457 B.C. Wafalme <strong>wa</strong>tatu katika kuanzisha na kutimiza amri, <strong>wa</strong>kaifan<strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> utimilivu uliotaki<strong>wa</strong> na unabii k<strong>wa</strong> kutia alama <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 2300. Kukamata<br />

miaka 457 B.C., <strong>wa</strong>kati amri ilipotimia, kama tarehe <strong>ya</strong> “amri”, kila hatu<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> majuma<br />

makumi saba ikaonekana katika kutimilika. (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

135


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea k<strong>wa</strong> kutengeneza na kujenga Yerusalema hata Masi<strong>ya</strong> Mfalme itaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

majuma saba, na majuma makumi sita na mawili”majuma makumi sita na kenda, ao miaka<br />

483. Amri <strong>ya</strong> Artasasta ikatendeka katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 457 B.C. Kutoka<br />

tarehe hii, miaka 483 ikafikia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 27 A.D. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule<br />

unabii huu ukatimilika. Katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 27 A.D.Kristo akabatiz<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Yoane na akapak<strong>wa</strong> mafuta <strong>ya</strong> Roho. Baada <strong>ya</strong> ubatizo <strong>wa</strong>ke akaenda Galila<strong>ya</strong>, “akihubiri<br />

Habari njema <strong>ya</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu akisema: Wakati umetimia.” Marko 1:14, 15.<br />

Habari Njema Imetole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Ulimwenguni<br />

“Naye ataimarisha na wengi muda <strong>wa</strong> juma moja” mwisho <strong>wa</strong> miaka saba <strong>ya</strong> mda<br />

ulioga<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 27 A.D. hata A.D. 34,<br />

Kristo na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kaeneza m<strong>wa</strong>liko <strong>wa</strong> Habari Njema zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi.<br />

Agizo la Mwokozi liliku<strong>wa</strong>: “Musiende katika njia <strong>ya</strong> Mataifa, <strong>wa</strong>la musiingie mji wo wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Wasamaria; lakini zaidi kwendeni k<strong>wa</strong> kondoo <strong>wa</strong>potevu za nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Israeli.” Matayo<br />

10:5, 6.<br />

“Na k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma atakomesha sadaka na toleo.” Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka A.D. 31,miaka tatu<br />

na nusu baada <strong>ya</strong> ubatizo <strong>wa</strong>ke, B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu alisulibish<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> kafara kub<strong>wa</strong> iliyotole<strong>wa</strong><br />

kule Golgota, mfano ukakutana na kilicho asili <strong>ya</strong> mfano. Kafara zote na sadaka za ka<strong>wa</strong>ida<br />

za ibada zilipash<strong>wa</strong> kukomesh<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Miaka 490 iliyoga<strong>wa</strong>nyi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi ikamalizika katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka A.D. 34. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ule, k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> tendo la Baraza (Sanhedrin) la Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, taifa likatia mhuri <strong>wa</strong><br />

kukataa injili k<strong>wa</strong> kifo cha Stefano na mateso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Ndipo ujumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

wokovu ukatole<strong>wa</strong> ulimwenguni. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong>kalazimish<strong>wa</strong> na mateso kukimbia toka<br />

Yerusalema, “<strong>wa</strong>kakwenda pahali po pote <strong>wa</strong>kihubiri neno.” Matendo 8:4.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo maelezo yote <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>ya</strong>katimia k<strong>wa</strong> ajabu sana. M<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong><br />

majuma makumi saba ukaimarish<strong>wa</strong> bila s<strong>wa</strong>li lo lote k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 457 B.C., na kumalizika<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>yo katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka A.D. 34. Majuma makumi saba (siku 490) kukat<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> 2300,<br />

hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> siku 1810 zilizobakia. Baada <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 490, siku 1810 zilipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutimia. Kutoka A.D. 34, miaka 1810 ikafika k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo siku 2300 za<br />

Danieli 8:14 zikamalizika katika 1844. K<strong>wa</strong> kumalizika k<strong>wa</strong> mda kub<strong>wa</strong> huu <strong>wa</strong> unabii,<br />

“Pahali patakatifu patasafish<strong>wa</strong>”--ambaye <strong>wa</strong>fafanisi wengi zaidi <strong>wa</strong>nachangan<strong>ya</strong> na kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili--kukaimarish<strong>wa</strong>. (Tazama chart, p. 220.)<br />

Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Kuhofisha<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo Miller haku<strong>wa</strong> na matumaini hata kidogo <strong>ya</strong> kufikia mwisho ambao sasa<br />

alifikia. Yeye mwenyewe aliweza k<strong>wa</strong> shida sana kusadiki matokeo <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Lakini ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> pembeni.<br />

136


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1818 akafikia hakika maalum k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika miaka makumi mawili na<br />

tano karibu Kristo angeonekana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Si hitaji kusema,”<br />

akasema Miller, “juu <strong>ya</strong> furaha ambayo inajaa moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ngu kuhusu maoni <strong>ya</strong><br />

matazamio <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza sana, <strong>wa</strong>la <strong>ya</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> bidii <strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

ushirika katika furaha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong>... Aa, kweli <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nga na utukufu <strong>ya</strong> namna<br />

gani iliyotokea! ...<br />

“S<strong>wa</strong>li likaja nyumbani k<strong>wa</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu nyingi kuhusu habari <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwengu, katika maoni <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda ambao ulihusu roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu mwenyewe.” Hakuweza<br />

lakini kufikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>ke kutoa k<strong>wa</strong> wengine nuru ambayo aliyoipata.<br />

Alitazamia upinzani k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siomcha Mungu, lakini aliku<strong>wa</strong> na tumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>tafurahi katika tumaini la kukutana na Mwokozi. Alisita kufundisha juu <strong>ya</strong> wokovu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> utukufu, upesi` kutimilika, isiwe angeku<strong>wa</strong> katika kosa na kukosesha wengine. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

hiyo akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kukumbusha na kufikiri k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu magumu yote ambayo ilionekana<br />

yenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Miaka tano <strong>ya</strong> kujifunza ikamletea kusadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> usahihi <strong>wa</strong><br />

musimamo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

“Wende na Ulihubiri k<strong>wa</strong> Uiimwengu”<br />

“Wakati niliku<strong>wa</strong> katika kazi zangu,” akasema, “nikasikia sauti kukariri katika masikio<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu, `Wende na uambie ulimwengu hatari <strong>ya</strong>o.’ Maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kitokea daima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ngu: `Wakati ninapom<strong>wa</strong>mbia mwovu; kama mwovu Ee mwovu, hakika utakufa, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

husemi kuon<strong>ya</strong> mwovu aache njia <strong>ya</strong>ke; mwovu yule atakufa katika uovu <strong>wa</strong>ke, lakini damu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke nitaitaka mkononi m<strong>wa</strong>ko.’ Nikaona kama mwovu angeweza kuony<strong>wa</strong>, wengi<br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>ngalitubu; na kama ha<strong>wa</strong>kuony<strong>wa</strong>, damu <strong>ya</strong>o ingeweza kutak<strong>wa</strong><br />

mkononi m<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Maneno <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kimrudia k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong>ke: “Wende na ulihubiri k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwenguni; damu <strong>ya</strong>o nitaitaka mkononi m<strong>wa</strong>ko.” Akangoja mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka tisa, mzigo<br />

ulizidi kulemea k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke, hata katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1831 yeye k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi akatoa sababu za imani <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Aliku<strong>wa</strong> sasa na miaka makumi tano, hakuzoea kusema mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi, lakini<br />

kazi zake zikabariki<strong>wa</strong>. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>kafuat<strong>wa</strong> na m<strong>wa</strong>musho <strong>wa</strong> dini.<br />

Jamaa kumi na tatu isipoku<strong>wa</strong> tofauti <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>wili,zilitubu. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> akilazimish<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuhubiri k<strong>wa</strong> mahali pengine, na karibu pahali pote wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kigeuka.<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>liamsh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> utakaso mkub<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kubali mambo <strong>ya</strong> dini na makafiri (<strong>wa</strong>sioamini) <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maarifa <strong>ya</strong><br />

ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Biblia. Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kaamsha akili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na kuzuia mambo <strong>ya</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong><br />

kidunia <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kikua na <strong>ya</strong> kutamanisha maisha.<br />

Katika mahali pengi makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti karibu aina zote <strong>wa</strong>kamfungulia k<strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

na mialiko mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara ikaja kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>huduma. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> desturi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kutotumika<br />

mahali <strong>wa</strong>sipom<strong>wa</strong>lika, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> upesi akajiona mwenyewe hawezi kutimiza hata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

nusu <strong>ya</strong> mialiko iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> ikimfikia. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hakika na ukaribu <strong>wa</strong><br />

137


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo na mahitaji <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha. Katika miji mikub<strong>wa</strong> mingine, wenye<br />

duka <strong>ya</strong> vileo vikali na <strong>wa</strong>kageuza duka zao ku<strong>wa</strong> vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> mikutano; nyumba za<br />

michezo <strong>ya</strong> kamari zikavunj<strong>wa</strong>; makafiri na hata na <strong>wa</strong>potovu <strong>wa</strong>lioach<strong>wa</strong> wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kabadilika. Mikutano <strong>ya</strong> maombi ikaanzish<strong>wa</strong> na makanisa mbali-mbali karibu kila saa,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>chuuzi <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> jua kali k<strong>wa</strong> kuomba na kusifu. Hapo hapaku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si <strong>wa</strong> kupita kiasi. Kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama ile <strong>ya</strong> Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza ikaamsha zamiri<br />

kuliko kuchocheza tamaa tu.<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1833 Miller akapokea ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kuhubiri k<strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Baptiste. Hesabu<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>huduma <strong>wa</strong> kanisa lake <strong>wa</strong>kakubali kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke; iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni k<strong>wa</strong> ukubali <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong><br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida ambao akaendelea na kazi zake. Akasafiri na kuhubiri bila kukoma, bila kupokea<br />

mali <strong>ya</strong> kutosha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> gharama <strong>ya</strong> kusafiri k<strong>wa</strong> mahali alipoalik<strong>wa</strong>, hivi kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote iliku<strong>wa</strong> kodi nzito k<strong>wa</strong> mali <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

“Nyota Zitaanguka”<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1833 ishara za mwisho zikaonekana zilizoahidi<strong>wa</strong> na Mwokozi kama<br />

dalili <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili: “Nyota zitaanguka toka mbinguni.” Na Yoane katika<br />

Ufunuo akasema, “Na nyota za mbinguni zikaanguka juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia kama vile mtini<br />

unavyotupa matunda mabichi <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>kati unapotikis<strong>wa</strong> na upepo mkub<strong>wa</strong>.” Matayo 24:29;<br />

Ufunuo 6:13. Unabii huu ulipata utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> kushangaza katika wingi <strong>wa</strong> vimondo (nyota<br />

ipitayo upesi mbinguni) v<strong>ya</strong> Novemba 13, 1833, ni tamasha <strong>ya</strong> kushangaza <strong>ya</strong> nyota<br />

ambayo historia hulinda kumbukumbu <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Kamwe mvua haikuanguka tena kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuliko vimondo vilivyoanguka juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia; mashariki, mangaribi, kaskazini na kusini,<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> namna moja. Katika neno moja, mbinguni pote kulionekana katika mwendo...<br />

Tangu saa nane hata asubui, mbingu ku<strong>wa</strong> bila mawingu kabisa na kweupe, mwendo <strong>wa</strong><br />

daima <strong>wa</strong> miangaza yenye kungaa <strong>ya</strong> ajabu ikalind<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni mwote.”<br />

Ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba nyota zote za mbinguni zilipatana kukutana pahali pa karibu pa<br />

opeo, na ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikiendelea kurush<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule ule, k<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong> umeme, k<strong>wa</strong> pande<br />

zote za upeo <strong>wa</strong> macho; na huku hazikuisha--maelfu k<strong>wa</strong> upesi katika njia za maelfu, kama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba ziliumb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> tukio lile.” “Picha halisi zaidi <strong>ya</strong> mtini kuangusha tini zake<br />

zinapopeperush<strong>wa</strong> na upepo <strong>wa</strong> nguvu, ndiyo si vyepesi kueleza tukio hili.”<br />

Katika gazeti la biashara la New York la tarehe 14, Novemba 1833, kukatokea nakala<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili; “Hakuna mtu <strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> elimu zote (philosophe) <strong>wa</strong>la m<strong>wa</strong>limu<br />

aliyetoa habari <strong>wa</strong>la kuandika tukio, nina<strong>wa</strong>za, kama lile la jana asubui. Nabii miaka elfu<br />

moja mia nane iliyopita akaitabiri sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong>, kama tuki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hatari <strong>ya</strong> kufahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> nyota hakika ni kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> nyota,... katika maana <strong>ya</strong> pekee k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

inawezekana k<strong>wa</strong> kweli.”<br />

Ndivyo ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> onyesho la dalili zile za kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, kuhusu habari ambazo Yesu<br />

aliambia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke: “Wakati munapoona maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> yote, mjue <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> yeye ni<br />

138


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

karibu, hata k<strong>wa</strong> milango.” Matayo 24:33. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lioshuhudia kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> nyota<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likutazama kama mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> hukumu ijayo.<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1840 utimilizo kub<strong>wa</strong> mwingine <strong>wa</strong> unabii ukaamsha usikizi <strong>wa</strong> mahali<br />

pengi. Miaka miwili mbele, Josiah Litch akatangaza habari <strong>ya</strong> Ufunuo 9, kutabiri kuanguka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Ottoman “Katika A.D. 1840, siku moja katika mwezi <strong>wa</strong> Agosti.” Siku<br />

chache tu mbele <strong>ya</strong> kutimilika k<strong>wa</strong>ke akaandika: “Itamalizika k<strong>wa</strong> tarehe 11 <strong>ya</strong> Agosti,<br />

1840, <strong>wa</strong>kati mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Ottoman katika Constantinople kuweza kutazami<strong>wa</strong> kuvunjika.”<br />

Maonyo Yalitimilika<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati kabisa uliotaj<strong>wa</strong>, Turkey ilikubali ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka za mapatano <strong>ya</strong> Ula<strong>ya</strong><br />

na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ikajitia yenyewe chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> mataifa <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo. Jambo k<strong>wa</strong> halisi<br />

kweli likatimiliza ukashiri. (Tazama Nyongezo.) Watu wengi <strong>wa</strong>lisadikish<strong>wa</strong> na kanuni za<br />

maelezo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>ya</strong>liyokubali<strong>wa</strong> na Miller na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Watu wenye elimu na cheo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajiunga pamoja na Miller katika kuhubiri na kutangaza maonyo <strong>ya</strong>ke. Tangu 1840 hata<br />

1844 kazi ikaenea k<strong>wa</strong> upesi.<br />

William Miller aliku<strong>wa</strong> na akili za kich<strong>wa</strong> cha nguvu, na akaongeza k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> hekima <strong>ya</strong><br />

mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> kujiunga mwenyewe na Chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> hekima. Aliamuru heshima po pote,<br />

ukamilifu na tabia njema vilitumi<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> damani unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> Kikristo, aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

muangalifu na mpole k<strong>wa</strong> wote, ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kusikiliza wengine na kupima mabishano <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Alijaribu maelezo yote k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu, na ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke halisi na maarifa <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko vikamwezesha kukanusha makosa.<br />

Lakini, kama pamoja na Watengenezaji <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, kweli alizoonyesha hazikukubali<strong>wa</strong><br />

na <strong>wa</strong>limu wengi <strong>wa</strong> dini. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ha<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kudumisha hali <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Maandiko, <strong>wa</strong>karejea k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, ha<strong>ya</strong> kiasili cha Wababa. Lakini Neno la<br />

Mungu liliku<strong>wa</strong> ni ushuhuda pekee uliokubali<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu.<br />

Cheko na zarau vilitumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> adui katika kusingizia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotazamia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha juu <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kijitahidi kuishi maisha takatifu na<br />

kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha wengine k<strong>wa</strong> kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Ilifanyika kuonyesha zambi k<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo na mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo kazi <strong>ya</strong> mapadri <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu wengi ikapunguza imani katika Neno la Mungu. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kafan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kutoku<strong>wa</strong> Waaminifu, na wengi <strong>wa</strong>kajiruhusu k<strong>wa</strong> kutembea k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Halafu <strong>wa</strong>tenda maovu <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>ya</strong>weka yote juu <strong>ya</strong> Waadventisti.<br />

Inga<strong>wa</strong> Miller akavuta makundi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sikilizi wenye akili, jina lake lilitaj<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> shida<br />

na magazeti <strong>ya</strong> dini isipoku<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> cheko ao mashitaki. Waovu, <strong>wa</strong>liposukum<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> dini, <strong>wa</strong>kakimbilia k<strong>wa</strong> mabisho <strong>ya</strong> matukano juu <strong>ya</strong>ke na kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Mzee huyu<br />

mwenye imvi aliyeacha makao <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza k<strong>wa</strong> kusafiri k<strong>wa</strong> garama <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mwenyewe kuletea dunia onyo kub<strong>wa</strong> la hukumu inayokaribia akasitaki<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

upumbavu.<br />

139


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Usikivu na Kutokuamini<br />

Usikivu ukaendelea kuongezeka. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> makumi mawili na mamia, makutano<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kaongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> maelfu mengi. Lakini baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati, upinzani ulionekana juu <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liogeuka, makanisa <strong>ya</strong>kaanza kuchukua hatua za kutiisha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokubali maoni <strong>ya</strong><br />

Miller. Jambo hili likaita jibu k<strong>wa</strong> kalamu <strong>ya</strong>ke: “Kama tunaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kosefu nina<strong>wa</strong>omba<br />

mtuonyeshe k<strong>wa</strong> namna gani kosa letu linaku<strong>wa</strong> kutoka katika neno la Mungu; tulichek<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutosha; na ile haiwezi kutusadikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba tunaku<strong>wa</strong> katika kosa; Neno la Mungu<br />

pekee linaweza kugeuza maoni yetu. Hukumu yetu ilifanyika k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi pamoja na<br />

maombi, kama tulivyoona ushuhuda katika Maandiko.”<br />

Wakati uovu <strong>wa</strong>mbele <strong>ya</strong> garika ulipomsukuma Mungu kuleta garika duniani, k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

aka<strong>wa</strong>julisha kusudi lake. K<strong>wa</strong> miaka 120 likasiki<strong>wa</strong> onyo k<strong>wa</strong> kutubu. Lakini<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>kuliamini. Wakazarau mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Kama ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Noa uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli,<br />

sababu gani <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong> dunia ha<strong>wa</strong>kuuona na kuuamini? Tendo la kudai haki la mtu<br />

mmoja kupinga hekima <strong>ya</strong> maelfu! Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuamini onyo <strong>wa</strong>la kutafuta kimbilio<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> safina.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> zarau <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndamano usiobadilika <strong>wa</strong> majira, mbingu za<br />

rangi <strong>ya</strong> samawi zisizonyesha mvua kamwe. Katika zarau <strong>wa</strong>katangaza mhubiri <strong>wa</strong> haki<br />

kama mwenye juhudi <strong>ya</strong> kishenzi. Wakaenda zao, kujikaza zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> njia zao mbovu kuliko<br />

mbele. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliotaj<strong>wa</strong> Hukumu za Mungu zikaanguka juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokataa<br />

huruma <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Wenye Mashaka na Wasioamini<br />

Kristo alisema k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama vile <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> siku za Noa “ha<strong>wa</strong>kujua hata garika ilipokuja<br />

na ku<strong>wa</strong>ondosha wote; ndivyo kutakavyoku<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.” Matayo 24:39.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>napojiunga pamoja na dunia, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

anasa <strong>ya</strong> dunia inaku<strong>wa</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, <strong>wa</strong>kati wote <strong>wa</strong>napotazamia miaka nyingi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mafanikio <strong>ya</strong> kidunia--ndipo, k<strong>wa</strong> gafula kama nuru <strong>ya</strong> umeme, utakuja mwisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> uongo. Kama vile Mungu alivyotuma mtumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kuon<strong>ya</strong> dunia<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Garika, ndivyo alivyotuma <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>liochaguli<strong>wa</strong> kujulisha ukaribu <strong>wa</strong><br />

hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho. Na kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Noa <strong>wa</strong>lichekelea k<strong>wa</strong> kuzarau ubashiri<br />

<strong>wa</strong> muhubiri <strong>wa</strong> haki, ndivyo hivyo katika siku za Miller wengi kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojidai<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kachekelea maneno <strong>ya</strong> maonyo.<br />

Hapo hapaku<strong>wa</strong> tena na ushahidi <strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong>kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba makanisa <strong>ya</strong>litoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuliko machukio <strong>ya</strong>liyoamsh<strong>wa</strong> na ujumbe huu uliotum<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kuja <strong>wa</strong>liona k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kukamata msimamo.<br />

“Mambo <strong>ya</strong> umilele <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o kitu cha kweli. Mbingu ililet<strong>wa</strong> karibu, na <strong>wa</strong>lijiona <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa mbele za Mungu.”<br />

140


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> kuona k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kati uliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu, mambo <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutendea wenzao <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> kufany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upesi. Umilele ulionekana kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> mbele<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu alitoa uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> miito <strong>ya</strong>o kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Maisha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> siku k<strong>wa</strong> siku iliku<strong>wa</strong> mi laumu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>siotakas<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong> katika furaha <strong>ya</strong>o, kutafuta feza, na tamaa <strong>ya</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> heshima <strong>ya</strong> kidunia. Ndipo <strong>wa</strong>kapinga imani <strong>ya</strong> kiadventisti.<br />

Wapinzani <strong>wa</strong>kajitahidi kupinga uchunguzi k<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liti<strong>wa</strong> muhuri. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>kafuata n<strong>ya</strong>yo za <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma.<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>kadai k<strong>wa</strong>mba sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko matakatifu--<strong>ya</strong>le<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nayotoa nuru k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu, sehemu ile inayofaa zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati wetu,<br />

haikuweza kufahamika. Wachungaji <strong>wa</strong>kasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba Danieli na Ufunuo viliku<strong>wa</strong> vitabu<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> siri isiyoweza kufahamika k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu.<br />

Lakini Kristo aliongoza <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> nabii Danieli, “Yeye<br />

anayesoma afahamu.” Matayo 24:15. Na kitabu cha Ufunuo kinapas<strong>wa</strong> kufahamika.<br />

“Ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo aliope<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu aonyeshe <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyopas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> upesi... Heri anayesoma nao <strong>wa</strong>naosikia maneno <strong>ya</strong> unabii huu, na<br />

kushika maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke; k<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>wa</strong>kati ni karibu.” Ufunuo 1:1-3,<br />

matoleo <strong>ya</strong> herufi za italics.<br />

“Heri anayesoma” kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>le ha<strong>wa</strong>tasoma; na “nao <strong>wa</strong>naosikia” hapo kuna<br />

wengine <strong>wa</strong>naokataa kusikia kitu cho chote juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii; “na kusikia maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke” wengi <strong>wa</strong>nakataa kusikia mafundisho katika Ufunuo; hakuna<br />

kati <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> anayeweza kudai mibaraka iliyoahidi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Namna gani <strong>wa</strong>tu husubutu kusingizia k<strong>wa</strong>mba Ufunuo ni siri inayopita fahamu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nadamu? Ni siri iliyofunuli<strong>wa</strong>, kitabu kilichofunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Ufunuo unaongoza ma<strong>wa</strong>zo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Danieli. Wote <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>naonyesha mafundisho makub<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> historia <strong>ya</strong> dunia. Yoane aliona hatari, vita, na kukombole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Aliandika mambo <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> mwisho unaopasa kukamilisha mavuno<br />

<strong>ya</strong> dunia, au k<strong>wa</strong> gala la mbinguni au k<strong>wa</strong> moto <strong>wa</strong> uharibifu, ili <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naogeuka kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> hata k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>weze kufundish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> hatari na mapigano <strong>ya</strong>nayo ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Sababu gani, basi, juu <strong>ya</strong> ujinga huu unaoenea sana juu <strong>ya</strong> sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> hii <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko matakatifu? Ni matokeo <strong>ya</strong> juhudi iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mfalme <strong>wa</strong> giza k<strong>wa</strong> kuficha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>nayofunua madanganyifu <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii, Kristo B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo huu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuona mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati vita juu <strong>ya</strong> fundisho la Ufunuo, akatangaza baraka k<strong>wa</strong> wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takaoweza kusoma, kusikia, na kushika unabii.<br />

141


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 19. Sababu gani Uchungu Mkub<strong>wa</strong> Ule?<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu huonyesha m<strong>wa</strong>ka k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, mfano <strong>wa</strong> kutisha kila matengenezo<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> ao mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> dini. Kanuni za matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kuhusu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamoja daima. Mabadiliko makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> sasa <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na uhusiano na <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

uliopita, na maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kanisa katika vizazi v<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na mafundisho k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati wetu.<br />

Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> upekee huongoza <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke duniani katika<br />

kuepeleka mbele kazi <strong>ya</strong> wokovu. Watu ni vyombo katika mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> kila<br />

chombo kulitole<strong>wa</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong> kutosha k<strong>wa</strong> kumwezesha kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi aliyope<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong>. Lakini hakuna mtu kamwe aliyefikia ufahamu kamili <strong>wa</strong> kusudi la Mungu katika<br />

kazi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>fahamu kabisa katika uchukuzi <strong>wa</strong>ke wote<br />

ujumbe ambao <strong>wa</strong>naoutoa katika jina lake. Hata manabii ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu kabisa mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

ufunuo <strong>ya</strong>liyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o. Maana <strong>ya</strong> ufunuo iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kufunuli<strong>wa</strong> toka kizazi k<strong>wa</strong> kizazi.<br />

Petro anasema: “Katika habari za wokovu huu manabii <strong>wa</strong>litafuta na kuchunguza, <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liotabiri juu <strong>ya</strong> neema itakayo<strong>wa</strong>fikia ninyi; <strong>wa</strong>lichunguza nini ao <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> namna gani<br />

Roho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong>o ali<strong>wa</strong>onyesha <strong>wa</strong>kati aliposhuhudia mbele mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong>takayompata Kristo, na utukufu utakao <strong>ya</strong>fuata. Wakafunuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

wenyewe lakini ni k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu <strong>wa</strong>liohudumi<strong>wa</strong>.” 1 Petro 1:10-12, Ni sisi herufi<br />

tofauti(italics). Fundisho la namna gani k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu katika kizazi cha ukristo!<br />

Watu hao “<strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu” <strong>wa</strong>litafuta na kuchunguza “k<strong>wa</strong> bidii” k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

mafunuo zilizotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> vizazi inga<strong>wa</strong> viliku<strong>wa</strong> havijazali<strong>wa</strong> bado. Kemeo gani k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ukavu <strong>wa</strong> macho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>penda dunia ambayo <strong>wa</strong>natosheka kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

unabii ha<strong>ya</strong>wezi kufahami<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Si mara chache mafikara hata <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupofush<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> manebo <strong>ya</strong> asili na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo ambayo <strong>wa</strong>nashika k<strong>wa</strong> nusu tu mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyofunuli<strong>wa</strong> katika Neno la Mungu. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, hata <strong>wa</strong>kati Mwokozi aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

pamoja nao, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo la kupend<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wote juu <strong>ya</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> kama mfalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

mda aliyepash<strong>wa</strong> kuinua Israel; k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati wote. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kufahamu<br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liyotabiri mateso na mauti <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

“Wakati Umetimia”<br />

Kristo ali<strong>wa</strong>tuma na ujumbe: “Wakati umetimia, ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ni karibu. Tubuni<br />

mukaamini Habari Njema.” Marko 1:15. Ujumbe ule uliku<strong>wa</strong> na msingi katika unabii <strong>wa</strong><br />

Danieli 9. ‘’Majuma makumi sita na tisa” <strong>ya</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kufikia k<strong>wa</strong> Mfalme na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litazamia mbele kuimarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> kule Yerusalema ili ata<strong>wa</strong>le juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

dunia yote nzima.<br />

142


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakahubiri habari iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o, inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>likosa kufahamu maana <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakati<br />

matangazo <strong>ya</strong>o msingi <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika Danieli 9:25, ha<strong>wa</strong>kuona katika shairi lililofuata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Masi<strong>ya</strong> alipash<strong>wa</strong> “kukatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali.” Mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o iliku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong><br />

uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kidunia; jambo hili likapofusha akili <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati kabisa <strong>wa</strong>lipotumainia kuona B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o kupanda k<strong>wa</strong> kiti enzi cha<br />

Dawidi, <strong>wa</strong>limwona akikat<strong>wa</strong>, kupig<strong>wa</strong>, kuzihaki<strong>wa</strong>, na kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> msalaba.<br />

Kukata tamaa k<strong>wa</strong> namna gani na uchungu <strong>ya</strong>liumiza mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi!<br />

Kristo alikuja k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati halisi uliotabiri<strong>wa</strong>. Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>litimia katika habari yote.<br />

Neno na Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ilishuhudia agizo la M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke. Lakini mafikara <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lifunik<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka. Kama Yesu aliku<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>ngetumbukia katika<br />

sikitiko na uchungu? Hili ndilo s<strong>wa</strong>li lililotesa roho zao <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> saa za kukata tamaa za<br />

Sabato ile iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong> kifo chake nakufufuka k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuach<strong>wa</strong>. “Nikikaa katika giza, B<strong>wa</strong>na ataku<strong>wa</strong> nuru k<strong>wa</strong>ngu... Atanileta<br />

inje k<strong>wa</strong> nuru na nitatazama haki <strong>ya</strong>ke.” “K<strong>wa</strong> wenye haki nuru inangaa gizani.” “Nitafan<strong>ya</strong><br />

giza ku<strong>wa</strong> nuru mbele <strong>ya</strong>o; na pahali pa kupotoka patanyosh<strong>wa</strong>. Maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> nita<strong>wa</strong>fanyia,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la sita<strong>wa</strong>acha.” Mika 7:8, 9; Zaburi 112:4; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 42:16.<br />

Matangazo <strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> halisi “Wakati umetimia, ufalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu ni karibu.” “K<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati” majuma makumi sita na tisa <strong>ya</strong> Danieli 9<br />

ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kufikia k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>, “Mupakali<strong>wa</strong>”--Kristo alipokea mafuta <strong>ya</strong> Roho<br />

baada <strong>ya</strong> ubatizo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Yoane. “Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu” haiku<strong>wa</strong>, kama <strong>wa</strong>livyofundish<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuamini, ufalme <strong>wa</strong> kidunia. Wala ule ujao, ufalme <strong>wa</strong> milele ambao “na wote wenye<br />

mamlaka <strong>wa</strong>tamutumikia na kumutii.” Danieli 7:27.<br />

Neno hili “Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu” linatumi<strong>wa</strong> kutaja mambo yote mawili ufalme <strong>wa</strong> neema<br />

na ufalme <strong>wa</strong> utukufu Mtume anasema: “Basi, tukaribie kiti cha neema pasipo woga,” ili<br />

tupate huruma na kuona neema. Waebrania 4:16. Ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha ufalme kunaonyesha<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> ufalme. Kristo anatumia neno la “Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni” kutaja kazi <strong>ya</strong> neema<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo kiti cha utukufu kinaonyesha ufalme <strong>wa</strong> utukufu. Matayo<br />

25:31, 32. Ufalme huu ukingali <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao. Hautasimamish<strong>wa</strong> hata <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

Wakati Mwokozi alipotoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke na akalia k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>, “imekwisha,” ahadi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> wokovu iliyo fany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mme na mke wenye zambi katika Edeni ikatimilika. Ufalme<br />

<strong>wa</strong> neema, ambao uliku<strong>wa</strong>ko mbele k<strong>wa</strong> ahadi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ukaimarish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo kifo cha Kristo jambo ambalo <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>litazamia kama maangamizi <strong>ya</strong><br />

tumaini lao iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni milele k<strong>wa</strong> kweli. Wakati ilileta uchungu mkali, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ushahidi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba imani <strong>ya</strong>o iliku<strong>wa</strong> halisi. Jambo lililo<strong>wa</strong>tumbukiza katika kukata tamaa likafungua<br />

mlango <strong>wa</strong> tumaini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu wote <strong>wa</strong> Mungu katika vizazi vyote.<br />

143


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Zahabu safi <strong>ya</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Yesu ilichanganyika na msingi <strong>wa</strong><br />

tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> choyo. Maono <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>livut<strong>wa</strong> na kiti cha ufalme, taji, na utukufu. Kiburi<br />

chao cha moyo, kiu cha utukufu <strong>wa</strong> kidunia, vika<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kupita bila kujali maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mwokozi <strong>ya</strong> kuonyesha asili <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke, na kuonyesha zaidi kifo chake.<br />

Makosa ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liishia k<strong>wa</strong> jaribio ambalo liliruhusi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kusahihish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kutole<strong>wa</strong> Habari Njema <strong>ya</strong> utukufu <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o aliyefufuka.<br />

Ku<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> kazi hii, maarifa ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lionekana machungu sana <strong>ya</strong>liruhusi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kufufuka k<strong>wa</strong>ke Yesu akajionyeshea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke njiani kwenda<br />

Emausi, na, “aka<strong>wa</strong>elezea maana <strong>ya</strong> maneno yote <strong>ya</strong>liyo andik<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Iliku<strong>wa</strong> kusudi<br />

lake kukaza imani <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> “neno la kweli la unabii.” (Luka 24:27; 2 Petro 1:19). Si k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe tu, bali k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong> Agano la Kale. Na kama hatua<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kabisa katika kutoa maarifa ha<strong>ya</strong>, Yesu akaongoza <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi k<strong>wa</strong> “Musa na<br />

manabii wote” <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Agano la Kale.<br />

Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Kukata Tamaa na Kuelekea Uhakikisho Tumaini<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna kamilifu zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>kati wote <strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

“<strong>wa</strong>memwona, yule ambaye Musa katika sheria, na manabii, <strong>wa</strong>liandika, juu <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Mashaka, kukata tamaa, <strong>ya</strong>katoa nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> uhakikisho, k<strong>wa</strong> imani isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na wingu.<br />

Walipita katika jaribio kub<strong>wa</strong> lisiloawezekana na <strong>wa</strong>liona namna gani neno la Mungu<br />

lilipata ushindi k<strong>wa</strong> kutimilika. Toka sasa na kuendelea nikitu gani kingeweza kutisha imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o? Katika huzuni kali zaidi <strong>wa</strong>lipata “faraja yenye nguvu”, tumaini lililoku<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

“nanga <strong>ya</strong> roho, vyote viwili kweli na kusimama imara.” Waeb. 6:18, 19.<br />

Asema B<strong>wa</strong>na: “Watu <strong>wa</strong>ngu ha<strong>wa</strong>tapatish<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> kamwe.” “Kilio kinakawia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

usiku, lakini furaha asubui.” Yoeli 2:26; Zaburi 30:5. K<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> kufufuko k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kakutana na Mwokozi, na mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o ika<strong>wa</strong>ka ndani <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kabla <strong>ya</strong> kupanda k<strong>wa</strong>ke, Yesu aka<strong>wa</strong>agiza, “Kwendeni katika<br />

duniani pote, mukahubiri Habari Njema,” akaongeza “Na tazama, mimi ni pamoja nanyi<br />

siku zote.” Marko 16:15; Matayo 28:20. K<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> Pentekote Mufariji aliyeahidi<strong>wa</strong><br />

akashuka, na roho za <strong>wa</strong>aminifu zikasisimka na k<strong>wa</strong> kuona ku<strong>wa</strong>po k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

aliyepanda (mbinguni).<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Wanafunzi Ulilinganish<strong>wa</strong> na Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> 1844<br />

Maarifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na sehemu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke katika maarifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotangaza kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Kama vile<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>livyohubiri, “Wakati umetimia, ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ni karibu,’‘ vilevile Miller<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>litangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba mda <strong>wa</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong> mwisho katika Biblia uliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

karibu kuisha, k<strong>wa</strong>mba hukumu iliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba ufalme <strong>wa</strong> milele ulipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuingiz<strong>wa</strong>. Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi k<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati <strong>ya</strong>lisimamia juu <strong>ya</strong> majuma<br />

makumi saba <strong>ya</strong> Danieli 9. Ujumbe uliotole<strong>wa</strong> na Miller na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke ulitangaza<br />

144


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300 za Danieli 8:14, mahali ambamo majuma makumi saba <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Sehemu moja. Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> kila moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong>lisimamia juu <strong>ya</strong> utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> sehemu<br />

mbalimbali za mda <strong>wa</strong> unabii ule ule.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, William Miller na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu kabisa<br />

ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>liuochukua. Makosa <strong>ya</strong>liyoanzish<strong>wa</strong> mda mrefu katika kanisa <strong>ya</strong>kazuia maelezo<br />

sahihi <strong>ya</strong> jambo kub<strong>wa</strong> katika unabii. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, ijapo <strong>wa</strong>litangaza ujumbe ambao Mungu<br />

ali<strong>wa</strong>tolea, lakini katika kukosa kufahamu maana <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kateseka k<strong>wa</strong> kukata tamaa.<br />

Miller akaingiza maoni <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida k<strong>wa</strong>mba dunia ni “mahali patakatifu,” na akaamini<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba “kutakasika k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu” kulionyesha kutakasika k<strong>wa</strong> dunia na moto<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo, mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300, akazani, zilifunua <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

Kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu iliku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> na kuhani mkuu<br />

katika utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kufunga kazi <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho--kuondoa ao<br />

kuweka mbali zambi za Israeli. Ilionyesha picha la kufunga kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kuhani Mkuu wetu<br />

mbinguni katika kuondoa ao kufutia mbali zambi za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke zilizoandik<strong>wa</strong> katika vitabu<br />

mbinguni. Kazi hii inaleta uchunguzi, kazi <strong>ya</strong> hukumu, na inatangulia bila kukawia kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu, k<strong>wa</strong>ni atakapokuja kila jambo litaku<strong>wa</strong> limekwisha<br />

kukat<strong>wa</strong>. Asema Yesu: “Na mshahara <strong>wa</strong>ngu ni pamoja nami, kulipa kila mtu kama ilivyo<br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Ufunuo 22:12. Ni hii kazi <strong>ya</strong> hukumu inayotangaz<strong>wa</strong> na ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 14:7. “Ogopeni Mungu, na kumutukuza k<strong>wa</strong> maana saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja.”<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liotangaza onyo hili <strong>wa</strong>litoa ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati unaofaa. Namna<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu juu <strong>ya</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> kusimamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

“majuma makumi saba,” vivyo hivyo Waadventisti ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu habari <strong>ya</strong> jambo<br />

lililopash<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> “siku 2300.” Katika mambo mawili ha<strong>ya</strong> makosa<br />

inayopend<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi ikapofusha akili k<strong>wa</strong> kutojua ukweli. Wote <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>katimiza<br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa ujumbe aliotamani utolewe, na wote <strong>wa</strong>wili katika kukosa<br />

kufahamu maana <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kateseka k<strong>wa</strong> kukata tamaa.<br />

Lakini Mungu alitimiza kusudi lake katika kuruhusu onyo la hukumu kutole<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong>. Katika maongozi <strong>ya</strong>ke ujumbe uliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi na utakaso <strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa. Je, upendo <strong>wa</strong>o uliku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia ao juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na mbingu? Je <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kuacha tamaa zao mba<strong>ya</strong> za dunia na kukaribisha kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o?<br />

Uchungu vile ungechunguza mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojidai kupokea onyo. Je, <strong>wa</strong>ngetupilia<br />

mbali tumaini lao katika Neno la Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lipoit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuvumilia makemeo <strong>ya</strong> dunia na<br />

jaribu la kukawia na kukata tamaa? K<strong>wa</strong>ni ha<strong>wa</strong>kufahamu mara moja mambo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, je<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngetupa pembeni kweli iliyo kubali<strong>wa</strong> na ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong> Neno lake? Jaribu hili linge<br />

fundisha hatari <strong>ya</strong> kukubali maelezo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu baadala <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> Biblia mtafsiri <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

145


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mwenyewe. Watoto <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>wa</strong>ngeongoz<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza k<strong>wa</strong> bidii sana Neno, na<br />

kuchunguza k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu zaidi msingi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o, na kukataa kila kitu, hata<br />

kilikubali<strong>wa</strong> sana na Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> kidunia, kile kisichoku<strong>wa</strong> na msingi kutika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Maandiko.<br />

Kile ambacho katika saa <strong>ya</strong> taabu kilionekana giza baadaye kingewek<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Ijapoku<strong>wa</strong> taabu ilitokea k<strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>ngejifunza k<strong>wa</strong> maarifa <strong>ya</strong> mibaraka <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba B<strong>wa</strong>na ni ” Mwenye rehema sana, mwenye huruma”, k<strong>wa</strong>mba njia zote zake ni ”<br />

huruma na kweli k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naoshika agano lake na shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke.” Yakobo 5:11; Zaburi<br />

25:10. ” Hata mangaribi na asubui 2300: halafu Pahali patakatifu patasafish<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

146


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 20. Upendo k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

6 Uamsho mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> dini umetabiri<strong>wa</strong> katika ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong><br />

Ufunuo 14. Malaika moja ameonekana akiruka “katikati <strong>ya</strong> mbingu, mwenye Habari Njema<br />

<strong>ya</strong> milele, ahubiri k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, na kila taifa na kabila na lugha na jamaa.”<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>” akatangaza: “Ogopeni Mungu, na kumutukuza k<strong>wa</strong> maana saa <strong>ya</strong><br />

hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja. Mukam<strong>wa</strong>budu yeye aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> mbingu na dunia na bahari na<br />

chemchemi za maji.” Ufunuo 14:6,7.<br />

Malaika ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> tabia bora <strong>ya</strong> kazi inayopas<strong>wa</strong> kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ujumbe na uwezo na<br />

utukufu, ambavyo vinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuishugulikia. Kuruka k<strong>wa</strong> malaika “katikati <strong>ya</strong> Mbingu,”<br />

“sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>,” na matangazo <strong>ya</strong>ke “k<strong>wa</strong> kila taifa na kabila na lugha na jamaa” inatoa<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kuenea k<strong>wa</strong> upesi, katika dunia nzima k<strong>wa</strong> tendo. K<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ambao inapas<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika, inatangaza kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu.<br />

Ujumbe huu ni sehemu <strong>ya</strong> habari njema (injili) ambayo ingeweza kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> tu katika<br />

siku za mwisho, ambapo tu ndipo inaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> hatika k<strong>wa</strong>mba saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

imekuja. Sehemu ile <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong>ke ambao inaelekea k<strong>wa</strong> siku za mwisho, Danieli<br />

aliagiz<strong>wa</strong> kufunga na kutia muhuri “hata <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mwisho.” Danieli 12:4. Mpaka <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

huu ndipo ujumbe juu <strong>ya</strong> hukumu utangazwe, wenye msingi na kutimilika k<strong>wa</strong> unabii.<br />

Paulo alion<strong>ya</strong> kanisa lisitazamie kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika siku zake. Mpaka baada <strong>ya</strong> uasi<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> na uta<strong>wa</strong>la mrefu <strong>wa</strong> “mtu <strong>wa</strong> zambi” tunaweza kutazamia kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu.<br />

Tazama 2 Watesalonika 2:3. “Mtu <strong>wa</strong> zambi” vilevile “siri <strong>ya</strong> uasi,” “m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> uharibifu,”<br />

na “yule mwenye uovu,” ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> cheo cha Papa, ambacho kiliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kushikilia<br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> miaka 1260. Mda huu ulimalizika k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798. Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

hakungefanyika mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule. Paulo anaeneza onyo lake k<strong>wa</strong> ile inayohusu Wakristo<br />

wote hata k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798. K<strong>wa</strong> upande huu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule, ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

mara <strong>ya</strong> pili ukatangaz<strong>wa</strong>. Sivyo ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> namna ile haujatole<strong>wa</strong> kamwe k<strong>wa</strong> vizazi<br />

vilivyopita. Paulo, kama tulivyoona, hakuuhubiri; aliuweka mbali k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao ujumbe<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Watengenezaji ha<strong>wa</strong>kuutangaza. Martin Luther aliweka siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

hukumu karibu <strong>ya</strong> miaka 300 zijazo kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> siku zake. Lakini tangu 1798 kitabu cha<br />

Danieli kilifunuli<strong>wa</strong>, na wengi <strong>wa</strong>katangaza ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> hukumu ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu.<br />

Katika Inchi Mbalimbali k<strong>wa</strong> Wakati Moja<br />

Kama Matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na sita, Mwendo (kazi), la Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu<br />

likaonekana katika inchi mbalimbali k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati moja. Watu <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujifunza mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii na <strong>wa</strong>kaona ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kusadikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba mwisho uliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

karibu. Makundi mbali mbali <strong>ya</strong> Wakristo, k<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza Maandiko tu, <strong>wa</strong>kafikia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi kuliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu.<br />

147


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Miaka mitatu baada <strong>ya</strong> Miller kufikia k<strong>wa</strong> maelezo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii. Dr.<br />

Joseph Wolff, “Mjumbe k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu,” akaanza kutangaza kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na. Alizali<strong>wa</strong> katika Ujeremani, <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>ke Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> Kijana sana <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ule, akasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> kikristo. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> msikizi mwenye bidii<br />

sana k<strong>wa</strong> mazungumzo katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> baba <strong>ya</strong>ke mahali Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kikusanyika kila siku k<strong>wa</strong> kuzungumzia matumaini <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>o, utukufu <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Masi<strong>ya</strong>, na kuimarish<strong>wa</strong> tena k<strong>wa</strong> Israeli. Siku moja, kusikia Yesu <strong>wa</strong> Nazareti kutaj<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

kijana akauliza kujua aliku<strong>wa</strong> nani. “Mu<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong> talanta kub<strong>wa</strong> mno” <strong>wa</strong>kajibu” Lakini<br />

alipojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>, baraza la hukumu la Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi likamkatia hukumu <strong>ya</strong> kifo.”<br />

“Sababu gani,” akafuatisha mwenye kuuliza, “je, Yerusalema iliharibi<strong>wa</strong>, na sababu gani<br />

tunaku<strong>wa</strong> katika utum<strong>wa</strong>?”<br />

“Ole, ole,” akajibu baba <strong>ya</strong>ke, “k<strong>wa</strong> sababu Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>liua manabii.” Mara moja<br />

<strong>wa</strong>zo likaja moyoni m<strong>wa</strong> mtoto: “Pengine Yesu pia aliku<strong>wa</strong> vilevile nabii, na Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kamuua <strong>wa</strong>kati aliku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa.” Inga<strong>wa</strong> alikataz<strong>wa</strong> kuingia katika kanisa la Kikristo,<br />

akakawia mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara inje kusikiliza mahubiri. Alipoku<strong>wa</strong> na miaka saba tu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuzali<strong>wa</strong>, aliku<strong>wa</strong> akijisifu k<strong>wa</strong> jirani <strong>wa</strong>ke mkristo juu <strong>ya</strong> kushinda k<strong>wa</strong> Israel <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>. Mzee akasema k<strong>wa</strong> upole: “Kijana mpenzi, nitak<strong>wa</strong>mbia nani<br />

aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli: aliku<strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong> Nazareti,... ambaye <strong>wa</strong>babu <strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

<strong>wa</strong>limsulubisha... Wende nyumbani na usome sura <strong>ya</strong> makumi tano na tatu <strong>ya</strong> Isa<strong>ya</strong>, na<br />

utasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo ni M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.”<br />

Akaenda nyumbani na akasoma Maandiko. K<strong>wa</strong> ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong> namna gani ilitimilika<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong> Nazareti. Je, maneno <strong>ya</strong> mkristo yule ni <strong>ya</strong> haki? Kijana akauliza baba <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

maelezo <strong>ya</strong> unabii lakini akakutana na ukim<strong>ya</strong> bila huruma na hakusubutu tena kamwe<br />

kusema inayoelekea fundisho lile pamoja naye.<br />

Wakati alipoku<strong>wa</strong> na miaka kumi na moja tu <strong>ya</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong>, akaenda duniani kupata<br />

elimu, kuchagua dini <strong>ya</strong>ke na kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> maisha. Peke <strong>ya</strong>ke na bila senti hata moja,<br />

alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta njia yeye mwenyewe. Akajifunza k<strong>wa</strong> bidii, na kujisaidia mwenyewe<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mahitaji <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha Kiebrania. Akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kukubali imani <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma<br />

na akaenda kufuata mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke katika College <strong>ya</strong> “Propagande de la Foi” (kutangaza<br />

imani). Hapo akashambulia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi matumizi maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na akalazimisha<br />

matengenezo. Baada <strong>ya</strong> mda, akatosh<strong>wa</strong>. Ika<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuweza kamwe kulet<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutii utum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Akatangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu asiyeweza kusahihsh<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuach<strong>wa</strong> kwenda mahali palipompendeza. Akaenda Uingereza na akajiunga na kanisa la<br />

Uingereza. Baada <strong>ya</strong> miaka miwili <strong>ya</strong> majifunzo akaanza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1821.<br />

Wolff aliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii hutangaza kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili k<strong>wa</strong><br />

nguvu na utukufu. Alipotafuta kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong> Nazareti kama Ni yule<br />

aliyeahidi<strong>wa</strong>, ku<strong>wa</strong>onyesha kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kama kafara k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi, aka<strong>wa</strong>fundisha pia juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

148


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wolff aliamini kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu. Maelezo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kamfan<strong>ya</strong> kuzania kurudi huko kama tarehe iliyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> na Miller. “Je, B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu ...<br />

hakututolea ishara za <strong>wa</strong>kati, kusudi tupate kujua hata, kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, jinsi<br />

mmoja anavyojua kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> jua kali k<strong>wa</strong> mtini na kutoa majani <strong>ya</strong>ke?<br />

Inatosha ... itajulikana k<strong>wa</strong> ishara za <strong>wa</strong>kati, k<strong>wa</strong> kutushawishi kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, kama vile Noa alivyota<strong>ya</strong>risha safina.”<br />

Kupinga Maelezo <strong>ya</strong> Watu Wengi<br />

Kufuatana na namna <strong>wa</strong>tu wote<strong>wa</strong>livyo tafsiri ao kutambua Maandiko, Wolff akaandika:<br />

“Sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Kikristo imepotoka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> maana kamili <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko, na ... <strong>wa</strong>napofikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>naposoma habari <strong>ya</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu Mataifa,na <strong>wa</strong>naposoma Yerusalema, <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu kanisa;<br />

na kama inasem<strong>wa</strong> dunia, maana <strong>ya</strong>ke ni mbingu; na k<strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufahamu maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>ma v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe: na kupanda juu <strong>ya</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, maana <strong>ya</strong>ke ni mkutano <strong>wa</strong> kundi kub<strong>wa</strong> la <strong>wa</strong>methodistes.”<br />

Tangu miaka 1821 hata 1845, Wolff akasafiri katika Misri, Abisinia, Palestina, Syria,<br />

Persia, Bokhara, India, na Amerika.<br />

Uwezo katika Kitabu<br />

Dr. Wolff alisafiri katika inchi zilizoku<strong>wa</strong> za kishenzi kabisa bila ulinzi, k<strong>wa</strong> kuvumilia<br />

taabu na kuzunguuk<strong>wa</strong> na hatari nyingi. Akates<strong>wa</strong> bila chakula, na baridi, kuuz<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

mtum<strong>wa</strong>, mara tatu akakati<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> kifo, akavizi<strong>wa</strong> na wezi, na mara zingine karibu<br />

kufa k<strong>wa</strong> kiu cha maji. Mara moja akan<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong> vyote na akaach<strong>wa</strong> na kusafiri mwendo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mamia <strong>ya</strong>kilometres k<strong>wa</strong> miguu katika milima, teluji zikipiga katika uso <strong>wa</strong>ke na<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>nyo zisizo naviatu zikagandamiz<strong>wa</strong> na udongo <strong>wa</strong> baridi sana.<br />

Walipomshauria k<strong>wa</strong>mba si vema kusafiri bila silaha katika makabila yenye ukaidi na<br />

uadui, akasema mwenyewe “ku<strong>wa</strong> na silaha “maombi, bidii k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, na tumaini<br />

katika usaada <strong>wa</strong>ke.” “Nimejaz<strong>wa</strong> vilevile na upendo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na jirani <strong>wa</strong>ngu katika<br />

moyo <strong>wa</strong>ngu, na Biblia inaku<strong>wa</strong> mikononi m<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” “Nilisikia nguvu zangu ku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kitabu hiki, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke utanilinda.”<br />

Akavumilia mpaka <strong>wa</strong>kati ujumbe ungeweza kupelek<strong>wa</strong> katika sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu inayo kati<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, Turks, Parsis, Wahindi, na<br />

mataifa na makabila akaga<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu katika lugha mbalimbali, na mahali po<br />

pote akatangaza kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>. Katika safari <strong>ya</strong>ke huko Boukhari<br />

akakutana mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>ya</strong>kifundish<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokaa peke <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Waarabu <strong>wa</strong> Yemen, akasema, <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na kitabu kinachoit<strong>wa</strong> Seera, ambacho kina<br />

tangazo la kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili na ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> utukufu; na <strong>wa</strong>natazamia<br />

mambo makuu kutendeka katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1840.” “Nikakuta <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Israeli, <strong>wa</strong> kabila la<br />

149


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Dani, ... <strong>wa</strong>naotazamia, pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Rekabu, kufika k<strong>wa</strong> upesi k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> katika<br />

mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu.”<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong> namna moja ilipatikana k<strong>wa</strong> mjumbe mwengine katika Tartares. Padri mmoja<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Tartares akauiiza <strong>wa</strong>kati gani Kristo angekuja mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Wakati mjumbe<br />

(missionaire) alijibu, k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakujua kitu k<strong>wa</strong> jambo lile, padri akashangaa k<strong>wa</strong> ujinga <strong>wa</strong><br />

namna ile k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> Biblia, na akaeleza habari <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe, yeye<br />

msingi k<strong>wa</strong> unabii, k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo angekuja karibu m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844.<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Waadventisti katika Uingereza<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>nzoni <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1826 ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> kristo ukaanza kuhubiri<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

Uingereza. K<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida, tarehe kamili <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu haikufundish<strong>wa</strong>, lakini ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mwenye uwezo na utukufu ukatangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi. M<strong>wa</strong>ndishi<br />

mmoja <strong>wa</strong> Kingereza akasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba karibu <strong>wa</strong>huduma 700 <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Uingereza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lijitoa katika kuhubiri “habari njema hii <strong>ya</strong> ufalme.”<br />

Ujumbe ulioonyesha m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ukatole<strong>wa</strong> vilevile<br />

katika Uingereza. Maandiko juu <strong>ya</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> kurudi <strong>ya</strong>katangaz<strong>wa</strong> sana kutoka America.<br />

Katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1842 Robert Winter, Mwingereza aliyeamini kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu alipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

America, akarudi katika inchi <strong>ya</strong>ke na kutangaza habari <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Watu wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajiunga naye katika kazi ndani <strong>ya</strong> sehemu mbalimbali za Ungereza.<br />

Katika upande <strong>wa</strong> America <strong>ya</strong> kusini, Lacunza, “Jesuite” <strong>wa</strong> Espania, akakubali ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kristo kurudi upesi. Kutaka kuepuka karipio la Roma, akatangaza habari <strong>ya</strong>ke chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

jina la kujit<strong>wa</strong>lia la Rabbi-Ben-Ezra, akajionyesha mwenyewe kama Mu<strong>ya</strong>hudi aliyegeuka.<br />

Karibu <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1825 kitabu chake kitatafsiri<strong>wa</strong> katika Kiingereza. Kilitumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuongeza usikizi uliokwisha kuamsh<strong>wa</strong> katika Uingereza.<br />

Ufunuo Ukafunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Bengel<br />

Katika Ujeremani ujumbe huu ulifundish<strong>wa</strong> na Bengel, mhubiri <strong>wa</strong> kiLuther na<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> Biblia. Wakati alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akita<strong>ya</strong>risha mahubiri kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 21, nuru<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo mara <strong>ya</strong> pili ikaangaza katika mafikara <strong>ya</strong>ke. Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo<br />

ukafunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ufahamu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Alipofunik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukub<strong>wa</strong> na utukufu <strong>wa</strong> mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> na nabii, akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuacha fundisho hilo k<strong>wa</strong> mda. Katika mimbara<br />

fundisho hilo likamjia tena k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu. Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati ule akajitoa mwenyewe kujifunza<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii na k<strong>wa</strong> upesi akafikia k<strong>wa</strong> imani k<strong>wa</strong>mba kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

karibu. Tarehe ambayo aliyoiweka kama <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili kuliku<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

miaka michache karibu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule ambao Miller alitangaza baadaye.<br />

Maandiko <strong>ya</strong> Bengel <strong>ya</strong>kaenez<strong>wa</strong> katika jimbo lake mwenyewe la Wurtemberg na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sehemu zingine za Ujeremani. Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi ukasiki<strong>wa</strong> katika Ujeremani, na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati uleule ujumbe huo ukavuta uangalifu katika inchi zingine. Huko Geneve, Gaussen<br />

150


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

akahubiri ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Wakati alipoingia katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuhubiri akaelekea<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mashaka. Katika ujana <strong>wa</strong>ke akapendez<strong>wa</strong> na mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii. Baada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kusoma Ancient History <strong>ya</strong> Rollin, uangalifu <strong>wa</strong>ke uka<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sura <strong>ya</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong> Danieli.<br />

Akashangaz<strong>wa</strong> na namna unabii ulitimilika k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu. Hapa paliku<strong>wa</strong> na ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko. Hakuweza kudumu kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> na akili za kibinadamu, na katika<br />

kujifunza Biblia akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> hakika.<br />

Akafikia k<strong>wa</strong> imani k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na kuliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu. Alipovut<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

umuhimu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli huu, akakusudia kuupeleka mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Lakini imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wengi k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong> Danieli ha<strong>ya</strong>wezi kufahamika iliku<strong>wa</strong> kizuizi kikub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mwishowe akakusudia--kama vile Farel alivyofan<strong>ya</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke katika kuhubiri Genève--<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuanza na <strong>wa</strong>toto, k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>o akatumainia ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>tavut<strong>wa</strong>. Akasema,<br />

“Nikusan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji <strong>wa</strong>toto; kama kundi linaongezeka ku<strong>wa</strong>, kub<strong>wa</strong>, kama likionekana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>nasikiliza, <strong>wa</strong>napendez<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na usikizi, k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>nafahamu na<br />

kueleza fundisho, nina hakika ku<strong>wa</strong> na kundi la pili karibu, na <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>taona<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni faida <strong>ya</strong>o kukaa na kujifunza. Wakati jambo hili linapotendeka, ushindi<br />

utapatikana.”<br />

Alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akisema na <strong>wa</strong>toto, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaja kusikiliza. Vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> kanisa<br />

lake vikajaa na <strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> heshima na wenye elimu, na <strong>wa</strong>geni <strong>wa</strong> inchi zingine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kazuru Geneve. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ujumbe ukapelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sehemu zingine.<br />

Alipoti<strong>wa</strong> moyo, Gaussen akatangaza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke na matumaini <strong>ya</strong> kuanzisha<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> unabii. Baadaye aka<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>limu katika chuo cha elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia<br />

na sifa za Mungu na dini, akiendelea k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> juma pili na kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong><br />

katikisimu, kusema k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto na ku<strong>wa</strong>fundisha katika Maandiko. K<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha m<strong>wa</strong>limu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> vitabu (chapa) na kama m<strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto, yeye k<strong>wa</strong> miaka mingi aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

chombo katika kuita uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> wengi k<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lionyesha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na kuliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu.<br />

Wahubiri Watoto <strong>wa</strong> Skandinavie<br />

Katika Skandinavie vilevile ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu alitangaz<strong>wa</strong>. Wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasimama kutubu na kuacha zambi zao na kutafuta rehema katika jina la Kristo. Lakini<br />

padri <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la mahali pale akapinga mabadiliko, na wengine <strong>wa</strong>liohubiri ujumbe<br />

<strong>wa</strong>katup<strong>wa</strong> gerezani. Mahali pengi ambapo <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na k<strong>wa</strong> karibu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lin<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>, Mungu akapendez<strong>wa</strong> kutuma ujumbe k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>dogo. Kama<br />

vile <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> umri <strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> mtu mzima, serkali haikuweza ku<strong>wa</strong>funga, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>karuhusi<strong>wa</strong> kusema bila kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Katika makao <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> umasikini <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kakusanyika kusikia maonyo. Wahubiri<br />

wengine <strong>wa</strong>toto ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> zaidi <strong>ya</strong> umri <strong>wa</strong> miaka sita ao mnane; ijapo maisha <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>ya</strong>lishuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>limpenda Mwokozi, <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha tu k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida akili na uwezo<br />

151


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

vinavyoonekana katika <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> umri ule. Wakati <strong>wa</strong>liposimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, lakini,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>libadilish<strong>wa</strong> na mvuto mbali <strong>ya</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>di zao za ka<strong>wa</strong>ida. Sauti na tabia vikageuka, na<br />

pamoja na uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katoa maonyo <strong>ya</strong> hukumu, “Ogopeni Mungu, na kumutukuza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maana saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja.”<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>kasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> kutetemeka. Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu akasema mioyoni. Wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta Maandiko, <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> na kiasi <strong>wa</strong>katengenez<strong>wa</strong>, na kazi<br />

ikafany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba hata <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la pale <strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika mabadiliko.<br />

Iliku<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong>mba habari <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika Skandinavie, na akaweka Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto ili kazi iweze kutendeka. Wakati<br />

Yesu alipokaribia Yerusalema, <strong>wa</strong>tu, <strong>wa</strong>kaogopesh<strong>wa</strong> na mapadri na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, <strong>wa</strong>kaacha<br />

tangazo lao la furaha <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiingia k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>toto<br />

katika vi<strong>wa</strong>nja v<strong>ya</strong> hekalu <strong>wa</strong>kachukua kiitikio, na <strong>wa</strong>kapaaza sauti, “Hosana k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Daudi!” Matayo 21:8-16. K<strong>wa</strong> namna Mungu alitenda kazi k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, ndivyo hivyo akatumika k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

katika kutoa ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

Ujumbe Unata<strong>wa</strong>nyika<br />

Amerika ika<strong>wa</strong> mahali pakub<strong>wa</strong> pa kazi <strong>ya</strong> kutangaza kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Maandiko <strong>ya</strong><br />

Miller na <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kaenez<strong>wa</strong> duniani pote. Mbali na katika eneo kub<strong>wa</strong> habari<br />

njema <strong>ya</strong> milele: “Ogopeni Mungu, na kumutukuza k<strong>wa</strong> maana hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja.”<br />

Mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii ambayo ilionekana kuonyesha kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika majira <strong>ya</strong> 1844<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kashik<strong>wa</strong> sana rohoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mabishano juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> haki, na <strong>wa</strong>kaacha kiburi na mafikara <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kakubali kweli<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> furaha. Wachungaji wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaacha mishahara <strong>ya</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga katika kutangaza<br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Karibu <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>chache, <strong>wa</strong>lakini, <strong>wa</strong>likubali habari hii; k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo<br />

ikatole<strong>wa</strong> zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> mapadri. Wakulima <strong>wa</strong>kaacha<br />

mashamba <strong>ya</strong>o; <strong>wa</strong>fundi <strong>wa</strong> mashini, <strong>wa</strong>kaacha vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>o; <strong>wa</strong>chuuzi <strong>wa</strong>kaacha biashara<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o; <strong>wa</strong>fundi <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>wa</strong>kaacha vyeo v<strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>wa</strong>kavumilia kazi ngumu, taabu,<br />

na mateso, ili <strong>wa</strong>pate kuita <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> toba k<strong>wa</strong> wokovu. Ukweli <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu<br />

ukakubali<strong>wa</strong> na maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Maandiko Rahisi Yanaleta Hakikisho<br />

Kama Yoane Mbatizaji <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong>liweka shoka katika shina la miti na kusihi sana<br />

wote kuzaa “matunda <strong>ya</strong>nayofaa k<strong>wa</strong> toba.” K<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha tofauti k<strong>wa</strong> uhakikika <strong>wa</strong><br />

amani na salama vilivyosiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mimbara <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi, ushuhuda rahisi <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko<br />

ukaleta hakikisho ambalo <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>liweza kabisa kabisa kupinga. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kamtafuta<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na k<strong>wa</strong> toba. K<strong>wa</strong> kuacha mapenzi ambayo <strong>wa</strong>lishikamana nayo <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> kidunia sasa <strong>wa</strong>katazama mbinguni. K<strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> upole na polepole<br />

152


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kajiunga k<strong>wa</strong> kupaza sauti: “Ogopeni Mungu, na kumutukuza k<strong>wa</strong> maana saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja.”<br />

Wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong>kauliza k<strong>wa</strong>a machozi: “Ninapash<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> nini ili niokolewe?”<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokosea jirani zao <strong>wa</strong>kajiharakisha k<strong>wa</strong> kutengeneza kosa. Wote <strong>wa</strong>liopata amani<br />

katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>katamani kuijulisha k<strong>wa</strong> wengine. Mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi ikarudia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o, na mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o. Malaki 4:5, 6. Vizuizi v<strong>ya</strong> kiburi na matengano<br />

vikatupili<strong>wa</strong> mbali. Maungamo <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>kafany<strong>wa</strong>. Mahali po pote roho ziliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

zikiomboleza mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>litumia usiku wote mzima katika maombi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> hakika k<strong>wa</strong>mba zambi zao zilisamehe<strong>wa</strong>, ao kugeuka k<strong>wa</strong> jamaa zao <strong>wa</strong>la jirani.<br />

Makundi yote, <strong>wa</strong>tajiri na maskini, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> chini, <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na hamu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kusikia mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> maraa <strong>ya</strong> pili. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikatoa uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu kulisiki<strong>wa</strong> katika makutano ha<strong>ya</strong>, na wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiongezeka kila siku k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu. Makutano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kasikiliza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

utulivu k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> heshima. Mbingu na dunia vilionekana kukaribiana. Watu <strong>wa</strong>karudi<br />

nyumbani na sifa k<strong>wa</strong> midomo <strong>ya</strong>o, na sauti <strong>ya</strong> furaha ikavuma k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu <strong>wa</strong> usiku.<br />

Hakuna aliyehuzuria mikutano hiyo angaliweza kamwe kusahau maono <strong>ya</strong> usikizi mwingi.<br />

Habari lliping<strong>wa</strong><br />

Tangazo la <strong>wa</strong>kati kamili <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kukaleta mabishano sana k<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong><br />

makundi yote, tokea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji katika mimbara hata k<strong>wa</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong> miongoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

wenye zambi. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>litangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na kizuizi k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kurudi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu; <strong>wa</strong>likataa tu <strong>wa</strong>kati kamili. Lakini jicho la Mungu linaloona vyote likasoma<br />

mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kutamani kusikia habari <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ili aihukumu dunia k<strong>wa</strong> haki.<br />

Matendo <strong>ya</strong>o ha<strong>ya</strong>ngevumilia uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong> moyo unaomtafuta Mungu, na <strong>wa</strong>liogopa<br />

kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o. Kama Ma<strong>ya</strong>hudi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza ha<strong>wa</strong>kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha kumpokea Yesu. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kukataa tu kusikiliza mabishano <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia lakini <strong>wa</strong>kachekelea <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitazamia B<strong>wa</strong>na. Shetani<br />

akatupa laumu k<strong>wa</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>naojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

upendo mdogo sana k<strong>wa</strong>ke hata ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

“Hakuna mtu anayejua habari za siku ile na saa ile,” iliku<strong>wa</strong> ubishi mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara<br />

ulioendelea kulet<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>liokataa imani <strong>ya</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Andiko ni: ‘’Habari za siku<br />

ile na saa ile hakuna mtu anayejua, hata malaika <strong>wa</strong>lio mbinguni, ... ila Baba peke <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Matayo 24:36. Maelezo <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>litole<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitazamia<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, na matumizi maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pinzani <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>lionyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Usemi moja la Mwokozi haupashwi kutumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu lingine. Inga<strong>wa</strong> hakuna<br />

mtu anayejua siku <strong>wa</strong>la saa <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, tunaagiz<strong>wa</strong> kujua <strong>wa</strong>kati unaku<strong>wa</strong> karibu.<br />

Kukataa <strong>wa</strong>la kutojali kujua <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke kunapoku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kutaku<strong>wa</strong> kwetu<br />

kama hatari kwetu kama ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> katika siku za Noa bila kujua <strong>wa</strong>kati gani garika<br />

153


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuja. Kristo anasema, “Lakini, usipoangalia, nitakuja k<strong>wa</strong>ko kama mwizi, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

hutajua saa nitakapokuja k<strong>wa</strong>ko.” Ufunuo 3:3.<br />

Paulo anasema k<strong>wa</strong> habari za <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojali onyo la Mwokozi: “Lakini ninyi ndugu, si<br />

katika giza, hata siku ile i<strong>wa</strong>pate ninyi kama mwizi: sababu ninyi wote ni <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> nuru, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mchana.” 1 Watesalonika 5:2-5.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotamani sababu <strong>ya</strong> kukataa kweli <strong>wa</strong>kafunga masikio <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> maelezo<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>, na maneno “Hakuna mtu anayejua siku ao saa” <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea kukariri<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

zarau na hata <strong>wa</strong>naojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hubiri <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lipoanza kuuliza njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

wokovu, <strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>kajitia kati <strong>ya</strong>o na ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> kufasiri k<strong>wa</strong> uongo Neno la<br />

Mungu.<br />

Waaminifu zaidi katika makanisa <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kupokea habari.<br />

Mahali ambapo <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiongoz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>padri, mahali ambapo <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza<br />

kutafuta Neno la Mungu <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe, mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kurudi <strong>ya</strong>lihitaji tu kulinganish<strong>wa</strong><br />

pamoja na Maandiko juu <strong>ya</strong> kuimarisha mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kimungu.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liongoz<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>ume, <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>zazi, ao <strong>wa</strong>toto na <strong>wa</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> kuamini<br />

jambo hili kama zambi hata k<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliza mambo <strong>ya</strong> “uzushi”<strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo kama<br />

iliyofundish<strong>wa</strong> na Waadventisti. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>liagiza ku<strong>wa</strong> na ulinzi aminifu juu <strong>ya</strong> roho hizi,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maana nuru ingine ilipas<strong>wa</strong> kuangaza juu <strong>ya</strong>o kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha Mungu.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokubali habari <strong>wa</strong>lingojea kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>o. Wakati ambao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litazamia kukutana naye uliku<strong>wa</strong> karibu. Wakakaribisha saa hii k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu <strong>wa</strong> heshima.<br />

Hakuna aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na maarifa hii anayeweza kusahau saa hizo za tamani za kungoja. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

maana juma chache mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule, kazi <strong>ya</strong> kidunia k<strong>wa</strong> sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> iliwek<strong>wa</strong><br />

pembeni. Waaminifu <strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> uangalifu <strong>wa</strong>kachunguza mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

katika saa chache kufunga macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> maono <strong>ya</strong> kidunia. Hapo hapaku<strong>wa</strong> kushona<br />

“mavazi <strong>ya</strong> kupanda nayo” (Tazama Nyongezo), lakini wote <strong>wa</strong>kasikia haja <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda<br />

wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kijita<strong>ya</strong>risha kuonana na Mwokozi. Mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o meupe<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> usafi <strong>wa</strong> roho--tabia zilizotakas<strong>wa</strong> na damu <strong>ya</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Hebu k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

kungeku<strong>wa</strong> vivyo na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na moyo <strong>wa</strong> namna moja <strong>wa</strong> kuchunguza, imani<br />

yenye juhudi.<br />

Mungu alitaka kuonyesha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke ulifunika kosa katika kuhesabu<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> kutazamia ule ukapita, na Kristo hakuonekana. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liotazamia Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kajua uchungu mkali. Lakini Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> akichunguza<br />

mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojidai kungoja kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>liongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hofu. Watu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>katangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong>kuamini kamwe k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo atakuja. Waliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kuchekelea huzuni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amini <strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

Lakini Yesu na jeshi lote la mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>litazamia k<strong>wa</strong> upendo na huruma juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu ijapo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kukatish<strong>wa</strong> tamaa. Kama kifuniko kinachotenga dunia na<br />

154


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

vile vinavyoonekana k<strong>wa</strong> visivyoonekana kikiinuli<strong>wa</strong>, malaika <strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza kuonekana<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisogea karibu na roho hizi za uaminifu na kuzilinda k<strong>wa</strong> mishale <strong>ya</strong> Shetani.<br />

155


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 21. Kutes<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Aijili <strong>ya</strong> Mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> Mpumbafu ao<br />

Mjinga<br />

William Miller na <strong>wa</strong>saidizi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>litafuta kuamsha <strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong> dini k<strong>wa</strong> tumaini la<br />

kweli la kanisa na mahitaji <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> maarifa makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kikristo. Walitumika pia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuamsha <strong>wa</strong>siogeuka k<strong>wa</strong> toba na mabadiliko. “Ha<strong>wa</strong>kujaribu kutubisha <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> dini<br />

fulani. Walitumika bila uchaguzi w makundi ao dini fulani. ” Akasema Miller, “Nilifikiri<br />

kusaidia wote. Nili<strong>wa</strong>za k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo wote <strong>wa</strong>ngefurahi katika kutazamia kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo, na k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>le ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuona kama mimi ha<strong>wa</strong>ngekosa kupenda <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liopash<strong>wa</strong> kukubali k<strong>wa</strong> moyo mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong>, siku<strong>wa</strong>za k<strong>wa</strong>mba kungeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

lazima <strong>ya</strong> mikutano <strong>ya</strong> kuachana... Hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liogeuka chini <strong>ya</strong> kazi zangu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lijiunga na makanisa mbalimbali iliyoku<strong>wa</strong>ko.”<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>lipinga juu <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Adventiste,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likatalia <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>o haki <strong>ya</strong> kuhuzuria kuhubiri juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

Wala hata kusema k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> tumaini lao katika kanisa. Waaminifu <strong>wa</strong>lipenda kanisa zao.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>lipoona haki <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kuchunguza mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii unakan<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>liona<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu una<strong>wa</strong>kataza ku<strong>wa</strong>tii. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo <strong>wa</strong>liona k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na haki kujitenga. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> kip<strong>wa</strong> cha m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 karibu elfu makumi tano <strong>wa</strong>katoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa.<br />

Katika makanisa mengi, k<strong>wa</strong> miaka nyingi kuongezeka kuliku<strong>wa</strong>ko lakini k<strong>wa</strong> kidogo<br />

kufuatana na matendo <strong>ya</strong> dunia iloyolingana na upungufu k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> kiroho. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ka ule kuliku<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> upunguo mkub<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> makanisa yote <strong>ya</strong> inchi.<br />

Jambo lilielez<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> magazeti na mimbarani.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na Barnes, m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong> maelezo na mchungaji <strong>wa</strong> moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> makanisa<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Philadelphia, “akasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba ... Sasa hakuna maamsho, hapana kugeuka,<br />

hakuna kuonekana sana k<strong>wa</strong> maendeleo katika neema katika <strong>wa</strong>limu, na hakuna anayekuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kuzungumza juu <strong>ya</strong> wokovu <strong>wa</strong> roho zao...kunaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong> kidunia Ni vile inaku<strong>wa</strong> katika makanisa yote.”<br />

Katika mwezi <strong>wa</strong> Februari <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka ule ule, M<strong>wa</strong>limu Finney <strong>wa</strong> Oberlin College<br />

akasema: “K<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida, makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong> inchi yetu, <strong>ya</strong>navyoonekana,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> ao baridi ao adui <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo yote <strong>ya</strong> tabia na usafi v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu ... ubaridi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kiroho unata<strong>wa</strong>la karibu kote k<strong>wa</strong> wingi <strong>wa</strong> kutisha; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyomagazeti <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> inchi<br />

yote <strong>ya</strong>nashuhudia ile. ...K<strong>wa</strong> wingi sana <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>nata<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong> na mtindo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisasa (mode),<strong>ya</strong>naunga mkono mwovu katika makundi <strong>ya</strong> anasa, katika michezo, katika<br />

furaha. ... Makanisa k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> huzuniyenye kurudia k<strong>wa</strong> ushenzi.<br />

Yalikwisha kwenda mbali <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na na amekwisha kujiondoa mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>o.’‘<br />

Binadamu Anakataa Nuru<br />

156


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Giza <strong>ya</strong> kiroho inafika, si k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kuondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> kumungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

upande <strong>wa</strong> Mungu bila sababu, bali ni k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> binadamu aliyekataa nuru.<br />

Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi, k<strong>wa</strong> kupenda dunia na kumsahau Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika ujinga juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong>. Katika kutoamini k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kamkataa Mkombozi. Mungu hakukatia mbali taifa<br />

la Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi k<strong>wa</strong> mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> wokovu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokataa kweli <strong>wa</strong>liweka “giza k<strong>wa</strong> nuru,<br />

na nuru k<strong>wa</strong> giza.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 5:20.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kukataa k<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> habari njema Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kushika kanuni zao za<br />

zamani, <strong>wa</strong>kati ambapo <strong>wa</strong>likubali k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu kaku<strong>wa</strong> tena kati <strong>ya</strong>o. Unabii <strong>wa</strong><br />

Danieli ulionyesha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Masi<strong>ya</strong> na kutabiri vilevile kifo chake.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo <strong>wa</strong>litia mashaka majifunzo <strong>ya</strong>ke, na mwishowe <strong>wa</strong> rabbis <strong>wa</strong>katangaza laana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>ngejaribu kukadirisha <strong>wa</strong>kati. Katika upofu na ugumu <strong>wa</strong> moyo Waisraeli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> karne zilizofuatana <strong>wa</strong>kasimama, bilakujali za<strong>wa</strong>di za neema <strong>ya</strong> wokovu, bila<br />

akili <strong>ya</strong> mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> habari njema, maonyo nzito na la kutisha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hatari <strong>ya</strong> kukataa<br />

nuru kutoka mbinguni.<br />

Yeye anayezuia hakikisho lamapash<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong>napingana na tamaa zake<br />

mwishowe atapoteza uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuchagua kati <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na kosa. Roho hutengana na<br />

Mungu. Mahali ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Mungu unakatali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> zarau, kanisa litaku<strong>wa</strong> katika giza,<br />

imani na upendo vitapunguka, na fitina huingia. Washiriki <strong>wa</strong> kanisa hutia nguvu zao katika<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> kidunia, na wenye zambi hugeuka ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>gumu katika ugumu <strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Ujumbe Wa Malaika <strong>wa</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 14 ulitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutenga <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojidai<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mivuto miba<strong>ya</strong>. Katika ujumbe huu, Mungu alituma k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa onyo ambalo kama lingelikubali<strong>wa</strong>, lingaliweza kusahihisha maovu ambayo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>funga mbali na yeye. Kama <strong>wa</strong>ngalikubali ujumbe, kushusha mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o na<br />

kutafuta mata<strong>ya</strong>risho k<strong>wa</strong> kusimama mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu angalionekana. Kanisa<br />

lingalifikia tena umoja ule, imani, na upendo <strong>wa</strong> siku za mitume, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>aminifu<br />

“<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na moyo mmoja” na <strong>wa</strong>kati “B<strong>wa</strong>na aliongezea k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa kila siku <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiokole<strong>wa</strong>.” Matendo 4:32; 2:47.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ngalipokea nuru kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Neno lake, <strong>wa</strong>ngalifikia umoja<br />

ule ambao mtume anaeleza, “umoja <strong>wa</strong> Roho katika kifungo cha salama”. Anasema, “Mwili<br />

ni mmoja, na Roho mmoja, kama vile mulivyoit<strong>wa</strong> katika tumaini moja la mwito wenu;<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na mmoja, imani moja, ubatizo mmoja.” Waefeso 4:3-5.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokubali ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong>likuja kutoka makanisa mbalimbali,<br />

na vizuizi v<strong>ya</strong>o v<strong>ya</strong> dini vikatup<strong>wa</strong> chini k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu. Kanuni za imani za mabishano<br />

zikavunjika k<strong>wa</strong> vipande vipande. Maoni <strong>ya</strong> uwongo juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kasahihis<strong>wa</strong>. Makosa <strong>ya</strong> kanyosh<strong>wa</strong>, mioyo ikaungana katika upatano <strong>wa</strong>kupendeza.<br />

157


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Upendo ukata<strong>wa</strong>la sana. Mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ngefan<strong>ya</strong> vile k<strong>wa</strong> wote, kama wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngelikubali.<br />

Wahuduma, ambao kama <strong>wa</strong>linzi <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kutambua dalili za kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu, <strong>wa</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza ukweli kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> manabii ao k<strong>wa</strong> ishara za <strong>wa</strong>kati.<br />

Upendo k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na imani katika Neno lake vikapunguka, na mafundisho juu <strong>ya</strong> kurudi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kristo ikaamsha tu kutokuamini k<strong>wa</strong>o. Kama k<strong>wa</strong> zamani ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu<br />

ukakutana na s<strong>wa</strong>li: “Nani katika <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> ao Wafarisayo aliyem<strong>wa</strong>mini?” Yoane 7:48.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lipinga majifunzo <strong>ya</strong> unabii, kufundisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> unabii viliti<strong>wa</strong><br />

muhuri na haviku<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> kufahamika. Makundi, k<strong>wa</strong> kutumainia <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>o,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kakataa kusikiliza; na wengine, inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lisadikish<strong>wa</strong> na ukweli, ha<strong>wa</strong>kusubutu kukiri<br />

ili <strong>wa</strong>sipate “kutoshz<strong>wa</strong> katika sunagogi.” Yoane 9:22. Ujumbe Mungu alioutuma k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujaribu kanisa ulionyesha namna gani <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong>liotia mapendo <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

dunia hii kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Kukataa maonyo <strong>ya</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kulisababisha na hali <strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

kupenda anasa <strong>ya</strong> kidunia, kuacha dini, na mauti <strong>ya</strong> kiroho ambayo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

makanisa katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844.<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Pili<br />

Katika Ufunuo 14 malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza amefuat<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong> pili, kutangaza, “Umeanguka,<br />

umeanguka, Babeli mji ule mkub<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong>ni umefan<strong>ya</strong> mataifa yote kuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

gazabu <strong>ya</strong> uasherati <strong>wa</strong>ke.” Ufunuo 14:8. Neno “Babeli” lilitoka k<strong>wa</strong> “Babel,” na maana<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ni machafuko. Katika Maandiko inaonyesha namna mbalimbali <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> uongo ao<br />

ukufuru <strong>wa</strong> dini. Katika Ufunuo 17 Babeli inafananish<strong>wa</strong> kama m<strong>wa</strong>namke--mfano<br />

uliotumi<strong>wa</strong> katika Biblia kama mfano <strong>wa</strong> kanisa, m<strong>wa</strong>namke mwema hufananish<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kanisa safi; m<strong>wa</strong>namke mwovu ni kama kanisa lililokufuru.<br />

Katika Biblia ushirika kati <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na kanisa lake unafananish<strong>wa</strong> na ndoa. B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

anasema: “Na nitakuoa ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ngu k<strong>wa</strong> milele, ndiyo, nitakuoa k<strong>wa</strong> haki.” “Mimi ni mme<br />

wenu.” Na Paulo anasema: “Nili<strong>wa</strong>patanisha ninyi k<strong>wa</strong> mme mmoja, ili niletee Kristo bikira<br />

safi.” Hosea 2:19; Yeremia 3:14; 2 Wakorinto 11:2.<br />

Uzinzi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong><br />

Kanisa, Kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika kuruhusu mambo <strong>ya</strong> kidunia kuta<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

moyo ni kama kuvunja k<strong>wa</strong> kiapo <strong>ya</strong> ndoa. Zambi <strong>ya</strong> Israeli katika kum<strong>wa</strong>cha B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

inaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> mfano huu. “Kama vile mke anavyoacha mme <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

udanganyifu, ndivyo mulivyonitendea mimi k<strong>wa</strong> udanganyifu, Ee nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Israeli,<br />

anasema B<strong>wa</strong>na.” “Mke <strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> uasherati! anayekaribisha <strong>wa</strong>geni pahali pa mme<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke!” Yeremia 3:20; Ezekieli 16:32.<br />

158


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Asema mtume Yakobo: “Ninyi <strong>wa</strong>zini, hamujui <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki <strong>ya</strong> dunia ni<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>ya</strong> Mungu? Basi kila mtu anayetaka ku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki <strong>ya</strong> dunia anageuka ku<strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu.” Yakobo 4:4.<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>namke (Babeli) yule “amevik<strong>wa</strong> nguo <strong>ya</strong> rangi <strong>ya</strong> zambarau na nyekundu,<br />

amepamb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> zahabu, na mawe <strong>ya</strong> bei kub<strong>wa</strong>, na lulu, naye aliku<strong>wa</strong> na kikombe cha<br />

zahabu mkononi m<strong>wa</strong>ke, kinachojaa machukizo, na machafu... Na katika kipaji cha uso<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke jina limeandik<strong>wa</strong>, SIRI, BABELI MKUBWA, MAMA YA MAKAHABA.” Anasema<br />

nabii: “Nikaona yule m<strong>wa</strong>namke amele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Yesu.” Babeli “ni mji ule mkub<strong>wa</strong> unaota<strong>wa</strong>la juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> dunia.”<br />

Ufunuo 17:4-6, 18.<br />

Mamlaka ambayo k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi ilidumisha uwezo juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> jamii <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wakristo wote ni Roma. Rangi <strong>ya</strong> zambarau, na nyekundu, zahabu, mawe <strong>ya</strong> bei kub<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

lulu, vinaonyesha fahari iliyovali<strong>wa</strong> na askofu mwenye kiburi <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Hakuna mamlaka<br />

ingine iliyoweza kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kweli “amele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu” kama kanisa<br />

lile ambalo lilitesa k<strong>wa</strong> ukali <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Babeli inasitaki<strong>wa</strong> vilevile k<strong>wa</strong> uhusiano usio <strong>wa</strong> sheria pamoja na “<strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwengu.” K<strong>wa</strong> kuachana na B<strong>wa</strong>na kupatana na <strong>wa</strong>pagani kanisa la Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi lika<strong>wa</strong><br />

kahaba, na Roma, katika kutafuta usaada <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kidunia, inapokea hukumu <strong>ya</strong><br />

namna moja.<br />

“Babeli ni mama <strong>ya</strong> makahaba.” Binti zake <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong>nayoshika<br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke na kufuata mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kuacha kweli ili kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapatano pamoja na<br />

dunia. Ujumbe unaotangaza kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> Babeli unapas<strong>wa</strong> kulinganish<strong>wa</strong> na makundi <strong>ya</strong><br />

ushirika <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> safi zamani na imegeuka ku<strong>wa</strong> potovu. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi ujumbe huu<br />

unafuata onyo la hukumu, unapas<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> katika siku za mwisho. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo haiwezi<br />

kutumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma tu, k<strong>wa</strong> maana lile liliku<strong>wa</strong> katika hali <strong>ya</strong> maanguko muda<br />

<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi.<br />

Tena, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nait<strong>wa</strong> kutoka katika Bebeli. Kufuatana na maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu wengi <strong>wa</strong>kingali katika Babeli, Na ni katika makundi gani <strong>ya</strong> dini ambamo<br />

munaku<strong>wa</strong> sehemu kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo? Katika makanisa inayokiri imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kiprotestanti. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kutokea k<strong>wa</strong>o makanisa ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>lipata msimamo bora k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli, na mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nao. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kashind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa<br />

<strong>ya</strong> namna moja ileile ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Israeli kuiga desturi na kujipendekeza na<br />

urafiki <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siomwogopa Mungu.<br />

Kujiunga Pamoja na Walimwengu<br />

Makanisa mengi <strong>ya</strong> kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>mefuata mfano <strong>wa</strong> uhusiano pamoja na “<strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong><br />

dunia” makanisa <strong>ya</strong> taifa, k<strong>wa</strong> uhusiano <strong>wa</strong>o na serkali; na makanisa mengine, k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta<br />

mapendeleo <strong>ya</strong> dunia. Neno “Babeli” machafuko--linaweza kutumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makundi ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

159


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>nayojidai k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>ya</strong>lipata mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia, lakini <strong>ya</strong>mega<strong>wa</strong>nyika<br />

katika makundi isiyohesabika pamoja na kanuni <strong>ya</strong> imani za mbalimbali.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la kikatolika la Roma inabisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba “kama kanisa la Roma lingeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na kosa <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu katika uhusiano k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, binti <strong>ya</strong>ke, kanisa la<br />

Uingereza, linaku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa <strong>ya</strong> namna moja, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu lina makanisa kumi inayojiweka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> Maria k<strong>wa</strong> namna moja linalojiweka <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo.”<br />

Na Dr. Hopkin husema: “Hakuna sababu <strong>ya</strong> kufikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba roho na kanuni za mpinga<br />

kristo na vitendo kusong<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ile ambayo inait<strong>wa</strong> sasa Kanisa la Roma. Makanisa <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na umpinga kristo ndani <strong>ya</strong>o, na <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> mbali kabisa <strong>ya</strong><br />

matengenezo k<strong>wa</strong> ... maovu na uba<strong>ya</strong>.”<br />

Juu <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Presbyteria kujitenga k<strong>wa</strong> Roma, Dr. Guthrie anaandika: “Miaka mia<br />

tatu iliyopita, kanisa letu, pamoja na Biblia iliyofunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwenge <strong>ya</strong>ke, na maneno<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong> maalum: “Tafuteni maandiko” k<strong>wa</strong> mabendera <strong>ya</strong>ke, lilitoka k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Ndipo akauliza s<strong>wa</strong>li hili la muhimu: Je, <strong>wa</strong>ligeuka ku<strong>wa</strong> safi <strong>wa</strong>lipotoka k<strong>wa</strong> Babeli ? ”<br />

Safari za K<strong>wa</strong>nza kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Habari Njema<br />

Namna gani kanisa lilitoka mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> habari njema? K<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong> kupatana na kipagani, ili <strong>wa</strong>pagani <strong>wa</strong>kubali wepesi dini <strong>ya</strong> kikristo. “Karibu kufikia<br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kumalizia karne <strong>ya</strong> pili karibu makanisa mengi <strong>ya</strong>likubali sura mp<strong>ya</strong>... Kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> zamani <strong>wa</strong>lipopumzika katika makaburi <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o pamoja na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liogeuka <strong>wa</strong>p<strong>ya</strong>, ... <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea mbele na kutoa mfano mp<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dini.” “Wingi <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>pagani, kujaa katika kanisa, kuchukua pamoja nao desturi zao, tamaa, na ibada <strong>ya</strong><br />

sanamu.” Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo ikategemea mapendeleo na usaada <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> dunia.<br />

Ikakubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> jina tu na wengi. “Lakini wengi <strong>wa</strong>kadumu katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> kipagani,<br />

zaidi kuabudu k<strong>wa</strong> uficho sanamu zao.”<br />

Je, matendo <strong>ya</strong> namna ile haikufanyika karibu katika kila kanisa linalojiita lenyewe<br />

Protestanti? K<strong>wa</strong> namna wenye kulianzisha <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na roho <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likufa, <strong>wa</strong>zao <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>katoa mfano mp<strong>ya</strong>.” Kukataa k<strong>wa</strong> upofu kukubali kweli yo yote<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>baba zao <strong>wa</strong>liona, <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tengenezaji <strong>wa</strong>katoka k<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong><br />

kujinyima na kuacha dunia.<br />

Aa, k<strong>wa</strong> wingi <strong>wa</strong> namna gani makanisa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>ya</strong>litoka k<strong>wa</strong> kanuni <strong>ya</strong> Biblia!<br />

Akazungumzia juu <strong>ya</strong> pesa, John Wesley akasema: ” Usipoteze sehemu <strong>ya</strong> talenta hii <strong>ya</strong><br />

damani k<strong>wa</strong> kupamba nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ko na vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> ufundi; katika mapicha <strong>ya</strong> bei kali,<br />

kupamba... Wakati wote utakapovaa mavazi <strong>ya</strong> rangi <strong>ya</strong> zambarau nyekundu na kitani,’ na<br />

zaidi` ku<strong>wa</strong> na maisha <strong>ya</strong> anasa kila siku,’ bila shaka wengi <strong>wa</strong>tashangilia uzuri <strong>wa</strong> tamaa<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ko, k<strong>wa</strong> ukarimu <strong>wa</strong>ko na utu wema <strong>wa</strong>ko. Lakini utoshelewe zaidi na heshima itokayo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.”<br />

160


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wata<strong>wa</strong>la, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> siasa, <strong>wa</strong>nacheria, <strong>wa</strong>ganga, <strong>wa</strong>chuuzi, <strong>wa</strong>najiunga kanisani k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kusudi la kwendesha faida zao za kidunia. Makundi mbalimbali <strong>ya</strong> dini, <strong>ya</strong>kaja kusaidi<strong>wa</strong><br />

na utajiri <strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kidunia <strong>wa</strong>liobatiz<strong>wa</strong>, ku<strong>wa</strong> njia nzuri sana <strong>ya</strong> kuvuta <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi.<br />

Makanisa mazuri sana, na garama nyingi <strong>ya</strong>kajeng<strong>wa</strong>. Mshahara <strong>wa</strong> juu sana ulilip<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mchungaji mwenye kipa<strong>wa</strong> cha kukaribisha <strong>wa</strong>tu. Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>lipas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> rahisi na<br />

kupendeza k<strong>wa</strong> masikio <strong>ya</strong> siku hizi. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo zambi za siku hizi zinafich<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> hila<br />

za wema, mfano <strong>wa</strong>kuogopa Mungu.<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ndishi mmoja katika New York Independent akasema hivi juu <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong><br />

Methodiste kama inavyoku<strong>wa</strong>: “Msitari <strong>wa</strong> mtengano kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>naomwogopa Mungu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ovu unapotea katika namna <strong>ya</strong> kivuli, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> bidii k<strong>wa</strong> pande zote mbili hujitahidi<br />

kutupia mbali tofauti yote kati <strong>ya</strong> desturi zao za kutenda na furaha.”<br />

Katika mwendo huu <strong>wa</strong> kutafuta anasa, kujinyima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo karibu kulipotea<br />

kabisa. “Kama feza zinahitaji<strong>wa</strong> sasa, ... hakuna mtu anayepash<strong>wa</strong> kuit<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa. Aa<br />

hapana! kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha maonyesho <strong>ya</strong> biashara, michezo <strong>ya</strong> kuingiza picha, michezo <strong>ya</strong> bahati<br />

(loterie), chakula cha jioni (banquet), <strong>wa</strong>la kitu cha kula--kila kitu cho chote k<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu.”<br />

Robert Atkins anaonyesha picha <strong>ya</strong> upungufu <strong>wa</strong> kiroho katika Uingereza: ‘’ Uasi, uasi,<br />

uasi, tazama neno lililochor<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> makanisa yote; na <strong>wa</strong>ngejua, na <strong>wa</strong>liiisikia na<br />

kungeku<strong>wa</strong> na tumaini; lakini, ole! Wakalalamika: “Sisi ni tajiri, tumepata vitu vingi; <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

hatuhitaji kitu chochote.”‘ Zambi kub<strong>wa</strong> iliyoshitaki<strong>wa</strong> Babeli ni k<strong>wa</strong>mba “amefan<strong>ya</strong><br />

mataifa yote kuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo <strong>ya</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong> uasherati <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Kikombe hiki ni mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uongo <strong>ya</strong>le aliyokubali kama matokeo <strong>ya</strong> urafiki pamoja na dunia. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

nafasi <strong>ya</strong>ke hutumia mvuto <strong>wa</strong> uovu juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia k<strong>wa</strong> kufundisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>liyopinga<br />

maneno <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> Biblia.<br />

Kama haingeku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba dunia inalewesh<strong>wa</strong> na mvinyo <strong>wa</strong> Babeli, wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngalisadikish<strong>wa</strong> na kungeuz<strong>wa</strong> kweli kamili za Neno la Mungu. Lakini imani <strong>ya</strong> dini<br />

inaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> na machafuko sana na kutopatana hata <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>ujui kitu gani cha<br />

kuamini. Zambi <strong>ya</strong> dunia isiyotubi<strong>wa</strong> inalala mlangoni m<strong>wa</strong> kanisa.<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> pili haukutmilika katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844. Makanisa basi <strong>ya</strong>lianguka<br />

kiroho k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa nuru <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu, lakini ha<strong>ya</strong>kuanguka kabisa.<br />

Namna <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiendelea kukataa mambo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> pekee k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liendelea kuanguka chini na kuendelea chini. Bado, lakini, itawezekana kusem<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba “Babeli imeanguka, ... k<strong>wa</strong> sababu amefan<strong>ya</strong> mataifa yote kuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo <strong>wa</strong><br />

hasira <strong>ya</strong> uasherati <strong>wa</strong>ke.” Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> masitaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

malaika <strong>wa</strong> pili. Lakini kazi <strong>ya</strong> uasi haijafikia hatua <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, Shetani atatumika “na uwezo wote, na ishara na maajabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwongo, na udanganyifu wote <strong>wa</strong> uzalimu”; na <strong>wa</strong>le ambao “ha<strong>wa</strong>kupokea mapendo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

161


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kweli, <strong>wa</strong>pate kuokole<strong>wa</strong>,” <strong>wa</strong>taach<strong>wa</strong> kupokea “nguvu <strong>ya</strong> upotevu, hata <strong>wa</strong>amini uwongo.”<br />

2 Watesalonika 2:9-11. Hata muungano <strong>wa</strong> kanisa pamoja na dunia utakapotimia kabisa<br />

ndipo kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> Babeli kutaku<strong>wa</strong> kamili. Mabadiliko ni <strong>ya</strong> kidogo kidogo na kutimilika<br />

kamili k<strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 14:8 kunaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao.<br />

Bila kutazama giza <strong>ya</strong> kiroho inayoku<strong>wa</strong> katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong>naosimamisha Babeli,<br />

wengi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>ngali <strong>wa</strong>napatikana katika ushirika <strong>wa</strong>o. Wengi<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>jaona kamwe kweli za kipekee k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu. Wengi ni <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotamani<br />

nuru kamili zaidi. Wanatazama bila kuona sura <strong>ya</strong> Kristo katika makanisa ambamo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naambatana nayo.<br />

Ufunuo 18 huonyesha <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ambao <strong>wa</strong>kingali katika Babeli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tait<strong>wa</strong> kujitenga k<strong>wa</strong> ushirika <strong>wa</strong>ke. Ujumbe huu, <strong>wa</strong> mwisho unaopas<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

dunia, itatenda kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Nuru <strong>ya</strong> kweli itaangaza juu <strong>ya</strong> wote ambao mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

inafunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuipokea, na <strong>wa</strong>na wote <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> katika Babeli <strong>wa</strong>tasikia<br />

mwito: “Tokeni k<strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Ufunuo 18:4.<br />

162


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 22. Unabii Unatimilika<br />

Wakati ulipopita ambapo kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na kulipotazami<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza--<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika<br />

<strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844--<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotazamia kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika mashaka na<br />

kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na hakika. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kuchunguza katika Maandiko, k<strong>wa</strong> kupima tena<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Maneno <strong>ya</strong> unabii, <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi na <strong>ya</strong> nguvu, <strong>ya</strong>lionyesha kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu. Kugeuka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu na uamsho <strong>wa</strong> kiroho miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

kulishuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba ujumbe uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Walihangaish<strong>wa</strong> na mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii, ambayo <strong>wa</strong>lizania kama, kulingana na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili, iliku<strong>wa</strong> fundisho la ku<strong>wa</strong>tia moyo k<strong>wa</strong> kungoja na uvumilivu katika<br />

imani,ili mambo <strong>ya</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> giza k<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong>o sasa ifunuliwe. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> unabii iliku<strong>wa</strong> Habakuki 2:1-4. Hakuna mtu, hata, aliyefahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba kukawia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi--<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kungojea--unaku<strong>wa</strong> katika unabii. Baada <strong>ya</strong> uchungu, andiko hili<br />

likaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> la maana sana: “Maono ha<strong>ya</strong> ni k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ulioamuri<strong>wa</strong>, lakini k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>ya</strong>tasema, <strong>wa</strong>la ha<strong>ya</strong>tasema uwongo; hata <strong>ya</strong>kikawia, u<strong>ya</strong>ngoje; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>takuja kweli, ha<strong>ya</strong>tachele<strong>wa</strong>. . . Mwenye haki ataishi k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>ke.”<br />

Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Ezekieli pia uliku<strong>wa</strong> faraja k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu: “B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu anasema hivi...<br />

Siku ni karibu, na kutimia k<strong>wa</strong> kila maono ... Nitasema, na neno nitakalolisema litatimiz<strong>wa</strong>;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la halitakawish<strong>wa</strong> tena.” “Neno nitakalolisema litatimia.” Ezekieli 12:2325,28. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kingoja <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi. Yeye anayejua mwisho tangu m<strong>wa</strong>nzo ali<strong>wa</strong>pa tumaini.<br />

Kama mafungu kama ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong>ko, imani <strong>ya</strong>o ingalianguka.<br />

Mfano <strong>wa</strong> mabikira kumi <strong>wa</strong> Matayo 25 pia unaonyesha mambo <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong><br />

Waadventiste. Hapo paonyesh<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> siku za mwisho. Mambo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>mefananish<strong>wa</strong> na tendo la ndoa <strong>ya</strong> mashariki:<br />

“Halafu ufalme <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni utafananish<strong>wa</strong> na mabikira kumi <strong>wa</strong>liot<strong>wa</strong>a taa zao,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>katoka kwenda kukutana na b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi. Watano <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pumbafu na <strong>wa</strong>tano<br />

wenye akili. Wale <strong>wa</strong>lio ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pumbafu, <strong>wa</strong>lichukua taa zao, bila mafuta; lakini wenye<br />

akili <strong>wa</strong>licukua mafuta ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>o pamoja na taa zao. Basi <strong>wa</strong>kati b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi<br />

alipokawia, <strong>wa</strong>o wote <strong>wa</strong>kasinzia na kulala usingizi. Lakini saa sita <strong>ya</strong> usiku kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kelele: Tazama, b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi! tokeni kukutana naye.” Matayo 25:1-6.<br />

Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kama kulivyotangaz<strong>wa</strong> na ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza,<br />

kulifahamika ku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi. Kuenea k<strong>wa</strong> matengenezo chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> karibu k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kukajibu k<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> mabikira. Katika mfano<br />

huu, wote <strong>wa</strong>lichukua taa zao, Biblia, “na <strong>wa</strong>kaenda kukutana na b<strong>wa</strong>na harusi.” Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>pumbafu “ha<strong>wa</strong>kuchukua mafuta pamoja nao,” “wenye akili <strong>wa</strong>lichukua mafuta<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>o pamoja na taa zao.” Wa nyuma <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza Maandiko ili<br />

kuchunguza ukweli na <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na akili <strong>ya</strong> kipekee, imani k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ambayo<br />

haingeangush<strong>wa</strong> na kukata tamaa na kukawia. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaendesh<strong>wa</strong> na musukumo, hofu<br />

163


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>o ikaamsh<strong>wa</strong> na ujumbe. Lakini imani <strong>ya</strong>o ilijeng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ndugu zao,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>litoshele<strong>wa</strong> na nuru yenye ku<strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong><strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maono, bila ufahamu kamili <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

kazi halisi <strong>ya</strong> neema ndani <strong>ya</strong> moyo. Ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea “kukutana” na B<strong>wa</strong>na katika<br />

matazamio <strong>ya</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> mara moja lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuta<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kukawia na uchungu.<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong>o ikaanguka.<br />

“Wakati b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi alipokawia, <strong>wa</strong>o wote <strong>wa</strong>kasinzia na kulala usingizi.” K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukawia k<strong>wa</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> kupitisha <strong>wa</strong>kati, kukata tamaa, ni kukawia kwenye<br />

kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> inje. Wale ambao imani <strong>ya</strong>o iliimarish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> ujuzi <strong>wa</strong> kipekee <strong>wa</strong> Biblia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na m<strong>wa</strong>mba chini <strong>ya</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong>o ambayo mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> uchungu ha<strong>ya</strong>kuweza<br />

kuharibu. “Wao wote <strong>wa</strong>kasinzia na kulala usingizi,” kundi moja katika kuacha imani <strong>ya</strong>o,<br />

lingine likangoja k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu hata m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi ulipas<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong>. Wale <strong>wa</strong><br />

kijuujuu ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza tena kuegemea k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ndugu zao. Kila mmoja anapas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kusimama ao kuanguka yeye mwenyewe.<br />

Ukaidi <strong>wa</strong> Dini Unaonekana<br />

Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, ushupavu <strong>wa</strong> dini ukaanza kuonekana. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha juhudi<br />

za ukaidi. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> ukaidi <strong>ya</strong>kakutana na kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na huruma k<strong>wa</strong> jamii kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

Waadventiste, ndipo <strong>wa</strong>kaleta laumu juu <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> ukweli.<br />

Shetani aliku<strong>wa</strong> akipoteza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na k<strong>wa</strong> kuleta laumu k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu,<br />

akatafuta kudangan<strong>ya</strong> wengine <strong>wa</strong>liokubali imani na ku<strong>wa</strong>endesha k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> kupita<br />

kipimo. Ndipo <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri <strong>wa</strong>kivisia kupata kosa lo lote, kila kitu<br />

kisichoku<strong>wa</strong> kitendo cha kukubali<strong>wa</strong>, na kulishikilia katika hali <strong>ya</strong> kupita kipimo ili kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

Waadventiste <strong>wa</strong>chukiwe. Kama angeweza kuleta <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>wa</strong> kutangaza imani <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili, <strong>wa</strong>kati uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke ungeendelea kuta<strong>wa</strong>la mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o, angepata faida<br />

Kub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Shetani ni “mushitaki <strong>wa</strong> ndugu zetu.” Ufunuo 12:10. Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke inaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

kutazama makosa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na na ku<strong>wa</strong>shikilia aki<strong>wa</strong>tangaza, lakini matendo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

mema <strong>ya</strong>napita bila kutaj<strong>wa</strong>. Katika historia yote <strong>ya</strong> kanisa hakuna matengenezo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> bila kukutana na vizuizi vikub<strong>wa</strong>. Po pote ambapo Paulo alisimamisha kanisa<br />

wengine <strong>wa</strong>liojidai kupokeo imani <strong>wa</strong>kaingiza ujushi. Luther pia alivumilia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>shupavu <strong>wa</strong>liojidai k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu alinena k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>lioweka ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

wenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lidangany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong>p<strong>ya</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaungana na Shetani k<strong>wa</strong> kuondoa k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu mambo ambayo Mungu aliongoza Luther<br />

kujenga. Wesleys alikutana na werevu <strong>wa</strong> Shetani katika kusukuma katika ushupavu <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> imara na <strong>wa</strong>siotakas<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

William Miller haku<strong>wa</strong> na huruma k<strong>wa</strong> ushupavu. “Ibilisi,” akasema Miller, “anaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na nguvu nyingi k<strong>wa</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong> wengine k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> leo.” “Mara nyingi, uso <strong>wa</strong> kungaa na<br />

164


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

upendo, shavu, lililolo<strong>wa</strong>na, maneno <strong>ya</strong> kukat<strong>wa</strong> na machozi, vimenipa ushahidi <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> moyo kuliko makelele yote katika ukristo.”<br />

Katika matengenezo adui zake <strong>wa</strong>kashitaki<strong>wa</strong> maovu <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiomba sana kukataa ushupavu. Mwendo <strong>wa</strong> namna ileile uliku<strong>wa</strong> ukifuat<strong>wa</strong><br />

na <strong>wa</strong>pinzani <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kiadventiste. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> na kuzidisha makosa <strong>ya</strong> ushupavu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaeneza taarifa ambazo haziku<strong>wa</strong> hata na uhusiano kidogo <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Amani <strong>ya</strong>o iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ikisumbuli<strong>wa</strong> na kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ku<strong>wa</strong> mlangoni. Waliogopa ingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> kweli,<br />

huku <strong>wa</strong>katumaini k<strong>wa</strong>mba haiku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> siri <strong>ya</strong> vita <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kupinga<br />

Waadventiste.<br />

Mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>lielekea mara kukomesha ushupavu.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioshirikiana k<strong>wa</strong> kazi hizi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika umoja; mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o ilijaz<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

upendo <strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> mwenzake na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Yesu, ambaye <strong>wa</strong>limtazamia kumwona<br />

upesi. Imani moja, tumaini la baraka moja, <strong>wa</strong>kahakikisha ngabo juu <strong>ya</strong> mashambulio <strong>ya</strong><br />

Shetani.<br />

Kosa Linasahihish<strong>wa</strong><br />

“Basi <strong>wa</strong>kati b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi alipokawia, <strong>wa</strong>o wote <strong>wa</strong>kasinzia na kulala usingizi. Lakini<br />

saa sita <strong>ya</strong> usiku kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kelele: Tazama b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi anakuja! tokeni kukutana naye.”<br />

Katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> jua kali <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 ujumbe ukatangaz<strong>wa</strong> katika maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko kabisa.<br />

Kile kilichoongoza k<strong>wa</strong> maendeleo ha<strong>ya</strong> kiliku<strong>wa</strong> ni uvumbuzi k<strong>wa</strong>mba amri <strong>ya</strong><br />

Artasasta k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kurudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Yerusalema, ambayo ilisaidia kujua m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong><br />

hesabu <strong>ya</strong> siku 2300, ikafanyika katika masika <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>wa</strong> 457 B.C., na si k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, kama ilivyoamini<strong>wa</strong>. Hesabu kutoka masika <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 457, miaka 2300<br />

ikamalizika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844. Mifano <strong>ya</strong> Agano la Kale pia ilielekeza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika kama <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao “kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu” kulipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufanyika.<br />

Kuchinj<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Kondoo <strong>wa</strong> Pasaka kuliku<strong>wa</strong> ni kivuli cha mauti <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, mfano<br />

ulitimilika, si k<strong>wa</strong> tukio tu, bali na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati. K<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> kumi na ine <strong>ya</strong> mwezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong> Wayuda, siku ile kabisa na mwezi ambapo k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi kondoo <strong>wa</strong> Pasaka<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> akichinj<strong>wa</strong>, Kristo akaanzisha karamu hiyo ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kukumbuka mauti<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe “M<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.” K<strong>wa</strong> usiku uleule akakamat<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kusulibi<strong>wa</strong> na kuua<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

165


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

UNABII WA 2300 SIKU / MIAKA<br />

Siku <strong>ya</strong> unabii = M<strong>wa</strong>ka mmoja<br />

34<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hesabu <strong>ya</strong> hizo siku mlizoipeleleza ile nchi, <strong>ya</strong>ani, siku arobaini kila siku<br />

kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, mta<strong>ya</strong>chukua maovu yenu, ndiyo miaka arobaini, nanyi mtakujua<br />

kufarikana k<strong>wa</strong>ngu. (Hesabu 14:34) 6 Tena utakapozitimiza hizo, utalala k<strong>wa</strong> ubavu <strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kuume, nawe utauchukua uovu <strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Yuda; siku arobaini, siku moja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ka mmoja, nimekuagizia. (Ezekieli 4:6)<br />

457 k.k – 1844 - 2300 Siku/ Miaka. 14 Akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia, Hata n<strong>ya</strong>kati za jioni na asubuhi<br />

elfu mbili na mia tatu; ndipo patakatifu patakapotakas<strong>wa</strong>. (Danieli 8:14) 24 Muda <strong>wa</strong><br />

majuma sabini umeamri<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko, na juu <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong>ko mtakatifu, ili kukomesha<br />

makosa, na kuishiliza dhambi, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uovu, na kuleta haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

milele, na kutia muhuri maono na unabii, na kumtia mafuta yeye aliye mtakatifu. 490 Siku /<br />

Miaka (Danieli 9:24)<br />

457 k.k - Amri <strong>ya</strong> kujenga tena na kurejesha Yerusalemu (Amri <strong>ya</strong> Mfalme Artaxerxes).<br />

25<br />

…Basi ujue na kufahamu, <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> tangu kuwek<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> kutengeneza na kuujenga<br />

up<strong>ya</strong> Yerusalemu hata zamani zake masihi aliye mkuu; kutaku<strong>wa</strong> na majuma saba; na katika<br />

166


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

majuma sitini na mawili utajeng<strong>wa</strong> tena pamoja na njia kuu zake na handaki, naam, katika<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za taabu. (Danieli 9:25)<br />

408 k.k - Yajenzi/ Kujenga up<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalemu<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 27 - Ubatizo na Upako <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo (Masihi). 27 Naye atafan<strong>ya</strong> agano thabiti<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> juma moja; na k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma hiyo ataikomesha sadaka na<br />

dhabihu; na mahali pake litasimama chukizo la uharibifu; na hivyo, hata ukomo, na<br />

ghadhabu iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> imem<strong>wa</strong>g<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenye kuharibu (Danieli 9:26-27)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 31 - Kusulibi<strong>wa</strong> na kifo cha Yesu Kristo. 26 Na baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le majuma sitini na<br />

mawili, masihi atakatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali, naye ataku<strong>wa</strong> hana kitu; na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> mkuu atakayekuja<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tauangamiza mji, na patakatifu; na mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke utaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na gharika, na hata<br />

mwisho ule vita vitaku<strong>wa</strong>po; uki<strong>wa</strong> umekwisha kukusudi<strong>wa</strong>. 27 Naye atafan<strong>ya</strong> agano thabiti<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> muda <strong>wa</strong> juma moja; na k<strong>wa</strong> nusu <strong>ya</strong> juma hiyo ataikomesha sadaka na<br />

dhabihu; na mahali pake litasimama chukizo la uharibifu; na hivyo, hata ukomo, na<br />

ghadhabu iliyokusudi<strong>wa</strong> imem<strong>wa</strong>g<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenye kuharibu (Danieli 9:26, 27)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 34 - Stefano Anapig<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mawe. Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi. Injili k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Ulimwengu. 14 Tena habari njema <strong>ya</strong> ufalme itahubiri<strong>wa</strong> katika ulimwengu wote, ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yote; hapo ndipo ule mwisho utakapokuja (Mathayo 24: 14) 46 Paulo<br />

na Barnaba <strong>wa</strong>kanena k<strong>wa</strong> ushujaa <strong>wa</strong>kasema, Iliku<strong>wa</strong> lazima neno la Mungu linenwe<br />

kwenu k<strong>wa</strong>nza; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mnalisukumia mbali, na kujiona nafsi zenu ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

hamkustahili uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele, angalieni, t<strong>wa</strong><strong>wa</strong>geukia Mataifa (Matendo <strong>ya</strong> Mitume 13:46)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 70 - Uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> Yerusalemu 1 Yesu akaenda zake, akatoka hekaluni;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kamwendea ili kumwonyesha majengo <strong>ya</strong> hekalu. 2 Naye akajibu<br />

aka<strong>wa</strong>ambia, Ham<strong>ya</strong>oni ha<strong>ya</strong> yote? Amin, na<strong>wa</strong>ambieni, Halitasalia hapa jiwe juu <strong>ya</strong> jiwe<br />

ambalo halitabomosh<strong>wa</strong>. (Mathayo 24:1, 2) 15 Basi hapo mtakapoliona chukizo la uharibifu,<br />

lile lililonen<strong>wa</strong> na nabii Danielii, limesimama katika patakatifu (asomaye na afahamu)… 21<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huo kutaku<strong>wa</strong>po dhiki kub<strong>wa</strong>, ambayo haijatokea namna <strong>ya</strong>ke tangu<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu hata sasa, <strong>wa</strong>la haitaku<strong>wa</strong>po kamwe (Mathayo 24: 15, 21)<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 - Utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Hekalu Takatifu Zaidi na M<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> Hukumu Mbinguni.<br />

1810 Siku / Miaka - Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Yesu Kristo kama Kuhani wetu Mkuu katika Hekalu la<br />

Mbinguni. 14 Basi, i<strong>wa</strong>po tunaye kuhani mkuu aliyeingia katika mbingu, Yesu, M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, na tu<strong>ya</strong>shike sana maungamo yetu. 15 K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> hamna kuhani mkuu asiyeweza<br />

kuchukuana nasi katika mambo yetu <strong>ya</strong> udhaifu; bali yeye alijaribi<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na sisi<br />

katika mambo yote, bila kufan<strong>ya</strong> dhambi. 16 Basi na tukikaribie kiti cha neema k<strong>wa</strong> ujasiri,<br />

ili tupewe rehema, na kupata neema <strong>ya</strong> kutusaidia <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mahitaji (Waebrania 4:14-16).<br />

Vivyo hivyo mifano <strong>ya</strong> kuelekea k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili inapas<strong>wa</strong> kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ulioonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> mfano. Kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu, ao Siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

167


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Upatanisho, kulitukia k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> kumi <strong>ya</strong> mwezi <strong>wa</strong> saba <strong>wa</strong> Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>kati kuhani<br />

mkuu, alipokwisha kufan<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Israeli yote, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo akaondoa<br />

zambi zao kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu, akaja na kubariki <strong>wa</strong>tu. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo iliamini<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo angeonekana kuja kutakasa dunia k<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu zambi na wenye zambi, na<br />

kubariki <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>naomungojea k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>pa kutokufa. Siku <strong>ya</strong> kumi <strong>ya</strong> mwezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

saba, Siku kuu <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahali patakatifu, ambao katika<br />

m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 ulianguka k<strong>wa</strong> tarehe <strong>ya</strong> makumi mbili na mbili <strong>ya</strong> Oktoba, ilizani<strong>wa</strong> kama ni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Siku 2300 zingemalizika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> masika, na mwisho<br />

ikaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi bila ubishi.<br />

“Kilio cha Usiku <strong>wa</strong> Manane”<br />

Maneno <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> na hakikisho la nguvu, na “kilio cha usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane” kikasiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu. Kama mawimbi, tukio hili likazambaa k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu toka mji k<strong>wa</strong> mji,<br />

kijiji k<strong>wa</strong> kijiji. Ushupavu ukatoweka kama baridi kali <strong>ya</strong> alfajiri kabla <strong>ya</strong> jua kutokea. Kazi<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna moja na ile <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ambako miongoni m<strong>wa</strong><br />

Israeli <strong>wa</strong> zamani <strong>wa</strong>lifuata ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> karipio kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha nyingi sana, lakini Zaidi uchunguzi mwingi <strong>wa</strong> moyo, ungamo la zambi, na kuacha<br />

dunia. Hapo kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kujitoa <strong>wa</strong>kfu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> miendo yote <strong>ya</strong> dini tangu siku za mitume, hakuna moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong>liojiepusha zaidi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> upungufu <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu na werevu <strong>wa</strong> Shetani kuliko ile ilioku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

masika <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844. K<strong>wa</strong> mwito, “Tazama b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi anakuja,” <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kingojea “<strong>wa</strong>kaamka, <strong>wa</strong>katengeneza taa zao”; <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza Neno la Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> usikizi<br />

mkuu ambao hauku<strong>wa</strong>ko mbele. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuku<strong>wa</strong> wenye vipa<strong>wa</strong> zaidi, bali wenye ku<strong>wa</strong> wenye<br />

unyenyekevu zaidi na wenye bidii, <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kutii mwito. Wakulima <strong>wa</strong>kaacha<br />

mavuno <strong>ya</strong>o katika mashamba, <strong>wa</strong>fundi <strong>wa</strong> mashine <strong>wa</strong>kaacha vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>o na k<strong>wa</strong> furaha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaenda kutoa maonyo. Makanisa k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong>kafunga milango <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe<br />

huu, na kundi kub<strong>wa</strong> la <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioukubali <strong>wa</strong>kajitenga k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wasiosadiki <strong>wa</strong>liokusanyika k<strong>wa</strong> mikutano <strong>ya</strong> Waadventiste <strong>wa</strong>kaona uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kusadikisha ukihuzuria ujumbe, “Tazama, b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi anakuja!” Imani ikaleta majibu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maombi. Kama manyunyu <strong>ya</strong> mvua juu <strong>ya</strong> inchi yenye kiu, Roho <strong>ya</strong> neema akashuka juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tafutao k<strong>wa</strong> bidii. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liotazamia upesi kusimama uso k<strong>wa</strong> uso pamoja na Mkombozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kaona furaha kub<strong>wa</strong>. Roho Mtakatifu akalainisha moyo.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokubali ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>kafikia <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao <strong>wa</strong>litumainia kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o. Wakaomba sana mtu k<strong>wa</strong> mwenzake. Wakakutana mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara katika mahali pa<br />

uficho kushirikiana pamoja na Mungu, na sauti <strong>ya</strong> maombezi ikapanda mbinguni kutoka<br />

mashambani na vichakani. Hakikisho la kibali cha Mwokozi <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> lazima zaidi k<strong>wa</strong>o<br />

kuliko chakula cha kila siku, na kama wingu lilitia giza katika akili zao, ha<strong>wa</strong>kutulia hata<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipoona ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> rehema.<br />

168


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kukatish<strong>wa</strong> Tamaa Tena<br />

Lakini tena, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kutazamia ukapita, na Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>o hakutokea. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>kaona<br />

kama Maria alivyofan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati alipokuja k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi la Mwokozi na kukuta linapoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi, akapaza sauti na kulia: “Wameondoa B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ngu, <strong>wa</strong>la sijui pahali<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipomuweka.” Yoane 20:13.<br />

Hofu k<strong>wa</strong>mba habari ingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> kweli ikatumi<strong>wa</strong> kama kizuio juu <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu<br />

usiosadiki. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>lipoona hakuna alama za hasira <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>kafunika tena hofu <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

na kuendelea na laumu lao na cheko. Kundi kub<strong>wa</strong> lililojidai kuamini <strong>wa</strong>kaacha imani <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Wenye kuzihaki <strong>wa</strong>kavuta <strong>wa</strong>zaifu na wenye kuogopea vyeo na ha<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga<br />

katika kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba ulimwengu unaweza kudumu k<strong>wa</strong> namna ileile k<strong>wa</strong> maelfu <strong>ya</strong><br />

miaka.<br />

Waaminifu <strong>wa</strong>liojitoak<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>meacha vyote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, na kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>livyoamini, <strong>wa</strong>katoa onyo lao la mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu. K<strong>wa</strong> hamu kub<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>meomba , “Kuja B<strong>wa</strong>na Yesu.” Lakini sasa k<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua tena mzigo <strong>wa</strong><br />

matata <strong>ya</strong> maisha na kudumu k<strong>wa</strong> matusi <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu wenye kuzihaki liliku<strong>wa</strong> jaribu la<br />

kutisha sana.<br />

Wakati Yesu alipopanda juu <strong>ya</strong> punda na kuingia Jerusalem kama mshindi <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba alitaka kuketi juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha ufalme cha Dawidi na kukomboa<br />

Israeli k<strong>wa</strong> magandamizi. K<strong>wa</strong> matumaini <strong>ya</strong> juu, wengi <strong>wa</strong>katandika mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> inje<br />

kama zulia (tapis) katika njia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>la kutapan<strong>ya</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke matawi yenye majani mengi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ngazi. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitimiza kusudi la Mungu,lakini <strong>wa</strong>kaangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uchungu mkali. Lakini siku chache zikapita kabla ha<strong>wa</strong>jashuhudia kifo cha maumivu<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> cha Mwokozi na kumlaza ndani <strong>ya</strong> kaburi. Matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kafa pamoja na<br />

Yesu. Hata <strong>wa</strong>kati B<strong>wa</strong>na alipofufuka toka kaburini ndipo <strong>wa</strong>kaweza kufahamu k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mambo yote <strong>ya</strong>litabiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> unabii.<br />

Ujumbe Ulitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Wakati Uliofaa<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna ileile Miller na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>katimiza unabii na <strong>wa</strong>katoa ujumbe<br />

ambao Maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>litabiri ulipash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu. Ha<strong>wa</strong>ngeweza<br />

kuutoa <strong>wa</strong>ngefahamu kabisa mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii <strong>ya</strong>nayoelekea uchungu <strong>wa</strong>o, na kutoa ujumbe<br />

mwengine kuhubiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yote kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Habari za malaika <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza na <strong>wa</strong> pili zilitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati unaofaa na zilitimiza kazi ambayo Mungu<br />

aliyokusudia <strong>wa</strong>itende.<br />

Dunia iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitazamia k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama Kristo hangetokea, Kiadventiste kingeach<strong>wa</strong> .<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi <strong>wa</strong>lipoacha imani <strong>ya</strong>o kuliku<strong>wa</strong> wengine <strong>wa</strong>liosimama imara.<br />

Matunda <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> adventiste, roho <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong> moyo, <strong>ya</strong> kukana dunia na<br />

kutengeneza maisha, ikashuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba iliku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kusubutu kukana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Roho Mtakatifu alishuhudia k<strong>wa</strong> mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

169


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuvumbua kosa katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati maalum za unabii. Adui zao ha<strong>wa</strong>kufaulu<br />

kuangusha maelezo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> unabii. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kukubali kukana msimamo uliofiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia na juhudi, kujifunza Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> maombi, katika akili zilizoangazi<strong>wa</strong> na Roho <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu na mioyo <strong>ya</strong> kuchom<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke wenye uzima, ambao ulisimama imara na<br />

kupinga <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> elimu na usemaji.<br />

Waadventiste <strong>wa</strong>liamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu ali<strong>wa</strong>ongoza kutoa onyo la hukumu.<br />

Wakatangaza, “limechunguza mioyo <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>liolisikia, ... ili <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaochunguza<br />

mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe, <strong>wa</strong>weze kujua upande gani ... <strong>wa</strong>ngepatikana, kama B<strong>wa</strong>na angefika<br />

sasa <strong>wa</strong>ngepaza sauti, `Huyu ndiye Mungu wetu, Tumemungoja, naye atatuokoa;’ ao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngeita miamba na milima kuanguka juu <strong>ya</strong>o ku<strong>wa</strong>ficha mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong>ke yeye<br />

anayeketi juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi!<br />

Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioendelea kuamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu aliongoza <strong>ya</strong>naelez<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong> William Miller: “Tumaini langu katika kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ni la nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> daima,<br />

nimefan<strong>ya</strong> tu, baada <strong>ya</strong> miaka <strong>ya</strong> uangalifu, kila nilichoona <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>ngu kufan<strong>ya</strong>.”<br />

“Maelfu mengi, k<strong>wa</strong> mfano wote <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu, <strong>wa</strong>lifany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kujifunza Maandiko<br />

katika mahubiri <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati; na k<strong>wa</strong> njia ile, katika imani na kum<strong>wa</strong>ngi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo, <strong>wa</strong>mepatanish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.”<br />

Imani Inaimarish<strong>wa</strong><br />

Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> ingali inakaa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao ha<strong>wa</strong>kukataa nuru k<strong>wa</strong> wepesi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liopokea na kulaumu ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu “Basi, msitupe mbali matumaini yenu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong>na za<strong>wa</strong>di kub<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu munahitaji uvumilivu, ili mukikwisha kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, mupate ile ahadi. K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> bado kidogo sana, Yeye anayekuja<br />

atakuja, <strong>wa</strong>la hatakawia. Lakini mwenye haki ataishi k<strong>wa</strong> imani: Naye kama akirudi nyuma,<br />

roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu haina furaha naye. Lakini sisi si <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kurudi nyuma k<strong>wa</strong> kupotea, lakini sisi<br />

ni pamoja nao <strong>wa</strong>lio na imani <strong>ya</strong> kuokoa roho zetu.” Waebrania 10:35-39.<br />

Onyo la upole hili linaambi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa katika siku za mwisho. Linaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong>mba B<strong>wa</strong>na angetokea k<strong>wa</strong> kukawia. Watu hapa <strong>wa</strong>lioambi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lifan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mungu katika kufuata uongozi <strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke na Neno lake; lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza<br />

kufahamu kusudi lake katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>o. Walijaribi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mashaka k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> aki<strong>wa</strong>ongoza k<strong>wa</strong> kweli. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu maneno <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kufaa: “Sasa<br />

mwenye haki ataishi k<strong>wa</strong> imani.” Wakainama k<strong>wa</strong> matumaini <strong>ya</strong> kukata tamaa,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza kusimama tu k<strong>wa</strong> imani katika Mungu na k<strong>wa</strong> Neno lake. K<strong>wa</strong> kukana imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o na kukana uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu ambaye alitumikia katika ujumbe ingeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kurudi nyuma k<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu. Maendeleo <strong>ya</strong>o tu <strong>ya</strong> salama iliku<strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>wa</strong>liokwisha<br />

kupokea k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, kuendelea kuchunguza Maandiko, na kungoja k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu na<br />

kukesha k<strong>wa</strong> kupokea nuru zaidi.<br />

170


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 23. Siri <strong>ya</strong> Wazi <strong>ya</strong> Pahali Patakatifu<br />

Maandiko ambayo ni <strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mengine <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> vyote viwili, msingi na nguzo <strong>ya</strong><br />

katikati <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu iliku<strong>wa</strong> tangazo, “Hata mangaribi na asubui <strong>ya</strong> siku elfu<br />

mbili mia tatu; halafu Pahali patakatifu patatakas<strong>wa</strong>.” Danieli 8:14. Ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> maneno<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mazoezi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amini wote juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja upesi k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Lakini B<strong>wa</strong>na hakutokea.<br />

Waamini <strong>wa</strong>lijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba Neno la Mungu halitaweza kushind<strong>wa</strong>; maelezo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> unabii<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa. Lakini kosa liliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pi?<br />

Mungu aliongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke katika mwendo mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Hangeuruhusu<br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke uwe <strong>wa</strong> giza na uchungu, kulaumi<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong> uwongo na <strong>wa</strong> ushupavu.<br />

Ijapo wengi <strong>wa</strong>kaacha kuhesabia n<strong>ya</strong>kati zao za unabii na <strong>wa</strong>kakana msingi ulioimarish<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwendo, wengine ha<strong>wa</strong>kutaka kukataa mambo <strong>ya</strong> imani na maisha <strong>ya</strong>liyokubali<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Maandiko na Roho <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>o kushikilia k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu ukweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyokwisha kupata. K<strong>wa</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> juhudi <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> kuvumbua kosa<br />

lao. K<strong>wa</strong> namna ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuona kosa k<strong>wa</strong> hesabu zao za n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kachunguza zaidi sana fundisho la Pahali patakatifu.<br />

Wakajifunza k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna ushahidi <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko unaokubali maoni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba dunia ni Pahali patakatifu; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kapata maelezo kamili <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu;<br />

asili <strong>ya</strong>ke, pahali, na matumizi:<br />

“Basi hata agano la k<strong>wa</strong>nza liliku<strong>wa</strong> na amri <strong>ya</strong> kuabudu Mungu, na Pahali patakatifu<br />

pake pa dunia. Maana hema ilitengenez<strong>wa</strong> ile <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> na taa, na meza na<br />

mikate <strong>ya</strong> onyesho k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, palipoit<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu. Na nyuma <strong>ya</strong> pazia la pili,<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> hema iliyoit<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu, yenye kifukizo cha zahabu na<br />

sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano iliyofunik<strong>wa</strong> na zahabu pande zote, na ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kopo la<br />

zabahu yenye mana, na fimbo <strong>ya</strong> Haruni iliyochipuka, na vibao v<strong>ya</strong> agano; na juu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

makerubi <strong>ya</strong> zahabu, <strong>ya</strong>kitia kivuli juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha rehema:” Waebrania 9:1-5.<br />

“Pahali patakatifu” iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni hema iliyojeng<strong>wa</strong> na Musa k<strong>wa</strong> agizo la Mungu kama<br />

pahali pa kukaa pa kidunia pa Mwenyezi Mungu. “Na <strong>wa</strong>nifanyie Pahali patakatifu; nipate<br />

kukaa katikati <strong>ya</strong>o” (Kutoka 25:8), iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni agizo lililotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Musa. Hema <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

maskani iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni umbo kub<strong>wa</strong> la fahari. Zaidi <strong>ya</strong> u<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong> inje, hema yenyewe iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na vyumba viwili vilivyoit<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu na Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu,<br />

vilivyoga<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> na pazia nzuri sana, Kifuniko cha namna moja kilifunga mlango k<strong>wa</strong><br />

chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza.<br />

Pahali Patakatifu na Patakatifu pa Patakatifu<br />

Katika Pahali patakatifu kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na kinara upande <strong>wa</strong> kusini pamoja na taa zake saba<br />

kutoa nuru mchana na usiku; upande <strong>wa</strong> kaskazini kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na meza <strong>ya</strong> mikate <strong>ya</strong> onyesho.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> pazia inayotenga Pahali patakatifu na patakatifu pa patakatifu kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

171


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> zahabu <strong>ya</strong> uvumba, ambalo wingu la manukato, pamoja na maombi <strong>ya</strong> Israeli,<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kipanda kila siku mbele za Mungu.<br />

Katika Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu palisimama sanduku, sanduku ilifunik<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

zahabu, gala <strong>ya</strong> Amri Kumi. Juu <strong>ya</strong> sanduku kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na kiti cha rehema kilichoku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

makerubi <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>liofany<strong>wa</strong> na zahabu ngumu. Ndani <strong>ya</strong> chumba hiki ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu kulionekana katika wingu utukufu lililoku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong> kerubi.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Waebrania katika Kanana, hema ao maskani ili<strong>wa</strong>kombole<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hekalu <strong>ya</strong> Solomono, ambayo, ijapo ni <strong>ya</strong> umbo la daima na <strong>ya</strong> ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> juu,<br />

ikafuata ulinganifu <strong>wa</strong> namna moja na vyombo vivyo hivyo. Katika umbo hili hema<br />

lika<strong>wa</strong>ko--isipoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> maangamizi <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Danieli-hata maharibifu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong> Waroma katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka A.D. 70. Hii ni Pahali patakatifu tu duniani<br />

ambapo Biblia inatoa maelezo yote, Pahali patakatifu pa agano la k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Lakini agano<br />

jip<strong>ya</strong> halina Pahali patakatifu?<br />

Kurudi tena k<strong>wa</strong> kitabu cha Waebrania, <strong>wa</strong>katafuta ukweli <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba Pahali<br />

patakatifu pa agano la pili ao jip<strong>ya</strong> ilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyokwisha kuelez<strong>wa</strong><br />

vizuri: “Basi hata agano la k<strong>wa</strong>nza liliku<strong>wa</strong> na amri <strong>ya</strong> kuabudu Mungu, na Pahali<br />

patakatifu pake pa dunia.” Kurudi nyuma k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> sura <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, <strong>wa</strong>nasoma:<br />

“Basi, neno kub<strong>wa</strong> katika maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> tunasoma ni hii: Tuna kuhani mukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

hii, aliyeketi mukono <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong> kiti cha Mwenyezi katika mbingu, mutumishi <strong>wa</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu, na <strong>wa</strong> hema <strong>ya</strong> kweli, ndiyo B<strong>wa</strong>na aliisimamisha, <strong>wa</strong>la si <strong>wa</strong>tu.” Waebrania<br />

8:1,2.<br />

Hapa panafunua Pahali patakatifu pa agano jip<strong>ya</strong>... Pahali patakatifu pa agano la k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

ilitengenez<strong>wa</strong> na Musa; hii ilitengenez<strong>wa</strong> na B<strong>wa</strong>na. Katika patakatifu pale pa kidunia<br />

makuhani <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitenda huduma <strong>ya</strong>o; katika hii, Kristo, Kuhani wetu Mkuu,<br />

alihudumia k<strong>wa</strong> mukono <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Hema takatifu moja iliku<strong>wa</strong> duniani, na<br />

ingine iliku<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Hema iliyojeng<strong>wa</strong> na Musa ilifany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mfano. B<strong>wa</strong>na alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akionyesha:<br />

“Sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na maneno yote ninayokuonyesha, mufano <strong>wa</strong> hema, mfano <strong>wa</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

vyote, ndivyo mutakavyofan<strong>ya</strong>.” “Na angalia uvifanye k<strong>wa</strong> mufano <strong>wa</strong>o ulioonyesh<strong>wa</strong><br />

mulimani.” Hema <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza iliku<strong>wa</strong> “mufano <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> sasa; ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke sadaka na<br />

zabihu zilitole<strong>wa</strong>”, mahali pake takatifu “mifano <strong>ya</strong> vitu vilivyo mbinguni.” Makuhani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitumika k<strong>wa</strong> mufano na kivuli cha vitu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni.” Kristo hakuingia<br />

katika Pahali patakatifu palipofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mikono, ndio mufano <strong>wa</strong> kweli, lakini aliingia<br />

mbinguni zenyewe, aonekane sasa mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu.” Kutoka 25:9,40;<br />

Waebrania 9:23; 8:5; 9:24.<br />

Hema <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni ni asili kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> hema Musa alijenga ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni mfano.<br />

Fahari <strong>ya</strong> hema <strong>ya</strong> kidunia iliku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> hekalu lile la mbinguni pahali<br />

172


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kristo anapohudumia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu mbele <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha ezi cha Mungu. Ukweli <strong>wa</strong> maana juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> hema <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni na ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu <strong>ya</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> na Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

kidunia na huduma zake.<br />

Vyumba Viwili<br />

Nafasi takatifu za mahali patakatifu mbinguni zinafananish<strong>wa</strong> na vyumba viwili katika<br />

Pahali patakatifu duniani. Yohana alijali<strong>wa</strong> na maono <strong>ya</strong> hekalu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu mbinguni.<br />

Alitazama kule “taa saba za moto zili<strong>wa</strong>ka mbele <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi.” Aliona malaika<br />

“mwenye chungu cha zahabu <strong>ya</strong> uvumba; akape<strong>wa</strong> uvumba mwingi, ili autie pamoja na<br />

maombi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu wote juu <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> zahabu iliyo mbele <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi.”<br />

Ufunuo 4:5; 8:3. Hapa nabii akaona chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza cha Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni;<br />

na aliona “taa saba za moto” na “mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> zahabu”, iliyofananish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kinara cha<br />

zahabu na mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> uvumba katika Pahali patakatifu pa dunia.<br />

Tena ‘’hekalu la Mungu likafunguli<strong>wa</strong>”, na akatazama ndani <strong>ya</strong> pazia juu <strong>ya</strong> patakatifu<br />

pa patakatifu. Na akaona “sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano lake” la kufananish<strong>wa</strong> na sanduku lililojeng<strong>wa</strong><br />

na Musa k<strong>wa</strong> kuweka ndani amri <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ufunuo 11:19.<br />

Hivyo, <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojifunza fundisho hili <strong>wa</strong>kaone bila shaka k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakika mbinguni<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> hema. Musa alijenga hema <strong>ya</strong> kidunia akifuata mfano alioonyesh<strong>wa</strong>. Paulo<br />

anafundisha ku<strong>wa</strong> mfano ule uliku<strong>wa</strong> hema <strong>ya</strong> kweli ambao unaku<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Na Yoane<br />

anashuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliiona mbinguni.<br />

Ndani <strong>ya</strong> hekalu mbinguni, Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu kunaku<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Sanduku inayowek<strong>wa</strong> amri inafunik<strong>wa</strong> na kiti cha rehema, ambapo mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke Yesu<br />

anatetea mwenye zambi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hapa ndipo kunafananish<strong>wa</strong> muungano <strong>wa</strong><br />

haki na rehema katika mpango <strong>wa</strong> wokovu, muungano ambao unashangaza mbingu yote<br />

mzima. Hii ndiyo siri rehema ambamo malaika <strong>wa</strong>natamani kutazama vile Mungu anaweza<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye haki <strong>wa</strong>kati anahesabia haki mwenye zambi anayetubu.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo kama mutetezi <strong>wa</strong> binadamu, inafananish<strong>wa</strong> katika Zakaria: “Atajenga<br />

hekalu la B<strong>wa</strong>na; na atachukua utukufu, na atakaa na kuta<strong>wa</strong>la juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti chake cha enzi;<br />

naye ataku<strong>wa</strong> kuhani k<strong>wa</strong> enzi <strong>ya</strong>ke, na mshauri <strong>wa</strong> amani ataku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>wili”.<br />

Zacharia 6:12,13.<br />

“Atajenga hekalu la B<strong>wa</strong>na”. K<strong>wa</strong> zabihu <strong>ya</strong>ke na upatanisho, kristo ni msingi na<br />

mjengaji <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Mungu, “jiwe kub<strong>wa</strong> la pembeni. Katika yeye jengo lote<br />

linaunganish<strong>wa</strong> vema na kukaa hata liwe hekalu takatifu katika B<strong>wa</strong>na”. Waefeso 2:20,21.<br />

“Atachukua utukufu”. Wimbo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaonunuli<strong>wa</strong> utaku<strong>wa</strong>: “k<strong>wa</strong>ke yeye<br />

aliyetupenda na kutuosha zambi zetu k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke,...k<strong>wa</strong> yeye utukufu na uwezo hata<br />

milele na milele”. Ufunuo 1:5,6.<br />

173


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Atakaa na kuta<strong>wa</strong>la juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti chake cha enzi; naye ataku<strong>wa</strong> kuhani juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti chake<br />

cha ufalme”. Ufalme <strong>wa</strong> utukufu haujaingili<strong>wa</strong> bado. Mpaka kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama mpatanishi<br />

imalizike, ndipo Mungu atamtolea ufalme ambao “hautaku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho” Luka 1:33. Kama<br />

kuhani, Kristo anakaa sasa pamoja na Baba katika kiti chake cha enzi. Juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti kile cha<br />

ufalme kunaku<strong>wa</strong> yeye “aliyechukua taabu zetu; na kubeba huzuni zetu”, ambaye aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

“katika mambo yote alijaribi<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na sisi, lakini pasipo kufan<strong>ya</strong> zambi”, kusudi<br />

aweze kusaidia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojaribi<strong>wa</strong>”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 53:4; Waebrania 4:15; 2:18. Mikono<br />

iliyojeruhi<strong>wa</strong>, upande uliochom<strong>wa</strong> mukuki,n<strong>ya</strong> yo ilioharibi<strong>wa</strong>, vinamtetea m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu<br />

aliye anguka ambaye wokovu <strong>wa</strong>ke ulipatikana k<strong>wa</strong> bei sa<strong>wa</strong> ile.<br />

“Na shauri la salama litaku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>wili”. Upendo <strong>wa</strong> Baba ni chemchemi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> ukoo uliopotea. Yesu ali<strong>wa</strong>ambia <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke, “Baba yeye mwenyewe<br />

ana<strong>wa</strong>penda”. Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> “ndani <strong>ya</strong> Kristo akipatanisha ulimwengu naye mwenyewe”.<br />

“Mungu alipenda ulimwengu hata kutoa M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> pekee”. Yoane 16:27; 2<br />

Wakorinto 5:19; Yoane 3:16.<br />

Siri <strong>ya</strong> Mahali Patakatifu Inaelez<strong>wa</strong><br />

“Hema <strong>ya</strong> kweli” mbinguni ni Pahali patakatifu pa agano jip<strong>ya</strong>. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> kifo cha<br />

Kristo, huduma <strong>ya</strong> kufananisha ilimalizika. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu Danieli 8: 14 ilitimilika katika<br />

mgawo huu, Pahali patakatifu ambapo maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naelekea ni Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

agano jip<strong>ya</strong>. Hivyo, unabii, huu “Hata mangaribi na asubui <strong>ya</strong> siku elfu mbili mia tatu,<br />

halafu Pahali patakatifu patasafish<strong>wa</strong>” unaelekea Pahali patakatifu mbinguni. Lakini<br />

kusafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> pahali patakatifu maana <strong>ya</strong>ke ni nini? Mbinguni kunaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> kitu cha<br />

kusafish<strong>wa</strong>? Katika Waebrania 9 kusafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa duniani na Pahali<br />

patakatifu pa mbinguni vinafundish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi :<br />

Karibu vitu vyote vinasafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> damu, na pasipo kum<strong>wa</strong>nga damu hakuna ondoleo.<br />

Basi, mifano <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyo mbinguni ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kusafish<strong>wa</strong> hivyo lakini vitu v<strong>ya</strong><br />

mbinguni yenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> zabihu nzuri zaidi kuliko hizi” (Waebrania 9:22,33), k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

zamani <strong>ya</strong> Kristo.<br />

Kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali Patakatifu<br />

Kusafish<strong>wa</strong> katika huduma <strong>ya</strong> kweli kunapas<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. “Pasipo<br />

kum<strong>wa</strong>nga damu hakuna ondoleo. Ondoleo, ao kuondoa Zambi, ndiyo kazi yenye<br />

kutimiz<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Lakini inawezekana je, zambi kuambatana na Pahali patakatifu mbinguni? Hii inaweza<br />

kujifunz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuangalia huduma <strong>ya</strong> mfano, k<strong>wa</strong> maana makuhani duniani <strong>wa</strong>litumika<br />

“k<strong>wa</strong> mufano na kivuli cha mambo <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni.” Waebrania 8:5.<br />

Huduma <strong>ya</strong> patakatifu pa kidunia iliku<strong>wa</strong> na sehemu mbili. Makuhani <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kihudumia kila siku katika Pahali patakatifu, lakini mara moja k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka kuhani mkuu<br />

174


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

alifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi maalumu <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho katika Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

kusafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu. Siku k<strong>wa</strong> siku mwenye zambi anayetubu alileta sadaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke na, kuweka mukono <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha kafara, akaungama zambi zake, katika<br />

mufano kuzihamisha kutoka k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe hata k<strong>wa</strong> kafara isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa. N<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

basi alichinj<strong>wa</strong>. “K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> uhai <strong>wa</strong> mwili ni katika damu.” Walawi 17:11. Sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu iliyovunj<strong>wa</strong> ilidai uhai <strong>wa</strong> mkosaji. Damu, inayoku<strong>wa</strong> mufano <strong>wa</strong> uhai <strong>wa</strong> mwenye<br />

zambi ambaye kosa lake huchukuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kafara (mn<strong>ya</strong>ma), ilibeb<strong>wa</strong> na kuhani katika<br />

Pahali patakatifu na kunyunyiz<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> pazia, nyuma ambapo paliku<strong>wa</strong> na sheria<br />

ambayo mwenye zambi aliyovunja. K<strong>wa</strong> ibada hii zambi ikahamish<strong>wa</strong> katika mfano hata<br />

Pahali patakatifu. Mara zingine damu haikupelek<strong>wa</strong> katika Pahali patakatifu, lakini n<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

ikali<strong>wa</strong> na makuhani. Ibada mbili hizo ziliku<strong>wa</strong> mufano <strong>wa</strong> uhamisho <strong>wa</strong> zambi kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwenye kutubu hata k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna hiyo kazi iliendelea kufanyika muda <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka wote mzima. Zambi za<br />

Israeli ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikihamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu, na kazi <strong>ya</strong> kipekee ika<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> lazima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ondoleo lao la zambi.<br />

Siku Kuu <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho<br />

Mara moja k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, k<strong>wa</strong> Siku Kuu <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho, kuhani akaingia katika Pahali<br />

patakatifu pa patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kutakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu. Wana <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong><br />

mbuzi <strong>wa</strong>kalet<strong>wa</strong> na kura ikapig<strong>wa</strong>, “kura moja ni <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na na kura ingine <strong>ya</strong> Azazeli.”<br />

Walawi 16:8. Mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na akachinj<strong>wa</strong> kama sadaka <strong>ya</strong> zambi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, na<br />

kuhani alipash<strong>wa</strong> kuleta damu ndani <strong>ya</strong> pazia na kuinyunyiza mbele <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha rehema na<br />

pia juu <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> uvumba mbele <strong>ya</strong> pazia.<br />

“Na Haruni ataweka mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke miwili juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha yule mbuzi aliye hai, na<br />

kukiri juu <strong>ya</strong>ke maovu yote <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Israeli na makosa <strong>ya</strong>o yote, hata zambi zao zote;<br />

naye ataziweka zote juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha yule mbuzi aliye hai na kumutuma jang<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mukono <strong>wa</strong> mutu aliye ta<strong>ya</strong>ri, na yule mbuzi atachukua juu <strong>ya</strong>ke maovu <strong>ya</strong>o yote mupaka<br />

inchi isiyo na <strong>wa</strong>tu; ataacha mbuzi kwenda zake jang<strong>wa</strong>ni.” Walawi 16:21,22. Mbuzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Azazeli hakurudi tena katika kambi la Israeli.<br />

Ibada ilikusudi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuvuta Waisraeli k<strong>wa</strong> utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na machukio <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi. Kila mutu aliomb<strong>wa</strong> kuhuzunisha roho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kati kazi hii <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho ilipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

ikiendelea. Kazi zote zikawek<strong>wa</strong> kando, na Israeli alipash<strong>wa</strong> kutumia siku yenyewe katika<br />

maombi, kufunga, na kuchunguza moyo.<br />

Kiti kingine kilikubali<strong>wa</strong> baadala <strong>ya</strong> mwenye zambi, lakini zambi hazikufut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

damu <strong>ya</strong> kafara (mn<strong>ya</strong>ma); zilihamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu. K<strong>wa</strong> sadaka <strong>ya</strong> damu<br />

mwenye zambi akatambua mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> sheria, akatubu kosa lake, na akaonyesha imani <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

katika Mukombozi atakaye kuja; lakini hakufunguli<strong>wa</strong> kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> sheria. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

Siku <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho kuhani mkuu, anapokwisha kupata sadaka k<strong>wa</strong> makutano, akaenda<br />

175


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu. Akanyunyiza damu <strong>ya</strong> sadaka juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha<br />

rehema, mara moja juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria, kufan<strong>ya</strong> malipizi k<strong>wa</strong> madai <strong>ya</strong>ke. Halafu, kama<br />

mwombezi, akachukua zambi juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe na kuzibeba kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu. Kuweka mukono <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli, yeye katika mufano<br />

akahamisha zambi hizi zote kutoka k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe hata k<strong>wa</strong> mbuzi. Ndipo mbuzi<br />

akazichukua mbali, na ziliangali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ziliteng<strong>wa</strong> milele kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Uhakika <strong>wa</strong> Mbinguni<br />

Kitu kilichotend<strong>wa</strong> katika mufano <strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa kidunia,<br />

inatend<strong>wa</strong> katika ukweli katika Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni. Baada <strong>ya</strong> kupanda k<strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

mbinguni Mwokozi wetu akaanza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama kuhani mkuu wetu: ” K<strong>wa</strong> sababu Kristo<br />

hakuingia katika Pahali patakatifu palipofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mikono, ndio mufano <strong>wa</strong> kweli, lakini<br />

aliingia mbinguni zenyewe, aonekane sasa mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu.” Waebrania<br />

9:24.<br />

Utumishi <strong>wa</strong> kuhani katika chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza, “ndani <strong>ya</strong> pazia” inayotenga Pahali<br />

patakatifu pa patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> behe<strong>wa</strong> (u<strong>wa</strong>nja) <strong>ya</strong> inje, ni mufano <strong>wa</strong> kazi ambayo Kristo<br />

alianza kisha <strong>wa</strong>kati alipo panda mbinguni. Kuhani katika utumishi <strong>wa</strong> kila siku akaonyesha<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu damu <strong>ya</strong> sadaka <strong>ya</strong> zambi, vilevile uvumba ambao unapanda pamoja na<br />

maombi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Israeli. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo Kristo anaombea damu <strong>ya</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baba k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

wenye zambi na anaonyesha mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, pamoja na manukato <strong>ya</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe,<br />

maombi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amini <strong>wa</strong>liotubu. Hiyo ndiyo iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> huduma katika chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

cha Pahali patakatifu katika mbingu.<br />

Huko imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>kamfuata <strong>wa</strong>kati alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akipanda. Hapa<br />

matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong>, “tumaini gani tuliyo nayo kama nanga <strong>ya</strong> roho, yote mbili kweli<br />

na ku<strong>wa</strong> imara, na inayoingia ndani <strong>ya</strong> pazia, pahali alipoingia Yesu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu,<br />

mutangulizi wetu, ameku<strong>wa</strong> kuhani mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> milele.” “K<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe<br />

aliingia mara moja tu katika Pahali patakatifu alikwisha kupata ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili yetu.” Waebrania 6:19,20; 9:12.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na mnane kazi hii ikaendelea katika chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

cha Pahali patakatifu. Damu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo ikahakikisha rehema na ukubali <strong>wa</strong> Baba k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>amini <strong>wa</strong>liotubu, lakini zambi zao zingali zikidumu k<strong>wa</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho. Kama<br />

katika huduma <strong>ya</strong> mfano huko kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na kazi <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ka, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hivyo kabla <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kumalizika kunaku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ondoleo la zambi k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu. Kazi hii ilianza <strong>wa</strong>kati siku 2300<br />

zilipokwisha. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule Kuhani wetu Mkub<strong>wa</strong> akaingia Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> kusafisha Pahali patakatifu.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Hukumu<br />

176


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika agano jip<strong>ya</strong> zambi za mwenye kutubu zinawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> imani juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na<br />

kuhamish<strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni. Na kama kusafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mfano<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa kudunia kulifany<strong>wa</strong> na ondoleo la zambi ambazo zilipachafua,<br />

vivyo hivyo utakaso <strong>wa</strong> sasa <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni unatimiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ondoleo, ao kufut<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> zambi<br />

zilizoandik<strong>wa</strong> pale. Lakini kabla <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili kuweza kufanyika uchunguzi unapash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufanyika pale <strong>wa</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho kuonyesha ni <strong>wa</strong>nani, k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> toba na imani<br />

katika Kristo, <strong>wa</strong>naostahili kupata faida <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong>ke. Basi utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> hivi unahusika na kazi <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi -kazi <strong>ya</strong> hukumu -<strong>ya</strong> kutangulia kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, k<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>wa</strong>kati atakuja, na mushahara <strong>wa</strong>ke ni pamoja naye kulipa kila mutu<br />

kama ilivyo kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ufunuo 22:12.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liofuata nuru <strong>ya</strong> neno la unabii <strong>wa</strong>liona k<strong>wa</strong>mba, badala <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

duniani k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300 katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844, Kristo aliingia k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu pa patakatifu mno pa mbinguni kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

kutangulia kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Wakati Kristo katika uwezo <strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke anapoondoa zambi za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>ya</strong>ke, ataziweka juu <strong>ya</strong> Shetani,<br />

anayepash<strong>wa</strong> kupata azabu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho. Mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli akatum<strong>wa</strong> mbali katika inchi<br />

isiyokali<strong>wa</strong>, hawezi kuja tena katika makutano <strong>ya</strong> Waisraeli. Ndivyo Shetani<br />

atakavyoangamiz<strong>wa</strong> milele mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na ataondole<strong>wa</strong> maisha katika<br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> zambi na wenye zambi.<br />

177


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 24. Kristo Anafan<strong>ya</strong> Kazi Gani Sasa?<br />

Fundisho la Pahali patakatifu likafungua siri <strong>ya</strong> uchungu. Likafungua k<strong>wa</strong> maoni kanuni<br />

kamili <strong>ya</strong> ukweli, yenye uhusiano na <strong>ya</strong> kulingana, kuonyesha mkono <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulioongoza<br />

kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liotazamia k<strong>wa</strong> imani kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke mara <strong>ya</strong> pili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kamtazamia kutokea katika utukufu, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o ha<strong>ya</strong>kufanyiki<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kapoteza akili juu <strong>ya</strong> Yesu. Sasa ndani <strong>ya</strong> patakatifu pa patakatifu <strong>wa</strong>katazama tena<br />

Kuhani <strong>wa</strong>o mkub<strong>wa</strong>, kutokea upesi kama mfalme na mkombozi. Nuru kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu ikaangazia <strong>wa</strong>kati uliopita, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> sasa, na <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao. Inga<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufahamu ujumbe <strong>wa</strong>liopata, k<strong>wa</strong>ni uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

Kosa haliku<strong>wa</strong> katika kutambua k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za unabii, lakini katika tukio kufanyika<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300. K<strong>wa</strong>ni yote <strong>ya</strong>liyotabiri<strong>wa</strong> na unabii <strong>ya</strong>litimilika. Kristo alikuja,<br />

si duniani, bali katika Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu pa hekalu katika mbingu; “Nikaona<br />

katika maono <strong>ya</strong> usiku, na tazama, pamoja na mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu aliku<strong>wa</strong> mmoja aliye<br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, akakaribia huyu Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku, <strong>wa</strong>kamuleta karibu naye.”<br />

Danieli 7:13.<br />

Kuja huku kulitabiri<strong>wa</strong> pia na Malaika: “Na B<strong>wa</strong>na munayemutafuta atakuja gafula<br />

hekaluni m<strong>wa</strong>ke; na mujumbe <strong>wa</strong> agano munayemupenda, tazameni, atakuja, B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

majeshi anasema.” Malaki 3:1. Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na katika hekalu <strong>ya</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> gafula,<br />

hakukuzani<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kimtazamia pale.<br />

Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> bado ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o. Pale kuliku<strong>wa</strong> kungali kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mata<strong>ya</strong>risho itimizwe k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kufuata k<strong>wa</strong> imani Kuhani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o mkub<strong>wa</strong> katika huduma <strong>ya</strong>ke, kazi mp<strong>ya</strong> zingeweza kufunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Ujumbe mwengine<br />

ulipash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa.<br />

Nani Atakayesimama?<br />

Nabii akasema: “Nani atakayevumilia siku <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke? na nani atakayesimama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati atakapoonekana? ... Naye atakaa kama mwenye kusafisha na kutakasa feza, naye<br />

atatakasa <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Lawi, na ata<strong>wa</strong>safisha kama zahabu na feza, nao <strong>wa</strong>tatoa k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

sadaka k<strong>wa</strong> haki.” Malaki 3:2,3. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naokaa duniani <strong>wa</strong>kati teteo <strong>ya</strong> Kristo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>takapoisha <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kusimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu bila muombezi. Mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

<strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> safi bila doa, tabia zao zenye kutakas<strong>wa</strong> kutoka zambini k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong><br />

manyunyu. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na juhudi <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe <strong>ya</strong> utendaji <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shindaji katika vita na yule muovu. Wakati hukumu <strong>ya</strong> ukaguzi inapoendelea<br />

mbele kule mbinguni, <strong>wa</strong>kati zambi za <strong>wa</strong>amini <strong>wa</strong>liotubu zinapoondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Pahali patakatifu, hapo panapash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na kazi <strong>ya</strong> kipekee <strong>ya</strong> kuacha zambi miongoni<br />

m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu duniani. Kazi hii inaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 14. Wakati<br />

kazi hii itakapotimiz<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong> kutokea k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Ndipo<br />

178


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kanisa ambalo B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke analopash<strong>wa</strong> kupokea litaku<strong>wa</strong> “kanisa la<br />

utukufu, pasipo doa <strong>wa</strong>la kikunjo <strong>wa</strong>la kitu cho chote kama hivi.” Waefeso 5:27.<br />

“Tazama, B<strong>wa</strong>na Arusi Anakuja”<br />

Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kama Kuhani Mkuu k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> usafisho<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu (Danieli 8:14), kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku (Danieli<br />

7:13), na kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na katika hekalu <strong>ya</strong>ke (Malaki 3:11) ni matukio <strong>ya</strong> namna moja.<br />

Jambo hili pia ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi k<strong>wa</strong> ndoa katika mfano <strong>wa</strong> mabikira kumi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Matayo 25.<br />

Katika mfano, <strong>wa</strong>kati b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi alipofika, “nao <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri <strong>wa</strong>liingia pamoja<br />

naye k<strong>wa</strong> arusi.” Kuja huku k<strong>wa</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi kulifanyika mbele <strong>ya</strong> arusi. Arusi ni mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

kupokele<strong>wa</strong> na Kristo katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke. Mji Mtakatifu, Yerusalema Mp<strong>ya</strong>, mji mkub<strong>wa</strong><br />

(capitale) ambao ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> ufalme, unait<strong>wa</strong> “bibi arusi, mke <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo.”<br />

Akasema malaika k<strong>wa</strong> Yoane: “Kuja hapa, nami nitakuonyesha yule bibi-arusi, mke <strong>wa</strong><br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.” “Akanichukua katika roho,“nabii asema, “akanionyesha ule mji mkub<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

Yerusalema mtakatifu, ukishuka toka mbinguni, k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.” Ufunuo 21:9,10.<br />

Bibi-arusi ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> Mji Mtakatifu, na mabikira <strong>wa</strong>liotoka kukutana na b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi<br />

ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> kanisa. Katika Ufunuo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nait<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>geni k<strong>wa</strong> chakula cha<br />

arusi. Kama <strong>wa</strong>geni, ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi ku<strong>wa</strong> bibi-arusi. Kristo atapokea kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku<br />

katika mbingu “mamlaka, na utukufu, na ufalme.” Yerusalema Mp<strong>ya</strong>, mji mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke, “umewek<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri, kama bibi-arusi aliyekwisha kupamb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mme <strong>wa</strong>ke.”<br />

Anapokwisha kupokea ufalme, atakuja kama Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mab<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>takaoshiriki k<strong>wa</strong> chakula cha arusi <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-<br />

Kondoo. Danieli 7:14; Ufunuo 21:2.<br />

Wanaongoja B<strong>wa</strong>na Wao<br />

Tangazo “Tazama, b<strong>wa</strong>na arusi anakuja” liliongoza maelfu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kutazamia kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na mara moja. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ulioagiz<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na-arusi akaja, si duniani, bali k<strong>wa</strong> Mzee <strong>wa</strong><br />

Siku katika mbingu, k<strong>wa</strong> arusi, kupokele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Nao <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liingia pamoja naye k<strong>wa</strong> arusi.” Ha<strong>wa</strong>kupash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> pale binafsi, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> duniani. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kungojea B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o atakaporudi<br />

kutoka arusini. Luka 12:36. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke na kumfuata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

imani. K<strong>wa</strong> nia hii <strong>wa</strong>lisem<strong>wa</strong> kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> arusi.<br />

Katika mfano, <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na mafuta katika taa zao <strong>wa</strong>kaingia k<strong>wa</strong> arusi. Wale<br />

ambao, katika usiku <strong>wa</strong> jaribu la uchungu, <strong>wa</strong>liongoja k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu, <strong>wa</strong>kichunguza Biblia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi--ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liona ukweli juu <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu katika mbingu<br />

na badiliko la huduma <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi. K<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>wa</strong>kamfuata katika kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

Pahali patakatifu juu. Na wote <strong>wa</strong>liokubali kweli zile zile, kumfuata Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

anavyotenda kazi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho, <strong>wa</strong>naingia k<strong>wa</strong> arusi.<br />

179


Kufunga Kazi ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika mfano <strong>wa</strong> Matayo 22 hukumu inafanyika mbele <strong>ya</strong> arusi. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> arusi mfalme<br />

anaingia kuona kama <strong>wa</strong>geni wote <strong>wa</strong>mevik<strong>wa</strong> mavazi <strong>ya</strong> arusi, vazi safi (lisiloku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

ma<strong>wa</strong>a) la tabia iliyosafish<strong>wa</strong> katika damu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo. Ufunuo 7:14, Wote ambao<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong>meonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mevaa vazi la arusi <strong>wa</strong>mekubali<strong>wa</strong> na kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong><br />

haki <strong>ya</strong> kupata sehemu katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na kukaa k<strong>wa</strong> kiti chake cha enzi. Kazi hii<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi <strong>wa</strong> tabia ni hukumu <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi, kazi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu<br />

kule mbinguni.<br />

Wakati mambo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le katika vizazi vyote <strong>wa</strong>liokubali Kristo <strong>ya</strong>napokwisha<br />

kuchunguz<strong>wa</strong> na kukat<strong>wa</strong>, ndipo rehema itafung<strong>wa</strong> na mlango <strong>wa</strong> rehema utafung<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

hivyo k<strong>wa</strong> maneno mafupi <strong>ya</strong> hukumu, “Nao <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri <strong>wa</strong>liingia pamoja naye k<strong>wa</strong><br />

arusi: mlango ukafung<strong>wa</strong>,” tumechukuli<strong>wa</strong> chini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

wokovu <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu itakapokamilika.<br />

Katika Pahali patakatifu pa kidunia, <strong>wa</strong>kati kuhani mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho<br />

alipoingia k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu, huduma ndani <strong>ya</strong> chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

ulimalizika. Vivyo <strong>wa</strong>kati Kristo alipoingia k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong> kumaliza upatanisho, alimaliza huduma <strong>ya</strong>ke katika chumba cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Ndipo<br />

huduma katika chumba cha pili ikaanza. Kristo ametimiza tu sehemu moja <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

kama mwombezi wetu, ili kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> sehemu ingine <strong>ya</strong> kazi. Aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiendelea kutetea<br />

damu <strong>ya</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baba k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wenye zambi.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivi inaku<strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba mlango ule <strong>wa</strong> tumaini na rehema ambazo <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> nazo k<strong>wa</strong> miaka 1800 <strong>wa</strong>lipata ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ulifung<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

mlango mwingine ukafunguli<strong>wa</strong>. Msamaha <strong>wa</strong> zambi ukatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> uombezi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu mno,. Hapo kukingali na “mlango <strong>wa</strong>zi” k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni, mahali Kristo aliku<strong>wa</strong> akifan<strong>ya</strong> kazi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mwenye<br />

zambi.<br />

Sasa ikaonekana matumizi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le maneno <strong>ya</strong> Kristo katika Ufunuo, <strong>ya</strong>nayosem<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuelekea <strong>wa</strong>kati huu kabisa: “Maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> anasema aliye mtakatifu, aliye <strong>wa</strong> kweli, aliye<br />

na ufunguo <strong>wa</strong> Daudi; naye anayefungua <strong>wa</strong>la hapana mtu anayefunga, naye anafunga <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

hapana mtu anayefungua .... Tazama, nimekupa mlango <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong>ko na hakuna mtu<br />

anayeweza kuufunga.” Ufunuo 3:7,8.<br />

Wale ambao k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>wa</strong>namufuata Yesu katika kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong>napokea<br />

faida <strong>ya</strong> uombezi, huku <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokataa nuru ha<strong>wa</strong>tapata faida. Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>liokataa<br />

kuamini Kristo kama Mwokozi ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kupokea rehema k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Wakati Yesu<br />

alipopanda mbinguni aliingia Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni kutoa mibaraka <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>liach<strong>wa</strong> katika giza kub<strong>wa</strong> kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea<br />

na kafara zao zabure na sadaka. Mlango ambao <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lipata mbele k<strong>wa</strong> kupita na<br />

180


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kumukaribia Mungu hauku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi tena. Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>likataa kumutafuta k<strong>wa</strong> njia moja<br />

tungaliweza kupatikana, ni k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni.<br />

Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>sioamini <strong>wa</strong>lionyesha uvivu na kutoamini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

ambao k<strong>wa</strong> kweli ha<strong>wa</strong>jui kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kuhani wetu Mkuu. Katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> mfano, <strong>wa</strong>kati kuhani<br />

mkuu alipoingia Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu mno, Israeli yote ililazimish<strong>wa</strong> kukusanyika<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu na kunyenyekeza roho zao mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ili <strong>wa</strong>weze kupata<br />

rehema <strong>ya</strong> zambi na bila “kukatili<strong>wa</strong> mbali” <strong>ya</strong> kusanyiko. Ni k<strong>wa</strong> maana gani tena siku hii<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> upatanisho iki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba tunafahamu kazi <strong>ya</strong> kuhani wetu Mkuu na kujua<br />

kazi gani tunazo omb<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Ujumbe ulitum<strong>wa</strong> kutoka mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> dunia katika siku za Noa, na wokovu <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

ulitegemea namna gani <strong>wa</strong>litendea ujumbe ule. M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 6:6-9, Waebrania 11:7. Katika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Sodomo, wote ila Loti pamoja na mke <strong>wa</strong>ke na mabinti <strong>wa</strong>wili, <strong>wa</strong>kateketez<strong>wa</strong><br />

na moto uliotum<strong>wa</strong> chini kutoka mbinguni. M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 19. Vivyo hivyo katika siku za Kristo.<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong> Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>sioamini: “Nyumba yenu imeach<strong>wa</strong> kwenu<br />

tupu.” Matayo 23:38. Kutazama chini k<strong>wa</strong> siku za mwisho, nguvu isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho <strong>ya</strong><br />

namna moja inatangaza, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao “ha<strong>wa</strong>kupokea upendo <strong>wa</strong> kweli, <strong>wa</strong>pate<br />

kuokole<strong>wa</strong>”. “Na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hiyo Mungu ana<strong>wa</strong>letea nguvu <strong>ya</strong> upotevu, hata <strong>wa</strong>amini<br />

uwongo.” 2 Watesalonika 2:10,11. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>nakataa mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> neno lake,<br />

Mungu anaondoa Roho <strong>ya</strong>ke na ku<strong>wa</strong>acha k<strong>wa</strong> udanganyifu <strong>wa</strong>naoupenda. Lakini Kristo<br />

akingali anaomba k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu, na nuru itatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoitafuta.<br />

Kupita k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 ulifuat<strong>wa</strong> na jaribio kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioshika<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Msaada <strong>wa</strong>o uliku<strong>wa</strong> nuru ambayo iliongoza mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni. K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>livyongojea na kuomba <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

kuhani <strong>wa</strong>o Mkuu aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiingia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi ingine <strong>ya</strong> huduma. Kumufuata k<strong>wa</strong> imani,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuona vilevile kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kanisa. Waka<strong>wa</strong> na maelezo kamili<br />

zaidi <strong>ya</strong> ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na <strong>wa</strong> pili, na <strong>wa</strong>kata<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> kupokea na kutoa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> dunia onyo kub<strong>wa</strong> la malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 14.<br />

Sura 25. Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu Isiyogeuka<br />

“Hekalu la Mungu likafunguli<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni na sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano lake likaonekana.”<br />

Ufunuo 11:19. Sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano la Mungu linaku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

patakatifu, chumba cha pili cha Pahali patakatifu. Katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> hema <strong>ya</strong> duniani, ambayo<br />

ilitumi<strong>wa</strong> “katika mfano na kivuli cha vitu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni,” chumba hiki kiliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kikifunguli<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> Siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> usafisho <strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo tangazo k<strong>wa</strong>mba hekalu la Mungu lilifunguli<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni na sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano<br />

lake lilionekana linaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu mno pa<br />

mbinguni katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 ambapo Kristo aliingia kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kumaliza upatanisho.<br />

Wale ambao katika imani <strong>wa</strong>limufuata Kuhani <strong>wa</strong>o Mkuu alipoingia k<strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

181


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

katika Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu mno, <strong>wa</strong>litazama sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano lake. K<strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

<strong>wa</strong>livyojifunza fundisho la Pahali patakatifu <strong>wa</strong>lipata kufahamu badiliko la kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mwokozi, na <strong>wa</strong>kaona k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> sasa anahudumia mbele <strong>ya</strong> sanduku la Mungu.<br />

Sanduku ndani <strong>ya</strong> hema duniani liliku<strong>wa</strong> na vipande mbili v<strong>ya</strong> mawe, ambapo sheria za<br />

Mungu ziliandik<strong>wa</strong>. Wakati hekalu la Mungu lilifunguli<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, sanduku <strong>ya</strong> agano<br />

lake ilionekana. Ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu mno mbinguni, sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

inatunz<strong>wa</strong>--sheria iliyosem<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu na kuandik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kidole chake juu <strong>ya</strong> vipande<br />

mbili v<strong>ya</strong> mawe.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liopata kufahamu maana <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liona, zaidi kuliko mbele, nguvu za maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mwokozi: “Hata mbingu na inchi zitakapoondoka, yodi moja <strong>wa</strong>la nukta moja<br />

haitaondoka.” Matayo 5:18. Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ambayo ni ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke, andiko<br />

la tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke, inapas<strong>wa</strong> kudumu milele.<br />

Katika orodha <strong>ya</strong> Amri kumi kunaku<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> Sabato. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikaonyesha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> Neno lake lile k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>livunja k<strong>wa</strong> ujinga amri hii k<strong>wa</strong> kutojali siku<br />

<strong>ya</strong> pumziko <strong>ya</strong> Muumba. Wakaanza kuchunguza sababu <strong>ya</strong> kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong><br />

juma. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kupata ushahidi wo wote k<strong>wa</strong>mba amri <strong>ya</strong> ine iliondole<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Sabato iligeuz<strong>wa</strong>. Wakatafuta k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu kujua na kutenda mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu;<br />

sasa <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kushika Sabato <strong>ya</strong>ke takatifu.<br />

Nguvu mingi ilifany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuangusha imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>amini <strong>wa</strong> Adventiste. Hakuna mtu<br />

aliweza kushind<strong>wa</strong> kuona k<strong>wa</strong>mba ukubali ule <strong>wa</strong> kweli juu <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

mbinguni unahusika na haki za sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na Sabato <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ine. Hapa kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na siri <strong>ya</strong> upinzani uliokusudi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> maelezo <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> umoja <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>nayofunua<br />

huduma <strong>ya</strong> Kristo ndani <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa mbinguni. Watu <strong>wa</strong>katafuta kufunga<br />

mlango ambao Mungu alifungua, na kufungua mlango ambao aliufunga. Lakini Kristo<br />

alifungua mlango <strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu. Amri <strong>ya</strong> ine iliku<strong>wa</strong> ndani<br />

katika sheria iliyotunz<strong>wa</strong> pale.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokubali nuru juu <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> Kristo na sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kaona<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> Ufunuo 14, ambayo ni onyo la mara tatu k<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. (Tazama mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kitabu,<br />

Nyongezo). Tangazo “Saa <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja “linatangaza kweli ambayo inapas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> hata upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi utakapoisha na atarudi kuchukua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe. Hukumu ambayo ilianza katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 inapas<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea hata<br />

kesi za wote zinapokwisha kukat<strong>wa</strong>, wote <strong>wa</strong>hai na <strong>wa</strong>liokufa; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo itaenea hata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu.<br />

Ili <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>weze kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha kusimama katika hukumu, ujumbe una<strong>wa</strong>agiza kuogopa<br />

Mungu, na kumutukuza,” na kum<strong>wa</strong>budu yeye aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> mbingu, na dunia na bahari na<br />

chemchemi za maji.” Matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kukubali k<strong>wa</strong> ujumbe huu <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong>tatu unatole<strong>wa</strong>:<br />

182


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Hapa ni uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu, na imani <strong>ya</strong> Yesu.” Ufunuo<br />

14:7,12.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kushika sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kipimo<br />

cha tabia katika hukumu. Paulo anasema: “Wote <strong>wa</strong>liokosa <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong> na sheria,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tahukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria, ... katika siku ile Mungu atakapohukumu siri za <strong>wa</strong>tu ... k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Yesu Kristo.” “Wale <strong>wa</strong>naotenda sheria <strong>wa</strong>takaohesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki.” Imani ina maana sana ili<br />

kushika sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu; k<strong>wa</strong>ni “pasipo imani haiwezekani kumupendeza.” “Kila tendo<br />

lisilotoka katika imani ni zambi.” Waroma 2:12-16; Waebrania 11:6; Waroma 14:23.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza aliita <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> “kuogopa Mungu, na kumutukuza” na kum<strong>wa</strong>budu<br />

yeye aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> mbingu na dunia. K<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> hii, <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kutii sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. Bila kutii<br />

hakuna ibada inayoweza kupendeza Mungu. “K<strong>wa</strong> maana kupenda Mungu ni kushika amri<br />

zake.” 1 Yoane 5:3; Tazama Mezali 28:9.<br />

Mwito k<strong>wa</strong> Kuabudu Muumba<br />

Wajibu k<strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Mungu unaimarish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye ni Muumba.<br />

“Kujeni, tuabudu na kuinama; Tupige magoti mbele <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na mwenye kutuumba.” Zaburi<br />

95:6; Tazama Zaburi 95:5; Zaburi 100:3; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 40:25,26; 45:18.<br />

Katika Ufunuo 14, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>meit<strong>wa</strong> kuabudu Muumba na kushika amri za Mungu.<br />

Moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> amri hizi inaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu kama Muumba: “Siku <strong>ya</strong> saba ni sabato<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ko: ... Maana k<strong>wa</strong> siku sita B<strong>wa</strong>na akafan<strong>ya</strong> mbingu na inchi, bahari<br />

na vyote vilivyo ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke, akapumzika siku <strong>ya</strong> saba. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi B<strong>wa</strong>na akabariki siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

sabato na kuitakasa.” Kutoka 20:10,11. Sabato, B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema, ni “alama, ... mujue <strong>ya</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> mimi ni B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu wenu.” Ezekieli 20:20. Kama Sabato ingeshik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wote,<br />

mtu angeweza kuongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba kama jambo la kuabudu. Hapo hapangaliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kamwe m<strong>wa</strong>budu sanamu, asiyesadiki (Mungu), <strong>wa</strong>la kafiri. Kushika Sabato ni alama <strong>ya</strong><br />

uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> “yeye aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> mbingu na dunia na bahari na chemchemi za maji.” Ujumbe<br />

unaoagiza <strong>wa</strong>tu kuabudu Mungu na kushika amri zake uta<strong>wa</strong>ita k<strong>wa</strong> kipekee mu<strong>wa</strong>ite<br />

kushika amri <strong>ya</strong> ine.<br />

Katika tofauti ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu na imani <strong>ya</strong> Yesu, malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu<br />

anaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> kundi lingine: “Mtu akiabudu n<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kupokea chapa<br />

katika kipaji cha uso <strong>wa</strong>ke, ao katika mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke, yeye atakuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo <strong>ya</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu.” Ufunuo 14:9,10. Ni nini inayoku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma, sanamu, chapa?<br />

Unabii ambamo mifano hii inapatikana unaanza k<strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 12. Joka yule aliyetafuta<br />

kuharibu Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke ilisem<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Shetani (Ufunuo 12:9); akavuta<br />

Herode kuua Mwokozi. Lakini mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Shetani katika kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> karne za k<strong>wa</strong>nza iliku<strong>wa</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Roma, ambamo upagani uliku<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

dini iliyoshinda. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo joka ni, k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> pili, mfano <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>ya</strong> kipagani.<br />

183


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika Ufunuo 13 ni n<strong>ya</strong>ma mwingine, “mfano <strong>wa</strong> chui,” ambaye joka akamupa “nguvu<br />

zake, na kiti chake cha ufalme na mamlaka nyingi.” Mfano huu, kama vile Waprostanti<br />

wengi <strong>wa</strong>livyoamini, unaku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Papa, iliyofuata k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu (mamlaka) na<br />

kiti cha ufalme na mamlaka iliyoshik<strong>wa</strong> kuanza na ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Roma. Juu <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na mfano <strong>wa</strong> chui inasem<strong>wa</strong>: “Naye akape<strong>wa</strong> kiny<strong>wa</strong> cha kusema maneno<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong>, na makufuru... Akafungua kiny<strong>wa</strong> chake atukane Mungu , na kutukana jina lake,<br />

na hema <strong>ya</strong>ke, nao <strong>wa</strong>naokaa mbinguni. Tena akape<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>shinda; akape<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka juu <strong>ya</strong> kabila na lugha na taifa.” Ufunuo 13:5-7. Unabii huu,<br />

karibu ku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na maelezo <strong>ya</strong> pembe ndogo <strong>ya</strong> Danieli 7, unaonyesha bila<br />

shaka Kanisa la Kiroma.<br />

“Akape<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke miezi makumi ine na miwili”--miaka mitatu na<br />

nusu, ao siku 1260, <strong>ya</strong> Danieli 7--mda ambao nguvu (uwezo) za Papa zilipas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kugandamiza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Mda huu kama ilivyotaj<strong>wa</strong> katika sura zilizotangulia, ulianza<br />

na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma (Papa), A.D. 538, na kumalizika katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ule mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa ikapata “kidonda cha kufa,” na unabii ukatimia, “yeye<br />

anayepeleka katika kifungo atachukuli<strong>wa</strong> katika kifungo.”<br />

Kuinuka k<strong>wa</strong> Mamlaka Mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> jambo hili mfano mwingine umetangaz<strong>wa</strong>: “Kisha nikaona mn<strong>ya</strong>ma mwingine<br />

akipanda juu toka dunia, naye aliku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili, mfano <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.”<br />

Ufunuo 13:11. Taifa hili ni mbalimbali na <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> mifano<br />

iliyotangulia. Falme kub<strong>wa</strong> zilizota<strong>wa</strong>la dunia zilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nabii Danieli kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> mawindo, <strong>wa</strong>liopanda <strong>wa</strong>kati “pepo ine za mbingu zilivuma k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

bahari kub<strong>wa</strong>.” Danieli 7:2. Katika ufunuo 17:15 malaika anaeleza k<strong>wa</strong>mba maji<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nafanyish<strong>wa</strong> na “Watu” na makutano <strong>ya</strong> mataifa na lugha”. Upepo ni mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

mashindano (vita). Pepo ne zinazo shindana juu <strong>ya</strong> bahari kub<strong>wa</strong> inaonyesha matendo <strong>ya</strong><br />

hatari <strong>ya</strong> ushindi na <strong>wa</strong>pinduzi ambayo falme zilifika k<strong>wa</strong> enzi.<br />

Lakini n<strong>ya</strong>ma aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mfano <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo alionekana “akipanda toka<br />

dunia.” Badala <strong>ya</strong> kuangusha mamlaka zingine na kujiimarisha mwenyewe, taifa lililoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke lilipas<strong>wa</strong> kupanda katika inchi isiokali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na likasitawi k<strong>wa</strong> amani.<br />

Linapas<strong>wa</strong> kutafut<strong>wa</strong> katika Bara kuu la Magaribi.<br />

Ni taifa gani la Dunia Mp<strong>ya</strong> liliku<strong>wa</strong> katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798 likipanda k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu, kutoa<br />

ahadi <strong>ya</strong> nguvu, na kuvuta uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> dunia? Taifa moja, na ni moja tu, linalokutana na<br />

unabii huu--mataifa <strong>ya</strong> muungano <strong>ya</strong> Amerika (United States of America). Karibu sana<br />

maneno kabisa kabisa <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi mtakatifu <strong>ya</strong>litumi<strong>wa</strong> bila kufahamu k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> historia katika kueleza kupanda k<strong>wa</strong> taifa. M<strong>wa</strong>ndishi mashauri anasema juu <strong>ya</strong> “siri <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutokea k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> pahali patupu,” na anasema, “Kama mbegu <strong>ya</strong> kim<strong>ya</strong> tunasitawi katika<br />

mamlaka.” Gazeti la Ula<strong>ya</strong> katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1850 linaeleza juu <strong>ya</strong> Amerika “kutokea” na<br />

“katika utulivu <strong>wa</strong> inchi siku k<strong>wa</strong> siku kuongeza k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke na kiburi.”<br />

184


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Naye aliku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili, mfano <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.” Pembe mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nakondoo<br />

inaonyesha ujana, hali <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa, upole. Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>liokimbilia Amerika k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> magandamizo <strong>ya</strong> kifalme na kutovumilia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mapadri kuliku<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong>liokusudia kuanzisha uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kiulimwengu na <strong>wa</strong> dini.<br />

Tangazo la uhuru linainua kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba “<strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>meumb<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong>” na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natole<strong>wa</strong> na haki <strong>ya</strong> daima k<strong>wa</strong> “maisha, uhuru, na kutafuta furaha.”<br />

Sheria inatoa haki k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>ya</strong> kujita<strong>wa</strong>la, kuhakikisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>jumbe<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liochaguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uchaguzi <strong>wa</strong> kupend<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>tafan<strong>ya</strong> na kuamuru sheria.<br />

Uhuru <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini ulitole<strong>wa</strong> pia. Uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> uchaguzi (Republicanism) <strong>ya</strong> Dini la<br />

Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> kanuni za msingi za taifa, siri <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke na usitawi. Mamilioni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>katafuta p<strong>wa</strong>ni zake, na Amerika ikapanda k<strong>wa</strong> pahali miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yenye<br />

uwezo mwingi zaidi duniani.<br />

Lakini n<strong>ya</strong>ma aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili, mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nakondoo “akasema kama<br />

joka. Naye atumia uwezo wote <strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma yule <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kufan<strong>ya</strong> dunia<br />

nao <strong>wa</strong>naokaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>abudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, ambaye kidonda chake cha mauti<br />

kilipona; ... aki<strong>wa</strong>ambia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, kumfanyia sanamu yule mn<strong>ya</strong>ma,<br />

aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na kidonda cha upanga, naye aliishi.” Ufunuo 13:11-14.<br />

Pembe mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo na sauti <strong>ya</strong> joka inaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> mabishano. Utabiri<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba itasema “kama joka” na kutumia “maneno k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo wote <strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma yule <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza” unatabiri roho <strong>ya</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na uvumilivu na <strong>ya</strong> kutesa. Na maneno k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mn<strong>ya</strong>ma aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili “naye dunia alifan<strong>ya</strong>” na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>wa</strong>abudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza” inaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> taifa hili ni kutumia nguvu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kushika maagizo fulani ambayo itaku<strong>wa</strong> tendo la heshima k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kipapa.<br />

Tendo la namna hiyo lingeku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> asili <strong>ya</strong> sheria zake za uhuru, k<strong>wa</strong> taratibu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> kukiri Tangazo la Uhuru, na k<strong>wa</strong> sheria. Sheria inaweka ta<strong>ya</strong>ri k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

“Baraza kuu haitaweka sheria kupendelea makao <strong>ya</strong> dini, <strong>wa</strong>la kukataza uhuru <strong>wa</strong> matumizi<br />

hiyo,” na k<strong>wa</strong>mba “hakuna jaribio la dini litakalodai<strong>wa</strong> kamwe kama sifa k<strong>wa</strong> kazi yo yote<br />

<strong>ya</strong> tumaini la <strong>wa</strong>tu wote chini <strong>ya</strong> mataifa <strong>ya</strong> muungano (United States). Kuvunja <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kinga hizi (mambo <strong>ya</strong>nayofan<strong>ya</strong> salama) za uhuru kunaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika mfano huu.<br />

Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na-kondooanayejitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> safi,<br />

mtulivu-asiyeumiza-anasema kama joka.<br />

“Aki<strong>wa</strong>ambia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, kumfanyia sanamu yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma.” Hapa<br />

panaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> serkali ambapo mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> sheria inadumu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu,<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kushangaza zaidi k<strong>wa</strong>mba Amerika ni taifa lenye maana fulani.<br />

Lakini “sanamu k<strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma” ni nini? Namna gani inafany<strong>wa</strong>?<br />

Wakati kanisa la zamani lilipochafuka, likatafuta msaada <strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kidunia.<br />

Matokeo: Kanisa la Roma (Papa), kanisa lililota<strong>wa</strong>la serkali, hasa zaidi sana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

185


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

azabu <strong>ya</strong> uzushi.” Ili Amerika ipate kufan<strong>ya</strong> ‘’sanamu <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma,” mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> dini<br />

inapas<strong>wa</strong> kutongoza serkali k<strong>wa</strong>mba serkali itatumi<strong>wa</strong> vilevile k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa kutimiza vifiko<br />

v<strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe.<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyofuata katika hatua za Roma <strong>ya</strong>meonyesha mapenzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> namna moja k<strong>wa</strong> kuzuia uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri. Mfano ni mateso <strong>ya</strong>liyoendelea <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>siokubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Kiingereza. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> karne za kumi na sita<br />

na kumi na saba, <strong>wa</strong>chungaji na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>siokubali kanuni za kanisa <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kulipa feza <strong>ya</strong> azabu, kufung<strong>wa</strong>, mateso (azabu kali), na mauti <strong>ya</strong> mfia dini.<br />

Uasi ukaongoza kanisa la m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni kutafuta usaada <strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> raia. Na jambo hili<br />

likata<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma (Papa)--mn<strong>ya</strong>ma. Paulo akasema: “ila maasi <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

<strong>ya</strong>fike mbele, na mtu yule <strong>wa</strong> kuasi akafunuli<strong>wa</strong>.” 2 Watesalonika 2:3.<br />

Biblia inatangaza: “Siku za mwisho zitaku<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za hatari. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kujipenda wenyewe, wenye kupenda feza, wenye kujisifu, wenye kiburi,<br />

wenye kutukana, <strong>wa</strong>siotii <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>sio na kushukuru, <strong>wa</strong>sio safi, <strong>wa</strong>siopenda wenzao,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siotaka kusamehe, <strong>wa</strong>shitaki <strong>wa</strong> uwongo, <strong>wa</strong>siojizuiza, <strong>wa</strong>kali, <strong>wa</strong>siopenda mema,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>danganyifu, <strong>wa</strong>kaidi, wenye kujivuna, wenye kupenda anasa kuliko Mungu; wenye<br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong> kuogopa Mungu, lakini <strong>wa</strong>kikana nguvu zake.” 2 Timoteo 3:1-5. “Basi, Roho<br />

anasema <strong>wa</strong>zi<strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika n<strong>ya</strong>kati za mwisho <strong>wa</strong>tu wengine <strong>wa</strong>tajitenga na<br />

imani, <strong>wa</strong>kisikiliza roho za kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mashetani.” 1 Timoteo 4:1.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>le “ha<strong>wa</strong>kupokea mapendo <strong>wa</strong> kweli, k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>pate kuokole<strong>wa</strong>,” <strong>wa</strong>takubali<br />

“nguvu <strong>ya</strong> upotevu, hata <strong>wa</strong>amini uwongo.” 2 Watesalonika 2:10,11. Wakati hali hii<br />

itakapofiki<strong>wa</strong>, matokeo <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong>tafuata ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> katika karne za k<strong>wa</strong>nza.<br />

Tofauti kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> imani katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti inazani<strong>wa</strong> na wengi kama<br />

utibitizo k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna umoja uliolazimish<strong>wa</strong> unaoweza kufany<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini pale<br />

kumeku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> miaka nyingi katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti nia iliyoongezeka katika<br />

upendeleo <strong>wa</strong> umoja. K<strong>wa</strong> kulinda umoja kama huo, mazungumzo <strong>ya</strong> mambo ambayo wote<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>ya</strong>kubali <strong>ya</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kuach<strong>wa</strong> kudai<strong>wa</strong>. Katika bidii <strong>ya</strong> kulinda umoja kamili,<br />

itaku<strong>wa</strong> tu ni hatua k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia nguvu.<br />

Wakati makanisa maalum <strong>ya</strong> Amerika, <strong>ya</strong>napoungana juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo kama <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong><br />

mafundisho kama inavyoshik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o katika umoja, <strong>ya</strong>tavuta serkali kulazimisha amri zao<br />

na kuimarisha sheria zao, ndipo Amerika <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti itakapofan<strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> serkali<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma, na azabu <strong>ya</strong> malipo <strong>ya</strong> raia juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>siokubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong><br />

kanisa bila mashaka <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> matokeo.<br />

Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na Sanamu Yake<br />

Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pembe mbili “naye ana<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> wote, <strong>wa</strong>dogo na <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

matajiri na masikini na <strong>wa</strong>huru na <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tiwe chapa katika mkono <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> kuume,<br />

186


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ao katika vipaji v<strong>ya</strong> nyuso zao; na k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu asiweze kununua <strong>wa</strong>la kuuza asipoku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

chapa ile, ao jina la mn<strong>ya</strong>ma yule, ao hesabu <strong>ya</strong> jina lake.” Ufunuo 13:16,17. Malaika <strong>wa</strong><br />

tatu anaon<strong>ya</strong>: “Mtu akiabudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kupokea chapa katika kipaji cha<br />

uso <strong>wa</strong>ke, ao katika mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke, yeye atakuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo <strong>ya</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.”<br />

“Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma” <strong>wa</strong> hiyo ibada inayolazimish<strong>wa</strong> ni <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, ao <strong>ya</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> chui, n<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 13--Kanisa la Roma (Papa). “Sanamu k<strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma” ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> namna ile <strong>ya</strong><br />

Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti iliyokufuru ambayo itasitawi <strong>wa</strong>kati makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti<br />

<strong>ya</strong>napotafuta msaada <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> serkali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mkazo <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanuni<br />

zao. “Chapa <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma” inaendelea kuelez<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> tofauti na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoabudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na<br />

sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke na kupokea chapa <strong>ya</strong>ke. Uchungaji <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> upande moja, na<br />

mvunjo <strong>wa</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> upande mwengine, utafan<strong>ya</strong> tofauti kati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>abudu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>abudu <strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma.<br />

Tabia <strong>ya</strong> kipekee <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na <strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke ni kuvunja amri za Mungu. Asema<br />

Danieli, juu <strong>ya</strong> pembe ndogo, kanisa la Roma (Papa): “Atafikiri kugeuza n<strong>ya</strong>kati na sheria.”<br />

Danieli 7:25.R.V. Paulo akataja mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> namna moja “mtu yule <strong>wa</strong> kuasi” (2<br />

Watesalonika 2:3), aliyejiinua mwenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ila tu k<strong>wa</strong> kugeuza sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu kanisa la Roma (Papa) liliweza kujiinua lenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mtu ye yote<br />

ambaye angeshika sheria k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu kama ilivyogeuz<strong>wa</strong> angeku<strong>wa</strong> anatoa heshima<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria za Papa, chapa cha utii k<strong>wa</strong> Papa pahali pa Mungu.<br />

Kanisa la Roma (Papa) limejaribu kugeuza sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Amri <strong>ya</strong> ine imebadilika<br />

hivi kama kuruhusu kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza badala <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> saba kama Sabato. Badiliko<br />

la kusudi, la kufikiri linaonyesh<strong>wa</strong>: “Atafikiri kugeuza n<strong>ya</strong>kati na sheria.” Badiliko katika<br />

amri <strong>ya</strong> ine kabisa linatimiza unabii. Hapa uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Papa unajiweka mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Waabudu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>tatofautika k<strong>wa</strong> kipekee k<strong>wa</strong> kushika k<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

amri <strong>ya</strong> ine, alama <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kuumba. Waabudu <strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong>tatofautika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> nguvu ili kupasua ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> Muumba, kuinua sheria <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza) kama “siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na” ambayo mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la<br />

Roma <strong>ya</strong>litetea k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza madai <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kiburi. (Tazama Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kitabu,<br />

Nyongezo). Lakini Biblia inaonyesha siku <strong>ya</strong> saba ku<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Akasema Kristo:<br />

“Basi, M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ndiye B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> sabato vilevile.” Marko 2:28. Utazame tena Isa<strong>ya</strong><br />

58:13; Matayo 5:1719. Maneno <strong>ya</strong>nayotangaz<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo aligeuza<br />

Sabato <strong>ya</strong>mekatali<strong>wa</strong> na maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe.<br />

Kim<strong>ya</strong> Kamili <strong>wa</strong> Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong><br />

Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>natambua “kim<strong>ya</strong> kamili cha Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> kadiri hakuna agizo lo lote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Sabato (Jumapili, siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) <strong>wa</strong>la kanuni halisi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kushik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke zinazohusiana nayo.”<br />

187


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Hata k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kufa k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, hakuna badiliko lililofanyika katika siku”; na “ni<br />

hivyo kama maandiko <strong>ya</strong>navyoonyesha, <strong>wa</strong>o (mitume) ... ha<strong>wa</strong>kutoa agizo lo lote la <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

kuonyesha kuach<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> saba, na kushik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

<strong>ya</strong> juma.”<br />

Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>natambua k<strong>wa</strong>mba badiliko la Sabato lilifany<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa lao,<br />

na kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba Waprotestanti, k<strong>wa</strong> kushika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma),<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natambua mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Maneno <strong>ya</strong>mesem<strong>wa</strong>: “Wakati <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> kale,<br />

jumamosi (siku <strong>ya</strong> saba) iliku<strong>wa</strong> siku iliyotakas<strong>wa</strong>; lakini kanisa, lilipoagiz<strong>wa</strong> na Yesu<br />

Kristo, na kuongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, likabadilisha Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma:<br />

Dimanche) k<strong>wa</strong> Jumamosi (siku <strong>ya</strong> saba <strong>ya</strong> juma:Samedi), k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo tunatakasa siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza, si siku <strong>ya</strong> saba, Jumapili maana <strong>ya</strong>ke, na sasa ni, siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na.”<br />

Kama alama <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Wakatoliki, <strong>wa</strong>andishi <strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nanena “Tendo kabisa la kugeuza Sabato k<strong>wa</strong> Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma),<br />

ambalo Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>nakubali; ... k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kushika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong><br />

juma), <strong>wa</strong>nakubali mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> kuamuru siku kuu, na kuzita<strong>wa</strong>la chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi.”<br />

Ni nini tena badiliko la Sabato, lakini ni alama, ao chapa, cha mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la<br />

Roma--“chapa <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma”? Kanisa la Roma halikuacha madai <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka.<br />

Wakati ulimwengu na makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>napokubali sabato iliotung<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napokataa Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, <strong>wa</strong>nakubali k<strong>wa</strong> kweli majivuno ha<strong>ya</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> vile <strong>wa</strong>nazarau kanuni zinazo<strong>wa</strong>tenga k<strong>wa</strong> Roma--k<strong>wa</strong>mba “Biblia, na ni Biblia tu,<br />

ni dini <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti.” K<strong>wa</strong> namna mwendo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>kulazimisha Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) unapata upendeleo, mwishoni italeta Waprotestanti wote chini <strong>ya</strong> bendera<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Roma.<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Kanisa la Roma <strong>wa</strong>natangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba “kushika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

<strong>ya</strong> juma) k<strong>wa</strong> Waprotestanti ni heshima kuu <strong>wa</strong>natoa, k<strong>wa</strong> kujichukia wenyewe, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa .”7 K<strong>wa</strong> kulazimisha kazi <strong>ya</strong> dini k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> serkali ni kufan<strong>ya</strong><br />

sanamu k<strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo kulazimisha kushika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma)<br />

katika Amerika kungeku<strong>wa</strong> kulazimusha kuabudu <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> vizazi vilivyopita <strong>wa</strong>lishika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) <strong>wa</strong>kizani<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kishika Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, sasa kunaku<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> kweli katika<br />

kila kanisa ambao k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>naamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) ni<br />

agizo la kimungu. Mungu anakubali uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o na uhaki <strong>ya</strong>o. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati kushika<br />

Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) itakapolazimish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria na ulimwengu<br />

utaangazi<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli, ndipo ye yote atakayevunja amri <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kutii<br />

amri <strong>ya</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo ataku<strong>wa</strong> anaheshimu mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kipapa kuliko <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Anaku<strong>wa</strong> akitoa heshima k<strong>wa</strong> Roma. Anaku<strong>wa</strong> akiabudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ndipo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>tapokea chapa cha utii k<strong>wa</strong> Roma--“chapa <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma.” Yale ha<strong>ya</strong>tafanyika hata<br />

188


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong>napowek<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na <strong>wa</strong>takapolet<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuchagua kati <strong>ya</strong> amri za<br />

Mungu na amri za <strong>wa</strong>tu, ndipo <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoendelea katika kuvunja amri <strong>wa</strong>tapokea “chapa<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma.”<br />

Onyo la Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Tatu<br />

Hofu <strong>ya</strong> kutisha zaidi iliyoambi<strong>wa</strong> daima k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu inaku<strong>wa</strong> katika ujumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu. Watu ha<strong>wa</strong>paswi kuach<strong>wa</strong> gizani juu <strong>ya</strong> jambo hili la maana; onyo<br />

linapas<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuzuri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ili wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>weze ku<strong>wa</strong> na bahati <strong>ya</strong> kuziepuka. Malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza anafan<strong>ya</strong> tangazo lake k<strong>wa</strong> “kila<br />

taifa, na kabila, na lugha, na jamaa.” Onyo la malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu ni la kuenea sana,<br />

linatangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> na litaagiza uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>tajitenga k<strong>wa</strong> makundi makub<strong>wa</strong> mawili--<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu na<br />

imani <strong>ya</strong> Yesu, na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naom<strong>wa</strong>budu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke na <strong>wa</strong>napokea chapa<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke. Kanisa na Serkali itaungana kushurutisha “wote” k<strong>wa</strong> kupokea “chapa cha mn<strong>ya</strong>ma,”<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ha<strong>wa</strong>taipokea. Nabii anatazama “<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioshinda yule n<strong>ya</strong>ma na<br />

sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke, na hesabu <strong>ya</strong> jina lake, <strong>wa</strong>mesimama kando <strong>ya</strong> bahari <strong>ya</strong> kioo, wenye vinubi<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” Ufunuo 15:2.<br />

189


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 26. Washujaa k<strong>wa</strong> Ajili <strong>ya</strong> Ukweli<br />

Matengenezo juu <strong>ya</strong> sabato katika siku za mwisho <strong>ya</strong>metabiri<strong>wa</strong> katika Isa<strong>ya</strong>: “B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

anasema hivi: Shikeni hukumu, na mufanye haki; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu wokovu <strong>wa</strong>ngu ni karibu<br />

kuja, na haki <strong>ya</strong>ngu kufunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Heri mtu anayefan<strong>ya</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong>, na m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mtu<br />

anaye<strong>ya</strong>shika sana; anayeshika sabato asizivunje, anayezuiza mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke usifanye uovu<br />

wo wote... Vilevile <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mgeni, <strong>wa</strong>naojiunga na B<strong>wa</strong>na, kumutumikia, na kupenda jina<br />

la B<strong>wa</strong>na, ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke, yeyote anayeshika sabato asiivunje, na kushika sana<br />

agano langu; hata <strong>wa</strong>le nita<strong>wa</strong>leta k<strong>wa</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong>ngu mtakatifu, na ku<strong>wa</strong>furahisha katika<br />

nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ngu <strong>ya</strong> maombi.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 56:1,2,6,7.<br />

Maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naelekea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kikristo, kama inavyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maneno<br />

(mstari 8). Hapa ni kuonyesha mbele mkusanyiko <strong>wa</strong> Mataifa k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> habari njema,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>napohubiri k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa yote habari za furaha.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na anaamuru, “Tia muhuri juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria katikati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ngu.: Isa<strong>ya</strong> 8:16.<br />

Muhuri <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu unapatikana katika amri <strong>ya</strong> ine. Hii tu, <strong>ya</strong> amri zote kumi,<br />

inayoleta maoni <strong>ya</strong> jina na an<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>ya</strong> Mutoa sheria. Wakati Sabato ilipogeuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa (kanisa la Roma), muhuri uliondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> sheria. Wanafunzi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Yesu <strong>wa</strong>nait<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuurudisha k<strong>wa</strong> kuinua Sabato kama ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> Muumba na alama<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Agizo limetole<strong>wa</strong>: “Piga kelele, usiache, pandisha sauti <strong>ya</strong>ko kama baragumu, uhubiri<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu kosa lao.” Wale ambao B<strong>wa</strong>na ana<strong>wa</strong>taja kama “<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu” <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukaripi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>o, kundi linalojifikiri <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> la haki katika<br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Lakini kemeo la upole la mwenye kutafuta mioyo lina<strong>wa</strong>shuhudia kuvunja<br />

amri za Mungu. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 58:1,2.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo nabii anaonyesha amri ambayo iliyoach<strong>wa</strong>: “Utan<strong>ya</strong>nyulisha misingi <strong>ya</strong> vizazi<br />

vingi; nawe utait<strong>wa</strong>, Mwenye kutengeneza pahali pa kubomoka; Mwenye kurudisha njia za<br />

kukalia. Kama ukigeuza mguu <strong>wa</strong>ko kutoka katika Sabato, usifanye mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ko katika<br />

siku <strong>ya</strong>ngu takatifu na kuita sabato siku <strong>ya</strong> furaha, siku takatifu <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, yenye heshima;<br />

kama ukiiheshimu, pasipo kufuata njia zako mwenyewe, <strong>wa</strong>la kutafuta mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ko<br />

mwenyewe, <strong>wa</strong>la kusema maneno <strong>ya</strong>ko mwenyewe; ndipo utajifurahisha katika B<strong>wa</strong>na.”<br />

Isa<strong>ya</strong> 58:12-14.<br />

“Tundu” lilifany<strong>wa</strong> katika sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kati Sabato ilipogeuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

Roma. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati umefika k<strong>wa</strong> tundu kutengenez<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Sabato ilishik<strong>wa</strong> na Adamu katika usafi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika Edeni; na Adamu, aliyeanguka<br />

lakini akatubu, <strong>wa</strong>kati alipofukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> shamba ao cheo chake. Ilishik<strong>wa</strong> na mababa wote<br />

tangu Abeli hata Noa, k<strong>wa</strong> Abrahamu, hata Yakobo. Wakati B<strong>wa</strong>na alipookoa Israeli,<br />

akatangaza sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> makutano.<br />

190


Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Kweli Kila Mara Ilishik<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Tangu siku ile hata sasa Sabato imeshik<strong>wa</strong>. Inga<strong>wa</strong> “mtu <strong>wa</strong> zambi” alifaulu katika<br />

kugandamiza chini <strong>ya</strong> mguu siku takatifu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, lakini ilifich<strong>wa</strong> katika mahali pa siri<br />

roho aminifu zikaitolea heshima. Tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Matengenezo (Reformation), wengine<br />

katika kila kizazi <strong>wa</strong>meimarisha kushik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli katika kuhusiana pamoja na “habari njema <strong>ya</strong> milele”<br />

<strong>ya</strong>tatofautisha kanisa la Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kutokea k<strong>wa</strong>ke. “Hapa ni uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu, na imani <strong>ya</strong> Yesu.” Ufunuo 14:12.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokubali nuru juu <strong>ya</strong> Pahali patakatifu na sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lijaz<strong>wa</strong> na furaha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>lioona umoja <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Walitamani nuru <strong>ya</strong> kuga<strong>wa</strong>ny<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

wote. Lakini kweli tafauti pamoja na ulimwengu haikukaribish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong>liojidai<br />

kufuata Kristo.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna haki <strong>ya</strong> Sabato ilivyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong>, wengi <strong>wa</strong>kasema: “Tuliku<strong>wa</strong> tukishika<br />

Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza) sikuzote, <strong>wa</strong>zazi wetu <strong>wa</strong>liishika. Kushika k<strong>wa</strong> Sabato mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

kungetutupa inje <strong>ya</strong> umoja pamoja na ulimwengu. Kundi ndogo linaloshika siku <strong>ya</strong> saba<br />

linaweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> nini juu <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu wote unaoshika Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong><br />

juma)?” K<strong>wa</strong> mabishano <strong>ya</strong> namna moja Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>katoa sababu zao za kukana Kristo.<br />

Vivyo hivyo <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Luther, Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kweli <strong>wa</strong>likufa katika imani <strong>ya</strong> Kikatoliki; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo dini ile iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kutosha.<br />

Wazo la namna ile lingehakikisha kizuizi zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> maendeleo yote katika imani.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>lishurutisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba kushika k<strong>wa</strong> Jumapili (siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong> juma) iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

desturi <strong>ya</strong> kanisa iliyoenea sana <strong>ya</strong> kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi. Kinyume cha mabishano ha<strong>ya</strong><br />

ilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Sabato na kushik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> zamani zaidi kuliko, hata<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> zamani za ulimwengu wenyewe--uliyoimarish<strong>wa</strong> na Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Biblia, wengi <strong>wa</strong>kashurutisha: “Sababu gani <strong>wa</strong>tu wetu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>fahamu s<strong>wa</strong>li hili la Sabato? Wachache <strong>wa</strong>naamini kama unavyo amini.<br />

Haiwezekani ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba unaku<strong>wa</strong> na hakika na <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kosefu.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kupinga mabishano <strong>ya</strong> namna hii iliku<strong>wa</strong> tu lazima <strong>ya</strong> kuita Maandiko na matendo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke katika vizazi vyote. Sababu mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara Mungu haku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akichagua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza na cheo k<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza katika matengenezo ni k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natumainia kanuni za imani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na desturi za elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na sifa za Mungu na<br />

dini na kutoona haja kamwe <strong>ya</strong> kufundish<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu. Watu <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na majifunzo <strong>ya</strong><br />

chini <strong>wa</strong>nait<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati zingine kutangaza kweli, si k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siojifunza,<br />

lakini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu si <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye majivuno <strong>ya</strong> kukataa kufundish<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu.<br />

Unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong>o na utii vina<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

191


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Historia <strong>ya</strong> Israeli <strong>wa</strong> zamani ni onyesho la kushangaza <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

uliopita <strong>ya</strong> jamii <strong>ya</strong> Waadventisti. Mungu aliongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke katika mwendo <strong>wa</strong>kurudi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu,ijapo kama vile alivyoongoza <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Israeli kutoka Misri. Kama wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liotumika k<strong>wa</strong> umoja katika kazi munamo m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844 <strong>wa</strong>ngepokea ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika<br />

<strong>wa</strong> tatu na kuutangaza katika uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu, miaka iliyopita ulimwengu<br />

ungeku<strong>wa</strong> umekwisha kuony<strong>wa</strong> na Kristo angeku<strong>wa</strong> amekwisha kuja k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Si Mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

Haiku<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong>mba Israeli azunguke zunguke miaka makumi ine<br />

jang<strong>wa</strong>ni; alitamani ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza mara moja k<strong>wa</strong> Kanana na ku<strong>wa</strong>imarisha kule, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takatifu na <strong>wa</strong>furaha. Lakini “ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kutokuamini k<strong>wa</strong>o.”<br />

Waebrania 3:19. Ni namna ileile, haiku<strong>wa</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

kupate kuchele<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>dumu miaka mingi sana duniani hii <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi na huzuni. Kutoamini kuka<strong>wa</strong>tenga k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Katika rehema k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu,<br />

Yesu akakawisha kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke, ili wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong>sikie onyo na kupata kimbilio kabla <strong>ya</strong><br />

hasira <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kumiminika.<br />

Sasa kama katika vizazi v<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli kutaamsha upinzani.<br />

Wengi k<strong>wa</strong> kijicho <strong>wa</strong>nashambulia tabia na makusudi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naosimama katika kutetea<br />

ukweli usiopend<strong>wa</strong> na wengi. Elia alitangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye kuleta taabu katika Israeli.<br />

Yeremia msaliti, Paulo mwenye kuchafua hekalu. Tangu siku ile hata leo, <strong>wa</strong>le ambao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>meshitaki<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>fitini, <strong>wa</strong>jushi, ao wenye<br />

kutengana.<br />

Kukiri k<strong>wa</strong> imani kulikofany<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na <strong>wa</strong>fia dini, mifano hiyo <strong>ya</strong> utakatifu<br />

ukamilifu imara, kunatia moyo ndani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoit<strong>wa</strong> sasa kusimama kama <strong>wa</strong>shahidi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> mtumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu kunaagizo linalosema:<br />

“Paza sauti <strong>ya</strong>ko kama baragumu, uhubiri <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu kosa lao, na nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Yakobo<br />

zambi zao.” “Nimekuweka ku<strong>wa</strong> mlinzi k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Israeli; k<strong>wa</strong> hivi sikia neno k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kiny<strong>wa</strong> changu, na u<strong>wa</strong>pe maonyo toka k<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 58:1; Ezekieli 33:7.<br />

Kizuizi kikub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali kweli ni k<strong>wa</strong>mba inahusika na taabu na laumu. Hii ni<br />

mabishano tu kinyume cha ukweli ambayo <strong>wa</strong>teteaji <strong>wa</strong>ke ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kamwe kupinga.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Kristo ha<strong>wa</strong>ngojei ukweli kukubali<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi.<br />

Wanakubali msalaba, pamoja na Paulo kuhesabu k<strong>wa</strong>mba “Mateso yetu mepesi <strong>ya</strong>liyo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

dakika tu, <strong>ya</strong>natufanyia utukufu <strong>wa</strong> milele unaouzito mwingi”; pamoja na mmoja <strong>wa</strong><br />

zamani, “akihesabu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kulaumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ni utajiri mwingi kuliko hazina za<br />

Misri.” 2 Wakorinto 4:17; Waebrania 11:26.<br />

Inatupasa kuchagua haki k<strong>wa</strong> sababu inaku<strong>wa</strong> haki, na kuacha matokeo k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kanuni, imani na uhodari, dunia inaku<strong>wa</strong> na deni k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo<br />

192


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke makub<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> namna ile kazi <strong>ya</strong> matengenezo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu inapash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuendelea mbele.<br />

193


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 27. Mabadiliko <strong>ya</strong> Kweli<br />

Popote Neno la Mungu lilipohubiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu, matokeo <strong>ya</strong>liyofuata ni <strong>ya</strong><br />

kushuhudia asili <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kimungu. Wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong>lijisikia zamiri zao kuamka. Hakikisho<br />

la kosa likashikilia nia zao na mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> na utambuzi <strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kapaza sauti: “Nani atakayeniokoa na mwili huu <strong>wa</strong> kufa?” Waroma 7:24. Kama vile<br />

msalaba ulivyofunuli<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>liona k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna kitu kingine bali tabia nzuri tu za Kristo<br />

ziliweza kupatanisha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na “ondoleo la<br />

zambi zile zilizopita.” Waruma 3:25.<br />

Roho hizi zikaamini na zikabatiz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kasimama k<strong>wa</strong> kutembea katika up<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

uzima, k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kufuata hatua zake, kuonyesha tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke, na<br />

kujitakasa <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe kama yeye ni mutakatifu. Vitu <strong>wa</strong>livyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kichukia sasa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kavipenda, na vile <strong>wa</strong>livyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kipenda <strong>wa</strong>kavichukia. Mwenye kiburi aka<strong>wa</strong> mpole,<br />

mtu asiyefaa na <strong>wa</strong> kujivuna aka<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> maana na mnyenyekevu. Mlevi aka<strong>wa</strong> mwenye<br />

busara, mpotovu aka<strong>wa</strong> mtakatifu. Wakristo ha<strong>wa</strong>kutafuta “kujipamba k<strong>wa</strong> kusuka nywele,<br />

na kuvaa vitu v<strong>ya</strong> zahabu, ao kuvaa mavazi; lakini ... katika mapambo <strong>ya</strong>siyoharibika, ndiyo<br />

roho <strong>ya</strong> upole na utulivu iliyo <strong>ya</strong> damani kub<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” 1 Petro 3:3,4.<br />

Maamsho <strong>ya</strong>liamsh<strong>wa</strong> na miito <strong>ya</strong> upole k<strong>wa</strong> mwenye zambi. Matunda <strong>ya</strong>lionekana<br />

katika roho zilizojitenga si k<strong>wa</strong> kujikana mwenyewe bali <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lihesabi<strong>wa</strong><br />

kustahili kutes<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kaona badiliko katika <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liotangaza jina<br />

la Yesu. Ni vile mambo <strong>ya</strong>livyoku<strong>wa</strong> katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza iliofuata n<strong>ya</strong>kati za uamsho<br />

<strong>wa</strong> dini.<br />

Lakini maamsho mengi <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za kisasa <strong>ya</strong>naonyesha tofauti kub<strong>wa</strong>. Ni kweli<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba wengi <strong>wa</strong>natangaza toba, na wengi <strong>wa</strong>naingia ndani <strong>ya</strong> makanisa. Hata hivyo<br />

matokeo si <strong>ya</strong> namna kama <strong>ya</strong> kushuhudia imani k<strong>wa</strong>mba hapo kumeku<strong>wa</strong> na maendeleo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kulingana <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> kiroho <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Nuru ambayo ina<strong>wa</strong>ka k<strong>wa</strong> muda ikafa k<strong>wa</strong> upesi.<br />

Maamsho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi mara nyingi <strong>ya</strong>naamsha sikitiko, hupendeza <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> kitu<br />

kinachoku<strong>wa</strong> kip<strong>ya</strong> na cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liogeuka <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na haja kidogo<br />

kusikiliza kweli <strong>ya</strong> Biblia. Isipoku<strong>wa</strong> hudumu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa inaku<strong>wa</strong> na kitu cha tabia <strong>ya</strong> ajabu,<br />

kama si vile, haina mvuto k<strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kila roho iliyogeuka kweli uhusiano k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na k<strong>wa</strong> vitu v<strong>ya</strong> milele utaku<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

kitu kikub<strong>wa</strong> chakuzungumuzi<strong>wa</strong> katika maisha. Ni pahali gani katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

wengi <strong>ya</strong> leo kunapatikana roho <strong>ya</strong> kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu? Waliogeuka ha<strong>wa</strong>ache kiburi na<br />

mapendo <strong>ya</strong> dunia. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kubali tena kuikana nafsi na kufuata Yesu mpole na mnyenyekevu<br />

kuliko mbele <strong>ya</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong>o. Uta<strong>wa</strong> karibu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> wengi <strong>wa</strong> makanisa.<br />

Ijapo imani ilipunguka mahali pengi sana, kunaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Kristo katika<br />

makanisa ha<strong>ya</strong>. Kabla <strong>ya</strong> kufika k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu za Mungu za mwisho, kutaku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong><br />

194


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na uamsho <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zamani za mababu ambao haujashuhudi<strong>wa</strong> tangu<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za mitume. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu itam<strong>wa</strong>ngi<strong>wa</strong>. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>tajitenga k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa hayo<br />

ambayo mapendo <strong>ya</strong> dunia hii <strong>ya</strong>liondoa upendo k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na Neno lake. Wahubiri wengi<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takubali k<strong>wa</strong> furaha zile kweli kub<strong>wa</strong> ambazo zinata<strong>ya</strong>risha <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na mara <strong>ya</strong> pili.<br />

Adui <strong>wa</strong> roho anataka kuzuia kazi hii, na kabla <strong>ya</strong> kufika k<strong>wa</strong> mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

hiyo, atafan<strong>ya</strong> nguvu kuuzuia k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kuingiza mwigo. Katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong>le ambayo<br />

anaweza kuleta chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke ataifan<strong>ya</strong> kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba baraka <strong>ya</strong> kipekee <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu imem<strong>wa</strong>ng<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o. Makutano <strong>ya</strong>tashangilia, “Mungu anatumika k<strong>wa</strong> ajabu,”<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ile kazi ni <strong>ya</strong> roho ingine. Chini <strong>ya</strong>mtindo <strong>wa</strong> dini, Shetani atatafuta kueneza mvuto<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> Wakristo. Hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>msho <strong>wa</strong> maono, mchanganyiko<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kweli na uwongo, uliotengenez<strong>wa</strong> vizuri sana k<strong>wa</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Lakini katika nuru <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu si vigumu kutambua tabia <strong>ya</strong> kazi hizi. Pahali pote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napozarau ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Biblia, kugeukia mbali na hizi zilizo zaili zinazo jaribu<br />

roho ambazo zinaomba kujikana mwenyewe na kukana dunia, hapo tunaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

hakika k<strong>wa</strong>mba baraka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu haikutole<strong>wa</strong>. Na k<strong>wa</strong> amri, “Muta<strong>wa</strong>tambua k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

matunda <strong>ya</strong>o,” (Matayo 7:16), ni ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong>mba kazi hizi si kazi <strong>ya</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Ukweli <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu inaku<strong>wa</strong> ngao juu <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Kuzarau kweli<br />

hizi kulifungua mlango k<strong>wa</strong> maovu <strong>ya</strong>nayoenea sasa katika ulimwengu. Umuhimu <strong>wa</strong><br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu umesahauli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> eneo kub<strong>wa</strong> sana. Wazo mba<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu limeongoza k<strong>wa</strong> makosa katika toba na utakaso, k<strong>wa</strong> kushusha kipimo cha uta<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hapa ndipo panapopatikana siri <strong>ya</strong> ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu katika maamsho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

wetu.<br />

Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Uhuru<br />

Waalimu wengi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>natetea k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong>ke aliondoa sheria.<br />

Wengine <strong>wa</strong>naionyesha kama kong<strong>wa</strong> mzito <strong>wa</strong> kuhuzunisha, na k<strong>wa</strong> kinyume “utum<strong>wa</strong>”<br />

<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>wa</strong>lioonyesha “uhuru” <strong>wa</strong> kufurahia chini <strong>ya</strong> habari njema.<br />

Lakini si vile manabii na mitume <strong>wa</strong>livyofan<strong>ya</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> sheria takatifu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Akasema Dawidi: “Na nitatembea huru k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> nimetafuta maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ko.” Zaburi<br />

119:45. Mtume Yakobo anatumia Amri kumi kama “sheria .kamili, <strong>ya</strong> uhuru.” Yakobo<br />

1:25. Mfumbuzi anatangaza baraka juu <strong>ya</strong>o “<strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri zake (<strong>wa</strong>naofua nguo zao),<br />

<strong>wa</strong>we na haki <strong>ya</strong> kula mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima, na kuingia katika mji k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Ufunuo<br />

22:14.<br />

Kama ingewezekana k<strong>wa</strong> sheria kugeuz<strong>wa</strong> ao kuwek<strong>wa</strong> pembeni, Kristo hangehitaji<br />

kufa k<strong>wa</strong> kuokoa mtu k<strong>wa</strong> azabu <strong>ya</strong> zambi. M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu alikuja “kutukuza sheria na<br />

kuifanyiza ku<strong>wa</strong> na heshima.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 42:21. Akasema: “Musizanie nilikuja kuharibu torati”;<br />

“hata mbingu na inchi zitakapoondoka, yodi moja <strong>wa</strong>la nukta moja haitaondoka, hata yote<br />

195


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>timie.” Juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe akasema: “Ninafurahi kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ko, Ee Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngu; Ndiyo, sheria <strong>ya</strong>ko ni moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Matayo 5:17,18; Zaburi 40:8.<br />

Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu haibadilike, ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke. Mungu ni mapendo, na<br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke ni mapendo. “Mapendo ni utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> sheria.” Asema m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong> Zaburi:<br />

“Na sheria <strong>ya</strong>ko ni kweli”; “maana maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ko yote ni haki.” Paulo anasema: “Basi torati<br />

ni takatifu, na ile amri ni takatifu, na <strong>ya</strong> haki na njema.” Waroma 13:10; Zaburi<br />

119:142,172; Waroma 7:12. Sheria kama hiyo inapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuendelea kama Muumba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Ni kazi <strong>ya</strong> toba na utakaso k<strong>wa</strong> kupatanisha <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>patanisha katika umoja pamoja na kanuni za sheria. Katika m<strong>wa</strong>nzo, mutu aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika umoja kamili pamoja na sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Lakini zambi ikamtenga k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> vita juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu nia <strong>ya</strong> mwili ni<br />

uadui juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> maana haitii sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>la haiwezi.” Waroma 8:7.<br />

Lakini “K<strong>wa</strong> maana Mungu alivyopenda ulimwengu, hata kutoa M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> pekee,” ili<br />

mutu aweze kupatanish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, kurudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> umoja pamoja na Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Badiliko hili ni kuzali<strong>wa</strong> kup<strong>ya</strong>, isipoku<strong>wa</strong> hivyo “hawezi kuona ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.” Yoane<br />

3:16,3.<br />

Kukubali Zambi<br />

Hatua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> upatanisho na Mungu ni kukubali zambi. “Zambi ni uasi (<strong>wa</strong><br />

sheria).” “K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> sheria zambi inajulikana.” 1 Yoane 3:4; Waroma 3:20. Ili kuweza<br />

kuona kosa lake, mwenye zambi anapas<strong>wa</strong> kupima tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kioo cha Mungu<br />

kinachoonyesha ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> haki na kumwezesha kutambua pungufu ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mwenyewe.<br />

Sheria inafunulia mtu zambi zake, lakini haitoi da<strong>wa</strong>. Inatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kifo ni<br />

sehemu <strong>ya</strong> mkosaji. Injili <strong>ya</strong> kristo peke <strong>ya</strong>ke inaweza kumweka huru k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu ao<br />

uchafu <strong>wa</strong> zambi. Anapash<strong>wa</strong> kuzoea kutubu mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

iliyovunj<strong>wa</strong>, na imani katika Kristo, kafara <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo anapata<br />

“ondoleo la zambi zile zilizopita” (Waroma 3:25) na anaku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Je, sasa anaku<strong>wa</strong> huru kuvunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu? Asema Paulo: “Basi, tunafanyiza<br />

sheria ku<strong>wa</strong> bule k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani? Hapana, hata kidogo; lakini tunasimamisha sheria.”<br />

“Sisi tuliokufia zambi, namna gani tutakaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke tena?” Yoane anasema: “K<strong>wa</strong> maana<br />

kupenda Mungu ni kushika amri zake; na amri zake si nzito.” Katika kuzali<strong>wa</strong> kup<strong>ya</strong> moyo<br />

unalet<strong>wa</strong> katika umoja pamoja na Mungu, katika upatano pamoja na sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakati<br />

badiliko hili linafanyika ndani <strong>ya</strong> mwenye zambi amepita toka mauti hata katika uzima,<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kosa na uasi hata k<strong>wa</strong> utii na uaminifu. Maisha <strong>ya</strong> zamani <strong>ya</strong>meisha; maisha<br />

map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho, imani, na mapendo <strong>ya</strong>meanza. Basi “haki <strong>ya</strong> sheria” “vita itimiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

ndani yetu, tusiotembea kufuata maneno <strong>ya</strong> mwili, lakini kufuata maneno <strong>ya</strong> Roho.” Lugha<br />

196


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong> nafsi itaku<strong>wa</strong>: “Ee ninapenda sana sheria <strong>ya</strong>ko! Ni ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ngu muchana kut<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Waroma 3:31; 6:2; 1 Yoane 5:3; Waroma 8:4; Zaburi 119:97.<br />

Bila sheria, <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>kubali kweli zambi <strong>ya</strong>o na ha<strong>wa</strong>one haja <strong>ya</strong> kutubu. Ha<strong>wa</strong>fahamu<br />

moyoni mahitaji <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Tumaini la wokovu limekubali<strong>wa</strong><br />

bila badiliko la asili <strong>ya</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>la matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> maisha. Hivi mabadiliko <strong>ya</strong> kijuujuu<br />

inajaa, na makutano <strong>ya</strong>naungana na kanisa ambayo ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kuungama na Kristo.<br />

Utakaso ni Nini?<br />

Maelezo yenye makosa juu <strong>ya</strong> utakaso pia <strong>ya</strong>naonekana k<strong>wa</strong> kutojali <strong>wa</strong>la kukana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Maelezo ha<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>ya</strong> uwongo katika mafundisho na <strong>ya</strong> hatari katika matokeo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> maisha, k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong>napata kibali.<br />

Paulo anatangaza, “Maana ha<strong>ya</strong> ni mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, hata utakaso wenu.” Biblia<br />

inafundisha <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi utakaso ni nini na namna gani unaweza kufiki<strong>wa</strong>. Mwokozi aliombea<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke: “U<strong>wa</strong>takase k<strong>wa</strong> kweli; neno lako ni kweli.” Na Paulo anafundisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> “kutakas<strong>wa</strong> na Roho Mtakatifu.’‘ 1 Watesalonika 4:3;<br />

Yoane 17:17; Waroma 15:16.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Roho Mtakatifu ni nini? Yesu aka<strong>wa</strong>mbia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke: “Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

anapokuja yule Roho <strong>wa</strong> kweli, ata<strong>wa</strong>ongoza ninyi katika yote <strong>ya</strong>liyo kweli.” Yoane 16:13.<br />

Na m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong> Zaburi anasema: “Sheria <strong>ya</strong>ko ni <strong>ya</strong> kweli.” K<strong>wa</strong> hivi sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni<br />

“takatifu na <strong>ya</strong> haki na njema,” tabia iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> utii k<strong>wa</strong> sheria ile itaku<strong>wa</strong> takatifu.<br />

Kristo aliye mufano kamili <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> namna ile Anasema: “Nimeshika amri za Baba<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu.” “Ninafan<strong>ya</strong> saa zote mambo <strong>ya</strong>nayomupendeza.” Yoane 15:10; 8:29. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama yeye--k<strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kufan<strong>ya</strong> tabia katika umoja<br />

pamoja na kanuni za sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke takatifu. Huu ni utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Biblia.<br />

lla tu K<strong>wa</strong> Njia <strong>ya</strong> Imani<br />

Kazi hii inaweza kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> tu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani katika Kristo, k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kukaa<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mukristo atajisikia mwenye mivuto <strong>ya</strong> zambi, lakini atashikilia<br />

vita isiyobadilika juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hapa ndipo msaada <strong>wa</strong> Kristo unahitaji<strong>wa</strong>. Uzaifu <strong>wa</strong> binadamu<br />

unaambatana na nguvu za kimungu, na imani inapaza sauti: “Asante k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu anayetupa<br />

sisi ushindi k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu Yesu Kristo.” 1 Wakorinto 15:57.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> utakaso ni <strong>ya</strong> kuendelea mbele. Wakati katika toba mwenye zambi anapopata<br />

amani pamoja na Mungu maisha <strong>ya</strong> Mukristo imeanza tu. Sasa anapash<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea katika<br />

ukamilifu,” kukua “hata kufika kipimo cha kimo cha <strong>wa</strong> utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo.” “Ninakaza<br />

mwendo hata nifikie mwisho <strong>wa</strong> za<strong>wa</strong>bu <strong>ya</strong> mwito mukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu katika Kristo<br />

Yesu.” Waebrania 6:1; Waefeso 4:13; Wafilipi 3:14.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naozoea maisha <strong>ya</strong> utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Biblia <strong>wa</strong>taonyesha unyenyekevu. Wanaona<br />

kutostahili k<strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe katika tofauti pamoja na ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Nabii Danieli<br />

197


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> mufano <strong>wa</strong> utakaso <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Badala <strong>ya</strong> kujitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> safi na mtakatifu, nabii<br />

huyu <strong>wa</strong> heshima akajitambulisha mwenyewe pamoja na wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Israeli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akimlilia Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Danieli ; 9:15,18,20; 10:8,11.<br />

Hapawezi ku<strong>wa</strong> kujiinua mwenyewe, hapana madai <strong>ya</strong> kujisifu k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zambi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotembea katika kivuli cha msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kalvari. Waliona k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni zambi <strong>ya</strong>o ambayo ilianzisha maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong>liyovunja moyo <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu, na <strong>wa</strong>zo hili litaongoza k<strong>wa</strong> kujinyenyekeza. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoishi karibu sana na Yesu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natambua <strong>wa</strong>zi zaidi uzaifu na hali <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu, na tumaini lao moja tu<br />

linaku<strong>wa</strong> katika tabia nzuri <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi aliyesulibi<strong>wa</strong> na kufufuka.<br />

Utakaso sasa unaoendelea mbele k<strong>wa</strong> sifa katika <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> dini unaeneza roho <strong>ya</strong> kujiinua<br />

na kutojali k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ambayo inauonyesha kama jambo la kigeni k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia.<br />

Watetezi <strong>wa</strong>ke hufundisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba utakaso ni kazi <strong>ya</strong> dakika moja, ambayo, katika “imani<br />

tu,” <strong>wa</strong>nafikia utakatifu kamili. “Uamini tu,” <strong>wa</strong>navyosema, “na mibaraka ni <strong>ya</strong>ko.” Hapana<br />

juhudi <strong>ya</strong> zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> mwenye kupokea inayopash<strong>wa</strong> kufany<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule<br />

ule <strong>wa</strong>kakataa mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kushurutisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>mewek<strong>wa</strong> huru k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kanuni <strong>ya</strong> kushika amri. Lakini inawezekana ku<strong>wa</strong> mutakatifu pasipo kuja katika umoja na<br />

kanuni ambazo zinaonyesha tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke?<br />

Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu unaku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume cha mafun-disho ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mtego <strong>ya</strong><br />

imani pasipo matendo. Si imani inayotafuta kibali cha Mungu bila kushika tabia<br />

inayohitaji<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong>. Ni kiburi. Tazama Yakobo 2:14-24.<br />

Hebu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>sijidanganye wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>naweza ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>napovunja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Zambi inayojulikana inan<strong>ya</strong>mazisha<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong> Roho na inatenga nafsi toka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Inga<strong>wa</strong> Yoane alidumu<br />

kabisa juu <strong>ya</strong> mapendo, hakusita kufunua tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> kundi linalojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> takatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napoishi katika kuvunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Yeye anayesema; Nimemujua, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

hashiki amri zake, ni mwongo, <strong>wa</strong>la kweli si ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini yeye anayeshika neno lake,<br />

katika huyu mapendo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>mekamilish<strong>wa</strong> kweli kweli.” 1 Yoane 2:4,5. Hapa kuna<br />

jaribio <strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kila mtu. Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napungua na kuzarau amri za Mungu, kama<br />

“<strong>wa</strong>kivunja amri moja katika hizi zilizo ndogo, na kufundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu hivyo” (Matayo<br />

5:18,19), tunaweza kujua k<strong>wa</strong>mba madai <strong>ya</strong>o ha<strong>ya</strong>na msingi.<br />

Kusema hana zambi ni ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye anatangaza ha<strong>ya</strong> anaku<strong>wa</strong> mbali k<strong>wa</strong><br />

utakatifu. Hana <strong>wa</strong>zo la kweli la usafi usioku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho na utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, na uovu<br />

na uba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zambi. Zaidi anajitenga mbali k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo,zaidi anajiona yeye mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwema.<br />

Utakaso <strong>wa</strong> Biblia<br />

Utakaso unahusu hali kamili <strong>ya</strong> mtu--roho, nafsi, na mwili. Tazama 1 Watesalonika<br />

5:23. Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>naalik<strong>wa</strong> kutoa miili <strong>ya</strong>o, “iwe zabihu iliyo hai, takatifu, <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza<br />

198


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mungu.” Waroma 12:1. Kila desturi yo yote inayozoofisha nguvu za mwili ao akili<br />

inaondolea mtu uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Muumba. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naompenda Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>tatafuta daima kuleta nguvu zote za maisha <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> umoja pamoja na sheria<br />

zinazoendeleza nguvu zao k<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Ha<strong>wa</strong>talegeza <strong>wa</strong>la kuchafua sadaka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nayotoa k<strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong> tamaa <strong>wa</strong>la ulafi.<br />

Furaha yote <strong>ya</strong> zambi inaelekea kuzoofisha na kuua fahamu za akili na za kiroho; Neno<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inaweza kufan<strong>ya</strong> mguso mdogo k<strong>wa</strong> moyo. “Tujisafishe wenyewe<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uchafu wote <strong>wa</strong> mwili na <strong>wa</strong> roho, tukitimiza utakatifu katika woga <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.” 2<br />

Wakorinto 7:1.<br />

Ni <strong>wa</strong>ngapi <strong>wa</strong>naojitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>naoharibu sura <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kimungu k<strong>wa</strong> ulafi,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuny<strong>wa</strong> mvinyo, k<strong>wa</strong> anasa zilizokataz<strong>wa</strong>. Na kanisa vivyo hivyo hushawishi uovu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kujaza tena mali <strong>ya</strong>ke ambayo mapendo k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ni zaifu sana kutoa. Kama Kristo<br />

angeingia k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong> leo na kutazama karamu iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> pale k<strong>wa</strong> jina la dini, je,<br />

hangalifukuza <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>kufuru, kama alivyofukuzia mbali <strong>wa</strong>badili feza k<strong>wa</strong> hekalu?<br />

“Hamujui <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mwili wenu ni hekalu la Roho Mtakatifu aliye ndani yenu,<br />

muliyepe<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu? Na ninyi si mali yenu wenyewe; k<strong>wa</strong> sababu mulinunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

bei; basi tukuzeni Mungu katika mwili wenu na katika roho yenu, maana ni <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” 1<br />

Wakorinto 6:19,20. Yeye ambaye mwili <strong>wa</strong>ke ni hekalu la Roho Mtakatifu hatafany<strong>wa</strong><br />

mtum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> desturi mba<strong>ya</strong>. Nguvu zake ni za Kristo. Mali <strong>ya</strong>ke ni <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Namna gani<br />

angetapan<strong>ya</strong> hazina uliyo gabizi<strong>wa</strong>?<br />

Wanaojitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo kila m<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>wa</strong>natumia feza nyingi k<strong>wa</strong> anasa mba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>namuiba k<strong>wa</strong> zaka na sadaka, <strong>wa</strong>napoteketeza k<strong>wa</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuharibu zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>navyotoa k<strong>wa</strong> kusaidia maskini ao kusaidia maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> habari<br />

njema. Kama wote <strong>wa</strong>naoshuhudia Kristo <strong>wa</strong>ngetakas<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, mali <strong>ya</strong>o, badala <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuitumia k<strong>wa</strong> anasa za bure na zenye hasara, <strong>ya</strong>ngerudish<strong>wa</strong> katika hazina <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na.<br />

Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>ngetoa mufano <strong>wa</strong> kiasi na kujitoa kafara. Ndipo <strong>wa</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu.<br />

“Tamaa <strong>ya</strong> mwili, na tamaa <strong>ya</strong> macho, na kiburi cha maisha” (1 Yoane 2:16) zinata<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

wingi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na mwito takatifu. “Tokeni katikati<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o, mukateng<strong>wa</strong> nao, B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema, <strong>wa</strong>la musiguse kitu kisicho safi.” K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naokubali pamoja na mapatano, ahadi za Mungu ni “Nitaku<strong>wa</strong> baba kwenu, nanyi<br />

mutaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ngu <strong>wa</strong>na na binti, B<strong>wa</strong>na Mwenyezi anasema.” 2 Wakorinto 6:17,18.<br />

Kila hatua <strong>ya</strong> imani na utii inaleta nafsi k<strong>wa</strong> uhusiano <strong>wa</strong> karibu sana na Nuru <strong>ya</strong><br />

Ulimwengu. M<strong>wa</strong>ngaza safi <strong>wa</strong> Jua la Haki unaangazia juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kurudisha mishale <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke. Nyota zinat<strong>wa</strong>mbia k<strong>wa</strong>mba hapo kuna nuru<br />

katika mbingu na k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke zinangaa; k<strong>wa</strong> hivi Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>naonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

199


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

hapo kuna Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha enzi ambaye tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke ni bora <strong>ya</strong> sifa na <strong>ya</strong> kuiga. Utakatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke utaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Katika sifa njema za Kristo tunaku<strong>wa</strong> na ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kukaribia k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha Mwenye<br />

uwezo usio na mwisho (Mungu). “Yeye asiyeachilia M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke, lakini alimutoa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

yetu zote, namna gani atakosa kututolea vitu vyote pamoja naye?” Yesu asema: “Kama<br />

ninyi mulio <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> munajua ku<strong>wa</strong>pa <strong>wa</strong>toto wenu za<strong>wa</strong>di njema, si zaidi Baba yenu aliye<br />

katika mbingu ata<strong>wa</strong>pa wote <strong>wa</strong>naomwomba Roho Mtakatifu?” “Kama mukiomba neno<br />

gani k<strong>wa</strong> jina langu, nitalifan<strong>ya</strong>.” “Mwombe, na mutapata, furaha yenu itimizwe.” Waroma<br />

8:32; Luka 11:13; Yoane 14:14; 16:24.<br />

Ni heshima <strong>ya</strong> kila mumoja kuishi ambako Mungu atakao kubali na kubarikia. Si<br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Baba yetu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> tupate ku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> hukumu na giza. Hapo<br />

hakuna ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> kweli katika kwenda pamoja na kich<strong>wa</strong> cha kuinama<br />

chini na moyo unaojaa na ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> uchoyo. Tunaweza kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu na kutakas<strong>wa</strong><br />

na kusimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> sheria pasipo ha<strong>ya</strong> na majuto.<br />

Katika Yesu <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Adamu <strong>wa</strong>lioanguka <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.” K<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

hii haoni ha<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ita ndugu zake.” Maisha <strong>ya</strong> mkristo <strong>ya</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> imani<br />

moja, ushindi, na furaha katika Mungu. “Maana furaha <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ni nguvu zenu.” “Furahini<br />

siku zote. Ombeni pasipo kuacha. Katika maneno yote mushukuru; maana maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> ni<br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kwenu katika Kristo Yesu.” Waebrania 2:11; Nehemia 8:10; 1<br />

Watesalonika 5:16-18.<br />

Ha<strong>ya</strong> ndiyo <strong>ya</strong>navyoku<strong>wa</strong> matunda <strong>ya</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong> Biblia na utakaso; na ni k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kanuni kub<strong>wa</strong> za haki zilizo wek<strong>wa</strong> katika sheria zinaangali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutojali k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

matunda ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>nashuhudi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> shida. Hii ndiyo sababu hapo kunaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> kidogo sana<br />

kazi nyingi ile, yenye kudumu <strong>ya</strong> Roho ambayo iliyoonyesha maamsha <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza.<br />

Ni k<strong>wa</strong> kutazama ile tunaku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kubadilika. Wakati amri hizo takatifu ambamo<br />

Mungu amefungulia <strong>wa</strong>tu ukamilifu na utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke zimezarauli<strong>wa</strong>, na akili za<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu zimevut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mafun-disho na maelezo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, hapo kulifuat<strong>wa</strong> na upungufu <strong>wa</strong><br />

uta<strong>wa</strong> katika kanisa. Ni <strong>wa</strong>kati tu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu imerudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> haki<br />

ndipo pale panaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na muamsho <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> zamani za k<strong>wa</strong>nza na uta<strong>wa</strong> miongoni<br />

m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>naojulikana.<br />

200


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 28. Hukumu Nzito<br />

“Nikaangalia hata viti v<strong>ya</strong> enzi vilipowek<strong>wa</strong>, na mmoja aliye mzee <strong>wa</strong> siku akaketi:<br />

mavazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> meupe kama theluji, na nywele za kich<strong>wa</strong> chake kama sufu safi, kiti<br />

chake cha enzi kiliku<strong>wa</strong> ndimi za moto, na magurudumu <strong>ya</strong>ke moto unao<strong>wa</strong>ka. Na mto <strong>wa</strong><br />

moto ukatoka, ukapita mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, elfu <strong>ya</strong> maelfu <strong>wa</strong>kamutumikia, na elfu kumi mara elfu<br />

kumi <strong>wa</strong>lisimama mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke: hukumu ikawek<strong>wa</strong>, vitabu vikafunguli<strong>wa</strong>.” Danieli 7:9,10.<br />

R.V.<br />

Ndivyo ilivyoonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njozi <strong>ya</strong> Danieli siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

inapopita katika mkaguo mbele <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>mzi <strong>wa</strong> dunia yote. Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku ni Mungu Baba.<br />

Yeye, chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vyote,kisima cha sheria yote, anapas<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza katika<br />

hukumu. Na malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu kama <strong>wa</strong>huduma na <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda, <strong>wa</strong>nahuzuria.<br />

“Na tazama, pamoja na mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu alikuja mmoja aliye mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu, akakaribia huyu Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku, <strong>wa</strong>kamuleta karibu mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akape<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka,<br />

na utukufu, na ufalme, ili <strong>wa</strong>tu wote, mataifa yote, na lugha zote <strong>wa</strong>mutumikie; mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke ni mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> milele, isiyopita kamwe, na ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke ufalme usioweza<br />

kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong>.” Danieli 7:13,14.<br />

Kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo kunakoelez<strong>wa</strong> hapa si kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili duniani. Anakuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Mzee <strong>wa</strong> Siku katika mbingu kupokea ufalme ambao utatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama mpatanishi. Ni kuja huko, na si kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili<br />

dunianini, ile iliyopash<strong>wa</strong> kufanyika k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300 katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1844. Kuhani<br />

wetu Mkuu anaingia Pahali patakatifu pa patakatifu kushughulika katika kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mtu.<br />

Katika huduma <strong>ya</strong> mfano ila <strong>wa</strong>le ambao zambi zao zilihamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Pahali patakatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na sehemu katika Siku <strong>ya</strong> Upatanisho. Vivyo hivyo katika upatanisho kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho na hukumu <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi kesi zilizoangali<strong>wa</strong> ni zile za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naojulikana. Hukumu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu ni kazi iliyoteng<strong>wa</strong> na itafany<strong>wa</strong> baadaye. “Hukumu<br />

inapash<strong>wa</strong> kuanza katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.” 1 Petro 4:17.<br />

Vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho katika mbingu vianapas<strong>wa</strong> kuamua matokeo <strong>ya</strong> hukumu. Kitabu<br />

cha uzima kinaku<strong>wa</strong> na majina <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>lioingia daima k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Yesu<br />

aliambia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke: “Lakini furahini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu majina yenu <strong>ya</strong>meandik<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

mbingu.” Paulo anasema juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi wenzake, “Walio na majina <strong>ya</strong>o katika kitabu<br />

cha uzima.” Danieli anatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>takombole<strong>wa</strong>, “kila mtu<br />

atakayeonekana ameandik<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu.” Na mfumbuaji anasema k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>le tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takaoingia Mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ambao majina <strong>ya</strong>o “<strong>wa</strong>lioandik<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu cha uzima cha<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.” Luka 10:20; Wafilipi 4:3; Danieli 12:1; Ufunuo 21:27.<br />

201


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Katika “Kitabu cha ukumbusho” kumeandik<strong>wa</strong> matendo mema <strong>ya</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>le wenye kuogopa<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, na kufikiri juu <strong>ya</strong> jina lake.” Kila jaribu lililostahimili<strong>wa</strong>, kila uovu uliozui<strong>wa</strong>, kila<br />

neno la huruma lililoonyesh<strong>wa</strong>, kila tendo la (kafara), kila huzuni iliyovumili<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo imeandik<strong>wa</strong>. “Umehesabu kutangatanga k<strong>wa</strong>ngu; Utie machozi <strong>ya</strong>ngu ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

chupa <strong>ya</strong>ko; Ha<strong>ya</strong> si katika kitabu chako?” Malaki 3:16; Zaburi 56:8.<br />

Mukusudi <strong>ya</strong> Siri<br />

Hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> pia ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> zambi za <strong>wa</strong>tu. “K<strong>wa</strong> maana Mungu ataleta kila kazi<br />

hukumuni, pamoja na kila neno la siri, kama liki<strong>wa</strong> jema ao kama liki<strong>wa</strong> ba<strong>ya</strong>.” Kila neno la<br />

bure <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takalolisema. <strong>wa</strong>tatoa hesabu <strong>ya</strong> neno hili siku <strong>ya</strong> hukumu.” “K<strong>wa</strong> masemo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ko utahesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki, na k<strong>wa</strong> masemo <strong>ya</strong>ko utahukumi<strong>wa</strong>.” Makusudi <strong>ya</strong> siri <strong>ya</strong>naonekana<br />

katika kitabu, k<strong>wa</strong> maana Mungu “atatia nuru maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyofich<strong>wa</strong> katika giza, na<br />

kuonyesha makusudi <strong>ya</strong> mioyo.” Muhubiri 12:14; Matayo 12:36,37; 1 Wakorinto 4:5.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> kila jina katika vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni kunaingia kila neno ba<strong>ya</strong>, kila tendo la<br />

choyo, kila mapash<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>siyotimiz<strong>wa</strong>, na kila zambi <strong>ya</strong> siri. Maonyo <strong>ya</strong>liyotum<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mbingu ao makaripio <strong>ya</strong>siyojali<strong>wa</strong>, n<strong>ya</strong>kati zilizotumi<strong>wa</strong> bure, mvuto uliotumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

wema ao k<strong>wa</strong> uba<strong>ya</strong> pamoja na matokeo <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> mbali, <strong>ya</strong>naandik<strong>wa</strong> yote k<strong>wa</strong><br />

taratibu na malaika m<strong>wa</strong>ndishi.<br />

Kipimo cha Hukumu<br />

Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni kipimo katika hukumu. “Ogopa Mungu, na shika amri zake; maana<br />

maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> ni yote inayofaa mtu kufan<strong>ya</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> maana Mungu ataleta kila kazi<br />

hukumuni.” “Semeni ninyi, na kutenda kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takaohukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> uhuru.”<br />

Muhubiri 12:13,14; Yakobo 2:12.<br />

Wale “<strong>wa</strong>naohesabi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mestahili” <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> na sehemu katika ufufuko <strong>wa</strong><br />

wenye haki, Yesu akasema: “Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaohesabi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mestahili kupata dunia<br />

ile na kufufuka kutoka <strong>wa</strong>fu,... ni <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> ufufuo.” “Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> mema <strong>wa</strong>tafufuka k<strong>wa</strong> ufufuko <strong>wa</strong> uzima.” Luka 20:35,36; Yoane 5:29. Wafu<br />

wenye haki ha<strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong> hata baada <strong>ya</strong> hukumu ambayo <strong>wa</strong>takayohesabi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>mestahili k<strong>wa</strong> “ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> uzima.” K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo ha<strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong>ko katika nafsi <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

vilivyoandik<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> vingali na chunguz<strong>wa</strong> kesi zao kukat<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Yesu atatokea kama mwombezi <strong>wa</strong>o, kutetea k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Na Kama<br />

mtu yeyote akitenda zambi, tunaye Mwombezi k<strong>wa</strong> Baba, Yesu Kristo mwenye haki.”<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> sababu Kristo hakuingia katika Pahali patakatifu palipofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mikono, ndio<br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong> kweli, lakini aliingia mbinguni zenyewe, aonekane sasa mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili yetu.” “Naye, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii anaweza pia ku<strong>wa</strong>okoa <strong>wa</strong>naokuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia <strong>ya</strong>ke; maana yeye ni hai siku zote apate ku<strong>wa</strong>ombea.” 1 Yoane 2:1; Waebrania 7:25;<br />

9:24.<br />

202


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakati vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho vinapofunguli<strong>wa</strong> katika hukumu, maisha <strong>ya</strong> wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioamini k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu <strong>ya</strong>nakuja katika ukumbusho mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Kuanzia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioishi k<strong>wa</strong>nza duniani, Mtetezi wetu anaonyesha kesi za kila kizazi k<strong>wa</strong> kufuatana. Kila<br />

jina linataj<strong>wa</strong>, kila kesi inachunguz<strong>wa</strong>. Majina <strong>ya</strong>nakubali<strong>wa</strong>, majina <strong>ya</strong>nakatali<strong>wa</strong>. Wakati<br />

mtu ye yote anaku<strong>wa</strong> na zambi zinazodumu k<strong>wa</strong> vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho, zisizoungam<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kusamehe<strong>wa</strong>, majina <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>tafut<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu cha uzima. B<strong>wa</strong>na akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia Musa:<br />

“Mutu aliyenikosea, ndiye nitakayemwondosha katika kitabu changu.” Kutoka 32:33.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>liotubu k<strong>wa</strong> kweli na katika imani <strong>wa</strong>kadai damu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo kama kafara <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong><br />

upatanishi <strong>wa</strong>lipata rehema <strong>wa</strong>kaingia katika vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. K<strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafany<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>wa</strong> Kristo na tabia zao zinaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> katika umoja na<br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, zambi zao zitafut<strong>wa</strong> mbali, na <strong>wa</strong>tahesabi<strong>wa</strong> wenyekustahili uzima <strong>wa</strong><br />

milele. B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema: “Mimi, ndiye anayefuta makosa <strong>ya</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu mwenyewe;<br />

nami sitakumbuka zambi zako.” “Yeye anayeshinda atavik<strong>wa</strong> nguo nyeupe, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

sitaondosha jina lake katika kitabu cha uzima; nami nitakiri jina lake mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ngu,<br />

na mbele <strong>ya</strong> malaika zake.’‘ “Basi kila mtu anayenikiri mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, nitamukiri vilevile<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ngu aliye mbinguni.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 43:25; Ufunuo 3:5; Matayo 10:32,33.<br />

Mtetezi <strong>wa</strong> kimungu anaonyesha maombi <strong>ya</strong>le yote <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lioshinda k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani<br />

katika damu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>pate kurudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> Edeni na kuvik<strong>wa</strong> taji kama ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>riti pamoja naye mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> “mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo.” Mika 4:8. Sasa Kristo anauliza<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mpago <strong>wa</strong> kimungu katika kuumb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mtu upate kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu<br />

hakuanguka kamwe. Anauliza k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke si rehema tu na kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki, bali<br />

sehemu katika utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke na kukaa k<strong>wa</strong> kiti chake cha enzi.<br />

Wakati Yesu anapoombea <strong>wa</strong>tu neema <strong>ya</strong>ke, Shetani ana<strong>wa</strong>shitaki mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Anaonyesha ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> maisha, upungufu <strong>wa</strong> tabia, ku<strong>wa</strong> na tofauti k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

zambi zote alizo<strong>wa</strong>jaribu nazo kufan<strong>ya</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> ana<strong>wa</strong>dai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Yesu haruhusu zambi zao, lakini anaonyesha toba <strong>ya</strong>o na imani. Anapoomba msamaha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>o, anainua mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke iliyojeruhi<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> Baba, kusema: Nime<strong>wa</strong>chora<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> viganja v<strong>ya</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong>ngu. “Zabihu za Mungu ni roho <strong>ya</strong> kuvunjika, moyo uliovunjika<br />

na toba hutauzarau, Ee Mungu.” Zaburi 51:17.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na Anahamakia Shetani<br />

Na k<strong>wa</strong> mushitaki anasema: “B<strong>wa</strong>na akuhamakie, Ee Shetani. Ndiyo B<strong>wa</strong>na aliyechagua<br />

Yerusalema, akuhamakie. Hiki si kinga kilichoondosh<strong>wa</strong> katika moto?” Zekaria 3:2. Kristo<br />

atavika <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe, ili aweze ku<strong>wa</strong>onyesha k<strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

“kanisa la utukufu, pasipo alama <strong>wa</strong>la kikunjo <strong>wa</strong>la kitu cho chote kama hivi.” Waefeso<br />

5:27.<br />

203


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ndivyo itakavyotimilika utimilizo kamili <strong>wa</strong> ahadi <strong>ya</strong> maagano map<strong>ya</strong>: “Maana<br />

nitasamehe uovu <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>la zambi <strong>ya</strong>o sitakumbuka tena.” “Katika siku zile na <strong>wa</strong>kati ule,<br />

anasema B<strong>wa</strong>na, uovu <strong>wa</strong> Israeli utatafutikana, <strong>wa</strong>la uovu hapana; na zambi za Yuda<br />

zitafutikana, <strong>wa</strong>la hazitaonekana.” “Na itaku<strong>wa</strong>, yeye aliyeach<strong>wa</strong> katika Sayuni, na yeye<br />

aliyebaki ndani <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema, atait<strong>wa</strong> mtakatifu, kila mmoja aliyeandik<strong>wa</strong> katika <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio hai ndani <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema.” Yeremia 31:34; 50:20; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 4:3.<br />

Kufutia Mbali k<strong>wa</strong> Zambi<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi na kufutia mbali zambi inapash<strong>wa</strong> kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na mara <strong>ya</strong> pili. Katika huduma <strong>ya</strong> mfano kuhani mkuu alitoka inje na<br />

kubariki makutano. Vivyo hivyo Kristo, k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke kama mpatanishi,<br />

ataonekana” si tena k<strong>wa</strong> zambi, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> wokovu.” Waebrania 9:28.<br />

Kuhani, katika kuondoa zambi kutoka Pahali patakatifu, aliziungama juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli. Kristo ataweka zambi hizi zote juu <strong>ya</strong> Shetani, mshawishi <strong>wa</strong> zambi.<br />

Mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli akapelek<strong>wa</strong> mbali “katika inchi isiyo na <strong>wa</strong>tu.” Walawi 16:22. Shetani,<br />

katika kuchukua hatia za zambi alizolazimisha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuzifan<strong>ya</strong>, atafung<strong>wa</strong> miaka<br />

elfu katika inchi isiyokali<strong>wa</strong> kama jang<strong>wa</strong> na mwishoni atates<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> azabu <strong>ya</strong> moto<br />

utakaoangamiza <strong>wa</strong>ovu. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi mpango <strong>wa</strong> wokovu utafikia utimilifu <strong>wa</strong>ke katika<br />

kungoa k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> zambi.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> Wakati Uliotaj<strong>wa</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliotaj<strong>wa</strong>--mwisho <strong>wa</strong> siku 2300 katika 1844--kazi <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi ikaanza na<br />

kufuti<strong>wa</strong> mbali k<strong>wa</strong> zambi. Zambi zisizoungam<strong>wa</strong> na kuach<strong>wa</strong> hazitafut<strong>wa</strong> kutoka vitabu<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> ukumbusho. Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kashuhudia kila zambi na kuiandika. Zambi<br />

inaweza kukan<strong>wa</strong>, kufich<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Baba, mama, bibi, <strong>wa</strong>toto, na k<strong>wa</strong> rafiki; lakini inawek<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong> mbingu. Mungu hadanganywe k<strong>wa</strong> matendo <strong>ya</strong>nayoonekana. Hafanyi<br />

makosa. Watu <strong>wa</strong>naweza kudangany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naochafuka ndani <strong>ya</strong> moyo, lakini<br />

Mungu anasoma maisha <strong>ya</strong> ndani.<br />

Ni <strong>wa</strong>zo la kutisha namna gani! Mshindi mkub<strong>wa</strong> kupita duniani hawezi kurudisha<br />

ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> matendo <strong>ya</strong> siku hata moja. Matendo yetu, maneno yetu, hata makusudi yetu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> siri, ijapo tuki<strong>ya</strong>sahau, <strong>ya</strong>tatoa ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kuhesabi<strong>wa</strong> haki <strong>wa</strong>la kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Katika hukumu matumizi <strong>ya</strong> kila kipaji <strong>ya</strong>tachunguz<strong>wa</strong>. Namna gani tumetumia <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

wetu, kalamu yetu <strong>ya</strong> wino, sauti yetu, mali yetu, mvuto wetu? Tumefan<strong>ya</strong> nini k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

katika nafsi <strong>ya</strong> maskini, wenye kutes<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong>tima, ao mjane? Tumefan<strong>ya</strong> nini na nuru pia na<br />

kweli tuliyope<strong>wa</strong>? Ila tu upendo ulioonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> matendo unaohesabi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

Upendo peke <strong>ya</strong>ke mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni haufanye tendo lo lote la damani.<br />

Choyo lliyofich<strong>wa</strong> Imefunuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

204


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mambo yote <strong>ya</strong> ukaidi <strong>wa</strong> choyo iliyofich<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>mefunuli<strong>wa</strong> katika vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Mara ngapi <strong>wa</strong>kati, ma<strong>wa</strong>zo, na nguvu zinazoku<strong>wa</strong> za Kristo zilitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani.<br />

Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>nashughulika katika upataji <strong>wa</strong> mali <strong>ya</strong> kidunia ao furaha <strong>ya</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu. Mali, <strong>wa</strong>kati, na nguvu zinatumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maonyesho na anasa; n<strong>ya</strong>kati za bidii<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuomba ni chache, k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta Maandiko, kuungama zambi.<br />

Shetani anavumbua mashauri mengi <strong>ya</strong>siyohesabika k<strong>wa</strong> kutumia ma<strong>wa</strong>zo yetu.<br />

Mdanganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong> anachukia mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>nayoonyesha kafara <strong>ya</strong><br />

upatanisho na Mpatanishi hodari. K<strong>wa</strong>ke kila kitu kinategemea juu <strong>ya</strong> kugeuza ma<strong>wa</strong>zo<br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoweza kuga<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi ha<strong>wa</strong>paswi kuruhusu kitu<br />

cho chote kujiingiza k<strong>wa</strong> shughuli <strong>ya</strong>o kukamilisha utakatifu katika kumcha Mungu. Saa za<br />

damani, badala <strong>ya</strong> kuzitoa k<strong>wa</strong> anasa ao k<strong>wa</strong> kutafuta faida, zinapash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kujifunza katika maombi k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Kweli. Pahali patakatifu na hukumu <strong>ya</strong> uchunguzi<br />

vinapas<strong>wa</strong> kufahami<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi. Wote <strong>wa</strong>nahitaji ujuzi <strong>wa</strong> cheo na kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kuhani <strong>wa</strong>o Mkuu.<br />

Kama sivyo itaku<strong>wa</strong> haiwezekani kutumia kanuni <strong>ya</strong> imani k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu.<br />

Mahali patakatifu huko mbinguni ndipo pahali Kristo anaweka shabaha <strong>ya</strong> kazi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu. Hii ni k<strong>wa</strong> kila roho inayoishi duniani. Inafungua k<strong>wa</strong> maoni mpango <strong>wa</strong><br />

wokovu, kutuleta chini k<strong>wa</strong>kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa kati <strong>ya</strong> ukamilifu na zambi.<br />

Maombezi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo<br />

Maombezi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mtu katika Pahali patakatifu kule juu ni lazima k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mpango <strong>wa</strong> wokovu kama ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> na kifo chake msalabani. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kifo chake<br />

akaanza kazi ile ambayo aliyopandia k<strong>wa</strong> kuitimiza mbinguni. K<strong>wa</strong> imani inatupasa kuingia<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> pazia, “pahali alipoingia Yesu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu.” Waebrania 6:20. Hapo nuru kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> msalaba imerudush<strong>wa</strong>. Hapo tunapata m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza zaidi juu <strong>ya</strong> siri za ukombozi.<br />

“Yeye anayefunika zambi zake hatasitawi: Lakini yeye anayezikiri na kuziacha atapata<br />

rehema.” Mezali 28:13. Kama <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoachilia (ruhusu) makosa <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>ngaliweza kuona<br />

namna gani Shetani anavyolaumu Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>ngeungama zambi zao na<br />

kuziacha. Shetani anatumika apate uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> moyo wote, na anajua <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama ma<strong>wa</strong>a<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nafurahi<strong>wa</strong>, atashinda. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo anatafuta daima kudangan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

werevu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> mauti ambao haiwezekani k<strong>wa</strong>o kuushinda. Lakini Yesu alisema k<strong>wa</strong> wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoweza kumfuata: “Neema <strong>ya</strong>ngu inafaa k<strong>wa</strong>ko.” “Nira <strong>ya</strong>ngu ni laini, na mzigo <strong>wa</strong>ngu<br />

ni mwepesi.” 2 Wakorinto 12:9; Matayo 11:30. Hebu kusiwe <strong>wa</strong>tu wo wote kuzania makosa<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o kama si<strong>ya</strong>kuponyeka. Mungu atatoa imani na neema k<strong>wa</strong> kushinda.<br />

Sasa tunaishi katika siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho. Wakati kuhani mkuu alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akifan<strong>ya</strong><br />

upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Israeli, wote <strong>wa</strong>lilazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuhuzunisha roho zao k<strong>wa</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi. K<strong>wa</strong> namna ileile, wote <strong>wa</strong>naotaka majina <strong>ya</strong>o kudumu katika kitabu cha uzima<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> sasa kuhuzunisha roho zao mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Hapo<br />

205


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kunapash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na uchunguzi mwingi, <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> moyoni. Roho hafifu iliyopendele<strong>wa</strong><br />

na wengi inapash<strong>wa</strong> kuach<strong>wa</strong>. Hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> vita <strong>ya</strong> nguvu mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoshinda mivuto mba<strong>ya</strong> inayoshindana k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la. Kila mtu anapash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukut<strong>wa</strong> pasipo a<strong>wa</strong>a ao kikunjo <strong>wa</strong>la kitu cho chote kama hivi.” Waefeso 5:27.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu juu <strong>ya</strong> vitu vyote vingine inafaa kila nafsi kusikia onyo la upole la<br />

Mwokozi: “Tazameni, ombeni, maana hamujui <strong>wa</strong>kati ule.” Marko 13:33.<br />

Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Wote Umekat<strong>wa</strong><br />

Rehema imeisha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mfupi kabla <strong>ya</strong> kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na katika mawingu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mbinguni. Kristo akitazama <strong>wa</strong>kati ule, anasema: “Yeye aliye mzalimu azidi ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mzalimu; na mwenye uchafu azidi ku<strong>wa</strong> mchafu; na mwenye haki azidi kufan<strong>ya</strong> haki; na<br />

mtakatifu azidi kutakas<strong>wa</strong>. Tazama, ninakuja upesi na mshahara <strong>wa</strong>ngu ni pamoja nami,<br />

kulipa kila mtu kama ilivyo kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke.” Ufunuo 22:11,12.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kipanda na kujenga, kula na kuny<strong>wa</strong>, wote pasipokufahamu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho imetangaz<strong>wa</strong> katika Pahali patakatifu mbinguni. Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Garika,<br />

baada <strong>ya</strong> Noa kuingia katika safina, Mungu akamfungia ndani na kufungia <strong>wa</strong>ovu inje;<br />

lakini k<strong>wa</strong> siku saba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea na maisha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kupenda anasa na <strong>wa</strong>kachekelea<br />

maonyo <strong>ya</strong> hukumu. “Ndivyo” asema Mwokozi, “kutakavyoku<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu.” K<strong>wa</strong> kim<strong>ya</strong>, bila kuon<strong>wa</strong> kama mwizi usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane, saa itakuja ambayo<br />

inaonyesha kukata shauri la mwisho <strong>wa</strong> kila mtu. “Basi angalieni: ... asije na ku<strong>wa</strong>situsha<br />

ninyi gafula, aka<strong>wa</strong>kuta mumelala.” Matayo 24:39; Marko 13:35,36.<br />

Hali ni yenye hatari <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao, huendelea kuchoka k<strong>wa</strong> kukesha k<strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>nageuka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> mivuto <strong>ya</strong> dunia. Wakati mtu <strong>wa</strong> biashara anaposhughulika katika kufuata faida, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

mwenye kupenda anasa anapotafuta anasa, <strong>wa</strong>kati binti <strong>wa</strong> desturi <strong>ya</strong> kuvaa nguo<br />

anapotengeneza mapambo <strong>ya</strong>ke--inaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> katika saa ile M<strong>wa</strong>mzi <strong>wa</strong> dunia yote<br />

atatangaza hukumu, “Umepim<strong>wa</strong> katika mizani, nawe umeonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> umepunguka.”<br />

Danieli 5:27.<br />

Sura 29. Asili <strong>ya</strong> Uovu<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naona kazi <strong>ya</strong> uovu, na msiba <strong>wa</strong>ke na uki<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>nauliza namna gani hii<br />

inaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Huyu Mmoja asiyeku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho katika hekima,<br />

uwezo na upendo. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naotaka ku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka <strong>wa</strong>nashikamana na jambo hili na<br />

kutafuta sababu <strong>ya</strong> kukataa manene <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko matakatifu. Desturi <strong>ya</strong> asili na mafahamu<br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong>meficha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia kuhusu tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, asili <strong>ya</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kanuni zake kuhusu zambi.<br />

Haiwezekani kueleza m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong> zambi vilevile kama kutoa sababu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke (zambi). K<strong>wa</strong>ni kuna mambo mengi <strong>ya</strong> kutosha inayoweza kufahami<strong>wa</strong> juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo na hali <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong> zambi kufan<strong>ya</strong> onyesho kamili haki na wema <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

206


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> hekima yo yote haku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye madaraka k<strong>wa</strong> zambi; hapaku<strong>wa</strong> bila sababu<br />

kuondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, hakuna upungufu katika mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kimungu, iliyotoa<br />

nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> uasi. Zambi ni mpelelezi (mdukizi) ambaye ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke hakuna sababu<br />

inayoweza kutole<strong>wa</strong>. Kuisamehe ni kuitetea. Kama iliweza kusamehe<strong>wa</strong> ingekoma ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

zambi. Zambi ni onyesho la kanuni inayoleta k<strong>wa</strong> vita sheria <strong>ya</strong> upendo, inayoku<strong>wa</strong> msingi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> zambi amani na furaha iliku<strong>wa</strong> katika viumbe vyote. Upendo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu uliku<strong>wa</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong>, upendo k<strong>wa</strong> mtu na k<strong>wa</strong> mwingine uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> bila ubaguzi.<br />

Kristo M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> pekee <strong>wa</strong> Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> mmoja pamoja na Baba <strong>wa</strong> milele katika hali,<br />

katika tabia, na katika kusudi--ni yeye peke <strong>ya</strong>ke ambaye aliweza kuingia katika mashauri<br />

yote na makusudi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. ‘’Katika yeye vitu vyote viliumb<strong>wa</strong> vilivyo mbinguni, ... iki<strong>wa</strong><br />

ni viti v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme ao usultani ao falme ao mamlaka.” Wakolosayi 1:16.<br />

Sheria <strong>ya</strong> upendo iliku<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, furaha <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vyote<br />

vilivyoumb<strong>wa</strong> ilitegemea k<strong>wa</strong> upatano pamoja na kanuni zake za haki. Mungu hapendezwi<br />

na utii <strong>wa</strong> kulazimish<strong>wa</strong>, na k<strong>wa</strong> wote anatoa uhuru <strong>wa</strong> mapenzi, k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>naweza<br />

kumfanyia kazi bila kulazimish<strong>wa</strong>).<br />

Lakini kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na mmoja aliyechagua kuharibu viba<strong>ya</strong> uhuru huo. Zambi ilianzia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke, yeye aliyeku<strong>wa</strong>, baada <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, aliheshimi<strong>wa</strong> sana k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, Lusifero aliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kerubi <strong>wa</strong> kufunika, mtakatifu na<br />

mwenye usafi. “B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu anasema hivi: Uliku<strong>wa</strong> muhuri <strong>wa</strong> ukamilifu, mwenye kujaa<br />

na hekima na ukamilifu <strong>wa</strong> uzuri. Wewe uliku<strong>wa</strong> katika Edeni, shamba la Mungu; kila jiwe<br />

la damani lilku<strong>wa</strong> kifunuko chako. ... Wewe uliku<strong>wa</strong> kerubi <strong>wa</strong> kufunika mwenye kuti<strong>wa</strong><br />

mafuta; nami nilikuweka juu <strong>ya</strong> mlima mtakatifu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu; umetembea huko na huko<br />

katikati <strong>ya</strong> mawe <strong>ya</strong> moto. Uliku<strong>wa</strong> mkamilifu k<strong>wa</strong> njia zako tangu siku ulipoumb<strong>wa</strong>, hata<br />

uovu ulipoonekana ndani <strong>ya</strong>ko. ... Moyo <strong>wa</strong>ko umen<strong>ya</strong>nyuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> uzuri <strong>wa</strong>ko,<br />

umeharibu hekima <strong>ya</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> kungaa k<strong>wa</strong>ko.” “Nawe ulisema moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ko ...<br />

Nitan<strong>ya</strong>nyua kiti changu cha enzi juu kupita nyota za Mungu, Na nitakaa juu <strong>ya</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong><br />

makutano. ... Nitapanda juu kupita vimo v<strong>ya</strong> mawingu, Nitafanana naaliye juu Sana.”<br />

Ezekieli 28:12-17; 28:6; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 14:13,14.<br />

Kutamani heshima ambayo Baba aliweka juu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke, mta<strong>wa</strong>la huyu <strong>wa</strong><br />

malaika akatamani k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo ambao uliku<strong>wa</strong> ni mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Kristo peke <strong>ya</strong>ke kuta<strong>wa</strong>la.<br />

Sauti isiyopatana sasa ikaharibu mapatano <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Kujiinua k<strong>wa</strong> nafsi kukaamsha<br />

visirani v<strong>ya</strong> uovu katika mioyo ambayo utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu uliku<strong>wa</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Baraza za<br />

mbinguni zikatetea pamoja na Lusifero. M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu akaonyesha mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke wema<br />

na haki <strong>ya</strong> Muumba na tabia takatifu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> kuiacha, Lusifero angezarau<br />

Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke na kujiletea uharibifu juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe. Lakini onyo peke likaamsha<br />

msimamo. Lusifero akaruhusu wivu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo kushinda.<br />

207


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kiburi kikazidisha tamaa <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka. Heshima za juu zilizotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Lusifero<br />

zikaleta kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na shukrani k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba. Akatamani ku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu. Huku<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> Mfalme aliyekubali<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> mbingu, mmoja k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo na<br />

mamlaka pamoja na Baba. Katika mipango yote <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, Kristo aliku<strong>wa</strong> mshirika, lakini<br />

Lusifero hakuruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuingia katika makusudi <strong>ya</strong> kimungu. “Sababu gani,” akauliza huyu<br />

malaika mkub<strong>wa</strong>, “inamupasa Kristo ku<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka? Sababu gani yeye anaheshimi<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupita Lusifero?”<br />

Manunguniko Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> Malaika<br />

Kuacha pahali pake mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, Lusifero akaendelea kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> manunguniko<br />

miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> malaika. K<strong>wa</strong> maficho <strong>ya</strong>siyoelezeka,k<strong>wa</strong> kuficha kusudi lake la kweli chini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> heshima k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, akajikaza kuamsha kutorizika juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria ambazo<br />

zilita<strong>wa</strong>la viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni, kutangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lilazimisha amri isiyohitajika.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni tabia zao ziliku<strong>wa</strong> takatifu, akashurtisha k<strong>wa</strong>mba malaika <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kutii amri za<br />

mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. Mungu alimtendea bila haki k<strong>wa</strong> kuweka heshima kub<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kristo. Akadai k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakukusudia kujiinua mwenyewe lakini aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitafuta kulinda<br />

uhuru <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji wote <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, ili <strong>wa</strong>weze kufikia maisha <strong>ya</strong> juu.<br />

Mungu akavumilia Lusifero muda mrefu. Hakuondole<strong>wa</strong> cheo k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> juu<br />

ijapo <strong>wa</strong>kati alipoanza kuonyesha madai <strong>ya</strong> uwongo mbele <strong>ya</strong> malaika. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara<br />

akatole<strong>wa</strong> rehema iki<strong>wa</strong> anakubali kutubu na kutii. Juhudi za namna ile ambayo upendo tu<br />

usio na mwisho ulifan<strong>ya</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>kumpata asadiki <strong>ya</strong> kosa lake. M<strong>wa</strong>nzoni manunguniko<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong> kujulikana kule mbinguni. Lusifero mwenyewe mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza hakufahamu tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> namna uchungu <strong>wa</strong>ke ulipohakikish<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> bila sababu,<br />

Lusifero akasadikish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba madai <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> haki na k<strong>wa</strong>mba ilimupasa<br />

ku<strong>ya</strong>ungama mbele <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Kama angalifan<strong>ya</strong> hivi, angalijiokoa mwenyewe<br />

na malaika wengi. Kama angalipenda kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> kujaza pahali<br />

alipoagiz<strong>wa</strong>, angalirudish<strong>wa</strong> katika kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini kiburi kikamkataza kutii. Akashikilia<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba haku<strong>wa</strong> na haja <strong>ya</strong> toba, na akajitoa kabisa katika vita kuu juu <strong>ya</strong> Muumba <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Nguvu zote za akili <strong>ya</strong> ufundi <strong>wa</strong>ke zikaelekeza k<strong>wa</strong> udanganyifu, kusudi malaika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>muunge mkono. Shetani akaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba alihukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uwongo na k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

uhuru <strong>wa</strong>ke ukapunguz<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> masingizio <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> Kristo akapita k<strong>wa</strong> kusimamia<br />

uwongo, kushitaki M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu juu <strong>ya</strong> shauri la kumfezelesha mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong><br />

mbinguni.<br />

Wote ambao hakuweza ku<strong>wa</strong>pindua k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ke aka<strong>wa</strong>shitaki ku<strong>wa</strong> wenye ubaridi<br />

(kutojali) k<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Akakimbilia k<strong>wa</strong> maafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> Muumba. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ujanja <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kuhangaisha malaika na maneno <strong>ya</strong> ujanja juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

makusudi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Kila kitu chepesi akakifunika katika fumbo, na k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kupotosha<br />

akatia mashaka juu <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Cheo chake cha juu<br />

208


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kikatoa nguvu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> masingizio <strong>ya</strong>ke. Akashawishi wengi kuungana pamoja naye<br />

katika uasi.<br />

Uchuki Ukasitawish<strong>wa</strong> Katika Uasi <strong>wa</strong> Juhudi<br />

Mungu katika hekima <strong>ya</strong>ke akaruhusu Shetani kuendelea na kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke, hata roho <strong>ya</strong><br />

uchuki ikasitawish<strong>wa</strong> katika uasi. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni lazima k<strong>wa</strong> mashauri <strong>ya</strong>ke kuendelea kabisa, ili<br />

tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli iweze kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> wote. Lusifero aliku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye kupend<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

na viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni, na mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong>o uliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> nguvu. Serkali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

haikuhusikana tu na <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> dunia zote alizoziumba; na Shetani<br />

akafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama akiweza kuchukua malaika pamoja naye katika uasi, angeweza<br />

kuchukua vilevile dunia zingine. Kutumia madanganyo na werevu, uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kudangan<strong>ya</strong> uliku<strong>wa</strong> mkub<strong>wa</strong> sana. Hata Malaika <strong>wa</strong>aminifu ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kabisa kutambua<br />

tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>la kuona ni kitu gani kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikiongoza.<br />

Shetani aliku<strong>wa</strong> akiheshimi<strong>wa</strong> sana, na matendo <strong>ya</strong>ke yote kuvik<strong>wa</strong> sana na siri, mpaka<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> vigumu kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> malaika tabia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hata ilipositawi<br />

kabisa, zambi haikuonyesha kitu kiba<strong>ya</strong> kilichoku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Viumbe vitakatifu havikuweza<br />

kutambua matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kuweka kando sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Shetani m<strong>wa</strong>nzoni alisema aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

anatafuta kuendelesha heshima <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na uzuri <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji wote <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Katika mipango <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> zambi, Mungu aliweza kutumia tu haki na kweli. Shetani<br />

aliweza kutumia mambo ambayo Mungu hakuweza kutumia--uongo na werevu. Tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>nganyi ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kufahami<strong>wa</strong> na wote. Alipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

kujionyesha mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> kazi zake za uovu.<br />

Ugomvi ambao alianzisha yeye mwenyewe mbinguni, Shetani aliuwekea juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Uovu wote aliutangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni lazima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba aonyeshe <strong>wa</strong>zi matokeo <strong>ya</strong> makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kugeuza sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mwenyewe ilipash<strong>wa</strong> kumuhukumu. Viumbe vyote v<strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu vilipash<strong>wa</strong> kuona<br />

mdanganyi kufunuli<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hata <strong>wa</strong>kati ilipokusudi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba hawezi tena kudumu mbinguni, Mungu <strong>wa</strong> hekima<br />

isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho hakumuangamiza Shetani. Utii <strong>wa</strong> viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> Mungu unapash<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> sadikisho la haki <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakaaji <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni na <strong>wa</strong> dunia zingine, <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

bila kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha kufahamu matokeo <strong>ya</strong> zambi, ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza basi kuona haki na rehema <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu katika maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Kama angaliangamiz<strong>wa</strong> mara moja, <strong>wa</strong>ngemtumikia<br />

Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> hofu kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> upendo. Mvuto <strong>wa</strong> mdanganyi haungeharibi<strong>wa</strong> kabisa, <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

roho <strong>ya</strong> uasi kungole<strong>wa</strong> kabisa. K<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vyote katika vizazi vyote, Shetani<br />

alipash<strong>wa</strong> kuendelesha kabisa kanuni zake, k<strong>wa</strong>mba mashambulio <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>ya</strong>pate kuonekana katika nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> viumbe vyote vilivyoumb<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Uasi <strong>wa</strong> Shetani ulipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> viumbe vyote ushuhuda k<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuogopesha <strong>ya</strong> zambi. Kanuni <strong>ya</strong>ke ingeonyesha matunda <strong>ya</strong> kuweka kando mamlaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

209


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mungu. Historia <strong>ya</strong> tendo hili la kuogopesha la uasi lilipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong><br />

akili takatifu zote ku<strong>wa</strong>okoa k<strong>wa</strong> zambi na k<strong>wa</strong> azabu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Wakati ilipotangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke wote mn<strong>ya</strong>nganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

ufalme anapash<strong>wa</strong> kufukuz<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> cheo cha furaha, mwongozi muasi<br />

(mhuni) akatangaza <strong>wa</strong>zi bila woga zarau k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Muumba. Akalaumu sheria<br />

za Mungu kama kizuio cha uhuru na akatangaza kusudi lake la kupata kuondosh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sheria. K<strong>wa</strong> kuwek<strong>wa</strong> huru k<strong>wa</strong> amri hii, majeshi <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kuingia juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

hali <strong>ya</strong> kujipandisha zaidi katika maisha.<br />

Kufukuzi<strong>wa</strong> Mbali Kutoka Mbinguni<br />

Shetani na jeshi lake <strong>wa</strong>katupa laumu la uasi <strong>wa</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo; kama ha<strong>wa</strong>kulaumi<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

kama ha<strong>wa</strong>ngeasi kamwe. Wagumu na <strong>wa</strong>kiburi, huku <strong>wa</strong>kajitangaza k<strong>wa</strong> matukano ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa na k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lites<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka makali. Muasi mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liomfuata <strong>wa</strong>kafukuz<strong>wa</strong> kutoka mbinguni. Tazama Ufunuo 12:7-9.<br />

Roho <strong>ya</strong> Shetani ingali inaendesha uasi duniani katika <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> uasi. Kama yeye<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kaahidia <strong>wa</strong>tu uhuru k<strong>wa</strong> kuvunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Hakikisho la zambi likaendelea<br />

kuamsha uchuki. Shetani anaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kujihakikisha <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe na kutafuta huruma<br />

<strong>ya</strong> wengine katika zambi zao. Badala <strong>ya</strong> kusahihisha makosa <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>naamsha hasira juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwenye kukaripia, kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> chanzo cha shida. K<strong>wa</strong> kusingizia k<strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

ileile <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kama alivyo<strong>ya</strong>tumia mbinguni, kumfan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama mwenye<br />

kuzani<strong>wa</strong> kama mkali na <strong>wa</strong> kushurutisha, Shetani akashawishi mtu k<strong>wa</strong> zambi. Akatangaza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba vizuizi visivyo na haki v<strong>ya</strong> Mungu viliongoza kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> mtu, kama<br />

vilivyoongoza k<strong>wa</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe.<br />

Katika kufukuzi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani kutoka mbinguni, Mungu alitangaza haki <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

heshima. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati mtu alipotenda zambi, Mungu alitoa ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoa M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke kufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> taifa lililoanguka. Katika upatanisho tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

imefunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Mabishanomakub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> msalaba <strong>ya</strong>naonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba zambi haiku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

hekima yo yote kulipiz<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> huduma <strong>ya</strong> kidunia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mwokozi, mdanganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong> akafunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Matukano <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> kutaka k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo<br />

amupe heshima kuu, uovu usiolala uliomuwinda pahali po pote, kuongoza mioyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

makuhani na <strong>wa</strong>tu kukataa upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke na kulalamika k<strong>wa</strong> sauti, “Asulibiwe! asulibiwe!” -<br />

-yote ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liamsha mshangao na hasira <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu. Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> zambi akatumia<br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke wote na werevu kuharibu Yesu. Shetani akatumia <strong>wa</strong>tu kama <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

kujaza maisha <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi k<strong>wa</strong> mateso na huzuni. Chuki na wivu na uovu, machukio na<br />

kisasi, vikaanguka kutoka Kalvari juu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Sasa kosa la Shetani likaonekana <strong>wa</strong>zi. Alifunua tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Mashitaki <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwongo <strong>ya</strong> Shetani juu <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>kaonekana katika nuru <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kweli.<br />

Alimshitaki Mungu juu <strong>ya</strong> kutafuta kujiinua mwenyewe katika kuomba utii k<strong>wa</strong> viumbe<br />

210


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

v<strong>ya</strong>ke na akatangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>kati Muumba alipolazimisha wote kujikana mwenyewe,<br />

Yeye mwenyewe hakutumia kujikana mwenyewe na hakutoa kafara yo yote. Sasa<br />

ilionekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu alitoa kafara kub<strong>wa</strong> sana ambayo upendo<br />

uliweza kufan<strong>ya</strong>, “maana, Mungu aliku<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, akipatanisha ulimwengu naye<br />

mwenyewe.” 2 Wakorinto 5:19. Kusudi aharibu zambi Kristo akajinyenyekea mwenyewe na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> mtiifu hata mauti.<br />

Mabishano k<strong>wa</strong> Ajiii <strong>ya</strong> Mtu<br />

Mbingu yote ikaona haki <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kufunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Lusifero alidai k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>nadamu <strong>wa</strong><br />

zambi <strong>wa</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> mbali <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi. Lakini azabu <strong>ya</strong> sheria ikaanguka juu <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu, na mtu aka<strong>wa</strong> huru kukubali haki <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> toba<br />

na kujishusha k<strong>wa</strong> kushinda nguvu za Shetani.<br />

Lakini Kristo hakuja duniani kufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kukomboa mtu tu. Alikuja kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

dunia zote k<strong>wa</strong>mba sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni sheria isiyobadilika. Mauti <strong>ya</strong> Kristo inaihakikisha<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> isiyogeuka na inaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba haki na rehema ndiyo msingi <strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu. Katika hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho itaonekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba hapana sababu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Wakati M<strong>wa</strong>mzi <strong>wa</strong> dunia yote atakapo muuliza Shetani, “Sababu gani uliasi juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ngu?” M<strong>wa</strong>nzishaji <strong>wa</strong> zambi hataweza kutoa sababu.<br />

Katika kupaza sauti k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi, “Imekwisha, “tarumbeta <strong>ya</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong> Shetani ililia.<br />

Vita kuu ikakusudi<strong>wa</strong>, kungoa k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> uovu kukahakikish<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> maana “siku<br />

inakuja, ina<strong>wa</strong>ka kama tanuru; na wenye kiburi wote, na wote <strong>wa</strong>naotumika uovu <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama makapi makavu; na siku itakayokuja ita<strong>wa</strong>teketeza, B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> majeshi anasema; hata<br />

haita<strong>wa</strong>achia, <strong>wa</strong>la shina <strong>wa</strong>la tawi.” Malaki 4:1. Uovu hautaonekana tena kamwe. Sheria<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mungu itaheshimi<strong>wa</strong> kama sheria <strong>ya</strong> uhuru. Viumbe vyote vilivyojaribi<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuhakikish<strong>wa</strong> havitageuka kamwe k<strong>wa</strong> kumtii yeye ambaye tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke imeonekana kama<br />

upendo usiopimika na hekima isiyo na mwisho.<br />

211


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 30. Uadui <strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

“Na nitatia uadui katikati <strong>ya</strong>ko na m<strong>wa</strong>namuke, na katikati <strong>ya</strong> uzao <strong>wa</strong>ko na uzao <strong>wa</strong>ke;<br />

ataponda kich<strong>wa</strong> chako, na wewe utaponda kisingino chake.” M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 3:15. Uadui huu si<br />

<strong>wa</strong> tangu a<strong>wa</strong>li. Wakati mtu alipovunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, hali <strong>ya</strong>ke ika<strong>wa</strong> mba<strong>ya</strong>, katika<br />

umoja na Shetani. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>lioanguka na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kajiunga katika urafiki <strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na matumaini. Kama Mungu hakujitia kati, Shetani na mtu <strong>wa</strong>ngaliingia katika<br />

mapatano kumpinga Mungu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, na jamaa lote la binadamu lingalijiunga katika<br />

upinzanii k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Wakati Shetani aliposikia k<strong>wa</strong>mba uadui ulipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kati <strong>ya</strong>ke na m<strong>wa</strong>namuke, na<br />

kati <strong>ya</strong> uzao <strong>wa</strong>ke na uzao <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>namuke, alijua k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> sababu yo yote mtu<br />

alipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu asiyeweza kupinga uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Kristo alitia uadui ndani <strong>ya</strong> mtu kumpinga Shetani. Pasipo neema hii <strong>ya</strong> kugeuka na<br />

nguvu inayomfan<strong>ya</strong> mp<strong>ya</strong>, mtu angaliendelea ku<strong>wa</strong> mtumishi ta<strong>ya</strong>ri daima kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Lakini kanuni mp<strong>ya</strong> katika nafsi inaleta vita; uwezo ambao Kristo anatoa<br />

unawezesha mtu kushindana na mkorofi mkuu. Kuchukia sana zambi badala <strong>ya</strong> kuipenda<br />

kunaonyesha kanuni kabisa kutoka juu.<br />

Uadui kati <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na Shetani ulionekana <strong>wa</strong>zi namna dunia ilivyompokea Yesu. Usafi<br />

na utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo uliamsha juu <strong>ya</strong>ke uchuki <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siomuogopa Mungu. Kujikana<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke kuliku<strong>wa</strong> laumu la duhakikisho k<strong>wa</strong> wenye kiburi na <strong>wa</strong>penda anasa <strong>ya</strong> mwili.<br />

Shetani na malaika <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaungana na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> kupinga <strong>ya</strong> Mshindi <strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

Uadui <strong>wa</strong> namna moja unaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Ye yote anayesimama imara<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> jaribu ataamsha hasira <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Kristo na Shetani ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kupatana. Na wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naotaka kuishi maisha <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> katika Kristo Yesu <strong>wa</strong>tapata mateso.” 2 Timoteo 3:12.<br />

Wajumbe <strong>wa</strong> Shetani <strong>wa</strong>natafuta kudangan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo na ku<strong>wa</strong>vuta k<strong>wa</strong> utii<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o. Wanapotosha Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> kutirniza kusudi lao. Roho iliyotia Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> mauti<br />

inaamsha <strong>wa</strong>ovu kuharibu <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Yote hii inaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> mbele katika ule unabii <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza: “Na nitatia uadui katikati <strong>ya</strong>ko na m<strong>wa</strong>namuke, na katikati <strong>ya</strong> uzao <strong>wa</strong>ko na uzao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke.”<br />

Sababu gani Shetani hakutani na ushindani mkub<strong>wa</strong>? K<strong>wa</strong> sababu askari za Kristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na uhusiano mdogo sana pamoja na Kristo. Zambi hai<strong>wa</strong>chukizi kama<br />

ilivyomchukiza B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o. Ha<strong>wa</strong>jitoi k<strong>wa</strong> kupigana nayo. Tabia <strong>ya</strong> mkuu <strong>wa</strong> giza<br />

ime<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> vipofu. Wengi ha<strong>wa</strong>jui k<strong>wa</strong>mba adui <strong>wa</strong>o ni mkub<strong>wa</strong> mwenye nguvu za<br />

kupigana kumpinga Kristo. Hata <strong>wa</strong>huduma <strong>wa</strong> habari njema ha<strong>wa</strong>oni ushaihidi <strong>wa</strong> kazi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke. Wanaonekana kutojali ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> hakika k<strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Adui M<strong>wa</strong>ngalifu<br />

212


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Adui huyu m<strong>wa</strong>ngalifu yuko anajiingiza katika kila jamaa, katika kila njia, katika<br />

makanisa, katika ma Baraza <strong>ya</strong> mataifa, katika manyumba <strong>ya</strong> sheria, katika baraza za<br />

hukumu, Kuleta matatizo, kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, kukosesha, po pote kuharibu nafsi na miili <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>naume na <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke, na <strong>wa</strong>toto. Anaharibu jamaa, kupanda uchuki, vita, fitina, na uuaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi. Na ulimwengu unaonekana kuzania mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni<br />

Mungu aliye<strong>ya</strong>weka na <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Wote <strong>wa</strong>siokusudia ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Shetani. Wakati Wakristo <strong>wa</strong>napochagua jamii <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siomwogopa<br />

Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>najihatarisha <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu. Shetani anajificha mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong><br />

macho na anafunika kifuniko chake cha udanganyi k<strong>wa</strong> macho <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Kufuatana na desturi za dunia anageuza kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> dunia, hageuzi kamwe dunia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kristo. Kujizoeza zambi kutaifan<strong>ya</strong> isionekane ku<strong>wa</strong> mba<strong>ya</strong> sana. Wakati katika njia <strong>ya</strong> kazi<br />

tunalet<strong>wa</strong> katika kujaribi<strong>wa</strong>, tunaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na hakika k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu atatulinda; lakini<br />

tukijiweka sisi wenyewe chini <strong>ya</strong> jaribu tutaanguka upesi ao baadaye.<br />

Mjaribu mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara anatumika k<strong>wa</strong> mafanikio zaidi katika <strong>wa</strong>le bila shaka<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siojizania ku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kipa<strong>wa</strong> na elimu ni kimtu ni za<strong>wa</strong>di za Mungu;<br />

lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati hizi zinapoongoza mbali kutoka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, zinaku<strong>wa</strong> mtego. Mara nyingi mtu<br />

mwenye elimu <strong>ya</strong> akili na <strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza ni chombo kizuri katika mikono <strong>ya</strong><br />

Shetani.<br />

Musisahau kamwe onyo la maongozi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu la kutangaza tangu karne nyingi hata<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati wetu. “Muwe na kiasi na kuangalia; mpinzanii wenu Shetani, kama simba<br />

anayenguruma anayezungukazunguka akitafuta mtu amumeze.” “Vaeni silaha zote za<br />

Mungu, mupate kuweza kusimama juu <strong>ya</strong> hila za Shetani.” 1 Petro 5:8; Waefeso 6:11. Adui<br />

wetu mkub<strong>wa</strong> anajita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> mashambulio <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho. Wote <strong>wa</strong>naomfuata Yesu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> katika vita pamoja na adui huyu. Zaidi sana Mkristo anapoiga Mfano <strong>wa</strong> Mungu,<br />

na zaidi hakuna shaka atajiweka mwenyewe alama k<strong>wa</strong> mashambulio <strong>ya</strong> Shetani.<br />

Shetani alishambulia Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu makali na hila; lakini alikomesh<strong>wa</strong> katika kila<br />

vita. Kushinda kule kote kunatuwezesha sisi kishinda. Kristo atatoa nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoitafuta. Hakuna mtu asipokubali yeye mwenyewe anaweza kushind<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani.<br />

Mjaribu hana uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la mapenzi ao kulazimisha mtu kufan<strong>ya</strong> zambi. Anaweza<br />

kutia ao kuanzisha taabu, lakini hapana uchafu. Jambo la hakika k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo alishinda<br />

linapasa kutia moyo <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu kupigana vita juu <strong>ya</strong> zambi na Shetani.<br />

213


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 31. Pepo Wachafu<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na na pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>naonyesh<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi katika Maandiko na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naingia katika historia <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>le “<strong>wa</strong>naotumikia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takaoriti wokovu” (Waebrania 1:14) <strong>wa</strong>nazani<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> wengi kama pepo za <strong>wa</strong>liokufa.<br />

Lakini Maandiko inaonyesha hakika k<strong>wa</strong>mba ha<strong>wa</strong> si pepo inayoachana na mwili <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokufa.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuumb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mtu, malaika <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiishi, k<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>kati misingi <strong>ya</strong><br />

dunia ilipowek<strong>wa</strong>, ‘’nyota za asubui <strong>wa</strong>liimba pamoja, na <strong>wa</strong>na wote <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lipiga<br />

kelele k<strong>wa</strong> furaha.” Yobu 38:7. Nyuma <strong>ya</strong> kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> mtu, malaika <strong>wa</strong>litum<strong>wa</strong> kulinda<br />

mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima mbele <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu kufa. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> cheo kuliko<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu, k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mtu aliumba “chini kidogo kupita malaika “. Zaburi 8:5.<br />

Nabii anasema, “Nikasikia sauti <strong>ya</strong> malaika wengi pande zote za kile kiti cha enzi.”<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mufalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong>nangojea-“ninyi <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke, munaofan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke,” “mukisikiliza sauti <strong>ya</strong> neno lake,” “majeshi <strong>ya</strong> malaika elfu nyingi.” Ufunuo 5:11;<br />

Zaburi 103:20,21; Waebrania 12:22. Kama <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>natoka, kama<br />

“kuonekana, k<strong>wa</strong> kumulika k<strong>wa</strong> umeme,” mruko <strong>wa</strong>o mwepesi sana. Malaika aliyetokea<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi la Mwokozi, sura <strong>ya</strong>ke “kama umeme,” ika<strong>wa</strong>letea <strong>wa</strong>linzi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hofu<br />

kutetemeka, na “<strong>wa</strong>ka<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>fu.” Wakati Saniaribu alipomtukana Mungu na<br />

kuogopesha Waisraeli, “malaika <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na alitoka, akapiga katika kambi <strong>ya</strong> Waasuria <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

elfu mia moja makumi mnane na tano.” Ezekieli 1:14; Matayo 28:3,4; 2 Wafalme 19:35.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>natum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> rehema k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> Abrahamu, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ahadi za baraka; k<strong>wa</strong> Sodomo, kuokoa Loti k<strong>wa</strong> maangamizo; k<strong>wa</strong> Elia, karibu<br />

kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong> katika jang<strong>wa</strong>; k<strong>wa</strong> Elisa, k<strong>wa</strong> magari <strong>ya</strong> farasi <strong>ya</strong> moto alipofungi<strong>wa</strong> ndani<br />

na adui zake; k<strong>wa</strong> Danieli, <strong>wa</strong>kati alipoach<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mawindo <strong>ya</strong> simba; k<strong>wa</strong> Petro,<br />

alipohukumi<strong>wa</strong> kifo katika gereza <strong>ya</strong> Herode; k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong> kule Filipi; k<strong>wa</strong> Paulo katika<br />

usiku <strong>wa</strong> zoruba juu <strong>ya</strong> bahari; k<strong>wa</strong> kufungua akili <strong>ya</strong> Kornelio k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali habari njema;<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutuma Petro pamoja na habari njema <strong>ya</strong> wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> mgeni <strong>wa</strong> Kimataifa--k<strong>wa</strong> hivi<br />

malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>litumikia <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Malaika Walinzi<br />

Malaika mlinzi amewek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kila mfuasi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. “Malaika <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na anapiga<br />

kambi kuzunguka <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naomwogopa, na ana<strong>wa</strong>okoa.” Akasema Mwokozi, juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naom<strong>wa</strong>mini: “Mbinguni malaika zao <strong>wa</strong>natazama siku zote uso <strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ngu.” Zaburi<br />

34:7; Matayo 18:10. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>lihatarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uovu usiolala <strong>wa</strong> mfalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

giza, <strong>wa</strong>naahidi<strong>wa</strong> na ulinzi usiokoma <strong>wa</strong> malaika. Matumaini <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo <strong>ya</strong>natole<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu kub<strong>wa</strong> za uovu za kukutana nazo--nguvu zisizohesabika,<br />

imara na zisizochoka.<br />

214


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu, k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong>liumb<strong>wa</strong> pasipo zambi, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> tabia,<br />

uwezo, na utukufu pamoja na viumbe vitakatifu vile vinavyoku<strong>wa</strong> sasa <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>lipoanguka katika zambi, <strong>wa</strong>nashiriki pamoja k<strong>wa</strong> kufezeresha Mungu na<br />

uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. K<strong>wa</strong> kuungana pamoja na Shetani katika uasi, <strong>wa</strong>nashirikiana katika vita<br />

kupigana na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Historia <strong>ya</strong> Agano la Kale inataja ku<strong>wa</strong>po k<strong>wa</strong>o, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati Yesu alipoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

duniani pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> ajabu sana. Kristo alikuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> mtu, na Shetani akakusudia kuta<strong>wa</strong>la ulimwengu. Akafaniki<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika kuimarisha ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu katika kila upande <strong>wa</strong> dunia isipoku<strong>wa</strong> Palestina. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

inchi ile tu ambayo haikujitoa kamili k<strong>wa</strong> mshawishi, Yesu akakuja, kunyosha mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

<strong>ya</strong> upendo, kualika wote kupata msamaha na amani k<strong>wa</strong>ke. Majeshi <strong>ya</strong> giza <strong>ya</strong>kafahamu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo inapata ushindi, mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>o ingeku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kumalizika.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>meku<strong>wa</strong> na pepo mba<strong>ya</strong> inasem<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi katika Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liotes<strong>wa</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> sababu tu <strong>ya</strong> magonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida; Kristo alifahamu ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong><br />

chanzo cha magonj<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu <strong>ya</strong> pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu. Wenye pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu kule Gadara,<br />

wenye <strong>wa</strong>zimu <strong>wa</strong> hali mba<strong>ya</strong>, kujinyonga, kujitapa, kutosha povu, kukasirika, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kijitesa <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe na kuhatarisha wote <strong>wa</strong>liopas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>karibia. Kutok<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

damu, kukabadili hali <strong>ya</strong> mwili na ma<strong>wa</strong>zo yenye kuhangaika <strong>ya</strong>lionyesha ajabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kufurahisha sana mfalme <strong>wa</strong> giza. Mumoja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>wa</strong> pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>kuta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>naotes<strong>wa</strong><br />

akatangaza, “Jina langu ni Legioni: maana: Jeshi.” Marko 5:9. Katika jeshi la Roma legioni<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuanzia <strong>wa</strong>tu elfu tatu hata elfu tano. K<strong>wa</strong> agizo la Yesu pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>katoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>natesa, ku<strong>wa</strong>acha <strong>wa</strong>napotulia, wenye akili, na <strong>wa</strong>pole. Lakini<br />

pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>karusha kundi la nguruwe katika bahari, na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> Gadara hasara<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> ikazima mibaraka Kristo aliyoitoa; mpon<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu akalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kutoka.<br />

Tazama Matayo 8:22-34. K<strong>wa</strong> kulaumu hasara <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> Yesu, Shetani akaamsha choyo<br />

cha woga k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na ku<strong>wa</strong>kataza kusikiliza maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Kristo akaruhusu pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu kuangamiza nguruwe kama laumu k<strong>wa</strong> Wayuda<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liolea <strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>ma najisi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> faida. Kama Kristo hakuzuia pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngalitumbukiza si nguruwe tu, bali <strong>wa</strong>chungaji <strong>wa</strong>o pia na wenye nguruwe ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

bahari.<br />

Tena, jambo hili liliruhusi<strong>wa</strong> ili <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>weze kushuhudia uwezo mkali <strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>wili mtu na mn<strong>ya</strong>ma, ili <strong>wa</strong>siweze kudangany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mipango <strong>ya</strong>ke. Iliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

vilevile mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lipash<strong>wa</strong> kutazama uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke kuvunja utum<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> Shetani na kufungua <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke. Inga<strong>wa</strong> Yesu Mwenyewe alitoka, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajabu sana <strong>wa</strong>kaendelea kutangaza rehema <strong>ya</strong> Mkarimu <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Mifano mingine imeandik<strong>wa</strong>: Binti <strong>wa</strong>m<strong>wa</strong>namuke <strong>wa</strong> Sirofoinike, aliyesumbuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

vikali k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani, ambaye Yesu alifukuza k<strong>wa</strong> neno lake (Marko 7:26-30); kijana<br />

aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na pepo ambayo mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara “kumtupa katika moto, na katika maji,<br />

215


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

am<strong>wa</strong>ngamize.” (Marko 9:17-27); mwenye pepo, aliyetes<strong>wa</strong> na pepo <strong>ya</strong> ibilisi mchafu<br />

aliyechafua Sabato tulivu kule Kapernaumu (Luka 4:33-36)--wote <strong>wa</strong>liponyesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mwokozi. Karibu kila mfano, Kristo akasema pepo mchafu kama kitu chenye akili,<br />

kum<strong>wa</strong>giza kutotesa mtu <strong>wa</strong>ke tena. Waabuduo kule Kapernaumu “wote <strong>wa</strong>kashangaa sana,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasemezana <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>kisema: Neno gani hili; k<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka na uwezo<br />

anaamuru pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu, nao <strong>wa</strong>natoka.” Luka 4:36.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kupata uwezo <strong>wa</strong> ajabu, wengine <strong>wa</strong>kakaribisha mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Shetani. Mambo<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong> bila shaka ha<strong>ya</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> na ugomvi pamoja na pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu. K<strong>wa</strong> kundi hili kuliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> na pepo <strong>ya</strong> uaguzi--Simon Magus, Elima mchawi yule, na kijakazi mwenye<br />

pepo aliyefuata Paulo na Sila kule Filipi. Tazama Matendo 8:9,18; 13:8; 16:16-18.<br />

Hakuna <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> katika hatari kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokana ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

na malaika zake. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>najali mashauri <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>napoona <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kifuata<br />

hekima <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe. K<strong>wa</strong> namna tunavyokaribia mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati, <strong>wa</strong>kati Shetani<br />

anapash<strong>wa</strong> kutumika k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, anaeneza mahali pote imani<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye haku<strong>wa</strong>ko. Ni kanuni <strong>ya</strong>ke kujificha mwenyewe na namna <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kutumika.<br />

Mwongo mkub<strong>wa</strong> anaogopa k<strong>wa</strong>mba tutaku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kutambua mipango <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuficha tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kweli akajifan<strong>ya</strong> mwenyewe aonyeshwe kama kitu cha kuchekelea ao<br />

cha kuzarau. Anapendez<strong>wa</strong> kufafanish<strong>wa</strong> kama mwenye kuchekesha, mwenye msiba, nusu<br />

mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na nusu m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu. Anapendez<strong>wa</strong> kusikia jina lake linapotumi<strong>wa</strong> katika mchezo<br />

na kicheko. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu amejificha mwenyewe na akili kamili, s<strong>wa</strong>li linauliz<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

popote: “Je, kiumbe cha namna hii kinaku<strong>wa</strong>ko kweli?” Ni k<strong>wa</strong> sababu Shetani anaweza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> upesi kuta<strong>wa</strong>la ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> bila kufahamu mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>mba Neno<br />

la Mungu linafungua mbele yetu nguvu za siri <strong>ya</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> hivi kutuweka k<strong>wa</strong> angalisho.<br />

Tunaweza kupata kimbilio na wokovu katika uwezo mukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mkombozi wetu.<br />

Tunachunga vizuri sana nyumba zetu k<strong>wa</strong> mapingo na kufuli kulinda mali yetu na maisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ovu, lakini ni marahaba kufikiri juu <strong>ya</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong>ovu kushindana na<br />

mashambulio <strong>ya</strong>ke tunayoku<strong>wa</strong> nayo, katika nguvu zetu wenyewe, hakuna ulinzi. Kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kiruhusi<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>naweza kuvuta mioyo yetu, kutesa miili yetu, kuharibu mali yetu na<br />

maisha yetu. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naomfuata Kristo <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> salama chini <strong>ya</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>naopita katika nguvu <strong>wa</strong>natum<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>linda. Waovu ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kuvunja ulinzi<br />

aliyoweka Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Sura 32. Namna <strong>ya</strong> Kumshinda Shetani<br />

Vita kuu kati <strong>ya</strong> Kristo na Shetani ni karibu kuisha, na mwovu huyo anazidisha mara<br />

mbili juhudi zake k<strong>wa</strong> kuvunja kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mtu. K<strong>wa</strong> kushikilia <strong>wa</strong>tu katika<br />

giza na ugumu <strong>wa</strong> moyo hata upatanishi <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi umalizika ndiyo shabaha anayoitafuta<br />

kutimiza. Wakati ubaridi unapoku<strong>wa</strong> mwingi ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa, Shetani hajali. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

216


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

roho zinapochunguza, “Nifanye nini nipate kuokole<strong>wa</strong>?” anaku<strong>wa</strong> pale kupiganisha uwezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke kupinga Kristo pia na kupinga mvuto <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati moja <strong>wa</strong>kati malaika <strong>wa</strong>lipokuja kujionyesha <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, Shetani akakuja vilevile miongoni m<strong>wa</strong>o, si k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuinama mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mfalme<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Milele, lakini kuharakisha makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke maovu <strong>ya</strong> kushindana na wenye haki.<br />

Utazame Yobu 1:6. Yeye anahuzuria <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napoabudu, kutumika k<strong>wa</strong> juhudi<br />

kuta<strong>wa</strong>la ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>naoabudu. K<strong>wa</strong> namna anavyoona mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kutafuta<br />

Maandiko, anaandika yote juu <strong>ya</strong> fundisho litakalofundish<strong>wa</strong>. Ndipo anatumia werevu <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

na akili ili habari isiweze kufikia <strong>wa</strong>le ambao ana<strong>wa</strong>dangan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> jambo halisi lile. Yule<br />

anayehitaji onyo zaidi atashurutish<strong>wa</strong> katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> jambo fulani ao k<strong>wa</strong> njia ingine atapata<br />

kizuizi k<strong>wa</strong> kusikia neno.<br />

Shetani anaona <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kileme<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> giza inayofunika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu. Anasikia maombi <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kuvunja mvuto <strong>wa</strong><br />

ubaridi na uvivu. Halafu k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu mp<strong>ya</strong> anajaribu <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong> tamaa ao<br />

kujifurahisha, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo anaua akili zao ili <strong>wa</strong>shindwe kusikia mambo kabisa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nayohitaji zaidi kujifunza.<br />

Shetani anajua k<strong>wa</strong>mba wote <strong>wa</strong>naozarau maombi na Maandiko <strong>wa</strong>tashind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mashambulio <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo anavumbua kila kitu cha kuvuta moyo. Wasaidizi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong><br />

mkono <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na juhudi siku zote <strong>wa</strong>kati Mungu anaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kazi.<br />

Wataonyesha <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong> Kristo wenye kujikana kama <strong>wa</strong>naodangany<strong>wa</strong> ao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naodangan<strong>ya</strong>. Ni kazi <strong>ya</strong>o kusingizia makusudi <strong>ya</strong> kila tendo bora, kueneza mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuchongea, na kuamsha mashaka katika mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jinga. Lakini inaweza kuonekana upesi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> nani, ambao mfano ni <strong>wa</strong> nani <strong>wa</strong>naoufuata, na <strong>wa</strong>nafan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

nani. “Muta<strong>wa</strong>tambua k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> matunda <strong>ya</strong>o.” Matayo 7:16; utazame vilevile Ufunuo<br />

12:10.<br />

Kweli Inatakasa<br />

Mdanganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong> anaku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zushi wengi <strong>wa</strong>liofany<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kupendeza onjo<br />

mbalimbali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao angeharibu. Ni mpango <strong>wa</strong>ke kuleta ndani <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siofaa, <strong>wa</strong>siogeuza <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaoshawishi mashaka na kutoamini. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

imani kamili katika Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nakubali kanuni zingine za kweli na <strong>wa</strong>najifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Wakristo, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivi <strong>wa</strong>nawezesh<strong>wa</strong> kuingiza kosa kama mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> maandiko.<br />

Shetani anajua k<strong>wa</strong>mba kweli, iliyokubali<strong>wa</strong> katika upendo, inatakasa nafsi. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo<br />

anatafuta kubadilisha maelezo <strong>ya</strong> uwongo, mifano, injili ingine. Tangu m<strong>wa</strong>nzo, <strong>wa</strong>tumishi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>mebishana juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> uwongo, si kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> tu, bali kama<br />

wenye kufundisha uwongo <strong>wa</strong> kufisha k<strong>wa</strong> nafsi. Elia, Yeremia, Paulo, k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipinga <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kigeuza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu. Ule uhuru ambao<br />

unaangaliarau imani kamili hafifu haikupata nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tetezi <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong> kweli.<br />

217


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Maelezo <strong>ya</strong>siyofahamika vizuri na <strong>ya</strong> kuji<strong>wa</strong>zia tu juu <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko na maelezo yenye<br />

kupingana katika ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> ni kazi <strong>ya</strong> adui wetu mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchafua akili. Ugomvi na fitina miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> makanisa vinatokana mara nyingi na<br />

kupinganisha Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> kuunga mkono maelezo <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kusimamia mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo, wengine <strong>wa</strong>nashikilia juu <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

Maandiko <strong>wa</strong>nayotenga kando k<strong>wa</strong> maneno mengine, kutumia maneno nusu <strong>ya</strong> fungu kama<br />

kuhakikisha msimamo <strong>wa</strong>o, huku sehemu iliyobaki inapoonyesha maana ku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume<br />

kabisa. K<strong>wa</strong> werevu <strong>wa</strong> nyoka <strong>wa</strong>najiingiza wenyewe nyuma <strong>ya</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong> kuteng<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyofasiri<strong>wa</strong> kufurahisha tamaa za mwili. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>nashikilia juu <strong>ya</strong> sura na mifano,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>na<strong>ya</strong>tafsiri k<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o, pamoja na heshima kidogo k<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong><br />

Maandiko kama mfasiri <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe, halafu kuonyesha mambo <strong>ya</strong> upumbavu <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

kama mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia.<br />

Biblia Yote ni Kiongozi<br />

Wakati ambapo kujifunza k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko kunapoauz<strong>wa</strong> pasipo roho <strong>ya</strong> maombi na<br />

inayoweza kufundish<strong>wa</strong>, mafungu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi<strong>wa</strong>zi kabisa <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupotea maana <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli. Biblia yote inapash<strong>wa</strong> kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kama vile inavyosom<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Mungu alitoa neno la haki la unabii; malaika na hata Yesu Mwenyewe alikuja kujulisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Danieli na Yoane vitu ambavyo “vilivyopash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> upesi.” Ufunuo 1:1. Mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

maana inayohusu wokovu wetu ha<strong>ya</strong>kufunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> kutatiza na kuongoza viba<strong>ya</strong><br />

mtafutaji m<strong>wa</strong>minifu <strong>wa</strong> kweli. Neno la Mungu ni <strong>wa</strong>zi k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naojifunza sana k<strong>wa</strong><br />

moyo wenye kuomba.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kilio, Ukarimu, <strong>wa</strong>tu ni vipofu k<strong>wa</strong> mashauri mpinzani. Anafaulu kuondosha Biblia<br />

na kutumia ma<strong>wa</strong>zo mengi <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu; sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inawek<strong>wa</strong> pembeni; na<br />

makanisa <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> utum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>napojitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> huru.<br />

Mungu ameruhusu garika <strong>ya</strong> nuru kumimin<strong>wa</strong> ulimwenguni k<strong>wa</strong> mvumbuzi <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> vyumbe vyo (science). Lakini hata <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> elimu zaidi, kama ha<strong>wa</strong>ongozwi<br />

na Neno la Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>napotea katika kujaribu kuchunguza mahusiano <strong>ya</strong> maarifa (science)<br />

na ufunuo.<br />

Maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu ni <strong>ya</strong> kipande na si kamili; k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo wengi ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi<br />

kupatanisha maoni <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> maarifa (science) pamoja na Maandiko. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>nakubali tu<br />

maelezo kama mambo <strong>ya</strong> ujuzi, na <strong>wa</strong>nafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba Neno la Mungu ni la kujaribi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

“elimu inayoit<strong>wa</strong> elimu k<strong>wa</strong> uwongo.” 1 Timoteo 6:20. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kueleza<br />

Muumba na kazi zake katika sheria za asili, historia <strong>ya</strong> Biblia inazani<strong>wa</strong> kama isioweza<br />

kutumaini<strong>wa</strong>u. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka juu <strong>ya</strong> Agano la Kale na Agano Jip<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mara nyingi <strong>wa</strong>nakwenda hatua mbali zaidi na kutosadiki ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Walipoachilia nanga <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>nagonga juu <strong>ya</strong> miamba <strong>ya</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

218


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ni kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> uongo <strong>wa</strong> Shetani kudumisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kubahatisha k<strong>wa</strong> mambo ambayo<br />

Mungu haku<strong>ya</strong>ulisha. Lusifero aka<strong>wa</strong> bila kurizika k<strong>wa</strong> sababu siri zote za makusudi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu hazikufunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke, na akakataa maneno <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>liyofunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Sasa anatafuta<br />

kujaza <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> namna ileile na ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza pia kutojali amri <strong>wa</strong>zi za Mungu.<br />

Wapungufu <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kiroho <strong>ya</strong>nayotole<strong>wa</strong> na moyo <strong>wa</strong> kujikana, k<strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

vinavyoelez<strong>wa</strong>, kukubali<strong>wa</strong> na kupokele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bidii kub<strong>wa</strong>. Shetani anaku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kutoa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong> moyo, na anapokeza hila za udanganyifu badala pa Kweli. Iliku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

namna hii ambayo dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma (papa) ilipata mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu. Na katika<br />

kukataa kweli k<strong>wa</strong> sababu inahusikana na msalaba, Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>nafuata njia ile ile.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>naojifunza manufaa na mashauri, ili <strong>wa</strong>siweze ku<strong>wa</strong> na tofauti na ulimwengu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taach<strong>wa</strong> kupata “uharibifu usiokawia” <strong>wa</strong>kizania ni kweli. 2 Petro 2:1. Yeye<br />

anayetazama k<strong>wa</strong> kuchukia udanganyifu moja atapokea mara hiyo mwingine. “Na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> Mungu ana<strong>wa</strong>letea nguvu <strong>ya</strong> upotevu, hata <strong>wa</strong>amini uwongo: ili <strong>wa</strong>hukumiwe<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>sioamini kweli, lakini <strong>wa</strong>lifurahi katika uzalimu.” 2 Watesalonika 2:11,12.<br />

Makosa <strong>ya</strong> Hatari<br />

Miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> ushindi zaidi v<strong>ya</strong> mdanganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong> ni maajabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwongo <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme). K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>navyokataa<br />

kweli <strong>wa</strong>natek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> udanganyifu.<br />

Kosa lingine ni mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>nayokana Umungu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, kudai k<strong>wa</strong>mba haku<strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu huu.<br />

Maelezo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>nakausha maneno <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi wetu juu <strong>ya</strong> uhusiano <strong>wa</strong>ke na Baba na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke siku zote za mbele. Yanaharibu imani katika Biblia kama ufunuo kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nakana ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko juu <strong>ya</strong> Umungu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, ni<br />

bure kubishana nao; hakuna mabishano, hakuna neno hata <strong>wa</strong>zi la kuweza, ku<strong>wa</strong>sadikisha;<br />

Hakuna anayeshikilia kosa hili anayeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo la kweli la Kristo <strong>wa</strong>la la mpango<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> mtu.<br />

Tena kosa lingine ni imani k<strong>wa</strong>mba Shetani haishi kama kiumbe chenye nafsi, k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

jina linalotumi<strong>wa</strong> katika Maandiko ni kufananisha tu ma<strong>wa</strong>zo maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na tamaa.<br />

Mafundisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> pili k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo ni kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kila mtu <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mauti ni uongo k<strong>wa</strong> kupotosha akili kusahau k<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe katika<br />

mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu. Shetani basi ameku<strong>wa</strong> akisema, ‘’Tazama, yeye ni katika vyumba v<strong>ya</strong><br />

ndani” (Tazama Matayo 24:23-26), na wengi <strong>wa</strong>mepotea katika kukubali udanganyifu huu.<br />

Tena <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> maarifa <strong>wa</strong>nadai k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna jibu la kweli linaweza ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuomba; hii ingeku<strong>wa</strong> uvunjaji <strong>wa</strong> sheria-mwujiza, na miujiza haiwezi ku<strong>wa</strong>ko.<br />

Ulimwengu, <strong>wa</strong>nasema, unata<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong> katika sheria zisizobabilika, na Mungu Mwenyewe<br />

hafanye kitu kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> sheria hizi. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi <strong>wa</strong>nafananinisha Mungu kama<br />

219


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

amelazimish<strong>wa</strong> katika sheria zake mwenyewe--kana k<strong>wa</strong>mba sheria za Mungu zingekataza<br />

uhuru <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Fundisho la namna hii linapinga ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> maandiko.<br />

Je, miujiza haikufany<strong>wa</strong> na Kristo na mitume <strong>wa</strong>ke? Mwokozi yule yule anapendez<strong>wa</strong><br />

basi kusikiliza maombi <strong>ya</strong> imani kama vile alivyotembea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Hali <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vinashirikiana na hali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ni sehemu <strong>ya</strong> mpango <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

kutusaidia, katika jibu k<strong>wa</strong> ombi la imani, lile ambalo hangalitoa tusilouliza.<br />

Mipaka <strong>ya</strong> Neno<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong>naondoa mipaka iliyowek<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Neno la Mungu. Wachache <strong>wa</strong>nasimamia k<strong>wa</strong> kukataa kweli moja tu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naweka<br />

kando moja<strong>wa</strong>po k<strong>wa</strong> ingine <strong>ya</strong> kanuni za kweli, hata <strong>wa</strong>napoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>sioamini.<br />

Makosa <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na sifa za Mungu na dini <strong>ya</strong> kupendez<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liendesha roho nyingi k<strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong> mashaka (sceptisim). Haiwezekani k<strong>wa</strong>o kukubali<br />

mafundisho ambayo <strong>ya</strong>nayopinga maelezo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu juu <strong>ya</strong> haki, rehema na wema. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi<br />

mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naonyesh<strong>wa</strong> kama mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, anakataa ku<strong>ya</strong>kubali kama Neno la<br />

Mungu.<br />

Neno la Mungu linaangali<strong>wa</strong> bila tumaini k<strong>wa</strong> sababu linakemea na kuhukumu zambi.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>siotaka kutii <strong>wa</strong>nafan<strong>ya</strong> nguvu kupindua mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>nakufuru ili<br />

kutetea uzarau <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o. Wengine pia, ni <strong>wa</strong>penda raha k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza kitu cho chote<br />

ambacho kinaomba kujikana mwenyewe, <strong>wa</strong>natunza sifa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hekima kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuteta Biblia.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naona kama sifa kusimama upande <strong>wa</strong> kutoamini, mashaka, na kukufuru.<br />

Lakini chini <strong>ya</strong> mfano mwema kutapatikana kujitumaini mwenyewe na kiburi. Wengi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napendez<strong>wa</strong> katika kupata kujua kitu fulani katika Maandiko kutatiza roho za wengine.<br />

Wengine k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> upande usiofaa k<strong>wa</strong> upendo tu <strong>wa</strong> mabishano. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kisha kuonyesha <strong>wa</strong>zi kutoamini, <strong>wa</strong>najiunga pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>siomwongopa Mungu.<br />

Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Kufaa<br />

Mungu ametoa katika Neno lake ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> kutosha <strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini<br />

akili zenye mpaka zinaku<strong>wa</strong> si zakutosha kabisa kufahamu makusudi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Hukumu<br />

zake hazivumbulikani, na njia zake hazifutikani!” Waroma 11:33. Tunaweza kutambua<br />

upendo usio na mpaka na rehema iliyoungana na uwezo usio na mwisho. Baba yetu aliye<br />

mbinguni atafunua kwetu k<strong>wa</strong> namna inavyotosha k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uzuri wetu kujua; zaidi <strong>ya</strong><br />

pale tunapash<strong>wa</strong> kutumainia Mkono ule unaoku<strong>wa</strong> ni Mwenye mamlaka yote, Moyo<br />

unaojaa upendo.<br />

Mungu hataondoa kamwe sababu zote za kutoamini. Wote <strong>wa</strong>naotafuta sababu za<br />

kuwekea mashaka <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>tazipata. Na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokataa kutii hata kila kizuizi kinapokwisha<br />

kuondole<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>takuja k<strong>wa</strong> nuru kamwe. Moyo usiofany<strong>wa</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> unaku<strong>wa</strong> katika uadui na<br />

220


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mungu. Lakini imani inati<strong>wa</strong> moyo k<strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu na itasitawi kama inavyolind<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hakuna mtu anaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu katika imani pasipo nguvu imara. Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kijiruhusu wenyewe kubishana, mashaka <strong>ya</strong>tapata msingi zaidi.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka na kutotumaini hakikisho (assurance) la neema<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>napatisha ha<strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> miti isiyozaa inayozuia nuru <strong>ya</strong> jua k<strong>wa</strong> mimea<br />

mingine, kuiletea kufifia na kufa chini <strong>ya</strong> baridi <strong>ya</strong> kivuli. Kazi <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

itatokea kama ushuhuda usiokoma juu <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Kunaku<strong>wa</strong> lakini sababu moja tu <strong>ya</strong> kufuata k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>natamani<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> huru k<strong>wa</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na mashaka. Badala <strong>ya</strong> kuuliza <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>siyofahamu, <strong>wa</strong>achwe<br />

<strong>wa</strong>toe ukubali k<strong>wa</strong> nuru ambayo imekwisha kuangaza juu <strong>ya</strong>o, na <strong>wa</strong>tapata nuru kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

zaidi.<br />

Shetani anaweza kuonyesha mfano karibu sana kufanana na kweli ule unaodangan<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotaka kudanganyi<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>naotamani kuepuka kafara iliyohitaji<strong>wa</strong> katika kweli.<br />

Lakini ni kitu kisichowezekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke kushika chini <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke nafsi moja inayotaka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu, k<strong>wa</strong> bei yo yote, kujua ukweli. Kristo ndiye kweli, “Nuru <strong>ya</strong> kweli inayotia<br />

nuru kila mtu anayekuja katika ulimwengu.” “Kila mtu akipenda kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke,<br />

atajua habari za <strong>ya</strong>le mafundisho.” Yoane 1:9; 7:17.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na anaruhusu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kupata k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu makali <strong>ya</strong> kutesa, si k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

anapendez<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>la kufurahish<strong>wa</strong> katika taabu <strong>ya</strong>o, bali k<strong>wa</strong> sababu jambo hili ni la lazima<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ushindi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong> mwisho. Hakuweza, k<strong>wa</strong> uthabiti k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke mwenyewe,<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>linda kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> jaribu, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu kusudi la jaribu ni ku<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>ya</strong>risha kupinga mivuto<br />

yote <strong>ya</strong> uovu. Hata <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>la mashetani ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kufunga ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kama <strong>wa</strong>taungama na kuacha zambi zao na kudai ahadi zake. Kila jaribu, la <strong>wa</strong>zi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la la siri, linaweza kuping<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kufaniki<strong>wa</strong>. “Si k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo, <strong>wa</strong>la si k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu, lakini<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong>ngu, B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> majeshi anasema.” Zekaria 4:6.<br />

“Naye ni nani atakaye<strong>wa</strong>umiza ninyi, kama ninyi mki<strong>wa</strong> wenye bidii katika maneno <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyo mema?” 1 Petro 3:13. Shetani anafahamu vizuri k<strong>wa</strong>mba roho inayoku<strong>wa</strong> zaifu zaidi<br />

inayokaa ndani <strong>ya</strong> Kristo inaku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu zaidi kuliko mshindani k<strong>wa</strong> majeshi <strong>ya</strong> giza.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hiyo anatafuta kufukuzia mbali <strong>wa</strong>askari <strong>wa</strong> msalaba kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> boma lao<br />

lenye nguvu, huku anapolala akijificha, ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kuangamiza wote <strong>wa</strong>naosubutu k<strong>wa</strong> udongo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Ila tu katika kutegemea Mungu na utii k<strong>wa</strong> amri zake tunaweza kulind<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Hakuna mtu anayeku<strong>wa</strong> salama k<strong>wa</strong> siku moja ao saa moja pasipo kuomba. Omba<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> hekima k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu Neno lake. Shetani ni mbing<strong>wa</strong> katika kutumia<br />

Maandiko, kuweka mafasirio <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> mafungu ambayo anatumaini kutuletea<br />

kik<strong>wa</strong>zo. Inatupasa kujifunza k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong> moyo. Huku tunapopash<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mara kujilinda juu <strong>ya</strong> mashauri <strong>ya</strong> Shetani, inatupasa kuomba k<strong>wa</strong> imani siku zote; “Na<br />

usitulete katika majaribu.” Matayo 6:13.<br />

221


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

222


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 33. Kinacholala Ng’ambo <strong>ya</strong> Pili <strong>ya</strong> Kaburi<br />

Shetani aliyechochea uasi huko mbinguni, alitaka kushawishi <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia<br />

kuungana katika vita <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kumpinga Mungu. Adamu na Ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na furaha<br />

kamili katika utii k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu--ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> daima <strong>wa</strong> kupinga madai <strong>ya</strong> Shetani<br />

ulioweka mbele katika mbingu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> taabu. Shetani<br />

akakusudia kuanzisha maanguko <strong>ya</strong>o, ili aweze kumiliki dunia na hapa kuimarisha ufalme<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kupingana na Aliye Juu.<br />

Adamu na Ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiony<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> adui <strong>wa</strong> hatari huyu, lakini aliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

akitumika katika giza, kuficha kusudi lake. Kutumia nyoka kama chombo chake, ndipo<br />

kiumbe cha mfano <strong>wa</strong> kupendeza, akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia Ha<strong>wa</strong>: “Ndiyo, Mungu amesema: Msile <strong>ya</strong><br />

miti yote <strong>ya</strong> shamba?” Ha<strong>wa</strong> akajihatarisha (akasubutu) kusemana naye na akaanguka<br />

mateka k<strong>wa</strong> uongo <strong>wa</strong>ke: “M<strong>wa</strong>namuke akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia nyoka: Matunda <strong>ya</strong> miti <strong>ya</strong> shamba<br />

tunaweza kula; lakini matunda <strong>ya</strong> mti ulio katikati <strong>ya</strong> shamba Mungu amesema: Musile<br />

matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>la musi<strong>ya</strong>guse, musife. Na nyoka akam<strong>wa</strong>mbia m<strong>wa</strong>namuke; Hakika<br />

hamutakufa, k<strong>wa</strong>ni Mungu anajua <strong>ya</strong> kama siku mutakapokula matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke, macho yenu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>tafunguli<strong>wa</strong>, na mutaku<strong>wa</strong> kama miungu, mukijua uzuri na uba<strong>ya</strong>.” M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 3:1-5.<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong> akakubali, na k<strong>wa</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke (m<strong>wa</strong>namuke) Adamu akaongoz<strong>wa</strong> katika zambi.<br />

Wakakubali maneno <strong>ya</strong> nyoka; <strong>wa</strong>kaonyesha kutotumaini Muumba <strong>wa</strong>o na ku<strong>wa</strong>za <strong>ya</strong> kama<br />

aliku<strong>wa</strong> akizuia uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Lakini ni kitu gani Adamu alichopata kujua ku<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong> maneno, “K<strong>wa</strong> maana siku<br />

utakapokula, hakika utakufa”? Je, alipas<strong>wa</strong> kuongoz<strong>wa</strong> katika maisha <strong>ya</strong> kujiinua zaidi?<br />

Adamu hakuona jambo hili ku<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mungu alitangaza ile kama<br />

azabu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke, mtu alipash<strong>wa</strong> kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> mavumbi: “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu mavumbi<br />

wewe, na utarudi k<strong>wa</strong> mavumbi.” M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 3:19. Maneno <strong>ya</strong> Shetani, “Macho yenu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>tafunguli<strong>wa</strong>,” <strong>ya</strong>lionekana ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli katika maana hii tu: macho <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kafunguli<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutambua ujinga <strong>wa</strong>o. Wakajua uba<strong>ya</strong> na kuonja tunda la uchungu <strong>wa</strong> uasi.<br />

Mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima uliku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kudumisha uzima. Adamu angeendelea kufurahia<br />

ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> kukaribia mti huu na kuishi milele, lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati alipofan<strong>ya</strong> zambi<br />

akazui<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima na akastahili kifo. Kufa ikaondoa kutokufa. Pale<br />

hapangaliku<strong>wa</strong> na tumaini k<strong>wa</strong> uzao ulioanguka kama Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> kafara <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

hangeleta kutokufa karibu nao. Na hivi ‘’kufa kulikuja juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>mefan<strong>ya</strong> zambi,” Kristo “ameleta uzima na maisha <strong>ya</strong>siyokoma nuru ni k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Habari Njema.” Katika Kristo tu kutokufa kunaweza kupatikana. “Anayeamini M<strong>wa</strong>na ana<br />

uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele; na asiyem<strong>wa</strong>mini M<strong>wa</strong>na hataona uzima.” Waroma 5:12; 2 Timoteo 1:10;<br />

Yoane 3:36.<br />

Uwongo Mkub<strong>wa</strong><br />

223


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Yule aliyeahidi uzima katika uasi aliku<strong>wa</strong> mdanganyi mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Na tangazo la nyoka<br />

katika Edeni--“Hakika hamutakufa”--liliku<strong>wa</strong> hubiri la k<strong>wa</strong>nza lililohubiri<strong>wa</strong> daima juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutokufa k<strong>wa</strong> roho (nafsi). Lakini tangazo hili, la kubaki tu k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Shetani,<br />

linakariri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mimbara na kukubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi k<strong>wa</strong> upesi kama mbele k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>zazi wetu <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, “Nafsi inayofan<strong>ya</strong> zambi itakufa” (Ezekieli<br />

18:20) inafany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kutaka kuonyesha, Nafsi inayofan<strong>ya</strong> zambi, haitakufa, lakini itaishi<br />

milele na milele. Kama mtu angalipe<strong>wa</strong> ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> uhuru <strong>ya</strong> kukaribia mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima, baada<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong>ke, zambi zingalifany<strong>wa</strong> kukaa milele. Lakini hakuna hata mtu mmoja <strong>wa</strong><br />

jamaa <strong>ya</strong> Adamu aliyeruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuonja (kut<strong>wa</strong>a) tunda linalotoa uzima. K<strong>wa</strong> hiyo hapo<br />

hakuna mwenye zambi <strong>wa</strong> kuishi milele.<br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> Kuanguka, Shetani akaalika malaika zake kufundisha imani katika kutokufa <strong>ya</strong><br />

milele k<strong>wa</strong> asili <strong>ya</strong> mtu. Akiisha kuingiza <strong>wa</strong>tu kukubali kosa hili, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ni ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza<br />

kuzania kama mwenye zambi angeishi katika mateso <strong>ya</strong> milele. Sasa mfalme <strong>wa</strong> giza<br />

anamuonyesha Mungu ku<strong>wa</strong> sultani mkali mwenye kutaka kisasi, kutangaza <strong>ya</strong> kama<br />

anatumbukiza katika jehanum wote <strong>wa</strong>siompendeza, <strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napojinyonga<br />

katika ndimi za moto <strong>wa</strong> milele, Muumba <strong>wa</strong>o ana<strong>wa</strong>tazama chini na kurizika. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi<br />

ibilisi mukub<strong>wa</strong> anavika Mtenda mema k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu tabia zake. Ukali ni tabia <strong>ya</strong><br />

Shetani. Mungu ni mapendo. Shetani ni adui anayejaribu mtu afanye zambi na baadaye<br />

akam<strong>wa</strong>ngamiza kama awezavyo. Ni mambo <strong>ya</strong> kuchukiza upendo, rehema, na haki,<br />

mafundisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>nateseka katika jehanum inayo<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>ya</strong> milele,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> zambi za maisha mafupi <strong>ya</strong> kidunia <strong>wa</strong>nateseka malipizi makali katika maisha<br />

yote <strong>ya</strong> Mungu!<br />

Ni mahali gani katika Neno la Mungu mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> namna ile inapatikana? Je, ma<strong>wa</strong>zo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> wema <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>ya</strong>geuzwe k<strong>wa</strong> ukali <strong>wa</strong>ushenzi? Hapana, <strong>ya</strong>le si mafundisho <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kitabu cha Mungu. “Ninavyoishi, B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu anasema, sina furaha k<strong>wa</strong> kufa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwovu; lakini mwovu aache njia <strong>ya</strong>ke apate kuishi; geukeni, geukeni mukaache njia yenu<br />

mba<strong>ya</strong>; k<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong> sababu gani munataka kufa?” Ezekieli 33:11.<br />

Je, Mungu anapendez<strong>wa</strong> katika kushuhudia mateso <strong>ya</strong>siyomalizika? Je, Yeye<br />

anapendez<strong>wa</strong> na maumivu <strong>wa</strong>la mazomeo na kilio cha nguvu cha viumbe vinavyoteseka<br />

anavyoshikilia katika ndimi za moto? Je, sauti hizi za kuchukiza ziwe sauti za nyimbo<br />

katika sikio la yule ambaye ana Upendo Pasipo Mwisho (Mungu)? Loo, matukano gani <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutiisha! Utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu hauongezwe k<strong>wa</strong> kudumisha zambi kupitiamilele na milele.<br />

Ujushi <strong>wa</strong> Maumivu Maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Milele<br />

Uovu ulifanyika k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> ujushi <strong>wa</strong> maumivu maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> milele. Dini <strong>ya</strong> Biblia,<br />

inajaa na upendo na wema, inati<strong>wa</strong> giza k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi na inavik<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

hofu kub<strong>wa</strong>. Shetani amepakaa rangi tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> rangi za uwongo. Muumba wetu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> rehema anaogop<strong>wa</strong>, na kuhofi<strong>wa</strong>, hata kuchuki<strong>wa</strong>. Maoni <strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ambayo<br />

224


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>meenea po pote ulimwenguni kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mimbara <strong>ya</strong>mefan<strong>ya</strong> mamilioni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye mashaka na <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu.<br />

Maumivu maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> milele ni moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo, mvinyo <strong>wa</strong> gazabu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke (Ufunuo 14:8; 17:21), ambayo Babeli inafan<strong>ya</strong> wote kuny<strong>wa</strong>. Wahuduma <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipokea ujushi huu k<strong>wa</strong> Roma kama <strong>wa</strong>livyokubali sabato <strong>ya</strong> uwongo. Kama tukiacha<br />

Neno la Mungu na kukubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uwongo k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>baba zetu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>ya</strong>fundisha, tunaanguka chini <strong>ya</strong> hukumu iliyotangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Babeli; tunakuny<strong>wa</strong><br />

mvinyo <strong>wa</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Kundi kub<strong>wa</strong> linaongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kosa la upande mwingine. Wanaona Maandiko<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nayoonyesha Mungu kama mwenye upendo na huruma na ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kuamini k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

atatupa viumbe k<strong>wa</strong> jehanum inayo<strong>wa</strong>ka milele. Kushikilia k<strong>wa</strong>mba nafsi k<strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida ni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> milele, <strong>wa</strong>kaishia k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>taokole<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo mwenye zambi anaweza<br />

kuishi katika anasa <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza nafsi, kutojali matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, na kukubali<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

Mungu. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo, <strong>ya</strong>nategemea k<strong>wa</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu lakini bila kujali<br />

haki <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>ya</strong>nafurahisha moyo <strong>wa</strong> tamaa za mwili.<br />

Wokovu <strong>wa</strong> Watu Wote Si Fundisho la Biblia<br />

Wanaoamini katika wokovu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>nageuza Maandiko. Mhubiri anayejulikana<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Kristo anakariri uwongo ulioenez<strong>wa</strong> na nyoka katika Edeni, “Hakika hamutakufa.”<br />

“Siku mutakayokula matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke, macho yenu <strong>ya</strong>tafunguli<strong>wa</strong>, na mutaku<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

miungu. ” Anatangaza <strong>ya</strong> kama mwovu zaidi katika wenye zambi--muuaji, mwizi, mzinzi--<br />

baada <strong>ya</strong> kifo ataingia katika hali <strong>ya</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong> milele. Hadizi za kweli za kupendeza,<br />

zinazofaa k<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza moyo <strong>wa</strong> tamaa za mwili!<br />

Kama ingeku<strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>ngepita mara moja mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> saa <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>ya</strong> mauti, tungeweza vema kutamani mauti kuliko uzima. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>meongoz<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika imani hii kumaliza <strong>wa</strong>la kukomesha maisha <strong>ya</strong>o. Kulemez<strong>wa</strong> na hatari na uchungu,<br />

inaonekana rahisi kuvunja mwendo <strong>wa</strong> maisha na kupanda upesi katika hali <strong>ya</strong> raha <strong>ya</strong><br />

makao <strong>ya</strong> milele.<br />

Mungu ametoa katika Neno lake ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> kama ataazibu <strong>wa</strong>vunjaji <strong>wa</strong> sheria<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke. Je, yeye anaku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye rehema vilevile hata asitimize haki juu <strong>ya</strong> mwenye zambi?<br />

Tazama k<strong>wa</strong> msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kalvari. Mauti <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu inashuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

“mushahara <strong>wa</strong> zambi ni mauti” (Waroma 6:23), k<strong>wa</strong>mba kila uvunjaji <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

unapash<strong>wa</strong> kupata malipizi. Kristo asiyeku<strong>wa</strong> na zambi aka<strong>wa</strong> mwenye zambi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong><br />

mtu. Akavumulia hatia za zambi na maficho <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke hata moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

ukapasuka na maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong>--yote ha<strong>ya</strong> ili wenye zambi <strong>wa</strong>weze<br />

kukombole<strong>wa</strong>. Na kila nafsi ambayo inakataa kushirikiana na upatanisho uliotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bei<br />

<strong>ya</strong> namna ile anapas<strong>wa</strong> kuchukua k<strong>wa</strong> nafsi <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe hatia na azabu <strong>ya</strong> zambi.<br />

Masharti Yameelez<strong>wa</strong><br />

225


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Mimi nitamupa yeye mwenye kiu, <strong>ya</strong> chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> maji <strong>ya</strong> uzima, bure.” Ahadi hii ni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le tu <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na kiu. “Yeye anayeshinda atariti maneno ha<strong>ya</strong>, nami nitaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ke, naye ataku<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Ufunuo 21:6,7. Mashairi <strong>ya</strong>meelez<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuriti vitu vyote, inatupasa kushinda zambi.<br />

“Lakini haitaku<strong>wa</strong> heri k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwovu.” Muhubiri 8:13. Mwenye zambi anajiwekea<br />

mwenyewe “hasira k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> hasira na ufunuo <strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, atakayelipa<br />

kila mutu k<strong>wa</strong> kadiri <strong>ya</strong> matendo <strong>ya</strong>ke;” “mateso na taabu juu <strong>ya</strong> kila nafsi <strong>ya</strong> mutu<br />

anayefan<strong>ya</strong> uovu.” Waroma 2:5,6,9.<br />

“Hakuna m<strong>wa</strong>sherati <strong>wa</strong>la mutu muchafu <strong>wa</strong>la mwenye tamaa, ndiye m<strong>wa</strong>budu sanamu,<br />

aliye uriti katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong> Kristo na Mungu.” “Heri <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naofula nguo zao, <strong>wa</strong>we na<br />

amri kwendea mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima, na kuingia katika muji k<strong>wa</strong> milango <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini inje ni<br />

imb<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>chawi, na <strong>wa</strong>zini, na <strong>wa</strong>uaji, na <strong>wa</strong>naoabudu sanamu, na kila mutu<br />

anayependa uwongo na kuufan<strong>ya</strong>.” Waefeso 5:5, ARV; Ufunuo 22:14,15.<br />

Mungu ame<strong>wa</strong>tolea <strong>wa</strong>tu tangazo la kanuni <strong>ya</strong> matendo na zambi. “Waovu wote<br />

ata<strong>wa</strong>haribu.” ‘’Lakini <strong>wa</strong>kosaji <strong>wa</strong>taharibi<strong>wa</strong> pamoja; mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu utaharibi<strong>wa</strong>.”<br />

Zaburi 145:20; 37:38. Mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> serikali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu itaharibu maasi, lakini haki <strong>ya</strong><br />

kulipiza kisasi itaku<strong>wa</strong> aminifu pamoja na tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kama <strong>wa</strong> rehema, na wema.<br />

Mungu hashurutishe mapenzi. Hapendezwi na utii <strong>wa</strong> utum<strong>wa</strong>. Anataka <strong>ya</strong> kama viumbe<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>tampenda k<strong>wa</strong> sababu anastahili upendo. Angali<strong>wa</strong>takia <strong>wa</strong>mtii k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sababu <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na shukrani <strong>ya</strong> akili k<strong>wa</strong> hekima <strong>ya</strong>ke, haki, na wema.<br />

Kanuni za serkali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu zinaku<strong>wa</strong> katika umoja pamoja na amri <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi,<br />

“Pendeni adui zenu.” Matayo 5:44. Mungu anatimiliza haki k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uzuri<br />

<strong>wa</strong> viumbe vyote na hata k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uzuri <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le ambao hukumu zake<br />

zitakapo<strong>wa</strong>tazama. Ange<strong>wa</strong>furahisha kama awezavyo. Ame<strong>wa</strong>zunguusha na alama za<br />

upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke na ku<strong>wa</strong>fuatisha na matoleo za rehema; lakini <strong>wa</strong>nazarau upendo <strong>wa</strong>ke,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>navunja sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kukataa rehema <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kupokea daima za<strong>wa</strong>di zake,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nampatisha ha<strong>ya</strong> Mtoaji. B<strong>wa</strong>na anavumilia ukaidi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu; lakini je,<br />

ata<strong>wa</strong>funga <strong>wa</strong>asi ha<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ke, ku<strong>wa</strong>lazimisha kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke?<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>kuta<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> Kuingia Mbinguni<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liochagua Shetani ku<strong>wa</strong> kiongozi <strong>wa</strong>o ha<strong>wa</strong>kuta<strong>ya</strong>-rish<strong>wa</strong> kuingia machoni pa<br />

Mungu. Kiburi, uongo, uasherati, ukali, <strong>ya</strong>mekaz<strong>wa</strong> katika tabia zao. Je, <strong>wa</strong>naweza kuingia<br />

mbinguni kukaa milele pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>le ambao <strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong>chukia duniani? Kweli haitaweza<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza k<strong>wa</strong> mwongo; upole hautaweza kutuliza kujisifu; usafi hauwezi<br />

kukubali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwovu; upendo usiotaka faida hauonekane <strong>wa</strong> kuvuta k<strong>wa</strong> mwenye choyo.<br />

Ni furaha gani mbingu ingeweza kutoa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshughulika sana katika faida za<br />

kujipendeza nafsi?<br />

226


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Je, <strong>wa</strong>le ambao mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o imejaz<strong>wa</strong> na uchuki k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> kweli na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

utakatifu, <strong>wa</strong>naweza kuchanganyika pamoja na makutano <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni na kujiunga katika<br />

nyimbo zao za sifa? Miaka <strong>ya</strong> rehema ilitole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o, lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuzoeza moyo <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

kupenda usafi. Ha<strong>wa</strong>kujifunza kamwe lugha <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Sasa ni kuchele<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Maisha <strong>ya</strong> maasi kumpinga Mungu haiku<strong>wa</strong>stahilisha k<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Usafi <strong>wa</strong>ke na<br />

amani <strong>ya</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> ni mateso k<strong>wa</strong>o; utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ungeku<strong>wa</strong> moto unaoteketeza.<br />

Wangetamani sana kukimbia kutoka mahali pale patakatifu na <strong>wa</strong>ngekaribisha vizuri<br />

maangamizi, ili <strong>wa</strong>weze kufich<strong>wa</strong> kutoka usoni pake yeye aliyekufa k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>komboa.<br />

Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu anaimarish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uchaguzi <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe. Kufukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o kutoka<br />

mbinguni ni k<strong>wa</strong> kujichagulia <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe na ni haki na rehema k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Kama maji <strong>ya</strong> Garika mioto <strong>ya</strong> siku kuu inatangaza hukumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna<br />

da<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>o imetumi<strong>wa</strong> katika maasi. Wakati uzima unapoisha, ni<br />

kuchele<strong>wa</strong> sana kugeuza ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> uasi hata <strong>wa</strong> utiifu, kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> uchuki<br />

hata k<strong>wa</strong> mapendo.<br />

Mshahara <strong>wa</strong> Zambi<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> maana mshahara <strong>wa</strong> zambi ni mauti, lakini za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele<br />

katika Yesu Kristo B<strong>wa</strong>na wetu.” Wakati ambao uzima ni uriti <strong>wa</strong> wenye haki, mauti ni<br />

sehemu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu. “Mauti <strong>ya</strong> pili” inawek<strong>wa</strong> kinyume na uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele. Waroma 6:23;<br />

tazama Ufunuo 20:14.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong> Adamu, mauti imewek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> uzao wote <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nadamu.<br />

Wote sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> huenda chini kaburini. Na k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> mpango <strong>wa</strong> wokovu, wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kulet<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> makaburi <strong>ya</strong>o: “kutaku<strong>wa</strong> ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu, wote wenye<br />

haki na <strong>wa</strong>sio haki pia.” “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu kama katika Adamu wote <strong>wa</strong>nakufa, hivyo wote<br />

katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>tafany<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hai.” Lakini tofauti imefany<strong>wa</strong> kati <strong>ya</strong> makundi mawili<br />

inayolet<strong>wa</strong>: “Wote <strong>wa</strong>lio katika makaburi <strong>wa</strong>tasikia sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke, nao <strong>wa</strong>tatoka; <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> mema k<strong>wa</strong> ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> uzima, na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liofan<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> ufufuo <strong>wa</strong><br />

hukumu.” Matendo 24:15; 1 Wakorinto 15:22; Yoane 5:28,29.<br />

Ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

Wale “<strong>wa</strong>naohesabi<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>mestahili” k<strong>wa</strong> ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza ni “heri na<br />

Watakatifu”. “Juu <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong> pili haina nguvu.” Luka 20:35; Ufunuo 20:6. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>siopata msamaha k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> toba na imani <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kupokea “mishahara <strong>ya</strong><br />

zambi,” azabu “kuf<strong>wa</strong>tana na matendo <strong>ya</strong>o,” kuishi katika “mauti <strong>ya</strong> pili.”<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni ni jambo lisilowezekana k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuokoa mwenye zambi katika zambi zake,<br />

anamwondolea maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke ambayo makosa ilin<strong>ya</strong>ngan<strong>ya</strong> na ambaye amejionyesha<br />

mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong>mba hastahili. ” Maana bado kidogo na mwovu hataku<strong>wa</strong>; ndiyo utafikiri<br />

sana pahali pake, naye hataku<strong>wa</strong>,” “Na <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> kama ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> mbele.” Zaburi 37:10;<br />

Obadia 16. Wanazama katika usahaulifu usioku<strong>wa</strong> na matumaini <strong>ya</strong> milele.<br />

227


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Hivi ndivyo itakavyofany<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> zambi. “Umeharibu <strong>wa</strong>ovu, Umefuta jina lao<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> milele na milele. Adui <strong>wa</strong>mekoma, <strong>wa</strong>meach<strong>wa</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> milele.” Zaburi 9:5,6.<br />

Yoane katika Ufunuo anasikia wimbo <strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>wa</strong> sifa usiochafuli<strong>wa</strong> na sauti hata moja <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutopatana. Hakuna nafsi za <strong>wa</strong>tu zinazotukana Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napojinyonga katika<br />

maumivu maba<strong>ya</strong> isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho kamwe. Hakuna viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> taabu katika jehanum<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takaochanganyisha na <strong>ya</strong>we <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> nguvu pamoja na nyimbo za <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Juu <strong>ya</strong> kosa kuhusu maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong> asili kunabaki mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> ufahamu katika<br />

mauti. Kulingana na maumivu maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> milele, ni kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko, k<strong>wa</strong> akili, na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo yetu <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu. Kufuatana na imani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi, <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika mbingu <strong>wa</strong>nafahamu yote <strong>ya</strong>nayofanyika duniani. Lakini namna gani ingeku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

furaha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu kujua mateso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lio hai, ku<strong>wa</strong>ona <strong>wa</strong>kiendelea na huzuni, uchungu, na<br />

maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong> maisha? Na ni chukizo la namna gani kuamini <strong>ya</strong> kama mara pumzi<br />

inapotoka mwilini nafsi <strong>ya</strong> roho isiyotubu inawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ndimi za jehanum!<br />

Maandiko <strong>ya</strong>nasema nini? Mtu hana ufahamu katika mauti: “Pumuzi <strong>ya</strong>ke inatoka,<br />

anarudia udongoni; siku ileile mafikiri <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>napotea.” “Maana <strong>wa</strong>lio hai <strong>wa</strong>najua <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>takufa: lakini <strong>wa</strong>fu ha<strong>wa</strong>jui kitu, ... Mapendo <strong>ya</strong>o na kuchukia k<strong>wa</strong>o na wivu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o umepotea; <strong>wa</strong>la ha<strong>wa</strong>na sehemu tena milele katika neno lo lote linalofanyika chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

jua.’‘ “K<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Hadeze haiwezi kukusifu, <strong>wa</strong>la kufa hakuwezi kukutukuza; <strong>wa</strong>le wenye<br />

kushuka k<strong>wa</strong> shimo ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kutarajia kweli <strong>ya</strong>ko. Mwenye uhai, mwenye uhai, ndiye<br />

atakayekusifu, kama mimi leo.” “Maana katika mauti hapana ukumbusho juu <strong>ya</strong>ko, Katika<br />

Hadeze nani atakayekupa asante?” Zaburi 146:4; Muhubiri 9:5,6; Isa<strong>ya</strong> 38:18, 19 ; Zaburi<br />

6:5.<br />

Petro siku <strong>ya</strong> Pentekote akatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Dawidi “alikufa, akazik<strong>wa</strong>, na kaburi<br />

lake ni kwetu hata leo.” “Maana Dawidi hakupanda katika mbingu.” Matendo 2:29,34. Neno<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Dawidi akingali katika kaburi hata ufufuo linaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong>mba wenye haki<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>ende mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>napokufa.<br />

Akasema Paulo: “Maana kama <strong>wa</strong>fu ha<strong>wa</strong>fufuliwi, basi Kristo hakufufuli<strong>wa</strong>: na kama<br />

Kristo hakufufuli<strong>wa</strong>, imani yenu ni bure; mungali katika zambi zenu. Basi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>liolala<br />

katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>mepotea.” 1 Wakorinto 15:16-18. Kama k<strong>wa</strong> miaka 4000 wenye haki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likwenda mara moja katika mbingu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kifo, namna gani Paulo amesema <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama hakuna ufufuo, “na <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>liolala katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>mepotea”?<br />

Wakati alipoku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuacha <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, Yesu haku<strong>wa</strong>mbia <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngekuja mara moja k<strong>wa</strong>ke: “Ninakwenda ku<strong>wa</strong>tengenezea ninyi pahali,” Akasema “Na<br />

kama ninakwenda ku<strong>wa</strong>tengenezea ninyi pahali, nitakuja tena, na nita<strong>wa</strong>karibisha ninyi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ngu.” Yoane 14:2,3. Paulo anat<strong>wa</strong>mbia zaidi <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba “B<strong>wa</strong>na mwenyewe atashuka<br />

toka mbinguni, na sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>, na sauti <strong>ya</strong> malaika mukub<strong>wa</strong>, na pamoja na baragumu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu: Nao <strong>wa</strong>liokufa katika Kristo <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza; kisha sisi tulio hai, tuliobaki,<br />

tutan<strong>ya</strong>kuli<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nao katika mawingu, kukutana na B<strong>wa</strong>na katika he<strong>wa</strong>, na hivi<br />

228


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

tutaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja na B<strong>wa</strong>na milele. Na anaongeza: “Basi mufarijiane k<strong>wa</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong>.” 1<br />

Tesalonika 4:1618. Katika kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, minyororo <strong>ya</strong> kaburi itavunjika na “<strong>wa</strong>fu katika<br />

Kristo” <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>tahukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kupatana na mambo <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> katika vitabu na kulip<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama vile matendo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>livyoku<strong>wa</strong>. Hukumu hii haitafanyika katika mauti. “K<strong>wa</strong> maana<br />

ameweka siku, atakayohukumu dunia k<strong>wa</strong> haki.” “Angalia, B<strong>wa</strong>na alikuja na <strong>wa</strong>takatifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke, elfu kumi, ili afanye hukumu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote.” Matendo 17:31; Yuda 15.<br />

Lakini kama <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>mekwisha kufurahish<strong>wa</strong> na mbingu ao kujinyonga katika ndimi za<br />

moto <strong>ya</strong> jehanum, ni haja gani <strong>ya</strong> hukumu ijayo? Neno la Mungu linaweza kufahamika<br />

katika mafikara <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida. Lakini ni fikara gani la haki tunaweza kuona <strong>wa</strong>la hekima ao<br />

haki katika maelezo inayokubali<strong>wa</strong> na wengi? Je, wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>tapokea sifa, “Verna,<br />

mutum<strong>wa</strong> mwema na m<strong>wa</strong>minifu, ... ingia katika furaha <strong>ya</strong> b<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ko,” <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kikaa machoni pake k<strong>wa</strong> miaka mingi? Je, <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>meit<strong>wa</strong> kutoka taabuni kupokea<br />

hukumu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>mzi, “Ondokeni k<strong>wa</strong>ngu, ninyi muliolaani<strong>wa</strong>, endeni katika moto<br />

<strong>wa</strong> milele”? Matayo 25:21,41.<br />

Maelezo juu <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong> nafsi <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwongo ambayo Roma ilipokea kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> ushenzi. Luther ali<strong>ya</strong>panga pamoja na hadisi<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> (za uwongo) vinavyofan<strong>ya</strong> sehemu <strong>ya</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> uchafu <strong>ya</strong> maagizo <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Biblia<br />

inafundisha <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>nalala hata ufufuo.<br />

Pumziko la heri k<strong>wa</strong> wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>liochoka! Wakati uki<strong>wa</strong> mrefu ao mfupi, lakini ni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati k<strong>wa</strong>o. Wanalala; <strong>wa</strong>naamsh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> baragumu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong><br />

utukufu. “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu baragumu italia, na <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siwe na kuoza. ... Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ule <strong>wa</strong> kuoza utakapovaa kutokuoza, na ule <strong>wa</strong> mauti utakapovaa kutokufa, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ule litakapotimia neno lililoandik<strong>wa</strong>; Mauti imemez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ushindi”. 1 Wakorinto 15:52-<br />

54.<br />

Kuit<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> usingizi <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>naanza kufikiri ni <strong>wa</strong>pi <strong>wa</strong>liishia. Shituko la<br />

mwisho liliku<strong>wa</strong> ni maumivu makali <strong>ya</strong> mauti; <strong>wa</strong>zo la mwisho, k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kianguka chini <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kaburi. Wanapofufuka kutoka kaburini, <strong>wa</strong>zo lao la k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

la furaha, litakariri<strong>wa</strong> katika shangwe la ushindi: Ee mauti, uchungu <strong>wa</strong>ko ni <strong>wa</strong>pi?” 1<br />

Wakorinto 15:55. “Ee kaburi, kushinda k<strong>wa</strong>ko ni <strong>wa</strong>pi?<br />

229


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 34. Roho za Wafu?<br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida, mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>lilet<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hekima <strong>ya</strong> kishenzi na katika giza <strong>ya</strong> maasi makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyounganish<strong>wa</strong> katika imani <strong>ya</strong><br />

Kikristo, <strong>ya</strong>kaondosha kweli ambayo “<strong>wa</strong>fu ha<strong>wa</strong>jui kitu.” Muhubiri 9:5. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naamini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba pepo za <strong>wa</strong>fu ni “roho za kutumikia, zilizotum<strong>wa</strong> kutumikia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>takaoriti<br />

wokovu.” Waebrania 1:14.<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba roho za <strong>wa</strong>fu zinarudi kutumia <strong>wa</strong>lio hai ikata<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>ya</strong> kisasa ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na majali<strong>wa</strong> na maarifa inayopita zaidi ile <strong>wa</strong>liyoku<strong>wa</strong> nayo mbele,<br />

sababu gani kutorudi duniani na kufundisha <strong>wa</strong> hai? Kama roho za <strong>wa</strong>fu zinatangatanga<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> rafiki zao duniani, sababu gani hazipelekane habari nao? Namna gani <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoamini<br />

katika uaminifu <strong>wa</strong> kibinadamu katika mauti <strong>wa</strong>naweza kukana “nuru <strong>ya</strong> Mungu”<br />

iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> na roho tukufu? Hapa kuna mferezi unaoweza kuangali<strong>wa</strong> kama takatifu<br />

ambamo shetani anatumika. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>lioanguka <strong>wa</strong>naonekana kama <strong>wa</strong>jumbe kutoka<br />

ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> kiroho.<br />

Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> anaku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuleta mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu mfano <strong>wa</strong> rafiki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokufa. Mfano ni kamilifu, ulifatish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uzahiri <strong>wa</strong> ajabu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>nafarijika na<br />

hakikisho <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>penzi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>na furaha mbinguni. Bila mashaka <strong>ya</strong> hatari, <strong>wa</strong>natoa<br />

sikio k<strong>wa</strong> roho za kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mashetani.” 1 Timoteo 4:1.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liokwenda k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi bila kujita<strong>ya</strong>risha <strong>wa</strong>nadai ku<strong>wa</strong> na furaha na ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mahali pa cheo bora huko mbinguni. Wageni <strong>wa</strong> uwongo kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mapepo (spirits) mara ingine hutoa maonyo halisi <strong>ya</strong>nayoshuhudia ku<strong>wa</strong> hakika. Halafu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hivi tumaini linapatikana, <strong>wa</strong>nafundisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong>nayongoa Maandiko. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

sababu k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>nataja mambo mengine <strong>ya</strong> kweli na palepale kutabiri mambo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

ujao jambo hilo linatoa mfano <strong>wa</strong> hakika, na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> uwongo <strong>ya</strong>nakubali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu huwek<strong>wa</strong> kando, Roho <strong>ya</strong> neema huzarauli<strong>wa</strong>. Pepo <strong>wa</strong>nakana Umungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Kristo na <strong>wa</strong>naweka Muumba k<strong>wa</strong> cheo pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe.<br />

Wakati inaku<strong>wa</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong>mba matokeo <strong>ya</strong> udanganyifu mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong>mepoke<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hila kama maonyesho <strong>ya</strong> kweli, pale kuliku<strong>wa</strong>, vilevile, maonyesho <strong>ya</strong> kupambanua <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwezo <strong>wa</strong> ajabu, kazi kabisa <strong>ya</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naamini <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu ni ujanja tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kibinadamu. Kama ikilet<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> maonyesho ambayo ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kuizania namna ingine<br />

isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kama ni <strong>ya</strong> ajabu, <strong>wa</strong>tadanganyi<strong>wa</strong> na ku<strong>ya</strong>kubali kama uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> msaada <strong>wa</strong> Shetani <strong>wa</strong>chawi <strong>wa</strong> Farao <strong>wa</strong>kaiga kazi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Tazama Kutoka<br />

7:10-12. Paulo anashuhudia k<strong>wa</strong>mba kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na kutatanguli<strong>wa</strong> na “kutenda k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Shetani na uwezo wote, na ishara na maajabu <strong>ya</strong> uwongo”. 2 Watesalonika 2:9,10. Na<br />

230


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Yoane anatangaza: “Naye anafan<strong>ya</strong> mastaajabu makub<strong>wa</strong>, hata kufan<strong>ya</strong> moto kushuka toka<br />

mbingu juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Naye ana<strong>wa</strong>kosesha <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mastaajabu <strong>ya</strong>le aliyope<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong>. Ufunuo 13:13, 14. Si mambo <strong>ya</strong> ujanja tu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyotabiri<strong>wa</strong> hapa. Watu <strong>wa</strong>nadanganyi<strong>wa</strong> na mastaajabu ambayo <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafan<strong>ya</strong>, si <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>nayotaka kufan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Mwito Wa Shetani K<strong>wa</strong> Wenye Akili<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye elimu naustaarabu mfalme <strong>wa</strong> giza anaonyesha imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na roho<br />

za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa na kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritisme) katika mifano <strong>ya</strong>ke safi<br />

zaidi na <strong>ya</strong> akili. Anapendez<strong>wa</strong> sana na <strong>wa</strong>zo la tendoo la kushangaza k<strong>wa</strong> furaha na<br />

maelezo yenye uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kushawishi <strong>ya</strong> mapendo na wema. Anaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kutumia<br />

kiburi sana katika hekima <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe ili ndani <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>aibishe B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Milele.<br />

Shetani anadangan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu sasa kama alivyodangan<strong>ya</strong> Ha<strong>wa</strong> katika Edeni k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuamsha tamaa <strong>ya</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kujiinua.<br />

“Mutaku<strong>wa</strong> kama miungu,” anatangaza, “mukijua uzuri na uba<strong>ya</strong>”. M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 3:5. Imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa inafundisha” k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu ni kiumbe cha<br />

maendeleo... karibu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha uungu”. Tena; “Hukumu itaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> haki, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ni<br />

hukumu <strong>ya</strong> kila mtu binafsi.... Kiti cha enzi ni ndani <strong>ya</strong>ko”. Na mwingine anasema: “Kila<br />

kiumbe cha haki na kikamilifu ni Kristo”.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo Shetani aligeuza tabia <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong> mtu mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> pekee <strong>ya</strong><br />

hukumu. Hii ni maendeleo, si kwenda juu, bali kwenda chini. Mtu hawezi kuinuka juu<br />

kuliko cheo chake cha usafi <strong>wa</strong>la wema. Kama nafsi ndiyo kipeo chake kikamilifu cha juu<br />

kuliko, hatafikia kamwe k<strong>wa</strong> kitu cho chote kinachoinuka zaidi. Neema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu tu<br />

inaku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kuinua mtu. Kuach<strong>wa</strong> upekee, maendeleo <strong>ya</strong>ke inapas<strong>wa</strong> kwenda<br />

chini.<br />

Mwito k<strong>wa</strong> Kupenda Anasa<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> ulafi, kupenda anasa, uasherati, imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa<br />

(spiritisme) inaonyesha umbo la uwongo la werevu kidogo. Katika mifano <strong>ya</strong>o mba<strong>ya</strong> sana<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napata kitu ambacho kinachoku<strong>wa</strong> katika umoja na tamaa zake. Shetani anaandika<br />

hesabu <strong>ya</strong> zambi kila mtu kutenda halafu anajihazali <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba saa za kufaa zisipunguke<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza mvuto. Anajaribu <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kutojizuia k<strong>wa</strong> kupunguza nguvu za<br />

mwili, akili na za mafundusho mazuri. Anaharibu maelfu katika mazoezi <strong>wa</strong> kufurahisha<br />

tamaa, kuharibu tabia yote nzima. Na kutimiza kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke, pepo <strong>wa</strong>natangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

“maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>namuweka mtu juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria yote”; “cho chote kinachoku<strong>wa</strong>, kinaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

haki”; <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba “Mungu hahukumu”, na <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba “zambi zote... zinaku<strong>wa</strong> bila kosa”.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napoamini <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba tamaa ni sheria <strong>ya</strong> juu zaidi, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba uhuru ni<br />

ruhusa, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mtu ni juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe tu, nani anayeweza kushangaa <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

231


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

uchafu unajaa k<strong>wa</strong> kila mkono? Wengi k<strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>nakubali maongozi <strong>ya</strong> tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Shetani anachukua maelfu katika <strong>wa</strong>vu lake <strong>wa</strong>naodai kufuata Kristo.<br />

Lakini Mungu ametoa nuru <strong>ya</strong> kutosha kuvumbua mtego huo. Msingi kabisa <strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa unaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> vita ikipiganisha Maandiko. Biblia<br />

inasema <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>fu ha<strong>wa</strong>jui kitu, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>mepotea; ha<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

sehemu katika furaha <strong>wa</strong>la huzuni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> duniani.<br />

Tena zaidi Mungu amekataza maarifa <strong>ya</strong> hila <strong>ya</strong>mazungumzo na roho za <strong>wa</strong>fu.<br />

“mashetani”. Kama ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>geni kutoka dunia zingine <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiit<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>natangaz<strong>wa</strong><br />

na Biblia ku<strong>wa</strong> “pepo za mashetani”. Tazama Hesabu 25:1-3; Zaburi 106:28; 1 Wakorinto<br />

10:20; Ufunuo 16:14. Kutendeana pamoja nao kulikataz<strong>wa</strong> katika azabu <strong>ya</strong> kufa. Walawi<br />

19:31; 20:27. Lakini imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme) imefan<strong>ya</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

katika jamii za ujuzoi <strong>wa</strong>kweli ikashambulia makanisa, na kupata upendeleo katika majamii<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> sheria, hata katika majumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme. Udanganyifu mkub<strong>wa</strong> huu ni uamsho<br />

katika hila mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> uchawi uliohukumi<strong>wa</strong> zamani.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha uba<strong>ya</strong> zaidi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kama katika mbingu, Shetani anasema k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwengu: “Si kitu ukiamini <strong>wa</strong>la usipoamini Mungu na Biblia, uishi kama unanvyopenda;<br />

mbingu ni makao <strong>ya</strong>ko”. Neno la Mungu linasema: “Ole <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naoita uovu mema, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naita mema uovu; <strong>wa</strong>naoweka giza k<strong>wa</strong> nuru, na nuru giza.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 5:20.<br />

Biblia llifananish<strong>wa</strong> kama Habari za Uwongo<br />

Mitume, <strong>wa</strong>nafananish<strong>wa</strong> na pepo za uwongo, <strong>wa</strong>nafany<strong>wa</strong>, k<strong>wa</strong> kukanusha mambo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyoandika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dunia. Shetani anafan<strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu kuamini <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba Biblia ni habari za uwongo, kitabu kilichopendeza k<strong>wa</strong> utoto <strong>wa</strong> taifa, lakini, sasa<br />

kuzani<strong>wa</strong> kama kisiuchofaa. Kitabu kinachopas<strong>wa</strong> kumuhukumu yeye na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

anakiweka katika kivuli; Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu anamfan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kama mtu yo yote. Na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu katika mifano <strong>ya</strong> kiroho <strong>wa</strong>najaribu kufan<strong>ya</strong> kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna kitu cha<br />

muujiza katika maisha <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi wetu. Miujiza <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe, inatangaza, k<strong>wa</strong> mbali<br />

zaidi kazi za Kristo.<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme) inajit<strong>wa</strong>lia sasa umbo la Kikristo.<br />

Lakini mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke ha<strong>ya</strong>wezi kukanush<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>la kufich<strong>wa</strong>. Katika mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> sasa<br />

unaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> hatari zaidi, <strong>wa</strong> hila, udanganyifu. Inajidai sasa kukubali Kristo na Biblia.<br />

Lakini Biblia inafasiri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza k<strong>wa</strong> moyo mp<strong>ya</strong>. Mapendo inaku<strong>wa</strong>ko<br />

kama sifa bora <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, lakini inaaibish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa zaifu kufan<strong>ya</strong> tofauti ndogo kati <strong>ya</strong><br />

uzuri na uba<strong>ya</strong>. Mashitaki <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong> zambi, matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke takatifu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nachung<strong>wa</strong> mbali na kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong> macho. Mifano inaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kukataa Biblia kama<br />

msingi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Kristo anakani<strong>wa</strong> kama mbele, lakini udanganyifu hautambuliwe.<br />

Wachache <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo la haki la uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kudangan<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme). Wengi <strong>wa</strong>navuta viba<strong>ya</strong> nao k<strong>wa</strong> kupendeza tu<br />

232


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

uchunguzi. Wangejaz<strong>wa</strong> na hofu kuu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zo la kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> pepo. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>najita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> ki<strong>wa</strong>nja kilichokataz<strong>wa</strong>, na mharibu <strong>wa</strong>utumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke, na<br />

ana<strong>wa</strong>shikilia ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>. Hakuna kitu kingine kisipoku<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> jibu<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> bidii, inayowezakuokoa nafsi hizi.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>naolinda zambi inayojulikana k<strong>wa</strong> makusudi <strong>wa</strong>naalika majaribu <strong>ya</strong> Shetani.<br />

Wanajitenga wenyewe kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> malaika zake, na <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> pasipo<br />

mateteo. “Na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napokuambia: Tafuta habari k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye roho na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fumu, <strong>wa</strong>naolialia kama ndege na kunungunika, sema, haifai k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kutafuta k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong>o? Waenda k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lio hai? K<strong>wa</strong> sheria na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ushuhuda! Kama ha<strong>wa</strong>semi sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na neno hili, kweli hapana asubui k<strong>wa</strong>o.” Isa<strong>ya</strong> 8:19,<br />

20.<br />

Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngekusudia kupokea ukweli juu <strong>ya</strong> asili <strong>ya</strong> mtu na hali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngeona katika imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme) uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Shetani na<br />

miujiza <strong>ya</strong> uwongo. Lakini wengi <strong>wa</strong>nafunga macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> nuru, na Shetani anafuma<br />

mitego <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong>o. “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu ha<strong>wa</strong>kupokea mapendo k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, <strong>wa</strong>pate kuokole<strong>wa</strong>,”<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii, “Mungu ana<strong>wa</strong>letea nguvu <strong>ya</strong> upotevu, hata <strong>wa</strong>amini uwongo.” 2<br />

Watesalonika 2:10, 11.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naopinga imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa (spiritisme)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nashambulia Shetani na malaika zake. Shetani hataacha hatua (=2,54cm) moja <strong>ya</strong> u<strong>wa</strong>nja<br />

ila tu akisukum<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Anaweza kutumia Maandiko na<br />

atapotosha maana <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho Wale <strong>wa</strong>takaosimama k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu <strong>wa</strong> hatari<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko.<br />

Pepo za mashetani <strong>wa</strong>naoiga ndugu ao rafiki <strong>wa</strong>tatokea k<strong>wa</strong> huruma za mapendo kwetu<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tafan<strong>ya</strong> miujiza. Inatupasa ku<strong>wa</strong>zuia k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong> Biblia <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>fu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>jui kitu cho chote na <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotokea ni pepo za mashetani.<br />

Imani <strong>ya</strong>o yote haikuanzish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la Mungu <strong>wa</strong>tadanganyi<strong>wa</strong> na kushind<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Shetani “anatumika na madanganyo yote <strong>ya</strong> uovu, ” Na madanganyo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>taongezeka.<br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotafuta maarifa <strong>ya</strong> kweli na safi nafsi zao katika utii <strong>wa</strong>tapata katika<br />

Mungu <strong>wa</strong> kweli ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> hakika. Mwokozi angetuma upesi kila malaika kutoka mbinguni<br />

kulinda <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke kuliko kuacha nafsi moja inayotumaini kushind<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naojifariji wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> uhakikisho k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna azabu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mwenye zambi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naokataa kweli ambayo Mbingu inayotoa kama ulinzi k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> taabu, <strong>wa</strong>takubali<br />

madanganyo <strong>ya</strong>liyotole<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani, madai <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa<br />

(spiritisme).<br />

Wenye kuzihaki <strong>wa</strong>nazani mizaha matangazo <strong>ya</strong> Maandiko juu <strong>ya</strong> shauri la wokovu na<br />

malipo <strong>ya</strong>takayokuja <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>naokataa kweli. Wanageuza jambo la kutia huruma k<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> ushupavu, uzaifu, na mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> uchawi kama kutii matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

233


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wamejitoa wote k<strong>wa</strong> mshawishi, <strong>wa</strong>mejiunga karibu sana naye na kujaz<strong>wa</strong> na roho <strong>ya</strong>ke, ili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siwe na upungufu kutoka katika mtego <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Msingi <strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani uliwek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> matumaini iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Ha<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

Edeni: “Hakika hamutakufa”. “Siku mutakapokula matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke, macho yenu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>tafunguli<strong>wa</strong>, na mutaku<strong>wa</strong> kama Mungu mukijua uzuri na uba<strong>ya</strong>.” M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 3:4,5. Kipeo<br />

chake cha madanganyo kitafikia katika mabaki <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati. Asema nabii:<br />

“Nikaona pepo <strong>wa</strong>chafu <strong>wa</strong>tatu <strong>wa</strong>liofanana na vyura, <strong>wa</strong>katoka kiny<strong>wa</strong> cha yule joka, na<br />

katika kiny<strong>wa</strong> cha yule nabii <strong>wa</strong> uwongo kama vyura. Maana ndio pepo za mashetani,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naofan<strong>ya</strong> alama, na kutoka na kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu wote, ku<strong>wa</strong>kusan<strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> vita <strong>ya</strong> siku ile kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Mungu Mwenyezi.” Ufunuo 16:13, 14.<br />

Ila tu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naolind<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu katika imani katika Neno lake, ulimwengu<br />

mzima utapita k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu katika njia za madanganyo ha<strong>ya</strong>. Watu <strong>wa</strong>najitumbukiza upesi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> salama <strong>ya</strong> ajali, kuamsh<strong>wa</strong> tu na kumiminika k<strong>wa</strong> hasira <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

234


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 35. Uhuru <strong>wa</strong> Zamiri Unatish<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kanisa la Roma sasa linapendele<strong>wa</strong> sana na Waprotestanti kuliko miaka <strong>ya</strong> zamani.<br />

Katika inchi hizo ambamo Kanisa la Kikatoliki linapata mwendo <strong>wa</strong> kuunganisha k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupata mvuto, ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>naanza kusimami<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba hakuna tofauti sana juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> lazima kama ilivyozani<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ukubali ule mdogo k<strong>wa</strong> upande wetu<br />

utatuongoza katika mapatano bora pamoja na Roma. Kuliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati Waprotestanti<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lifundisha <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kutafuta umoja na Roma kungeku<strong>wa</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Lakini ni tofauti kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna gani tunaona katika taarifa <strong>ya</strong> sasa!<br />

Watetezi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Rome (Papa) <strong>wa</strong>natangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba kanisa limeshitaki<strong>wa</strong> uwongo,<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba si haki kuhukumu kanisa la leo k<strong>wa</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi za<br />

ujinga na giza. Wanarehemu ukali <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kuogopesha k<strong>wa</strong> ushenzi <strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati zile.<br />

Je, <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kusahau madai <strong>ya</strong> kutoweza kukosa kulikowek<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo huu?<br />

Roma inadai <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba “kanisa halikukosa kamwe; <strong>wa</strong>la kukosa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao,<br />

kufuatana na Maandiko, halitakosa daima.”<br />

Kanisa la Roma halitaacha kamwe madai <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kutoweza kukosa (infallibilité). Acha<br />

vizuizi (amri) vilivyoamri<strong>wa</strong> sasa na serikali za dunia vitoshwe na Roma irudishwe katika<br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, na hapo k<strong>wa</strong> upesi ingeku<strong>wa</strong> uamsho <strong>wa</strong> uonevu <strong>wa</strong>ke na<br />

mateso.<br />

Ni kweli <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong>ko katika ushirika <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la<br />

Kikatoliki la Roma. Maelfu katika kanisa lile <strong>wa</strong>namtumikia Mungu kufuatana na nuru bora<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nayoku<strong>wa</strong> nayo. Mungu anatazama na upendo <strong>wa</strong> huruma juu <strong>ya</strong> nafsi hizi, zilizolele<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika imani ile <strong>ya</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong> na isiyotosheleka. Ataleta mishale <strong>ya</strong> nuru kupen<strong>ya</strong> giza, na<br />

wengi <strong>wa</strong>takamata misimamo <strong>ya</strong>o pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Lakini Kanisa la Roma kama chama haliko tena katika umoja na habari njema <strong>ya</strong> Kristo<br />

sasa kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Kanisa la Roma linatumia shauri lo lote k<strong>wa</strong> kupata<br />

uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu, kuanzisha tena mateso, na kuharibu mambo yote ambayo<br />

Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>mefan<strong>ya</strong>. Kanisa la Kikatoliki liko linapata nafasi k<strong>wa</strong> pande zote. Angalia<br />

kuongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong>ke. Tazama uwingi <strong>wa</strong> vyuo v<strong>ya</strong>o vikub<strong>wa</strong> (colleges) na<br />

seminaires, vinavyosimami<strong>wa</strong> na Waprotestanti. Tazama usitawi <strong>wa</strong> utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> sala katika<br />

Uingereza na maasi <strong>ya</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara k<strong>wa</strong> vyuo v<strong>ya</strong> Wakatoliki.<br />

Mapatano na Ukubali<br />

Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>mesaidia ama kupendelea mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Papa; <strong>wa</strong>mefan<strong>ya</strong><br />

mapatano na mkubaliano ambayo <strong>wa</strong>katoliki wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>meshangaa ku<strong>ya</strong>ona. Watu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunga macho <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong> kamili <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma. Watu <strong>wa</strong>nahitaji kupinga<br />

maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> adui huyu <strong>wa</strong> hatari k<strong>wa</strong> uhuru <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na dini.<br />

235


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakati msingi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma linaimarish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo, si la ushenzi na<br />

ujiinga. Huduma <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma ka<strong>wa</strong>ida ni <strong>ya</strong> kuvuta sana. Maonyesho <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

mazuri sana mengi na kanuni kub<strong>wa</strong> za dini zinavuta <strong>wa</strong>tu na kun<strong>ya</strong>mazisha sauti <strong>ya</strong> akili<br />

na zamiri. Jicho linavut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uzuri. Makanisa mazuri kabisa, maandamano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

ajabu, mazabahu <strong>ya</strong> zahabu, sanduku za kuwekea vitu vitakatifu za johari, mapicha mazuri,<br />

na muchoro bora vinavuta wenye kupenda uzuri. Muziki ni <strong>wa</strong>ajabu. Nukta za muziki nzuri<br />

za kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong> za kinanda zinachanganyika na nyimbo tamu sana za sauti<br />

nyingi kama inavyoongeza katika madari <strong>ya</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> juu sana na sehemu ndefu <strong>ya</strong> nguzo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> majengo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kanisa <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>ya</strong>navuta akili <strong>ya</strong> uchai na heshima.<br />

Utukufu huu <strong>wa</strong> inje na ibada vinacheka tamaa za nafsi yenye kugonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> zambi. Dini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kristo haihitaji mivuto <strong>ya</strong> namna hiyo. Nuru inayongaa kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> msalaba inaonekana<br />

safi na <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza na hakuna mapambo <strong>ya</strong> inje <strong>ya</strong>nayoweza kuongeza damani <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> ufundi, malezi <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza tamaa, mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong>natumi<strong>wa</strong><br />

na Shetani kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kusahau mahitaji <strong>ya</strong> nafsi na kuishi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu huu<br />

tu.<br />

Fahari na sherehe <strong>ya</strong> kuabudu k<strong>wa</strong> Kikatoliki kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuvuta<br />

(kushawishi) kufan<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong>, nzuri <strong>wa</strong>kupoteza akili, na hiyo, wengi <strong>wa</strong>medanganyika.<br />

Wanajipatia uhakikisho juu <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma ku<strong>wa</strong> mlango <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Hakuna hata<br />

mmoja ila tu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoweka miguu <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> kweli, ambao mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

hufany<strong>wa</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> salama juu <strong>ya</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke. Mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

uta<strong>wa</strong> pasipo uwezo ni kitu kile wengi <strong>wa</strong>natamani.<br />

Madai <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> haki k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kusamehe zambi <strong>ya</strong>naongoza <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Roma<br />

kujisikia huru k<strong>wa</strong> zambi, na agizo la maungamo linaelekea vile vile kutoa ruhusa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uovu. Yeye anayepiga magoti mbele <strong>ya</strong> mtu aliyeanguka na anafungua katika maungamo<br />

ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> siri <strong>ya</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke anapoteza cheo cha nafsi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Katika kufunua zambi za<br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> padri--mwenye kufa <strong>wa</strong> kosa-cheo cha tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke ni chini, na anaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

mchafu k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo. Ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni <strong>ya</strong> kushusha cheo katika mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu aliyeanguka, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu kuhani anasimama kama mjumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Ungamo hili la ha<strong>ya</strong> la mtu k<strong>wa</strong> mtu ni chemchemi <strong>ya</strong> siri ambamo kumebubujika uwingi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> uovu unaochafua ulimwengu. K<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong> yeye anayependa anasa, ni kupendeza zaidi<br />

kuungama k<strong>wa</strong> mtu <strong>wa</strong> mauti kuliko kufungua roho k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Ni jambo la kupendeza<br />

zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> kiumbe m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu kutubu kuliko kuacha zambi; ni rahisi kuhuzunisha <strong>wa</strong>la<br />

kutesa mwili k<strong>wa</strong> nguo <strong>ya</strong> gunia kuliko kusulubisha tamaa za mwili.<br />

Mfano Wa Kushangaza<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>lipozarau k<strong>wa</strong> siri kuja k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kali k<strong>wa</strong> inje katika kushika amri zake, kuzilemeza k<strong>wa</strong> masharti<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nayofan<strong>ya</strong> utii ku<strong>wa</strong> mzito. Kama vile Wayuda <strong>wa</strong>livyojidai kuheshimu sheria, vivyo<br />

hivyo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma <strong>wa</strong>najidai k<strong>wa</strong> heshima <strong>ya</strong> msalaba.<br />

236


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wanaweka misalaba k<strong>wa</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong>o, mazabahu <strong>ya</strong>o, na mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o. Po pote alama<br />

<strong>ya</strong> msalaba k<strong>wa</strong> inje inaheshimi<strong>wa</strong> na kutukuz<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo <strong>ya</strong>nazik<strong>wa</strong><br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> desturi za uongo na malipizi makali. Roho aminifu zinalind<strong>wa</strong> katika woga <strong>wa</strong><br />

hasira <strong>ya</strong> Mungu aliyechukiz<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa wengi <strong>wa</strong>naishi katika anasa na<br />

tamaa <strong>ya</strong> mwili.<br />

Ni juhudi <strong>ya</strong> daima <strong>ya</strong> Shetani kusingizia tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, asili <strong>ya</strong> zambi, na matokeo<br />

kwenye mti <strong>wa</strong> kuchoma <strong>wa</strong>fia dini katika vita kuu. Madanganyo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>natoa <strong>wa</strong>tu ruhusa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> zambi. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule ule anaanzisha ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong> uwongo juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ili<br />

<strong>wa</strong>m<strong>wa</strong>ngalie k<strong>wa</strong> hofo na chuki kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> upendo. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>liyopotosh<strong>wa</strong><br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> tabia za Mungu, mataifa <strong>ya</strong> kishenzi <strong>wa</strong>liongoz<strong>wa</strong> kuamini kafara za kibinadamu<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> za lazima k<strong>wa</strong>kupata mapendo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mambo makali <strong>ya</strong> kuogopesha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>metend<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> mifano mbalimbali <strong>ya</strong> ibada <strong>ya</strong> sanamu.<br />

Umoja <strong>wa</strong> Upagani na Ukristo<br />

Kanisa la Katoliki la Roma, k<strong>wa</strong> kuunganisha upagani na Ukristo, na, kama upagani,<br />

kusingizia tabia <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, lilitumia basi matendo makali. Vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> mateso<br />

vilishurutisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kukubali mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakuu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa <strong>wa</strong>kajifunza kuvumbua<br />

njia za kufanyiza mateso makub<strong>wa</strong> iwezekanavyo bila kuondoa maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>singekubali madai <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> mara nyingi yule aliyetes<strong>wa</strong> alipokea mauti ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kufunguli<strong>wa</strong> kuzuri.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> Roma kanisa liliku<strong>wa</strong> na malezi <strong>ya</strong> shida, njaa, <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong> mwili.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kupata kibali cha Mungu, wenye kutubu <strong>wa</strong>lifundish<strong>wa</strong> kupasua vifungo ambavyo<br />

Mungu alivifan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kubariki na kufurahisha maisha <strong>ya</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>nadamu duniani. U<strong>wa</strong>nja <strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa unaku<strong>wa</strong> na mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liotoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> masumbuko <strong>ya</strong> bure, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kukomesha, kama machukizo k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, kila <strong>wa</strong>zo na nia <strong>ya</strong> huruma k<strong>wa</strong> viumbe<br />

wenzao.<br />

Mungu hakuweka kamwe moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mizigo hii mzito juu <strong>wa</strong>tu wo wote. Kristo<br />

hakutoa mfano k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>naume na <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke kujifungia wenyewe katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong><br />

(monasteres) ili kuweza kustahili kuingia mbinguni. Hakufundisha kamwe <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

mapendo <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kukomesh<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Papa anadai ku<strong>wa</strong> mjumbe mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Lakini je, Kristo alijulikana daima<br />

kutupa <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> gereza k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ha<strong>wa</strong>kumtolea heshima kub<strong>wa</strong> kama Mfalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

mbingu? Je, sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke ilisiki<strong>wa</strong> kuhukumu k<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>siomkubali?<br />

Kanisa la Roma sasa linaonyesha uso mzuri k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu, kufunika k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong><br />

kujitetea ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> maovu <strong>ya</strong> kuchukiza. Limejivika lenyewe mavazi <strong>ya</strong> mfano<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Kikristo, lakini linaku<strong>wa</strong> lisilobadilika. Kanuni yo yote <strong>ya</strong> dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma katika vizazi<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliopita inaku<strong>wa</strong>ko leo. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>liyoshauri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> miaka <strong>ya</strong> giza <strong>ya</strong>ngali<br />

<strong>ya</strong>nashik<strong>wa</strong>. Dini <strong>ya</strong> Roma ambayo Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>naheshimu sasa ni ileile iliyota<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

237


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

katika siku za Matengenezo (Reformation), <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liposimama k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hatari <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o kufunua zambi lake.<br />

Kanisa la Roma ni kama vile unabii ulivyotangaza k<strong>wa</strong>mba lingeku<strong>wa</strong>, ni kukufuru k<strong>wa</strong><br />

n<strong>ya</strong>kati za mwisho. Tazama 2 Watesalonika 2 :3,4. Chini <strong>ya</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> kigeugeu linaficha<br />

sumu isiyobadilika <strong>ya</strong> nyoka. Je, uwezo huu, ambao ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> miaka elfu<br />

umeandik<strong>wa</strong> katika damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, utakubali<strong>wa</strong> kama sehemu <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Kristo?<br />

Badiliko katika Kanisa la Protestanti<br />

Madai <strong>ya</strong>mewek<strong>wa</strong> katika inchi za Kiprotestanti <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kikatoliki inaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

tofauti kidogo k<strong>wa</strong> Dini <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti kuliko n<strong>ya</strong>kati za zamani. Hapo kumeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

badiliko; lakini badiliko haliko katika kanisa la Roma. Kanisa la Katoliki linafanana sana na<br />

Kanisa la Kiprotestanti linaloku<strong>wa</strong> sasa k<strong>wa</strong> sababu Kanisa la Kiprotestanti kiliharibika<br />

tabia sana tangu siku za Watengenezaji (Reformateurs).<br />

Makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti, kutafuta mapendeleo <strong>ya</strong> ulimwen-gu, <strong>ya</strong>naamini kila kitu<br />

kiba<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kizuri, na kama matokeo <strong>wa</strong>taamini mwishoni kila kitu kizuri ku<strong>wa</strong> kiba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> sasa, kama ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong>, kujitetea k<strong>wa</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong>o isiyoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

na mapendo k<strong>wa</strong>ke, kuomba musamaha k<strong>wa</strong> “ushupavu” <strong>wa</strong>o. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>nasihi sana <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba giza <strong>ya</strong> kiakili na <strong>ya</strong>kiroho iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> pote <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> Miaka <strong>ya</strong> Katikati ilisaidia<br />

Roma kueneza mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi na mateso, na <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba akili kub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za<br />

sasa na kuongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> wema katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> dini kunakataza m<strong>wa</strong>msho <strong>wa</strong><br />

kutovumilia. Watu <strong>wa</strong>nacheka sana <strong>wa</strong>zo la k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo <strong>ya</strong> namna ile <strong>ya</strong>naweza<br />

kutokea k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>kati za nuru. Inapas<strong>wa</strong> kukumbuk<strong>wa</strong> lakini <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> namna nuru<br />

inapotole<strong>wa</strong> zaidi, na zaidi giza <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naopotea na kuikataa itaku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Siku <strong>ya</strong> giza kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lio elimish<strong>wa</strong> imesaidia k<strong>wa</strong> mafanikio <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la Roma<br />

(Papa). Siku <strong>ya</strong> nuru kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lioelimish<strong>wa</strong> nayo itasaidia vile vile. Katika miaka<br />

iliyopita <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> pasipo maarifa <strong>ya</strong> ukweli, maelfu <strong>wa</strong>likamat<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mtego, bila kuona <strong>wa</strong>vu uliotandik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>nyo zao. Katika kizazi hiki wengi<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>tambui <strong>wa</strong>vu na <strong>wa</strong>natembea ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke mara moja bila kufikiri. Wakati <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napotukuza mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe juu <strong>ya</strong> Neno la Mungu, akili inaweza kutimiza<br />

maumivu makub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko ujinga. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo elimu <strong>ya</strong> uwongo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu utahakikisha<br />

mafanikio <strong>ya</strong> kuta<strong>ya</strong>risha njia k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali kanisa la Roma (Papa), kama kukataa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maarifa kulivyofan<strong>ya</strong> katika Miaka <strong>ya</strong> Giza.<br />

Kushika Siku <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza (Jumapili)<br />

Kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (jumapili) ni desturi ilioanzish<strong>wa</strong> na Roma, ambayo anadai<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> alama <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Kanisa la Roma (Papa)--<strong>ya</strong> mapatano k<strong>wa</strong> desturi<br />

za kidunia, heshima k<strong>wa</strong> desturi za kibinadamu juu <strong>ya</strong> amri za Mungu--inaenea sehemu zote<br />

za makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti na ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong> kutukuza Siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza (Jumapili) ambayo kanisa la Roma limeigeuza mbele <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

238


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sheria za kifalme, baraza za ka<strong>wa</strong>ida na maagizo <strong>ya</strong> kanisa zilizokubali<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kidunia ziliku<strong>wa</strong> ni hatua ambazo siku kuu za kishenzi zilifikia cheo cha heshima katika<br />

dunia la Wakristo. Mpango <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong> kulazimisha <strong>wa</strong>tu wote kushika Siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

<strong>ya</strong> juma iliku<strong>wa</strong> sheria iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> na Constantine. Inga<strong>wa</strong> iliku<strong>wa</strong> kweli sheria <strong>ya</strong> kipagani,<br />

ilikaz<strong>wa</strong> na mfalme akiisha kukubali dini <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo.<br />

Eusebius, kama askofu aliyetafuta upendeleo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, na aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> rafiki <strong>wa</strong><br />

kipekee <strong>wa</strong> Constantine, akaendesha matangazo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo alihamisha Sabato na<br />

kuiweka k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche). Hakuna ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko uliotole<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

uhakikisho. Eusebius yeye mwenyewe, bila ku<strong>wa</strong> na hakikisho akatangaza uwongo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

“Vitu vyote,” anasema, “Kila kitu kilichoku<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Sabato, hivi<br />

tumevihamisha k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na”. 2<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna Kanisa la Roma lilipoimarish<strong>wa</strong>, kutukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

kukaendelea. K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mfupi siku <strong>ya</strong> saba iliendelea kushik<strong>wa</strong> kama Sabato, lakini<br />

baadaye badiliko likafanyika. Baadaye Papa akatoa maagizo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba padri <strong>wa</strong> wila<strong>ya</strong><br />

alipas<strong>wa</strong> kukaripia <strong>wa</strong>naoharibu siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche) <strong>wa</strong>silete msiba mkub<strong>wa</strong> juu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe na k<strong>wa</strong> jirani.<br />

Amri za baraza zilizo hakikisha upungufu, <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>wa</strong>kaomb<strong>wa</strong> sana kutoa<br />

amri ambayo ingeogopesha mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na ku<strong>wa</strong>lazimisha kuacha kazi k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche). K<strong>wa</strong> mkutano <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> kanisa uliofany<strong>wa</strong> Roma, mipango yote<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mbele ikahakikish<strong>wa</strong> tena na kuingiz<strong>wa</strong> katika sheria <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na kukaz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong> serikali1]<br />

Lakini ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

(dimanche) ukaleta mashaka. Watu <strong>wa</strong>kauliza haki <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kutia<br />

pembeni tangazo hili, “Siku <strong>ya</strong> saba ni Sabato k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu <strong>wa</strong>ko,” ili kuheshimu<br />

siku <strong>ya</strong> jua. K<strong>wa</strong> kusaidia ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Biblia, mashauri mengine <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

lazima.<br />

Musimamizi <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche), ambaye karibu mwisho <strong>wa</strong> karne<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kumi na mbili alizuru makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Uingereza, akaping<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong>aminifu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli; na k<strong>wa</strong> hivi nguvu <strong>ya</strong>ke iliku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> bure hata akatoka k<strong>wa</strong> inchi <strong>wa</strong>kati moja.<br />

Wakati aliporudi, akaleta mkunjo <strong>wa</strong>onyesho ambayo alidai kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu mwenyewe,<br />

iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> na agizo la kulazimisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche), pamoja na<br />

matisho <strong>ya</strong> ajabu kuogopesha <strong>wa</strong>siotii. Maandiko ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> damani <strong>ya</strong>lisem<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>la kutaj<strong>wa</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuanguka kutoka mbinguni na kupatikana pale Yerusalema juu <strong>ya</strong> mazabahu <strong>ya</strong><br />

Simeona Mtakatifu, katika Golgotha. Lakini, k<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>liandik<strong>wa</strong> katika jumba kub<strong>wa</strong> la<br />

askofu kule Roma. Madanganyo na maandiko <strong>ya</strong> uwongo <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> katika miaka yote<br />

<strong>ya</strong>kihesabi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma. (Tazama k<strong>wa</strong> Mwisho <strong>wa</strong> Kitabu<br />

(Nyongezo), hati k<strong>wa</strong> ukarasa 37.)<br />

239


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Lakini ijapo <strong>wa</strong>lifan<strong>ya</strong> nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> kuanzisha utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kuu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>katubu k<strong>wa</strong>mba sabato inatoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Katika karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na sita baraza la Papa ikatangaza: “Acha<br />

Wakristo wote <strong>wa</strong>kumbuke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba siku <strong>ya</strong> saba ilitakas<strong>wa</strong> na Mungu, na ilikubali<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kushik<strong>wa</strong>, si k<strong>wa</strong> Wayuda tu, lakini na k<strong>wa</strong> wengine wote <strong>wa</strong>naodai kuabudu Mungu;<br />

inga<strong>wa</strong> sisi Wakristo tumebadilisha Sabato <strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na.”4 Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kiharibu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>najua tabia <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Mufano <strong>wa</strong> kushangaza <strong>wa</strong> mipango <strong>ya</strong> Roma ulitole<strong>wa</strong> katika mateso marefu <strong>ya</strong> mauaji<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> Waldenses (Vaudois), wengine <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shika Sabato. (Tazama Nyongezo.)<br />

Historia <strong>ya</strong> makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Ethiopia na Abyssinia ni <strong>ya</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong> kipekee. Katikati <strong>ya</strong> huzuni<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Miaka <strong>ya</strong> Giza, Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> Afrika <strong>ya</strong> Kati <strong>wa</strong>lifichama k<strong>wa</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> dunia na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kasahauli<strong>wa</strong> na ulimwengu na k<strong>wa</strong> karne nyingi <strong>wa</strong>kafurahia uhuru katika imani <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Mwishoni Roma ikajifunza juu <strong>ya</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o, na mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Abyssinia akadangany<strong>wa</strong> hata<br />

akakubali Papa kama mjumbe mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Amri ikatole<strong>wa</strong> kukataza kushik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Sabato chini <strong>ya</strong> malipizi makaii1] Lakini uonevu <strong>wa</strong> Papa (kanisa la Roma) k<strong>wa</strong> upesi<br />

uka<strong>wa</strong> nira <strong>ya</strong> kutia uchungu sana ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Abyssinia <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia kuivunja.<br />

Wakuu <strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>kafukuzi<strong>wa</strong> mbali k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>o na imani <strong>ya</strong> zamani ikarudish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wakati makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Afrika <strong>ya</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kishika Sabato katika utii k<strong>wa</strong> amri za<br />

Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>kaepuka na kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche) k<strong>wa</strong> kufuatana na desturi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kanisa. Roma ikavunja Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> kujiinua mwenyewe, lakini makanisa <strong>ya</strong><br />

Afrika, <strong>ya</strong>kajificha karibu miaka elfu moja, ha<strong>ya</strong>kushirikiana k<strong>wa</strong> uasi huu. Walipolet<strong>wa</strong><br />

chini <strong>ya</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>kalazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuweka pembeni kweli na kutukuza sabato <strong>ya</strong> uwongo.<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> upesi <strong>wa</strong>lipopata tena uhuru <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>karudia kutii amri <strong>ya</strong> ine. (Tazama<br />

Nyongezo).<br />

Mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naonyesha <strong>wa</strong>zi uadui <strong>wa</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>simamizi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Neno la Mungu linafundisha <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutendeka tena k<strong>wa</strong> namna kukariri<strong>wa</strong> kama vile Wakatoliki na Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong>najiunga<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutukuza siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche).<br />

Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> Pembe Mbili Mfano <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo<br />

Unabii <strong>wa</strong> Ufunuo 13 unatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> pembe mbili mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

m<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo atafan<strong>ya</strong> “dunia na <strong>wa</strong>naokaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke” kuabudu kanisa la Rome--<br />

lililofananish<strong>wa</strong> na mn<strong>ya</strong>ma “aliku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> chui. “Mn<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> pembe mbili itasema<br />

vilevile “<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia, kufanyia sanamu yule mn<strong>ya</strong>ma”. Tena, naye<br />

ana<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> wote, “<strong>wa</strong>dogo na <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>, na matajiri na maskini na <strong>wa</strong>huru na <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong>,”<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pokee chapa cha mn<strong>ya</strong>ma. Ufunuo 13:11-16. Amerika ni uwezo uliofananish<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

n<strong>ya</strong>ma yule <strong>wa</strong> pembe mbili mfano <strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo. Unabii huu utatimilika <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

Mwungano <strong>wa</strong> mataifa <strong>ya</strong> Amerika <strong>wa</strong>takapokaza kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche),<br />

ambayo Roma inadai kama hakikisho k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

240


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

“Nikaona kimoja cha vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>ke, kama kimeti<strong>wa</strong> kidonda cha kufa; kidonda chake<br />

cha kufa kikapona; dunia yote ikastaajabia mn<strong>ya</strong>ma yule”. Ufunio 13:3. Kidonda cha kufa<br />

kinaonyesha kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma (Papa) katika m<strong>wa</strong>ka 1798. Baada <strong>ya</strong> hii, asema<br />

nabii, “kidonda chake cha kufa kikapona: na dunia yote ikastaajabia n<strong>ya</strong>ma yule”. Paulo<br />

akataja <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba “m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> uharibifu” ataendelea na kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mwisho kabisa <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati”. 2 Tesalonika 2:3-8. Na “<strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>naokaa juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tam<strong>wa</strong>budu, <strong>wa</strong>le, majina <strong>ya</strong>o ha<strong>ya</strong>kuandik<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu cha uzima”. Ufunuo 13:8.<br />

Katika Ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> Zamani na mp<strong>ya</strong>, kanisa la Papa litapokea heshima k<strong>wa</strong> heshima<br />

iliyotole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche).<br />

Tangu katikati <strong>ya</strong> karne <strong>ya</strong> kumi na tisa, <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> unabii <strong>wa</strong>meonyesha ushuhuda<br />

huu k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu. Sasa tunaona maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> upesi k<strong>wa</strong> utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> unabii. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> Waprotestanti kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na madai <strong>ya</strong> namna moja <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche), na ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> namna moja <strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong><br />

maandiko, kama k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la Roma (Papa). Tangazo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba hukumu za<br />

Mungu zinafikia <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuvunja sabato <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (di-manche)<br />

litarudili<strong>wa</strong>: ta<strong>ya</strong>ri linaanza kulazimish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Ni ajabu k<strong>wa</strong> werevu, Kanisa la Roma. Linaweza kusoma kitu gani kinapas<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>--<strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti <strong>ya</strong>natoa heshima <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> Roma <strong>wa</strong>napokubali sabato<br />

<strong>ya</strong> uwongo na <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>najita<strong>ya</strong>risha kuikaza k<strong>wa</strong> namna kanisa lenyewe lilifan<strong>ya</strong><br />

katika siku zilizopita. K<strong>wa</strong> upesi gani litapata usaada <strong>wa</strong> Waprotestanti katika kazi hii si<br />

vigumu kuele<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Kanisa la Wakatoliki <strong>wa</strong> Roma linafan<strong>ya</strong> muungano mkub<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Papa,<br />

mamilioni <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong>ke katika kila inchi <strong>wa</strong>naagiz<strong>wa</strong> utii k<strong>wa</strong> Papa, hata taifa lao liwe<br />

la namna gani <strong>wa</strong>la serkali <strong>ya</strong>o. Ijapo <strong>wa</strong>naweza kuapa kiapo kuahidi uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> serikali,<br />

lakini kinyume cha hii kunaku<strong>wa</strong> kiapo <strong>wa</strong>la naziri <strong>ya</strong> uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Roma.<br />

Historia inashuhudia juu <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong> uerevu <strong>wa</strong> Roma kujiingiza mwenyewe katika<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> mataifa, kuweza kupata ustawi, kuendesha makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe, hata k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Ni majivuno <strong>ya</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong>mba hawezi kubadili kamwe. Waprotestanti ha<strong>wa</strong>jui<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nalolifan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napokusudia kukubali usaada <strong>wa</strong> Roma k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kutukuza siku <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche). K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>navyoelekea k<strong>wa</strong> kusudi lao, Roma inakusudia<br />

kuimarisha mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke, kujipatia tena uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke uliopotea. Acha kanuni k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

liimarishwe na kanisa liweze kuta<strong>wa</strong>la uwezo <strong>wa</strong> serikali; na desturi za dini ziweze<br />

kukaz<strong>wa</strong> na sheria za dunia; k<strong>wa</strong> kifupi, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kanisa na <strong>ya</strong> serikali<br />

itata<strong>wa</strong>la zamirina ushindi <strong>wa</strong> Roma umehakikish<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Jamii <strong>ya</strong> Waprotestanti itajifunza namna gani makusudi <strong>ya</strong> Roma inavyoku<strong>wa</strong>, ila tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati unapokwisha kupita k<strong>wa</strong> kuepuka mtego. Linasitawi k<strong>wa</strong> utulivu katika mamlaka.<br />

241


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>natumia mvuto katika vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> sheria, katika makanisa, na katika<br />

mioyo <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Linaimarisha nguvu zake kuendesha maangamizo <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>kati mda<br />

utakapofika k<strong>wa</strong> kushangaza. Yote linayotumaini (kanisa) ni mahali pafaapo. Ye yote<br />

atakayeamini na kutii Neno la Mungu atapata laumu na mateso.<br />

242


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 36. Migogoro Inayokaribia<br />

Tangu m<strong>wa</strong>nzo kabisa <strong>wa</strong> vita kub<strong>wa</strong> mbinguni, kusudi daima la Shetani liliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuvunja sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> yeye kufikia kusudi lake ni kukataa sheria yote ama kukataa<br />

moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> amri zake, matokeo <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> namna moja. Mtu anayekosa “katika neno moja<br />

tu” anaonyesha zarau k<strong>wa</strong> sheria yote; mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke na mfano <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong><br />

kosa; anaku<strong>wa</strong> mwenye kukosa juu <strong>ya</strong> yote”. Yakobo 2:10.<br />

Shetani amepotesha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivi makosa <strong>ya</strong>kaingia katika imani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> maelfu. Mapigano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho kati <strong>ya</strong> ukweli na uwongo ni juu <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu, kati <strong>ya</strong> Biblia na dini <strong>ya</strong> uwongo na mambo <strong>ya</strong> asili. Biblia inafikia wote, lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>chache tu <strong>wa</strong>naoikubali kama kiongozi cha uzima. Katika kanisa wengi <strong>wa</strong>nakana nguzo<br />

za imani <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Uumbaji, kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> mtu, upatanisho <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> kufa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke, na sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu huta<strong>wa</strong>li<strong>wa</strong> yote ao sehemu. Maelfu <strong>wa</strong>naizania ku<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> uzaifu kuweka tumaini kamili katika Biblia.<br />

Ni rahisi kufan<strong>ya</strong> sanamu na maelezo <strong>ya</strong> uwongo kama kufan<strong>ya</strong> sanamu <strong>ya</strong> mti ao jiwe.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kueleza Mungu viba<strong>ya</strong>, Shetani anaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kumzania katika tabia <strong>ya</strong> uwongo.<br />

Sanamu <strong>ya</strong> utilivu imewek<strong>wa</strong> katika pahali pa Mungu mwenye uhai kama anavyofunili<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika Neno lake, katika Kristo, na katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> uumbaji. Mungu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu hodari wengi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tunga mashairi, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> siasa, <strong>wa</strong>andishi <strong>wa</strong> habari k<strong>wa</strong> magazetu-<strong>wa</strong> vyuo vikub<strong>wa</strong><br />

(universités) vingi, hata <strong>wa</strong>v<strong>ya</strong>ma v<strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na za Mungu na dini (théologie) ni<br />

afazali kidogo kuliko Bali, mungu <strong>wa</strong> jua <strong>wa</strong> Foiniki katika siku za Eli<strong>ya</strong>. Hapana kosa<br />

linalofika k<strong>wa</strong> ujasiri zaidi juu <strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, hapana linaloku<strong>wa</strong> mba<strong>ya</strong> zaidi<br />

katika matukio <strong>ya</strong>ke, kuliko mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu haina na masharti<br />

tena. Ufikiri <strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>huduma wenye kujulikana <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kifundisha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong><br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> sheria zinazota<strong>wa</strong>la inchi <strong>ya</strong>o haziku<strong>wa</strong> za lazima, <strong>ya</strong> kama zilizuia mambo <strong>ya</strong> uhuru<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na hai<strong>wa</strong>pashwi kutii<strong>wa</strong>; muda gani <strong>wa</strong>tu kama <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>ngevumili<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

mimbara?<br />

Ingeku<strong>wa</strong> muaminifu zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> mataifa kuvunja sheria zao kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

viumbe vyote kutangua sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke. Jaribio la kufan<strong>ya</strong> nafasi sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu lilijaribi<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika Ufransa <strong>wa</strong>kati kukana Mungu ulipoku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la. Ilionyesh<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> kutupa amri ambazo Mungu aliamuru ni kukubali kanuni <strong>ya</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong><br />

uovu.<br />

Kuweka Kando Sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naofundisha <strong>wa</strong>tu kutunza sheria za Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> urahisi <strong>wa</strong>napanda uasi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuvuna uasi. Kuacha amri iliyoamuri<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kuweka yote kando, na sheria<br />

za kibinadamu k<strong>wa</strong> upesi hazitajali<strong>wa</strong>. Matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kutangua amri za Mungu ingeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama hazikutumaini<strong>wa</strong>. Mali ha<strong>ya</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> tena na usalama. Watu <strong>wa</strong>ngekamata milki <strong>ya</strong><br />

jirani zao k<strong>wa</strong> jeuri, na <strong>wa</strong>lio hodari zaidi <strong>wa</strong>ngeku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tajiri kuliko. Maisha yenyewe<br />

243


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>ngeheshimi<strong>wa</strong> Kiapo cha ndoa hakingedumu tena ku<strong>wa</strong> kama boma k<strong>wa</strong> kulinda<br />

jamaa. Yeye aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo angekamata mke <strong>wa</strong> jirani <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> jeuri. Amri <strong>ya</strong> tano<br />

ingeku<strong>wa</strong> kando pamoja na <strong>ya</strong> ine. Watoto ha<strong>wa</strong>ngekataa kukamata maisha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zazi <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

kama k<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> vile <strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kupata tamaa <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o iliyoharibika. Ulimwengu<br />

uliostaarabika ungeku<strong>wa</strong> kundi la wezi na <strong>wa</strong>uaji <strong>wa</strong> siri, na amani na furaha ingekomesh<strong>wa</strong><br />

duniani.<br />

Ta<strong>ya</strong>ri mafundisho ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>mefungua milango <strong>ya</strong> uovu ulimwenguni. Bila sheria na uovu<br />

vinafiagia kama pepo kali <strong>ya</strong> kip<strong>wa</strong>. Hata katika nyumba za <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> Wakristo<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> unafiki, mvunjo <strong>wa</strong> urafiki, usaliti <strong>wa</strong> matumaini matakatifu, upendeleo <strong>wa</strong><br />

tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong>. Kanuni za dini, msingi <strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> ushirika, unaonekana <strong>wa</strong> kutikisika sana<br />

karibu kuanguka. Wavunja sheria <strong>wa</strong>ovu mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>wa</strong>nafany<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kupokea<br />

mambo <strong>ya</strong> uangalifu kama k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>lifikia sifa nzuri. Matangazo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>metole<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>o. Mtambo <strong>wa</strong> kupiga chapa unatangaza maelezo <strong>ya</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong> uovu, kuingiza<br />

wengine katika madanganyo, wizi, na uuaji. Kupumbazuka k<strong>wa</strong> kosa, kukosa ku<strong>wa</strong> na kiasi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutisha na uzalimu <strong>wa</strong> namna yo yote ulipasa kuamsha mambo yote. Ni kitu gani<br />

kinaweza kufanyika kuzuia mwendo <strong>wa</strong> uovu?<br />

Kukosa Kiasi Kumetia Wengi Katika Mashaka<br />

Baraza za hukumu zimeharibika, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>mevut<strong>wa</strong> na tamaa k<strong>wa</strong> faida na upendo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> anasa za mambo <strong>ya</strong> uasherati. Kukosa kiasi kumetia wengi katika mashaka hivyo<br />

Shetani ameku<strong>wa</strong> na uta<strong>wa</strong>la karibu kamili juu <strong>ya</strong>o. Wana sheria <strong>wa</strong>mapotosh<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>navut<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> feza (rush<strong>wa</strong>), <strong>wa</strong>medanganyika. Ulevi na ulafi, udanganyifu <strong>wa</strong> kila<br />

namna, unaonekana miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naosimamia sheria. Sasa Shetani hawezi tena<br />

kulinda ulimwengu chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kuzuia Maandiko, anatumia njia zingine<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza kusudi lile lile moja. K<strong>wa</strong> kuharibu imani katika Biblia ni kutumia pia<br />

kuharibu Biblia yenyewe.<br />

Ni kama katika miaka <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitumika katika makanisa kuendelesha<br />

mashauri <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> kupinga mambo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>ya</strong>siyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi katika<br />

Maandiko, <strong>wa</strong>natumia maelezo ambayo <strong>ya</strong>napenda kueneza mbegu za mashaka. Kushikama<br />

na k<strong>wa</strong> kosa la Papa la maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong> asili na ufahamu <strong>wa</strong> mtu katika mauti,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nakataa ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> kipekee juu <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa<br />

kurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisme). Mafundisho <strong>wa</strong> maumivu<br />

maba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> milele <strong>ya</strong>meongoza wengi ku<strong>wa</strong> kutoamini Biblia. K<strong>wa</strong> madai <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ine<br />

<strong>ya</strong>navyoshurutisha, inaoonekana <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> kushika Sabato <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> saba kunaamri<strong>wa</strong>; na<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> namna inavyoku<strong>wa</strong> njia moja tu k<strong>wa</strong> kujiokoa wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> shuguli ambayo ha<strong>wa</strong>taki<br />

kuifan<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote <strong>wa</strong>katupilia mbali sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na Sabato pamoja.<br />

Kama matengenezo <strong>ya</strong> Sabato inavyoenea, kukataa huku k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuepuka amri <strong>ya</strong> ine kutaku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kuenea pote. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>nafungua mlango<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kumkana Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa kurudi na kujionyesha na<br />

244


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisme), na zarau k<strong>wa</strong> sheria takatifu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu-daraka la kutisha<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> uovu unaoku<strong>wa</strong>ko katika jamii la Kikristo.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni jamii lilelile linalodai <strong>ya</strong> kama mkazo <strong>wa</strong> kushika siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche)<br />

kungesitawisha mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>hali <strong>ya</strong> kijamii. Ni moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> mashauri <strong>ya</strong> Shetani<br />

kuchangan<strong>ya</strong> uwongo na ukweli shauri laonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> njema. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> mwendo <strong>wa</strong><br />

siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche) <strong>wa</strong>ngeshindania matengenezo ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>nahitaji, kanuni<br />

katika umoja pamoja na Biblia; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati ambao kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na madai pamoja na hizi<br />

kinyume k<strong>wa</strong> sheria za Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke ha<strong>wa</strong>wewzi kujiunga pamoja nao. Hakuna<br />

kitu kinachoweza kuthibitika kuweka kando amri za Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> amri za <strong>wa</strong>tu.<br />

Katika makosa mawili makub<strong>wa</strong>, kutokufa k<strong>wa</strong> nafsi na utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

(dimanche), Shetani ataleta <strong>wa</strong>tu chini <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo <strong>ya</strong>ke. Wakati kosa la k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

linapowek<strong>wa</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na<br />

kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisma), kosa la mwisho hufan<strong>ya</strong> kifungo cha huruma pamoja na<br />

Roma. Waprotestanti <strong>wa</strong> Umoja <strong>wa</strong> Mataifa <strong>ya</strong> Kiamerika <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kunyoosha<br />

mikono <strong>ya</strong>o ngambo <strong>ya</strong> shimo kub<strong>wa</strong> kushika mkono <strong>wa</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>likufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu (Spiritualisme); <strong>wa</strong>kifikia k<strong>wa</strong> shimo<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> kukumbatia mikono na mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Roma. Na chini <strong>ya</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong> umoja huu <strong>wa</strong><br />

mara tatu, inchi hii itafuata katika hatua za Roma k<strong>wa</strong> kukan<strong>ya</strong>nga haki za zamiri.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisme) , inaku<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo mkub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>. Shetani yeye<br />

mwenyewe “hujigeuza”. Ataonekana kama malaika <strong>wa</strong> nuru. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea na <strong>wa</strong>tu, miujiza itafanyika,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>taponyesh<strong>wa</strong>, na maajabu mengi <strong>ya</strong>siyokukanish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>tafanyika.<br />

Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kiroma <strong>wa</strong>naojisifu juu <strong>ya</strong> miujiza ku<strong>wa</strong> alama <strong>ya</strong> kanisa la kweli<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tadanganyika upesi k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo huu <strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> miujiza; na Waprotestanti,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napokwisha kutupia mbali ngao <strong>ya</strong> ukweli, <strong>wa</strong>tadanganyika vile vile. Wafuasi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa<br />

la Roma, Waprotestanti, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>pendao anasa za dunia <strong>wa</strong>taonekana vivyo hivyo katika<br />

umoja huu mabadiliko makub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisme), Shetani hutokea kama mtenda mema <strong>wa</strong> kabila, kuponyesha<br />

magonj<strong>wa</strong> na kuonyesha ka<strong>wa</strong>ida mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> dini, lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati ule ule anaongoza<br />

wengi k<strong>wa</strong> maangamizi. Kukosa kiasi kunaondoa akili; mapendeleo <strong>ya</strong> anasa, vita, na<br />

kum<strong>wa</strong>nga damu hufuata. Vita huamsha tamaa mba<strong>ya</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong> nafsi na kufutia k<strong>wa</strong> milele<br />

mateka <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>lioloanish<strong>wa</strong> katika uovu na damu. Nikusudi la Shetani kuchochea mataifa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> vita, k<strong>wa</strong>ni anaweza kupotosha <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> mata<strong>ya</strong>risho <strong>ya</strong> kusimama k<strong>wa</strong> siku ile <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu.<br />

245


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Shetani amejifunza siri za maumbile, na anatumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke wote kuta<strong>wa</strong>la m<strong>wa</strong>nzo<br />

kadiri Mungu anavyoruhusu. Ni Mungu anayelinda viumbe v<strong>ya</strong>ke kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> mharibu.<br />

Lakini jamii <strong>ya</strong> Ukristo limeonyesha zarau k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke, na B<strong>wa</strong>na atafan<strong>ya</strong> kile<br />

alichotangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba-angeondoa ukingaji <strong>wa</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoasi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke na kukaza wengine kufan<strong>ya</strong> pamoja. Shetani anaku<strong>wa</strong> na uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> wote<br />

ambao Mungu asio <strong>wa</strong>linda k<strong>wa</strong> kipekee. Atasaidia na kusitawisha wengine, ili kuzidisha<br />

makusudi <strong>ya</strong>ke wenyewe; na ataleta taabu k<strong>wa</strong> wengine, na kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kuamini <strong>ya</strong><br />

kama ni Mungu ndiye anaye<strong>wa</strong>tesa.<br />

Anapotokea kama tabibu mkuu anayeweza kupon<strong>ya</strong> magonj<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>o yote, Shetani ataleta<br />

ugonj<strong>wa</strong> na msiba hata miji <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ingie k<strong>wa</strong> maangamizi. Katika misiba baharini na<br />

inchini, katika mateketeo makub<strong>wa</strong>, katika tufani kali na mvua <strong>ya</strong> mawe, katika zoruba,<br />

garika, kimbunga, mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> maji kujaa, na tetemeko la inchi, katika namna maelfu,<br />

Shetani anatumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Anaondolea mbali mavuno yenye kukomea yote, na njaa na<br />

taabu hufuata. Huga<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>a <strong>ya</strong> mauti angani, na maelfu huangamia.<br />

Ndipo mdanganyifu mkub<strong>wa</strong> atashawishi <strong>wa</strong>tu kutwika taabu zao zote k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na utii k<strong>wa</strong> amri za Mungu ni laumu la daima k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kosaji. Itatangaz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>namkosea Mungu juu <strong>ya</strong> mvunjo <strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba zambi hii<br />

imeleta misiba ambayo haitakoma hata kushika k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kutakapo kaz<strong>wa</strong> kabisa.<br />

“Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoharibu heshima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>nazuia kurudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

majali<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na kufanyiki<strong>wa</strong>”. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo mashitaki <strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> zamani juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tumushi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>ya</strong>takariri<strong>wa</strong>. “Wakati Ahaba alipomuona Eli<strong>ya</strong>, Ahaba<br />

akam<strong>wa</strong>ambia: Ni wewe mwenye kutaabisha Israeli”? 1 Wafalme 18:17,18. Uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> miujiza utatumia mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naomtii Mungu kuliko <strong>wa</strong>tu. “Pepo”<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tatangaza <strong>ya</strong> kama Mungu ame<strong>wa</strong>tuma kusadikisha <strong>wa</strong>naokataa siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kosa lao. Watalilia uovu mkub<strong>wa</strong> ulimwenguni na kusaidia ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> dini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kama hali iliopoteza cheo cha mafundisho imalet<strong>wa</strong> na ukufuru <strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

Chini <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Roma, <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioteseka k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> habari njema <strong>wa</strong>lishitaki<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama <strong>wa</strong>tenda maovu katika mapatano pamoja na Shetani. Ndivyo hivyo itakavyoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

sasa. Shetani ataletea <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoheshimu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kushitaki<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoleta hukumu duniani. K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> kutisha anajaribu kuta<strong>wa</strong>la zamiri, anasukuma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> dini na <strong>wa</strong> dunia kukaza sheria za kibinadamu katika kuasi sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoheshimu Sabato <strong>ya</strong> Biblia <strong>wa</strong>tashitaki<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>wa</strong> sheria na ukim<strong>ya</strong>,<br />

kuvunja amri za maana za kijamii, kuleta machafuko <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong>la na makosa, na<br />

kuita hukumu za Mungu inchini. Watashitaki<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> chuki k<strong>wa</strong> serekali. Wajumbe<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naokana kanuni <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>taonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> mimbara shuguli <strong>ya</strong> utii k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> dunia. Katika vyumba vikub<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> sheria na baraza za hukumu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri <strong>wa</strong>tahukumi<strong>wa</strong>. Rangi <strong>ya</strong> uwongo itatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maneno <strong>ya</strong>o; maana<br />

mba<strong>ya</strong> kuliko itawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mashitaki <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

246


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wakuu <strong>wa</strong> kanisa na serekali <strong>wa</strong>tajiiunga k<strong>wa</strong> kushawishi ao kushurutisha wote<br />

kuheshimu siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Hata katika <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Kiamerika wenye uhuru na wenye<br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>wa</strong>takubali matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> kukaza kushika siku<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Uhuru <strong>wa</strong> zamiri ambao umegaramish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kafara kub<strong>wa</strong> hauta heshimi<strong>wa</strong><br />

tena. Katika kuja k<strong>wa</strong> karibu k<strong>wa</strong> shindano tutaona kuonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> mfano maneno <strong>ya</strong> nabii,<br />

“Joka akakasirikia yule m<strong>wa</strong>namke, akakwenda zake kufan<strong>ya</strong> vita juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zao <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liobaki, <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu, na ku<strong>wa</strong> na ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Yesu Kristo”. Ufunuo<br />

12:17.<br />

247


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 37. Maandiko - Mlinda Yetu Pekee<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko kama mlinda usalama <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> kupinga<br />

mvuto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> uongo na roho za giza. Shetani hutumia kila shauri lo lote<br />

iwezekanavyo kuzuia <strong>wa</strong>tu kupokea maarifa <strong>ya</strong> Biblia, k<strong>wa</strong> usemi ao maneno <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>ziinafunua madanganyifu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Madanganyo makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho ni karibu kufunguli<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbele yetu. Mpinga Kristo atafan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ajabu mbele <strong>ya</strong> macho yetu k<strong>wa</strong> ukaribu<br />

kutaku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> kufanana na iliyo <strong>ya</strong> kweli ambayo itaku<strong>wa</strong> haiwezekani kutofautisha<br />

kati <strong>ya</strong>o isipoku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Maandiko. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naojitahidi kutii amri zote za Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taping<strong>wa</strong> na kuzarauli<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> kuvumilia jaribu, <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu mapenzi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu kama inavyofunili<strong>wa</strong> katika Neno lake. Hapana mtu bali <strong>wa</strong>le ambao <strong>wa</strong>maimarisha<br />

akili k<strong>wa</strong> kweli za Biblia <strong>wa</strong>takaosimama katika vita kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> kusulibi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke mwokozi alielezea <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kama alipash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuua<strong>wa</strong> na kufufuka tena. Lakini maneno <strong>ya</strong>liondole<strong>wa</strong> mbali kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> ma<strong>wa</strong>zo <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi. Wakati jaribu lilipofika, kifo cha Yesu kikaharibu kabisa matumaini <strong>ya</strong>o kama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba haku<strong>wa</strong>on<strong>ya</strong> mbele. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo katika mambo <strong>ya</strong> unabii na <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao<br />

umefunuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele yetu k<strong>wa</strong> kama ulivyofunuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi na Kristo<br />

mwenyewe. Tukio zinazo ambatana na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kufung<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> majaribu na kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mata<strong>ya</strong>risho k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong>naonyesh<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi. Lakini wengi ha<strong>wa</strong>naufahamu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kweli hizi za maana sana, na <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu utafika uta<strong>wa</strong>kuta <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri.<br />

Wakati Mungu anapotuma maonyo, anaagiza kila mtu kujali<strong>wa</strong> na sababu k<strong>wa</strong> kukubali<br />

ujumbe. Hukumu za kutisha juu <strong>ya</strong> kuabudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke(Ufunuo 14:9-11)<br />

inapash<strong>wa</strong> kuongoza wote kujifunza namna alama <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma inavyoku<strong>wa</strong> na namna gani<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuepuka kuipokea. Lakini jamii <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong>taki ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Biblia, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu unazuia<br />

tamaa za moyo <strong>wa</strong> zambi. Shetani anatoa mambo <strong>ya</strong> udanganyifu <strong>wa</strong>naopenda.<br />

Lakini Mungu ataku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takaodumisha Biblia, na ni Biblia peke <strong>ya</strong>ke, kama<br />

ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>ya</strong> mafundisho yote na msingi <strong>wa</strong> matengenezo yote. Nia za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza,<br />

matoleo <strong>ya</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> kweli, makusudi <strong>ya</strong> baraza za kanisa, sauti <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi-hakuna<br />

moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kuzani<strong>wa</strong> kama ushahidi k<strong>wa</strong> kukubaliana ao kutokubali<br />

mafundisho yo yote. Inatupasa kudai zahiri “B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema hivi”. Shetani anaongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

kutazama k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji, k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> elimu <strong>ya</strong> tabia na sifa za Mungu na dini kama<br />

viongozi v<strong>ya</strong>o, badala <strong>ya</strong> kuchunguza Maandiko <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe. K<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>ongozi<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>, anaweza kuvuta wengi.<br />

Wakati Kristo alipokuja, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida <strong>wa</strong>limsikia k<strong>wa</strong> furaha. Lakini mkuu <strong>wa</strong><br />

ukuhani na <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>kajiingiza <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe katika uzalimu; <strong>wa</strong>kakataa<br />

ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Umasi<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke. “Namna gani inaku<strong>wa</strong>”, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>kauliza, “<strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la<br />

wetu na <strong>wa</strong>ndishi <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza ha<strong>wa</strong>amini Yesu? Waalimu kama <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioongoza taifa la<br />

Wayuda kukataa Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

248


Kutukuza Mamlaka Ya Kibinadamu<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Kristo aliku<strong>wa</strong> na maoni <strong>ya</strong> unabii k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> kutukuza mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu<br />

kuta<strong>wa</strong>la zamiri, ambalo liliku<strong>wa</strong> jambo la laana la kitisha katika vizazi vyote. Maonyo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke si kufuata viongozi vipofu <strong>wa</strong>liowek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukumbusho kama onyo la upole k<strong>wa</strong><br />

vizazi <strong>wa</strong>kati vijavyo.<br />

Kanisa la Roma linawek<strong>wa</strong> akiba <strong>ya</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> kutafsiri Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> mapadri. Inga<strong>wa</strong><br />

matangenezo ilitoa Maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> wote, lakini kanuni <strong>ya</strong> namna moja iliyoshik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Roma inazuia wengi katika makanisa <strong>ya</strong> Kiprotestanti kutochunguza Biblia <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe.<br />

Wanafundish<strong>wa</strong> kukubali mafundusho <strong>ya</strong>ke kama ilivyofasiri<strong>wa</strong> na kanisa. Maelfu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nasubutu kutopata kitu, lakini ni <strong>wa</strong>zi katika maandiko, ile inayoku<strong>wa</strong> kinyume k<strong>wa</strong><br />

imani <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Wengi <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kutoa nafsi zao k<strong>wa</strong> mapadri. Wanapita mbali <strong>ya</strong> mafundusho<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi karibu bila kuony<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini je, <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hudumu <strong>wa</strong>sioweza kukosa?<br />

Namna gani tunaweza kutumaini uongozi <strong>wa</strong>o isipoku<strong>wa</strong> tunajua kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Neno la<br />

Mungu <strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chukuaji <strong>wa</strong> nuru? Ukosefu <strong>wa</strong> uhodari <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho<br />

unasukuma wengi kufuata <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza, na <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kufung<strong>wa</strong> bila ku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

matumaini katika kosa. Wanaona ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu katika Biblia na <strong>wa</strong>nasikia uwezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu kufikia matangazo jake, huku <strong>wa</strong>kiruhusu mapadri ku<strong>wa</strong>rudisha kutoka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> nuru. Shetani anafunga wengi ku<strong>wa</strong>funga na kamba za hariri za upendo k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> adui za msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kristo. Kifungo hiki kinaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> cha <strong>wa</strong>zazi, cha jamii,<br />

cha ndoa ao ujamii <strong>wa</strong> jamaa nyingi ku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja. Nafsi chini <strong>ya</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>o hauna uhodari<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kutii nia za<strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wengi hudai <strong>ya</strong> kama si kitu cho chote mtu anachoamini, kama tu maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong><br />

kamili. Lakini maisha <strong>ya</strong>nafany<strong>wa</strong> na imani. Kama ukweli unaku<strong>wa</strong> ndani unafikia kipimo<br />

na tunauzarau, tunaukataa k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, kuchagua giza badala nuru.<br />

Ujinga hauachiliwi k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kosa la zambi, kama pale kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na nafasi yo yote,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kujua mapenzi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mtu mmoja anayesafiri anafika mahali ambapo panaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

njia nyingi na mti wenye mkono <strong>wa</strong> kuonyesha njia mahali gani kila moja inaongoza. Kama<br />

akizarau alama na kukamata njia yo yote inayoonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> haki, angeweza ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>kini, lakini katika kubahatisha kule kote atapatikana mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> njia mba<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Shuguli <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>nza na <strong>ya</strong> Juu Sana<br />

Haitoshi ku<strong>wa</strong> na makusudi mema, kufan<strong>ya</strong> kitu mtu anachofikiri ku<strong>wa</strong> cha haki ao kite<br />

muhuduma anacho<strong>wa</strong>ambia ku<strong>wa</strong> cha haki. Anapash<strong>wa</strong> kuchunguza maandiko k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe. Anaku<strong>wa</strong> na amani inayoonyesha kila alama <strong>ya</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> safari <strong>ya</strong> kwenda<br />

mbinguni, na hapashwe kuamini kitu cho chote.<br />

249


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ni <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na <strong>ya</strong> juu sana k<strong>wa</strong> kila kiumbe chenye akili kujifunza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Maandiko mambo inayoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli, ndipo kutembea katika nuru na kutia wengine moyo<br />

kufuata mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke. Inatupasa kutengeneza nia zetu sisi wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

tutakavyojibu sisi wenyewe mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>liojifunza, k<strong>wa</strong> ujanja <strong>wa</strong> hekima kub<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>nafundisha <strong>ya</strong> kama Maandiko<br />

<strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na siri, maana <strong>ya</strong> kiroho si <strong>ya</strong> kutambulikana katika lugha iliyotumi<strong>wa</strong>. Watu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> ni <strong>wa</strong>alimu <strong>wa</strong> uwongo. Lugha <strong>ya</strong> Biblia inapash<strong>wa</strong> kuelez<strong>wa</strong> kufuata maana <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

zahiri, ila tu kama mfano ao picha inatumi<strong>wa</strong>. Kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngekamata tu Biblia kama<br />

inavyosom<strong>wa</strong>, kazi ingetimiz<strong>wa</strong> ambayo ingeleta maelfu katika zizi la Kristo maelfu juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

maelfu <strong>wa</strong>naotangatanga katika makosa. Sehemu nyingi za Maandiko ambazo wenye<br />

hekima <strong>wa</strong>nazozania kutoku<strong>wa</strong> za maana zinajaa na faraja k<strong>wa</strong> yeye anayefundish<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

shule la Kristo. Ufahamu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> Biblia hauko zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo akili iliolet<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uchunguzi kama k<strong>wa</strong> umoja <strong>wa</strong> kusudi, tamaa <strong>ya</strong> juhudi baada <strong>ya</strong> haki.<br />

Matokeo <strong>ya</strong> Zarau <strong>ya</strong> Maombi na Kujifunza Biblia<br />

Biblia haipashwi kujifunz<strong>wa</strong> pasipo maombi. Roho Mtakatifu peke <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

anayetuwezesha kuona umuhimu <strong>wa</strong> vitu rahisi kufahami<strong>wa</strong>, ao kutuzuia kupotoa mambo<br />

magumu <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Malaika <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>nata<strong>ya</strong>risha moyo kufahamu Neno la Mungu.<br />

Tutapendez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> uzuri <strong>wa</strong>ke, kugombez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maonyo <strong>ya</strong>ke na kuti<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na ahadi<br />

zake. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara majaribu huonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> na nguvu nyingi sana k<strong>wa</strong> sababu yule<br />

aliyejaribi<strong>wa</strong> hawezi mara hiyo kukumbuka ahadi za Mungu na kukutana na Shetani<br />

anayeku<strong>wa</strong> na silaha za Maandiko. Lakini malaika <strong>wa</strong>nazunguka <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotaka<br />

kufundish<strong>wa</strong>, na <strong>wa</strong>taleta k<strong>wa</strong> ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong>o ukweli unayohitaji<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

“Yeye ata<strong>wa</strong>fundisha ninyi vitu vyote, na ku<strong>wa</strong>kumbusha ninyi vitu vyote<br />

niliyo<strong>wa</strong>ambia ninyi”. Yoane 14:26. Lakini mafundusho <strong>ya</strong> Kristo <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

kuwek<strong>wa</strong> katika akili ili Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu a<strong>ya</strong>lete katika ukumbusho wetu katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

hatari.<br />

Ajali <strong>ya</strong> makutano mengi sana inaku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kukusudi<strong>wa</strong>. Kila mshiriki <strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

inampasa kudai k<strong>wa</strong> bidii: “B<strong>wa</strong>na unataka nifanye nini”? Matendo 9:6. Inatupasa sasa<br />

kutafuta maarifa <strong>ya</strong> ndani na <strong>ya</strong> nguvu katika vitu v<strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Hatuna na <strong>wa</strong>kati k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupoteza. Tunaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> udongo <strong>wa</strong> kupendeza <strong>wa</strong> Shetani. Zamu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu usilale!<br />

Wengi hushangilia <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> matendo maba<strong>ya</strong> ambayo <strong>wa</strong>siyo<strong>ya</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong>.<br />

Haitoshi <strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>o ni miti katika bustani <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Ina<strong>wa</strong>pasa kuzaa matunda. Katika<br />

vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>naandik<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>limaji <strong>wa</strong> udongo. K<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liozarau<br />

rehema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>katumia viba<strong>ya</strong> neema <strong>ya</strong>ke, moyo na upendo <strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu ungali<br />

ukitetea.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong> mvua hakuna tofauti <strong>ya</strong> kuonekana kati <strong>ya</strong> miti na miti ingine; lakini <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kip<strong>wa</strong> na upepo na majira <strong>ya</strong> baridi inapofika, miti isiyokauka inadumu imara <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

250


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

miti ingine inapo ponoa majani <strong>ya</strong>o. Acha upinzani uamke, acha kutovumilia kutikisika<br />

tena, acha mateso i<strong>wa</strong>shwe, na mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>siyo na bidii na <strong>ya</strong> unafiki ikubali imani; lakini<br />

Mkristo <strong>wa</strong> kweli atasimama imara, imani <strong>ya</strong>ke kuzidi ku<strong>wa</strong> hodari; tumaini lake kuzidi<br />

kungaa, kuliko siku za mafani-kio.<br />

“Maana ataku<strong>wa</strong> kama mti uliopand<strong>wa</strong> kando <strong>ya</strong> maji, unaofikisha mizizi <strong>ya</strong>ke karibu <strong>ya</strong><br />

mto; hautaona woga <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> jua kali linapokuja, lakini majani <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> mabichi;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>la hautahangaika m<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>wa</strong> uchache <strong>wa</strong> mvua, <strong>wa</strong>la hautaacha kuzaa matunda”,<br />

Yeremia 17:8.<br />

251


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 38. Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu Ulio <strong>wa</strong> Mwisho<br />

“Nyuma <strong>ya</strong> maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> nikaona malaika mwingine akishuka kutoka mbinguni,<br />

mwenye mamlaka kub<strong>wa</strong>; na dunia ikangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Akalia k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kub<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

akisema: Umeanguka, umeanguka Babeli ule mkub<strong>wa</strong>, umeku<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> mashetani, na<br />

boma la kila pepo mchafu na boma la kila ndege mchafu mwenye kuchukiza;<br />

Na nikasikia sauti nyingine toka mbinguni ikisema: Tokeni k<strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu,<br />

musishirikiane na zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>la musipokee mapigo <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Ufunuo 18:1,2,4. Matangazo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyofany<strong>wa</strong> na malaika <strong>wa</strong> pili <strong>ya</strong> Ufunuo 14 (fungu 8) ni <strong>ya</strong> kukariri<strong>wa</strong>, pamoja na mtajo<br />

mwingine <strong>wa</strong> machafuko <strong>ya</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>kiingia katika Babeli tangu ujumbe ulipotole<strong>wa</strong> mara<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza.<br />

Hali <strong>ya</strong> kitisha inaelez<strong>wa</strong> hapa. K<strong>wa</strong> kila kukataa k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli akili za <strong>wa</strong>tu zitaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

giza sana, mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o mikaidi zaidi. Wataendelea kukan<strong>ya</strong>nga moja<strong>wa</strong>po <strong>ya</strong> maagizo <strong>ya</strong><br />

amri kumi hata <strong>wa</strong>napotesa <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoishika ku<strong>wa</strong> takatifu. Kristo anawek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sifuri<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> zarau lililowek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Neno lake na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Ungamo la dini litaku<strong>wa</strong> ni tendo la kudangan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuficha uovu <strong>wa</strong> msingi kabisa.<br />

Uaminifu katika imani <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> roho za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokufa hurudi na kujionyesha na kuongea<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>tu (spiritualisme) inafungua mlango k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> mashetani, na k<strong>wa</strong> hivyo<br />

mvuto <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> utaonekana katika makanisa. Babeli umejaza kipimo cha zambi<br />

zake, na maangamizo ni karibu kuanguka.<br />

Lakini Mungu akingali na <strong>wa</strong>tu katika Babeli, na <strong>wa</strong>aminifu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kuit<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoka ili <strong>wa</strong>sishirikiane na zambi zake na “<strong>wa</strong>sipokee mapingo <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Malaika anashuka<br />

toka mbinguni kuangazia dunia k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke na kutangaza zambi za Babeli. Mwito<br />

umesikilika: “Tokeni k<strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu”. Matangazo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> onyo <strong>ya</strong> mwisho<br />

kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia.<br />

Nguvu za dunia, kuungana k<strong>wa</strong> vita kupinga amri za Mungu, zitaamuru <strong>ya</strong> kama “wote,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>dogo na <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>, na matajiri na masikini na <strong>wa</strong>huru na <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong>” (Ufunuo 13:16)<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takubali desturi za kanisa k<strong>wa</strong> kushika sabato <strong>ya</strong> uwongo. Wote <strong>wa</strong>naokataa mwishoni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tatangaz<strong>wa</strong> wenye kustahili mauti. K<strong>wa</strong> upande mwingine, sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inaagiza<br />

siku <strong>ya</strong> pumziko <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inaon<strong>ya</strong> hasira juu <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naovunja amri zake.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> matokeo, ndivyo ilivyolet<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, ye yote atakayekan<strong>ya</strong>nga juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na kutii sheria <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu anapokea alama <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma, ishara <strong>ya</strong><br />

uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo anaouchagua kutii badala <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Mtu a<strong>wa</strong>ye yote akimsujudu<br />

huyo mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke, yeye naye atakuny<strong>wa</strong> katika mvinyo <strong>wa</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

iliyotengenez<strong>wa</strong>, pasipo kuchangany<strong>wa</strong> na maji, katika kikombe cha hasira <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Ufunuo<br />

14:9,10.<br />

252


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Hakuna mmoja anayeteseka na hasira <strong>ya</strong> Mungu mpaka kweli inapokwisha kulet<strong>wa</strong><br />

nyumbani k<strong>wa</strong> moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke na zamiri na inapokatali<strong>wa</strong>. Wengi ha<strong>wa</strong>kupata kamwe bahati <strong>ya</strong><br />

kusikia mambo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> kipekee k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu. Yeye anayesoma kila moyo hataacha<br />

mmoja anayetamani kweli kudangany<strong>wa</strong> kama matokeo <strong>ya</strong> mashindano. Kila mmoja<br />

anapash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na nuru <strong>ya</strong> kutosha kufan<strong>ya</strong> mpango <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> akili.<br />

Jaribu Kub<strong>wa</strong> la Uaminifu<br />

Sabato, jaribu kub<strong>wa</strong> la uaminifu, ni ukweli hasa unaoping<strong>wa</strong>. Huku kushika sabato <strong>ya</strong><br />

uwongo kutaku<strong>wa</strong> neno la kukiri la utii k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>nayo mpinga Mungu, kushika k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Sabato <strong>ya</strong> kweli ni ushahidi <strong>wa</strong> uaminifu k<strong>wa</strong> Muumba. Wakati kundi moja linapopokea<br />

alama <strong>ya</strong> n<strong>ya</strong>ma, lingine hupokea muhuri <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Maonyo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kukosa uvumulivu <strong>wa</strong> dini kungepata uta<strong>wa</strong>la, <strong>ya</strong> kama kanisa na<br />

serkali <strong>wa</strong>ngetesa <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshika amri za Mungu, <strong>ya</strong>ngetangaz<strong>wa</strong> pasipo sababu na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

upuzi. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna kushika k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche) kunatikis<strong>wa</strong> mahali<br />

pengi sana, jambo lililoku<strong>wa</strong> halikusadiki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu linaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> karibu, na<br />

ujumbe utaleta tukio ambalo lisingaliweza ku<strong>wa</strong>ko mbele.<br />

Katika kila kizazi Mungu ametuma <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong>ke kukemea zambi ulimwenguni na<br />

katika kanisa. Watengenezaji (réformateurs) wengi, k<strong>wa</strong> kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>kakusudia<br />

kutumia busara nyingi katika kushambulia zambi za kanisa na za taifa. Wakatumainia, k<strong>wa</strong><br />

mfano <strong>wa</strong> maisha safi <strong>ya</strong> Kikristo, kuongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia. Lakini Roho <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu akaja juu <strong>ya</strong>o; pasipo hofu <strong>ya</strong> matokeo, ha<strong>wa</strong>kuweza kuzuia kuhubiri mafundisho<br />

zahiri <strong>ya</strong> Biblia.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo ujumbe utatangaz<strong>wa</strong>. B<strong>wa</strong>na atatumika k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> vyombo vinyenyekevu<br />

vinavyojitia <strong>wa</strong>kuf wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Watumukaji <strong>wa</strong>tastahilish<strong>wa</strong> zaidi k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupak<strong>wa</strong> mafuta <strong>ya</strong> roho Mtakatifu kuliko k<strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>ma v<strong>ya</strong> vitabu. Watu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>talazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuendelea mbele na juhudi takatifu , kutangaza maneno ambayo Mungu<br />

anayotoa. Zambi za Babeli zitafunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Watu <strong>wa</strong>tashitush<strong>wa</strong>. Maelfu ha<strong>wa</strong>jasikia kamwe<br />

maneno kama ha<strong>ya</strong>. Babeli ni kanisa, lililoanguka k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> zambi zake, k<strong>wa</strong> sababu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kukataa k<strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli. Jinsi vile <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>navyo kwenda k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong>o na<br />

mas<strong>wa</strong>li “je, mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> ni hivyo”? Wahubiri <strong>wa</strong>naonyesha mifano k<strong>wa</strong> kutuliza zamiri<br />

iliyoamsh<strong>wa</strong>. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna wengi <strong>wa</strong>napouliza zahiri “B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema hivi”, kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mapadri <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi itaamsha makutano <strong>ya</strong>nayopenda zambi k<strong>wa</strong> kutukana na kutesa<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>nao tangaza.<br />

Mapadri <strong>wa</strong>tatumia juhudi zaidi za kupita uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kibinada-mu k<strong>wa</strong> kufungia mbali<br />

nuru, k<strong>wa</strong> kuzuia mabishano <strong>ya</strong> mas<strong>wa</strong>li ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maana sana. Kanisa linaomba k<strong>wa</strong> mkono<br />

hodari <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> serikali, na katika kazi hii, <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong> kanisa la kiroma na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>protestanti huungana. K<strong>wa</strong> namna mwenendo <strong>wa</strong> mkazo <strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche)<br />

unapoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> nguvu zaidi, <strong>wa</strong>shikaji <strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>wa</strong>tatish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kulipa feza na kifungo.<br />

253


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wengine <strong>wa</strong>natole<strong>wa</strong> vyeo v<strong>ya</strong> mvuto na wengine za<strong>wa</strong>di zingine k<strong>wa</strong> kukana imani <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Lakini jibu lao ni “Mtuonyeshe kutoka katika Neno la Mungu kosa letu”. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioshitaki<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> baraza <strong>wa</strong>nafan<strong>ya</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> ukweli, na wengine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nao<strong>wa</strong>sikia huongoz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kukata shauri la kushika amri zote za Mungu. Kama sivyo<br />

maelfu ha<strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kujua kitu juu <strong>ya</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kweli.<br />

Utii k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu ungetende<strong>wa</strong> kama uasi. Mzazi atatumia ukali k<strong>wa</strong> mtoto mwenye<br />

kuamini. Watoto <strong>wa</strong>taondole<strong>wa</strong> katika urithi na kufukuz<strong>wa</strong> kutoka nyumbani. “Na wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naotaka kuishi maisha <strong>ya</strong> uta<strong>wa</strong> katika Kristo Yesu <strong>wa</strong>tapata mateso”. 2 Timoteo 3:12.<br />

Ku<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>teteaji <strong>wa</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong>napokataa kuheshimu siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche)<br />

wengine <strong>wa</strong>taingiz<strong>wa</strong> gerezani, wengine <strong>wa</strong>tahamish<strong>wa</strong>, wengine <strong>wa</strong>tatende<strong>wa</strong> kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tum<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> namna roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu atakavyoondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu hapo kutaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> kigeni. Moyo unaweza ku<strong>wa</strong> na jeuri sana <strong>wa</strong>kati uchaji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na<br />

upendo <strong>ya</strong>napoondole<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Machafuko Yanakaribia<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna machafuko <strong>ya</strong>navyokaribia, jamii kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>lioungama imani katika<br />

ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu, lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kutakasi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> utii k<strong>wa</strong> ukweli, <strong>wa</strong>taacha<br />

nia <strong>ya</strong>o na kujiunga k<strong>wa</strong> upinzani. K<strong>wa</strong> kujiunga pamoja na ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong>mefikia kuona<br />

mambo karibu <strong>ya</strong> nuru <strong>ya</strong> namna moja, na <strong>wa</strong>nachagua upande <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wengi. Watu ambao<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>wa</strong>lifurahi katika ukweli <strong>wa</strong>natumia kipa<strong>wa</strong> chao na hadizi za kupendeza k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuongoza viba<strong>ya</strong> roho. Wanaku<strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>wa</strong>kali <strong>wa</strong> ndugu zao <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza. Waasi ha<strong>wa</strong> ni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> shetani k<strong>wa</strong> kueleza viba<strong>ya</strong> na kushitaki <strong>wa</strong>naoshika Sabato na<br />

kuchochea <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>pinga.<br />

Watumishi <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>metoa onyo. Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ime<strong>wa</strong>lazimisha.<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>kushauriana na faida zao za mda, <strong>wa</strong>la ha<strong>wa</strong>kutafuta kulinda sifa <strong>ya</strong>o ao maisha <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Kazi inaonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> mbali kabisa na uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o kuitimiza. K<strong>wa</strong>ni ha<strong>wa</strong>wezi kurudi<br />

nyuma. Kuona uzaifu <strong>wa</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>nakimbilia k<strong>wa</strong> Mwenye Uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> kutaka nguvu.<br />

N<strong>ya</strong>kati mbalimbali katika historia zimeonyesh<strong>wa</strong> na maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> ukweli <strong>wa</strong> kipekee,<br />

uliofanyiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mahitaji <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule. Kila ukweli mp<strong>ya</strong> umefan<strong>ya</strong><br />

namna <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> upinzani. Mabalozi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jibu <strong>wa</strong>o na<br />

kuacha matokeo k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Upinzani Umeongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> Kimo Kip<strong>ya</strong><br />

Jinsi ushindani umeongezeka k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu nyingi; <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nahangaika<br />

tena, k<strong>wa</strong>ni inaonekana k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>meleta taabu. Lakini zamiri na Neno la Mungu<br />

vina<strong>wa</strong>hakikishia <strong>ya</strong> kama mwenendo <strong>wa</strong>o ni <strong>wa</strong> haki. Imani <strong>ya</strong>o na uhodari umeongezeka<br />

pamoja na ujushi. Ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o ni “Kristo ameshinda nguvu za dunia, je, tutaogopa<br />

ulimwengu uliokwisha kushind<strong>wa</strong>”?<br />

254


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Hakuna mtu anayeweza kutumikia Mungu pasipo kujiweka k<strong>wa</strong> kosa yeye mwenyewe<br />

kinyume cha ushindani <strong>wa</strong> majeshi <strong>ya</strong> giza. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>tamshambulia, kukilisha<br />

hatari <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke unapata mawindo kutoka mikononi m<strong>wa</strong>o. Waovu <strong>wa</strong>tatafuta<br />

kumtenga k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> majaribu <strong>ya</strong> kutamanisha. Wakati ha<strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong>faulu, uwezo<br />

hutumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kushurutisha zamiri.<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna Yesu anavyodumu ku<strong>wa</strong> Muombezi <strong>wa</strong> mtu katika pahali patakatufu<br />

juu, mvuto unaozuia <strong>wa</strong> Roho Mtakatifu huonekana k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la na <strong>wa</strong>tu. Wakati<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la wetu wengi <strong>wa</strong>napoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> Shetani, Mungu vivyo hivyo<br />

anaku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>ke miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naongoja katika taifa. Watu <strong>wa</strong>chache<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tadumu k<strong>wa</strong> kuzuia maendeleo <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong> uovu. Ushindaji <strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>wa</strong> ukweli utazui<strong>wa</strong><br />

ili ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu uweze kufan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Onyo la mwisho litasimamisha<br />

uangalifu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ongozi, na wengine <strong>wa</strong>talikubali nakusimama pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu.<br />

Mvua Ya Mwisho Na Kilio Cha Nguvu<br />

Malaika anayeungana na malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu ni k<strong>wa</strong> kuangazia dunia yote na utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza ulipelek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> makao yote <strong>ya</strong> utumishi ulimwenguni, na<br />

katika inchi zingine kuliku<strong>wa</strong> na usikizi <strong>wa</strong> dini kub<strong>wa</strong> sasa ulioshuhudi<strong>wa</strong> tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

matengenezo. Lakini hizi zinapash<strong>wa</strong> kupita k<strong>wa</strong> onyo la mwisho la malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu.<br />

Kazi itaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna moja na ile <strong>ya</strong> Siku <strong>ya</strong> Pentecote. “Mvua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza” ilitole<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kufungua <strong>wa</strong> habari njema kuwezesha kuotesha mbegu <strong>ya</strong> damani; vivyo hivyo “mvua<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mwisho” itatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kuiv<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mavuno. Hosea 6:3; Yoeli 2:23.<br />

Kazi kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> habari njema si <strong>ya</strong> kufunga na onyesho ndogo zaidi la uwezo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

kuliko kutazama m<strong>wa</strong>nzo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Unabii uliotimia katika kumimini<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mvua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kufungua k<strong>wa</strong> habari njema <strong>ya</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kutimia vile vile katika mvua <strong>ya</strong> mwisho<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Hapo ndipo panaku<strong>wa</strong> “n<strong>ya</strong>kati za ufufuko” ambazo mtume Petro aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitazamia<br />

mbele. Matendo 3:19, 20.<br />

Watumishi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, nyuso zao kungaa na utakaso mtakatifu, <strong>wa</strong>taharikisha toka<br />

mahali mbali mbali kutangaza habari njema kutoka mbinguni. Miujiza itafanyika, <strong>wa</strong>gonj<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>taponyesh<strong>wa</strong>. Shetani vivyo hivyo anatumika na maajabu <strong>ya</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, hata kushusha<br />

moto kutoka mbinguni. Ufunuo 13:13. K<strong>wa</strong> hivyo <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia <strong>wa</strong>tashawishi<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchagua upandeunao ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Ujumbe huu utachukuli<strong>wa</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> mabishano sana ni k<strong>wa</strong> tendo lauhakikisho <strong>wa</strong> ndani<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. Mabishano <strong>ya</strong>meonyesh<strong>wa</strong>, vitabu vilitumia mvuto <strong>wa</strong>vyo, lakini<br />

wengi <strong>wa</strong>mezui<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kufahamu kabisa ukweli. Sasa ukweli umeonekana <strong>wa</strong>zi kabisa.<br />

Mahusiano <strong>ya</strong> ujamaa, mahusiano <strong>ya</strong> kanisa ni zaifu kudumu ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ana <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu sasa. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong>liochanganyika kupinga ukweli, hesabu kub<strong>wa</strong> huchukua<br />

kituo chao k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na.<br />

255


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

256


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 39. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> Taabu<br />

“K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule Mikaeli atasimama, Mfalme Mkub<strong>wa</strong> anayesimama k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko; na kutaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu, kama usivyoku<strong>wa</strong> mbele tangu <strong>wa</strong>kati taifa<br />

lilipoku<strong>wa</strong> hata <strong>wa</strong>kati ule: na k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ule <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko <strong>wa</strong>taponyesh<strong>wa</strong>, kila mtu<br />

atakayeonekana ameandik<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu.” Danieli 12:1.<br />

Wakati ujumbe <strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> tatu unamalizika, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>metimiza<br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong>o. Wamepokea, “mvua <strong>ya</strong> mwisho” na <strong>wa</strong>najita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> saa <strong>ya</strong> kujaribi<strong>wa</strong><br />

inayoku<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>o. Jaribu la mwisho limekwisha kulet<strong>wa</strong> duniani, na wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liohakikish<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tiifu (<strong>wa</strong>aminifu) k<strong>wa</strong> amri za Mungu <strong>wa</strong>mepokea “muhuri <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu aliye hai.” Ndipo Yesu anapomaliza uombezi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika Pahali patakatifu kule juu<br />

na kusema k<strong>wa</strong> sauti kuu, “Imefanyika”.<br />

“Yeye aliye muzalimu azidi ku<strong>wa</strong> muzalimu; na mwenye uchafu azidi ku<strong>wa</strong> mchafu; na<br />

mwenye haki azidi kufan<strong>ya</strong> haki; na mtakaifu azidi kutakas<strong>wa</strong>”: Ufunuo 22:11. Kristo<br />

amefan<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke na amefutia mbali zambi zao. “Na ufalme na<br />

mamlaka, na ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> falme chini <strong>ya</strong> mbingu” (Danieli 7:27) ni karibu kutole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>riti <strong>wa</strong> wokovu, na Yesu kuta<strong>wa</strong>la kama Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> mab<strong>wa</strong>na.<br />

Wakati anapoacha Pahali patakatifu, giza inafunika <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia. Wenye haki<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kuishi machoni pa Mungu Mtakatifu pasipo mwombezi. Kizuio juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu<br />

kimeondole<strong>wa</strong>, na Shetani anaku<strong>wa</strong> na mamlaka kamili juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siotubu. K<strong>wa</strong> mwisho<br />

Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu imeondole<strong>wa</strong>. Ndipo Shetani anatumbukiza <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia katika taabu<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> mwisho. Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naacha kushika k<strong>wa</strong> kuzuia pepo kali <strong>ya</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>nadamu. Ulimwengu wote utahusika katika maangamizo <strong>ya</strong> kuogopesha zaidi kuliko <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lifika juu <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema <strong>ya</strong> zamani. Hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> majeshi sasa ta<strong>ya</strong>ri,<br />

zinangoja tu ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, kueneza uki<strong>wa</strong> po pote.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naoheshimu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>tazani<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> mateso <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuogopesha na um<strong>wa</strong>ngaji <strong>wa</strong> damu ambavyo vinajaza dunia k<strong>wa</strong> taabu. Uwezo uliofatana<br />

na onyo la mwisho umekasirisha <strong>wa</strong>ovu, na Shetani atachochea roho <strong>ya</strong> uchuki na mateso<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>liopokea ujumbe.<br />

Wakati ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuliondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> taifa la Wayuda, <strong>wa</strong>kuhani na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liendele<strong>ya</strong> kujizania wenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>teule <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Utumishi katika hekalu<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikiendelea; siku k<strong>wa</strong> siku baraka <strong>ya</strong> Mungu iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikitaki<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye<br />

kosa <strong>ya</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Vivyo hivyo <strong>wa</strong>kati hukumu isiyobadilika <strong>ya</strong> Pahali<br />

patakatifu inapokwisha kutangaz<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu uliku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kuwek<strong>wa</strong><br />

milele, <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia ha<strong>wa</strong>taitambua. Ka<strong>wa</strong>ida za dini zitaku<strong>wa</strong> zikiendelesh<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le ambao Roho <strong>ya</strong> Mungu imeondole<strong>wa</strong>; juhudi <strong>ya</strong> shetani k<strong>wa</strong> kutimiza nia zake mba<strong>ya</strong><br />

atachukua mfano <strong>wa</strong> juhudi <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

257


Wakati <strong>wa</strong> Taabu <strong>ya</strong> Yakobo<br />

<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna Sabato inavyoku<strong>wa</strong> jambo la upekee la ushindani po pote katika jamii <strong>ya</strong><br />

Wakristo wote, italazimish<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>naosimama katika upinzani k<strong>wa</strong><br />

kanisa na serekali ha<strong>wa</strong>pashwi kuvumili<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ni bora k<strong>wa</strong>o kutes<strong>wa</strong> kuliko<br />

mataifa yote kutup<strong>wa</strong> katika fujo. “Inafaa kwetu ka<strong>ya</strong>fa akasema mtu mmoja afe k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu, na k<strong>wa</strong> hiyo taifa lote lisiangamie”, Yoane 11:50. Neno hili litaonekana la<br />

kutibitisha; amri mwishoni itatole<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotukuza Sabato <strong>ya</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ine,<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>shitaki na kutoa uhuru k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu baada <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati fulani ku<strong>wa</strong>ua. Kanisa la Roma k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> mkufuru <strong>wa</strong> Kiprotestanti katika ulimwengu <strong>wa</strong> sasa atafuata njia<br />

ileilne. Watu <strong>wa</strong> zamani na Mungu <strong>wa</strong>tatumbukuz<strong>wa</strong> katika musukosuko hiyo <strong>ya</strong> taabu<br />

inaonyesha kama <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>kobo. Yeremia 30:5-7.<br />

Usiku <strong>wa</strong> Yakobo <strong>wa</strong> uchungu, <strong>wa</strong>kati alipo shindana katika maombi k<strong>wa</strong> kuokole<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Esau (M<strong>wa</strong>nzo 32:24-31) inaonyesha tendo la <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu.<br />

Sababu <strong>ya</strong> udanganyifu uliotumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kupatabaraka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> baba <strong>ya</strong>keambayo<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong> Esau, Yakobo alikimbia, alipojulish<strong>wa</strong>juu <strong>ya</strong> vitisho v<strong>ya</strong> kifo vilivyofany<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

ndugu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Baada <strong>ya</strong> kukaa miaka nyingi mbali na k<strong>wa</strong>o, akachagua kurudi inchini <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

asili. Alipofikamipakani akajaz<strong>wa</strong> na hofu k<strong>wa</strong> habari <strong>ya</strong> kumkaribia Esau, akahakikisha<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> nduguye atalipisha kisasi. Tumaini pekee la Yakobo liliku<strong>wa</strong> ni rehema za Mungu;<br />

ulinzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kipekee ulipash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> ni maombi.<br />

Peke <strong>ya</strong>ke pamoja na Mungu, akaungama zambi zake k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu sana. Taabu<br />

katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke ilifika. Katika giza akaendelea kuomba. Gafula mkono ukawek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

bega lake. Akafikiri k<strong>wa</strong>mba adui ndiye aliku<strong>wa</strong> akitafuta maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zote za<br />

kukata tamaa akapigana k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu na adui <strong>wa</strong>ke. Wakati siku ilipoanza kucha, mgeni<br />

akatumia nguvu zisizoku<strong>wa</strong> za kibinadamu. Yakobo akaonekana kukauka na akaanguka,<br />

muombaji zaifu, mwenye kulia k<strong>wa</strong> shingo la mshindani <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> siri. Akajua nyuma <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliku<strong>wa</strong> malaika <strong>wa</strong> agano aliyeku<strong>wa</strong> akigombana naye. Alidumu katika majuto<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke; sasa anapash<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na matumaini <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

alisamehe<strong>wa</strong>. Malaika akasihi sana, “Uniache niende, ni mapambazuko”, lakini mzee mkuu<br />

akapandisha sauti, “Sitakuacha kwenda mpaka utakaponibariki”. Yakobo akaungama uzaifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke na kutostahili k<strong>wa</strong>ke, huku akatumainia rehema za Mungu mwenye kulinda maagano.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> toba na kujitoa, kiumbe hiki cha mauti na mwenye zambi akashindana na<br />

Mtukufu <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni.<br />

Shetani akamshitaki Yakobo mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke; akashawishi<br />

Esau kusafiri na kinyume chake. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> usiku <strong>wa</strong> mzee mkuu <strong>wa</strong> kushindana, Shetani<br />

akajaribu kumkatisha tamaa na kuvunja tumaini lake k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Alivut<strong>wa</strong> karibu kukata<br />

tamaa; lakini akatubu k<strong>wa</strong> kweli juu <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke na kushikilia Malaika imara<br />

nakaendelea na maoni <strong>ya</strong>ke pamoja na vilio v<strong>ya</strong> juhudi hata akashinda.<br />

258


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> namna Shetani alivyomshitaki Yakobo, ataendelea na masitaka <strong>ya</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Anaku<strong>wa</strong> na taarifa sahihi <strong>ya</strong> zambi alizoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>jaribu nazo kutenda na<br />

anatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong> haki hawezi ku<strong>wa</strong>samehe zambi zao k<strong>wa</strong>ni kum<strong>wa</strong>ngamiza na<br />

malaika zake. Anadai <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tolewe mikononi m<strong>wa</strong>ke kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na anamruhusu ku<strong>wa</strong>jaribu iwezekanavyo. Tumaini lao k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, imani <strong>ya</strong>o,<br />

itajaribi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukali. Wanapo jikumbusha <strong>ya</strong>lipopita, imani <strong>ya</strong>o inazama, k<strong>wa</strong>ni k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maisha <strong>ya</strong>o yote <strong>wa</strong>naweza uzuri ndogo. Shetani anajaribu ku<strong>wa</strong>tisha k<strong>wa</strong> mafikara ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kezi zao hakuna matumaini. Anatumaini pia kuharibu imani <strong>ya</strong>o ili <strong>wa</strong>jitoe k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu na<br />

kugeuza utii <strong>wa</strong>o kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Maumivu Makuu ambao Mungu Atalaumi<strong>wa</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni maumivu ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nateseka nayo si hofu <strong>ya</strong> mateso.<br />

Wanaogopa <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba katika kosa fulani ndani <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>tashind<strong>wa</strong> kupata<br />

utimilifu <strong>wa</strong> ahadi <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi: “Mimi nitakulinda, utoke katika saa <strong>ya</strong> kujaribi<strong>wa</strong> iliyo<br />

ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kufikia dunia yote”. Ufunuo 3:10. Je, <strong>wa</strong>ngeonekana kuthibitish<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>siostahili<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong>o wenyewe <strong>ya</strong> tabia, ndipo jina takatifu la Mungu lingelaumi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Wanaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> toba <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliopita <strong>wa</strong> zambi zao nyingi na kuomba ahadi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwokozi: “Ao ashike nguvu zangu, afanye salama nami; Ndiyo afanye salama nami”.<br />

Ysa<strong>ya</strong> 27:5. Ijapo kuteseka k<strong>wa</strong> mashaka na msiba, ha<strong>wa</strong>achi maombezi <strong>ya</strong>o. Wanaweka<br />

mshiko <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kama Yakobo alivyoweka mshiko <strong>wa</strong> Malaika; na msemo <strong>wa</strong> roho zao ni<br />

“Sitakuacha kwenda, kama haunibariki.”<br />

Zambi Zilifutili<strong>wa</strong> Mbali<br />

Katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu, kama <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na zambi zisizoungam<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>napoteseka na hofu na maumivu makali, <strong>wa</strong>ngezamish<strong>wa</strong>. Kukata<br />

tamaa kungaliondoa imani <strong>ya</strong>o, na ha<strong>wa</strong>ngeweza kumuomba Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wokovu.<br />

Lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kuficha maovu k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>ya</strong>funua. Zambi zao zimetangulia k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu na<br />

zimefutili<strong>wa</strong> mbali, na ha<strong>wa</strong>taweza kuzikumbuka.<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na anaonyesha katika matendo <strong>ya</strong>ke pamoja na <strong>ya</strong>le <strong>ya</strong> Yakobo <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ginsi yo yote hawezi kuvumilia uovu. Wote <strong>wa</strong>naoachilia ao kuficha zambi zao na<br />

kuziruhusu kudumu katika vitabu v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni bila kuziungama na bila kusamehe<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tashind<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani. Zaidi <strong>wa</strong>napoheshimu nia <strong>wa</strong>napoishikilia, ni uhakikisho <strong>wa</strong><br />

ushindi adui <strong>wa</strong>oa. Wale <strong>wa</strong>naochelewesha mata<strong>ya</strong>risho ha<strong>wa</strong>taweza ku<strong>ya</strong>pata <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong><br />

hatari, <strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>kati wo wote unaofuata. Kesi za wote kama <strong>wa</strong>le ni bila tumaini.<br />

Historia <strong>ya</strong> Yakobo pia ni matumaini <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu hatatupa <strong>wa</strong>le ambao,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liodangany<strong>wa</strong> katika zambi, na <strong>wa</strong>merudi k<strong>wa</strong>ke na toba <strong>ya</strong> kweli. Mungu atatuma<br />

malaika ku<strong>wa</strong>fariji <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> katika hatari. Jicho la B<strong>wa</strong>na ni juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

259


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Ndimi za moto <strong>ya</strong> tanuru inaonekana karibu ku<strong>wa</strong>teketeza, lakini Mtakasaji ata<strong>wa</strong>leta kama<br />

zahabu iliyojaribi<strong>wa</strong> ao kutakas<strong>wa</strong> katika moto.<br />

Imani lnayovumilia<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong> taabu na maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong>nayoku<strong>wa</strong> mbele yetu <strong>ya</strong>tadai imani ile<br />

inayoweza kuvumilia ulegevu, kukawia, na njaa, imani ambayo haitalegea katika majaribu<br />

makali. Ushindi <strong>wa</strong> Yakobo ni ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong> kushurutisha. Wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takaoshikilia ahadi za Mungu, kama alivyofan<strong>ya</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tafaulu kama alivyofaulu.<br />

Kushindana na Mungu--namna gani <strong>wa</strong>chache <strong>wa</strong>naojua umuhimu <strong>wa</strong>ke! Wakati mawimbi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kukata tamaa <strong>ya</strong>napopita k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu juu <strong>ya</strong> mwombaji, namna gani <strong>wa</strong>chache<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nashikamana katika imani na ahadi za Mungu.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>naotumia imani ndogo tu sasa <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> katika hatari kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuanguka chini<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> Shetani. Na hata kama <strong>wa</strong>navumilia jaribu <strong>wa</strong>tatumbukia<br />

katika <strong>wa</strong>si<strong>wa</strong>si kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu k<strong>wa</strong> sababu ha<strong>wa</strong>kuifan<strong>ya</strong> kamwe ku<strong>wa</strong> zoezi la<br />

kumtumaini Mungu. Inatupasa sasa kutibitisha ahadi zake.<br />

Kila mara taabu ni kub<strong>wa</strong> linapofikiri<strong>wa</strong> aotend<strong>wa</strong> la mbele kuliko <strong>wa</strong>kati ule k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hakika linapash<strong>wa</strong> kutendeka ao kuonekana, lakini hii si kweli juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu<br />

unaoku<strong>wa</strong> mbele yetu. Maelezo mengi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi ha<strong>ya</strong>wezi kuikia ukub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> majaribu. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati ule <strong>wa</strong> shida kila nafsi inapash<strong>wa</strong> kusimama yenyewe mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu.<br />

Sasa, <strong>wa</strong>kati kuhani wetu Mkub<strong>wa</strong> anapofan<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho k<strong>wa</strong> ajili yetu, inatupasa<br />

kutafuta ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kamilifu katika Kristo. Si k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zo ambalo mwokozi wetu aliweza<br />

kuwezesh<strong>wa</strong> kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> majaribu. Shetani anapata ndani <strong>ya</strong> mioyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kibinadamu mahali padogo ambapo anaweza kupata tegemeo la kusimamisha mguu; tamaa<br />

fulani <strong>ya</strong> zambi inatunz<strong>wa</strong> pale, na k<strong>wa</strong> njia ambayo majaribu <strong>ya</strong>ke kusimamia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Lakini Kristo anajitangaza mwenyewe: “Mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> dunia hii anakuja; na yeye hana kitu<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong>ngu.” Yoane 14:30. Shetani hakuweza kupata kitu ndani <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

ambacho kingeweza kumwezesha kupata ushindi. Hapaku<strong>wa</strong> zambi ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke ambayo<br />

Shetani angeweza kutumia k<strong>wa</strong> faida <strong>ya</strong>ke. Hii ni ka<strong>wa</strong>ida ambayo inapash<strong>wa</strong> kujitenga<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>takaosimama katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu.<br />

Ni katika maisha ha<strong>ya</strong> ambayo tunapash<strong>wa</strong> kujitenga na zambi, katika imani k<strong>wa</strong> damu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kristo <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho. Mwokozi wetu <strong>wa</strong> damani anatualika kujiunga k<strong>wa</strong>ke sisi<br />

wenyewe, kuunga uzaifu wetu k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zake, kutostahili kwetu k<strong>wa</strong> matendo mema <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Inabaki kwetu kushirikiana mbingu katika kazi <strong>ya</strong> kulinganisha tabia zetu k<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu.<br />

Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani <strong>ya</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong> na uharibifu itafikia kipimo cha juu (mwisho) <strong>wa</strong>kati<strong>wa</strong><br />

taabu. Maono <strong>ya</strong> kuogof<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> tabia isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu karibu <strong>ya</strong>tafunuli<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

mbingu, k<strong>wa</strong> alama <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kazi za miujiza <strong>ya</strong> mashetani. Pepo <strong>wa</strong>ba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>taendelea<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> “falme za dunia” na k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu wote, ku<strong>wa</strong>shurtisha kuungana na Shetani katika<br />

260


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

mapigano <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho juu <strong>ya</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Watu <strong>wa</strong>tatokea kudai ku<strong>wa</strong> Kristo<br />

Mwenyewe. Watafan<strong>ya</strong> maajabu <strong>ya</strong> kupon<strong>ya</strong> na kujifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na mambo <strong>ya</strong> ufunuo<br />

kutoka mbinguni kupinga Maandiko.<br />

Kama tendo la kutukuz<strong>wa</strong> katika ukub<strong>wa</strong> hadithi iliotung<strong>wa</strong>makusudi <strong>ya</strong> kuingiz<strong>wa</strong><br />

kama mchezo mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> madanganyo, Shetani mwenyewe atajifan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> Kristo.<br />

Kanisa lilitazamia <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi kama utimilizo <strong>wa</strong> matumaini <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Sasa mshawishi mkub<strong>wa</strong> atafan<strong>ya</strong> kuonekana k<strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo amekuja. Shetani<br />

atajionyesha mwenyewe kama kiumbe chenye utukufu cha <strong>wa</strong>ngavu <strong>wa</strong> kushangaza,<br />

kufanana na sifa <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu katika Ufunuo. Ufunuo 1:13-15.<br />

Utukufu unaomzunguka unapita kila kitu ambacho macho <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu (<strong>wa</strong>naokufa)<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>jaona kamwe. Shangwe <strong>ya</strong> ushindi italia, “Kristo amekuja!” Watu <strong>wa</strong>tamsujudia .<br />

Atanyosha mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke juu na ku<strong>wa</strong>bariki. Sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke itaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kupendeza, lakini<br />

inapojaa na sauti tamu zinazofuatana. K<strong>wa</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong> huruma ataonyesha mambo mengine <strong>ya</strong><br />

kweli <strong>ya</strong> ‘’mbinguni <strong>ya</strong>liotamk<strong>wa</strong> na Mwokozi. Ataponyesha magonj<strong>wa</strong>, na baadaye, katika<br />

tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kujitia k<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong> Kristo, anajidai kuweza kubadili Sabato na kuiweka<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza (dimanche). Anatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshika siku <strong>ya</strong> saba<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> takatifu <strong>wa</strong>natukana jina lake. Hii ni madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> nguvu isiyoweza kuzui<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

mtu. Watu wengi <strong>wa</strong>natoa usikizi k<strong>wa</strong> mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> uchawi, <strong>wa</strong>kisema, Huu ni “uwezo<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu”, Matendo 8:10.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu Ha<strong>wa</strong>taongoz<strong>wa</strong> Viba<strong>ya</strong><br />

Lakini <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu ha<strong>wa</strong>taongoz<strong>wa</strong> viba<strong>ya</strong>. Mafundisho <strong>ya</strong> kristo huyu <strong>wa</strong> uwongo<br />

ha<strong>ya</strong>ako k<strong>wa</strong> mapatano na Maandiko. Baraka <strong>ya</strong>ke itatamk<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>abuduo <strong>wa</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke, ni kundi kabisa ambalo Biblia inatangaza <strong>ya</strong> K<strong>wa</strong>mba gazabu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

pasipo kuchangany<strong>wa</strong> itamimin<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Tena zaidi, Shetani hakuruhusi<strong>wa</strong> kuiga namna <strong>ya</strong> majilio <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Mwokozi ameon<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> madanganyo k<strong>wa</strong> jambo hili. “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> uwongo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tasimama, na manabii za uwongo, nao <strong>wa</strong>taonyesha alama kub<strong>wa</strong> na maajabu <strong>wa</strong>pate<br />

kudangan<strong>ya</strong> kama ikiwezekana, hata <strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong>... Basi kama <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>ambia ninyi:<br />

Tazama yeye ni jang<strong>wa</strong>ni; musitoke; Tazama, yeye ni katika vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> ndani nyumbani,<br />

musisadiki. K<strong>wa</strong> maana kama umeme unavyokuja toka mashariki na unaangaza hata<br />

mangaribi; hivi kuja k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu kutakavyoku<strong>wa</strong> vile”. Matayo 24:24-27.<br />

Utazame vilevile Matayo 25:31; Ufunuo 1:7; 1 Watesalonika 4:16,17. Kuja huku, hapo<br />

hakuna namna <strong>ya</strong> kuiga. Itashuhudi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu wote mzima.<br />

Ila <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong> juhudi tu <strong>wa</strong> Maandiko <strong>wa</strong>liokubali upendo <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>takaolind<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> nguvu <strong>ya</strong>nayofan<strong>ya</strong> dunia ku<strong>wa</strong> mateka. K<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Biblia<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tavumbua mdanganyi huyu k<strong>wa</strong> umbo la uwongo <strong>wa</strong>ke. Je, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu sasa<br />

261


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> wenye imara sana k<strong>wa</strong> Neno lake ili <strong>wa</strong>singejitoa k<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong> mashauri<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o? Je, katika shida <strong>ya</strong> namna hii, <strong>wa</strong>ngeshikamana k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia, na k<strong>wa</strong> Biblia pekee?<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> Kikristo <strong>wa</strong>takapotangaza agizo juu <strong>ya</strong> wenye kushika amri<br />

kuondole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> serkali na ku<strong>wa</strong>acha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotaka maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>o, <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>takimbia kutoka katika miji na vijiji na kushirikiana pamoja katika makundi,<br />

kukaa katika mahali pa uki<strong>wa</strong> sana na pa upekee. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>tapata kimbilio katika ngome za<br />

milima, kama Wakristo <strong>wa</strong> mabonde <strong>ya</strong> Piedmont (Vaudois). (Tazama sura <strong>ya</strong> ine). Lakini<br />

wengi katika mataifa yote na makundi yote, <strong>wa</strong> juu na chini, <strong>wa</strong>tajiri na maskini, weusi na<br />

weupe, <strong>wa</strong>tatup<strong>wa</strong> katika utum<strong>wa</strong> usio na haki kabisa na <strong>wa</strong> jeuri. Wapenzi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tapitia k<strong>wa</strong> siku za taabu kufungi<strong>wa</strong> ndani <strong>ya</strong> gereza <strong>ya</strong> fito za chuma, kupe<strong>wa</strong> hukumu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kuua<strong>wa</strong>, labda kuachi<strong>wa</strong> kufa katika giza, gereza la kuchukiza mno.<br />

Je, B<strong>wa</strong>na atasahau <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> saa hii <strong>ya</strong> majaribu? Je, alimsahau muaminifu Nuhu,<br />

Loti, Yusufu, Elia, Yeremia, ao Danieli? Inga<strong>wa</strong> adui <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong>sukuma k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu katika<br />

gereza, lakini kuta za gereza haziwezi kukata habari kati <strong>ya</strong> nafsi zao na Kristo. Malaika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takuja k<strong>wa</strong>o katika vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> kifungo v<strong>ya</strong> kipekee. Gereza itaku<strong>wa</strong> kama jumba la<br />

mfalme, na kuta za giza zitaangazi<strong>wa</strong> kama vile Paulo na Sila <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiimba usiku<br />

<strong>wa</strong> manane katika gereza <strong>ya</strong> Wafilipi.<br />

Hukumu za Mungu zitajia <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naotaka kuangamiza <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, azabu<br />

ni “tendo la kigeni”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 28:21; utazame vilevile Ezekieli 23:11. B<strong>wa</strong>na ni<br />

mwenye”rehema na mwenye neema, si mwepesi k<strong>wa</strong> hasira, mwema na kweli nyingi, ...<br />

akisamehe uovu na makosa na zambi”. Lakini “hataachilia wenye zambi hata kidogo”.<br />

Kutoka 34:6, 7; Nahamu 1:3. Taifa inalostahimili <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu, na linalojaza kipimo cha<br />

uovu <strong>wa</strong>ke, mwishoni litakuny<strong>wa</strong> kikombe cha hasira pasipo kuchangany<strong>wa</strong> na rehema.<br />

Wakati Kristo anapomaliza uombezi <strong>wa</strong>ke katika Pahali patakatifu, hasira (ghazabu)<br />

pasipo kuchangany<strong>wa</strong> itahofish<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoabudu mn<strong>ya</strong>ma itamimin<strong>wa</strong>. Mapigo<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Misri <strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna moja na hukumu zenye eneo kub<strong>wa</strong> zaidi zile ambazo<br />

zinapas<strong>wa</strong> kuanguka duniani mbele kabisa <strong>ya</strong> wokovu <strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Asema mfumbuzi: “Ikaanguka jipu mba<strong>ya</strong>, zito, juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye chapa <strong>ya</strong> mn<strong>ya</strong>ma, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioabudu sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke. “Bahari “ikaku<strong>wa</strong> damu kama damu <strong>ya</strong> mfu”. Na “mito na<br />

chemchemi za maji; zikaku<strong>wa</strong> damu”. Malaika anatangaza: “Wewe mwenye haki, B<strong>wa</strong>na,<br />

... k<strong>wa</strong> sababu umehukumu hivi. K<strong>wa</strong>ni <strong>wa</strong>lim<strong>wa</strong>ga damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu na <strong>ya</strong> manabii,<br />

nawe ume<strong>wa</strong>pa damu kuny<strong>wa</strong>; nao <strong>wa</strong>mestahili”. Ufunuo 16:2-6. K<strong>wa</strong> kuhukumu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mauti, k<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>mehesabi<strong>wa</strong> makosa <strong>ya</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>o kama<br />

ingem<strong>wa</strong>gika na mikono <strong>ya</strong>o. Kristo alitangaza k<strong>wa</strong> Wa<strong>ya</strong>hudi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>ke kosa <strong>ya</strong><br />

damu yote <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>takatifu iliyom<strong>wa</strong>gika tangu siku za Abeli (Matayo 23:34-36). K<strong>wa</strong>ni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> na roho <strong>ya</strong> namna moja kama <strong>wa</strong>uaji ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> manabii.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> pigo linalofuata, uwezo unatole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> jua “kuunguza <strong>wa</strong>tu k<strong>wa</strong> moto”. Ufunua<br />

16:8,9. Manabii <strong>wa</strong>naeleza <strong>wa</strong>kati huu <strong>wa</strong>kutisha: “Mavuno <strong>ya</strong> shamba <strong>ya</strong>meharibi<strong>wa</strong>... miti<br />

262


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

yote <strong>ya</strong> shamba imekauka k<strong>wa</strong> sababu furaha imekauka katika <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu”. “Wan<strong>ya</strong>ma<br />

<strong>wa</strong>namlio <strong>wa</strong> huzuni makundi <strong>ya</strong> mifungo <strong>ya</strong>nafzaika, sababu na<strong>wa</strong>na malisho.... Maji <strong>ya</strong><br />

mito <strong>ya</strong>mekauka, na moto umekula malisho <strong>ya</strong> jang<strong>wa</strong>”. Joel 1:11,12, 18-20.<br />

Mapigo ha<strong>ya</strong> si <strong>ya</strong> mahali pote, lakini <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> mapigo <strong>ya</strong> kutisha zaidi isiyofahamika<br />

kamwe. Hukumu zote zilizotangulia kufung<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> rehema ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zikichanganyika na<br />

rehema. Damu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo imelinda mwenye zambi k<strong>wa</strong> kiasi kamili cha kosa lake; lakini<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mwisho, hasira si <strong>ya</strong> kuchangany<strong>wa</strong> na rehema. Wengi <strong>wa</strong>tatamani ulinzi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ambayo <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kiizarau.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>napoteseka na kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napoteseka na njaa, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

ha<strong>wa</strong>taach<strong>wa</strong> kuangamiz<strong>wa</strong>. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>tolea mahitaji <strong>ya</strong>o. “Atape<strong>wa</strong> chakula chake;<br />

maji <strong>ya</strong>ke ha<strong>ya</strong>takosekana”. “Mimi, B<strong>wa</strong>na, nita<strong>wa</strong>sikia, mimi, Mungu <strong>wa</strong> Israeli,<br />

sita<strong>wa</strong>acha”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 33:16; 41:17.<br />

Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> maonyo <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu itaonekana <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngepash<strong>wa</strong> upesi kutia muhuri k<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>o, kama <strong>wa</strong>livyofan<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>fia dini mbele <strong>ya</strong>o. Ni <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong> kutisha. Waovu <strong>wa</strong>meshangilia.<br />

“Imani yenu inaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>pi sasa? Sababu gani Mungu ha<strong>wa</strong>okoi k<strong>wa</strong> mikono yetu kama<br />

munaku<strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke”? Lakini <strong>wa</strong>naongojea <strong>wa</strong>nakumbuka Kristo alipokufa juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

msalaba <strong>wa</strong> Kalvari. Kama Yakobo, wote <strong>wa</strong>nashindana na Mungu.<br />

Makundi <strong>ya</strong> Malaika Wanalinda<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>natua k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liolinda neno la uvumilivu la Kristo. Wameshuhudia shida<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o na <strong>wa</strong>mesikia maombi <strong>ya</strong>o. Wanangojea neno la Mkuu <strong>wa</strong>o ku<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong>kua k<strong>wa</strong> hatari<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Lakini <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> kungojea <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu kidogo. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuny<strong>wa</strong> kikombe na kubatiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ubatizo. Matayo 20:20-23. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>teule<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu utafupish<strong>wa</strong>. Mwisho utakuja upesi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>navyotazamia.<br />

Inga<strong>wa</strong> amri <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida imeweka <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>shika amri <strong>wa</strong>napoweza kuua<strong>wa</strong>, adui zao<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu zingine <strong>wa</strong>taharakisha amri na kujaribu kuondoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>o. Lakini hakuna<br />

mtu anayeweza kupita <strong>wa</strong>linzi <strong>wa</strong>liotua kuzunguka kila nafsi aminifu. Wengine<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lishambuli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> kukimbia k<strong>wa</strong>o kutoka mijini, lakini panga zilizoinuli<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o<br />

zikavunjika kama majani makavu. Wengine <strong>wa</strong>kalind<strong>wa</strong> na malaika katika hali <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong><br />

vita.<br />

Katika vizazi vyote viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>mekamata sehemu <strong>ya</strong> juhudi katika mambo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Wamekubali kukaribisha na <strong>wa</strong>nadamu, kutenda kama viongozi k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>safiri<br />

<strong>wa</strong>jinga, <strong>wa</strong>kafungua milango <strong>ya</strong> gereza na kuweka huru <strong>wa</strong>tumishi <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Wakaja<br />

kusukuma jiwe k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi la Mwokozi.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>nazuru mikutano <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu, kama <strong>wa</strong>livyokwenda Sodomo, kuhakikisha<br />

kama <strong>wa</strong>mepitisha mpaka <strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. B<strong>wa</strong>na, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chache<br />

263


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>namtumikia k<strong>wa</strong> kweli, anazuia misiba na anazidisha utulivu <strong>wa</strong> makutano. Wenye<br />

zambi <strong>wa</strong>nafahamu kidogo sana <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>ndeni k<strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong>o juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>chache ambao <strong>wa</strong>nafurash<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>gandamiza.<br />

Kila mara katika baraza za ulimwengu huu, malaika <strong>wa</strong>meku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nenaji. Masikio <strong>ya</strong><br />

kibinadamu <strong>ya</strong>mesikiliza k<strong>wa</strong> miito <strong>ya</strong>o, midomo <strong>ya</strong> kibinadamu <strong>ya</strong>mezihakia mashauri<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Wajumbe ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>metibitisha vyema kuliko <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe kuweza<br />

kutetea kisa cha <strong>wa</strong>liozulumi<strong>wa</strong> kuliko <strong>wa</strong>teteaji <strong>wa</strong>o wenye uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kusema vema.<br />

Wameshinda na kufunga <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>ngeleta mateso k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong> bidii, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>nangojea ishara za kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Mfalme <strong>wa</strong>o.<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoshindana <strong>wa</strong>napoendesha maombi <strong>ya</strong>o mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, mbingu<br />

zaangaza na mapambazuko <strong>ya</strong> siku <strong>ya</strong> milele. Kama sauti tamu za nyimbo za malaika<br />

maneno <strong>ya</strong>naanguka k<strong>wa</strong> sikio: “saidia anakuja. ” Sauti <strong>ya</strong> Kristo inakuja kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

milango <strong>wa</strong>zi: “Tazama, ninaku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nanyi. Msiogope. Nimepigana vita k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

yenu, na katika jina langu munaku<strong>wa</strong> zaidi kuliko <strong>wa</strong>shindaji.”<br />

Mwokozi mpenzi atatuma msaada <strong>wa</strong>kati tunapouhitaji. Wakati <strong>wa</strong> taabu ni hatari <strong>ya</strong><br />

kutisha k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, lakini kila m<strong>wa</strong>mini <strong>wa</strong> kweli anaweza kuona k<strong>wa</strong> imani<br />

upindi <strong>wa</strong> ahadi ukimzunguka. “Hivi <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> na B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>tarudi, <strong>wa</strong>tafika<br />

Sayuni na kuimba; Furaha <strong>ya</strong> milele itaku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>o; <strong>wa</strong>tapata shangwe na<br />

furaha; huzuni na kulia kutakimbia”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 51:11.<br />

Kama damu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shuhuda <strong>wa</strong> Kristo ilim<strong>wa</strong>ngika k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu, uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

haungeku<strong>wa</strong> ushuhuda kusadikisha wengine k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kweli, k<strong>wa</strong> maana moyo mgumu<br />

umefukuza nyuma mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> rehema hata <strong>ya</strong>sirudi tena. Kama wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong><br />

sasa kuanguka ku<strong>wa</strong> mawindo k<strong>wa</strong> adui zao, ingeku<strong>wa</strong> ushindi k<strong>wa</strong> mta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> giza.<br />

Kristo amesema: “Muje, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ngu, mwingie ndani <strong>ya</strong> vyumba vyenu, na kufunga<br />

milango yenu nyuma yenu; mujifiche k<strong>wa</strong> dakika kidogo, hata <strong>wa</strong>kati kasirani hii inapopita.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> maana tazama, B<strong>wa</strong>na anakuja kutoka pahali pake kuazibu wenye kukaa duniani k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ajili <strong>ya</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong>o”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 26:20,21.<br />

Wokovu utaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liongojea k<strong>wa</strong> uvumilivu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kuja<br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke na majina <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>meandik<strong>wa</strong> katika kitabu cha uzima.<br />

264


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 40. Ukombozi Mkub<strong>wa</strong><br />

Wakati ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> sheria za kibinadamu zitakapoondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoheshimu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, katika inchi mbalimbali kutaku<strong>wa</strong> mwendo <strong>wa</strong> namna<br />

moja k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>o. K<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>kati ulioamri<strong>wa</strong> katika agizo<br />

unapokaribia, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>tafan<strong>ya</strong> shauri pamoja usiku mmoja shauri la kuangamiza k<strong>wa</strong> pigo<br />

litakalon<strong>ya</strong>mazisha <strong>wa</strong>shupavu na <strong>wa</strong>siotii.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu wengine <strong>wa</strong>po katika vyumba v<strong>ya</strong> gereza, wengine mwituni na katika<br />

milima--<strong>wa</strong>naomba ulinzi <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Watu wenye silaha, <strong>wa</strong>kilazimish<strong>wa</strong> na malaika<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ovu, <strong>wa</strong>najita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> mauti. Sasa, k<strong>wa</strong> saa <strong>ya</strong> mwisho kabisa, Mungu atajitia<br />

kati kati: “Mutaku<strong>wa</strong> na wimbo kama vile <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> usiku, <strong>wa</strong>kati karamu takatifu<br />

inapotakas<strong>wa</strong>; na furaha <strong>ya</strong> moyo kama vile mtu anavyokwenda... katika mlima <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na,<br />

aliye M<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong> Israeli. Na B<strong>wa</strong>na atafan<strong>ya</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> utukufu kusiki<strong>wa</strong>, naye<br />

ataonyesha kushuka k<strong>wa</strong> mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong> nuru, k<strong>wa</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong> kasirani <strong>ya</strong>ke, na ulimi <strong>wa</strong><br />

moto unaokula, pamoja na zoruba na garika na mvua <strong>ya</strong> mawe”: Isa<strong>ya</strong> 30:29,30.<br />

Makutano makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> karibu kushambulia juu <strong>ya</strong> mawindo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>kati giza kub<strong>wa</strong>, nzito kuliko usiku, inaanguka duniani. Ndipo upindi <strong>wa</strong> mvua<br />

unazunguka mbingu kuonekana kuzunguka kila kundi la maombi. Makutano yenye kasirani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>mefung<strong>wa</strong>. Makusudi <strong>ya</strong> hasira <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>mesahauli<strong>wa</strong>. Wanatazama k<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> agano la<br />

Mungu na kutamani kulind<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu sauti imesiki<strong>wa</strong>, kusema, “Tazama”. Kama Stefano <strong>wa</strong>natazama<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>naona utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika kiti chake cha enzi. Tazama<br />

Matendo 7:55, 56. Wanatambua alama za unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na <strong>wa</strong>nasikia ombi, “nataka<br />

sana ha<strong>wa</strong> ulionipa <strong>wa</strong>kae pamoja nami pahali nilipo”. Yoane 17:24. Sauti imesiki<strong>wa</strong><br />

ikisema, “Wanakuja, <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, <strong>wa</strong>pole, na safi! Wameshika neno la uvumilivu <strong>wa</strong>ngu”.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> usiku <strong>wa</strong> manane Mungu anaonyesha uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Jua linatokea likingaa k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zake. Alama na maajabu <strong>ya</strong>nafuata. Waovu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natazama k<strong>wa</strong> hofu kuu k<strong>wa</strong> tokeo lile, huku wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>kitazama alama za ukombozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o. Katikati <strong>ya</strong> mbingu zenye hasira kukaonekana nafasi moja <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>ya</strong> utukufu<br />

usioelezeka na pale sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ikatokea kama sauti <strong>ya</strong> maji mengi, ikisema,<br />

“imefanyika! ” Ufunuo 16:17.<br />

Sauti inatetemesha mbingu na dunia. Hapo ni tetemeko kub<strong>wa</strong> la inchi, “hata tangu <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia haliku<strong>wa</strong> namna ile, namna lilivyoku<strong>wa</strong> kub<strong>wa</strong> tetemeko hili. ”<br />

Ufunuo 16:18. Miamba iliyopasuka ikata<strong>wa</strong>nyika pande zote. Bahari ikatikisatikisa k<strong>wa</strong><br />

hasira kali. Hapo kunasiki<strong>wa</strong> mlio <strong>wa</strong> nguvu <strong>wa</strong> tufani kama sauti <strong>ya</strong> mashetani. Upande <strong>wa</strong><br />

juu <strong>wa</strong> inchi ukapasuka. Misingi <strong>ya</strong>ke yenyewe <strong>ya</strong>onekana kutoweka. <strong>Miji</strong> yenye bandari<br />

iliyoku<strong>wa</strong> kama Sodomo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uovu imemez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maji yenye hasira. “Babeli ule<br />

mkub<strong>wa</strong>” ukakumbuk<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, “kupe<strong>wa</strong> kikombe cha mvinyo <strong>ya</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong><br />

265


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

kasirani <strong>ya</strong>ke. ” Ufunuo 16:19. Mvua <strong>ya</strong> mawe makub<strong>wa</strong> sana ikafan<strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

uharibifu. <strong>Miji</strong> yenye kiburi inaangush<strong>wa</strong> chini. Majumba <strong>ya</strong> fahari ambayo <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>litolea<br />

mali nyingi <strong>ya</strong>o ikafunik<strong>wa</strong> na ikageuka mavumbi mbele <strong>ya</strong> macho <strong>ya</strong>o. Kuta za gereza<br />

zimevunjika k<strong>wa</strong> vipande vipande, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>mewek<strong>wa</strong> huru.<br />

Makaburi <strong>ya</strong>mefunguka, na “wengi <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>naolala mavumbini m<strong>wa</strong> inchi <strong>wa</strong>taamka,<br />

wengine <strong>wa</strong>pate uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele, na wengine k<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> na kuzarauli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> milele”. “Na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liomuchoma”, <strong>wa</strong>le ambao <strong>wa</strong>lichekelea maumivu makali <strong>ya</strong> kifo cha Kristo, na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pinzani (adui) <strong>wa</strong>kali zaidi <strong>wa</strong> kweli <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>tafufuka kuona heshima inayowek<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu na <strong>wa</strong>tiifu. Danieli 12:2; Ufunuo 1:7.<br />

Umeme kali utafunika dunia k<strong>wa</strong> shuka la ndimi <strong>ya</strong> moto. Juu <strong>ya</strong> ngurumo (radi), sauti<br />

za ajabu na hofu kub<strong>wa</strong>, zinatangaza mwisho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> wenye kujisifu na<br />

wenye kutaka vita, <strong>wa</strong>kali k<strong>wa</strong> wenye kushika amri za Mungu, sasa <strong>wa</strong>natetemeka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

woga. Mashetani <strong>wa</strong>natetemeka <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>napoomba rehema.<br />

Siku <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

Asema nabii Isa<strong>ya</strong>: ” K<strong>wa</strong> siku ile mtu atatupa sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> feza, na sanamu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong><br />

zahabu, <strong>wa</strong>lizojifanyizia kuziabudu, k<strong>wa</strong> pan<strong>ya</strong> na k<strong>wa</strong> popo; <strong>wa</strong>ingie katika mapango <strong>ya</strong><br />

miamba, na ndani <strong>ya</strong> pahali pa juu <strong>ya</strong> mawe <strong>ya</strong>liyo pasukapasuka, toka mbele <strong>ya</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, na toka utukufu <strong>wa</strong> mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke, <strong>wa</strong>kati atakaposimama kutikisatikisa sana<br />

dunia”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 2:20, 21.<br />

Wale <strong>wa</strong>liotoa vyote k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Kristo sasa <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> katika salama. Mbele <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu nausoni k<strong>wa</strong> mauti <strong>wa</strong>meonyesha uaminifu <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong>ke yeye aliyekufa k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o. Nyuso zao, juzijuzi ziliku<strong>wa</strong> zenye kufifia na zenye kukonda, sasa zinangaa k<strong>wa</strong> ajabu.<br />

Sauti zao zinainuka k<strong>wa</strong> wimbo <strong>wa</strong> ushindi: “Mungu ni kimbilio letu na nguvu yetu,<br />

Msaada aliye karibu sana <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mateso. K<strong>wa</strong> hivi hatutaogopa, hata inchi ikibadilika,<br />

na hata milima ikihamish<strong>wa</strong> moyoni m<strong>wa</strong> bahari; Hata maji <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong>kinguruma na kuchafuka,<br />

hata milima ikitikisika k<strong>wa</strong> kiburi chake”. Zaburi 46:1-3.<br />

Wakati maneno ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> tumaini takatifu <strong>ya</strong>napopanda k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu, utukufu <strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong><br />

mbinguni unapita k<strong>wa</strong> milango inayofunguka kidogo. Ndipo pale panatokea kinyume cha<br />

mawingu mkono unaoshika mbao mbili za mawe. Sheria ile takatifu, iliyotangaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Sinai, imefunuli<strong>wa</strong> sasa kama kanuni <strong>ya</strong> hukumu. Maneno <strong>ya</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi ili wote <strong>wa</strong>weze<br />

ku<strong>ya</strong>soma. Ukumbusho umeamsh<strong>wa</strong>. Giza <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> uchawi na uzushi<br />

imesafish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kila <strong>wa</strong>zo.<br />

Ni vigumu kueleza hofu kuu na kukata tamaa k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokan<strong>ya</strong>nga sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> urafiki na ulimwengu, <strong>wa</strong>meweka kando maagizo <strong>ya</strong>ke na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kafundisha wengine kuzivunja. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>mehukumi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria ile ambayo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>meizarau. Wanaona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> bila kisingizio. Adui za sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>zo mp<strong>ya</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kweli na mapash<strong>wa</strong>. Kuchele<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong>naona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

266


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sabato ni muhuri <strong>wa</strong> Mungu mwenye uhai. Ni kuchele<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong>naona msingi <strong>wa</strong><br />

mchanga ambapo juu <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>lijenga. Wameku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kipigana kumpinga Mungu. Waalimu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> dini <strong>wa</strong>meongoza roho k<strong>wa</strong> jehanum (kupotea milele) <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kidai ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> Paradiso. Ni madaraka makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> namna gani <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu katika kazi takatifu, matokeo<br />

<strong>ya</strong> kutisha namna gani k<strong>wa</strong> kutokuamini k<strong>wa</strong>o!<br />

Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> Wafalme Anatokea<br />

Sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu imesikilika kutangaza siku na saa <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. Israeli <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

anasimama k<strong>wa</strong> kusikiliza, nyuso zao zikaangazi<strong>wa</strong> na utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Karibu pale<br />

kukatokea k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong> mashariki wingu nyeusi dogo. Ni wingu linalomzunguka<br />

Mwokozi. K<strong>wa</strong> utulivu <strong>wa</strong> heshima <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kalitazama k<strong>wa</strong> namna liliku<strong>wa</strong><br />

likikaribia, hata linapoku<strong>wa</strong> wingu jeupe kub<strong>wa</strong>, upande <strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>wa</strong>ke ni utukufu kama<br />

moto unaoteketeza, na upande <strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>wa</strong>ke upindi <strong>wa</strong> mvua <strong>wa</strong> agano. Sasa si “Mtu <strong>wa</strong><br />

huzuni”, Yesu anapanda (farasi) kama mshindi mkub<strong>wa</strong>. Malaika <strong>wa</strong>takatifu, makutano<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>siyohesabika, <strong>wa</strong>namtumikia, “elfu elfu, na elfu kumi mara elfu kumi”. Kila<br />

jicho linamwona Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> uzima. Taji la utukufu linaku<strong>wa</strong> katika kipaji cha uso <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Uso <strong>wa</strong>ke unashinda (muangaza) <strong>wa</strong> jua la saa sita. “Naye ana jina llien<strong>ya</strong> kuaandik<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika vazi lake na paja lake, MFALME WA WAFALME NA BWANA WA<br />

MABWANA”. Ufunuo 19:16.<br />

Mufalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme anashuka juu <strong>ya</strong> wingu, amefunik<strong>wa</strong> katika moto unao<strong>wa</strong>ka.<br />

Dunia inatetemeka mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke: “Mungu wetu atakuja, <strong>wa</strong>la hatan<strong>ya</strong>maza; Moto utakuia<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke, Na tufani inayovuma sana itamuzunguka. Ataita mbingu zilizo juu na inchi, ili<br />

apate kuhukumu <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke”. Zaburi 50:3,4.<br />

“Na <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> dunia, na <strong>wa</strong>tu mashuhuri, na matajiri, na kila mtum<strong>wa</strong>, na kila mtu<br />

mwenye uhuru <strong>wa</strong>kajificha katika pango na chini <strong>ya</strong> miamba: Mutuangukie, mutufiche<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong>ke yeye anayeketi juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha ufalme, na gazabu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> maana siku kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> gazabu <strong>ya</strong>ke imekuja na nani anayeweza kusimama”? Ufunuo<br />

6:15-17.<br />

Mabishano <strong>ya</strong> mizaha <strong>ya</strong>mekoma, midomo <strong>ya</strong> uwongo imen<strong>ya</strong>mazish<strong>wa</strong>. Hakuna kitu<br />

kinachosiki<strong>wa</strong> lakini sauti <strong>ya</strong> maombi na sauti <strong>ya</strong> kilio. Waovu <strong>wa</strong>naomba kuzik<strong>wa</strong> chini <strong>ya</strong><br />

miamba kuliko kukutana na uso <strong>wa</strong>ke yeye <strong>wa</strong>liyezarau. Sauti ile iliyoingia k<strong>wa</strong> sikio la<br />

maiti, <strong>wa</strong>najua. Mara ngapi inaku<strong>wa</strong> sauti zile za upole zili<strong>wa</strong>ita k<strong>wa</strong> toba. Mara ngapi<br />

iliku<strong>wa</strong> ikisiki<strong>wa</strong> katika maombi <strong>ya</strong> rafiki, <strong>ya</strong> ndugu, <strong>ya</strong> Mkombozi. Sauti ile inayoamsha<br />

ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> maonyo <strong>ya</strong>liyozarauli<strong>wa</strong> na miito iliyokatali<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Kunaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liochekelea Kristo katika unyenyekevu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Alitangaza: “Tangu<br />

sasa mutaona M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu akiketi k<strong>wa</strong> mkono <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong> uwezo, na akija katikati <strong>ya</strong><br />

mawingu <strong>ya</strong> mbingu”. Matayo 26:64. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>namutazama katika utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong> sasa kumwona yeye kukaa k<strong>wa</strong> mkono <strong>wa</strong> kuume <strong>wa</strong> uwezo. Pale kunaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

267


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Herode mwenye kiburi aliyechekelea cheo chake cha ufalme. Pale panaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liomvika taji la miiba juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> chake na katika mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke fimbo <strong>ya</strong> kifalme <strong>ya</strong><br />

kufananisha--<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioinama mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kutoa heshima <strong>ya</strong> kumzihaki, <strong>wa</strong>liomtemea<br />

mate Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> uzima. Wanatafuta kukimbia mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong>ke. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liopigilia<br />

misumari k<strong>wa</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke na miguu <strong>wa</strong>natazama alama hizi k<strong>wa</strong> hofu na majuto.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> hofu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi <strong>wa</strong>zi makuhani na <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>nakumbuka matukio <strong>ya</strong> Kalvari,<br />

namna gani, <strong>wa</strong>lipotikisa vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>o katika shangwe <strong>ya</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong> Shetani, <strong>wa</strong>kapaaza<br />

sauti, “Aliokoa wengine; hawezi kujiokoa yeye mwenyewe”. Matayo 27:42. K<strong>wa</strong> sauti<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> kuliko kelele, “Asulibiwe, asulibiwe”! ambayo ikavuma katika Yerusalema,<br />

inaongeza maombolezo <strong>ya</strong> kukata tamaa, ‘’Yeye ni M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu”! Wanatafuta<br />

kukimbia mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme.<br />

Katika maisha <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naokataa kweli kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na n<strong>ya</strong>kati ambapo zamiri inaamka,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati nafsi inaposumbuli<strong>wa</strong> na masikitiko <strong>ya</strong> bure. Lakini mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> ni nini<br />

kulinganisha na majuto <strong>ya</strong> siku ile! Katikati <strong>ya</strong> hofu kuu <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>nasikia <strong>wa</strong>takatifu kupaaza<br />

sauti: “Tazama, huyu ndiye Mungu wetu, Tuliyemungoja, naye atatuokoa”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 25:9.<br />

Sauti <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu inaita k<strong>wa</strong> kuamsha <strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>naolala. Po pote duniani<br />

<strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>tasikia sauti ile, na <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoisikia <strong>wa</strong>taishi, jeshi kub<strong>wa</strong> la kila taifa, na kabila na<br />

lugha na jamaa. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong> gereza <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>nakuja, <strong>wa</strong>napovik<strong>wa</strong> utukufu<br />

<strong>wa</strong> milele, kupaaza sauti: “Ee mauti, kushinda k<strong>wa</strong>ko ni <strong>wa</strong>pi? Ee mauti, uchungu <strong>wa</strong>ko ni<br />

<strong>wa</strong>pi”? 1 Wakorinto 15:55.<br />

Wote <strong>wa</strong>naamka kutoka makaburini <strong>wa</strong>ki<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> hali ileile <strong>wa</strong>liyopoingia nayo<br />

kaburini. Lakini wote <strong>wa</strong>nafufuka pamoja na up<strong>ya</strong> na nguvu za ujana <strong>wa</strong> milele. Kristo<br />

alikuja kurudisha na kupon<strong>ya</strong> kile kilichopotea. Atabadilisha miili yetu <strong>ya</strong> unyonge na<br />

kuzifan<strong>ya</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>ke mwili mtukufu. Mwili <strong>wa</strong> mauti na <strong>wa</strong> kuharibika, mara moja<br />

unaoharibika na zambi, unaku<strong>wa</strong> sasa kamilifu, mzuri na <strong>wa</strong> kuishi milele. Madoo na ulema<br />

vimebaki ndani <strong>ya</strong> kaburi. Waliokombole<strong>wa</strong> “<strong>wa</strong>takua” (Malaki 4:2) k<strong>wa</strong> kimo kamili cha<br />

uzao katika utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> kizazi cha k<strong>wa</strong>nza, alama za mwisho za laana za zambi<br />

zimeondole<strong>wa</strong>. Waaminifu <strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>taonyesha mfano kamili <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o katika<br />

roho na nafsi na mwili.<br />

Wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>lio hai <strong>wa</strong>mebadilika “k<strong>wa</strong> dakika moja, k<strong>wa</strong> kufunga na kufungua k<strong>wa</strong><br />

jicho”. K<strong>wa</strong> sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>mefany<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> maisha <strong>ya</strong> milele na pamoja na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>liofufuka <strong>wa</strong>tachukuli<strong>wa</strong> juu kumlaki B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>o katika mawingu. Malaika<br />

“<strong>wa</strong>takusan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke toka pepo ine, toka mwisho huu <strong>wa</strong> mbingu mpaka<br />

mwisho mwingine”. Matayo 24:31. Watoto <strong>wa</strong>dogo <strong>wa</strong>mechukuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong> mama<br />

zao. Rafiki <strong>wa</strong>lioachana <strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> mauti <strong>wa</strong>meunganika, hakuna kuachana<br />

tena kamwe, na pamoja na nyimbo za furaha <strong>wa</strong>napanda pamoja k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Katika Mji Mtakatifu<br />

268


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Po pote k<strong>wa</strong> jeshi lisilohesabika la <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> kila jicho limekaz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu.<br />

Kila jicho linatazama utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke ambaye “uso <strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> umeharibi<strong>wa</strong> sana zaidi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mtu ye yote, na sura <strong>ya</strong>ke zaidi <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 52:14. Juu <strong>ya</strong> vich<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>shindaji Yesu anaweka taji <strong>ya</strong> utukufu. K<strong>wa</strong>ni kila mmoja kule kunataji ambalo lina “jina<br />

jip<strong>ya</strong>” lake mwenyewe (Ufunuo 2:17) na m<strong>wa</strong>ndiko “Utakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na”. Katika kila<br />

mkono kumewek<strong>wa</strong> tawi la ngazi la ushindi na kinubi chenye kungaa. Ndipo, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

malaika wenye kuamrisha <strong>wa</strong>napopiga sauti, kila mkono unapiga juu <strong>ya</strong> nyuzi na mguso <strong>wa</strong><br />

ufundi mzuri sana, mkazo <strong>wa</strong> masauti. Kila sauti inainuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sifa za shukrani: “K<strong>wa</strong><br />

yeye aliyetupenda na kutuosha zambi zetu k<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke, na kutufan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong><br />

makuhani k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke; k<strong>wa</strong> yeye ni utukufu na uwezo hata milele na milele”.<br />

Ufunuo 1:5,6.<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> makutano <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> ni Mji Mtakatifu. Yesu anafungua milango, na<br />

mataifa <strong>ya</strong>liyolinda ukweli <strong>wa</strong>naingia ndani. Ndipo sauti <strong>ya</strong>ke imesiki<strong>wa</strong>, “Kujeni, ninyi<br />

muliobariki<strong>wa</strong> na Baba <strong>ya</strong>ngu, mriti ufalme muliotengeneze<strong>wa</strong> tangu kuumb<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

ulimwengu”. Matayo 25:34. Kristo anaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke ununuzi <strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ke,<br />

kusema; ‘’Tazama, mimi ni hapa pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>toto ulionipa “Wale ulionipa nili<strong>wa</strong>chunga”.<br />

Waebrania 2:13; Yoane 17:12. Ee, furaha <strong>ya</strong> saa ile <strong>wa</strong>kati Baba <strong>wa</strong> milele, kutazama k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tatazama mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke, uharibifu <strong>wa</strong> zambi ukisha ondole<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

binadamu mara ingine tena katika umoja na Mungu!<br />

Furaha <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi ni k<strong>wa</strong> kuona, katika ufalme <strong>wa</strong> utukufu, mioyo iliyookole<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maumivu <strong>ya</strong>ke makali na unyenyekevu. Mtu aliyeokole<strong>wa</strong> atashiriki katika furaha <strong>ya</strong>ke;<br />

<strong>wa</strong>natazama <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liopatikana k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> maombi <strong>ya</strong>o, kazi, na kafara <strong>ya</strong> upendo.<br />

Shangwe itajaa katika mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>napoona yule aliyeokoa wengine, na ha<strong>wa</strong> zaidi<br />

na wengine.<br />

Wanadamu Wawili Wanakutana<br />

Wakati <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napokaribish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> kilio cha<br />

shangwe nyingi. Wanadamu <strong>wa</strong>wili ni karibu kukutana. M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu anapash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kupokea baba <strong>wa</strong> taifa letu--aliyeumb<strong>wa</strong>, aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> zambi, na k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke<br />

alama za msalaba zinaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sura <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi. Wakati Adamu alipotambua alama za<br />

misumari, k<strong>wa</strong> unyenyekevu anaanguka yeye mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Mwokozi<br />

anamwinua na kum<strong>wa</strong>lika kutazama tena k<strong>wa</strong> makao <strong>ya</strong> Edeni ambapo amehamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati mrefu.<br />

Maisha <strong>ya</strong> Adamu <strong>ya</strong>lijaz<strong>wa</strong> na huzuni. Kila jani lililokufa, kila n<strong>ya</strong>ma <strong>wa</strong> kafara, kila<br />

doa juu <strong>ya</strong> utakatifu <strong>wa</strong> mtu, iliku<strong>wa</strong> ukumbusho <strong>wa</strong> zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Maumivu <strong>ya</strong> majuto<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kutisha sana <strong>wa</strong>kati alipokutana na laumu zilizotup<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe<br />

kama sababu <strong>ya</strong> zambi. K<strong>wa</strong> uaminifu akatubu zambi <strong>ya</strong>ke, na alikufa katika tumaini la<br />

ufufuko. Sasa, k<strong>wa</strong> njia <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho, Adamu amerudishi<strong>wa</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza.<br />

269


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Alipojaz<strong>wa</strong> na furaha, anatazama miti ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> mara <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza furaha <strong>ya</strong>ke,<br />

matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke yeye mwenyewe aliku<strong>wa</strong> akikusan<strong>ya</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na hatia. Ameona<br />

mizabibu ambayo mikono <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe ilikomalisha, maua aliyo<strong>ya</strong>penda zamani<br />

kulinda. Hii ni Edeni iliyorudish<strong>wa</strong> kweli!<br />

Mwokozi akamwongoza k<strong>wa</strong> mti <strong>wa</strong> uzima na akam<strong>wa</strong>lika kula. Akatazama mkutano<br />

<strong>wa</strong> jamaa <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong>. Ndipo akatupa taji lake k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong> Yesu na<br />

kumkumbatia Mkombozi. Akagusa kinubi, na sehemu <strong>ya</strong> juu pa mbingu ikarudisha mwitiko<br />

<strong>wa</strong> sauti za wimbo <strong>wa</strong> ushindi: “Anastahili M<strong>wa</strong>na kondoo” aliyechinj<strong>wa</strong>”. Ufunuo 5:12.<br />

Jamaa <strong>ya</strong> Adamu inatupa taji zao k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>napoinama <strong>wa</strong>kiabudu.<br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong>lilia k<strong>wa</strong> kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> Adamu na <strong>wa</strong>kafurahi <strong>wa</strong>kati Yesu alipofungua kaburi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>lioamini k<strong>wa</strong> jina lake. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>natazama kazi <strong>ya</strong> ukombozi kutimiz<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kuunga sauti zao k<strong>wa</strong> kusifu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> “bahari <strong>ya</strong> kioo iliyochanganyika na moto” <strong>wa</strong>mekutanika kundi la <strong>wa</strong>tu ambao<br />

“<strong>wa</strong>liomshinda yule mn<strong>ya</strong>ma na sanamu na alama <strong>ya</strong>ke, na hesabu <strong>ya</strong> jina lake”. Wale elfu<br />

mia moja na makumi ine na ine <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> katika <strong>wa</strong>tu, na <strong>wa</strong>naimba “wimbo mp<strong>ya</strong>”<br />

wimbo <strong>wa</strong> Musa na wimbo <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo. Ufunuo 15:2,3. Hakuna mtu bali <strong>wa</strong>le elfu<br />

mia moja na makumi ine na ine <strong>wa</strong>takaoweza kujifunza wimbo ule, k<strong>wa</strong> maana ni wimbo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> mambo <strong>ya</strong> maisha ambayo hakuna jamii ingine <strong>wa</strong>liku<strong>wa</strong> nayo”. Ha<strong>wa</strong> ndio <strong>wa</strong>naofuata<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo kila pahali anapokwenda. “Ha<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liochukuli<strong>wa</strong> kutoka katikati <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>hai,<br />

ni “malimbuko <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu na k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo”. Ufunuo 14:4,5.<br />

Walipitia katika <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> mateso makub<strong>wa</strong> ambayo ha<strong>ya</strong>jaku<strong>wa</strong>ko tangu taifa<br />

liliku<strong>wa</strong>ko; <strong>wa</strong>livumilia maumivu makuu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> taabu <strong>ya</strong> Yakobo; <strong>wa</strong>lisimama<br />

pasipo mwombezi katika kumimin<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu za Mungu. “Wamefua<br />

mavazi <strong>ya</strong>o na ku<strong>ya</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> meupe katika damu <strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo”. “Na katika viny<strong>wa</strong> v<strong>ya</strong>o<br />

haukuonekana uwongo; maana <strong>wa</strong>o ni pasipo kilema” mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu. “Ha<strong>wa</strong>taona njaa<br />

tena, <strong>wa</strong>la ha<strong>wa</strong>taona kiu tena, <strong>wa</strong>la jua halita<strong>wa</strong>piga, <strong>wa</strong>la joto lo lote. K<strong>wa</strong>ni M<strong>wa</strong>na-<br />

Kondoo, aliye katikati <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi ata<strong>wa</strong>chunga, naye ata<strong>wa</strong>ongoza hata chemchemi za<br />

maji yenye uhai, na Mungu atapangusa machozi yote katika macho <strong>ya</strong>o”. Ufunuo 7:14;<br />

14:5; 7:16,17.<br />

Waliokombole<strong>wa</strong> katika Utukufu<br />

Katika vizazi vyote <strong>wa</strong>teule <strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>metembea katika njia nyembamba.<br />

Wametakas<strong>wa</strong> katika tanuru <strong>ya</strong> mateso. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> Yesu <strong>wa</strong>kavumilia uchuki, masingizio,<br />

kujinyima, na hasara za uchungu. Walijifunza uba<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zambi, uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke, kosa <strong>ya</strong>ke,<br />

msiba <strong>wa</strong>ke; <strong>wa</strong>naitazama na machukio makuu. Maana <strong>ya</strong> kafara isiyoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho<br />

iliyofany<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> da<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>ke ina<strong>wa</strong>nyenyekeza na kujaza mioyo <strong>ya</strong>o na shukrani.<br />

Wanapenda sana k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>lisamehe<strong>wa</strong> sana. Tazama Luka 7:47. Washiriki <strong>wa</strong> mateso<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Kristo, <strong>wa</strong>nastahili ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>shiriki <strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

270


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wariti <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>natoka k<strong>wa</strong> vyjumba v<strong>ya</strong> orofani, vibanda vibovu, gereza, mahali<br />

<strong>wa</strong>uaji <strong>wa</strong>naponyong<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sheria, milimani, jang<strong>wa</strong>ni, mapangoni. Waliku<strong>wa</strong> “maskini,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kites<strong>wa</strong>, kusumbuli<strong>wa</strong>”. Mamilioni <strong>wa</strong>lienda k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi <strong>wa</strong>kilemez<strong>wa</strong> na sifa mba<strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>likataa kujitoa k<strong>wa</strong> Shetani. Lakini sasa ha<strong>wa</strong>teseki tena, ha<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>nyike<br />

tena, na ha<strong>wa</strong>onewe. Toka sasa <strong>wa</strong>nasimama <strong>wa</strong>napovaa mavazi <strong>ya</strong> utajiri kuliko nguo <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioheshimi<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>wa</strong> dunia <strong>wa</strong>liyovaa, kuvik<strong>wa</strong> na mataji <strong>ya</strong> utukufu zaidi kuliko <strong>ya</strong>le<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyovik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> paji la uso <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> dunia. Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> utukufu amepanguza<br />

machozi k<strong>wa</strong> nyuso zote. Wanatoa wimbo <strong>wa</strong> sifa, <strong>wa</strong>zi, tamu, na <strong>wa</strong>kupatana. Wimbo <strong>wa</strong><br />

furaha ukaenea katika miruko <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni: “Wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu wetu anayeketi juu <strong>ya</strong><br />

kiti cha enzi, na k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo”. Na wote <strong>wa</strong>kaitika, “Amina: Baraka na utukufu, na<br />

hekima, na shukrani, na heshima, na uwezo, na nguvu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu wetu hata milele na<br />

milele”. Ufunuo 7:10,12.<br />

Katika maisha ha<strong>ya</strong> tunaweza tu kuanza kufahamu asili <strong>ya</strong> ajabu <strong>ya</strong> wokovu. K<strong>wa</strong><br />

ufahamu wetu wenye mpaka tungeweza kufikiri zaidi k<strong>wa</strong> kweli ha<strong>ya</strong> na utukufu, uzima<br />

(maisha) na mauti, haki na rehema, <strong>ya</strong>nayokutana katika msalaba; lakini k<strong>wa</strong> mvuto zaidi<br />

<strong>wa</strong> nguvu za akili yetu tunashind<strong>wa</strong> kuele<strong>wa</strong> maana <strong>ya</strong>ke kamili. Urefu na upana, urefu <strong>wa</strong><br />

kwenda chini na urefu <strong>wa</strong> kwenda juu, <strong>wa</strong> upendo <strong>wa</strong> ukombozi unafahamika kidogo tu.<br />

Shauri la wokovu halitafahamika kamili, hata <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napoona kama<br />

<strong>wa</strong>navyoon<strong>wa</strong> na kujua kama <strong>wa</strong>navyojulikana; lakini katika vizazi v<strong>ya</strong> milele kweli mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

itaendelea kufunuli<strong>wa</strong> akili <strong>ya</strong> ajabu na furaha. Ijapo masikitiko na maumivu na majaribu <strong>ya</strong><br />

dunia <strong>ya</strong>napomalizika na sababu imeondole<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> na maarifa <strong>ya</strong><br />

kupambanua, na akili <strong>ya</strong> kufahamu bei <strong>ya</strong> wokovu <strong>wa</strong>o. Msalaba utaku<strong>wa</strong> ni wimbo <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> milele.<br />

Katika Kristo aliyetukuz<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>namtazama Kristo aliyesulibi<strong>wa</strong>. Haitasahauli<strong>wa</strong> kamwe<br />

<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mwenye Enzi <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni alijinyenyekeza mwenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> kuinua mtu<br />

aliyeanguka, ili achukue kosa na ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> zambi na kuficha uso <strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke hata misiba <strong>ya</strong><br />

ulimwengu uliopotea unapovunja moyo <strong>wa</strong>ke na kuangamiza maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke. Muumba <strong>wa</strong><br />

dunia yote akaweka pembeni utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke sababu <strong>ya</strong> upendo k<strong>wa</strong> mtu--hii itaamsha milele<br />

mshangao <strong>wa</strong> viumbe vyote. Wakati mataifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napomtazama Mkombozi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>o na kujua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke ni <strong>wa</strong> kutoku<strong>wa</strong> na mwisho, <strong>wa</strong>naendelea katika<br />

wimbo: “Anastahili M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo aliyechinj<strong>wa</strong>, na aliyetukomboa k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> damu<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe <strong>ya</strong> damani!”<br />

Siri <strong>ya</strong> msalaba inaeleza siri zote. Itaonekana <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba yeye anayeku<strong>wa</strong> pasipo<br />

mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> hekima hangefan<strong>ya</strong> shauri lingine k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> wokovu wetu isipoku<strong>wa</strong> kafara<br />

<strong>ya</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong>ke. Malipo k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> kafara hii ni furaha <strong>ya</strong> kujaza dunia na viumbe<br />

vilivyokombole<strong>wa</strong>, vitakatifu, v<strong>ya</strong> furaha, na v<strong>ya</strong> milele. Hii ni damani <strong>ya</strong> nafsi ambayo<br />

Baba anatoshele<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> bei iliyolip<strong>wa</strong>. Na Kristo mwenyewe, k<strong>wa</strong> kutazama matunda <strong>ya</strong><br />

kafara <strong>ya</strong>ke kub<strong>wa</strong>, anatoshele<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

271


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

272


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 41. Dunia katika Uharibifu<br />

Wakati sauti <strong>ya</strong> Mungu inapogeuza utum<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, pale panaku<strong>wa</strong> na muamko<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kutisha <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liopoteza vyote katika vita kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> maisha. Kupofush<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

madanganyo <strong>ya</strong> Shetani <strong>wa</strong>tajiri <strong>wa</strong>kajisifu wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong> ukuu <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>siofaniki<strong>wa</strong> sana. Lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>kujali kulisha wenye njaa, kuvika <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> unchi,<br />

kufan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> haki, na kupenda rehema. Sasa <strong>wa</strong>meondole<strong>wa</strong> vyote vilivyo<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>meach<strong>wa</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong> (maskini). Wanatazama k<strong>wa</strong> hofu juu <strong>ya</strong> kuangamia k<strong>wa</strong><br />

sanamu zao. Wameuzisha nafsi zao k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong> dunia na ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tajiri k<strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu. Maisha <strong>ya</strong>o ni <strong>ya</strong> kushind<strong>wa</strong>, anasa zao zimegeuka ku<strong>wa</strong> uchungu. Faida <strong>ya</strong> maisha<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o yote imepotea k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati moja. Watajiri <strong>wa</strong>nalilia kuangamia k<strong>wa</strong> nyumba zao kub<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

kuta<strong>wa</strong>nyika k<strong>wa</strong> zahabu <strong>ya</strong>o na feza, na hofu <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe <strong>wa</strong>napash<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuangamia pamoja na sanamu zao. Waovu <strong>wa</strong>naomboleza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba matokeo ni vile<br />

inavyoku<strong>wa</strong>, lakini ha<strong>wa</strong>tubu k<strong>wa</strong> maovu <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Mhubiri aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> ukweli k<strong>wa</strong> kafara makusudi <strong>ya</strong> kupata upendeleo <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu sasa<br />

anatambua mvuto <strong>wa</strong> mafundisho <strong>ya</strong>ke. Kila mustari ulioandik<strong>wa</strong>, kila neno lililotamk<strong>wa</strong><br />

lililoongoza <strong>wa</strong>tu kudumu katika kimbilio la uwongo limeta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> mbegu: na sasa<br />

anatazama mavuno. B<strong>wa</strong>na anasema: “Ole <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>chungaji, <strong>wa</strong>naoharibu na kuta<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong><br />

kondoo za malisho <strong>ya</strong>ngu! ... Angalieni, nitaleta juu yenu uovu <strong>wa</strong> matendo yenu”. “k<strong>wa</strong><br />

uwongo mumehuzunisha moyo <strong>wa</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>lio haki, nisio<strong>wa</strong>huzunisha; nakutia nguvu mikono<br />

<strong>ya</strong> mwovu, hata asigeuke toka njia <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> uovu, na kuponyesh<strong>wa</strong> hai”. Yeremia 23:1,2;<br />

Ezekieli 13:22.<br />

Wahubiri na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naona <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>measi juu <strong>ya</strong> Muumba <strong>wa</strong> sheria yote <strong>ya</strong> haki.<br />

Kuweka pembeni maagizo <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kulitoa mwinuko k<strong>wa</strong> maelfu <strong>ya</strong> nguvu za uovu, hata<br />

dunia ika<strong>wa</strong> mfereji moja mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> zambi. Hakuna lugha inayoweza kueleza tamaa <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>sio<strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>napotazama <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>livyopoteza milele--uzima <strong>wa</strong> milele.<br />

Watu <strong>wa</strong>nashitakiana <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza k<strong>wa</strong> uharibifu, lakini wote<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naunganika k<strong>wa</strong> kukusan<strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> uchungu mkub<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>chungaji<br />

<strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong>liotabiri “maneno <strong>ya</strong> laini” (Isa<strong>ya</strong> 30:10), <strong>wa</strong>lioongoza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>sikilizaji <strong>wa</strong>o kufan<strong>ya</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na kutesa <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>ngeishika kama takatifu.<br />

“Tumepotea”! <strong>wa</strong>meomboleza, “na ninyi ndio munaoku<strong>wa</strong> sababu yenyewe”. Mikono<br />

iliyo<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>za zamani k<strong>wa</strong> heshima itan<strong>ya</strong>nyuli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu <strong>wa</strong>o. Po pote<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> vita na um<strong>wa</strong>ngaji <strong>wa</strong> damu.<br />

M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni <strong>wa</strong>meku<strong>wa</strong> katika vita pamoja na muovu,<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuon<strong>ya</strong>, kuangazia, na kuokoa <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Sasa wote <strong>wa</strong>mefan<strong>ya</strong> mipango<br />

(makusudi) <strong>ya</strong>o; <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>meungana kabisa na Shetani katika vita kupigana na Mungu.<br />

Mabishano si <strong>ya</strong> Shetani peke <strong>ya</strong>ke, lakini pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu. “B<strong>wa</strong>na ana mashindano na<br />

mataifa”. Yeremia 25:31.<br />

273


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Malaika <strong>wa</strong> Mauti<br />

Sasa malaika <strong>wa</strong> mauti anaenda mbele, anaonyesh<strong>wa</strong> katika ndoto <strong>ya</strong> Ezekieli k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoku<strong>wa</strong> na silaha za kuchinja, k<strong>wa</strong>o agizo limetole<strong>wa</strong>: “Ueni kabisa mzee na kijana, na<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>wili <strong>wa</strong>sichana, na <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>dogo, na <strong>wa</strong>na<strong>wa</strong>ke, lakini musikaribie mtu aliye na<br />

alama ile juu <strong>ya</strong>ke; na anzieni k<strong>wa</strong> pahali pangu patakatifu”, ‘’halafu <strong>wa</strong>kaanza k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zee<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio mbele <strong>ya</strong> nyumba, “<strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>linzi <strong>wa</strong> kiroho <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu. Ezekieli 9:6.<br />

Walinzi <strong>wa</strong> uwongo <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza kuanguka. “K<strong>wa</strong> maana tazama, B<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

anakuja kutoka pahali pake kuazibu wenye kukaa duniani k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong>o; na<br />

dunia itafunua damu <strong>ya</strong>ke, na haitafunika tena <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>lioua<strong>wa</strong>”. “Na itaku<strong>wa</strong> siku ile<br />

makelele makub<strong>wa</strong> toka k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>ya</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> katikati <strong>ya</strong>o; nao <strong>wa</strong>takamata kila mtu<br />

mkono <strong>wa</strong> jirani <strong>ya</strong>ke, na mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke utan<strong>ya</strong>nyuli<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> mkono <strong>wa</strong> jirani <strong>ya</strong>ke” Isa<strong>ya</strong><br />

26:21; Zekarai 14:13.<br />

Katika vita yenye <strong>wa</strong>zimu <strong>ya</strong> tamaa kali zao wenyewe na k<strong>wa</strong> kumiminika k<strong>wa</strong> gazabu<br />

<strong>ya</strong> Mungu isiyo changany<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>kuhani <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>naanguka, <strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la, na <strong>wa</strong>tu. “Na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioua<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na siku ile <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> toka mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia hata mwisho <strong>wa</strong> dunia”.<br />

Yeremia 25:33.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>taangamiz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza <strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Kristo<br />

atachukua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, na dunia itafanyi<strong>wa</strong> utupu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

“Tazama B<strong>wa</strong>na anafan<strong>ya</strong> dunia ku<strong>wa</strong> utupu, na anaiharibu, na anaipindua, na<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong>sambaza popote <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>ke... Inchi itafany<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> utupu kabisa, na kuharibi<strong>wa</strong><br />

kabisa; k<strong>wa</strong> maana B<strong>wa</strong>na amesema neno hili... k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>wa</strong>mevunja sheria, <strong>wa</strong>megeuza<br />

amri, <strong>wa</strong>mevunja agano la milele. K<strong>wa</strong> sababu hii laana imekula dunia, na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naokaa<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>naonekana ku<strong>wa</strong> na laumu: k<strong>wa</strong> hivi <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong> dunia <strong>wa</strong>mechom<strong>wa</strong>”. Isa<strong>ya</strong><br />

24:1,3,5,6.<br />

Dunia inaonekana kama jang<strong>wa</strong> lenye uki<strong>wa</strong>. <strong>Miji</strong> imeharibi<strong>wa</strong> na tetemeko, miti<br />

kungole<strong>wa</strong>, miamba iliyopasuka duniani imeta<strong>wa</strong>nyika juu <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> dunia. Mapango<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>naonyesha alama mahali milima ilipasuka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> misingi <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Uhamisho <strong>wa</strong> Shetani<br />

Sasa matukio <strong>ya</strong>mefanyika <strong>ya</strong>liyoonyesha mbele heshima <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> Siku<br />

<strong>ya</strong> upatanisho. Wakati zambi za Israeli zilipoondole<strong>wa</strong> kutoka Pahali patakatifu k<strong>wa</strong> uwezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong> sadaka <strong>ya</strong> zambi, mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli alionyesh<strong>wa</strong> hai mbele <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na. Kuhani<br />

mkuu akaungama juu <strong>ya</strong>ke “maovu yote <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Israeli,... ku<strong>ya</strong>weka juu <strong>ya</strong> kich<strong>wa</strong> cha<br />

mbuzi”. Walawi 16:21. Vilevile, <strong>wa</strong>kati kazi <strong>ya</strong> upatanisho katika Pahali patakatifu pa<br />

mbinguni itakapotimia, ndipo, mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na malaika <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni na jeshi la<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong>, zambi za <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu zitawek<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> Shetani; atatangaz<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

kosa <strong>ya</strong> uovu wote aliolazimisha <strong>wa</strong>o kuufan<strong>ya</strong>. Kama vile mbuzi <strong>wa</strong> Azazeli aliochukuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika inchi isiyokali<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>tu, vivyo hivyo Shetani atahamish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dunia yenye uki<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

274


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Baada <strong>ya</strong> kuonyesha mambo <strong>ya</strong> ajabu <strong>ya</strong> kuja k<strong>wa</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na, mfunuaji anaendelea: “kisha<br />

nikaona malaika akishuka toka mbingu, mwenye ufunguo <strong>wa</strong> shimo lisilo na mwisho, na<br />

munyororo mkub<strong>wa</strong> katika mkono <strong>wa</strong>ke. Akamshika yule joka mkub<strong>wa</strong>, yule nyoka <strong>ya</strong><br />

zamani, anayeit<strong>wa</strong> Diabolo na Shetani, akamufunga miaka elfu, na akamutupa katika shimo<br />

lisilo na mwisho, na kumufunga, na kutia muhuri juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, asipate kudangan<strong>ya</strong> mataifa<br />

tena, hata ile miaka elfu itimie; na nyuma <strong>ya</strong> hayo inapash<strong>wa</strong> afunguliwe <strong>wa</strong>kati kidogo”.<br />

Ufunuo 20:1-3.<br />

“Shimo lisilo na mwisho” ni mfano <strong>wa</strong> dunia katika machafuko na giza. Kutazamia siku<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, Yeremia anatangaza; “Niliangalia inchi, na tazama, iliku<strong>wa</strong> uki<strong>wa</strong>, haina<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu; niliangalia mbingu, nazo haziku<strong>wa</strong> na nuru. Niliangalia milima, na tazama,<br />

zilitetemeka, na vilima vyote vilitikisika polepole. Nikaangalia, na tazama, hakuna mtu hata<br />

mmoja, na ndege zote za mbingu <strong>wa</strong>mekimbia. Nikaangalia, na tazama, shamba lililozaa<br />

sana limeku<strong>wa</strong> jang<strong>wa</strong>, na miji <strong>ya</strong>ke yote iliku<strong>wa</strong> imebomoka”. Yeremia 4:23-26.<br />

Hapa ndipo makao <strong>ya</strong> Shetani pamoja na malaika <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>ovu k<strong>wa</strong> miaka 1000.<br />

Amefungi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> dunia hii, hataku<strong>wa</strong> na ruhusa <strong>ya</strong> kuingia k<strong>wa</strong> dunia zingine k<strong>wa</strong>kujaribu<br />

na kusumbua <strong>wa</strong>le ambao ha<strong>wa</strong>jaanguka kamwe. K<strong>wa</strong> nia hii “amefung<strong>wa</strong>”. Hakuna<br />

anayebakia ambaye anaweza kutumia uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong>ke. Amekata k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

mudanganyifu na uharibifu ambayo iliku<strong>wa</strong> anasa <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> pekee.<br />

Isa<strong>ya</strong> alipoku<strong>wa</strong> akitazamia maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani, anapaza sauti: “Umeanguka toka<br />

mbinguni, namna gani, Ee, Lusifero, m<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> asubui! Umekat<strong>wa</strong> hata kufika udongo,<br />

Wewe uliyeangusha mataifa! Nawe ulisema moyoni m<strong>wa</strong>ko: Nitapanda mbinguni,<br />

nitan<strong>ya</strong>nyua kiti changu cha enzi juu kuliko nyota za Mungu: ... Nitafanana na Mkuu Sana.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong>ni hivi utashush<strong>wa</strong> mpaka Hadeze, K<strong>wa</strong> pande za mwisho za shimo. Wao <strong>wa</strong>naokuona<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takutazama k<strong>wa</strong> kubanua sana; <strong>wa</strong>takufikiria, <strong>wa</strong>kisema: Huyu ndiye mtu aliyetetemesha<br />

dunia, aliyetikisa <strong>wa</strong>falme; aliyefan<strong>ya</strong> dunia kama jang<strong>wa</strong>, na aliyeharibu miji <strong>ya</strong>ke; yule<br />

asiyefungua nyumba <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ke? Isa<strong>ya</strong> 14:12-17.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka 6000, nyumba <strong>ya</strong> gereza <strong>ya</strong> Shetani imepokea <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu,<br />

lakini Kristo amevunja vifungo v<strong>ya</strong>ke na kufungua <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong>. Peke <strong>ya</strong>ke pamoja na<br />

malaika <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>ovu anafahamu moyoni tokeo la zambi: “Wafalme wote <strong>wa</strong> mataifa, <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

wote <strong>wa</strong>nalala katika utukufu, Kila mmoja ndani <strong>ya</strong> nyumba <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe (kaburi);<br />

Lakini wewe umetup<strong>wa</strong> inje kutoka kaburi lako, Kama tawi linalochukiza... Hutaung<strong>wa</strong><br />

pamoja nao katika maziko: K<strong>wa</strong> sababu umeiharibu inchi <strong>ya</strong>ko, na kuua <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ko.” Isa<strong>ya</strong><br />

14:18-20. K<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka 1000, Shetani ataona matokeo <strong>ya</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong>ke juu <strong>ya</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu. Maumivu <strong>ya</strong>ke ni mingi sana. Sasa ameach<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kufikiri sana sehemu aliyofan<strong>ya</strong><br />

tangu alipoasi na kutazamia mbele k<strong>wa</strong> hofu kub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati ujao <strong>wa</strong> kutisha <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

atakapopash<strong>wa</strong> kuazibi<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

275


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mda <strong>wa</strong> miaka 1000 katikati <strong>ya</strong> ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza na <strong>wa</strong> pili, hukumu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu<br />

itafanyika. Paulo anaonyesha k<strong>wa</strong> hii kama tukio linalofuata kurudi k<strong>wa</strong> Yesu. 1 Wakorinto<br />

4:5. Wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>nata<strong>wa</strong>la kama <strong>wa</strong>falme na makuhani. Yoane anasema: “Nikaona viti<br />

v<strong>ya</strong> enzi, nao <strong>wa</strong>kakaa juu <strong>ya</strong>o vilevile, nao <strong>wa</strong>kape<strong>wa</strong> hukumu... Wataku<strong>wa</strong> makuhani <strong>wa</strong><br />

Mungu na <strong>wa</strong> Kristo, nao <strong>wa</strong>tata<strong>wa</strong>la pamoja naye miaka elfu”. Ufunuo 20:4-6.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati huu “<strong>wa</strong>takatifu <strong>wa</strong>tahukumu dunia”. 1 Wakorinto 6:2. K<strong>wa</strong> umoja na<br />

Kristo <strong>wa</strong>nahukumu <strong>wa</strong>ovu, kukata kila jambo kufuatana na matendo <strong>ya</strong>liyotend<strong>wa</strong> katika<br />

mwili. Ndipo sehemu ambayo <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>napas<strong>wa</strong> kutes<strong>wa</strong> nayo imetole<strong>wa</strong>, kufuatana na<br />

matendo <strong>ya</strong>o, na imeandik<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> majina <strong>ya</strong>o katika kitabu cha mauti.<br />

Shetani na malaika <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>mehukumi<strong>wa</strong> na Kristo na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Paulo anasema:<br />

“Hamujui <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba tuta<strong>wa</strong>hukumu malaika”? 1 Wakorinto 6:3. Yuda anatangaza: “Hata<br />

malaika <strong>wa</strong>siolinda enzi <strong>ya</strong>o giza k<strong>wa</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong> siku ile kub<strong>wa</strong>”. Yuda 6.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> miaka 1000, ufufuo <strong>wa</strong> pili utafanyika. Halafu <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>tafufuli<strong>wa</strong><br />

kutoka katika <strong>wa</strong>fu na kuonekana mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> utimilizo <strong>wa</strong> “hukumu<br />

iliyoandik<strong>wa</strong>”. Zaburi 149:9. Ndivyo Mfunuaji anasema: “Na <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>liobaki ha<strong>wa</strong>ku<strong>wa</strong> hai<br />

hata itimie ile miaka elfu”. Ufunuo 20:5. Na Isa<strong>ya</strong> anatangaza juu <strong>ya</strong> wenye zambi: “Nao<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takusany<strong>wa</strong> pamoja, kama vile kukusan<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fung<strong>wa</strong> katika shimo, na <strong>wa</strong>tafung<strong>wa</strong><br />

katika kifungo, na nyuma <strong>ya</strong> siku nyingi <strong>wa</strong>taangali<strong>wa</strong>”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 24:22.<br />

276


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Sura 42. Vita Imemalizika<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> mwisho <strong>wa</strong> miaka 1000, Kristo anarudi duniani akisindikiz<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong><br />

na jamii <strong>ya</strong> malaika. Anaagiza <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>toke kupokea maangamizi <strong>ya</strong>o. Wanatoka,<br />

wengi sana kama mchanga <strong>wa</strong> bahari, <strong>wa</strong>napoku<strong>wa</strong> na alama za ugonj<strong>wa</strong> na mauti. Tofauti<br />

namna gani k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liofufuka katika ufufuko <strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza!<br />

Macho yote inageuka kutazama utukufu <strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> sauti moja majeshi<br />

<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>napaza sauti: “Amebariki<strong>wa</strong> anayekuja k<strong>wa</strong> jina la B<strong>wa</strong>na”! Matayo 23:39. Si<br />

mapendo <strong>ya</strong>nayoongoza maneno ha<strong>ya</strong>. Nguvu <strong>ya</strong> kweli inalazimisha maneno kutoka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

midomo isiyotaka. Kama vile <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>livyokwenda katika makaburi, ndivyo hivyo<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafufuka pamoja na uadui <strong>wa</strong> namna moja k<strong>wa</strong> Kristo na roho <strong>ya</strong> namna ileile <strong>ya</strong> uasi.<br />

Ha<strong>wa</strong>tape<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> rehema mp<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> kuponyesha maisha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati uliopita.<br />

Nabii anasema: “Na miguu <strong>ya</strong>ke itasimama siku ile juu <strong>ya</strong> mlima <strong>wa</strong> Mzeituni, ... na<br />

Mlima <strong>wa</strong> Mzeituni utapasuka katikati <strong>ya</strong>ke”. Zakaria 14:4. Wakati Yerusalema mp<strong>ya</strong><br />

unaposhuka toka mbinguni, utapumzika k<strong>wa</strong> pahali palipota<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong>, na Kristo, pamoja na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke na malaika, <strong>wa</strong>naingia k<strong>wa</strong> mji mtakatifu.<br />

Wakati alipokat<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> kudangan<strong>ya</strong>, mta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong> uovu aliku<strong>wa</strong> maskini na<br />

mwenye huzuni, lakini k<strong>wa</strong> namna <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>napofufuka na anapoona makutano<br />

makub<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> upande <strong>wa</strong>ke, matumaini <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong>narudi. Anakusudia si kutokuacha vita<br />

kub<strong>wa</strong>. Atapanga <strong>wa</strong>potevu chini <strong>ya</strong> bendera <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> kukana Kristo <strong>wa</strong>mekubali amri <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwongozi m<strong>wa</strong>si, ta<strong>ya</strong>ri kufan<strong>ya</strong> mapenzi <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lakini, kweli k<strong>wa</strong> werevu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza, hakubali yeye mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong> Shetani. Anadai ku<strong>wa</strong> mwenyewe <strong>wa</strong>dunia <strong>wa</strong><br />

haki ambaye alin<strong>ya</strong>ngany<strong>wa</strong> uriti bila sheria.<br />

Anajionyesha mwenyewe kama mkombozi, kuhakikisha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>liodanganyi<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke ume<strong>wa</strong>leta kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> makaburi <strong>ya</strong>o. Shetani ana<strong>wa</strong>fan<strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zaifu<br />

ku<strong>wa</strong> wenye nguvu, na ku<strong>wa</strong>sukuma wote k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu zake mwenyewe ku<strong>wa</strong>ongoza<br />

kukamata makao <strong>ya</strong> mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Akatazama k<strong>wa</strong> mamilioni <strong>ya</strong>siyohesabika <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liofufuli<strong>wa</strong> kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>fu, na akatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba kama muongozi <strong>wa</strong>o anaweza<br />

kupata tena kiti chake chaenzi na ufalme.<br />

Katika makutano makub<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>ya</strong> kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na taifa lenye maisha marefu lile lililoishi<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> garika, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kimo kirefu sana na <strong>wa</strong> akili nyingi; <strong>wa</strong>tu ambao kazi zao za<br />

ajabu zikaongoza ulimwengu kuabudu akili zao, lakini mambo <strong>ya</strong> uvumbuzi <strong>wa</strong> ukali na<br />

uovu <strong>wa</strong>o ikafan<strong>ya</strong> Mungu ku<strong>wa</strong>haribu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> viumbe v<strong>ya</strong>ke. Pale kunaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme<br />

na <strong>wa</strong>jemadari <strong>wa</strong>sioshind<strong>wa</strong> kamwe k<strong>wa</strong> vita. Katika mauti ha<strong>wa</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong>kupata badiliko.<br />

Wanapotoka k<strong>wa</strong> kaburi, <strong>wa</strong>naendesh<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> tamaa <strong>ya</strong> namna ileile <strong>ya</strong> kushinda <strong>wa</strong>le<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lio<strong>wa</strong>ta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>lishind<strong>wa</strong>.<br />

Shambulio la Mwisho la Kumpinga Mungu<br />

277


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Shetani anashauriana pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu ku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong>. Wanatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba jeshi<br />

ndani <strong>ya</strong> mji ni ndogo k<strong>wa</strong> kulinganisha na la k<strong>wa</strong>o na linaweza kushind<strong>wa</strong>. Wafundi <strong>wa</strong><br />

ujuzi <strong>wa</strong>nafan<strong>ya</strong> vyombo v<strong>ya</strong> vita. Waongozi <strong>wa</strong> askari <strong>wa</strong>napanga <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> vita katika<br />

makundi na sehemu.<br />

Mwishoni agizo la kuendelea mbele linatole<strong>wa</strong>, na jeshi lisilohesabika likaendelea, jeshi<br />

ambalo nguvu zenye kuunganika za vizazi vyote hazikuweza kamwe ku<strong>wa</strong> sa<strong>wa</strong>. Shetani<br />

anaku<strong>wa</strong> mbele, <strong>wa</strong>falme na <strong>wa</strong>askari nao <strong>wa</strong>nafuata. K<strong>wa</strong> utaratibu <strong>wa</strong> kiaskari makundi<br />

katika mistari <strong>ya</strong>kaendelea mbele <strong>ya</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong> dunia iliyovunjika hata k<strong>wa</strong> Mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

K<strong>wa</strong> agizo la Yesu, milango <strong>ya</strong> Yerusalema Mp<strong>ya</strong> ikafung<strong>wa</strong>, na majeshi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani<br />

<strong>ya</strong>najita<strong>ya</strong>risha k<strong>wa</strong> kushambulia.<br />

Sasa Kristo anatokea kutazama adui zake. Mbali juu <strong>ya</strong> mji, juu <strong>ya</strong> msingi <strong>wa</strong> zahabu<br />

yenye kungaa, ni kiti cha enzi. Juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti hiki cha enzi M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu anakaa, na<br />

pembeni <strong>ya</strong>ke ni raia <strong>ya</strong> ufalme <strong>wa</strong>ke. Utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Baba <strong>wa</strong> Milele unamuzunguka M<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke. Kungaa k<strong>wa</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong>ke kunatoka juu <strong>ya</strong> milango, kujaza dunia na m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza.<br />

Karibu sana na kiti cha enzi kunaku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> zamani na bidii katika kazi <strong>ya</strong><br />

Shetani, lakini <strong>wa</strong>lipo ondosh<strong>wa</strong> kama vinga kutoka motoni, <strong>wa</strong>kafuata Mwokozi <strong>wa</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong><br />

bidii sana. Wanaofuata ni <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>liokamilisha tabia katikati <strong>ya</strong> uwongo na uasi,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>lioheshimu sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>limwengu <strong>wa</strong>lipoitangaza ku<strong>wa</strong> iliondole<strong>wa</strong>, na<br />

mamilioni, <strong>wa</strong> vizazi vyote, <strong>wa</strong>lioua<strong>wa</strong> kama <strong>wa</strong>fia dini k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> imani <strong>ya</strong>o. Mbali zaidi<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> “makutano makub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong>siyoweza mtu ku<strong>ya</strong>hesabu, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kila taifa, na<br />

kabila, na jamaa, na lugha, ... <strong>wa</strong>mevik<strong>wa</strong> mavazi myeupe, na matawi <strong>ya</strong> mitende katika<br />

mikono <strong>ya</strong>o”. Ufunuo 7:9 . Vita <strong>ya</strong>o imemalizika, ushindi <strong>wa</strong>o umepatikana. Tawi la ngazi<br />

linafananisha shangwe, nguo yeupe ni alama <strong>ya</strong> haki <strong>ya</strong> Kristo ambayo saa imeku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Katika msongano wote ule pale hakuna <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> kuhesabia wokovu k<strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe k<strong>wa</strong><br />

wema <strong>wa</strong>o wenyewe. Hakuna kitu kinachosem<strong>wa</strong> cha kile <strong>wa</strong>lichoteseka nacho; sauti <strong>ya</strong><br />

msingi <strong>ya</strong> kila wimbo <strong>wa</strong> sifa ni, Wokovu k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu wetu na k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo.<br />

Hukumu Inatangaz<strong>wa</strong> Juu <strong>ya</strong> Waasi<br />

Mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kaaji <strong>wa</strong>liokusanyika <strong>wa</strong> dunia na <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni k<strong>wa</strong> mkutano na kuviik<strong>wa</strong><br />

taji k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na <strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Na sasa, kuvik<strong>wa</strong> mamlaka makub<strong>wa</strong> na uwezo, Mfalme <strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>falme anatangaza hukumu juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>asi <strong>wa</strong>liovunja sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke na kutesa <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

“Nikaona kiti cha enzi, kikub<strong>wa</strong>, cheupe, naye anayeketi juu <strong>ya</strong>ke, dunia na mbingu<br />

zikakimbia uso <strong>wa</strong>ke; na pahali pao hapakuonekana. Nikaona <strong>wa</strong>fu, <strong>wa</strong>kub<strong>wa</strong> na <strong>wa</strong>dogo,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>mesimama mbele <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, na vitabu vikafunuli<strong>wa</strong>; na kitabu kingine kikafunguli<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

kilicho cha uzima; na <strong>wa</strong>fu <strong>wa</strong>kahukumi<strong>wa</strong> katika mambo ha<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong>liyoandik<strong>wa</strong> katika vile<br />

vitabu, sa<strong>wa</strong>sa<strong>wa</strong> na matendo <strong>ya</strong>o”. Ufunuo 20:11, 12.<br />

Wakati jicho la Yesu linapoangalia juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu, <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na ufahamu <strong>wa</strong> kila zambi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liyoitenda. Wanaona pahali miguu <strong>ya</strong>o ilipoacha njia <strong>ya</strong> utakatifu. Majaribu <strong>ya</strong> kuvuta<br />

278


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

ambayo <strong>wa</strong>liimarisha k<strong>wa</strong> anasa katika zambi, <strong>wa</strong>jumbe <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>liozarauli<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

maonyo <strong>ya</strong>liyokatali<strong>wa</strong>, mawimbi <strong>ya</strong> rehema <strong>ya</strong>liyorudish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ukaidi, moyo usiotubu--<br />

yote inaonekana kama <strong>ya</strong>meandik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maandiko <strong>ya</strong> moto.<br />

Juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi kunafunuli<strong>wa</strong> msalaba. K<strong>wa</strong> maoni kamili kukatokea mambo <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuanguka k<strong>wa</strong> Adamu na hatua za kufuatana katika shauri la wokovu. Kuzali<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong><br />

unyenyekevu k<strong>wa</strong> Mwokozi; maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> ka<strong>wa</strong>ida; ubatizo <strong>wa</strong>ke katika Yorodani;<br />

kufunga na majaribu katika jang<strong>wa</strong>; huduma <strong>ya</strong>ke kufunua k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu mibaraka <strong>ya</strong><br />

mbinguni; siku zilizojaa na matendo <strong>ya</strong> rehema, usiku <strong>wa</strong> kukesha katika maombi kule<br />

milimani; mashauri <strong>ya</strong> hila <strong>ya</strong> tamaa na uovu ambayo <strong>ya</strong>lilipa faida zake; maumivu makali<br />

<strong>ya</strong> siri katika Getesemane chini <strong>ya</strong> uzito <strong>wa</strong> zambi za ulimwengu; usaliti <strong>wa</strong>ke k<strong>wa</strong> kundi la<br />

<strong>wa</strong>uaji, matukio <strong>ya</strong> usiku ule <strong>wa</strong> kitisho kikuu-mfung<strong>wa</strong> asiyeshindana aliyeach<strong>wa</strong> na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke, aliyeshitaki<strong>wa</strong> katika jumba la kuhani mkuu, katika chumba kikub<strong>wa</strong> cha<br />

hukumu cha Pilato, mbele <strong>ya</strong> Herode mwenye hofu, aliyechekele<strong>wa</strong>, kutukan<strong>wa</strong>, kutes<strong>wa</strong>,<br />

na kuhukumi<strong>wa</strong> kufa--yote <strong>ya</strong>naelez<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Na sasa mbele <strong>ya</strong> makutano <strong>ya</strong>liyo<strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong><strong>wa</strong><strong>ya</strong> maoni <strong>ya</strong> mwisho <strong>ya</strong>nafunuli<strong>wa</strong>; Mtes<strong>wa</strong>ji<br />

mvumulivu akakan<strong>ya</strong>nga njia <strong>ya</strong> Kalvari; Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni kutundik<strong>wa</strong> msalabani;<br />

makuhani na <strong>wa</strong>limu <strong>wa</strong>kachekelea maumivu makali <strong>ya</strong> kukata roho <strong>ya</strong>ke; giza kub<strong>wa</strong> sana<br />

kuonyesha <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong>kati Mkombozi <strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu alipotoa maisha <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Ajabu <strong>ya</strong> kutisha inaonekana kama tu ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong>. Shetani na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke ha<strong>wa</strong>na uwezo<br />

<strong>wa</strong> kugeuza na kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> picha. Yeyote aliyehusika k<strong>wa</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> tendo anakumbuka<br />

sehemu aliyoifan<strong>ya</strong>. Herode, aliye<strong>wa</strong>ua <strong>wa</strong>toto <strong>wa</strong>sioku<strong>wa</strong> na kosa <strong>wa</strong> Betelehemu; chanzo<br />

Herodias, ambaye juu <strong>ya</strong> nafsi <strong>ya</strong>ke kunadumu damu <strong>ya</strong> Yoane Mtabizaji; mzaifu, Pilato<br />

mwenye kulinda <strong>wa</strong>kati; askari wenye kuchekelea; msongano <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenye <strong>wa</strong>zimu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liopaaza sauti, “damu <strong>ya</strong>ke na iwe juu yetu, na juu <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>toto wetu”! --kutafuta namna<br />

yote bila kuweza kujificha kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> uso <strong>wa</strong>ke Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>kati<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>napotupa taji zao k<strong>wa</strong> miguu <strong>ya</strong> Mwokozi, kuapaaza sauti, “Alikufa<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong>ngu”!<br />

Hapo kuna Neno, mkatili mkali na muovu, kutazama utukufu <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le alio<strong>wa</strong>tesa na k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maumuvu <strong>ya</strong>o akapata furaha <strong>ya</strong> kishetani. Mama <strong>ya</strong>ke anashuhudia kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke mwenyewe,<br />

namna gani tamaa alizoendelesha na mvuto <strong>wa</strong>ke na mfano zimezaa matunda katika mauaji<br />

<strong>ya</strong>liyoletea dunia kutetemeka.<br />

Hapo kunaku<strong>wa</strong> mapadri <strong>wa</strong> Papa na maaskofu <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong> mabalozi <strong>wa</strong> Kristo,<br />

huku <strong>wa</strong>lipoku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kitumia mbao zenye v<strong>ya</strong>ngo v<strong>ya</strong> kutundikia <strong>wa</strong>tu, gereza, na kigingi<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> kuta<strong>wa</strong>la <strong>wa</strong>tu Wake. Hapo panaku<strong>wa</strong> maaskofu wenye kiburi <strong>wa</strong>liojiinua wenyewe<br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>wa</strong>kasubutu kugeuza sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu Aliye juu. Wale <strong>wa</strong>liojidai ku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>baba <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na hesabu <strong>ya</strong> kutoa k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. K<strong>wa</strong> mda kitambo unapopita<br />

<strong>wa</strong>mefany<strong>wa</strong> kuona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mwenye Kujua yote anaku<strong>wa</strong> na wivu <strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

279


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Wanajifunza sasa <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Kristo anatambua faida zake pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naoteseka.<br />

Ulimwengu mzima wenye uovu unasimama k<strong>wa</strong>kushitaki k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> maasi makub<strong>wa</strong><br />

juu <strong>ya</strong> kupinga serkali <strong>ya</strong> mbinguni. Ha<strong>wa</strong>na yeyote k<strong>wa</strong> kutetea maneno <strong>ya</strong>o; ha<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

sababu yo yote; na hukumu <strong>ya</strong> mauti <strong>ya</strong> milele inatangaz<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong>o.<br />

Waovu <strong>wa</strong>naona kile <strong>wa</strong>lichopote<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> sababu <strong>ya</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong>o. “Yote hii”, nafsi<br />

iliyopotea inalia, “ningaliweza ku<strong>wa</strong> nayo, Ee, upumbafu <strong>wa</strong> namna gani! nimebadili amani,<br />

furaha, na heshima k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uba<strong>ya</strong>, sifa mba<strong>ya</strong>, na kukata tamaa”. Wote <strong>wa</strong>naona <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>mba kufukuz<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>o mbinguni ni k<strong>wa</strong> haki. Katika maisha <strong>ya</strong>o <strong>wa</strong>metangaza:<br />

“Hatuwezi ku<strong>wa</strong> na mtu huyu (Yesu) kuta<strong>wa</strong>la juu yetu”.<br />

Shetani Ameshind<strong>wa</strong><br />

Kama vile katika bumbuanzi <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>natazama ibada <strong>ya</strong> kuvik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> taji k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na<br />

<strong>wa</strong> Mungu. Wanaona mikononi m<strong>wa</strong>ke mbao za sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>lizozizarau.<br />

Wanashuhudia nguvu <strong>ya</strong> ibada kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong>; na kama wimbi la sauti za<br />

nyimbo zinapoenea k<strong>wa</strong> makutano inje <strong>ya</strong> mji, wote <strong>wa</strong>napaaza sauti, “Haki na kweli ndizo<br />

njia zako, wewe Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu”. Ufunuo 15:3. K<strong>wa</strong> kuanguka na kumusujudu,<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kamuabudu mfalme <strong>wa</strong> uzima.<br />

Shetani anaonekana kama anahangaika. Mara kerubi <strong>wa</strong> kufunika, anakumbuka mahali<br />

gani ameanguka. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> baraza pahali alipoheshimi<strong>wa</strong> zamani ameondole<strong>wa</strong> milele.<br />

Anaona sasa mwingine anayesimama karibu <strong>ya</strong> Baba, malaika <strong>wa</strong> umbo lenye utukufu.<br />

Anajua <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba cheo cha malaika huyu kingeweza ku<strong>wa</strong> chake.<br />

Ufahamu unakumbuka makao <strong>ya</strong> hali <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> usafi, amani na kutoshele<strong>wa</strong> ilivyoku<strong>wa</strong><br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke mpaka <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong>ke. Anakumbuka kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke miongoni m<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu na matokeo<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke--uadui <strong>wa</strong> mtu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu wenzake, maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong> maisha, kupinduka k<strong>wa</strong><br />

viti v<strong>ya</strong> enzi, makelele, vita, na mapinduzi. Anakumbuka bidii zake za daima k<strong>wa</strong> kupinga<br />

kazi <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Anapoangalia matunda <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke anaona tu kushind<strong>wa</strong>. Mara k<strong>wa</strong> mara<br />

katika maedeleo <strong>ya</strong> vita kuu ameku<strong>wa</strong> akishind<strong>wa</strong> na kulazimish<strong>wa</strong> kuacha.<br />

Kusudi la muasi mkuu liliku<strong>wa</strong> daima kuhakikisha ku<strong>wa</strong> serkali <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ndiyo<br />

msimamizi <strong>wa</strong> uasi. Ameongoza makundi mengi kukubali maelezo <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> maelfu <strong>ya</strong><br />

miaka mkuu huyu <strong>wa</strong> mapatano <strong>ya</strong> kufan<strong>ya</strong> maba<strong>ya</strong> ameficha uwongo ku<strong>wa</strong> haki. Lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>kati umefika sasa <strong>wa</strong>kati historia na tabia <strong>ya</strong> Shetani zitakapofunuli<strong>wa</strong>. Katika juhudi<br />

<strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> mwisho k<strong>wa</strong> kuondoa Kristo k<strong>wa</strong> kiti cha enzi, kuharibu <strong>wa</strong>tu Wake, na kukamata<br />

makao <strong>ya</strong> Mji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, mshawishi mkub<strong>wa</strong> amekwisha kufunuli<strong>wa</strong> kabisa. Wale<br />

<strong>wa</strong>liojiunga naye <strong>wa</strong>naona kushind<strong>wa</strong> kabisa k<strong>wa</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

280


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Shetani anaona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba uasi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong> mapenzi haukumstahilisha kuingia mbinguni.<br />

Amezoeza nguvu zake k<strong>wa</strong> vita kumpinga Mungu; usafi na umoja <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni ungeku<strong>wa</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>ke mateso makub<strong>wa</strong>. Anainama chini na kukubali haki <strong>ya</strong> hukumu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Kila s<strong>wa</strong>li la kweli na kosa katika mashindano <strong>ya</strong> siku nyingi limefany<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi sasa.<br />

Matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kuweka pembeni sheria za Mungu <strong>ya</strong>mewek<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi mbele <strong>ya</strong> macho <strong>ya</strong><br />

viumbe vyote. Historia <strong>ya</strong> zambi itasimama milele k<strong>wa</strong> wote kama ushuhuda <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba<br />

pamoja na ku<strong>wa</strong>ko k<strong>wa</strong> sheria <strong>ya</strong> Mungu kunafung<strong>wa</strong> furaha <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vyote<br />

alivyoviumba. Viumbe vyote, v<strong>ya</strong> uaminifu na vyenye uasi, k<strong>wa</strong> mapatano pamoja<br />

vinatangaza, “Haki na kweli njia zako, wewe Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>takatifu”.<br />

Saa imefika <strong>wa</strong>kati Kristo anapash<strong>wa</strong> kutukuz<strong>wa</strong> juu <strong>ya</strong> kila jina linalotaj<strong>wa</strong>. K<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong> furaha inayowek<strong>wa</strong> mbele <strong>ya</strong>ke--<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba aliweza kuleta <strong>wa</strong>na wengi katika utukufu--<br />

akavumilia msalaba. Anaangalia k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong>, <strong>wa</strong>liofany<strong>wa</strong> up<strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

mwenyewe. Anatazama ndani <strong>ya</strong>o matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kazi <strong>ya</strong> roho <strong>ya</strong>ke, na anatoshele<strong>wa</strong>. Isa<strong>ya</strong><br />

53:11. K<strong>wa</strong> sauti ambayo ina<strong>wa</strong>fikia makutano, wenye haki na <strong>wa</strong>ovu, anatangaza:<br />

“Tazama biashara <strong>wa</strong> damu <strong>ya</strong>ngu! K<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong> niliteseka, k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> ha<strong>wa</strong><br />

nilikufa”.<br />

Mwisho Mkali Sana <strong>wa</strong> Waovu<br />

Tabia <strong>ya</strong> Shetani inaendelea bila kubadilika. Uasi kama maji mengi yenye kupita k<strong>wa</strong><br />

nguvu tena <strong>ya</strong>mejipenyeza k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu. Anakusudia kutoacha vita yenye kukata tamaa <strong>ya</strong><br />

mwisho <strong>ya</strong> kupambana na Mfalme <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni. Lakini k<strong>wa</strong> mamilioni isiyohesabika yote<br />

ambayo aliyoshawishi katika uasi, hakuna anayekubali sasa mamlaka <strong>ya</strong>ke. Waovu<br />

<strong>wa</strong>mejaz<strong>wa</strong> na uchuki <strong>wa</strong> namna moja k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu unaoongoz<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani, lakini<br />

<strong>wa</strong>naona <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba hoja lao halina matumaini. “K<strong>wa</strong> sababu umeweka moyo <strong>wa</strong>ko kama<br />

moyo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, k<strong>wa</strong> hivi, tazama, nitaleta <strong>wa</strong>geni juu <strong>ya</strong>ko, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> mataifa wenye<br />

kuogopesha, na <strong>wa</strong>tachomoa panga zao juu <strong>ya</strong> uzuri <strong>wa</strong> hekima <strong>ya</strong>ko, nao <strong>wa</strong>tatia uchafu<br />

kungaa k<strong>wa</strong>ko. Watakuleta chini k<strong>wa</strong> shimo. ... nitakuharibu, Ee kerubi la kufunika, kutoka<br />

katikati <strong>ya</strong> mawe <strong>ya</strong> moto... nitakutupa hata inchi, nitakulaza mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>falme, <strong>wa</strong>pate<br />

kukuona ... nitakufan<strong>ya</strong> ku<strong>wa</strong> majivu juu <strong>ya</strong> inchi mbele <strong>ya</strong> wote <strong>wa</strong>naokutazama ...<br />

utaku<strong>wa</strong> maogopesho, <strong>wa</strong>la hutaku<strong>wa</strong> tena hata milele”. Ezekieli 28:6-8, 16-19.<br />

“Maana kasirani kali <strong>ya</strong> B<strong>wa</strong>na ni juu <strong>ya</strong> mataifa yote”. “Atanyeshea <strong>wa</strong>ovu mitego;<br />

Moto na kiberiti na upepo <strong>wa</strong> kuchoma zitaku<strong>wa</strong> fungu la kikombe chao”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 34:2;<br />

Zaburi 11:6. Moto utashuka kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> Mungu mbinguni. Dunia itaharibika. Miako <strong>ya</strong><br />

moto unaoteketeza inatoka k<strong>wa</strong> nguvu kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> kila shimo kub<strong>wa</strong> linaloku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>zi.<br />

Miamba halisi inaku<strong>wa</strong> motoni. Na viumbe v<strong>ya</strong> asili vitayeyush<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> moto mkali, na<br />

inchi na kazi zilizo ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke zitateketea. 2 Petro 3:10. Uso <strong>wa</strong> dunia utaonekana kama<br />

fungu moja kub<strong>wa</strong> lililoyeyuka--, zi<strong>wa</strong> la moto lililochafuka. Maana ni “siku <strong>ya</strong> kisasi cha<br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na, m<strong>wa</strong>ka <strong>wa</strong> malipo, k<strong>wa</strong> ubishi <strong>wa</strong> Sayuni”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 34:8.<br />

281


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Waovu <strong>wa</strong>naazibi<strong>wa</strong> “kama ilivyo kazi <strong>ya</strong>o”. Shetani atates<strong>wa</strong> si k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> uasi <strong>wa</strong>ke<br />

pekee, bali k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> zambi zote alizozilazimisha <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu kuzitenda. Katika<br />

ndimi za moto <strong>wa</strong>ovu <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> maangamizi <strong>ya</strong> mwisho, shina na matawi-Shetani ni<br />

shina lenyewe na <strong>wa</strong>fuasi <strong>wa</strong>ke ni matawi. Azabu kamili <strong>ya</strong> sheria ilijili<strong>wa</strong>; matak<strong>wa</strong> <strong>ya</strong><br />

haki <strong>ya</strong>metimiz<strong>wa</strong>. Kazi <strong>ya</strong> Shetani <strong>ya</strong> uharibifu imekomesh<strong>wa</strong> milele. Sasa viumbe v<strong>ya</strong><br />

Mungu vimekombole<strong>wa</strong> milele k<strong>wa</strong> majaribu <strong>ya</strong>ke.<br />

Wakati dunia inapofunik<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> moto, wenye haki <strong>wa</strong>nakaa k<strong>wa</strong> salama ndani <strong>ya</strong> Mji<br />

Mutakatifu. Wakati Mungu anaku<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ovu kama moto unaoteketeza, anaku<strong>wa</strong> ngao<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke. Tazama Ufunuo 20:6; Zaburi 84:11.<br />

“Nikaona mbingu mp<strong>ya</strong> na dunia mp<strong>ya</strong>; k<strong>wa</strong> maana mbingu za k<strong>wa</strong>nza na dunia <strong>ya</strong><br />

k<strong>wa</strong>nza zimekwisha kupita”. Ufunuo 21:1. Moto utakaoteketeza <strong>wa</strong>ovu utasafisha dunia.<br />

Kila alama <strong>ya</strong> laana imeondole<strong>wa</strong> mbali. Hakuna jehanum inayo<strong>wa</strong>ka milele itakayoendelea<br />

mbele <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> matokeo <strong>ya</strong> kutisha <strong>ya</strong> zambi.<br />

Kumbusho <strong>ya</strong> Kusulubi<strong>wa</strong><br />

Ukumbusho moja peke unaodumu: Mkombozi wetu atachukua hata milele alama za<br />

kusulubi<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>ke, alama pekee za kazi <strong>ya</strong> ukali ambazo zambi imetenda. Katika miaka <strong>ya</strong><br />

milele vidonda v<strong>ya</strong> Kalvari vitaendelea kuonyesha sifa <strong>ya</strong>ke na vitatangaza uwezo <strong>wa</strong>ke.<br />

Kristo alihakikishia <strong>wa</strong>nafunzi <strong>wa</strong>ke <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba alikwenda kuandalia makao k<strong>wa</strong> ajili<br />

<strong>ya</strong>o katika nyumba <strong>ya</strong> Baba <strong>ya</strong>ke. Lugha <strong>wa</strong>la maneno <strong>ya</strong> binadamu ha<strong>ya</strong>toshi kueleza<br />

za<strong>wa</strong>di <strong>ya</strong> wenye haki. Itajulikana tu k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>le <strong>wa</strong>naoitazama. Hakuna <strong>wa</strong>zo lenye mpaka<br />

linaloweza kufahamu utukufu <strong>wa</strong> Paradiso <strong>ya</strong> Mungu!<br />

Katika Biblia uriti <strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> unait<strong>wa</strong> “inchi”. Waebrania 11:14-16. Huko<br />

Mchungaji <strong>wa</strong> mbinguni ataongoza kundi lake k<strong>wa</strong> chemchemi za maji <strong>ya</strong> uzima. Huko<br />

kunaku<strong>wa</strong> na vijito vyenye kutiririka, safi kama jiwe lingaalo, na pembeni <strong>ya</strong>o miti yenye<br />

kutikisika inayotupa vivuli v<strong>ya</strong>o k<strong>wa</strong> njia zilizota<strong>ya</strong>rish<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> ajili <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong><br />

B<strong>wa</strong>na. Inchi kub<strong>wa</strong> tambarere zinainuka ku<strong>wa</strong> vilima v<strong>ya</strong> uzuri, na milima <strong>ya</strong> Mungu<br />

inapandisha vilele v<strong>ya</strong>o virefu. Katika inchi tambarare hizo za amani, pembeni <strong>ya</strong> vijito<br />

hivyo v<strong>ya</strong> uzima, <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu, <strong>wa</strong>lioku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>safiri na <strong>wa</strong>naohangaika <strong>wa</strong>tapata makao.<br />

“Nao <strong>wa</strong>tajenga nyumba, na kukaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke; na <strong>wa</strong>tapanda mizabibu, na <strong>wa</strong>takula<br />

matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke: ha<strong>wa</strong>tajenga na mtu mwingine kukaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke; ha<strong>wa</strong>tapanda, na mtu<br />

mwingine kula matunda <strong>ya</strong>ke: ... Na <strong>wa</strong>chaguli<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>ngu <strong>wa</strong>tafurahia kazi <strong>ya</strong> mikono <strong>ya</strong>o”.<br />

“Jang<strong>wa</strong> na inchi kavu zitafurahi; na jang<strong>wa</strong> litashangilia na kutoa maua kama <strong>wa</strong>ridi”. “Na<br />

imb<strong>wa</strong> mwitu atakaa pamoja na m<strong>wa</strong>na-kondoo, na chui atalala chini pamoja na m<strong>wa</strong>nambuzi;<br />

na mtoto mudogo ata<strong>wa</strong>ongoza... Ha<strong>wa</strong>taumiza <strong>wa</strong>la kuharibu wote katika mulima<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ngu wote mtakatifu”. Isa<strong>ya</strong> 65:21, 22; 35:1; 11:6,9.<br />

282


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Maumivu ha<strong>ya</strong>wezi ku<strong>wa</strong>ko mbinguni. Hakutaku<strong>wa</strong> na machozi tena, Hakutaku<strong>wa</strong> tena<br />

mafuatano <strong>ya</strong> maziko. “Wala mauti haitaku<strong>wa</strong> tena; <strong>wa</strong>la maombolezo, <strong>wa</strong>la kilio: ... k<strong>wa</strong><br />

maana maneno <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>nza <strong>ya</strong>mekwisha kupita”. “Wala hapana mwenyeji atakayesema,<br />

mimi ni mgonj<strong>wa</strong>; <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>naokaa ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke <strong>wa</strong>tasamehe<strong>wa</strong> uovu <strong>wa</strong>o”. Ufunuo 21:4;<br />

Isa<strong>ya</strong> 33:24.<br />

Huko ni Yerusalema Mp<strong>ya</strong>, muji mkub<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> inchi mp<strong>ya</strong> yenye utukufu. “M<strong>wa</strong>ngaza<br />

<strong>wa</strong>ke uliku<strong>wa</strong> mfano <strong>wa</strong> jiwe la bei kub<strong>wa</strong>, kama jiwe la <strong>ya</strong>spi, safi kama bilauri”. “Na<br />

mataifa <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liookole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tatembea katika nuru <strong>ya</strong>ke. Na <strong>wa</strong>falme <strong>wa</strong> dunia <strong>wa</strong>taleta<br />

utukufu na heshima <strong>ya</strong>o ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke”. “Tazama hema <strong>ya</strong> Mungu ni pamoja na <strong>wa</strong>tu, naye<br />

atakaa pamoja nao, nao <strong>wa</strong>taku<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tu <strong>wa</strong>ke, na Mungu mwenyewe ataku<strong>wa</strong> pamoja nao,<br />

na ataku<strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>o”. Ufunuo 21:11,24,3.<br />

Ndani <strong>ya</strong> Muji <strong>wa</strong> Mungu “<strong>wa</strong>la hautaku<strong>wa</strong> usiku tena”. Ufunuo 22:5. Hautaku<strong>wa</strong><br />

kuchoka tena. Tutaona ubaridi daima <strong>wa</strong> asubui bila mwisho <strong>wa</strong>ke. Nuru <strong>ya</strong> jua itatanguli<strong>wa</strong><br />

na m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza <strong>wa</strong> ajabu ambao si <strong>wa</strong> kuumiza, lakini ambao unapita mbali sana m<strong>wa</strong>ngaza<br />

<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>kati <strong>wa</strong> saa sita yetu. Waliookole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>tatembea katika utukufu <strong>wa</strong> siku zote.<br />

“Nami sikuona hekalu ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke, k<strong>wa</strong> maana B<strong>wa</strong>na Mungu Mwenyezi na M<strong>wa</strong>na-<br />

Kondoo ndio hekalu lake”. Ufunuo 21:22. Watu <strong>wa</strong> Mungu <strong>wa</strong>naku<strong>wa</strong> na ruhusa <strong>ya</strong><br />

kuendelea ku<strong>wa</strong> na umoja <strong>wa</strong>zi na Baba na M<strong>wa</strong>na. Sasa tunaangalia mufano <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

kama katika kioo, lakini ndipo tutamwona uso k<strong>wa</strong> uso, pasipo pazia <strong>ya</strong> giza katikati.<br />

Ushindi <strong>wa</strong> Upendo <strong>wa</strong> Mungu<br />

Huko upendo na huruma ambavyo Mungu mwenyewe alivyopanda katika roho <strong>ya</strong>tapata<br />

mazoezi <strong>ya</strong> kweli na mazuri kabisa. Umoja ulio safi pamoja na viumbe vitakatifu na<br />

<strong>wa</strong>aminifu <strong>wa</strong> vizazi vyote, vifungo takatifu vinavyofunga pamoja “jamaa lote mbinguni na<br />

duniani”--hivi vinasaidia kuanzisha furaha <strong>ya</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong>. Waefeso 3:15.<br />

Huko, akili <strong>ya</strong> kuishi milele zitatazama sana na furaha <strong>ya</strong> milele maajabu <strong>ya</strong> uwezo <strong>wa</strong><br />

uumbaji, siri za upendo <strong>wa</strong> ukombozi. Kila akili itakuz<strong>wa</strong>, kila uwezo <strong>wa</strong> kufahamu<br />

utaongez<strong>wa</strong>. Upataji <strong>wa</strong> maarifa hautaondoa utendaji. Mambo makub<strong>wa</strong> sana <strong>ya</strong>taendesh<strong>wa</strong><br />

mbele, tamaa za juu sana zitafiki<strong>wa</strong>, tamaa za nguvu zitatimilika. Na tena hapo kutatokea<br />

vimo vip<strong>ya</strong> v<strong>ya</strong> kushinda, maajabu map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kushangaa, kweli mp<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kufahamu,<br />

makusudi map<strong>ya</strong> <strong>ya</strong> kuita nguvu za akili na roho na mwili.<br />

Mali yote <strong>ya</strong> ulimwengu itafunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong> Mungu.<br />

Wanapofunguli<strong>wa</strong> k<strong>wa</strong> mauti, <strong>wa</strong>taruka bila kuchoka k<strong>wa</strong> dunia za mbali. Watoto <strong>wa</strong> dunia<br />

<strong>wa</strong>taingia katika furaha na hekima <strong>ya</strong> viumbe vile havikuanguka na kuga<strong>wa</strong>n<strong>ya</strong> hazina za<br />

maarifa <strong>ya</strong>liyopatikana kupitia vizazi k<strong>wa</strong> vizazi. Pamoja na ndoto isiyo na giza <strong>wa</strong>tatazama<br />

k<strong>wa</strong> utukufu <strong>wa</strong> uumbaji--jua na nyota na mambo yote, yote katika utaratibu <strong>wa</strong>o<br />

ulioagiz<strong>wa</strong> kuzunguka kiti cha enzi cha Mungu.<br />

283


<strong>Hadithi</strong> <strong>wa</strong> <strong>Kiroho</strong> <strong>ya</strong> <strong>Miji</strong> <strong>Miwili</strong><br />

Na miaka <strong>ya</strong> milele, kama inavyopita upesi, italeta daima na zaidi mambo <strong>ya</strong> funuo<br />

tukufu <strong>ya</strong> Mungu na <strong>ya</strong> Kristo. Watu <strong>wa</strong>takavyojifunza zaidi habari <strong>ya</strong> Mungu, ndivyo zaidi<br />

<strong>wa</strong>takayoshangaa juu <strong>ya</strong> tabia <strong>ya</strong>ke. K<strong>wa</strong> namna Yesu atakavyofunua mbele <strong>ya</strong>o utajiri <strong>wa</strong><br />

ukombozi na kazi bora za kushangaza katika mashindano makub<strong>wa</strong> na Shetani, mioyo <strong>ya</strong><br />

<strong>wa</strong>liokombole<strong>wa</strong> <strong>wa</strong>nafurahi sana na kufan<strong>ya</strong> ibada, na sauti elfu kumi mara elfu kumi<br />

zinaungana kuongeza nguvu la itikio la wimbo <strong>wa</strong> sifa.<br />

“Na kila kiumbe kilicho mbinguni na juu <strong>ya</strong> dunia na chini <strong>ya</strong> dunia na vile ndani <strong>ya</strong><br />

bahari, na vyote vilivyo ndani <strong>ya</strong>ke, nilivisikia, vikisema: Baraka na heshima na utukufu na<br />

uwezo k<strong>wa</strong> yeye anayeketi juu <strong>ya</strong> kiti cha enzi, na k<strong>wa</strong> M<strong>wa</strong>na-Kondoo hata milele na<br />

milele”. Ufunuo 5:13.<br />

Vita kuu imekoma. Zambi na wenye zambi ha<strong>wa</strong>ko tena. Ulimwengu wote mzima ni<br />

safi. K<strong>wa</strong> Yeye aliyeumba vyote, kunajaa uzima na nuru na furaha po pote katika ufalme za<br />

anga pasipo mpaka. Kutoka k<strong>wa</strong> chembe ndogo hata k<strong>wa</strong> ulimwengu mkub<strong>wa</strong> sana, vitu<br />

vyote, vyenye uhai na vitu visivyoku<strong>wa</strong> na uhai, katika uzuri <strong>wa</strong>o pasipo kivuli na furaha<br />

kamili, vitatangaza <strong>ya</strong> k<strong>wa</strong>mba Mungu ni upendo.<br />

284


Kungojea Mwisho

Hooray! Your file is uploaded and ready to be published.

Saved successfully!

Ooh no, something went wrong!